Music Theory for the 21st-Century Classroom Music Theory for the 21st-Century Classroom Robert Hutchinson University of Puget Sound August 17, 2020 Website: musictheory.pugetsound.edu ©2017 Robert Hutchinson Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the appendix entitled “GNU Free Documentation License.” Acknowledgements I owe a huge thanks to Robert Beezer for recommending PreTeXt (formerly “MathBook XML”) as a means to author Music Theory for the 21st–Century Classroom. His work creating the “world” of PreTeXt made it easier than I could have imagined to create this text in all its forms (online, PDF, and print). Also of incredible value, and without whom this text would not exist, is Jahrme Risner, who helped me wrap my head around the nitty gritty of PreTeXt and patiently coached me through entering commands in the terminal. I wish to thank my colleague, Gwynne Kuhner Brown, for co–piloting the use of this text at the University of Puget Sound and for suggesting extremely helpful clarifications and corrections. Finally, I must thank my wife, Dawn Padula, Director of Vocal Studies at the University of Puget Sound and musician extraordinaire, for entertaining my endless questions about my choices for musical examples and the clarity of explanations and diagrams. v Preface Music Theory for the 21st–Century Classroom is an openly–licensed online four–semester college music theory textbook. This text differs from other music theory textbooks by focusing less on four–part (SATB) voiceleading and more on relating harmony to the phrase. Also, in traditional music theory textbooks, there is little emphasis on motivic analysis and analysis of melodic units smaller than the phrase. In my opinion, this led to students having difficulty with creating melodies, since the training they are given is typically to write a “melody” in quarter notes in the soprano voice of part writing exercises. When the assignments in those texts ask students to do more than this, the majority of the students struggle to create a melody with continuity and with appropriate placement of harmonies within a phrase because the text had not prepared them to do so. In Music Theory for the 21st–Century Classroom, students learn about motive, fragment, phrase, and subphrase, as well as types of melodic alteration like inversion, intervallic change, augmentation, diminution, rhythmic change, ornamentation, extension, and retrograde. By understanding motive and subphrase (also known as “phrase segment” or “phrase member”), I believe students will better understand the logic and construction of melodies, which will aid them in creating their own music. This text is meant to take the student from the basics of reading and writing pitches and rhythms through twelve–tone technique and minimalism over the course of four semesters. Whenever possible, examples from popular music and music from film and musical theater are included to illustrate melodic and harmonic concepts, usually within the context of the phrase. Performances of notated examples are linked to legal, copyrighted YouTube videos with the start and stop time embedded to prevent the instructor the need to search for the passage. The online nature of the text allows links between related concepts (including the index) as well as to relevant pages on the internet. While I have considered creating a unique curriculum for the theory program at my university since 2001, the impetus to create an online music theory textbook that could be of use not only to my students but to students at other colleges came from reading “Transforming Music Study from its Foundations: A Manifesto for Progressive Change in the Undergraduate Preparation of Music Majors” by the College Music Society’s Task Force on the Undergraduate Music Major. The ideas in “the Manifesto,” as it is often called—that colleges need to train students to be composer–performer–improvisers (and I would add “arrangers”) like Bach and Beethoven as well as Charlie Parker and Jimmy Page—resonated with my musical experience growing up, which included writing, arranging, and playing popular music on electric guitar, electric bass, vi vii keyboards, and drumset in high school—both in my uncle’s home recording studio and with a garage band I formed. It also resonated with my experiences playing jazz and fusion as a professional bassist ever since I was in college, a situation where the majority of the basslines I play are improvised from lead-sheet symbols. My Ph.D. is in composition with a supporting area in music theory. I teach students to write motets and fugues in the upper–division counterpoint class. I believe in compositional craft. I also acknowledge that there are many things one can value in music, including lyrics, groove, production, texture, emotion, harmony, virtuosity, and intellect, to name a few. In this textbook I try to cover as many as possible of these items that relate to how music is made and how understanding can enrich one’s experience. Robert Hutchinson Tacoma, Washington 2017 Contents Acknowledgements v Preface vi 1 Basic Concepts 1.1 1.2 1.3 1.4 1.5 1.6 Pitch . . . . . Notation . . . . Octave Registers . Accidentals . . . Enharmonic Notes Practice Exercises. 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 Major Scales and Key Signatures 2.1 2.2 2.3 2.4 Half Steps and Whole The Major Scale . . Major Key Signatures Practice Exercises. . Steps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 Minor Scales and Key Signatures 3.1 3.2 3.3 3.4 Minor Scales . . . Minor Key Signatures Scale Degree Names . Practice Exercises. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 5 6 9 10 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 Basics of Rhythm 4.1 4.2 4.3 4.4 4.5 4.6 4.7 1 1 1 3 3 4 10 10 14 15 17 Time Signature . . . . . . . Durational Symbols . . . . . . Dots and Ties . . . . . . . . Meter . . . . . . . . . . . Tuplets . . . . . . . . . . Common Rhythmic Notation Errors Practice Exercises. . . . . . . viii . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 17 19 20 21 21 23 CONTENTS ix 5 Intervals 5.1 5.2 5.3 5.4 5.5 5.6 26 Introduction to Intervals . . . . . . . . . . How to Identify Perfect, Major, and Minor Intervals How to Write Perfect, Major, and Minor Intervals . Inversion of Intervals Explained. . . . . . . . Augmented and Diminished Intervals. . . . . . Practice Exercises. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 Triads 6.1 6.2 6.3 6.4 6.5 6.6 6.7 Introduction to Triads Lead-Sheet Symbols . Inverted Triads. . . Analyzing Chords. . Simple “Sus” Chords Summary . . . . . Practice Exercises. . 32 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 Roman Numerals and Cadences 7.1 7.2 7.3 7.4 7.5 Roman Numeral Chord Symbols Diatonic Chords in Major . . . Diatonic Chords in Minor . . . Cadences . . . . . . . . . Practice Exercises. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Introduction to Seventh Chords. . . . . . The IV/5 “sus” chord . . . . . . . . . Roman Numerals of Diatonic Seventh Chords Practice Exercises. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . The Circle of Fifths Progression . . . . . Harmonic Rhythm . . . . . . . . . . Shorter Progressions from the Circle of Fifths Harmonic Function . . . . . . . . . . Exceptions Created by Harmonic Sequences . The Subtonic VII Chord in Popular Music. . The Best-Seller Progression . . . . . . . The i–VII–VI–VII Progression . . . . . . Practice Exercises. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Introduction to Non-Chord Passing Tones . . . . . Neighbor Tones . . . . Appoggiatura . . . . . Escape Tone. . . . . . Double Neighbor . . . . Anticipation. . . . . . 51 52 53 54 55 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 Non-Chord Tones 10.1 10.2 10.3 10.4 10.5 10.6 10.7 39 40 40 42 49 51 9 Harmonic Progression and Harmonic Function 9.1 9.2 9.3 9.4 9.5 9.6 9.7 9.8 9.9 32 32 34 35 36 37 38 39 8 Seventh Chords 8.1 8.2 8.3 8.4 26 27 29 29 30 31 55 60 61 67 76 78 80 82 84 87 Tones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87 87 88 89 90 91 92 CONTENTS x 10.8 Pedal Point . . . . . . . 10.9 Suspension . . . . . . . 10.10Retardation . . . . . . . 10.11Incomplete Neighbor. . . . 10.12Adding Non-Chord Tones to a 10.13Practice Exercises. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Chord Progression . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 Melodic Analysis 11.1 11.2 11.3 11.4 11.5 11.6 Motive. . . . . Melodic Alteration Fragment . . . . Phrase . . . . . Subphrase . . . Practice Exercises. 103 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 Form in Popular Music 12.1 12.2 12.3 12.4 12.5 12.6 Verse-Chorus Form . . AABA Form . . . . ABAC Form . . . . The 12-Bar Blues . . . Harmonically Closed and Practice Exercises. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Open Sections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . The Perfect Authentic Cadence . . . The Sentence . . . . . . . . . The Period . . . . . . . . . . The Asymmetrical Period . . . . . The Double Period . . . . . . . Phrase Groups and Phrase Chains. . The Elision . . . . . . . . . . Summary of Phrases in Combination . Practice Exercises. . . . . . . . Texture . . . . . . . . Chorale Texture . . . . . Arpeggiated Accompaniments Block Chord Accompaniments Afterbeats and Offbeats . . The 3–2 Son Clave . . . . Distinctive Bass Lines . . . . 118 . 119 . 120 . 121 . 121 . 122 123 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 Accompanimental Textures 14.1 14.2 14.3 14.4 14.5 14.6 14.7 . 103 . 106 . 110 . 111 . 114 . 115 118 13 Phrases in Combination 13.1 13.2 13.3 13.4 13.5 13.6 13.7 13.8 13.9 . 93 . 95 . 98 . 98 . 99 . 100 . . . . . . . . 123 . 123 . 125 . 131 . 132 . 136 . 138 . 140 . 140 143 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 Creating Contrast Between Sections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143 . 144 . 146 . 149 . 160 . 164 . 172 175 15.1 The Elements of Music . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175 15.2 Mozart, Eine kleine Nachtmusik, K. 525, II. . . . . . . . . 176 15.3 “Rude” by MAGIC! . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178 CONTENTS xi 16 Figured Bass 16.1 16.2 16.3 16.4 16.5 16.6 Historical Context . . . . . . . Figured Bass Inversion Symbols . . The Cadential Six-Four Chord . . . Other Occurrences of Six-Four Chords Additional Information . . . . . . Practice Exercises. . . . . . . . 181 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 Secondary Dominant Chords 17.1 17.2 17.3 17.4 17.5 17.6 17.7 189 Examples with Secondary Dominants . . Tonicization . . . . . . . . . . . . Secondary Dominants in Major and Minor . Analyzing Secondary Dominants . . . . Writing Secondary Dominants . . . . . Irregular Resolutions of Secondary Chords . Practice Exercises. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 Secondary Diminished Chords 18.1 18.2 18.3 18.4 18.5 Secondary Diminished Chords . . . . . Secondary Diminished Chords in Major and Analyzing Secondary Diminished Chords . Writing Secondary Diminished Chords . . Practice Exercises. . . . . . . . . . Mode Mixture . . . . . . . . . . Harmonization of Borrowed Scale Degrees Analyzing and Writing Borrowed Chords The Deceptive Cadence with 2 VI . . . The Picardy 3rd . . . . . . . . . Practice Exercises. . . . . . . . . . 189 . 191 . 193 . 194 . 194 . 195 . 199 201 . . . Minor. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 Mode Mixture 19.1 19.2 19.3 19.4 19.5 19.6 . 181 . 182 . 184 . 185 . 186 . 187 . 201 . 203 . 204 . 204 . 205 207 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 The Neapolitan Chord . 207 . 215 . 215 . 216 . 218 . 218 220 20.1 The Neapolitan Chord . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220 20.2 Examples of the Neapolitan Chord . . . . . . . . . . . 221 20.3 Practice Exercises. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223 21 Augmented Sixth Chords 21.1 21.2 21.3 21.4 21.5 21.6 21.7 21.8 21.9 Augmented Sixth Chords . . . . . . . . . Types of Augmented Sixth Chords . . . . . Analyzing Augmented Sixth Chords . . . . . Lead-Sheet Analysis of Augmented Sixth Chords Examples with Augmented Sixth Chords . . . Distingushing Between Chromatic Harmonies. . Descending Chromatic Bass Lines . . . . . . Chromatic Pre-Dominant Chords . . . . . . Practice Exercises. . . . . . . . . . . . 224 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224 . 224 . 225 . 225 . 226 . 231 . 231 . 235 . 236 CONTENTS xii 22 Modulation 22.1 22.2 22.3 22.4 22.5 22.6 22.7 22.8 237 Modulation . . . . . . . . . . . . Tonicization versus Modulation . . . . . Key Relationships . . . . . . . . . Modulations with Diatonic Pivot Chords . How to Recognize a Key After a Modulation Modulations with Chromatic Pivot Chords Modulations Without Pivot Chords . . . Practice Exercises. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 Enharmonic Modulation 23.1 23.2 23.3 23.4 262 Enharmonic Modulation . . . . . The V7 and Ger+6 as Pivot Chords . The Fully Diminished Seventh as Pivot Practice Exercises. . . . . . . . . . . . . . Chord . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 Binary and Ternary Forms 24.1 24.2 24.3 24.4 24.5 24.6 24.7 24.8 24.9 Binary and Ternary Form . . . Sectional versus Continuous . . Balanced Binary . . . . . . Rounded Binary . . . . . . Simple Binary . . . . . . . Binary Principle . . . . . . Ternary Form . . . . . . . Distinguishing between Rounded Practice Exercises. . . . . . . 262 . 263 . 267 . 271 274 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Binary and . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Ternary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 Sonata and Rondo Forms 25.1 25.2 25.3 25.4 25.5 25.6 . 237 . 237 . 241 . 241 . 244 . 245 . 248 . 257 294 Sonata Form . . . . . . . . . . . . The Four Structural Functions in Music. . . Rondo Form. . . . . . . . . . . . . Rondo Character . . . . . . . . . . . Standard Forms in a Multimovement Classical Practice Exercises. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Piece . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26 Voice Leading Triads 26.1 Voice Leading . . . . . . . . . . . 26.2 Types of Motion . . . . . . . . . . 26.3 Objectionable Parallels . . . . . . . . 26.4 Voice Ranges . . . . . . . . . . . 26.5 Rules of Melody . . . . . . . . . . 26.6 Rules of Spacing . . . . . . . . . . 26.7 Voice Leading Root Position Triads in Four 26.8 Voice Leading First-Inversion Triads . . . 26.9 Voice Leading Second Inversion Triads . . 26.10Special Situations . . . . . . . . . . 26.11Types of Six-Four Chords . . . . . . . 26.12Summary of Doubling Rules for Triads . . 26.13Practice Exercises. . . . . . . . . . . 274 . 274 . 276 . 278 . 281 . 282 . 283 . 286 . 288 . 294 . 296 . 301 .304 . 305 . 305 310 . . . . . . . . . . . . Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 310 . 310 . 311 . 311 . 312 . 312 . 313 . 315 . 318 . 318 . 319 . 319 . 319 CONTENTS xiii 27 Voice Leading Seventh Chords 27.1 27.2 27.3 27.4 27.5 27.6 323 Voice Leading Seventh Chords . . . . . Voice Leading Successive Seventh Chords . Voice Leading the V7 to I Progression . . The Special Resolution of vii ◦7 (and vii ø7 ) When to Use Seventh Chords . . . . . Practice Exercises. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 Voice Leading With Non-Chord Tones 28.1 28.2 28.3 28.4 330 Voice Leading With Non-Chord Tones . . . . Avoiding Objectionable Parallels . . . . . . Adding Non-Chord Tones to a Chord Progression Practice Exercises. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29 Voice Leading Chromatic Harmonies 29.1 29.2 29.3 29.4 29.5 Voice Leading Secondary Chords . . . Voice Leading Borrowed Chords . . . Voice Leading the Neapolitan Chord . . Voice Leading Augmented Sixth Chords. Practice Exercises. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Species Counterpoint . . . First Species Counterpoint . Second Species Counterpoint. Third Species Counterpoint . Fourth Species Counterpoint . Fifth Species Counterpoint . Invention Expositions . . . Fugue Analysis. . . . . . Practice Exercises. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 330 . 331 . 331 . 335 337 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 Introduction to Counterpoint 30.1 30.2 30.3 30.4 30.5 30.6 30.7 30.8 30.9 . 323 . 325 . 326 . 328 . 328 . 329 . 337 . 338 . 339 . 339 . 341 343 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 Introduction to Jazz Theory 31.1 Jazz Chord Basics . . . . . . . . . . 31.2 Chord Symbol Specifics . . . . . . . . 31.3 Altered Dominant Seventh Chords . . . . 31.4 Chord Labels . . . . . . . . . . . . 31.5 How to Write Jazz Chords . . . . . . . 31.6 How to Analyze Jazz Chords. . . . . . . 31.7 Jazz Chord Voicings . . . . . . . . . . 31.8 Standard Chord Progressions . . . . . . 31.9 Scales . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31.10How to Determine Chord-Scale Relationships. 31.11Harmonizing the Bebop Scale . . . . . . 31.12Practice Exercises. . . . . . . . . . . . 343 . 343 . 345 . 347 . 348 . 349 . 349 . 353 . 357 364 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 364 . 366 . 366 . 367 . 368 . 369 . 371 . 372 . 374 . 377 . 378 . 379 CONTENTS xiv 32 Impressionism and Extended Tonality 32.1 32.2 32.3 32.4 32.5 Impressionism . . . Pandiatonicism. . . Quartal, Quintal, and Polychords . . . . Practice Exercises. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Secundal Harmony . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 382 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33 Set Theory 33.1 33.2 33.3 33.4 33.5 33.6 33.7 33.8 33.9 Set Theory . . . Normal Form . . Prime Form . . . Interval Vector . . Forte Numbers . . Lists of Set Classes Transposition (Tn ) Inversion (Tn I). . Practice Exercises. 392 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 Serialism 34.1 34.2 34.3 34.4 34.5 34.6 34.7 . 382 . 386 . 387 . 388 . 390 Twelve-Tone Technique . . . . Determining Row Forms . . . Writing Row Forms . . . . . Twelve-Tone Matrix . . . . . Row Form Presentation in Music Non-Twelve-Tone Serialism . . Practice Exercises. . . . . . . 392 .395 . 396 . 399 . 401 . 401 .404 . 405 . 406 408 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35 Minimalism . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 408 . 410 . 411 . 411 . 412 . 413 . 414 417 35.1 Additive Minimalism . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 417 35.2 Phase Shifting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 418 35.3 Homework Assignments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 420 A Answers to Practice Exercises 421 B GNU Free Documentation License 452 Index 459 Chapter 1 Basic Concepts 1.1 Pitch & 51 Pitch has to do with notes. On the piano there are 88 notes. As you move to the right on a piano, the notes sound higher. Notes sound lower as you move to the left. Try it on a piano with a smaller range at the following website. lower higher 1 2 3 1.2 Notation 4 2 & 8 7 9 10 F Fine œ œ E œ ledger lines F Every E staff with7 the dots the 5 a five-line 1 The2 F clef, 3 when 4placed on 6 9 lines œsurrounding 8 10 ledger 2 3 2 E B B D D Good F Every Good Boy Boy Does F Fine Does A A C C E w wE G ? Grass Eat w Do wFine? w w Cows C wG B D F B Boys B w All A w Eat Grass A Goodw Always w & ? G Fine F w E Do D Cows C second line from the top, creates the bass clef . See the example for the names of lines and spaces, remember them. A and for mnemonics toAlways 1 3 G G G B Good 2 3 4 Boys 5 All A 6 7 8 9 11 10 1.3 Octave Registers 3 7 4 6 Notes are written on a five-line staff . A clef orients the lines to a reference point. For example, the G clef, when placed on a five-line staff, becomes the treble clef , the most well known clef. In treble clef, the notes on the lines are E–G–B–D–F from lowest to highest, often remembered through the traditional mnenomic “Every Good Boy Does Fine.” The spaces are F–A–C–E from lowest to highest. Staves (the plural of “staff” in musical terminology is “staves”) are extended by the ledger lines. & & HW 5 HW 4 11 12 & œ The note w names used inwmusic are ABCDEFG (knownw as thew“musical alphabet”). note A returnswand & After G, the B again and again. ?ABCDEFG w occurs & œ w w B w w w w œ ? 1 2 3 4 5 6 1 7 8 9 10 11 12 œ ?Example 1 2 4 3 & w bœ ‹œ w bw w #w ? ? & & ? ? ? 2 ? & CHAPTER 1. BASIC CONCEPTS A Always ledger lines G B E D F 2 Grass Eat E G D C Cows Boys Do B A All octave (which means the G Good The distance from the first A to the second A is an F Fine Every Boy Good notes are eight steps apart.) A 1 ? half step whole step B0 C1 2 D 4 E 5 F 6 F G 7 ? A 8 (octave) Fine ? whole step D G B C2 C3 C4 & œ Good B4C5 C6 Boys Do C7 A FC Do A C E C8 Note that the register number changes after the noteB each time (B4 is followed by C5 ). In treble clef, middle C is notated on the ledger line below the staff. In bass clef, middle C is notated on the ledger line above the staff. 3 7 C 3 The distance from any note to a note register D of the same name in the next Boy A Does F above or below is called an octave “8ve”). Good G B (abbreviated How can the piano keyboard have 88 notes Every when there areB onlyD seven note E BoysF G Good names? The musical alphabet repeats 7 times (with an extra ABC at the top), which means we have at least seven octave registers. (There are also five chromatic notes in each register, which we will learn about when we discuss Accidentals.) When learning about octave registers, we will focus on the note C for reasons that will soon become clear when we learn about the major scale. We use octave registers (C4 , D5 , etc.) to specify the exact register of a note. The note C4 is known as “middleAC” and is an important reference Always point. See the keyboard 3in the example Fine F below. 4 2 2B & half step ? 3 œ ? 4 & œ 7 B œ œ ? Figure 1.3.1 Middle C (C4) in treble clef and bass clef 4 The other two commonly used clefs are alto clef and tenor clef . Each use a C clef that, when 8placed on a staff, designate the placement of middle C. B œ B œ B0 C1 C2 C Figure 1.3.2 Middle C in alto clef and tenor clef The grand staff , which is a treble and bass clef joined together by a bracket, is how piano music is written. 8 B œœ & 44 œ œ œ œ ? 44 œ œ œ œ Middle C 5 & ? œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ˙ œ œ C2œ œ ˙ C3 œ œ œ B0 C1 œ œ œ Middle C Note that middle C is always clearly notated in either the upper or lower staff and never floats between the two staves. ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ C4 B4C5 to A Major key signature w & w w w ww CHAPTER 1. BASIC CONCEPTS 1.4 Accidentals m6 195 A is below F M3 w w 3 A is above F b ww w ww w ww w # ww w b w w w w w w & #w b w a pitchwa half step. w b w• The sharpwsymbol—4—raises There are five types of accidentals; accidentals are characters that can be placed before notes to raise or lower them. m2 • The pitch am6 half P4 step. P5 M2flat symbol— M7 m7 m32—lowers M6 aM3 °4 +5 • The double sharp symbol—5—raises a pitch two half steps, or a whole step. How Intervals Invert • The double flat symbol—3—lowers a pitch two half steps, or a whole 1 8 M m step. 2 7 P P • The natural symbol— 3 66—cancels + out° any other accidentals that may have occurred earlier in4a measure or in Major Key Signatures or Minor Key 5 Signatures. 201 &w bw nw #w nw G Figure 1.4.1 1.5 Enharmonic Notes 4 2 Observe that C and D are the same note on the piano but are written as different notes on the staff. & #œ bœ Figure 1.5.1 4 2 4 2 4 2 This occurs with all the black keys on the piano (C =D , D =E , F =G , 2 4 2 G =A , A =B ). When two notes sound the same but are written as two 4 2 CHAPTER & 1. BASIC CONCEPTS 4 different notes on the staff, the written notes are said to be enharmonic. Notes on the white keys of the piano can be written enharmonically as well 4 2 5 (C=B , E=F , D=C , etc.). HW 5 & 1.6 1 Practice Exercises & 51 1 2 3 5 4 1. 3 6 7 8 10 For each note on the piano keyboard, specify the note name and9octave register. & 1 1 1 2. & 6 & 2 2 2 3 w Bw 3 3 w 4 4 w 5 w ?w 5 6 5 4 6 6 7 7 7 w w 8 8 9 Bw 10 8 w 9 11 9 w 10 12 10 w w w Bw w w B w w For each note on the staff, specify the note name and octave register. 2 7 2 w w HW w & & w 2 1 3. 11 1 Provide two2 Example Bw ww B 3 4 3 4 enharmically 1 & w bœ ‹œ w w w 5 w ?w w? w 6 6 5 equivalent bw 2 7 7 notes w 11 12 each9 given10note.11 12 8 for8 9 3 w 10 4 #w 1 2 3 4 versions of the textbook, homework exercises, and practice exercises can b œ ‹ w ? # œ be found at musictheory.pugetsound.edu ‹ w w bw HW ∫ w 16 PDF Example Chapter 2 Major Scales and Key Signatures 5 2.1 Half Steps and Whole Steps ? A half step on a piano keyboard is the distance from one note to the next nearest note. A whole step is made of two half steps. half step whole step 2.2 The Major Scale A major scale contains a specific succession of whole and half steps. It is helpful to think of the pattern as consisting of two tetrachords. (A tetrachord is a four-note scale segment.) The lower tetrachord consists of the pattern whole step, whole step, half step. A whole step joins the lower tetrachord to the upper tetrachord. The upper tetrachord duplicates the pattern in the lower one: whole step, whole step, half step. If we use W for whole step and H for half step, the major scale pattern is W–W–H, Whole–step connection, W–W–H. 5 B 9 CHAPTER 2. MAJOR SCALES AND KEY SIGNATURES & tetrachord W #œ bœ 6 tetrachord W HW W W H 12 Figure 2.2.1 The D major scale on a keyboard B 10 &œ tetrachord W œ #œ W H œ W œ tetrachord W W H œ #œ œ Figure 2.2.2 The D major scale in treble clef All major scales use the notes of the musical alphabet in order; no notes are skipped and no notes occur twice. In the example above, the first four notes 4 2 2 are D–E–F –G, not D–E–G –G. In D–E–G –G, G erroneously occurs twice 4 and the F between E and G is skipped. 2.3 Major Key Signatures A key signature is placed at the beginning of a piece (or the beginning of a section) and is written with the clef on the beginning of each line of music. The key signature reminds the performer which sharps or flats are in the scale (or key) of the piece and prevents the composer or arranger from writing every sharp or flat from the scale every time it occurs. W W & œH œ # œ W œ œ W W H W CHAPTER 2. MAJOR SCALES AND KEY SIGNATURES 13 ## 2 ## 2 œœ œœ ˙ œœ & & 4 œ œ œ œ œ œ 4˙ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ œ˙œ œ œœ œ˙ œ œ œ œœ œœ œ ˙˙ 25 # & # œœ œœ œœ ˙ œœ ˙ œœ œœ 7 œœ œœ œœ ˙ ## œ œLittle˙ Star"œin Dœ major œ œTwinkle, & œ œ œ œ œ Figure œ ˙ 2.3.1œ "Twinkle, œœ œœ ˙ œ There are 15 major key signatures. The key of C major has no sharps or # ## ## b & # 37 50 & 62 & ## ## flats in the key signature. The other key signatures can have between 1 to 7 sharps and 1 to 7 flats, giving us the other 14 key signatures. # # # # ## # ## # # # # # # # # # # # # # # # # & # # # G G D D A A E E B B Figure 2.3.2 Major Key Signatures using Sharps &b F bb Bb bbb Eb bbbb Ab bbbbb Db F# F C# C bbbbbb bbbbbbb Gb Cb Figure 2.3.3 Major Key Signatures using Flats It is important to memorize the order of sharps and flats, since you will be writing key signatures regularly. The order of sharps is F–C–G–D–A–E–B, often remembered by a mnemonic. One common mnemonic for the order of sharps is “Fast Cars Go Dangerously Around Every Bend.” The order of flats is B–E–A–D–G–C–F. It is the reverse of the order of sharps. It is easy to remember since the first four letters make the word BEAD, and GCF is something most students learn as “Greatest Common Factor” when studying math in elementary school. A mnemonic that works forward and backward is “Father Charles Goes Down And Ends Battle,” which reversed is “Battle Ends And Down Goes Charles’ Father.” A helpful learning device to remember the order of keys in relation to the order of sharps and flats is the circle of fifths. As you ascend in fifths (clockwise), key signatures get one degree “sharper.” (C to G is a fifth because C=1, D=2, E=3, F=4, and G=5.) As you descend in fifths (counterclockwise), key signatures get one degree “flatter.” B bbbbbbb B bbbbbbb 52 CHAPTER 2. MAJOR SCALES AND KEY SIGNATURES 1b 2b 0b C 0# F Bb 1# G b 3b E A 4b 8 D # 2 3# A b 7# C# Db 5b 6# F# Gb 6b 5# B 4# E Cb 7b Figure 2.3.4 Circle of Fifths for Major Keys Note the overlapping keys at the bottom of the circle. B major is enhar2 4 2 monically the same as C major, F major is enharmonically the same as G 4 2 major, and C major is enharmonically the same as D major. 2.3.1 Identifying Key Signatures While it is preferable to memorize key signatures, use the following method to determine major key signatures based on the sharps or flats in the key signature. 1. For key signatures withs sharps: Go up a half step from the last sharp to find the key. 2. For key signatures with flats: The second-to-last flat is the key. ? & CHAPTER 2. MAJOR SCALES AND KEY SIGNATURES B¯≤ major scale E major scale HW 1. 25 2 ? & 2.4 Practice Exercises 23 2. 27 23 HW 34 25 41 27 & 55 3. HW 48 60 53 & Using the WWHWWWH pattern, write the specified major scales without using key scale signatures. C˜ major A¯≤ major scale D¯≤ major scale A ?major scale & & 21 9 ? DOuble bars? new clefs? Given the key signature, specify the major key. E? major # # b scale # # b B¯≤ major scale & b bb # ____ 1 C˜ major # scale & & ____ 2 ## # bb ____ 8 ____ 9 ____ 3 bbbb b ____ 10 ____ 4 #### # ## # bb ? b ____ 5 ____ 6 # # scaleb b # # # # # A¯≤ #major # # ? # b b bbb ____ 11 ____ 12 ____ 13 ____ 7 bbbbbb ____ 14 Write the major key signature for each key given. Be sure to use the ? b b order # # # #flats. b b # b b for #sharps correct and # bb b bb b ? bb ____ 1 1. A major & ### ____ 6. C¯≤ major 8 ____ ____ ____ 2 3 4 2. B¯≤ major 3. F˜ major bbbbbbb #### ## # b ____ ____ ____ 9 7. E¯≤ major 10 8. B major 11 b bb 3 ____ ____ ____ 5 6 7 4. D¯≤ major 5. D major #### # bbb #### # # ____ ____ ____ 9. F major 10. C˜ major 12 13 14 ? to download the homework. # # # # #Click here # PDF versions of the textbook, homework exercises, and practice exercises & & can be found at musictheory.pugetsound.edu 65 55 61 #### # # & & 69 63 69 74 77 & 85 & ? 83 ? 107 79 ? & ? b 3b E 4 b bA 3# A Db 54 55 5# 6# C# 5b 53 7# F# B Gb E Cb 7b 6b Chapter 3 Major scale 3̂ 4̂ 5̂ w 6̂ w w 3ˆ 4̂ w 5̂ 6ˆ 7ˆ 8̂ 4̂ w w w w & w w w w w Scales Minor and Key Sigb b b natures w bw bw & w 1̂ 2̂ Natural Minor scale 1̂ 2̂ w w Harmonic Minor scale 1̂ 2̂ bw b 3ˆ w w bw w w & w w bw w w w 5̂ 7̂ b 6ˆ bw 3.1 & Minor Scales 56 4# 8̂ 7̂ 8̂ There are three minor scales: the natural minor scale, the harmonic minor Melodic Minor scale (ascending scale, and the melodic minorversion) scale. Play or sing through each one and notice b 3ˆ 1̂ 2̂ 4̂ 6̂ 7̂ 8̂ 5̂ the differences. The melodic minor scale has an ascending version, shown above, and a descending version that is the same as the natural minor scale. 57 Melodic Minor scale 1̂ 2̂ b 3ˆ 4̂ b 7ˆ b 6ˆ b 3ˆ & w w bw w w w w w bw bw w w bw w w 5̂ 6̂ 7̂ 8̂ ascending 5̂ 4̂ 2̂ 1̂ descending So far, we have looked at minor scales in relation to the major scale. However, we will typically encounter minor scales in music using minor key signatures. 3.2 Minor Key Signatures Minor key signatures agree with the notes of the natural minor scale. Since 2 2 2 the C natural minor scale had E , A , and B , the key signature of C minor 2 2 2 has three flats, written in the order of flats—B , E , A . 10 b 4 œœœ œ œ & b b 4 ‰ œ nœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ nœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ nœ nœ œ œ œ œ œ bSCALES b 6ˆ 7̂ 7̂ 7̂ 6̂ 6ˆ CHAPTER 3. MINOR AND KEY SIGNATURES Natural Minor scale written with major key signature b 3ˆ 4̂ 5̂ 1̂ 2̂ 72 & 73 w bw w w b &bb w b &bb bw b & b b 44 b & b b w œ bœ w &b 95 &b b Bb b 83 b & b bbbbb bb & b b bbb 99 F# bb add 3 flats subtract 3 sharps & bbb E b major b 7ˆ w 8̂ w w 8̂ ### f# # G subtract 1 sharp and add 2 flats bb g b & b&b Below are the minor key signatures. # a a b e d ## bb b g C minor w (œ) ( b œ ) w half steps between: 1 & 91 w Note on uppercase versus lowercase: When writing below the five-line staff to designate keys, we will use the shorthand of upper case for major ( C ) and lowercase for minor ( c ). When writing prose, we will use uppercase: C major and C minor. We use the term relative minor when referring to a minor key that has the 2 same key signature as a major key. For example, the relative minor of E major is C minor because both have three flats in the key signature. Conversely, one 2 could say the relative major of C minor is E major. The relative major is three half steps above the relative minor. 95 75 #### # # bbbbb 94 6 b 6ˆ bw Therefore, a minor key signature will have three lowered notes—the 3rd, 7 6th, and 7th—in relation to the corresponding major key signature. We use b major when referring to a minor scale that has the same 94 term parallel Eminor the C minor 1st scale degree (in this case C) as the major. We say, “The parallel minor of E major is E minor,” and ) parallel major of F minor is F major.” One ( ) (“The method of half figuring out a minor steps between: 1 2 key 3 signature is to add three flats to the parallel major key signature. This is the same as subtracting three sharps. 75 101 w w w w w b 7ˆ b 6ˆ Natural Minor scale written with minor key signature b 3ˆ 4̂ 5̂ 1̂ 2̂ 74 11 2 3 ### #### #### # #### # # #### # ## bbb bbbb bbbbb bbbbbb bbbbbbb f# c c# f g# bb d# eb a# ab Here are circle of fifths diagrams for both major and minor, for comparison. 7 B bbb 93 CHAPTER 3. MINOR SCALES AND KEY SIGNATURES 1b 2b 0b a 0# d g 1# e b # 2 3b c 4b f bb 5b Figure 3.2.1 12 7# a# 6# d# eb 6b 5# g# 4# ab 7b # 3# f c# B bbbbbbb 52 CHAPTER 3. MINOR SCALES AND KEY SIGNATURES 1b 2b 0b C 0# F Bb 1# G D # 2 b 3b E 75 3# A A 4b 6 & 13 # a e b 7# C# D b# # ## 5bb # f# 6# F# #### b #### G # c# 6b 5# 4# E b C # B ## # # #### ## b #7 # a# d# g# b minor b b minorb b band melodic b b b b minor b b b bscales b b b b busing b b b b b bkey &Writingb harmonic b when b 83 bb signatures requires you to raise scale degrees. a B bbbbbbb 91 92 b &bb 93 b &bb 115 b &bb 123 d g c f Harmonic Minor scale: raise 7̂ in minor b 3ˆ 1̂ 2̂ 4̂ b &bb w w w w w 5̂ eb b 6ˆ w Melodic Minor scale (ascending version): raise 6̂ and 7̂ in minor b 3ˆ 4̂ 2̂ 5̂ 6̂ 1̂ b &bb w w w w w nw ab nw w nw w 7̂ 7̂ 8̂ 8̂ Compositions in minor typically do not strictly use only one of the three minor scales, however. The three minor scales are distillations of composers’ actual practice. CHAPTER 3. MINOR SCALES AND KEY SIGNATURES bb 4 ‰ œ n œ œ œ œ œ b œ œ œ œ œ œ n œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ b & 4 œ œ harmonic minor 58 7̂ 58 14 5 harmonic minor natural minor b 6ˆ b 7ˆ 7̂ b 6ˆ 7̂ bb 4 ‰ œ n œ œ œ œ œ b œ œ œ œ œ œ n œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ b & 4 œ œ harmonic minor bb & 10 b 60 natural minor b 6ˆ b 7ˆ 7̂ Figure 3.2.2 J.S. Bach, C Minor Invention 7̂ b 6ˆ YT: HFeLqgVLxBM 148 58 60 152 harmonic minor 5 7̂ 5 harmonic minor harmonic minor # 4 minor œ œ œnatural # œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ & b 44 œ œ œœ œœ œœ œ minor natural œ œ œ n œ œ œœ œœ œ wœ œ œ œ b ‰ n œ b œ b œ œ & 4 œ œ œœ œherœwedœ œ- dingœ has where b C El -Óean - orŒRigœ-œby, œ picks œ œupœtheœriceœ œin the church œ been, œ œ Œ œœ b Œ & b 6ˆ b 7ˆ without syncopation 7̂ 7̂ 7̂ b 6ˆ # 4 œ # œ œ # œ œ œb 7ˆ œb 6ˆ œ p œ œ œ œ œ w & 4 œ œ œ œ church where her wed - ding has been, bb b œ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ œ œ œ œœ œ Œ œ œ œ œ #œœ œœ œœœ œ œ œœ œœ œ œœ œ Œ Œ & b C Ó Œ156 incorrect rhythmic notation & p & 68 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ7̂œ œ œbb6ˆ7ˆ œb 6ˆœ œ œ œ . œ œ J harmonic minor 69 œ œ œ bb œ notation # œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ correct rhythmic Œ & & bb œ44 œ 158œ œ œ YT: 1 O0PChj-uQPo 2 1 2 ˆ b Figure 3.2.3 Mozart, Symphony No. 40 in G Minor, K. 7̂ 6 550, 1st movement & 68 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ . œ œ 65 El - ea - nor Rig - by 60 65 natural minor harmonic minor picks up the rice in the melodic minor harmonic minor œ œ œ œ interval b b b 44horizontally ‰ œ n œ œ œ=œ"melodic" measured & œ œ nœ œ œ œ œ œ œ b ˆ# œ œ . 7̂ ? 44 œ #6 œ œ . 7̂ # # œœ b 6ˆ J J J 69 160 b &bb 72 œœ œœ J œœœ œ nœ nœ œ œ œ œœ œ œ . 7̂ 6̂ ˙ œ. ˙ measured vertically = "harmonic" interval YT: xp3zPzDnTEk 162 Figure 3.2.4 J.S. Bach, Well-Tempered Clavier, Book One, Fugue 2 in C Minor ?w w w w w 3.3 Scale Degree major Names major perfect perfect w w w w perfect major major perfect third fourth fifth sixth seventh octave unison second (M3) (P4) (P5) (M6)have(M7) Scale degrees,(P1) though(M2) often referred to by numbers, also names.(P8) 163 ? 164 tonic ? w1̂ supertonic mediant subdominant dominant 2̂ 3̂ 4̂ 5̂ w w w w submediant w6̂ leading tone w7̂ These names will be used throughout this text to refer to scale degrees, chords built on these scale degrees, and keys associated with these scale degrees. Another way to understand why some scale degrees have “sub-” in their names is through the following example. mediant tonic E majorsupertonic scale 1̂ HW? & w 163 23 w w w6̂ w w? 5̂ 4̂ 3̂ 2̂ subdominant B¯≤ major scale CHAPTER 3. MINOR SCALES AND KEY SIGNATURES 25 C˜ major scale ? & tonic 55 164 27 ____ 1 Notice that b ww ### # subtonic bbb #### HW 74 48 79 # # # # #2. & # 55 83 # # #3. &8589 # # # 63 HW 94 87 4. 99 ? HW 89 104 7. E¯≤ major 8. B major 9. F major ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ 6 2 4 5 the tonic, subtonic is a3 whole step below bb #### # # bbbbb #### # #### # ## subdominant 10. C˜ major ____ 7 while the leading bbbbbbb 10 11 12 13 9 ? 8 Specify the minor key for each key signature given. ? bb b b #2.# C˜ major# # # # 3. G¯≤ major # 1. E¯≤ major bb b b4.b bD major bb & ____ 1 ### & ? 6. B major ____ 8 11. C¯≤ major ____ 2 ____ 3 ____ ____ 4 ____ 5 # # # # # #8. F˜ major b # bbbbbbb ____ ____ 6 # #9.# #A¯≤ major b b # b 7. D¯≤ major ____ ____ ____ 9 12. A major 10 13. B¯≤ major 11 ____ ____ 12 E major 13 14. bbbbbb ____ 14 bbbbb 5. F major ____ 7 #### # # 10. G major ____ 14 Write the minor key signature and specified minor scale in each example. & ? F harmonic minor scale (include key signature) B melodic minor scale (include key signature) ? & ? Write the minor key signature for the given key in each example. A¯≤ harmonic minor2.scale 1. D minor F˜ minor (include key signature) & 6.& B minor 3. F minor C˜ melodic minor scale 5. A¯≤ minor 4. D˜ minor (include key signature) ? 8. G˜ minor 9. B¯≤ minor 10. E minor 2 minor: is the subtonic 2. EDminor 3. A˜ minor 4. G minor 5. B¯≤ minor 9. G˜ minor 10. A¯≤ minor 7. C minor Specify the minor key from G natural scale the scale degree name. F˜ melodic minor scale (include key signature) 2 (include key signature) (a) minor: A is the mediant ? 1.(b) F minor (c) & (d) 109 w w 5. D major ## b submediant 3.4 Practice Exercises ____ ____ ____ ____ 411. HW dominant ww 4. D¯≤ major 3. F˜ major the ? 34 tone is only a half step below the tonic. & 69 4 & ? bb bb 6. C¯≤ major ?mediant supertonic 2. B¯≤ major DOuble bars? new clefs? 60 65 ?1. Awmajor A¯≤ major scale 15 3 6. F˜ minor ? (e) 11.(f) E¯≤ minor (g) major: B is the dominant major: C is the submediant 7. A minor 8. B minor 4 minor: D is the subdominant 2 major: B˜ minor is the leading tone 12. C 13. C minor 4 minor: E is the supertonic Click here to download the homework. 14. D˜ minor w7̂ CHAPTER 3. MINOR SCALES AND KEY SIGNATURES 16 PDF versions of the textbook, homework exercises, and practice exercises can be found at musictheory.pugetsound.edu Chapter 4 Basics of Rhythm bb E b major 7 b w inœ music, In relation & to rhythm we will discuss time signatures, durational ( ) (b œ ) w symbols, meter, beat, pulse, tempo. 94 C minor half steps between: 1 2 3 #### # bbb 4.1b bTime bSignature # 95 & ### b add signature, 3 flats subtract 3 of sharps In a time the topF #number the# time bb f Bb many” and the bottom number tells you “of what.” ## 4 4 3 &b 2 "How many?" 3 101 "Of what?" 1/2 notes (half notes) b b b b 85 4 106 107 & 44 ˙ G 5 ### 6 16 110 “how 6 1/16 notes (sixteenth notes) ˙ & 44 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ J œ J eighth notes (equal 1/8 of a whole note) (can be beamed or flagged) 109 g half notes (equal of a whole note) In the present day, the1/2most common time signature is 44 (also known as “common time”). It makes sense to introduce durational symbols in the context of 44 because a whole note takes up a whole measure in 44 , a half note takes up 4 , a quarter note takes up 1 of a measure, and so on. half a measure ofnotes quarter 4 (equal 1/4 of a whole note) 4 & 44 œ 108 bb subtract 1 sharp and add 2 flats signature tells you 1/8 notes (eighth notes) 1/4 notes (quarter notes) whole note 4 4 w 4.2&Durational Symbols 105 # œ J œ J sixteenth notes (equal 1/16 of a whole note) (can be beamed or flagged) 4 & 4 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œR œR œR œR 4 & 4 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œR œR œR œR œR œR œR œR ÔÔÔÔÔÔÔÔ thirty-second (32nd) notes (equal 1/32 of a whole note) (can be beamed or flagged) 111 & whole rest half rest ∑ 17 Ó quarter rest Œ eighth sixteenth 32nd rest rest rest ‰ ≈ ® half notes (equal 1/2 of a whole b 3note) ˙ 101 & 2 the measure ## 4 4 ˙ the measure b b b b 85 CHAPTER OFnote RHYTHM 1/2 note is4. BASICS 1/4 is beat value œ 106 œ œ œ œ 1/8 note is beat value beat value note 105 quarter notes (equal 1/4 of a whole note) 4 whole &4 w œ & 44 œœ œœ J notes (equal 1/2 of a whole note) 4 half ˙ &4 ˙ œ J the measure eighth notes (equal 1/8 of a whole note) (can be beamed or flagged) 107 œ quarter notes (equal 1/4 of a whole note) 1/16 note is beat value 18 œ œ J 4 œ œ œ œ œ 4 note)œ (can be sixteenth notes (equal 1/16 of&a whole beamed or flagged) J J 108 # # # 6 the measure 16 eighth notes (equal 1/8 of a whole note) (can be beamed or flagged) œ œ J œ J œ J œ œ œ œ œ œ4 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ & 4 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ Rœ œR œR RœR œRR œR sixteenth notes (equal 1/16 of a whole note) (can be beamed or flagged) 109 4 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ &œ 4œ œœœ œœ œœœ œœ œœœ œœœœœ œœœ œœ œœœ œœ œœœ œœœ œœ œœœ œœRÔ œRÔœœRÔ œœRÔ œRÔœœRÔ œRÔœœRÔ RÔ RÔ RÔ RÔ RÔ RÔ RÔ RÔ 110 thirty-second (32nd) notes (equal (can 1/32 of be a whole note) (canor be flagged) beamed or flagged) thirty-second (32nd) notes (equal 1/32 of a whole note) beamed Figure 4.2.1 111 & 111 Here are durational symbols for rests. & whole rest half rest ∑ Ó quarter rest Œ eighth sixteenth 32nd rest rest rest ‰ ≈ ® To put this information into practice, listen to the durational values double in speed in each measure of the following example. ? 44 œ œ œ œ œ œ ˙ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ Middle C CHAPTER 4. BASICS OF RHYTHM 44 19 eighth notes are twice as fast as quarter notes sixteenth notes are twice as fast as eighth notes 4 & 4 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ .. œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ .. .. œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ .. 5 ? 44 ˙ this pattern of 8 notes takes 8 beats ˙ ˙ ˙ sixteenth notes are four times faster than quarter notes ˙ .. ˙ ˙ .. .. ˙ .. this is another way of notating 32nd notes, showing 4+4 32nd notes are twice as fast as sixteenth notes (there are eight 32nd notes for each quarter note) & œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ w 9 this pattern of 8 notes takes 1 beat ˙ ? ˙ ˙ ˙ Two rare durational values are the double whole note (also called a “breve”) and the 64th note, which is twice as fast as a 32nd note. ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ & ∑ ∑ ∑two∑ways of notating the double whole 64th notes 64th 11 rest œ œ œ œ œ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ R ∑ ∑ Ù∑ ÔÔ › „ ? ∑ ∑&∑ ∑ W ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ double whole note (or breve) 4 4 rest 4.3 Dots and Ties 8 We have a whole note, which lasts for four beats, and a half note, which lasts for two beats, but we don’t have a durational value that lasts three beats. To do so requires using a dot or a tie. A tie links two notes together to create a new duration. Ties occur between notes of the same pitch. A slur, which looks like a tie, is placed over or under notes of differenttwo pitches and means to play them in a notes connected ways of notating the double whole 64th 64thmanner. noteincreases (or breve) rest duration of that note restby half. A A dot addeddouble to awhole note the second dot represents half the value of the first dot, or a quarter of the original duration. (These are known as “double-dotted notes.”) W › & 112 & ˙. 113 tie joins notes together to create a new duration = ˙ dot equals half of the note's duration & 44 118 œ œœœœ œ RÔÔ „ ˙ .. = ˙ second dot equals half of the first dot's duration œ œ J ˙ Ù j œ œ slur means to play with no audible gap between the notes ? CHAPTER 4.11.BASICS OF RHYTHM E¯≤ minor 12. C˜ minor 4.4 Meter 8 113 112 & & ˙. 113 116 117 112 120 ? 119 123 118 j œ œœ œ œœ œœRÔ œ Ùœ œ œ 64th notes 64th ˙ œ ˙ .. ˙ œ œ œ Ô j œ œ œ œ J ˙ œœ œœœœœœ œ œ œœœœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœœœœœ œœœœ œ Ù W › „ & = œ œfour œbeats="quadruple" RÔÔ œ 4. three beats="triple" two beats="duple" j tie joins j notes together 2 œ œ 32 ˙œ œ ˙œ œ ˙œ œ 44 œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ & 8 œ œ to œcreateœa new duration j . = ˙ œ ˙ .. = beats˙in each bar œ naturally œ divide into two parts & ˙each œ of these meters is "simple" because the œ J ˙ j j 6 œ . œ . 9 œ . œ . œ . 12 ˙ . ˙ . ˙ . ˙ . & 16 œ œ œ œ œ œ 8 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ 4 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ 3 these meters Meter beats œ œis "compound" œ œ œ œbecause œ theœ ___________________________ œ in œeachœbarœnaturally œ œ divide œ œ œintoœthree œ œparts &each4 =ofœ_____________________ second dot equals half of equals half of 2 is “simple Thedot time signature duple meter.” The time signature 32 is 8three beats="triple" beats="duple" the first dot's duration four beats="quadruple" thetwo note's duration slur means to play with no 4 “simple triple meter.” Finally, 4 is “simple quadruple meter.” audible gap between the notes When describing meter, we say how the beat is divided before the number of beats in the measure. 3 5 6 ("simple" or "compound")triplet ("duple,"quintuplet "triple," or "quadruple") sextuplet (how the beat is divided) (the number of beats) 126 & ˙ ..„ 3 &4 œ 118 113 W › double whole Meter describesdouble the number measure (also know as rest a “bar”) and whole note of (or beats breve) in arest how the beats are normally divided. = Example Beat is "[t]he basic pulse underlying measured music and thus the unit by which musical time is reckoned..." according to Barry Kernfeld in The New Grove Dictionary ofnotes Jazz, 2nd edition. Pulse and beat are synonymous. tie joins together to create Tempo refers toa new the duration speed 1. of the beat or=pulse. Tempo can be referred to in beats per minute (bpm), such as 60bpm (where the rate of the beat = to a second), or, in classical = would be equal music, with terms like Allegro, Andante, and Adagio, sometimes in combinations with "M.M." for Maelzel’s second dot equals half of dot equals half of = 2. Metronome. the first dot's duration the note's duration slur means to play with no Meters with two beats in a bar are described as duple. If there are the three audible gap between notes beats in a bar, the meter is described as triple, and if there are four beats in a bar, the meter is described as quadruple.3 5 6 = 3. If the beats are normally divided into two parts, the meter is described two ways of notating the double whole 64th notes 64th as simple.118If the beats divided into three parts, rest the meter is double wholeare note normally (or breve) rest sextuplet triplet quintuplet described as compound. 115 8 two ways of notating the 14.20 D˜ minor 13. C minor 120 j j 2 œ œ &8 œ œ œ œ two beats="duple" four beats="quadruple" 32 ˙œ œ ˙œ œ ˙œ œ 44 œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ j j . . . . . . . . . 6 œ & 16 œ œ œ œœ œ œ 98 œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ 12 4 ˙œ œ œ ˙œ œ œ ˙œ œ œ ˙œ œ œ two beats="duple" 123 three beats="triple" With compound meters the bottom number specifies the division of the beat. 6 is “compound duple meter” because The beat value is a dotted note. We say 16 6 it has two beats. The time signature 8 is also compound duple. Compound time signatures have a top number greater than four that is divisible by 3 (6, 9, 12).each of these meters is "simple" because the beats in each bar naturally divide into two parts three beats="triple" four beats="quadruple" each of these meters is "compound" because the beats in each bar naturally divide into three parts 126 & The following table summarizes meter and time signatures. Top number of time signature: Top number of time signature: Number of beats: 2 6 Duple 3 9 Triple 4 12 Quadruple = Simple = Compound 8 112 118 120 113 j equals ˙ half ofœ 118 ˙ .. = ˙ œ œ 3 =dot & ˙ .second œ the first dot's duration œ slur means to play with no J ˙ 3 audible gap œ of theœnotesœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ &equals 464thbetween second dot half dot equals half of two ways of notatingthe thenote's duration double whole 64ththe notes first dot's duration CHAPTER 4. BASICS OF RHYTHM 21 slur means to play withtriplet no qu double whole note (or breve) rest rest audible gap between the notes 3 5 œ 6 œ œ œ W › „ œ 3 œ &œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ 120œ œ œ Rœ œ œÙtwo œj œ 5 three beats="triple" & 4Tuplets ÔÔ 3 œ jœbeats="duple" 118 4.5 6 2 œ œ 3 ˙ ˙ 3 œ triplet sextuplet quintuplet œ aœgrouping œ œ œ ofœ notes œ &œthat œ 2œ œ œ œœ œœ œ œ œ ˙œ œ 44 8 œœwould œœ œœœnot &that4 describes tie joins notes together Tuplet is a generic term to create a new duration beats="triple" four beats="quadruple" twooccur beats="duple" sextuplet triplet quintuplet normally within three a beat. j j j each of these meters is "simple" because the beats in each b . œ =œ note˙ 3naturally A ˙quarter into eighth sixteenth œ divides ˙˙two.. beats="duple" ˙ three œ œnotes œ œor four = ˙ two & œ 2 ˙ 4 œ œ beats="triple" four beats="quadruple" 120 œ J œ occurs notes. & 8 Aœ triplet œ œ œ is2 a œgrouping œ œofj three œ j œeighth œ notes 4 œthat œ˙ œ œ within œ beats="duple" œ œthe three beats="triple" four beats=" two span ofdotthe quarter would be123a grouping of˙five sixteenth second dot equals half of equals half of note. A quintuplet 2 œ œ 3 ˙ ˙ j j44 œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ the first dot's duration theoccur note's duration & 8 œ œ œ œ 2 œ œ œ œ œ œ . toœparts . 9 œ . œ . œ . 12 . notes each to within the span of one quarter note. It is not uncommon see slur means to play with no 6 œ of these meters is "simple" because the beats in each bar naturally divide into two audible the notes8 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ 4 œ̇ œ œ &gap16between œœœœœœ quintuplets, sextuplets, and septuplets. dot equals half of the note's duration 123 118 36 œœj. œjœ. 9œ œœ. œ œœ. œ œ . œ œ12 œ˙ . œ œ ˙œ. œ œ ˙œ. œ œ ˙œ. œ œ & 16 4 œœœœœœ & 8 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œj.œ j4. œ œ. œ œ. œ .œ œ œ œ .œ œ œ . 123 6 œœœœœœœ œtriplet 98 œœ œ2œquintuplet œœ œ œ œœ œ œœ 12 œ sextuplet œ˙ œ œ ˙œ œ œ ˙œ . œ œ ˙œ . œ œ & 16 4 & 4 each of these meters is "compound" because the beats in each bar naturally divide into three parts each of these meters "simple" because the beats in each bar naturally divide into two parts fourisbeats="quadruple" two beats="duple"three beats="triple" 3 5 each of 6these meters is "compound" because the beats in each b 126 four beats="quadruple" two beats="duple"three beats="triple" If you write a piece of music that naturally has a triplet division to the 3 beat, you should use 68 , 98 each or 12 depending on the number of3beats beats in each of meters is "compound" because the in each bar naturally divide into three parts 8 these 126 measure. 126 & 42 œ œ œ œ œ œ & 120 3 3 & 68 œ œ œ œ œ œ & 42 œ œ œ œ œ œ 3 3 128 œ & 68 œ œ œ œ Inœ compound a duplet is a grouping of two eighth notes to occur 6 œ meter, œ œ œquarter œ note and&a quadruplet is a grouping 9of &span 8 of œa dotted within the Figure 4.5.1 Two measures that sound 127 the same four eighth notes to occur with the span of a dotted quarter note. 127 128 4 & 4 4œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ 127 6 & 8 œ128. & œ œ œ œ duplet œ œ œ œ9 œ quadruplet &4 œ œœœœœ œœ œ œœœ 2 4 4.6 Common Rhythmic Notation Errors The standard practice when notating rhythms is to use beaming to show where the beginning of each beat occurs. Consider the following example: 4 4œ œ œ œœœœœ œœ œœ œœœ œ œ œœ œœ œ & 4& 4J J It is difficult to discern where the downbeats are. downbeats? ? ? ? ? ? ? 4 4& 4œ œJ œ œœœœœ œœ œœ œœœ œ œ œœ œœ downbeats? &4 J œ Here is the same rhythm correctly notated. The downbeats provide a reference point, matching the conductor’s beat pattern or your tapping toe. & # 4 œ œ# œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ BASICS œ 4 œ œ œ œ œ œ CHAPTER œ œ 4. OF RHYTHM œ El - ean - or Rig - by, # 4 & 4 œœ œ œ œ picks up the rice without syncopation El - ea - nor Rig - by 156 130 158 in the church 1 9 where her wed - ding has been, 2 3 4 4œ œ œ&œ 4 #œœ œœ œ# œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ w 22 œ wœ picks up the rice in the church where her wed - ding has been, In compound meters like 68 , the beat is the dotted quarter. 6 & 8 &œ 44œ œJ œ œ œœœœœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œœ. œ œJ incorrect rhythmic notation 1 2 3 9 4 & 44 œ œ1 œ œ œ œ œ œ2 œ œ œ œ ? ? ? correct rhythmic notation 1 2 downbeats? & 68 &œ 44œ œœ œ œ œœœœœ œœ œœ œ œ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ. œ œ J 131 44 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ & The exception to this practice of “showingJthe beats” involves syncopation. Syncopation occurs when notes on weak beats and on weak parts of beats are emphasized and nearby strong beats are deemphasized. Syncopation is downbeats? ? ? ? common in popular music. 2 3 Strong beats are the first beat of each measure (in 4 and 4 ) and beats 1 and 3 in 44 . Syncopation at the beat level involves ties across those strong beats. Numbers in parentheses in the example below are beats that are obscured through syncopation. 132 & 44 œJ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ 133 137 2 &4 œ & 43 œ & 44 œ 141 144 & 158 & 166 & œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ (1) œ œ œ ˙ œ œ (1) (3) ˙ œ ˙. œ œ (1) œ ˙ Syncopation can also occur at the division of the beat level. Below are two syncopation figures that don’t show the beat but are acceptable because they are common and to write them out correctly involves more symbols (beamed eighths and ties) for the performer to comprehend. 4 &4 œ 141 œ œ œ œ ˙ œ (3) CHAPTER 4. BASICS OF RHYTHM 144 exceptions to rhythmic notation rules & 44 œJ œ œ œ œ J J 44 œ œ J œ J 2-beat syncopated pattern 146 œ œ (1) œ ˙ 23 œ œ J 4-beat syncopated pattern & 44 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ 44 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ this "proper" rhythmic notation of the above syncopations is not required An example of syncopation at the eighth-note level (the division of the beat) can be found in the following example from “Eleanor Rigby.” 148 & 148 152 & # 4 œœ 4 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ #œ œ œ El - ean - or Rig - by, picks up the rice # & 44 œ œ œ œ œ without syncopation El - ea - nor Rig - by œœ œ œ œœ œœ in the church where her wed - ding has been, œ œ œ œ #œ œ #œ picks up the rice in the w œ œ œ œ œ w church where her wed - ding has been, Notice how syncopating notes gives them emphasis and creates a “pull” incorrect rhythmic notation against the rhythm 156 of the accompaniment. 6 & 8 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ . œ œJ 4.7 Practice Exercises 1. correct rhythmic notation After listening to each example, specify2 the meter (e.g., triple”). 1 1 “compound 2 158 (a) Lin-Manuel Miranda, “First Burn” 6 & 8 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ. œ œ YT: r2ys-AimNbE œ Al Green,= Willie Mitchell, measured(b) horizontally "melodic" intervalAl Jackson Jr., “Let’s Stay Together” ? 44 œ J 160 œ .. œ #œ # œ J #œ œ œœ .. # œ œ J J YT: uSu6tcbMOu0 ˙ ˙ measured vertically = "harmonic" interval (c) Kenny Kirkland, “Dienda” 162 wFarjeon,w“Mornw ? w (d) Traditional Scottish w Gaelicw tune, wtext by Eleanor w w ing Has Broken” YT: ko1gUVP461A perfect unison (P1) major second (M2) major third (M3) perfect fourth (P4) perfect fifth (P5) major sixth (M6) major perfect seventh octave (M7) (P8) YT: qH0iFkxQba4 submediant leading tone dominant subdominant Guy Lawrence, James Napier, and Sam Smith, mediantHoward Lawrence, tonic (e)supertonic ? w1̂ 163 w “Disclosure” 2̂ 164 ?w tonic w 3̂ w w 5̂ 4̂ w6̂ supertonic mediant dominant subtonic submediant subdominant b ww ww w w w7̂ 46 ˙. #œ & # ˙˙ .. # œœ ‰ Œ ‰ p ? ˙. œ ‰ œ œ nœ f # w & # ˙˙ ˙˙ 2. ? 2142# # ˙ 49 & ˙ & 19 YT: 93ASUImTedo ˙ ww ˙ ˙ œ bb ˙ œ w œ ≈ ≈ b œr œ ˙ & œ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ poco cresc. ˙˙ œ ˙ Ó ∑ ˙ ∑ œ œ #œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ∑ ˙˙˙ ∑ ˙˙˙˙˙˙∑ ∑˙˙˙˙˙ ∑ wwww ∑ ∑ ww ˙ n œœ ˙˙ ‰˙ ˙ J ‰ ‰ ˙˙ ## ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ 15 15 Meter: 1. D minor 94 # œ ∑& œJ& ∑ ˙‰ ˙ ∑ ∑ &b ∑ ? ∑ 25 b 113 115 ∑ 3. ? # ∑ ∑ 6. F˜ minor ?? b ∑ Meter: # ∑ ‰ ∑ 4. D˜ minor 5. A¯≤ minor œ ∑ # ∑ ∑Jn b œ ∑ & p 23 œ Mozart, K. 283, III, mm. 187-190 9. B¯≤ #minor 10. E minor j ‰ j n ‰ & œj ? ∑ œ & œ œ b œœ ∑ p ∑ ∑ # 5. B¯≤ minor & ∑ # ∑? œ œœ & 9. G˜ minor 10. A¯≤ minor 23 œ œ œ œ œ ˙ œ˙ 7. A minor 11. E¯≤ minor d. Time ∑ Signature: ∑ 8. B minor œœ Meter: ∑ ∑ 12. C˜ minor ˙œ b œœ 13. C minor œœ œœ ∑ 14. D˜ minor ∑ Use one note value (with one or two dots as necessary) to show the sum of all the rhythmic values given. ∑∑ ∑ ∑ Example 1. 2. 118 4. ? ‰ œ œ œ˙ œ # œ œ œ œ 3. 119 œ œ 8. G˜ minor ∑ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœœœœ ? ## # ∑ ? œ Corelli, 5, No. 1, mm. 12-15 œ Op. Op. 5, No. 1, mm. 12-15 J Corelli, œ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ w ∑˙˙ ˙˙ ∑ ˙ ˙˙∑ ∑˙˙p˙˙ ∑w w∑ œ ∑œ œ∑n # w ˙ ˙ j j ˙ ‰ ˙ œj Ó Ó n # & œ Ó Ó œœ ˙ œ˙ ˙œ˙ ∑ p ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ # œ ∑œ œ œ∑ œ ∑ ### # n # ∑ & 3. F minor ‰ œ œ ≈ œ œ Beethoven, Op. 110, III, mm. 124-125 2. E"Pavane minorPassamaize" 3. A ˜ minor 4.Danceries, G minor m. 7 Gervaise, from Sixième Livre de && b œ˙ ∑ 116 117 ∑ 1. F minor 24 109 # ∑ ∑ œ ? Signature: HWc. Time 104 & ∑ 2. F˜ minor œ # œ œ œ œ7. C minor 6. B minor n œœ ?# œ J ? 99# # ∑ 24 ‰ j œœ ∑ œw œ œ . œ J 14 Ócresc. p˙ & œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ # œœœ œœœ œœœ Mozart, K. 283, III, mm. 187-190 ∑Ó Ó ? b b œR≈≈Œ‰. . ∑ ∑ ∑? ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ b. Time Signature: Meter: 89 19 rK œ ? b œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ b œœœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ b b n œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ nœ œ œ œ œ œ j # œ ‰ œœ & 51 œJ # ww˙ b & b4 œ ∑ ∑œ &&∑ # ## œ∑˙˙ #œ œ ?# œ ? ## ? # & # ∑ 24 œn œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ f ∑ ?œ . # œ . & œ œœ # œ . ˙. œ . n œ œœ a. Time Signature: 19 ∑ Op. 5, No. 1, mm. 12-15 For each example, specify the implied timeCorelli, signature and the meter (e.g., ˙˙ ˙˙ œ œ n# ˙duple”). ˙ “simple ˙ Ó ˙ w ˙ ˙ ## Beethoven, Op. 57, I, mm. 78-80 CHAPTER 4. BASICS OF RHYTHM 15 ? ## # & ∑ 14 2 ∑ ˙ .. ∑= œ œ ∑œ ∑ œ œ œ ∑œ∑j ∑ =œ =œ œ œ œ ∑ =œœœœœœ =œ œ œ œ ∑ ∑ CHAPTER 4. BASICS OF RHYTHM 4. 5. 25 Specify the meter of each time signature. (a) The meter of 4 2 (b) The meter of 9 16 (c) The meter of 3 4 is: is: is: Correct the incorrect rhythmic notation in each example in order to show the beats. The subdivisions grouped into beats are shown in parentheses11 above the rhythms to be corrected. Example 1. ã 43 œJ . (œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ) 2. œ ã 68 œ 6 œ˙ ã8 ( 381 3. œ 3 (œ œ œ ã4 œ œ œ ( 379 Incorrect œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ) œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ) œ œ œ. œ œ œ J 3 (œ 4 68 ( œ œ œ 68 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ) œ (œ œ 43 œ . Correct œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ) œ œ. œ œœœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ) œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ) (œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ) Click here to download the homework. versions of the textbook, homework exercises, and practice exercises 44 PDF be found at musictheory.pugetsound.edu ãcan 383 Chapter 5 10 10 148 148 152 152 # 4 Intervals & # 44 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ & œœ œ œ œ œ #œœ# œœ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ w œ œ œœ œœ w 4 Elœ- eanœ- or Rigœ - œby,œ œpicksœ upœthe rice in theœchurch whereœher œwed œ- ding has been, # 4 towithout œ œ in# œthe œnextœ chapter, In&order œ œ œwe wwill focus œ œ syncopation œ œ ofœ œ#triads 44 œ prepare œ forœ theœ study # # œ # œ primarily on major and minor seconds, thirds, and sixths, œ œ œ œ œ œperfect, œ œ œ œ & 4 - ea - nor Rigœ- byœ picksœ up the rice in the church where her wedand œ been,wdimin- ding has ished, andElaugmented fourths and fifths. We will leave discussion of augmented El - ean - or Rig - by, without syncopation picks up the rice in the church where her wed - ding has been, El - ea - nor Rig - by up the rice the chapters church whereon herSeventh wed - ding has been, and and diminished sixths andpicks sevenths forinthe Chords incorrect rhythmic notation Augmented Sixth156Chords. We will return to Section 5.5 at that time. incorrect rhythmic notation 156 6 & 86 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ . .œ œJ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œœ œœ 5.1 Introduction&to8 Intervals J correct rhythmic notation 1of scales,notation 2 1 2 melodies. Intervals are the 158 building correct blocks rhythmic chords (or harmonies), and Intervals are a measurement between two pitches, either vertically 1 2 1 2 or hori158 zontally. When measuring vertically, we refer to harmonic intervals because the two notes sound simultaneously. When measuring horizontally, we refer to melodic intervals because the notes occur one after the other. & 686 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ . œ œ & 8 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ. œ œ œ œ measured horizontally = "melodic" interval ? 44 œ ? 44 Jœ J 160 ˙ ˙ ˙˙ When you measure fromvertically the tonic=up to each scale degree of a major scale, measured "harmonic" interval you find the following intervals: ? 162 162 ? . #œ œ œœ .. # # œœ œœ . . # œ œ œ. # œ J J œœ œ . # #Jœœ œœ . # œ measuredJvertically = "harmonic" J interval J measured horizontally = "melodic" interval 160 ?w w perfect unison (P1) w major second (M2) w major third (M3) w perfect fourth (P4) w perfect fifth (P5) w major sixth (M6) w w major perfect seventh octave (M7) (P8) 163 All intervals in the example above are either “perfect” or “major.” 5.1.1 Numeric Size of Interval There are two elements to naming intervals: the quality and the number (for example, “major sixth,” abbreviated as “M6”). Let us first focus on the numeric size of intervals. 26 ? CHAPTER 5. INTERVALS 11 11 Odd-numbered intervals will always be a line to a line or a space to a space. 165 165 ? ? 2 ? 9 ? ww 3rds 3rds ww ww 5ths 5ths w w ww ww w w 7ths 7ths w w Even-numbered intervals will always be a space to a line or a line to a space. 168 168 165 ? w w ? ww ? 2nds 2nds w w ww ww 4ths 4ths ww ww w w w w 6ths 6ths w w w w w w 8ves 8ves 11 172 5.1.2 Interval Quality: Perfect 172 5ths versus Major/Minor 7ths 3rds 168 ww ? ww 4 27 3rds ww 174 2nds ww Intervals such as the unison, fourth, fifth, and octave can be classified11 as “perfect” but never “major” or “minor”. Conversely, the intervals of the second, third, sixth, and seventh can be major or minor but never perfect in quality. ? ww ww ww ww 185 185 2nds ww4ths w Perfect Intervals: ? 172 Major or Minor Intervals: ? w w w w w w 6ths w w w w Unison, 4th, 5th, 8ve 2nd, 3rd, 6th, 7th bw w w w 8ves w w w #w Perfect intervals5ths are always natural to natural, sharp to sharp, and flat to 7ths 4 flat except for the fourths and fifths between B and F, which involve B to F 2 192 B to F. 192 and M7 m7 M7 m7 ? w w ?w b w # #www bw ? 199 199 ? 4ths ? ? 206 206 ? 199 n b ww # n ww perfect fourths 177 Minor 172 w w w w ww w# # ww b b ww b n ww perfect fifths 6ths exceptions between B and F w w bw w #w n w wb w w n w wb w ## www n w w w w #w perfect octaves 8ves intervals are one half step smaller than major intervals. M7 m7 M7 m7 5.2 How to Identify Perfect, Major, and Minor Intervals 206 ? Here are two methods for identifying intervals. The first method involves thinking of the lower note of an interval as the tonic (the first note of the scale). Remember that all the notes above the tonic in a major scale are perfect or major. Determine if the upper note is in the major scale. If it is not, determine if the interval is a half step smaller than a major interval, in which case it is a minor interval. ? b w # # ww n b ww # n ww bw 174 #w bw nw #w # w bw bw n w CHAPTER 5. INTERVALS exceptions between B and F 28 bw w & 177 bw #w nw bw #w nw Interval: m7 quality size (P, M, m) (number) 178 think of lower note as tonic 179 & w b w7 œ œ & w 1 both notes are on spaces, so count in odd numbers to determine the numeric size of the interval (3) (5) E¯≤ is not in the F major key signature, so the interval is not major œ œ œ œ œ Aœ œ key signature of F major 180 &b m7 E¯≤ E F M7 If the lower note of an interval has a sharp or flat on it, cover up the accidental, determine the interval, then factor the accidental back in. 12 #w & #w 182 Interval: ?7 186 & # #w w cover sharp on lower note to think in G major instead of G˜ # w w #w #w F˜ is in G major, raising G to G˜ makes so this is a M7 this a half step smaller, therefore it is a m7 The second method is to memorize how many half steps there are in each interval. To determine the size of an interval, count the number of half steps between the two notes then refer to your memory. Number of half steps 1 2 3 4 5 6 Name of interval m2 M2 m3 M3 P4 Tritone∗ Number of half steps 7 8 9 10 11 12 Name of interval P5 m6 M6 m7 M7 P8 ∗ A “tritone” is a generic name for an augmented fourth ( + 4) or diminished fifth ( ◦ 5). These two intervals are enharmonic. Augmented and Diminished Intervals are discussed later in this chapter. #w & #w #w w # CHAPTER 5. INTERVALS w w #w #w 29 8 9 10 bcover w sharp on lower1 so2 this3 is a4 M7b œ5 n œ6thisœ7a bhalf bw step smaller, œ n œ & notew to think inwG major bœ nœ bœ nœ therefore it is a m7 instead of G˜ counting half steps 186 Interval: ?7 F˜ is in G major, raising G to G˜ makes 10 half steps = m7 5.3 How to Write Perfect, Major, and Minor Intervals counting half steps #w & #w #w 1 #2 3 w 4 5 6 7 8 # w9 10 b w bw b œ given nwœ below. To write an intervalwabove a given note,w use the two methods # œ b œ n œ b œ n œ & n œ sixth above the note A, start with the A w asked to write w b œa minor If you are 186 4 G to G˜ makes G major, major scale and key signature. F˜ In is A in major, there is raising an10Fhalf , which steps is= am7major 6 cover sharp on lower so this M7 sixth thisabove a halfA.step smaller, sixth above the note A. Therefore, F isisa aminor Interval: ?7 12 note to think in G major instead of G˜ 188 & w## ww & 182 ### ? m6 up = ? & w #ww w # w w M6 up is F#, according F˜ is in G major, to A Major key so signature cover sharp on lower this is a M7 Interval: ?7 186 therefore it is a m7 bw w Nw #ww #w m6 above A = F raising G to G˜ makes œ bœ nœ bw w bœ nœ bœ nœ bœ nœ counting half steps note to think in G major this a half step smaller, therefore is10 a m7 Alternatively, you can simply know 1 2count3 the4number 5 of 6 half 8 9Ifityou 7 steps. instead of G˜ there are 8 half steps in a minor sixth, you can count from A up to F. Writing small intervals up to a major third below a given note is straightforward using a combination of whole and half steps. However, to write 10 half steps = m7larger intervals below a given note, it is sometimes helpful to invert the interval first 186 (Inversion of Intervalscounting Explained is discussed in the next section). half steps 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 bw b œ n œ9 b10w œ b œ n œ b œ n œ # & #w nwœ Nw w b œ Explained 5.4 Inversion of# Intervals 10 half w w wsteps = m7 & 188 ? There are an up interval, one lower and onem6 higher. m6188only up = two ? notes inM6 aboveTo A =invert F is F˜, according an interval, change the position of the notes so the note that was lower is now ? to A Major key signature higher. w & w m6 &w w m6 up = ? w ### w ww w M6 up is F˜, according to A Major key signature w & Awis below wF w ww M3 w Nw w m6 above A = F w A is above w F w In the above example, to a FM3. ThisM3 is true for notes m6a m6 inverts A is below A isall above F a M3 (or m6) away from each other. Below are examples of how intervals invert. 195 & b ww b ww ww m2 201 & 210 & M7 M2 w b ww w ww bw w m7 m3 M6 M3 w ww w m6 P4 ww # ww # ww P5 °4 +5 Note that the symbol ◦ represents “diminished” (one half step smaller than perfect or minor) and the symbol + represents “augmented” (one half step larger than perfect or major). Below is a chart of how intervals invert. CHAPTER 5. INTERVALS 30 (larger) Augmented HowMinorIntervals Invert Major Perfect (smaller) Diminished 203 & 8 7 6w #w 5 m3 diminished third b ww m P ° ‹ # ww +3 M3 minor third augmented third major third ww º4 & M P + # # ww # ww +4 P4 To write a small interval below a given note, you should be able to combine whole steps and half steps up to the interval of a perfect fourth (two whole fourth steps plusdiminished one halffourth step). To write perfect a larger interval belowaugmented a given fourth note, invert the interval size, determine the note above, then write it below the given note. 210 & w 202 º3 & 207 214 1 2 3b w #w 4 & w w ? invert interval: m7 down = M2 up #w w M2 above E is F˜ m7 down = ? w #w m7 below = F˜ 5.5 Augmented and Diminished Intervals A is above F Augmented intervals are one half step larger than perfect or major intervals 219 & and diminished intervals are one half step smaller than perfect or minor intervals. Remember that perfect intervals (unisons, fourths, fifths, and octaves) can never be major or minor, and major and minor intervals (seconds, thirds, sixths, and sevenths) can never be perfect in quality. However, any size of interval can be augmented or diminished. (larger) Perfect (smaller) Diminished Minor Augmented Major Here are musical examples illustrating the continuum of interval quality. 202 & 13 Diminished 203 & # b ww º3 Minor CHAPTER 5. INTERVALS diminished 144 207 ID # only & & 150 203 210 & 6 156 ID # & Qual & wwbº4w w & 202 3 Ex. ____ # b ww 1. ____ diminished w & third w w w 2. ____ # ww w +4 w # ww ww P4 ww ? ww 1. ____ diminished fourth & wwº3 w w 2. ____ 3. ____ ww #4.# ww____ # ww minor third 2. ____ 3. ____P4 13. M3↑ Incorrect 14. m2↑ 31 w w 5. ____ w w augmented fourth ? ww M3 # ww 3. ____ m3 augmented third 4. ____ perfect fourth 1. ____ º4 # ‹ ww major third ?majorb wwthird w 5.6 Practice wwwwww ?? w wwbwww Exercises & b & w ww w ID # onlyHW #w & 207 ww # ‹ ww6. ____ +3 5. ____ bw bw w #w # ww w 4. ____ 5. ____+4 16. º5↑ Correct 17. M6↑ # ww augmented third 6. ____ ww b ww w each example. diminished fourth perfect fourth augmented fourth 1. Specify only the number, not the quality, for 3 Ex. ____ 1. ____ 2. ____ 3. ____ 4. ____ 5. ____ 144 1. ____ 2. ____ 3. ____ 4. ____ 5. ____ 6. ____ w w 150 ww ? w ww 168 w www & w w 210 w ww ? ID # only # w w w w w w ? # w w b ww 4. ____ w____ HW & b3w ww www b w w & b Ex. ____ 1. 2. ____ 3. ____ 5. ____ & 1. ____ 2. ____ 3. ____ 4. ____ 5. ____ 6. ____ 150 2. Identify the interval quality 9. and size for each example. 7. ____ ____ 10. ____ 11. ____ 12. w ____ w 8. ____ w 156 w ? www w b w w w ? & w # www #www HW 174 w#ww & ww# w ? bb ww ID # & Qual # w b w w #w & 1. ____ b w w 3. ____ 4. ____ 6. ____ # w 2.2.____ bw w 5.5. ____ 1. ____ ____ 3. ____ 4. ____ ____ 6. ____ 156 13. ____ 14. ____ ____ 16. ____ 17. b w____ 18.#____ 162 w following # wwintervals 15.above w 3. Write the the? givenwnote. 180 w b w & b w ? w # ww ID # & Qual # w b w b w w # ww w w HW & ? 4. w____ bw w 3. ____ 5. ____ 6. ____ Write above & 1.1.____ bw w____ 2.2.____ # w b w ____ 3. ____ 4. ____ 5. ____ 6. ____ 7 162 168 w b w 1. m6↑ 2. P4↑ 3. M3↑ 4. M6↑ 5. M7↑ 6. m2↑ ? w # w ww b#www www # ww # www wwb w 186 HW & ? b w b w 4. Write the following intervals below the given note. & 1. ____ w ?4. b____ ww 5. ____ HW 2.#____ 3.w____ 6. ____ ww & ww w w w ? b w 11. ____ 12.#____ 168 bw ____ 9. ____ 10. ____ 8. ____ w Writing below & 1.7.M2↑ w ww 3.#M7↑ 4. M2↑ 2. +4↑ 5. M6↑ 6. #P5↑ w w ? w w b w 174 b w 192 w bw # w & 1. #º5↓w b w ? 2. M3↓ 3. P4↓ 4. M6↓ 5. m3↓ 6. M2↓ ↑↓ w #w & #w w w # wb ww ?10.b____ wb w w # w & b w 7. w ____ 9. ____ 11. ____ 12. ____ 8. ____ ? 16.#____ Click here 13. to ____ download the w w 210 14. ____homework. 15.w____ 17. ____ 18.b____ b w & HW174 180 PDF versions of the textbook, homework exercises, and practice exercises w 8. m6↑ 12. m7↑ w 7. m3↑ 9. P4↑ ww ? 10.b wm6↑ 11.#+5↑ # w w # 198 can be&found at musictheory.pugetsound.edu b w 5. M3↓ ? 1. m6↓ 2. M2↓ 3. +5↓ 4. P4↓ 6. m3↓ b ww bww ? ww Write above & #www b w # b17.w# w____ 18.# w____ 15. ____ ? 16.w____ & 13.w____ 14.b w____ bww 216 #w 180 & 1. m6↑ 2. P4↑ 3. M3↑ 4. M6↑ 5. M7↑ 6. m2↑ 186 ? 13. M3↑ 14. m2↑ 15. P5↑ 16. º5↑ 17. M6↑ 18. b+5↑ w w 11. P5↓ 7. w M7↓ 8. M2↓ 9. m3↓ 10. P4↓ 12. m3↓ Write above & b w ? w # w b w HW ↑↓ & ww w w 222 w w w ? 4. bM6↑ w 1. m6↑ 2. P4↑ 3. w M3↑ 5. M7↑ 6. m2↑ w w & 1. M2↑ 186 3. M7↑ 4. M2↑ 2. +4↑ 5. M6↑ 6. P5↑ 192 ? 16.wM3↓ 17. M6↓ 18. P5↓ ↑↓ HW 14. +4↓ 15.#m2↓ & 13. wwº5↓ w w ? wb w w w w & w 3. M7↑ 4. M2↑ 1. M2↑ 2. +4↑ 5. M6↑ 6. P5↑ 228 192 # 8. m6↑ b 12. m7↑ b b 9. P4↑ ?#10. ↑↓ # #m6↑ 11. +5↑ b7.b m3↑ b 198 b & # w w & w ? w #b ww ___ minor B¯ major & Ex.w___ w ___ b¯ minor 1. ___ major ww b w # w 8. m6↑ 10. m6↑ 12. m7↑ 11. +5↑ 232 9. P4↑ #7. m3↑ 198 b b b b16. º5↑ 17. M6↑ 18. +5↑ 14. m2↑ 15. P5↑ & 13.# M3↑ ? # w ___ minorw &2. ___wmajor w ___ minor bw 3. ___#major w 144 162 6 HW # # ww +3 M3 minor third third 6 # ww m3 236 ã 68 œ 15. P5↑ 18. +5↑ ( œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ) (œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ) 238 & www œ œ œ œ œ œ. Fifth Third www Fifth Third œ www Fifth Third Root ww w Fifth Third Root 1. º5↓ 2. m7↓ Minor bw w Diminished 210 & HW & 216 ↑↓ 222 203 & w 7. M7↓ 8. M2↓ & # b ww º3 9. m3↓ ? bw # ww 6. m7↓ 12. +6↓ w bw # ‹ ww +3 18. P5↓ 16. º7↓M3 17. M6↓ # # # # major third j j . b b b b b minor third bw #w 11. P5↓ # # ww m3 15. m2↓ 14. +4↓ bw 5. M3↓ 10. P4↓ w w & Chapter 6 13. º5↓ ? w 6. +2↓ #w 4. P4↓ bw w 202 3. +5↓ 5. m3↓ augmented third w. ‰ n n# ## Œ ‹ œ œ # œ ˙ œ œ bb b b B¯≤ œ j ˙ . 1. ___œmajor œ # œ minor nn # b¯≤ & Ex. ___ J n œJ œ œJ ___ œ . major œ œJ œ º4œœ œ‰ œ . ‹ œJ # œœ___ +4œJ minor P4 J Œ ‰ J ## b ww Œ wwb b b b cresc. # ww & & j jœ j j j to Triads 6.1 Introduction œ b œj œ . fourth œ œ œj augmented œ œ diminished perfect fourth b œ œ j œ œ œ œj # œminor ?2. ___ œ fourth ___ minor œ œ n n n n # # # # ˙ . 3. ___ major œ œ œ œ œ œ ___ œ b b b b major œ œ Œ ‰ ‰ofŒ three ‰ Œ notes J Jthirds.J œA Jtriadœ isœ also J A triad consists stacked in consecutive œ # ˙ œ . J Correct Incorrect J 42 207 232 diminished third w ã 68 œ & 236 210 w Beethoven, Op. 127, II, mm. 100-102 #w w # # # # w # w. ‰Œ & ? #### ∑ called a chord as well as a harmony. (Harmony also refers to chord progressions.) invert interval: 45 m7ofdown = M2when up it is stacked in thirds is called the root. The lowest ?note a triad The middle note is the third and the highest note of the triad is the fifth. (We m7 below = F˜ m7 downinversions =? will discuss of triads later.)M2 above E is F˜ 238 214 œ wwwww & & ˙˙ ..w 46 & 2. M2↓ b Triads &b 2284 242 w 1. m6↓ Major 4. M6↓ w ? #w 3. P4↓ 218 49 œ œ œ œ œ. Fifth Fifth Third Third Root ‰Œ ‰ œ Fifth Fifth FifthFifth www ww Third www ww Third Fifth wwww Third Third Fifth Third w wœ œRoot œn œ œw œ œThird œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ Root œ œ œRoot œ œ œ œ œ œ œ wœ œ œ œ œRoot œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ Root œœœ Beethoven, Op. 57, I, mm. 78-80 #œ & # ˙ . # œœ Root Root There f of triads—augmented, major, minor, p˙ . are four qualities œ . diœ œ . and œ œ ? œ minished. . œ ‰ œ œ nœ ˙. œ . n œ œœ f +5 # w M3 w P5 P5 b w º5 b b w w w m3 w M3 w m3 & & bb w + augmented œ œ w M3 & & M3 r ≈ ≈ b œ œ major œ œ M œ w m3 m Kr minor œ œ œ œ. J & w m3 œ œdiminished œ ≈ œ œ º Beethoven, Op. 110, III, mm. 124-125 Major and minor triads are common, diminished are less common, p triadscresc. poco cresc. and augmented triads are rare. œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ # œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ ? b b n œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ b œœœœ n œœœœ œœœœ œœœœ œœœœ œœœœ œœœœ bœ œ œ œ œ 6.2 Lead-Sheet Symbols b b∑ œ & ? b ‰Œ≈R. b 51 Lead-sheet symbols (also known as “lead-sheet notation” and “lead-sheet chord symbols”) are often used as shorthand for chords in popular music and jazz. These symbols allow a guitarist or pianist to choose how to “voice” the chords, i.e., how they want to arrange the notes. 52 ww & w C major triad in different voicings—all chords below contain only C, E, and G ? ∑ www ∑ ww ww w ww w w w 32 ww w ww w ∑ w ww ww ww ww ww CHAPTER 6. TRIADS 33 Lead-sheet symbols for triads communicate the root and quality of a chord. 44 44 Lead-sheet Symbol F Gm D◦ C+ Chord Quality major minor diminished augmented Notes in the Chord F–A–C 2 G–B –D 2 D–F–A 4 C–E–G Here is a musical example with lead-sheet symbols and guitar tablature. A A 422 422 422 422 ###### 44 ‰ œjj œ œ œ œ & & 4 ‰ œ œ œ œ œ œœ .. œœ œœ # ### # & # & ? ## ### ? # 444 œœœ w 444 w She's just She's just œœœ a girl a girl œœœ and and she's on she's on œœœ D D 424 424 424 424 # ### Œ # & # Œ & # ### # & # & ? ## ### ? # œœœ œ ww F #m F #m Ó œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ Ó fi - re fi - re œœœ ww œœœ œœœ œœœ E E j‰ Œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœj ‰ Œ Hot - ter than a fan - ta - sy Hot - ter than a fan - ta - sy œœœ œ œœœ œ œœœ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ Lone - ly like a high - way Lone - ly like a high - way œœœ œœ œœœ ww œœ œœœ œœ œœœ œœ # ### YT: J91ti_MpdHA # # & Figure & 6.2.1 Alicia Keys, Salaam Remi, Jeff Bhasker, Billy Squier, “Girl on Fire” 426 (2012) 426 # # ## can see in the example above, major triads are represented by an As#you # & & uppercase letter ( A , E , and D ) while minor triads are represented with the 4 root in uppercase followed by a lowercase “m” (e.g., F m ). Diminished triads # ? # are?represented by including the diminished symbol ( ◦ ) after the chord root # ##◦# (e.g., C ) while augmented triads are represented by including the augmented 426 426 symbol after the root ( C+ ). ? #### ˙ œ œ ˙ œ nœ #˙ ˙ #˙ ˙ CHAPTER 6. TRIADS 34 Sara Bareilles "Love Song" 6.3 Gm F/A B bsus2 Inverted Triads &b œ œ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ ? b Œ ‰ j ‰ œj œ œ œ œ œ 67 C œœœ œœœ œœœ œœ œ j Ó ‰ œj ‰ œ œ œ Dm C/E œœœ œœœ œœœ œœ œ j j Ó ‰œ ‰œ œ œ D/F # F œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ # œœ An inverted triad does not have the root as the lowest note. It is important to distinguish between root and bass. The root of a chord is the lowest note when the notes are stacked in thirds. The bass is the lowest note, which might be the root, third, or fifth. A triad is in “root position” when the root is the lowest note, “first inversion” when the third of the chord is the lowest note, and “second inversion” when the fifth of the chord is the lowest note. 71 & www C ? ∑ ww w "root position" ww w w wC 222 & ? E ∑ ww wG ‰ j‰ j #œ œ #œ "second inversion" ∑ www wG Csus4 fifth of chord is lowest note Csus2 (also Csus9) (also Csus)∑ ∑ ∑ 6.3.1 "Slash" Chords Fifth Fifth Fifth In lead-sheet notation, an inverted chord has the triad before the slash (/) and the bass note after Third it. “ C/E ” means a C triad with Fourth an E as the lowest note. Second (or ∑ ∑ note that is not the root of∑ the chord. In Therefore, a slash chord has a bass Root Root Root fact, it is possible to .have slash chords where the bass note is not one of the C Major root of chord is lowest note 77 ww w wE "first inversion" Ó ww & w third of chord is lowest note www & 4 chord tones (e.g., C F ). ww &w slash chord C/E bass note Remember, in a slash chord, the first letter you see represents the root of the chord. The letter after the slash is the lowest note (the bass). Lead-sheet Symbol F/A Dm/A . 2 G◦ D . 4 C+ G Root of Chord F D G C Notes in the Chord F–A–C D–F–A 2 2 G–B –D 4 C–E–G Bass Note (Lowest Note) A A 2 D 4 G ˙ ˙ es: es: es: es: cc œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ ˙˙˙ ˙˙˙ cc ˙˙ ˙˙ 474 474 CHAPTER 6. TRIADS œœ œ ˙ œ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œœ ˙ œœ œ ˙ ˙˙˙ ˙˙˙ ˙˙˙ ˙˙ ˙˙˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ 6.4 Analyzing Chords When a three-note chord is represented by four or more notes (some of which are duplicates of the original three notes) and spread out across a grand staff, we can arrive at a lead-sheet symbol by answering three questions: ˙˙ ˙ ˙˙˙ ˙˙ 1. What is the root of the chord? 2. What is the quality of the chord (i.e., is the chord major, minor, diminished, or augmented)? 3. What is the bass note (i.e., is the chord inverted)? ww w & & 476 476 Lead-sheet: ? ? ww w ___ ww i Lead-sheet: ___ ___ Subphrases: ___ & ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ # 2 œJ (œ)œ(# œ)œ œ . œ œ . œ œ . œ œ œ œ j (œ) œ œ œ & 4 J J ( ) œ œ #œ. ( ) œ. ww___ ___ ___ ___ ___ Jw ___ ___ Í & & e: iv i # 2 œJ (œ)œ(# œ)œ œ . œ œ .410œ #œ . œ œ œ œ j (œ) œ œ œ & 4 J &J ( ) œ œ Jw #œ. ( ) œ. ? Í w Motives: e: ∑∑ Motives: You could also choose to write all the notes only on the spaces in a staff. 401 Subphrases: # www ww To determine the root of the chord, write all the notes only on the lines of the staff in treble clef (you may need to use ledger lines). 22 410 35 i ? iv w i ii o V i iv V www w iio V i iv ∑∑ 12 3 The bottom note is the root when the chord is stacked as a triad. In this case, the root is D. Next, determine the quality of the triad (major, minor, diminished, or augmented) by analyzing if there is a M3 or m3 from the root to the 3rd, and D F if there is a M3 or m3 from the 3rd to 5th. 12 3 D F # 1 2 34 F A Since there 411is a m3 (3 half steps) from D to F and a M3 (4 half steps) from F to A, the triad is minor. Finally, determine if the chord is inverted by checking to see if a note other than the root is the lowest note. Since the bass note (lowest note) is the root & 411 & # V D CHAPTER 6. TRIADS 36 35 D, the chord is not inverted. The chord is in root position, so the lead-sheet symbol is Dm . Now, try the process again. & 478 w bw ? w w Lead-sheet: 22 ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ On scratch paper, stack theSubphrases: notes only on lines in the treble clef to determine the root. Motives: 411 479 & ? ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ 401 ∑ ∑ ∑ # œ (œ)œ œ œ œ & 42 J (# œ) œ . J œ . J œ . œJ œ œ œ (œ) œ œ (œ) œ # œ . (œj) œ . Í & b www ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ e: ∑ i # 410 & iv iio V i The root is E. Analyze the quality of the triad by measuring from E to G and from G to 2 B. 492 & ? ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ & & 478 411 ∑ ∑ ∑ E G ∑ D F 35 1 2 34 It is an E diminished triad ( E◦ ). Finally, determine if the chord is inverted. Is the root (E) the lowest note? 499 ? 12 3 B¯≤ ∑ ∑ w bw bw ∑ ?& ∑ ww w w F A ∑ Since the lowest note is G, the chord is inverted. Our lead-sheet symbol is E◦ /G , which means we have an E◦ chord with a G in the bass. 506 479 & 6.5 Simple “Sus” Chords ? ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ Common in popular music are “sus” chords, with “sus” being a shortening of “suspended,” a term we will study in the chapter on non-chord tones. The two basic sus chords are the sus4 and sus2 chords. In the sus4 chord (also labeled simply as “sus”), a perfect 4th replaces the 3rd of the chord. In the sus2 chord (sometimes called “sus9”), a major 2nd replaces the 3rd of the chord. Both of these sus chords have a perfect 5th from the root to the fifth. ∑∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ 492 & ? ∑ ∑ i iv V CHAPTER 6. TRIADS 59 222 59 63 63 65 65 67 67 71 71 C AMajor w & cw# ww ww w ?c & w 37 Csus4 F #m (also Csus) # ww # www Fifth # w Fourth w Root # w www & Fifth Third Root Csus2 D (also Csus9) ww Fifth# w Second (or Ninth) Root w ww w & E #w w F #m w example with a sus4 chord. ww # # ww # c w ww & # www # # w E A/C B/D G #/B## w 3 # ## # w ? & c œ˙ œ œ œ œ˙w œ œ œ œ œ #œw œ œ œ œ˙ œwœ œ œ œ œ œ w˙ œ ˙w #˙w œ ˙ w # # I'm˙Sorry" ? to# #Say "Hard œ œ Peter# ˙Cetera and David Foster ˙ A/C # B/D # G #/B # 3 # # # # E# # # & # # C œ˙m œ œ œ œ˙ œ œF /Aœ œ œ œ œ Bœsus4œ œ˙ œ œ Bœ œ œ œ œ œ ˙ ˙ œ ˙ & # # œ˙ œ œ œ œ œ œ ˙ œ œ . ? #### ˙ œ œ˙ ˙˙ œ œ œ œœ # ˙ œœ ˙˙ ? # # # # œ# nœ ˙ B˙ sus4 B #F˙#/A # #### C m & œ œ œ œ œ˙ œ œ œ œ . œœ œœ Sara ˙˙ Bareilles "Love Song" ˙ œ ˙ œ œ ˙ D/F # Gm F/A B bsus2 C Dm C/E F &? b# # #œ# œœ œ n œ œ œ YT:œ PLtKoLkxDSQ œœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ˙ œœœ œœœ œœœ˙ œœ œ œ œ œ # ˙ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ Peter œ œCetera and David œ Foster, Figure 6.5.1 j I’m Sorry”# œ j “Hardœjto Say j j ?Here j œ ‰ œ ‰ example ‰ œa ‰sus2 œ chord. Ó ‰ ‰ Ó Sara ‰ Bareilles j‰ j b œis aŒ musical œ Ó with "Love Song" œ # œ œ œ# Gœm C/E F œ F/Aœ B bsus2 œ C œ D m # œ D/F œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ &b œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœœ œœ œœ œœ œœœ œ œ œ j œœ j œ œ œ # œœœ ? j ‰ j Ó ‰ œj ‰ œj Ó ‰ œ ‰ œ Ó ‰ j ‰ Œ ‰ b œ œ œ œ"second inversion" # œ œj œ œ œ "first inversion" "root position" œ œ œ #œ ww ww ww & www w w G ww w ww w C E w A Here is I'm a musical "Hard to Say Sorry" E D Peter Cetera and David Foster ? YT: qi7Yh16dA0w wE ∑ ∑ Song” ∑ w inversion" "root position" "second inversion" Figure 6.5.2 Sara Bareilles, “Love"first wG ww w w w C not invert sus chords this text. &Weroot wwwwill ww inof chord w 9Innotea later w G 7chapter,wwwthere is a ww note third ofmore chord issophisticated lowest iswlowest fifthCofsus chord is lowest note section on sus chords like C sus and (29) . C E w ? Summary 6.6 ∑ w w ∑ wE Triad construction isCsummarized in the following table. root of chord is lowest note third of chord is lowest note ∑ wG fifth of chord is lowest note 5 5 8 #w CHAPTER# 6.w w TRIADS# ww & 242 248 HW # w ˜m Ex. C ____ 1. ____ # # # www & # # www Augmented: Major: 2. ____ #w & # # ww 1. ____ 254 w Minor: b b ww # ww & ## w 8 # # www Sus2: 7. ____Diminished: 8. ____ 242 260 C ˜m Ex. 13. ____ ____ 1. ____ 14. ____ # # # www & #w & # ww 248 266 Sus4: 1. HW 242 260 278 248 2. 266 284 6 254 272 290 3. HW HW 260 278 294 86 266 284 298 4. PRAC EXER 272 290 HW 5. 92 302 284 & 320296 &? 302 326 103 & 308 2. ____ 3. ____ 14. ____ 13. ____ & & 15. ____ E 9. Gsus2 Fsus4 Write 7.the specified8. triads and sus chords. 2.DE+ 14. ¯≤+ 3.15. A¯≤Fsus2 ˜ ? 4. ____ 4. C˜ 16. ____ 10. Dº b www 5. ____ 5. Dsus4 17. ____ 11. C˜m ˜ 16.4.EC ¯≤m Analyze & the following inverted triads using ? slash notation. 1. Gm Bm 13. & & & &? & & b b www 1. Dm 1. Dm/A bw ww ? b ww # www& # w2. A w3. E¯≤sus4 2. w B¯≤º/D¯≤ w ? w # w? w & EFsus4 ¯≤/B¯≤ 1. _____ Ex.7._____ 8. E 5. C˜m/E ww w 4. G¯≤+ 3. F˜/A˜ w w 2. _____ _____ 9. Gsus2 3. _____ 10.4.Dº 6. Gº/D¯≤ 7. Dº/F b b www 6. ____ # # # www ## w‹ www w 12. ____ 5. ____ ____ 18. b b www 6. ____ 6. Fº 18. ____ 12. A+ 5. Dsus4 17. B bBwww 5. F˜º w ? 5. _____ 11. C˜m 6.Cº Fº 18. ww b ww w 6. B¯≤sus2 4. Em/B 6.12. _____ A+ 8. A/C˜ ? & && b w∑ ? ∑ ∑ ∑& ∑ ? ∑ B & ww 14. D¯≤+ 18. Cº 13. Gm 15. F˜ 16. E¯≤m 17. B ?Ex. Fm/C∑ 1. ∑G/D 4. E∑ º/B¯≤ ∑2. Bm/D ∑ 3. D¯≤/F ∑ & Correct the misspelled triads. Label your corrected spelling with lead& Write the specified inverted triads. Correct Incorrect & Incorrect∑ Correct ∑ Incorrect b w ∑ b # www∑ && # ww b ww # # ww w w ? & ∑ Ex. _____ ∑ ∑ Cm 1. ∑ ____ & 303 & 290 98 ? 5. ____ sheet notation. All of the examples are in root position (the lowest note 9 is the root). 296 278 311 308 # ww 38 ? b b www # # # www b ww ? b ww b www # ww & b b b w ◦ w and Analyze & the triad types (M, m, + , ) using lead-sheetb wsymbols.# #Sus2 sus4 chords included.9. ____ 7. ____ are also 8. ____ 10. ____ 11. ____ 12. ____ # www 2. w 3. E¯≤sus4 4. G¯≤+ # wwwb ww b b www5. F˜º #6.w‹ wwBw¯≤sus2 ? ##wwAww w #1.## #Dm b w ? b # w & b # ww ww ? b w w ww & & Ex. C____ ˜m 1. ____ 2. ____ 3. ____ 4. ____ 5. ____ 1. ____ 8 # www b b www ? b # www 2. ____ ____ Interval 4. ____ Lower Interval 3.Upper M3 M3 # ww w steps) (4 half # wwwsteps)? #(4# half b www M3 m3 3. ____ 4. ____ 5. ____ (4 half steps) (3 half steps) ? b ww M3 b ww bm3 w b wwsteps) b(4whalf steps) bw (3 bhalf 9. m3 ____ 10. ____ m311. ____ (3 half steps) b ww #b bwwwwwwhalfP4steps) ? bb(3 w bwM2 b w w ww (2 half steps) (5 half steps) 2. ____ 3. 4. ____ ____ 15. ____ 16.____ ____M217. P4 # ww steps) (5 halfwsteps)? #(2 # half w 6.7 Practice Exercises 1. Bm 2. E+ 3. A¯≤sus2 254 272 79 b www Correct 2. ____ Click here to download the homework. Click & here to download the Unit 1 Practice Test. ∑b # www ∑ Incorrect Correct ∑ ∑ 3. ____ ∑ & ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ & & Chapter 7 Roman Numerals and Cadences 7.1 Roman Numeral Chord Symbols Music is full of patterns that are similar from one piece to the next. As we saw with minor scales, we were able to use scale degree numbers to show the different patterns for harmonic, melodic, and natural minor, despite the fact that there are 15 minor key signatures. Using numbers instead of note names helps us see these patterns. Thinking of music in terms of numbers is also helpful with transposition, which means moving melodies and/or chord progressions from one key to another. Thinking of music in terms of numbers also helps us to analyze it and to spot similar patterns between many different pieces in different keys. We will use Roman numerals to represent chords within a specified key. The Roman numeral “ I ” represents a triad built on 1̂ , or the 1st note of the scale. Uppercase Roman numerals represent major triads and lowercase Roman numerals (e.g., “ i ”) represent minor triads. Uppercase Roman numerals with a “ + ” are augmented (e.g., “ III+ ”), and lowercase Roman numerals with a “ ◦ ” are diminished (e.g., “ vii◦ ”). (There is also the Nashville Number System, which uses Arabic numbers for chords instead of Roman numerals.) Key Lead-Sheet G 230 Bm f G◦ 2 c E & Root Scale Degree of Root Roman Numeral B G 2 E 3̂ 2̂ 3̂ iii ii◦ III Notes15in Chord 4 B–D–F 2 2 G–B –D 2 2 E –G–B For inversion of Roman numerals, we will use a modified “slash chord” notation until we study Figured Bass. For now, we will write “ I /3rd” if the 3rd of the I chord is the bass note, for example. G: ii/5th C: I/3rd the 3rd of the I chord (C-E-G) is in the bass the 5th of the ii chord (A-C-E) is in the bass The following table offers more examples. 31 & 39 CHAPTER 7. ROMAN NUMERALS AND CADENCES Key 14 Roman Num. g a 222 D Root Scale Deg. of Root V/3rd D iv/5th C MajorD 4 vii◦ /3rd CFifth ww & w 5̂ Csus4 4̂ Csus) (also 7̂ Fifth Fourth Root www & Third Root 40 Notes in Chord 4 D–F –A Csus2 D–F–A (also 4 Csus9) C –E–G Fifth Bass Note 4 F A E ww Second (or Ninth) w & Root 7.2 Diatonic Chords in Major slash Observe the pattern ofchord diatonic chords in major represented by Roman numerals. (Diatonic means notes within a key signature and can be contrasted with the term “chromatic.”) One C/E sees the pattern M-m-m-M-M-m- ◦ in triad bass note quality. Lead-sheet symbols 225 Dm Em F G www Am www Bº I ii iii IV V vi viiº & ww w C: ww w C ww w www www Roman numerals (require key designation) 226 & 240 & Figure 7.2.1 7.3 Diatonic Chords in Minor 248 & Because there are three versions of the minor scale, there are more than seven diatonic chords in minor. The sixth and seventh scale degrees affect all of the triads except the tonic, making 13 possible diatonic triads in minor. C: I ii iii IV V vi viiº Roman numerals (require key designation) CHAPTER 7. ROMAN NUMERALS AND CADENCES 226 227 NATURAL MINOR Am Bº & ww w a: i iiº HARMONIC MINOR Am Bº & ww w a: 228 i www iiº MELODIC MINOR Am B & w ww a: i # www ii rare www www wwwG v VI VII ww w E # www F # www www C Dm III iv www www # www C+ Dm III+ iv rare # ww w C+ Em # www V ww w VI viiº # www # www # www G˜º ˜viº V rare G˜º F˜º E IV rare F rare D III+ 41 viiº rare Most Commonly Used Chords (Roman numerals) in Minor from the natural minor scale 229 Am Bº C Dm # www ww w n www i iiº III iv V VI VII & ww w a: www www ww w E F G # www G˜º and viiº from the harmonic minor scale Figure 7.3.1 However, when one analyzes a large amount of tonal music, one finds the following Roman numerals are most commonly used in minor. & w ww Am B # ww w D # www # www F˜º # www # www # ww w C+ E G˜º CHAPTER 7. ROMAN NUMERALS AND CADENCES a: i ii III+ IV V ˜viº rare rare rare 42 viiº rare Most Commonly Used Chords (Roman numerals) in Minor from the natural minor scale 229 Bº C Dm i iiº III iv & ww w a: ww w Am www www # www ww w n www V VI VII E F # www G˜º G and viiº from the harmonic minor scale Notice that both VII (the “subtonic triad”) and vii◦ (the “leading-tone triad”) are included. The subtonic triad ( VII ), built on the lowered 7̂ that occurs in natural minor, regularly occurs in circle of fifth progressions in minor and in rock and pop music, while the leading-tone triad ( vii◦ ), built on raised 7̂ , is usually either a passing harmony or has dominant function. 7.4 Cadences We’ve been studying harmony—triads and chords. A cadence is a harmonic arrival point, a harmonic moment of stasis. A cadence can be compared to a comma or period in written language—the ear gets a moment to process a short passage of music, then the music continues. We will differentiate between four basic cadences now, adding more specificity in a later chapter. 1. Authentic Cadence (AC): a phrase ending with the chords V – I 2. Plagal Cadence (PC): a phrase ending with the chords IV – I 3. Deceptive Cadence (DC): a phrase ending with the chords V – vi 4. Half Cadence (HC): a phrase ending on the V chord ? ### j œ. œ œ œ w CHAPTER 7. ROMAN NUMERALS AND CADENCES . œ w 43 Francis Scott Key and John Stafford Smith 7.4.1 Examples of Authentic Cadences "The Star-Spangled Banner" F b 3 &b 4 œ œ 5 O'er the b & b 43 œ œ 5 B b/D œ. B b/D G m C ø7/G b B b/F œ œ (œ ) ˙ J j œœœ œœœ ( œœœ ) ˙˙˙ land of the œœ .. ? b 3 œ (œ ) œ . b 4 œ œ ( ) œ. B¯≤: V F Bb free œ œ and œ . (œ ) œ J home ˙ of the brave! œœ œœœ œœœ ... ( œœœ ) œœœ œ J œ bœ œ bœ j ˙ œ œœ ( œœ ) ˙ œ ( ) I/3rd V I the Bb F7 ˙˙ ˙ œ. j œ. œ œ œ œ I/3rd vi iiJ 7/5th I/5th ˙ ˙ V7 I authentic cadence YT: LGvW6jHUHiY Figure 7.4.1 Francis Scott Key and John Stafford Smith, “Star-Spangled Banner” In the example above, the notes surrounded by parentheses are non-chord tones, which will be studied later. Also, there are seventh chords in this example, which we will study in the next chapter. Here is another example ending with an authentic cadence. 2 "I Want to Hold Your Hand" C# F# D #m Lennon–McCartney C# F# ## # œœ œ œ . œ œ . œ œ œ œ Œ ‰ œJ œ œ œ V # # # 44 ‰ J œ œ œ ˙ B 10 # ## # 4 & # # 4 ‰ œj œ Œ œœ œœ ? # # # # # 44 j # œ. œ œ. I want to hold your 10 F˜: IV V œœ œ j œ ‰ œj œ Œ œœ œœ j œ. œ œ. B hand, I vi 14 Œ œ ‰ œj œ Œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ I want to hold your hand. ‰j œœ œœ œœ œœ œ j œ "Just Give Me a Reason" G 14 œ. IV j jœ œ œœœ œ œ œ. œ V I authentic cadence Pink, Jeff Bhasker, Nate Ruess Em # 4 œ œ œ . œ œ œ YT:‰ jenWdylTtzs j œ œ œ œ œ œ Œ ≈ V 4 œ œ œ œ Figure 7.4.2R Lennon-McCartney, “I Want to Hold Your Hand” C 4 ≈ 7.4.2 #Examples of Plagal Cadences I & 4 let you see the parts œœ .. of me that weren't all that pret - ty j œœ œœ œ œ œ ˙˙˙ œ ˙ ˙ ? # 44 ≈ œ œ G: I # œ. C V œ ˙˙ IV œ J œ ( ) œ And with œœœ œ Here are examples with plagal cadences. 17 Ó vi œ ( ) G œ Œ Score CHAPTER 7. ROMAN NUMERALS AND CADENCES Lyrics: John Newton, Harriet Beecher Stowe Tune: "New Britain" (traditional) G C G Lennon–McCartney "Amazing Grace" 2 C# F# D #m B C# F# ## 3 & # # #4# # œ44 ‰ œJ˙œ œ œœœ œœ œ˙˙. œ œ . œ œœœ œ œ Œ ˙ ‰ œJ œ œ˙˙ ..œ œ ˙ . Ó V ˙ ˙. ˙ ˙ "I Want to HoldG/B Your Hand" Em B 10 7 & # ?# 18 & # ?# 18 27 & # ?# 27 G/D Was ∑ ∑ ∑ 14 ∑ ∑ 17 ∑ # & 44 ≈ I ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ I/5th I ∑ I see. I want to hold your hand. be - lieved. me home. be - gun. A MEN. Œ ‰j Œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ j˙ ˙˙j.. j œ. œ˙ œ. œ œ. œ 7 V vi I IV ∑ ∑ ‰ œj œ Œ œ œœ œœ œœ ˙. œ ˙ œ. œ œ œ œ IV V I I plagal cadence authentic cadence ∑ ∑ ∑ Pink, Jeff Bhasker, Nate Ruess Em # j V 44 œR œ œ . œ œ œ ‰ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ Œ ≈ œ œ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ 17 ‰ œj œ œœ œœ ˙˙ j œ. œ I/5th V Figure 7.4.3 "Just Give Me a Reason" G 14 ∑ D7 blind, butyour now I want to hold hand, first lead first G: FI/3rd ˜: IVvi ∑ G/D I # # # #The4 hour ‰ grace j Œwillœ & # # And 4 œœ œœ Than when we œ œ œœ ? ? ### # #43# œœ44 ˙˙ j œœ œj # œ. œ œ. œ 10 7 44 let you see the parts ∑ ∑ ? # 4 ≈ œ 4 œ œ V ∑C # œ. # ∑ & œœ .. œ. ?# w w∑ ev - IV - ∑ - of me that weren't all that pret - ty j œœ œœ œ œ œ ∑ ∑ œ ˙ œœ .. G: I C œ J ∑ œ ( ) ∑ j ∑ œœ œœ œ œ - 'ry touch ∑ ˙˙ ˙ ∑ ˙ IV œ you œ ∑ (œ ) ∑ ∑ ∑ œ them œ ˙˙ ˙˙ ∑ œœœ œ ˙˙ vi G fixed ( ) And with I plagal cadence YT: OpQFFLBMEPI Figure 7.4.4 Pink, Bhasker, and Ruess, “Just Give Me a Reason” Œ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ CHAPTER 7. ROMAN NUMERALS AND CADENCES "Take Me to Church" 19 # j œ V 43 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ‰ œ . œ œ œ œ œ ‰Œ œ œ œ . œ œ œ ≈Œ œ b œ œ . œ œ ‰Œ C # 3 & 4 ∑ A - G 3 - œœC ˙˙G # 3 j‰œœ . œ œ œ œ œ œ œ V # 34 œ œ œ œ œ ? œ 4 ∑ ˙˙ A A # 3 G: IV & 4 ∑ I œœ ˙˙ œ 3 "Voi? che# sapete" œ 4 ∑ ˙˙ "Take Me to Church" 19 3 19 24 24 24 24 - men , C A - - G Cm - men, A - ˙˙G ˙ G - ˙˙G œC m œœC ˙ œ œ œ ‰Œ œœ œ œ . œ œ œ ≈Œb œœ b œ œ . ˙˙ œ ˙ - men , A men, œ œA - - - men. Andrew Hozier-Byrne ˙˙G œ ‰Œ ˙˙ œ - men. ˙˙ impliedœplagal cadences ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙ œœ ˙ b œœœ Wolfgang ˙˙ œAmadeus˙˙Mozart ˙ b b b B C m/E Bœ/F F 7 œG m YT: PVjiKRfKpPI œ œ b 2 G:Hozer-Byrne, Iœ Church” œ œ Me œ to œIV œ .I œ iv ŒI Figure & b 7.4.5 4 œ I œ IV“Take implied plagal cadences œ don - ne ve - de b & b 42 œBœb œœ œœ. ≈ œ œœ œœ. b 2Pœ œ. .œ œ œ. .œ b & 4 j j ? b b 42 don œ ‰- œne ‰ve - - I te IV I "Voi che sapete" b & b B¯≤:42 Iœ œ œœ œœ. ≈ œ œœ œœ. œ . œ. . P. ? b b 42 œj ‰ œj ‰ ≈C œm/Eœœ œœb ≈ œ œœ œœ œ. .œ . œ. œ. . œ œ j j œde ‰- œte ‰ œ œ œ ≈ œ œœ œ ≈ œ œœ œœ ii/3rd œ. . . œ. . . j j œ ‰ œ ‰ œ œ ii/3rd iv I ‰ œj œœ œœ ≈B b/Fœ œœ ≈F 7 œ œœ œG m œœ œ. . œœ œ. . œj. œj.. œ œœ œœ Œ œ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ s'io ‰ l'ho ‰ nel cor, œ‰ j œ œ œ œ œ œ ≈I/5thœ œœ V≈ œ œœ viœ œ œ œœ œ. . œœ œ. . . deceptive . cadence œ j j œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ ‰ œ ‰ œ œ œ œ s'io l'ho 7.4.3 Examples of Deceptive Cadences B¯≤: I 3 Andrew Hozier-Byrne G A 19 45 nel cor, Wolfgang Amadeus Mozart 7 I/5th V7 vi deceptive cadence YT: 53geSxS8-Ak Figure 7.4.6 Mozart, The Marriage of Figaro, “Voi che sapete” 3 6 ww b ww ww # www b b w b www # & w w w CHAPTER 7. ROMAN NUMERALS AND CADENCES w w ww 46 "True Colors" Kelly and Billy Steinberg w ? b F/C w A m7TomG/B w C bFww #Gwsus w C ww F/C C w w w 4 79 4 28 86 28 HW Œ j j œ œ‰ j &Ex.4 _____ E¯≤œ/B . ¯≤œ 1.œ _____ œ œ . œ2. _____ œ œ ww j b ww & 4 ww j # &4 . œœ .. œœ ˙˙ # wwœœ ... œœ ˙˙ w ? b wœ œ ˙ œ œ ˙ b w w j j True col - ? 4 œ. œ ˙ 4 1. _____ 92 & bw bC:wwIV/5th I "Thinking Out Loud" 33 ors, true col - œ. œ ˙ 2. _____ w IV/5th I j Œ œ œ . œ œ 4.œ _____ œ œ . œ5. œ_____ 3. _____ ors are w w b bb www bow. b ww ww w œ œœ œ œ œœ œœ œœœ œœœœ bw jw j beau - ti -ful like a rain œœ w ww w w w 4. _____ - j œ . 5. _____ œ œ . œ œ6.. _____ œ ˙ # www cadencevib b ww deceptive bw 3. _____ 7 Vsus ∑ 6. _____ w Bm E m7 b w # wAYT:œLPn0KFlbqX8 œ œ w œ œ œb œww V/3rd #I ww # w IV Ed Sheeran and Amy Wadge G A ? b#w œ œ œ #œwww œ 4 œœ œœ œ Œ œ œ œ œ œ ˙ w ≈œ œ œ # w andœ Steinberg, V # 7.4.7 4 Kelly Figure “True Colors” E m7 G 7.The _____ 9.from 10. _____toIAct _____ soopera me I 8. fall_____ inexample, lovewith you ev_____ - 'ry the sin-gleprelude day just11. want to Richard tell you I am12. hon-ey following I _____ of Wagner’s 33 98 Tristan is arguably one of the most famous deceptive cadences in # # und 44 ofIsolde, j the&history classical Tristan und Isolde, Preludemusic. ˙ œ œ toœ Act I. . œ œ œ ˙ . œ Richard Wagner ˙˙ œœ . œ. œœ œœ œœ ˙˙ .. F œ. j j ? # # 4# œj # œ j œ œ œ . n œ œ #œœœ 4 . 6 œ . & 8 # œ œ # œœ œ œ œ n œ # œ œ œ . œ œ E7 Sii ? 68 # œœ nœ D: œœ œœ œœ 7 più f IV ‰ œœ .. œ. V vi ii7 a: V7 ƒ œ n œœ ... œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœœœœ œ J IV V p half cadence œ œœ . œ . œ œ œ œ œ‰ œ œ œ‰ VI deceptive cadence YT: ghjz6D34HPQ Figure 7.4.8 Wagner, Tristan und Isolde, Prelude to Act I A deceptive cadence means V did not go to I . This means that “ V to not- I ” is technically a more correct description for a deceptive cadence than V - vi , which is the most common realization of “ V to not- I .” In the example below, V goes to IV/3rd . Wolfgang Amadeus Mozart CHAPTER 7. ROMAN NUMERALS AND CADENCES 47 Ave Verum Corpus, K. 618 (textural reduction) 100 100 104 104 # & # C ˙˙ .. œœ # & ## C ˙˙ .. # œœ ˙˙ .. œœ œœ œœ œœ ˙˙ .. reduction)œœ ˙ # # Corpus, Ave? Verum C w K.˙618 (textural ww & ? # # C ˙w ˙ œ ? # # œœ œœ œœ œ & ## ww .. ˙˙ D/A œ # œœ ˙. œœ œœG/Bœœ j œœ ˙ œ˙ . œ ˙˙ ˙ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ ˙˙ .. œœ œ œœ œœ D/A ˙˙ D: I/5th œ ˙. œ ? # # œœ jœœ œœ œ j ˙ j œ # œ j ˙ . YT: 1Qxrru15jfo "Eine kleine Nachtmusic," K. 525 (reduction) 108 œ # c Dœœ & œ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœœœœœœ 108 œj œ œ œ œ œ œ œj œœ œ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ Iœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ? # c œ œœœœœœœ D: I A ˙ œ ˙˙ œœ œœ ˙ Ó œœ Ó j IV/3rd ˙˙ ˙ œ . œdeceptive cadence ˙ Ó A G/B V œ Wolfgang Amadeus Mozart ˙ ˙˙ Ó deceptive cadence 7.4.4 Examples of K. Half Cadences "Eine kleine Nachtmusic," 525 (reduction) D œœ œ œ œ œ œ #Aœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ #Aœ œœœ œœœœ œœœœ œœœ# œ œœœ # œœœ œ œœœVœ œœœ œ œœœ œ IV/3rd # œœœ œ œ œ œ Œ E m7/G Figure 7.4.9 Mozart, Ave Verum Corpus, D: K.I/5th 618 ?# c # & D:c œœ œœ œœ ˙˙ .. œœ Amadeus Mozart œœ œœ œœ œœWolfgang œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œ œ œœ ˙˙ .. ˙˙ . œœ œj/Gœ œ œ œ œ œ# œj E m7 œœ œ œ œ œœ œœœ œœœœ œœœ œœœ iiœ/3rd œ #œ œœœœœœœœ #œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ #Vœœœ œ œœœ œ œœœ œ œœœ œ œœœœœ Œ #œ œ œ œ œ #Vœœœ œ œ œ œ Œ ii7/3rd V V 7 Wolfgang Amadeus Mozart A A half cadence (phrase ends on V) œ œ œ œ œ œ œ# œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ Œ œœœœ half cadence (phrase ends on V) YT: TpPuLwtDQrY Figure 7.4.10 Mozart, Eine kleine Nachtmusik, K. 525, I. 7 C: IV/5th I w IV/5th I vi7 Vsus V/3rd I œ ˙ IV deceptive cadence CHAPTER 7. ROMAN NUMERALS AND CADENCES 33 # 4 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ ˙ Œ V # 4 E m7 G A Bm E m7 me I fall in lovewith you ev - 'ry sin-gle day 33 48 Ed Sheeran and Amy Wadge "Thinking Out Loud" # & # 44 ˙ œœ ˙˙ œ ? ## 4 4 . j œ œ œ D: ii7 œœ œœ œ œ œ œ IV œ. j œœ œ j œ V vi œœ .. œ. G A I just want to tell you I am œœ œœ ˙˙ .. œ œ ˙. œœœ œ. ii7 œœ œ j œ œ œœ IV ≈œ œ œ so hon-ey œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœœœœ œœœœœ V half cadence YT: lp-EO5I60KA Figure 7.4.11 Sheeran and Wadge, “Thinking Out Loud” You may encounter chords with no thirds in rock and pop music. If you encounter a chord that has only a root and fifth, label it with a “5” after the root in lead sheet labeling (e.g., B5 , as in the next example). Additionally, you may encounter incomplete chords, which are chords containing only the root and third but no fifth. 5 CHAPTER 7. ROMAN NUMERALS AND CADENCES 49 "Love Yourself" Justin Bieber, Benny Blanco, and Ed Sheeran C #m # V # 44 œJ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ 37 # & # 44 ‰ Œ A E I've been so caught up in my job, did - n't 37 C # m7 œœ .. œœ œ ˙ œ . œ ‰ œœ ˙˙ J E: vi # V # œJ ‰ Œ 40 ## 40 & ? ## œœ .. œ. IV A œœ ‰ œ I ∑ œœ ˙˙ œ ˙ J V B5 ‰ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ know, I'm bet - ter ∑ sleep - ing on my own 'Cause ∑ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ .. œœ œ œ œ . œ ‰ œœ œœ J vi see what's go - ing on And now I ∑ ? # # 44 ‰ Œ B5 IV if you Œ V half cadence "Every Breath You Take" Sting ____ ____ ____ j j YT: j oyEuk8j8imI b b b b 44 ‰ œ œ œ œ (œ) œ ‰ œ œ œ œJ (œ) (œ) ‰ œ (œ) (œ) œ œ V J Blanco, and Sheeran, Figure 7.4.12 Bieber, J “Love J Yourself” 42 Incorrect Ev - ry smile you fake 42 8 112 ∑ 11 Correct I'll be watch-ing you. ( œ œ œ(œ) œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ) œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ ) b 3b (4œœ œ œ œœ œExercises bãPractice b4 4 . (œ) œ (œ) (œ )œ œœ ( œ)œ œ œ43 œœ . œ œ œœ œ . œ œ œ œ œ(œ ) œœ(œœ) (œ) œ œ œ œ J œœ œ œ œ œ 1. Label the following chords with lead sheet symbols (above) and Roman ?numerals 4 (œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ) b b b3b (4œ œœ (below). œ œ) œ œœœ œœ œœœœ1.œœœ_____ œ œ œœœœ œœœ2.œœ_____ œœœ 3 œ_____ œ œ œ œ œ œ5.œ_____ œ œ œ (œ ) 3. Eº Ex.œ_____ œ 1. ã 4 4 œ œ œ œ 4.œ _____ 7.5 Example V ____ # # # # # # w ____ # # w # #____ b w 2 3 b w b n w w ww b w 4 # ww & ww (œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ) (w œ œ Cadence œ œ œ type: œw œ_______________ œ œ œ œ œ) 6 6 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ . ã8 8 w J w # w # ?b w ## # w # w ## w # b # w (œw œ œ bœ bœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ) (œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ) 6 d:˙_____ œ œ 3.68b: _____ 4. c: _____ 5. A: _____ 1. E: _____ œ2. e: _____ ã Ex. 8 iiº A ¯≤: ____ 1 379 2. 381 3. 2. Given the Roman numeral and key, write the key signature, notate the triad, and label the chord with a lead-sheet symbol (above). ˜m/Ab # Ex. F_____ b 1.w____ # # # w 2. ____b b b b w # # 3. ____ &˜ ˜ ww b b www? b ww w ? ww & # ww & ˜˜ w Ex. E: ii/3rd 1. f: V 2. D: IV/5th n w º w ## w # 3. b¯≤:vii ? # ww b b w b b b # w # b 2. ____ bb 1. ____b w 3. ____ 4. ____ ? 1. G: _____ 2. E ¯≤: _____ ? & 3. B ¯≤: _____ 4. f ˜: _____ 5. f : _____ & 6. D: _____ 1. _____ 118 383 387 124 391 Ev - 'ry claim you stake ____ #### w & 5. ____ w ? 2. _____ 1. g: III 7. _____ ### ww w 8. _____ 3. _____ 4. _____ 5. _____ 3. A¯≤: ii 11. _____ 10. _____ w # # ww7. ____b b 6. b____ w ww ? w 2. A: vi 9. _____ 6. _____ # b: iiº 12. 4. _____ ww 8. ____ & # # ww b ww # w ww bb # ww w CHAPTER 7. ROMAN NUMERALS AND w w CADENCES 3. ww ww w 50 w # b w b w b w Label lead-sheet symbols above and Roman numerals below and analyze ? #### w ### w ## w 10. D: _____ 7. c ˜of : _____ A: _____ d: _____ 11. g: _____ the type cadence8.that ends9.the phrase. Thomas a’Becket, “Columbia, the Gem of the Ocean” "Columbia, the Gem of the Ocean" 130 12. e: _____ David T. Shaw Œ # œœœœœ .œ œ œ c œ . & œ œ œ œ œ ˙ ˙˙ œ ˙˙˙ œ œ ˙˙ ˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ œ œ œ˙˙ Lead-sheet symbols: _____ ?# c Œ _____ œ œ œ œ G: _____ 1 Roman numerals: _____ œ _____ 2 _____ 3 _____ œ œ œ _____ _____ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ _____ 4 _____ 5 _____ 6 Cadence type: _______________ YT: Iyn3HEVFOhM Bob Marley, “Could You Be Loved” 6 Bob Marley "Could You Be Loved" # 4 V # 4 Ó ____ 46 46 œ (œ) œ œ ˙ ____ ‰ œ ( œ) (œ) ____ Ó Ó ____ (œ ) J œ. Ó # j j j j & # 44 ‰ œœj‰ œœj‰ œœj ‰ œœj ‰ œœj‰ œœj ‰ œœj‰ œœj ‰ œœ ‰ œœ ‰ œœ ‰ œœ ‰ œœj ‰ œœj‰œœj‰ œœj œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ? # # 44 œœ‰ ‰ .œœ œ ‰ ‰ . r œœ ‰ ‰ . œr œœ ‰ Œ œœ ‰ ‰ . œœœ ‰ ‰ . œ œœ ≈ œ ≈ œ œ R œ R R ( ) œ( ) œ Could you be loved and be loved? ____ ____ ____ 1 2 3 ____ 4 Cadence type: _______________ "Blowin' in the Wind" 50 j ____ ____YT: g3t6YDnGXAc ____ ____ Click here ‰ œj œ œ œ œ (œ ) œ œ œ œ . œ œ(œ .) the V b to44 download œ homework. The 50 Bob Dylan ____ an - swer my friend, & b 44 ‰ œ œ œ ? 4‰ b 4 œ ____ is blow-in' in ____ ____ ‰œj œ . œ œ(œ ) œ œ œ œ œ œ ˙ ( )( ) ( ) the wind, the an - swer is blow-in in the wind. œ œ . œ œ œ œ œ . œ œ œ œ œ . œ œ œ œ œ . œœ œ œ œ . œ œ œ œ œ . ‰ j ‰ j ‰j œ œ œ œœ (œ ) œ œ œ œ œ 1 Œ‰ œ œ œ œ . œœ .. œ œ. ‰ j œ œ . œ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ 2 3 4 5 6 7 Cadence type: _______________ "Stand by Me" 55 55 Ben E. King, Jerry Leiber, Mike Stoller ## 4 j V # 4 œ œ œ œ œ Œ ‰(œJ) (œ) (œ) Lead-sheet symbols: ## 4 & # 4 ‰Œ Just as long ____ ww w as you stand ? ### 4 ‰ œ œ œ ‰ œ Œ œ œ 4 J j œ œ œ œ œ (œ)(œ) œ( ) Œ ‰(œJ) (œ) (œ ) œ œ . Œ ‰ J ( ) ____ ww w ____ stand by œ ‰œ Œ J ww w me. and dar - lin' dar - lin' ww w œ œ œ ‰ œJ Œ œ œ œ ‰ œJ Œ œ œ Chapter 8 15 Seventh Chords 230 & 8.1 Introduction to Seventh Chords G: ii/5th C: I/3rd A seventh chord adds to a triad another note a third higher than the fifth. Chords, being the built3rd in thirds, members that are odd fifth, of the Ihave chord the numbers—third, 5th of the ii chord seventh, and we will eventually discuss extensions of the ninth, eleventh, and (C-E-G) is in the bass (A-C-E) is in the bass thirteenth. The fifteenth would be the double octave, so chords only extend as high as the thirteenth. 15 230 root Rt 231 & fifth third 3rd & w w seventh 7th 5th 230 ninth 9th C: I/3rd& w w w w w eleventh thirteenth 11th 13th 15 (this is for later) G: ii/5th In classical and popular music, there are five types of chords comthe 3rd of the I chord theseventh 5th of the ii chord monly encountered: (C-E-G) is in the bass (A-C-E) is in the bass 232 & G: ii/5th C: I/3rd • the major seventh chord • the major-minor the seventh (also known as a dominant seventh chord) 3rd ofchord the I chord the 5th of the ii chord root third fifth seventh ninth eleventh thirteenth (C-E-G) is in the bass (A-C-E) is in the bass • the minor Rt seventh 3rd chord 5th 7th 9th 11th 13th • the&half-diminished seventh w chord w 231 w w w w 9th 11th w (this is for later) root third seventh fifth ninth eleventh thirteenth • the fully-diminished chord seventh (often called diminished seventh chord) 231 232 232 Rt 3rd 5th & w w w b www & wwww w m7seventhm Full name: M major seventh major-minor M7 M Full name: major seventh major-minor seventh Primary abbrev: maj7 7 Other labels: Maj7, Δ7, MM7 Mm7, Dom7 7th w minor seventh m7 -7, mm7 Primary abbrev: triad maj7 7 triad triad Other labels: Maj7, Δ7, MM7 Mm7, Dom7 b www bminor w seventh m7 m7 -7, mm7 Lead-sheet symbols: 237 & 242 & 242 & w 13th b b b wwww b b ∫ wwww (this is for later) half-diminishedm7 seventh fully-diminished seventh º º º7 ø7 triad triad º7 b m7( 5), -7(-5), dm7 dim7, dd7 C7 Cm7 Cø7 www b www b www b www ∫Cwwwo7 & b b b b b Another way Mw typesb w of seventh chords is w m3five m bw b www w between M m7 m7 M3M7 m3 M3 º b ww m7 º b ∫ w & the wwwto wdifferentiate wwwthe ww º7m3m3 by triad m3 m3 M3 m3 b triad triad b w triad b w learning howtriad thirds are in each one. w stacked w m3 m3 M3 m3 M3 Figure 8.1.1 Lead-sheet symbols : Cmaj7 237 w w half-diminished seventh fully-diminished seventh ø7 º7 m7( b5), -7(-5), dm7 dim7, dd7 Cmaj7 www w M3 m3 M3 C7 b www w Cm7 m3 m3 M3 b b wwww 51 Cø7 m3 M3 m3 b b b wwww Co7 M3 m3 m3 b b ∫ wwww m3 m3 m3 CHAPTER 8. SEVENTH CHORDS 52 In later chapters we will discuss other seventh chords built on augmented triads and minor triads. 8.2 The IV/5 “sus” chord An additional four-note chord that sounds like and functions similar to a V7 chord is the IV /5̂ (or F/G in C major) chord. In popular music this chord often is substituted for the V7 chord 16 F/G 244 or F w w major & w w basstriad note is G G9sus4 www w a variant: Dm7/G or www w w sus4 9th 7th Root 2 Here is a musical example with the IV /5̂ chord in A major. 248 & "O-o-h Child" A b ±7/C B b m7 D b/E b œ œ œ. œ œ. œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ Stan Vincent Db b V b b b 44 Œ 60 bb b b 4Horns & 4 Œ œœœ Bass ? b b b 44 œ œ œ . b Some - day yeah 60 62 62 Db b V b bb Œ b & b bb Œ ˙˙˙ b V b b b ∑ b & b b b ∑ 64 ? b b b ∑ b we'll put it to - geth - er and we'll get it un - done ˙˙˙ œ œ œ œ. œ œ œ ± A b 7/C œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ Some - day when your head is much œœ œ ˙˙ ˙ ? bb b œ œ œ œ œ . b œ 64 7 œ œ œ ˙˙˙ œ œ œ ≈ œ œ œ B b m7 D b/E b œœœœœ œ light - ter Œ ‰ œœ œœ ≈ œœ œœ œœ œœ ˙˙ ˙ j œ œ œ. œ œ œ ‰ œ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ YT: gIsj8VxQNkw ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ Figure 8.2.1 Stan Vincent, “O-o-h Child” Another example of this chord is found in the opening to the Beatles’ “The Long and Winding Road”. In the key E2 major, the chord is A2/B2. G9sus4 www w w 230 3rd of the I chord the (C-E-G) & is in the bass the 5th of the ii chord (A-C-E) is in the bass CHAPTER 8. SEVENTH CHORDS 231 53 root third fifth seventh ninth eleventh thirteenth YT: fR4HjTH_fTM C: I/3rd Rt 3rd 5th 7th 9th G: ii/5th 11th 13th Figure 8.2.2 Beatles, “The Long and Winding Road” & w (C-E-G) is in the bass w w w w I chordw the w 3rd of the the 5th of the ii chord (A-C-E) is in the bass (this is for later) 8.3 Roman Numerals of Diatonic Seventh Chords 232 231 237 232 242 Full name: major seventh major-minor seventh minor seventh half-diminished seventh fully-diminished seventh ø7 there are a few 7conWhen notating seventh7 chords with m7 Roman numerals, Primary abbrev: maj7 º b Other labels: Maj7, Δ7, MM7 Mm7, Dom7 -7, mm7 m7( 5), -7(-5), dm7 dim7, dd7a ventions to follow. An uppercase Roman numeral means a major triad and ww ww & & w www w & wwww &triadwwww maj7 & Lead-sheet symbols: C C: IM7 237 243 242 244 & 243 b ww ww bw b www w b b b wwww b b ∫wwwww root Roman third lowercase numeral fifth means a seventh minor triad.ninth Addingeleventh “7” after thirteenth a Roman Rt means 3rd 5th seventh 7th between9th 13th numeral there is a minor the root 11th and seventh of the 7 m M M7 chord. Therefore, V M means m7 a major triad m7 withºa minor seventh m7 º between the º7 triad triad vi7 means triad roottriad and seventh and a minor triadtriad and a minor seventh between the root and seventh. Add “M7” for a major seventh chord (e.g., IM7 ). The (this is for later) maj7 7 m7 ø7 o7 Lead-sheet symbols : C C ( ø7 ) means C C triad with a C half-diminished symbol there is a diminished minor seventh rootmajor-minor to seventh. Theminor diminished symbol ( ◦7 )seventh on a seventh chordseventh Full name: majorfrom seventh seventh seventh half-diminished fully-diminished m3 m3 M3 m3 M3 means maj7 the triad is diminished from the ø7 root Primary abbrev: m3 m3 and the M3 m3 to seventh 7 m7distance 7 is am3 º m3 m3 M3 m3 M3 Other labels: Maj7, Δ7, seventh. MM7 Mm7, Dom7 -7, mm7 m7( b5), -7(-5), dm7 dim7, dd7 diminished Below are the diatonic seventh chords used in major and minor and their Roman numerals. m M M7 M m7 m7 m7 º º º7 & & ww ww &a: wwwwi7 www w M3 m3 M3 w b www w b www w wwwtriad w C7 ii7 ww ww wwwiiø7 w b www w w ww ww w b b wwww b b b wwww b b wwww www triad w Cm7 IVM7 ww ww www M7 III w b b wwww ww ww wwwiv7 w www w www w iii7 m3 m3 M3 w m3 M3 m3 b b b wwww w triadw ww Cø7 b b b wwww # wwww V7 b b ∫ wwww www w b b ∫ wwww www triad w vi7 wwwV7 w www w www M7 VI w # wwww www w M3 m3 m3 Co7 viiø7 b b ∫ wwww w # www www o vii w7 C: IM7 ii7 iii7 IVM7 V7 vi7 viiø7 Figure 8.3.1 Roman numerals for diatonic seventh chords in major & www w a: i7 www w iiø7 IIIM7 iv7 V7 VIM7 244 & Figure 8.3.2 Roman numerals for diatonic seventh chords in minor w # www viio7 m3 m3 m3 1. g: III ? 3. A¯≤: ii 2. A: vi ? ____ 6. ____ CHAPTER 8. 5.SEVENTH CHORDS 391 135 bb w 407 2. 139 413 7. f: _____above. 8. D: _____ sheet symbol œ # & 3. 419 # J.S. Bach & œ œ œ maj7/D G_____ ### _____ 143 bb bb b b b (1999) “No Scrubs” "No Scrubs" 1. a: iv7 425 9. f˜: _____ 10. g: _____ 11. c: _____ œ œ œ œ œ œ ( œ) œ ( œ) ˙ . _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ ## œ œ2. g: iiø7 œ 3. D: viiœ ø7 œ bbb 12. G: _____ #### œ 4. c: V7 # _____ œ) œ œ (œ ) œ œ (M7 5. B: IV /3rd Analyze the harmonies in the excerpts with lead-sheet symbols and _____ _____ _____ _____ above _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ Roman numerals 8 9 10 11 7 below. 12 # &(a) b & 54 w ?# œ œ œ M7 1. A: ii7 Ex. e: III /5th ? 8. ____ b ww b www ww w ø7/C D _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ # #_____ 1. b: 2. E¯≤b: _____ 3. #e: _____ 4. E: 5.#d: _____ 6. B¯≤: _____ w # bb b_____ ˙ œ w ? # 3 w # # w # œ www œ œ b œ œwwwœ œ ww 4 b # ww œ œ wwœ œ œ œ ˙ww & w_____ w w w w_____ _____ _____ _____ w_____ w w w # w w _____ _____ _____ # _____ w ?Ex.bE¯≤b:____ # w _____ # ww ww4 4.b bG:b _____ _____ 3 w b b viinø7www/ 7th 1.1 g:#_____www 22. D:# _____ n5 ww 6 5. d: _____ ww ww 3.b bc˜: _____ Given the Roman numeral, provide the notes of the chord and the lead& below. merals 395 431 7. ____ 8.4 Practice Exercises_____ _____ _____ __________ 8. G: _____ _____ d: VII 7. C˜: IV_____ I/5th 5. e: viiº_____ /3rd_____ _____ 6._____ œ œ œ # œ œ œ w w 3 œ œ w w # # # w # œ œ ww œwith# lead-sheet bœ w œ nuœ wwand Roman 1. Analyze 4 œb chords w œ œ# #symbols # ww&the given wœ above 12 401 & Menuet, BWV Anh. 116 4. b: iiº ## 2. D¯≤: iii7 ## 3. f˜: viio7 b ? b b b& b b b b b b b44b # b b œ œ œ œ# Lead-sheet _____symbols: _____ _____ 7. f: V7 ? 4 8. A¯≤: ii7 bbbbbbb 4 œ Roman numerals: # bbb Cadence type: _______________ Kevin Briggs, Kandi Burruss, M7 5.Tameka c: iv7/3rd G: ILopes Cottle,6.Lisa 4. D: vi7 _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ #œ œ nœ œ b œ œ œ bœ œ bœ œ œ 9. b: viio7/5th 10. B¯≤: viiø7 11. e: iiø7/3rd a¯≤: _____ œ _____ 2 1 œ œ _____ 3 _____ 12. F: IVM7 _____ 4 bb & b b b b b ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ 145 YT: FrLequ6dUdM 10 ? b b b b ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ b b (b) b Mozart, Piano Sonata K. 545, I Piano Sonata K. 545, I œ œ _____ 145 & 44 ˙ Allegro Wolfgang Amadeus Mozart _____ œ. _____ œœœ Œ ( ) œ œ ˙ _____ _____ œ Ÿœ (œ)œ œ Œ _____ _____ & 44 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ C: _____ 1 _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ 2 3 4 5 6 7 Cadence type: _______________ 149 & ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ YT: 5NkzTTkqTB4 Click here to& download the homework. & ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ 153 9 Chapter 9 Harmonic Progression and Harmonic Function In this chapter we will look at common harmonic progressions and examine the principle of harmonic function that underlies progressions. 9.1 The Circle of Fifths Progression The circle of fifths progression ( I – IV – vii◦ – iii – vi – ii – V – I ) was a stalwart of the Baroque era in music. You will find many examples of this progression in the music of Bach, Handel, and Vivaldi, especially in minor ( i – iv – VII – III – VI – ii◦ – V – i ) with the subtonic VII . 55 CHAPTER 9. HARMONIC PROGRESSION AND HARMONIC FUNCTION56 11 Gm7 Dm ˙ ‰ œ œ œ &b C œ œœœ œœœ œ œ ‰ 157 ˙ ‰ œ œ œ œ œ œ ˙ œ 11 Gm7 œ œ œ œ C7 œœ œœœœœœ ? C Dm œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ #œ œ œ œ œ œ œ b ˙œ ‰ œ œ ˙ œ œ œ œ˙ œ œ œ œ VII7 & b d:C œi œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ‰ iv‰ 7 157 B¯≤maj7 ? C˙ œ œ œœœ œ œ œœ œ œœ # œœœ œœœ œ œ˙ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œœjœ b œ œ œ nœ œ œ #œ. œ œ œ J œ ˙ &b Fmaj7 159 Eø7 A7 iv7 d: i 159 Dm VII7 ? b Fmaj œ œ œ7 œ œ œ œ œ Bœ¯≤majœ 7œ œ œ œ œ Eœø7œ œ œ œ œ œ œ A7 œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œœ œ ˙œ œ˙ œ œ œ œ ˙œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ VIM7 œ # œV.7 iiø7n œ & b IIIM7œ j œ Ji Dm ∑ ∑ œ∑œ œ∑œ œ∑œ œ∑ œ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ œ ∑ œ ∑œ œ∑œ œ∑œ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ & b ∑ ∑ ∑ ? œ œ dHrvGOd6G20 œœ œ b œ œ œ œYT: j œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ 1047, Figure 9.1.1 J.S. Bach, Brandenburg Concerto No. 2 in F Major, BWV œ I. M7 M7 iiø7 V7 i ? ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ III∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ VI ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ b Gm Cm/E¯≤ F B¯≤ E¯≤ Ao/C D Gm 162 162 C7 b 4 œ. œ œ œ. œ œ. œ & b 4 œ . œ œœ .. œ œ . œ œ . œ f ˙ ˙˙ ? b b 44 ˙˙ ˙ g: i iv/3rd œœ .. œœ œœ . œœ œœ .. œœ œœ .. œœ œœ . œœ # œœ . œœ œœ .. œœ œœ . œœ # œœ . œœ œ . œœ œœ œ œ .. . . . . . nœ. ˙˙˙ VII ˙˙ ˙˙ III ˙˙ ˙ VI ˙˙ ˙ iio/3rd œ V œ ˙ i .. b ∑ f6jvsEb-Usk ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ & b ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ YT: 166 Figure 9.1.2 George Frideric Handel, Suite in G minor, Passacaglia ? b ∑ ∑ the∑ circle ∑ of∑ fifths ∑ for ∑ key ∑ signatures ∑ ∑ ∑because ∑ ∑this∑circle ∑ of∑ fifths ∑ for∑ harmonic ∑ ∑ b progression contains diatonic notes only. The circle of fifths for key signatures This circle (the circle of fifths for harmonic progression) is different than (Figure 2.3.4) contained all 12 notes of the chromatic scale. f ˙ ˙˙ ˙˙˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ ? b b 44 ˙˙ ˙ ˙ AND HARMONIC .. ˙˙ œ FUNCTION57 ˙ CHAPTER 9. HARMONIC PROGRESSION œ ˙ g: i iv/3rd VII III iio/3rd VI V i Major I V V iv minor iiº ii IV i VI VII viiº III iii vi Figure 9.1.3 Circle of Fifths for Harmonic Progression The circle of fifths (for harmonic progression) is sometimes known as the “circle of descending fifths.” 12 166 & ? œ œ begins on C descending fifths œ œ œ œ œ œ ends on C ∑ circle ∑ of∑ fifths ∑ progression ∑ ∑ ∑has been ∑ ∑used ∑regularly ∑ ∑since∑the Baroque ∑ ∑ & ∑ ∑ ∑ The 168 Figure 9.1.4 Circle of descending fifths occurring diatonically on the staff era. ? ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ œ ? œ œ œ CHAPTER 9. HARMONIC PROGRESSION AND HARMONIC FUNCTION58 œ G/B 168 & ≈ œœœ C ≈ œ œ œ œ & ≈ œ œ œ œ G: I/3rd œ Em/G 170 & & ≈ œ œœ ≈ œœœ & ∑ 8 & ∑68 ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ #œ œœ œ ≈ œ œ œ ∑ œœœ œ D/F˜ ≈ #œ V/3rd ≈ œ iii ≈ œ œœ #œ œœ œ œœ œ ≈ I ∑ œ œœ iv7 œ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑A 7 ∑ D˙∑7 Œ œJ œJ ∑ œœ. œ. œ. œ. b œœ œ œ œ ˙˙˙˙ b & f ? bb ˙ œœœœ œ. œ. œ œ ˙ . . g: œ œ ≈ œ œ G Figure 9.1.5 W.A. Mozart, Piano Sonata in C, K. 545, I (1780s) 7 F7 ∑ Cm œ∑ œ œ∑ œ ∑ ? bb J J J J ˙ ≈ œ œ œ ∑ YT: 5NkzTTkqTB4 ∑ ∑ ∑ Hal - la - hal - lo - he! 68 Bm Am ii ∑ ≈ œœ ≈ # œ œ viio/3rd ≈ œ œ IV œ vi/3rd 172 œ ≈ œ œ œ F˜o/A ends on C VII7 ∑ œ ∑ E¯≤maj∑7 Œ ˙ B¯≤maj7 œœ. œ. œ. œ. ˙ œœ œ œ œ ˙˙˙ O - ho! ø œœ. œ. œ. œ. # ˙ œœ œ œ ˙˙ œ #˙ Tra - la - lei! œœœœ ˙ œ. œ. œ œ ˙ . . ˙ ˙ IIIMA7 VIMA7 iiø7 œœœœ œ. œ. œ œ . . 7 V ? bb ∑ &b b ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ? bb ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ 71 ∑ ∑ YT: PiIblkOtm3g ∑ ∑ Figure 9.1.6 Richard Wagner, Die Meistersinger, Act II, Scene 6 (1860s) 71 F & www major w basstriad note is G 16 www w www ww sus4 9th 7th Root www ww CHAPTER 9. HARMONIC PROGRESSION AND HARMONIC FUNCTION59 G9sus4 or 7 Dm G7 F/G AmF7 244 & ? 44www major w triad w w bass note is G 248 a: i7 16 Am7 16 Dm7 i7 a: F/G Am7 ?256 244 7 wG7 iv7 VII7 iv7 VII7 77 Fmaj Fmaj 7 w V7 i7 B Bøø77 E E77sus4 7 7 E Am Bø7 E7sus4 E7 w 7 Bwø7 Fmaj w w w MA7 iiwø7 IIIMA7 VI G7 wDm7 w Cmaj7 Fmaj7 Cmaj7 w IIIMA7 iiø7 VIMA7 a variant:Dm7/G Cmaj7 Fmaj7 www w w w C˜m c˜: i Am7 A or wwww w w wE7 w w7 V Am7 w V7sus4 V7 i7 G9sus4 E7sus4 w F˜m w www w w w 7 7 B7 iv G7 Cmaj7 ø7 D˜ VII Fmaj7 G ˜7 7 ø7 7E III E7sus4 C˜m 7 w ?4 w w w w ? #4# # #w ‰ j‰ j‰ j‰ j ‰ j‰ jw‰ j‰ j ‰ j‰ jw‰ j‰ j ‰ j‰ j‰ j‰ j ø7 MA7 MA7 7 7 7 7 a: i7 œ œiv œ œVII œ œIII œ œ VI œ œ ii œ œ V œsus4œ Vœ œ C˜m F˜m B E ? # # # # 44VI ‰ j‰ j‰ j‰ iijø7‰ j‰ j‰ j‰ jV7‰ j‰ j‰ j‰ ji ‰ j‰ j‰ j‰ j œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ 268 ? 264 286 294 ? #### 272 294 Dm7 c˜: i ? #### Bø7 ivYT: EgT_us6AsDg VII E7 III Figure 9.1.9 Antonina Armato, Tim James, 7Adam Schmalholz, “Love You A D˜ø7 G˜ C˜m Like A Love Song” (2010s) (bass and chords only) 268 ? #### 292 272 276 ?The # # # #circle ‰ jof‰ fifths ‰ j ‰ j‰ jhas ‰ ja‰feeling ‰j j‰ jprogression j ‰ jof‰ inevitability j‰ j‰ j ‰ about j‰ j‰it jbecause it consists of harmonic sequences. To understand harmonic œ œsequence œ œ we œ œ œ œ œ œ œsince œ œ œ œ will first look at melodic sequences, the bass line is the “melody” in a œ harmonic sequence. Ask yourself idea: VI iiø7 what happens V7 after this melodic i U b 2 ‰ b b & 4 œ œ œ ˙ ƒ ? œ œœ œ œ ? œ œ œ œ œ isœœa musical œ œ œ idea œ œ pitch b b C Ó a Œsequence Œ repeated œat aœ œdifferent Œ level. ? &Therefore, Figure 9.1.10 Beethoven, Symphony No. 5, Op. 67, I. p b iiø7 VIMA7 Am7 Am Dm G Cmaj Fmaj B E Am ? ? #44# # # 44 ‰ jw‰ j‰ j‰ j ‰ j‰w j‰ j‰ j ‰ j‰ wj‰ j‰ j ‰ j‰ j‰ j‰ j w œ œ œ wœ w w œ œ œ œw a: i7 iv7 VII7 œ IIIœMA7œ œVIMA7 iiø7 V7 œ œ i7 œ œ 278 286 &b Cmaj Cmaj77 G9sus4 or Dm7 G7 ? & 44www ww ?264 248 281 IIIMA7 w www ww Bø7 E7 F sus4 YT: FHhZPp08s74 major 9th 7th triad Freddie Perren Figure 9.1.8 and Dino Fekaris, “I Will Survive” (chords only) Root note is G (1970s) bass a: i7 iv7 VII7 IIIMA7 VIMA7 iiø7 V7sus4 V7 270 278 284 VII7 Dm77 G G77 orDm G9sus4 ? 44 Am7 ? 44 w a: iw7 ?248 ? w www ww w G9sus4 E7 Dm /G or G9sus4 w a variant: ? 444 F ww ? w ww w www wsus4 wwww wwww w YT: K8wE58PTIkw & 4www wwmajor 9th ww Moon” ww 7 (1950s) 7th triad Figure Me to the (chords only) MA7 MA7 ø7 MA7 MA7 77 Howard, 77“Fly III w bass w a: i77 noteBart iv i77 a: i9.1.7 iv VII VI ii V sus4 V Root is G 264 256 ?256 www sus4 9th 7th w wRoot iv7 Am77 F/GAm 248 256 244 264 270 a variant:Dm7/G or Cmaj7 Fmaj7 Bø7 268 272 272 276 &b 281 b œ œ œ œ G ˜7 C˜m ? # # # # ‰ j‰ j‰ j‰ j ‰ j‰ j‰ j‰ j ‰Vj7‰ j‰ j‰ j ‰ i j‰ j‰ j‰ j CHAPTER PROGRESSION AND HARMONIC FUNCTION60 U b 2 9.‰œ HARMONIC b œ œ œ & b 4 œ œ œ œ˙ œ œ œ œ œ? œ œ œ œ ?œ œ Sequences can be short orø7long. For example, look at this familiar idea and VI ƒ ii V7 i notice how all four bars are sequenced down a step in the following four bars. U b & bbb bC 42Ó ‰ Œœ œ œœ œ œœ œœ ˙ œ œ œ œ Œ œ œ œ ? œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ?Œ ? & ƒp D˜ø7 iiø7 A VI Figure 9.1.11 Mozart, Symphony No. 40, œ I. œ œœœ œœ œ Œ œ œ œœœ œœ œ œ Œ œ bass b b Clook Ó again Œ œatœ the ? line in “Love You Like A Love Song” and notice &Now how it can be thought of a two-note idea treated as a descending sequence. p 276 281 ? #### ˙ ↓2nd ↓2nd ˙ œ ↓5th œ ↓2nd ˙ ↓5th ↓5th œ ˙ ↓5th œ Figure 9.1.12 “Love You Like A Love Song” bass line sequence in groups of two notes Sometimes we will hear a circle of fifths sequence where some of the chords are not in root position, as in the Handel and Mozart examples. In these two examples, we are hearing the sequence of the roots, even though they are not clearly presented in the bass. 17 282 œ ? b b œ̇ Gm g: i ? bb Cm/E¯≤ F œœ̇ B¯≤ E¯≤ œœ̇ Ao/C iv/3rd VII III VI iio/3rd œ̇œ œœ̇ œ̇œ D Gm V i # œœ̇ œœ̇ 283 YT: f6jvsEb-Usk Figure 9.1.13 Handel Passacaglia with roots as open note heads We will return to the idea of harmonic sequence later in this chapter. 9.2 Harmonic Rhythm You will find that all of the progressions we discuss can have different harmonic rhythm. Harmonic rhythm is a term for how long each chord lasts. For example, in “Fly Me To The Moon” (Figure 9.1.7), “I Will Survive” (Figure 9.1.8), and “Love You Like A Love Song” (Figure 9.1.9), each chord lasts for four beats and has whole-note harmonic rhythm. In the Mozart (Figure 9.1.5) and Wagner examples (Figure 9.1.6), on the other hand, each chord lasted for two beats, and so had a faster harmonic rhythm. Listen to the following example to hear four-beat harmonic rhythm change to two-beat harmonic rhythm. ? bb ˙ œ̇ œœ œ̇ œœ̇ # œœ̇ œ̇œ o œœ̇ g: i iv/3rd VII III VI /3rd V i CHAPTER 9. HARMONIC PROGRESSION ANDiiHARMONIC FUNCTION61 ? ### 4 w 4 283 A: IV w I w w vi V ˙ ˙ IV I w ˙ ˙ V IV I w V half-note harmonic rhythm whole-note harmonic rhythm ? ### 291 YT: F90Cw4l-8NY Figure 9.2.1 Dan Smith, “Pompeii” In some music, harmonic rhythm will remain consistent, while in other pieces there will be an infinite variety to the length of harmonies. Throughout this text, we will be examining harmonic rhythm and the placement of harmonies within the phrase. 9.3 Shorter Progressions from the Circle of Fifths 9.3.1 II-V-I The “ ii – V – I ” progression can be found in many pieces of music in all styles—classical, popular, but especially jazz, since the Great American Songbook (popular songs from the 1930s, 40’s, and 50’s) on which jazz repertoire is built contains 13 many examples of this progression. 175 Dm7 & 44 w G9 C: ii7 V9 œ #œ œ œ œ bœ œ œ w ? 44 www & ∑ ? ∑ 178 ∑ www w ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ œ www w œ ˙. I ∑ YT: MENQyu4D7Ig ∑ Figure 9.3.1 Duke Ellington, “Take the ‘A’ Train” ∑ C6 ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ w ? 44 www www w www w CHAPTER 9. HARMONIC PROGRESSION AND HARMONIC FUNCTION62 C: ii7 7 V9 I Cm F7 B¯≤maj7 E¯≤maj7 Aø7 D7 Em7 A7 Dmaj7 8 œ œ œ œ ˙ ? b#b# 4J J J J & 4 ˙. œ Hal - la - hal - lo - he! . w ? # # 44œœœ œ.www œ. œ. ˙ b œ œ œ œ ˙˙˙ &b 68 178 68 f ? b ∑ b ˙ ˙ œ Œ ˙ b˙ n˙ O - ho! œœ. wwœ. œ. œ. ˙ œœ wœ œ œ ˙˙˙ D: ii7 181 & ## ? ## ∑ œœ œœœœ ˙ ∑ œ œ œœ œ ˙∑ œ. œ. œ ∑œ ˙ . . . œ. YT:˙ sUg1Dpsd6fw . . ∑E bm w œ. wwœ. œœ Tra - la - lei! IMA7 iiø7 VIMA7 bb 4 &bbb 4 ‰ œ. ? bb 4 ‰ œ bbb 4 œ ? bb b bb œœ j nœ ˙ œ œ D¯≤: ii ∑ ∑ ? bb b ∑ b –V–I • vib– ii b & b bbb A b 13 œœ J œ œœ œ. # ˙ œ # ˙˙˙ œœœ œ œ œœ ii7 b b # V ∑D b6 ˙ V13 I V+9 Ó Ó I ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ YT: d22CiKMPpaY Ó sigh is just a sigh 76 Figure 9.3.3 Herman Hupfeld, “As Time Goes By” (1931) 9.3.2 VI-II-V-I œ ∑œ œ œ œ. œ. œ œ . . 7 œœ œœ n œœœœœœ ˙˙˙˙ n œœœ œ œ œ œœ œ œœ œ œ œœ œœ ˙ œ œ œ ˙ œ œ kiss is just a kiss, a œœ .. V7 ∑ 76 ∑ E bm7 ˙ œ œJ a wJ œD∑ 6œ œ œ ˙A 9( 5) œ œ œ œ œ œ . ? bb 4 œ œ œ œ œ. J œœ J bbb 4 J A b7 You must re - mem - ber this a 71 œœ. œœ V7 Figure g: 9.3.2 iv7 Miles Davis, VII7 “Tune-Up” IIIMA7 71 Œ This progression can occur in one of the following three ways (or orderings): • I – vi – ii – V • ii – V – I – vi One can think of these reorderings as rotations, as shown in the example below. ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ # 4f w w ? b b A:˙ IV Iœ œ œ viœ ˙ V IV œ œ Iœ œ V ˙ IV Iœ œ Vœ œ œ half-note rhythm œ. AND harmonic œ. œharmonic œ. œ. œ œ CHAPTER 9. HARMONIC FUNCTION63 . œ. œrhythm ˙ whole-note œ. ˙ . PROGRESSION ˙ . œHARMONIC . . . ø7 7 7 MA7 MA7 7 g: 71 iv start ? ### 291 ? ### III E bm A b7 b start VI ii b V b b # start E m7ii A 13 D 6 œ œ œ œ ˙A 9( 5)I œ œ œ ? b b 4 œ œ œ œ œ œ. J œ œ œ œ. J bbb 4 J vi I 71 VII ii œœ œœ bb b 4 ‰ J œ œœ b & b 4V j œ œ . œ œ. nœ ˙ œ. I œ œœ œœœœ œ œœ of the œviœœ – iiœ – V –œœ I progression ? b b9.3.4 4 ‰Rotations Figure œ œ bbb 4 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ 9.3.2.1 vi You must re - mem - ber this a D¯≤: ii vi-ii-V-I V kiss is just a kiss, a V7 ii7 V13 V D b6 ˙ vi sigh is just a sigh I n œœ œœœ ˙˙˙ n œœœ œœ ii ˙ œ œœœ ˙ œ ˙ œ V+9 Ó Ó Ó I The vi – ii – V – I progression contains the last four chords of the circle of fifths progression. 295 76 175 76 178 bb 4 & b b 47 B b m7 F m7 ˙. œ œ œ œ Cœ6 œ the prom - isedœ kiss œof You œ # œare œ & 44b b w4 œ bœ œ ∑ & b b 4 Œ ‰ œj Ó Œ ‰ œj Ó œœ œœ w wwww ? 44 www www w ? bb 4 ˙ bC:b ii74 ˙ ˙ ˙ V9 ˙ ˙ I Dm w E b7 G9 # j & # 44 ˙ . œ b˙ nœ. aœ www YT:wOPapxr8GvGA w ? # 4 w Figure #9.3.5 4 Jerome Kern, “All the w Things You Are” A¯≤: Em vi77 ii7 A7 V7 ± Ab 7 13 œ ˙. spring - time, œ Œ ˙. ‰ Ó j œœ œ ˙ ˙ DmajI7MA7 w ww w Here isD:another example from more ii7 V7 recent popular music. IMA7 C˜m # & # 44 ˙˙˙ 181 ? ## 4 ˙ 4 E: vi # & # 185 ? ## F ˜m ˙˙ ˙ ˙ ii B E C˜ m ˙ ˙ ˙˙ ˙ ˙˙ ˙ ˙ V I ∑ F ˜m ˙˙˙ ˙˙ ˙ vi ii ˙ Bsus4 ˙˙˙ ˙ B ˙˙ ˙ ˙ Vsus4 V YT: ZyhrYis509A Figure 9.3.6 Søren Rasted, Claus Norreen, René Diff, and Lene Nystrøm, “Barbie Girl” (chords only) ∑ CHAPTER 9. HARMONIC PROGRESSION AND HARMONIC FUNCTION64 9.3.2.2 I-vi-ii-V Here are examples of the I – vi – ii – V progression, sometimes called the 1950s progression because of its prevalence during that decade, although this progression was also widely used in the 1930s and ’40s. bb &bb 80 80 A b66 A 4 4 œ w Blue Blue moon moon b & b b b 44 Œ Œ œœœ Œ œ ? b b b 44 Œ b ˙ ˙ 80 80 A¯≤¯≤:: A II B bm9 m9 B F m7 m7 F E b 99 E A A b 66 œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ w you saw saw me me stand stand--ing you ing aa-- lone, lone, œœœœ Œ œœœ œ ˙ vi77 vi ii99 ii Œ ˙ F F m7 m7 œœœ œ V99 V II ‰ E E b 99 œ œœ œ œœ œ with with--out out aa dream dream in in my my heart heart œœœ Œ œœœ Œ œ œ Œ œœ Œ œœ ˙ B B b m9 m9 ˙ 7 vi vi7 ˙ ˙ 9 ii ii9 œœœ œ 9 V V9 b bb b bb & ? & bb b b b ∑∑w b 85 85 85 85 YT: WTj7DvlptAc Figure 9.3.7 Richard Rodgers, “Blue Moon” (1934) 86 86 86 86 Vb F 66 F 44 œ w D m7 m7 D Some--where where Some G m7 m7 C C 77 G Œ ‰ œj œ œ ˙ œ be -- yond yond the the sea be sea j 4 & b 4 Œ Œ ‰ œjœ œœœ œœ œœœ ... œœœ Ó œœ œ œœ œ . œ ? 4 Œ b 4 œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ F: F: II vi77 vi F F 66 ii77 ii V77 V D D m7 m7 G G m7 m7 C C 77 Œ œ œ . œjj œ œ œ œœ some wait -- ing some -- where wherewait ing for for me me Œ ‰ jœ jj Ó œ . œ œ œ œ œ . œ œœ œœ œœ œœ .. œœœœœ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ II vi vi77 ii ii77 V V77 ∑ ∑ C ∑13 C ∑7(13b9)∑F ±9∑ ∑ A m7 ∑ /E∑D m9∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ V b ∑ G∑m7 ∑ ∑ ∑ C 13sus 44 œ œ ˙ œ œ YT: œ œ_R8HhlaMvko œ œ œ ˙. b Œ Sea” œ œLasry, œ œ“Beyond V œ Figure 9.3.8 Charles Trenet and Albert The (1945) 91 Take my∑ bass hand a∑stran next b ∑ for ∑this ∑ line ∑ inI'm ∑ the ∑- gerrecording. ∑in ∑par - a∑- dise∑ ∑ ∑ All ∑ lost∑ in∑ a ∑ &Listen ˙˙˙ œœœ b œœœ ˙˙ .. & b 44 w œœœ ww www ˙ œ œ ˙˙ .. œ w ? b ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑w ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ˙ ˙ ? b 44 ˙ œ œ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ 91 91 91 F: ii7 V7 IMA7 authentic cadence vi7 connects to next phrase 99 ? bb 4 Œ bb 4 ˙ ˙ V ˙ ˙ I ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ii CHAPTER A 9.¯≤: HARMONIC PROGRESSION AND HARMONIC FUNCTION65 I vi7 ii9 V9 I vi7 ii9 V9 291 F# ? # # # # # 44 # ˙ ? # # # #86# # 86 G #m C# F# D #m vi ii V I vi F6 D m7 ˙ F˜: I 295 D #m F6 ˙ ˙ D m7 G m7 C 7 ˙ b bb b bb & ? ˙b b b b ∑∑w ˙ & bb G # m 85 C # 85 ˙ ii G m7 Some-where be - yond the sea some - where wait - ing for me 4 jÓ Œ ‰ jœ & b 4 Œ Œ ‰ œjœ œœœ œœ œœ .. œjœ Ó œ . œ œ œ œ œ . œ œ œ 9.3.2.3 ii-V-I-vi œ œ œ œ œœ œ œœ œœ .. œœœ œ œ œ .. œœ Below is an example of the ii – V – I – vi progression. In this example, the vi ? acts 4 asŒ a link between the Vœ– I cadence in the middle of the chord phrase b 4 œ of the next œphrase. œ œ activity œ œ œ and the ii chordœ at This harmonic œ theœ beginning œ œ œ œ œ after the arrival on the I chord is like a “turnaround” in jazz. We discuss Fools Fall in Love” (1955) G m7 V b 44 œ œ ˙ 91 C7 4 Œ YT: ‰ j mEHcTciiXQY Œ œ œ. j Vb 4 œ w œ œ œœ ˙ œ œœ œœ Figure 9.3.9 Frankie Lymon, Herman Santiago, Jimmy Merchant, “Why Do F: I vi7 ii7 V7 I vi7 turnarounds more in a later chapter on jazz harmony. 91 V Take my hand 4 &b 4 w www ? b 44 ˙ ˙ F: ii7 C 13sus ± C 13 C 7(13 b9) F 9 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ˙. ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙ I'm a stran - ger in œœ œœ œœ b œœ ˙ V7 ii7 A m7/E D m9 Œ œ œ œœ par - a - dise ˙˙˙ ... ˙. ˙ IMA7 authentic cadence V7 All lost in a œœœ œ œ œ www w ˙ ˙ vi7 connects to next phrase YT: WFrUsa5SUv0 Figure 9.3.10 Robert Wright, George Forrest, Alexander Borodin, “Stranger in Paradise” (1953) If you view this video on YouTube, you will briefly see the double bass part, which has lead-sheet symbols on it. 9.3.3 III-VI-II-V The iii – vi – ii – V circle of fifths segment is sometimes repeated (or looped) within a song. CHAPTER 9. HARMONIC PROGRESSION AND HARMONIC FUNCTION66 10 95 10 95 95 95 97 97 97 97 ## & # ∑ 99 C # m7 ## & # ## & # ? ### ### & ### &# # & # ? ### ## & # ? # # # ∑ 99 99 œ ˙ 44 Cœœœ #m7œœœ ... œ Fœ #.m7œ œœ .. œ 44 œ œ œœ ˙ 44 great ˙ - test ˙ 44 œœœ 7 œœœ ... œ œ 7. œ A: iii vi œœ .. œ great - test C # m7 # ### ? # & # 44w ˙ œœ œ w ˙ œœ œiii7 A: iii7 C # m7 ∑? # #∑# ˙∑ ### œ & J ‰ŒÓ ∑ 99 F # m7 ### 4 & 4 œ œœ F # m7 Bm E œ œ œ œ. Bm ˙ Œ ii ˙ œœ .. œ œ˙ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ . viœœ ...7 œ œ œ œ iiœ œ ˙ ∑ ∑ ∑ is hap - pen - ing to me ‰ œj œœ E œœ .. œ Fœ #m7 œ œ œ œ Bœ m œ œ. œœ ... œ œ œ œ œ œ Œ vi7 ∑ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ . œœE œœ œœE/Dœ œœœ œ œœ œœ Bœœ m œ. œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ. œ - pen - ingœ to me love of all is hap ˙ œ œ . œœ œœ œœ 7 œ œœœ œ œ œœ iiœœ V /7th œ. V œœ love of all ˙ ∑ E/D ∑ ∑ ˙ E/D œœ œ œ œ œ Vœ/7thœ œœ œE œ œE/Dœ œœ j ‰ œ œ œ œ œ I've found the œ œ œ œœ œ œœ œ œ Vœ 7/7thœ V œœ YT: IYzlVDlE72w I've V found ∑ 7 the ∑ œ ∑ ∑œ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ Figure 9.3.11 Michael Masser and Linda Creed, “Greatest Love of All” (1977) iii7 vi7 ii V V7/7th Sometimes, this progression is rotated to ii – V – iii – vi , as in “September,” the well known song by Earth, Wind, and Fire. ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ## ∑& #∑ 44 ∑œ œ ∑œ Ó∑ B m7 ## j & # 44 œœ .. œœ œ. œ ? # # # 44 œ œ œ E Ba - de - ya A: ii7 ∑ ∑ C # m7 ∑ F # m7 ∑ ∑ B m7 ∑ E ∑ C # m7 F # m7 ∑œ œ ∑œ œ ∑œ œ ∑ œ ∑œ œ ∑Ó ∑ œ ∑œ œ ∑œ œ ∑œ say do you re-mem-ber ˙˙ ˙ œœ œ œœ œ V iii7 Œœ #œ œ œ œ Ba - de - ya j œœ .. œœœ ˙˙˙ œ. œ œ Œœ #œ œ œ œ œ ˙˙ ˙ vi7 ii7 V danc-ing in Sep-tem-ber œœ œ œœ œ œ œ œ iii7 ˙˙ ˙ œ œ vi7 YT: Gs069dndIYk Figure 9.3.12 Maurice White, Al McKay, Allee Willis, “September” (1978) This ii – V – iii – vi progression is also seen in the following song. CHAPTER 9. HARMONIC PROGRESSION AND HARMONIC FUNCTION67 b & b bbb c œ . œœ .. ? bb c b b b œ. 214 j œœœ ... œœœ ˙˙˙ j œ ˙ œ. j œœœ ˙˙˙ j œ ˙ D¯: ii7 V iii7 vi b & b bbb j œœœ ... œœœ ˙˙˙ j œ ˙ œ. j œœœ .. œœœ ˙˙˙ . j œ ˙ œ. ii7 V iii7 vi 205 YT: dQw4w9WgXcQ Figure 9.3.13 Mike Stock, Matt Aitken, and Pete Waterman, “Never Gonna Give You Up” (1987) ? bb bbb 9.4 Harmonic Function Now we will address non-circle-of-fifths progressions. Notice that we have not included the vii◦ or IV chord in any of the shorter circle of fifths progressions above. However, it is a common axiom that Rock ‘n’ Roll is made up of three chords: I , IV , and V . This is because each of those chords represents ¯/F Gø7 a harmonic function. Harmonic function refers to the tendency of certain chords to progress to other chords, or to remain at rest. Many texts on music theory enumerate three harmonic functions. In this text, we will discuss four. 1. Tonic function (abbreviated “ton.”): The I chord has tonic function, which is a state of stability and rest. Tonic chords do not demand progression to other chords. 2. Dominant function (abbreviated “dom.”): The V and vii◦ (chords containing the leading tone 7̂ and supertonic 2̂ ) tend to progress to tonic ( I ). Special note: The I/5th chord has dominant function when it resolves to the V chord, as in the third chord from the end of the “Star-Spangled 17 Banner.” F 152 152 b & b 43 œ œ b & b 43 œ œ O'er the B b/D F B b œ. land œœ .. ? b b 43 œ ( œ ) œ . œ ( œ) œ . B b/D G m C ø7/G b B b/F œ œ (œ ) ˙ J j œœœ œœœ ( œœœ ) ˙˙˙ of the free j ˙ œ œœ ( œœ ) ˙ œ ( ) F7 œ œ œ . ( œJ ) œ œœ œœœ œœœ ... ( œœœ ) œœœ œ J and the home of the œ bœ œ. j œ bœ œ. œ œ œ œ B¯≤: I/5th V7 dom. Figure 9.4.1 Key and Smith, “The Star-Spangled Banner” Bb ˙ brave! ˙˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ I ton. ? bb œ A: IV ˙ I œœ̇ V vi whole-note harmonic rhythm g: i iv/3rd VII ˙IV œœ V I # œ̇IV I half-note harmonic rhythm III iio/3rd VI V œœ̇ V i CHAPTER 9. HARMONIC PROGRESSION AND HARMONIC FUNCTION68 start I # vi ?3. #Pre-dominant w(abbreviated w ii “pre-dom.”): w ii (chords ˙ ˙ w The IV˙ and # 44 w function w containing the subdominant 4̂ and submediant 6̂ ) tend to˙ progress to 283 start chords A: of IVdominant Iii function. vi vi V I start IV VI VV IV I half-note harmonic rhythm whole-note harmonic rhythm Vvi 4. Tonic prolongation function (abbreviated “ton. prol.”): The vi and iii (chords that share two common tones with 1̂ –3̂ –5̂ from the tonic triad) V Iand progress to chords ofstart iipre-dominant tend tostart occur after the tonic chordstart function. vi ii I 291 # Harmonic function next section. F # is represented D #m G # mon aCflowchart F # in the D #m G #m C# ? #I# # # # 44 ii ˙ vi ˙ # ˙ ˙ 9.4.1 The Harmonic Flowchart F˜: I vi V FUNCTION: 291 Tonic F# ? # # # # # 44 I # ˙ ROMAN NUMERALS: F˜: I ii V D #m ˙ vi # iiiG m vi ˙ ii I I Tonic Prolongation C# ˙V ˙ V vi Pre-Dominant ˙ V F # IV ˙ I ii D #m ˙ vi ˙ vi ˙ ii ii V Dominant C# G #viiº m ˙ V ii ˙ Tonic I V (dashed lines represent possible movement within a functional area) Tonic Prolongation FUNCTION: Pre-Dominant Dominant Tonic Figure 9.4.2Tonic Harmonic Flowchart in Major iii I in the plagal cadence IV ROMAN Remember that IV goes to and Vviiº goes to viI in I NUMERALS: the deceptive cadence. When IV goes to I , label IV as having tonic prolongavi ii V tion function. The plagal cadence and deceptive cadence are exceptions to the harmonic flowchart. (dashed lines representin possible movement withinaddition a functional Here is the Harmonic Flowchart minor. Note the ofarea) the subtonic VII chord, which has one function—to progress to III . FUNCTION: Ton. ROMAN NUMERALS: i VII Ton. Prol. Pre-Dom. Dom. III iv viiº VI iiº V Ton. i Figure 9.4.3 Harmonic Flowchart in Minor The tonic chord I can progress directly to a chord of any other function and, in fact, many pieces begin with a I – V – I progression, representing harmonic function of Tonic-Dominant-Tonic. 9.4.2 Tonic-Dominant-Tonic Progression This is the most elemental progression in music, often realized with I – V – I . 181 185 185 190 190 V7 ? # # cD: ˙ii7 ˙ ˙ IMA7 ˙ ˙ ˙B ˙ ˙B C˜m F˜m E C˜ m F ˜m Bsus4 # 9. HARMONIC PROGRESSION CHAPTER AND HARMONIC V I vi ii Vsus4 V ˙˙˙ FUNCTION69 ˙˙ ˙˙ & # E:c vi˙˙˙ ii˙˙˙ ˙˙ ˙˙˙ ˙˙˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ G D 7/A D 7/F # G œ . œ œ˙ ? ### 3c œ˙. œ œ ˙ Œ ˙ ˙ Œ œ˙ œ ˙ Œ & 4 œ œ Œ ˙ E:p vi ii V I vi ii Vsus4 V œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ? # 3 Œ œG œ œ œ Dœ7/Aœ œ œ Dœ7/Fœ# œ œ Gœ œ œ œ. œ œ # 43 œ . œ œ Œ Œ œ œI Œ & G:4 œ Vœ7/5th Œ I V7/3rd tonic dominant tonic C p G G7 C œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œÓ œ œ &?c# 4˙3 Œ œ œ œœ œ œœ œ œ œœ Ó ˙˙ # œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ. œœ n œœ œ. ˙ œ œ œ œ . œ. œ.YT:œ. OmQQoohTW80 . . 7/5th 7/3rd p G: I V V I Figure 9.4.4 W.A. Mozart, Piano Sonata, K. 283, I. . w tonic dominant œ œ Ó œœ œœ. tonic ? c wwC Ó G G7 C œ. œ. w &C:c I˙ œ œ œ œ œœ œ Vœ œ Ó V˙˙ 7 œ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œI œœ Ó ˙ œ œ œ œ . œ. œ. œ. # œ œ . . n œ. . p w œ œ Ó œœ. œœ. Ó ? c ww œ. œ. w C: I V7 V tonic I dominant tonic YT: o1iUR3GG4DQ Figure 9.4.5 Ludwig van Beethoven, Piano Sonata in C major, Op. 2, No. 3, 11 I. 103 #### 3 œ œ œ & # 8 J J J B con brio ## & # # # 38 ‰ œœ œœ œ œ La 103 don na è ? # # # # 38 œj ‰ ‰ # B: I F# œ. œ œ R RÔ ‰ qual œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œ V ‰ œ œ J œ. œ œ œ J più ma al œœ œ œœ œ œ B/F # ven to, ‰ œ œœœ œœœ j ‰ ‰ œ V I/5th dominant tonic œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ ˙ œ˙ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ? 4 ‰J Œ YT: Œ4iUwkJuRdiY b 4 F 107 œ J mo - bi - le tonic 107 F# C C 7sus F Figure 9.4.6 Giuseppe Verdi, Rigoletto, “La donna è mobile” Hey Jude, don't make it bad take a sad song and make it 4 &b 4 Œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ ? 4 Œ j j b 4 œ œœ œ œ œj œ œj œ œœ œ œ œ œœ F: I V œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœœ j œ œ. œ œ. j œ œœ œ œ œœ œ V7sus4 œ œ bet - ter œœ œœ œœ j œj œ œ œj œ œ œ œ œœ I ? # # # # 38 œj ‰ ‰ # œ œ œ œ œ œ j ‰ ‰ œ I V V HARMONICIFUNCTION70 /5th CHAPTER 9.B:HARMONIC PROGRESSION AND tonic 107 107 ? 4 b 4 F œ ˙ Hey Jude, dominant C œ œ œ œ ‰J Œ don't make it bad 4 &b 4 Œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ ? 4 Œ j j b 4 œ œœ œ œ œj œ œj œ œœ œ œ œ œœ F: I V tonic tonic œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ˙ œ œ œ Œ C 7sus take a sad song and make it œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœœ j œ œ. œ œ. j œ œœ œ œ œœ œ V7sus4 dominant YT: A_MjCqQoLLA Figure 9.4.7 Lennon-McCartney, “Hey Jude” F œ œ bet - ter œœ œœ œœ j œj œ œ œj œ œ œ œ œœ I tonic 12 CHAPTER 9. HARMONIC PROGRESSION AND HARMONIC FUNCTION71 œ œ œ J œ œ œ œ œ. Œ ? # # # 44 œ . A 112 E7 ### 4 ‰ j ‰ j ‰ & 4 œ œ œœ œœ ? ### 4 4 œ œ œ All 112 my ex - es live in Tex j‰ j œœœ œœœ œ œ A: I - œ œ ≈ œ Œ as ‰ j‰ œœœœ œ œ j‰ j‰ œœœœ œœœœ œ œ V7 tonic ? ### œ œ œ œ œ ‰ œ œ œ œ ˙ J ### ‰ & 114 ? ### œ A I hang my j ‰ œœœ œ V7 œ hat in Ten - nes - see j ‰ j ‰ œœœ œœœ œ œ œ œ j œœœ œ 116 Db bb 4 &bbb 4 œ œ œœ w Ó ‰ œj ‰ œœ œ œ j œœ ‰ œ j œœ ‰ œ œ œ I (dominant) 116 j œœœœ dominant E7 114 And that's why j œœ œ tonic Db Œ YT: Jk7uXaNuWNE œ œ œ œ E b m7 A b 7 w E b m7 A b 7 Œ Db œ œ œ œ Figure 9.4.8Startspreading Sanger D.news Shafer and Linda J. toShafer, - the I'm lea - ving day, “All My Ex’s I want Live to bein Texas” (1986) œ œœ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ 4 b b b bprinciple &The b 4 Œ Óof œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œœ Œ Ó œ “Tonic-Dominant-Tonic” could also be represented with I – vii◦ – I . Even though we learned that “dominant” means “5̂ ” (and also œ œ in terms œ œ “ V? ”) in 4 sections, b b earlier ∑ to “dominant œ Œ Œ function” œŒ Œ œ Œ of harmony Œ œ Œ means Œ œ“a b b 4progresses chordb that the tonic chord.” We will revisit this concept and other possibilities for D¯≤: “dominant function” later. ii7 V7 I I ii7 V7 I 9.4.3 Tonic-PreDominant-Dominant-Tonic Progression This sequence of harmonic functions can be realized in four possible ways: • I – ii – V – I • I – IV – V – I • I – IV – vii◦ – I • I – ii – vii◦ – I Here are examples with I – ii – V – I . CHAPTER 9. HARMONIC PROGRESSION AND HARMONIC FUNCTION72 14 194 14 194 196 196 198 &c ?c ‰ œ‰ œ œ œ œœ ‰ œœœœœœ‰ œœœœœœ œ œ ≈ œJ .œ œ œ ≈ œJ œ. œ œ ≈ œJ . œ ≈ œJ . œ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ C D m7/C ‰ œ œ œ ‰ œ œ œ œ ii‰7/7thœ œ œ œ œ œ ‰ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ c & ≈ œ .œ tonic œ œ ≈ œ œ. œ œ œ . pre-dominant œ ≈ ≈ œJ . œ J J G 7/B C J ‰ ˙ œ œ ‰ ˙ œ œ ‰ ˙ œ œ ‰˙ œ œœ œœœœœ ? & c œ .œ œ œ œ œ œ .œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ≈ J ≈ J ≈ œJ . œ ≈ œJ . œ C: I ii7/7th ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ? tonic pre-dominant C D m7/C C: I ‰ œ‰ œ œ œœœœœ & œ .œ œ œdominant œG m œ ≈ J ≈ œJ . Gœ m œ Œ b C œ œ œ œ œ˙œ œ œ œ b ˙ & œœ œœ œœ œœ ? G 7/B V7/3rd ‰ œ tonic œ‰ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œø œ ≈œ œJ . G m œ ≈ œJA . 7/G œ œ Œ ˙œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ˙œœ œ œœ œ œœ œœ C I œ œ œœ œœ œ œ œœ œœ œ œ YT: œœ œœvqM4tCZ7RV8 œ œ œœ œœ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œœ œœ œ œ œœ œœ œ œ Figure 9.4.9 J.S. Bach, Well-Tempered Clavier, Book I, Prelude 1 in C major 7/3rd I BWV V 846 198 œ Œ tonic Œ Ó Ó ø Œ Ó Gm Aœ7/G œ g: i i i iiø7/7th œ œ Œ œ œ œ œ b C œœ œ œœœ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ Œ œœ œœ b & œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œœ œœ œ œ ø œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ # 7 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ A /G D 7/F D7 Gm ? bb C Œ œ Œ Ó dominant Gm Gm b œ œ œœœ œ œ œ œœ œ Œ œœ œœ # œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ Œ b ? & b b Cœ Œœ œœ œœ œ œŒ œœ œœÓ œ œ œ œ Œœ œÓœ œ œ œ œœŒ œœ Ó# œ œ œœ œœ œ Œœ œœÓœœ œ œ œœ œœ œœœ œœ œœ œœ œœœ œœ 203 g: 203 207 207 i ? b b A œøø77/G Œ Ó ii /7th b & b œœ œ œœœA bœœœ œœ œ œœœ œœœ b b b œ 3œ ˙ . œ œ b & 4 ˙. ? bb œ Œ Ó Z ? b b biiø743/7th œœœ œœœ b (pre-dom.) œ ° A A¯≤: I b bb b b 3 ˙ . & 4 ˙. i i iiø7/7th Œ Ó œ Œ Ó G im Œ Œ œ # œ œ Œ œ DV77 Œ œ # œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œœ Dœœb œ œ œœ œœ œ œ Eœœb œœ œœ œœ # œœ œœ œœ Aœœb œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ ˙. œ œ œ œ œ Œ ˙. œ œ œ œ œ Œ Ó œ Œ Ó œ Œ Œ #œ œœ V7 œœ œœ œœ V7/3rd œ i œ œ œ dominant œ tonic œ œ * ° *° *° * b DIV Eb AIb V . ˙YT: O0PChj-uQPo œ œ œ œ œ Œ ˙. œ œ œ œ Figure 9.4.10 W.A. Mozart, Symphony No. 40 in G minor, K. 550, I.œ (textural reduction) Z œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ ? b b b 43 œ œ b œ œ œIV A¯≤: Iœ V I * ° *° *° ° * # DV77/F/3rd tonic pre-dom. ? ## œ œ œ V7 œ œ œ I œ œ CHAPTER 9. HARMONIC PROGRESSION AND HARMONIC (dominant) tonic FUNCTION73 116 116 Db Db bb 4 &bbb 4 œ œ œœ w Œ œ œ œ œ E b m7 A b 7 Œ w Db œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œœ Œ Ó Startspreading - the news bb 4 &bbb 4 Œ Ó ? bb 4 bbb 4 E b m7 A b 7 ∑ I'm lea - ving to œ Œ œ Œ œŒ D¯≤: I œ day, Œ I tonic œœ I want to be œ Œœ Œ œŒ œ Œ œ ii7 ii7 V7 V7 pre- dom. dom. I pre- dom. tonic dom. YT: 5-pyc_z7WbY Figure 9.4.11 John Kander and Fred Ebb, “Theme from New York, New York” (1977) A jj j ? ### 4 4 œ. #œ œ œ œ œ Œ Ó 295 j œ œ . œ œJ œJ œ Œ Ó Bm A: I ? ### 299 ii tonic pre-dom. j jœ j Œ Ó œ œ œ # œ œ. jj j Œ Ó œ. ‹œ œ œ œ œ E A V ? # # # 44 A w 303 I dominant tonic w w D w E E YT: 7PCkvCPvDXk A: I IV V V I Figure 9.4.12 Meghan Trainor and Kevin Kadish, “All About That Bass” (bass line and chord symbols only) (2014) ˙˙˙ are examples ˙˙ Here ˙˙˙ with I˙˙˙– IV – V – I ˙ & progression. 308 309 C: I vi IV V versus ˙˙˙ ˙˙ ˙ I vi C Am ˙ C: I 311 G¯≤ ? b b b 44 bb w D¯≤: IV 315 ˙˙ ˙ vi ii/3rd V F G ˙ IV A¯≤ D¯≤ B¯≤m V I vi w ˙˙ ˙ realizing the Ton-PreDom-Dom-Ton ? 44 ˙ w ˙ V w ? 4 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ bœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ b 4 œœœœœœœœ œœœœœœœœ F F: I FUNCTION: 319 œ A tonic E¯≤ B¯≤ F ¯≤VII IV I ton. prol. pre-dom. tonic ? bb œ Œ Ó Œ Ó #œ œ Œ Ó Œ Œ œ 7/3rd CHAPTER HARMONIC V PROGRESSION AND iiø79./7th V7 HARMONIC FUNCTION74 i (pre-dom.) Ab dominant Db b & b b b 43 ˙˙ .. 207 Eb ˙. ˙. Z œœ œœ œ œ ? b b b 43 b A œ œ œ œ œ ? # # # 44 œ # œj œj œ œj Œ Ó œ° . * °œ * 295 A¯≤I: I A: pre-dom. œ œ œ œ œ œ tonic œ œ Œ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ Bm œ j œ œ . œ œJ *œJ °œ Œ Ó * ° iiV I dominant pre-dom. tonic j jœ j Œ Ó j œj œ œj Œ Ó œ œ œ # œ œ. œ. ‹œ œ YT: pceSX1hceOI ? ### 299 IV tonic tonic Ab E A V I Figure 9.4.13 Frédéric Chopin, Waltz in A-flat major, Op. 34 No. 1 dominant ? # # # 44 A w 303 18 ˙˙˙ & ? # # # 44 C: I D IV tonic w E E V A œ V pre-dom. I dominant tonic ˙˙˙ ˙˙˙A ˙˙ ˙˙˙ ˙˙ ˙˙˙ ˙˙˙ Bm ˙ ˙ j j j j œ YT: CXnEgbDcITo œ œ œ Œ Ó . œ œJ œ œJ œ Œ Ó # œ œ œ . vi David IV Crane,VMarta versus I vi ii/3rdAlleeV Willis, Figure 9.4.14 Kauffman, Michael Skloff, 308 295 309 A:Danny I ii (bass line and chords only) Phil Solem, Wilde, “I’ll Be There For You” C Am F G (1995) E A Progressions using vii◦ ( I – IV – vii◦ – I and I – ii – vii◦ – I ) are less common because of the instability of diminished chords. C: I vi IV V V I 9.4.4 The Tonic-Tonic Prolongation-PreDominant-Dominant G¯≤ A¯≤ D¯≤ B¯≤m A D E E A Progression ? 44 ˙ ˙j œj œ ˙œj ˙Œ Ó j j jœ œ œ Œ Ó # œ œ. œ œ. ‹œ œ ? ### 299 311 303 315 308 w w A: I tonic ? b b b 44 w b# b 4 w w ? # w w – Vw , althoughœ in w # This progression 4 w is most commonly realized with I – vi – IV D¯≤: IV V I vi classical music one will often encounter I – vi – ii/3rd – V (mentioned above in A:onI vi – ii – V – I ). IV V the section F E ¯≤ B¯≤thirds. Notice the bass line starts with descending V F I ? b 44 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ b œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ œ œ˙œ œ œ œ˙˙œ œ ˙˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ I ˙˙ & F: I ˙ ˙ ¯≤VII˙ IV C: I FUNCTION: vitonic IV V prol. versus ton. I vi pre-dom. ii/3rd tonicV 309 319 & ? b b 22 b œ . j b œ œ œ Figure 9.4.15 Compare I – vi – IV – V to I – vi – ii/3rd – V (the bass lines are the same) D¯≤sus2 A¯≤ E¯≤ A¯≤ E¯≤ D¯≤sus2 A¯≤ E¯≤ A¯≤ E¯≤ Here is a musical example with I – vi – ii/3rd – V . 315 & 319 & E¯≤: ¯≤VII IV I œ œ ˙ IV I b œ . œj œ œ ¯≤VII IV I œ œ ˙ IV I CHAPTER 9. HARMONIC PROGRESSION AND HARMONIC FUNCTION75 15 b &bb 211 ? bb ? ### ? ### œ. ‹œ œ A ˙˙˙ & ? ? 323 327 E¯≤: I vi ii7/3rd V tonic ˙˙ ˙ 223 vi I ˙˙˙ tonic B¯≤ ton. prol. pre-dom. F m7/A b Bb dominant œBm œ œ œ njœ œ œ œ b œ œ œ . œ œJ œ œJ œ œ œŒn œ œÓœ œ b œ œ œ œ n œ œ œ œ Cm AŒ ii œœ j œœj œœ j Œ œ œ œœ œw. # œ œ œ wœ ii7/3rd vi I œœœ Œ ton. prol. F œœœ œœœ Œ œœœ œœœ œœœ Ó w V pre-dom. Cm dominant Gm w w ww www w ww YT: SSeveT_9ZxEw œ w w w Figure 9.4.16 Ludwig van Beethoven, Pathétique Sonata, Op. 13, I V V I ?IVb c b w w w 9.4.4.1 I–vi–IV–V w ˙ D A: I 319 Bb b &w b c ? # # # 44 w ? F m7/A b ˙ œ œ œ œ œ œnœ œ œ œ bœ œ œ œœnœœœœ bœœœ C œnœ œ œbœ p C œ & œœ œœ œœ Œ œœ œœ œœ Œ œœ œœ œœ Œ œ œ œ œ w w œ œ œ w 44 215# œj œj œ œjb Œ˙˙ Óœ œ œ. & b bœœ ÿ cresc. A: I E Œ œœ œœ œœ ? j œj œ œj b b b wŒ Ó A 219 311 Cm Eb V C: I b Eb ˙˙ ˙ E ˙˙ E ˙˙ ˙ ˙˙ ˙ A ˙˙ ˙ B¯≤: I earlier, the progression V vi As mentioned I – vi –iiIV – V was so prevalent in the 1950s that it is known as the “’50s progression” and the “’50s doo-wop unusual unusual F ˜7 Asus2 E9 G D Em7 F ˜7 progression.”Bm IV V versus I vi ii /3rd V Listen 309 for this bass line in the following examples. # wC & # c www ww ? 44 ˙ # ww ? # # c www C: I www Am ww w w w w w Fw w ˙ w ˙ #w w vi w IV w b: i V7 VII IV9 VI Figure 9.4.17 I – vi – IV – V bass line in C major w Gw w ˙w Vw III ww w ww iv7 w ww # ww V7 unusual unusual • Hoagy Carmichaelunusual and Frank Loesser, “Heart and Soul” (in C major) YT: pNjpTOB4ksY • Curtis Williams, Jesse Belvin, Gaynel Hodge, “Earth Angel” (in A-flat major) (1954) YT: VJcGi4-n_Yw 18 j œj œ œj Œ Ó ? # # # 44 # œ œ. œ j œ . œ œJ œ œJ œ Œ Ó A Bm CHAPTER 9. HARMONIC PROGRESSION AND HARMONIC FUNCTION76 295 • Dolly “I Will Always Love You” ii(in A major) (1974) A: Parton, I ? ### 299 A j œj œ œj Œ Ó j œj œ œj Œ Ó # œ œ. œ œ. ‹œ œ YT: 3JWTaaS7LdU E • Johnny V Ramone, Dee Dee Ramone, Joey I Ramone, “Rock ‘n’ Roll High School” (in C major) A D E E A ? # # # 44 w 303 w w w YT: vSkQEoZngyc œ A: I IV V V I In the above examples, the chords have have half-note harmonic rhythm. In the following example, the chords have whole-note harmonic rhythm (4 beats per chord). ˙˙ &˙ 308 ˙˙ ˙ ˙˙˙ ˙˙ ˙ ˙˙˙ ˙˙ ˙ ˙˙ ˙ ˙˙˙ • John Stephens and Toby Gad, “All of Me” (in A-flat major) (2013) C: I vi IV V versus I vi ii/3rd V 309 ? 44 ˙ C Am YT: 450p7goxZqg ˙ F ˙ G ˙ The I – vi – IV – V progression can also be rotated to IV – V – I – vi , as in the C: I vi IV V following example. 311 G¯≤ ? b b b 44 bb w D¯≤: IV ? bb b bb A¯≤ D¯≤ B¯≤m V I vi w w w 315 YT: PIh2xe4jnpk Figure 9.4.18 Nasri Atwey, Adam Messinger, Mark Pellizzer, Ben Spivak, Alex Tanas, “Rude” (bass line and chords only) (2014) ? bb b bb 323 You will see more examples of Tonic-Tonic Prolongation-PreDominantDominant progressions, including the use of the iii chord, in the Practice Exercises and the Homework. Remember, there are two exceptions in Harmonic Function: IV has tonic prolongation function when it progresses to I , and I/5th has dominant func327 when it progresses to V . tion ? bb b bb 9.5 Exceptions Created by Harmonic Sequences Exceptions to the harmonic flowchart often can be explained by harmonic sequences. FUNCTION: œ ŒPre-Dom. Œ œœ œœ Prol. œœ œœ œœDom.Œ œTon.œ œ Œ œ œ œ œ ?Ton.b w Ton. œIV œ œ œœ œœ œœ w œœ œœ œœ w bb iii w V ROMAN I NUMERALS:CHAPTERI 9. I vi ii HARMONIC vi PROGRESSION ii7AND /3rd HARMONIC V FUNCTION77 b VII b bm E b VII CVII F m7/A b Bb B¯≤ F Cm Gm b 4 œ ˙ œ œ œ œ œ œnœ œ œ œ bœ œ œœ œœœ b nœ & b b b 4C w ww www & ww w p E D A ? 4 ??#bb#bb#b# 4C44 œœ œ&œœœœœœœ œœœ œ œ Œwn œ œœœ œ œœœœ œœœœ œ Œ œœ œœ œœ w wwœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ wœ 219 211 (dashed lines represent possible movement within a functional area) 327 BE ¯≤:¯≤E:: III 223 331 ˆ 339 7/3rd ii iiIV ton. prol. pre-dom. unusual unusual F m7/A b nwŒœ œœœœ œ œœ œœœœ œ w D ¯≤viV VII Bb ˙ œ œ œ œ œ œ nœ œ œ œ bœ œ bb G ∑ A A Gœ∑œ n œ œGœ œ b∑œFœ˜m ˙G ∑ ∑ œ œ n œF∑˜œmœ œ & b # ? # # 44œ YT: Q4TK82N1nEk w w ÿ n wKeith Forsey, n w Giorgio nw nw w wWhat Figure 9.5.1 cresc. Moroder, Irene Cara, “Flashdance... A Feeling” A:Œ(1983) ¯≤œVIIœ œ ¯≤VIIŒ œ I œ œI Œ ¯≤VIIœ∑œ œœ¯≤VII Œvi cadence ? œœ œœvi∑ œœ œ ∑œ œ dom. ∑ ∑ ∑ œ œ œ œ deceptive FUNCTION: tonic ?Thebb bb sequence œ dom. w œ œ œ œ œ œ is between w the first two bars b w and the last wtwoœbarsœ ofœthe example. FUNCTION: 215 Eb viV¯≤VII bwœ œ œ œ n œ œ œ b œ ww tonic Cm dom. vi ii /3rd V ? b b 44 I w wF Cm w up a P5 Gm bb 4 wB¯≤ up a P5 & 4 w ww www www ww w sequenced up a M2 ? b b 44 Figure 9.5.2 Exceptions in w “Flashdance... What A Feeling”wcreated by sew quence w 7 219 ? bb 343 223 ? bb 353 There in theii verse of “HotelviCalifornia,” in B¯≤are : I unusual chord resolutions V the example below. unusual unusual # & # 44 www Bm ? # # 44 www b: i F ˜7 ww w Asus2 V7 VII # ww www w w unusual ww w ww ww D w ww Em7 IV9 VI III iv7 E9 # www G w w ww ww unusual ww w F ˜7 ww w # ww V7 unusual YT: YW4dzWE1SUs Figure 9.5.3 Don Felder, Don Henley, Glenn Frey, “Hotel California” (1977) The example below shows how these exceptions come about through harmonic sequences. 15 sequenced up a M2 CHAPTER 9. HARMONIC PROGRESSION AND HARMONIC FUNCTION78 343 ? ## 4 4 w up a P5 w 18 w up a P5 down a M2 ? ## w w w up a P5 w w pre-dom. dom. down a M2 jœ œ œ j œj œ œj Œ Ó ? # # # 44 Ó œ . # œ œ œ Œencounter œ. Look for harmonic sequencesœas a possible explanation J when J you 351 295 A Bm Figure 9.5.4 Exceptions in “Hotel California” created through sequences A: I progressions. unusual chord 299 ii E A j j # jPopular ? # j j j œ œ œ VIIŒ Chord Ó Œ Ó 9.6 #The Subtonic in œ œ œ œ Music # œ œ . œ. ‹œ œ we will discuss mode mixture and the Mixolydian mode later, the ? b bAlthough V I ubiquity of the subtonic chord (2 VII ) in rock and popular music makes it bimportant to Adiscuss here. D E E A 323 ?The # # # 2 VII 44 w ˙˙˙ & ˙˙ ˙ w w w œ chord can precede tonic, dominant, and pre-dominant chords, which means it can substitute for any function except tonic. 303 A: I FUNCTION: 308 Ton. ROMAN NUMERALS: C: I vi 309 311 I ˙˙˙ IV V Ton. Prol. ˙˙˙ iii vi bVII V versus V ˙˙˙ ˙ IV ˙˙ Pre-Dom. ii bVII I vi I Dom. Ton. ii/3rd bVII V ˙ V˙˙ ˙˙˙ I ? 44 ˙movement within a functional area) (dashed lines represent possible ˙ ˙ ˙ C Am F G C: I Music vi IV V chord Figure 9.6.1 Harmonic Flowchart for Popular with Subtonic VII in Major G¯≤ A¯≤ D¯≤ B¯≤m Notice also that movement from IV – I (from the plagal cadence) is common in the following examples from popular music. Here are examples ending with 2 VII – IV – I , where IV progresses to I (a D¯≤: IVand is precededVby 2 VII . I vi plagal cadence) ? bb 327 IV b ? b b b b 44 b w w w w F E¯≤ B¯≤ F ? b b ? b 44 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ b œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ b œœœœœœœœ 315 335 ¯≤VII F: I ? bb 339 319 FUNCTION: tonic ton. prol. IV I pre-dom. tonic b YT: A_MjCqQoLLA ? bb C b œ . j b œ . œj œline and chords Figureb 9.6.2 Lennon-McCartney, Jude” (bass œ œ œ œ œ“Hey ˙ œ œ œ ˙only) (1968) the following questions: When a phrase ends on the IV chord, ? b bdoesConsider it have dominant function (i.e, is it a half cadence)? Does IV have b dominant function in popular music when it progresses to I ? If so, does 2 VII 347 have pre-dominant function in the above progression? ? bb 355 b 19 ? b 44 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ b œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœœœœœœœ F: I 9. HARMONIC¯≤PROGRESSION VII IV I FUNCTION79 CHAPTER AND HARMONIC FUNCTION: ?319b b 323 tonic ton. prol. pre-dom. tonic Notice that 2 VII begins the phrase in the following example, and proceeds 19 to a IV – I conclusion. b D¯≤sus2 A¯≤ E¯≤: ¯≤VII IV Ton. Ton. Prol. FUNCTION: ? bb 323 E¯≤ A¯≤ E¯≤ ? bb C b œ . j b œ œ œ E¯≤ b œ . œj œ œ I IV I ¯≤VII IV Dom. Ton. Pre-Dom. iii ROMAN NUMERALS: œ œ ˙ D¯≤sus2 A¯≤ IV I A¯≤ E¯≤ œ œ ˙ IV I 19 V ii YT: z8rQ575DWD8 I bVII Figure 9.6.3 U2, “Desire” (bass line and chords) (1988) b I vi bVII bVII 2 VII preceding and following the IV chord. The following example (dashed lines represent possiblehas movement within a functional area) Does the 2 VII chord have tonic prolongation as labeled, or is it “pre predominant” in function? Ton. Dom. Ton. FUNCTION: Ton. Prol. Pre-Dom. 327 E D A D iii IV V ROMAN I I vi ii NUMERALS: bVII bVII bVII E: I ¯≤VII IV ¯≤VII ? # # # # 44 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ n œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ nœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ? #### 331 327 ? #### 339 ? #### 347 331 ? #### ? ### ton. prol. tonic pre-dom. FUNCTION: (dashed lines represent possible movement within a functional area) dom. E D A D # ? # 4 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ # 4 Keith Forsey andn œ Steve œ œ œ œSchiff, œ œ œ “Don’t œ œ œ œMe)” œœ Figure # 9.6.4 œ œ œ œYou œ œ œ(Forget œ n œ œAbout (bass line and chords) (1985) YT: CdqoNKCCt7A VII cadencing to IV the I chord in ¯≤VIIthe first four Here is E: an I example with 2¯≤VII ton. in prol. tonic pre-dom. dom. four FUNCTION: bars then progressing to the vi chord a deceptive cadence in the second bars. ? # # # 44 nw G A: ¯≤VII FUNCTION: G nw ¯≤VII dom. A w I A w I tonic G nw ¯≤VII G nw ¯≤VII dom. F ˜m F ˜m vi vi w w deceptive cadence 355 339 ? #### ? ### 363 347 ? ### 355 YT: GaH25Sghoqc Figure 9.6.5 Walter Becker and Donald Fagen, “Reelin’ in the Years” (bass line and chords) CHAPTER 9. HARMONIC PROGRESSION AND HARMONIC FUNCTION80 16 9.7 The Best-Seller Progression # & # 44 ˙ ˙˙ 231 D A Bm G ˙˙ ˙ ˙˙ ˙ ˙˙˙ V vi IV ? # # 44 ˙ ˙ ˙ D: I ˙ # ∑ progression ∑ ∑occurs∑in many∑ popular ∑ songs, ∑ has ∑a Wikipedia ∑ &The# I – V∑ – vi – IV 233 Figure 9.7.1 The I – V – vi – IV “Best-Seller” Progression page, and has been mentioned in a New Yorker article about bestselling novels (see the third paragraph from the end of the article). The music group Axis of Awesome made a compilation of several songs with the I – V – vi – IV progression that makes for an entertaining summary (warning: there is some language 13 after the 5-minute mark). Here is a written-out example that includes the I – V – vi – IV progression. ? # # ∑ 122 122 ∑ ∑ ∑ ## & # 44 ∑≈ œ œ œ œ ∑œ œ œ œ A 243 E ∑ ∑ # # # ∑ ∑ & # ∑ & # ? # # # ∑ ∑ ? ## ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ F˜m ∑ œ œ œ ∑ œ œ . ˙ ∑ # ? ## ## 44 ∑ œ ∑ œ & œ ∑ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œ ? ### 4 4 ˙ 249 ˙ ## ˙ ∑ ∑ ∑ & A: I V 124 # # # ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ & ? ## ∑ ∑ YT: hLQl3WQQoQ0 ∑ Ne-ver mind I'll find ∑ some-one like ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ D œ∑ œ you ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ I wish œ ∑ œ œ ∑ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œœœ œ ˙ ˙ vi ∑ ∑ ∑ ˙ IV ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ 124 Figure 9.7.2 Adele Adkins and Dan Wilson, “Someone Like You” (2011) ∑ ∑ The I – V – vi – IV progression can be rotated to become vi – IV – I – V and 255 IV – I – V – vi . ## & # 137 137 & ### ? ### ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ 20 352 13 ? # # 9. HARMONIC PROGRESSION AND HARMONIC FUNCTION81 CHAPTER # # # 4 ≈ start & 4 œ œ œI œ œ œ œ œ A 122 # # # 4IV & 4 122 F˜m start E œ œ œ œ œ . vi˙ Ne-ver mind I'll find œ some-one like œ œ you œ V vi œ œ I wish œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœœ œ œœ œœ œ œ œ ? # # # 44 ˙ ˙ œ D V œ ˙ ˙ ˙ IV I ˙ Figure 9.7.3 A: IExample of I – V –Vvi – IV rotation tovivi – IV – I – V IV 360Here is an example with the vi – IV – I – V progression. ? ## bb 4 &bb 4 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ 124 Fm ? ## D¯≤ bb 4 & b b 4 œ. œœ .. 16 Hel - lo from ? b b b 44 b œ. the oth - er j œœ ˙˙ œ ˙ j œ ˙ E¯≤ œœ .. œ. j œœœ ˙˙˙ œ. 377 124 j œ ˙ A¯≤ side œ. j œ ˙ I V # & # 44 ˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ 126 ∑ ∑YQHsXMglC9A ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ? b#b#b b44 ∑ ˙ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ YT: & ˙ Greg Kursten,˙ “Hello” (2015)˙ Figure 9.7.4 Adele Adkins and 231 D A¯≤: vi A IV Bm G bb & b b ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ – IV can also bevithought of as IV being in minor: I – I – V progression V 126The viD: i – VI – III – VII 233 bbbb & ? bb b b Fm œœœ ∑ ∑ ? bb b œ b A¯≤: vi D¯≤ œœ œ∑ ∑ œ IV A¯≤ E¯≤ bb œ œœ œ∑ ∑ œœœ ∑ ∑ b∑b ∑œœ ∑ œ I Fm œ bbbb œ V f: i D¯≤ A¯≤ œœ ∑œ ∑ œœ œ∑ ∑ œ œ VI III E¯≤ œœœ ∑ ∑ œ VII Figure 9.7.5 “Best-Seller” Progression with Roman Numerals in Major and Relative Minor 235 Whether you hear this progression in major or minor depends on whether you hear the first chord as the tonic or if you hear the third and fourth chord as tonic and dominant. Here is an example with the IV – I – V – vi progression. b & b b b ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ? b b b ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ b b & b bb 249 ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ B¯≤: I/5th V7 I dom. ton. CHAPTER 9. HARMONIC PROGRESSION AND HARMONIC FUNCTION82 bb 4 &bbb 4 Œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ G¯≤ 157 bb 4 & b b b 4 ww w 157 D¯≤ Now that it's rain - ing more than ev - er Know that we still have each oth - ww w ? b b b 44 bb w w D¯≤: IV I 159 b & b bbb œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ A¯≤ 159 & bbbb B¯≤m er You can stand un - der my um - br - el - la You can stand un - der my um - br - el - b w ww ww w V vi ? bb bbb w 20 ? ## 352 w start start YT: CvBfHwUxHIk vi I Figure 9.7.6 Christopher Stewart, Terius Nash, Kuk Harrell, Shawn Carter, “Umbrella” (2007) V IV IV V 9.8 The i–VII–VI–VII Progression I Thevii – VII – VI – VII ( Am – G – F – G ) progression is similar to the descending 1̂ –27̂ –26̂ –5̂ bass line of the “Andalusian progression” ( Am – G – F – E ) in flamenco music, with the exception of the last bass note or chord. Here are examples of the i – VII – VI – VII progression. 360 ? 44 Am œ œ Œ a: i ? G œ œ VII Œ F œ. VI G œ œ œ œ œ. œ œ VII 362 YT: iXQUu5Dti4g Figure 9.8.1 Jimmy Page and Robert Plant, “Stairway to Heaven” (chords and bass line only) (1970) ?4 4 œ œ Œ Am 360 vi G F Œ œ œ œ. G I œ œ œ œ œ. œ œ CHAPTER 9. HARMONIC PROGRESSION AND HARMONIC FUNCTION83 a: i VII VI VII 362 16 231 Cm a: i c: i 362 ? bb 366 b Am B¯≤ G A¯≤ F B¯≤ G VII VI VI VII VII 4 ? b b 44 œ œ œ ? 4œ œœœ œœ œŒœ œ œ œœ œœœ Œœ œ œ œœœ. œ œ œœ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œœœ. œ œ œ œ œ b 360 VII B¯≤ A¯≤ Cm 366 D: I 233 bb œ œœ & b b VII Fm ? bb œ bb V start D¯≤ i œœ œ œ VI A¯≤ œœ œ E¯≤ VII œœœ œ œ start vi IV VI Fm D¯≤ œ œ b b b bVIIœœœ bbbb A¯≤ œœ œ E¯≤ œœVII œœ œ œ i œ œ 374 Figure 9.8.3 The i – VII – VI – VII progression rotating to VI – VII – i – VII A¯≤: vi IV I V f: i VI III VII ?In bsome b b cases, the fourth chord is eliminated. In that case, VI – VII – i – VII becomes VI – VII – i – i , as in the following examples. 235 B¯≤ G ? b b 44 œAœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œBm œœœœœœ œœœœœœœœ œœœœœœœœ b # & # 44 ˙ c: i ˙ VII ˙ VI ˙ VII ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ YT: rYEDA3JcQqw Figure 9.8.2 Adele Adkins and Paul Epworth, “Rolling In The Deep” (chords and bass line only) (2010) ? #b # 44 ˙ ? The can also be˙rotated to become b b i – VII – VI – VII progression ˙ ˙ VI – VII – i – VII . D 4 œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ b & 4 B¯≤ C Dm B¯≤ C Dm ? b 44 ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ w w ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ w w d: VI VII i VI VII i & b ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ 239 YT: 4RYlgoQrshw ? b ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ Figure 9.8.4 Christopher Bridges, Calvin Broadus, Johnny Mollings, Lenny Mollings, William Roberts II, “All I Do Is Win” (chords and bass line) (2010) ?4b œ44 ˙œ Œ ˙ Œ œ œw ˙ VII w a: i ˙ œ˙ œ ˙œ œ œww. ˙ ˙ œ. œ œ VI VII d: VI VII iPROGRESSIONVI VII i FUNCTION84 CHAPTER 9. HARMONIC AND HARMONIC Cm B¯≤ A¯≤ B¯≤ ? b b 44F œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œG œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œAm œœœœ b w w œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ wœ œ œ œ w c:w i VII VII w VI w 4 w &4 362 239 ? b bb 366 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœœœœœœœ œœœœœœœœ ? 44 œœ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ start start i a: VI VII VII VI i VII VII VII YT: F6AggxvVFRY 12 Figure 9.8.5 Philip Glass, Metamorphosis Two (1989) VI i – VII – VI – VII i be thought The www can# also # wwww progression # # # # w of asb being www inb ba wwmajor # wwww 12 b b b _____ key: vi – V – IV –&V .# _____ w w w w w w_____ _____ _____ _____ _____ 407 407 Am ww F ww G G1.# b: _____ w 2. Eb¯≤: _____ Ex. e: III /5th 9.9 Practice Exercises b b b 1. A: ii7 b & _____ b _____ bb Day One Day One: & 1. a: iv7 b b b 2. D¯≤: iii7 _____ 419 _____ M7 419 1. 425 425 431 431 432 432 433 433 435 434 434 441 447 _____ _____ _____ w www 6.bBb ¯≤G: ww_____ ˙˙˙ ˙˙˙ # wwww˙˙ 5.b d:F˙˙_____ ˙˙˙ww &˙˙ # w ˙˙ b b ww ˙˙ w & ˙ _____˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ www 5.b d: _____ ww 2. E¯≤:#_____ww 3. e:# _____ # w 4. E:b _____ ww 6. B#¯≤: _____ ?1. b:b _____ w ww n b w # ww # www b w b b n w bb w ww _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ a: i VII VI VII C: vi V IV V www w # ww #9. f#˜: _____ ww 12.#G: _____ ? b 7.b f:n_____ ww ww # wwww 10.b bg: _____ w b b11.b c:n w_____ b b www 8. #D: _____ w ww Figure 9.8.6 The same progression relative major maj7/D G_____ _____ viewed _____from minor _____ _____ and _____ 413 # 7. f:more # # #12. _____# common 10. g: _____ b 11.to c: _____ b 9. f˜: _____# #progressions There are several explore fu# # G:in_____ # # 8. D: _____bharmonic b b & 7 maj G _____ /D _____ _____ _____ ture chapters dealing with topics like secondary _____ chords, mode the _____ mixture, 413 #augmented # # sixth # # # M7 b ø7and# jazz ø7harmony. b Neapolitan chord, 7 7 chords, &Ex. e: IIIM7/5th # 1. A: ii b 2. g: ii #3. D: vii b b 4. c: V #5. B:# IV /3rd 401 374 _____ _____ 401 2. # # wwww Am #4. #E:# _____ G 3. e: _____ # #2.# g: iiø7 _____ ## _____ 3. D: viiø7 # # #3. f˜: viio7 # # _____ _____ 4. D: vi7 bbb # _____ _____ 4. c: V7 5. B: IVM7/3rd b b 5.b c: iv7/3rd # 6. G: IM7 _____ _____ Write the circle of fifths _____ progression in the following keys root _____ _____ _____ _____ with_____ o7 7 7 Label 7 7 position triads. Roman numerals below and lead-sheet symbols 1. a: iv 2. D¯≤: iii 3. 4. D: vi 5. ? b # f˜: vii # c: iv /3rd b 6. G: IM7 b b above. b b b _____ b b _____ # _____ b _____ _____ _____ (a) In 7. f: V7 ?F bmajor: 8. A¯≤: ii7 #9.#b: viio7/5th b10.b B¯≤: viiø7 11.# e: iiø7/3rd b12. F: IVM7 b bb bbb ?b 7. f: V7 8. A¯≤: ii7 9. b: viio7/5th 10. B¯≤: viiø7 11. e: iiø7/3rd 12. F: IVM7 ? b _____ I I _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ 7 8 1 2 3 4 5 6 # I I _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ (b) In &B #minor: 7 8 1 2 3 4 5 6 # I I _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ & # _____ 7 8 1 2 3 4 5 6 ? b b _____ i i _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ 7 8 1 2 3 4 5 6 13 I I ? _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ b Review. Write intervals above the given note. b 1 the following 7 8 2 3 4 5 6 # ? # b w w I & & # _____ w _____ _____ _____# w _____ _____ _____ # w_____ w8I 7 1 2 3 4 5 6 5. º5↑ 6. m7↑ 3. P5↑ 1. º7↑# # 2. M3↑ 4. M7↑ I I _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ # & 7 8 1 2 3 4 5 6 & & bw 1. m3↑ w i _____ 1 w _____ 2. m6↑ w 2 w _____ 3 3. P5↑ bw ? w _____ _____ 4 5 4. º7↑ ? #w w _____ 6 5. M3↑ w _____ 7 b w_____ i 8 6. M6↑ w & 457 bw F˜º7 w w F˜7/C˜ 3. P5↑ ? w bw ? 4. º7↑ Dm/F 5. M3↑ & Am 6. M6↑ & 9. HARMONIC PROGRESSION? CHAPTER AND HARMONIC FUNCTION85 447 3. 453 461 & G B˜º ¯≤m/B ? ? FF˜˜7m/C˜ 5. g: b: _____ _____ 5. ADº/F ¯≤maj7 & 2.2.cA: ˜: _____ _____ ? FF˜˜º /A7˜ w 8. F: _____ 3.3.Ec:¯≤:_____ _____ Am/G C˜m 4. E: G: _____ _____ 4. ? Dmaj7 Dm/F & 6.6.D: B:_____ _____ ? f ˜_____ : _____ 7.7.d: Fm Am 8.8.AF: ¯≤: _____ _____ Review. Correct the rhythmic notation of the following example. G˜º/B Incorrect ã&44 œ œ œ œ œ 465 Day Two: 5. ? 44 œ A¯≤maj7 Correct && b w ww _____ ?b w F: _____ 1 7. œ œ& 2. c˜: _____ Bo/D C/E Incorrect F˜/A˜ Dm/F Am/G 3. E¯≤: _____ C/G G 4. G: _____ C Correct Half Cadence = 6. D: _____ = œ 7. f ˜: _____ œ œ œ Cadence œ Deceptive Plagal Cadence = Authentic = I/5th viio/3rd I/3rd Cadence ii/3rd V ˙ œ œ œ œ) Fm 8. A¯≤: _____ I passing Analyze the following progressions with lead-sheet symbols above and pre-dom. FUNCTION: tonic dom. tonic Roman numerals below. 469 245 œ œ. ≈ 5. b: _____ C: I 6. B 7 F˜m (4 œ œœœ œ ? œ ˙˙˙œ & 4œ œœœœ œ œ œœœœ œ ?œ œœœœ œ œ œœœœ œ ) (œ œœœ œ œ Dmaj 6 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ For each cadence, label the chord(s) involved. . & ã&8 C 253 B D 1. f:a:_____ _____ 1. 1. a: _____ 471 # w7. d: _____ w ( œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ?œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ) ( œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ? œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ) 461 243 bw 6. B: _____ Review. lead-sheet symbol and key, write the key signature, 7. º7↑Given the 8. M3↑ 10. m7↑ 11. º5↑ 12. P5↑ 9. +6↑ triad or seventh chord, and Roman numeral. & 4. 2. m6↑ w 5. g: _____ w & 465 457 469 1. m3↑ _____ ww w w _____ 2 _____ ww w w _____ 3 #### _____ ww w _____ ww # # # # ww w E: _____ 1 _____ 4 _____ _____ ww ww w w w w _____ 2 _____ 3 _____ ww ww _____ 4 # # ww the wRomanwwnumerals, ww write (a) chords b b the ww triads ww or seventh ww ww ww & Given w w w w w w w _____ _____ _____ do For the _____ progression, the following: _____ _____ _____ _____ (b) Analyze the harmonies with lead-sheet symbols above the staff w harmony w using (c) the harmonic function ofbeach ? #Analyze w the wabbre#viations w “ton.” b w forwtonic function, w “dom.” for dominant function, “pre-dom.” for pre-dominant “ton. _____ prol.” for tonic b: _____ _____ _____ function, B¯≤: _____ and_____ _____ _____ 1 2 function 3 4 1 2 3 4 prolongation # bb w w b ww _____ ww_____ ww w _____ _____ that _____ _____ _____ the (d) Specify cadence ends the_____ progression & # &? ## 261 14 473 ww w 44 w D: ww w www w _____ I G: _____ _____ _____ 1 2 FUNCTION: ww w _____ w iii _____ _____ 3 w vi7 w bbb w ii7/3rd _____ ww w _____ V w E¯≤: _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ 4 1 2 3 _____ ˙˙˙ ˙˙ ˙ _____ ˙ ˙ I _____ _____ 4 Cadence: _______ 479 ? b b 44 g: FUNCTION: _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ i VI iv iiø7/3rd V7 _____ _____ _____ _____ www _____ _____ i _____ 17 CHAPTER 9. HARMONIC PROGRESSION AND HARMONIC FUNCTION86 Click here to download the first homework assignment for this chapter. Click here to download the second homework assignment for this chapter. Chapter 10 Non-Chord Tones 10.1 Introduction to Non-Chord Tones Non-chord tones are notes that do not belong to the chord. Sometimes referred to as “embellishing tones” and “non-harmonic tones,” non-chord tones are classified by how they are approached and left (either by same tone, step, or leap). There are nine types of non-chord tones. Table 10.1.1 Non-Chord Tone Passing Tone Neighbor Tone Appoggiatura Escape Tone Double Neighbor Anticipation Pedal Point Suspension Retardation Approached by step step leap step see text step same note same note same note Left by step in same direction step in opposite direction step leap in opposite direction see text same note same note step down step up The following qualifiers can be applied to non-chord tones: • Accented—occuring on the beat • Unaccented—occuring on the weak part of the beat (on the offbeat) • Chromatic—not belonging to the key • Metrical—equal to the duration of the beat • Sub-metrical—smaller than the beat • Super-metrical—larger than the beat 10.2 Passing Tones Passing tones are notes that pass between chord tones. 87 CHAPTER 10. NON-CHORD TONES 88 E¯≤ b 4 &bb 4 Œ Cm (E¯≤-G-B¯≤) œ Girl Œ pt œ (œ ) œ Œ you're the one œ I app œ ( ) want œ to (C-E¯≤-G) pt œ œ ( ) want me b b∑b b b & (C-E¯≤-G) 4 E¯≤ b 4 &bb 4 Œ œ ? bb b 4 Œ & b b4 YT: rClUOdS5Zyw Cm (E¯≤-G-B¯≤) app pt pt Martin, Figure 10.2.1 Jason Desrouleaux, Ian Kirkpatrick, Samuel Denison 9(˜5)=A¯≤-C-E-G¯≤-B¯≤ D¯≤6=D¯≤-F-A¯≤-B¯≤ D¯≤=D¯≤-F-A¯≤ A¯≤ E¯≤ Mitch Allan, “Want to Want Me” (2015) Cm Lindy Robbins, ( ) ( ) ((C-E¯≤-G) ) (E¯≤-G-B¯≤) app the passing tone is In the first bar of the “Want toptWant Me” example, pt Girl you're the one I want to want me unaccented. In the third bar, it is accented (on the beat). The non-chord tone ( ) ( ) ( ) in bar 2 is an appoggiatura. 4 There can be two consecutive diatonic passing tones in a descending sigh is just you're athe one sigh Girl I want to want me scale segment from the root and fifth of a chord. œ Œ œ œ œ Œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ˙ ˙ œ Œ Œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ? b b ∑ bbb 7 4 D¯≤ A¯≤9(˜5) D¯≤6 ? ? b ∑b (D¯≤-F-A¯≤) (A¯≤-C-E-G¯≤-B¯≤) (D¯≤-F-A¯≤-B¯≤)b b b b ∑ b b b b œ (œpt) (œpt) œ ˙ ˙ A¯≤9(˜5) D¯≤6 ? b b b D¯≤ b b (D¯≤-F-A¯≤) (A¯≤-C-E-G¯≤-B¯≤) (D¯≤-F-A¯≤-B¯≤) 8 œ œpt œpt) œa ˙sigh ? b b bb ∑sigh∑ ∑ ( is∑) ∑ ∑(just ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ˙∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ b 7 sigh is just a sigh ? b b ∑b bb YT: d22CiKMPpaY 5 5 5 ? b b ∑b bb 8 ? b b b ∑ ∑ ∑ B¯≤∑ 7 ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑E¯≤∑7 ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ bb (B¯≤-D-F-A¯≤) (E¯≤-G-B¯≤-D¯≤) pt pt pt pt bb 4 & 4 j œ ( œœ ) ( # n œœ ) œœ œœ .. j œœ ( b( œœ )) (( # n œœ )) œœ œœ .. œ pt pt œ œ (pt ) ( pt ) Figure 10.2.2 Herman Hupfeld, “As Time Goes By” (1931) 7 Here is an example with chromatic passing tones. 8 b ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ & b ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ YT: _40V2lcxM7k 11 Figure 10.2.3 Thelonious Monk, “Blue Monk” (1954) In the next section we discuss the neighbor tone. 10.3 Neighbor Tones Neighbor tones move away from a note by step then return to the note. b 4 Œ &bb 4 Œ œ Œ (œ ) œ œ (œ ) œ CHAPTER 10. NON-CHORDœ TONES (E¯≤-G-B¯≤) 18 Girl (C-E¯≤-G) app pt you're the one I want pt œ ( ) to want œ 89 me G ? b b ∑ bbb # 3 . ( œ ) œ .. ( # ntœ ) œ .. ( ntœ ) œ .. (ntœ ) ˙ œ œ œ œ ˙ œ # œ œ œ & 4 D¯≤œ . ( ) ( ) ( ) A¯≤9((˜5)) D¯≤6 nt pt nt nt (D¯≤-F-A¯≤-B¯≤) (D¯≤-F-A¯≤) (A¯≤-C-E-G¯≤-B¯≤) p œ (œpt) (œpt) œ ˙ ˙œ ??b b# b 43 Œ œ œ bb œ œ (G-B-D) Allegretto 269 5 4 pt sigh is # & ∑ just ∑ 272 ∑ a ∑ sigh ∑ ∑ ∑ YT: frrGAqzuOlA ∑ ∑ ∑? b b b∑b 7 Figure 10.3.1 Ludwig van Beethoven, Minuet in G, WoO 10, No. 2 In the next section B¯≤7 we discuss the appoggiatura.E¯≤7 (B¯≤-D-F-A¯≤) (E¯≤-G-B¯≤-D¯≤) ? # ∑ ∑ pt∑ pt ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ pt ∑pt ∑ ∑ bb 4Appoggiatura 10.4 & 4 j œ ( œœ ) #( n œœ ) œœ œœ .. j œœ ( b( œœ )) #(( n œœ )) œœ œœ .. œ left by ptstep.ptIt is usually ac)( ) The appoggiatura by leap and œ œ is(ptapproached pt cented 282 # (on the beat), which makes it a particularly expressive non-chord tone. ∑Cm ∑ B¯≤ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ B¯≤ ∑ & A¯≤ 8 11 b &?b #b 44 ∑˙ (C-E¯≤-G) Near, 289 & # ∑ (B¯≤-D-F) ∑ œ . far, ∑ (A¯≤-C-E¯≤) app leap ∑ j (∑œ ) œ where - ev ∑ step - ∑œ er ∑ ∑ YT: WNIPqafd4As pt ant ( (B¯≤-D-F) œ ) ∑( œ ) œ ∑ you are ∑ ? b b œŒÓ ∑ b 13 live Figure 10.4.1 James Horner and Will Jennings, “My Heart Will Go On” (1997) ?The# example ∑ above∑ also has∑an anticipation, ∑ ∑ is discussed ∑ in a∑ later which section in this chapter. 2 14 E ?&# ### # 44∑ w 296 (E-G˜-B) ∑ Œ œ∑ ( œ œ ) ∑œ app A (A-C˜-E) w ∑ Bsus4 B (B-E-F˜) (B-D˜-F˜) ∑˙ ˙ ∑ ? # ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ? # # # # ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑YT: IxuThNgl3YA ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ 18 Figure 10.4.2 Bruce Springsteen, “Born to Run” (1975) Notice that both the appoggiaturas in the following example resolve up. Both the leap to and step away from any appoggiatura can be from any direction. b ?# 3 Œ 4 œ œ œ œ œ CHAPTER 10. NON-CHORD TONES A¯≤ j bb b 6 œ & 8 œ 272 b & b b ∑ E¯≤/G j app j j œ œ œ Œ (nœ ) (nœ ) œ œ œ (nœ ) (nœ ) app app ‰ œ œ œ œ œ ‰ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ‰ œ‰ œŒ . œ œ œ œ‰ œ‰ œŒ . œ œ œ œ J J (A¯≤-C-E¯≤) app ? b b 68 ‰ b ∑ ∑ ∑ j œ Œ œ ∑ (E¯≤-G-B¯≤) ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ? b b ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ In the b next section we discuss the escape tone. ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ 275 ∑ ∑ YT: Fcomfvmq28Q ∑ Figure 10.4.3 W.A. Mozart, Symphony No. 40, K. 550, II 10.5 Escape Tone E 2 90 (E-G˜-B) (A-C˜-E) (B-E-F˜) (B-D˜-F˜) app An escape b#b b 4tone ∑ is approached ∑ by( œstep ∑œ ) andœ left ∑by leap in the ∑ ˙opposite˙ ∑direc& ? # tion. An Œ œ is the end of wthe “Star-Spangled Banner.” # # easy 4 wexample to remember A 288 14 Bsus4 B The word “of” in “home of the brave” is an escape tone. 18 ? b b B¯≤/F∑ b (B¯≤-D-F) b 3 œ. &b 4 ∑ home b & b ∑ 20 ∑ F ∑(F-A-C-E¯≤) ∑ œ œ J esc ( ) of ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ (B¯≤-D-F) ˙ the ∑ ∑ B¯≤ 7 brave. ∑ YT: LGvW6jHUHiY ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ Figure 10.5.1 Francis Scott Key and John Smith, “Star-Spangled Banner” (1814) Here is another example, with escape tones used in a melodic sequence. ? b b 68 ‰ b œ œ‰ œ‰ œŒ . œ œ œ J CHAPTER 10. NON-CHORD TONES C G/F (C-E-G) (G-B-D-F) (C-E-G) œ & 43 f 3 ?&# #4# # Œ 44 275 2 14 œ . ( œ )œ . (esc œ) œ esc E œœ œœ w (E-G˜-B) œ œ F (F-A-C) app app ( # œ) œ œ œ ? œapp œ Œ œœŒ ( œ œ) œ œ G7 C (G-B-D-F) (C-E-G) 91 œ ‰ ( œ) ‰ œ œ ‰ œ Œ Œ œ œ A Œ w (A-C˜-E) F7 B¯≤/F œœ Bsus4 B (B-E-F˜) (B-D˜-F˜) ˙ Œ˙ Œ B¯≤ & b ∑ 3 ∑œ . ∑ ∑ ∑ (∑œ) ∑ ∑œ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ˙ &b 4 J 279 18 C/E œ œ œ œ œ œ ‰ ‰ Œ. œ J (B¯≤-D-F) (F-A-C-E¯≤) escYT: A-Qfd7gpGfU (B¯≤-D-F) Figure 10.5.2 Joseph Haydn, Piano Sonata in C Major, Hob. XVI:35, III (1780) of the brave. ?Here∑ ishome ∑an example ∑ ∑ of∑an escape ∑ ∑ tone ∑ in∑popular ∑ ∑music. ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ 2 C Em7 E 20 Fmaj7 Bsus4 B (A-C(F-A-C-E) ˜-E) (B-E-F˜) (B-D˜-F˜) esc ? 4# # # # 44 œ.wœ. œ œ œ œ œ Œ œœ. ( œ œœ) œ. œœ. œ( œw.) w ≈ R &4 Œ ˙ w ˙ b b ∑43 œ . ∑ & & ∑ (C-E-G) (E-G˜-B) pt pt 14 A (E-G-B-D) app ( ) ( ) F7 B¯≤/F 18 B¯≤ œ œ ∑ ∑ JYT: ∑ap87QgZKTNw (B¯≤-D-F) esc 24 (F-A-C-E¯≤) (B¯≤-D-F) ∑˙ ( ) ∑ Figure 10.5.3 Paul McCartney and Linda McCartney, “Silly Love Songs” home of the brave. (1976) Em7 C 20 (E-G-B-D) 10.6(C-E-G) Double pt .œ œ. œ(ptœNeighbor . œ. œ(esc œ .) œ œ œ . œ ( ) ) œ œ 4 &4 Œ ≈ R Fmaj7 (F-A-C-E) w w The double neighbor (sometimes called a “neighbor group”) occurs when both the upper and lower neighbor occur before the return to the starting tone. C 24 dn œ 4 œ ( œ œ ) œ œ (# œ dn œ ) œ œ (# œ œ ) œ &4 (C-E-G) dn Figure 10.6.1 C major arpeggio embellished with double neighbors 25 & ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ j ?b bb 6 œ & b 8 œ A¯≤ E¯≤/G j app j j œ œ 92 œ Œ ( n œ) ( n œ) œ œ ( n œ) œ) implied)œ ( n(Dm C G C G C Dm app app ‰ œœ. jœ œ œœ œ œ œ .œ œ œ œ‰(# œ œœ) œ œœ (œ œœ)œ œ #œœ œ) œœ . j œ œ œ œ . ? 6 c œ œ œ œœ œ œ J œ œ œ (œ œ & b b b 8 œ‰ œ ‰ œ‰ Œ . œ ‰ ‰ Œ. p œ dn œ dn dn ˙˙ œ J œœ ˙˙ œ œœ œœ J œ œ 272 j œ Œ œ (A¯≤-C-E¯≤) app (E¯≤-G-B¯≤) CHAPTER 10. NON-CHORD TONES 319 ?c œ C C: (C-E-G) I 275 G/F C/E (G-B-D-F) V I (C-E-G) V œ œ Ó ∑ G7 C (G-B-D-F) (C-E-G) I (F-A-C)(ii implied) F œ ii esc œ ( œ )œ œ (# œ) œ) œ 3 œ œ . ( œ )œ . ( esc ‰ ‰ œ‰ œ Œ Œ &4 YT: ep6rzB1Kx3U f œ œœ œ œœin C Major, Op. Figure 10.6.2 Friedrich Kuhlau,?Sonatina 55, No. 1, I (1823) œ 3 Œ œ œœ œœ Œ œ Œ Œ Œ &The4 double neighbor is sometimes confused with escape tones and appogœ app app giaturas. Be sure to keep track of chord tones when analyzing non-chord tones. Look at the next example and ask yourself how you would analyze the harmony and non-chord tones on beat 4 of the first measure. D 279 E¯≤ (D-F˜-A) (E¯≤-G-B¯≤) nt nt nt b 4 # œ(#app œ œ ) œ ( œ ) œ ( œ ) œ ( œ ) œ ( n œ) œ œ œ œ œ b & 4 œ (œ œ ) œ œ (œ œ ) œ dn dn œ œœ ? b b 44 œ # œœ Œ Œ Œ dn ? YT: PmO3Wlono6w Figure 10.6.3 W.A. Mozart, Piano Sonata K. 333, I (1784) In the next section we discuss the anticipation. 10.7 Anticipation An anticipation is a non-chord tone that anticipates the arrival of the next chord and is often found at cadences, as in the next example. œ. œ ˙ (E-G˜-B) app A¯≤: vi IV ( œ œ ) # œ ? # 4 Œ TONES CHAPTER # # 4 10.w NON-CHORD œ 2 œ. (A-C˜-E) E 14 B¯≤/FA 126 18 I œ ˙ Bsus4 B (B-E-F˜) (B-D˜-F˜) ˙ V 7 E/B B7 AmajB¯≤ ˙ 93 E nt(B¯≤-D-F) ant (F-A-C-E¯≤) # # # # (B¯≤-D-F) œ œ 3 (œ) (œ) esc œ œ œ œ ‰ & b 3 œ4. (œ) œ J œ (œ)˙ œ œ (œ) ˙ . &b 4 3 J pt pt E 20 w B7/A E/G˜ F7 F˜m/A # # # #home 3 & C 4 œœœ œœœ Œ (C-E-G) pt pt ?4# #Œ# # 43œ. œ. œ œ œ œŒœ œ &4 126 A che so ( ) ( ) E: IV ii/3rd - spi - ri the la li - - - ber brave. - œœ7 œœœ ‰ œj œœ (œ) œœ 7 œ œ Emœ ( ) œ ntFmaj ant (E-G-B-D) (F-A-C-E) œœ.) œ œœ œœ. œ œ œ.Œ œ. œ(esc w œ ≈ R of IVM7 I/5th V7 V7/7th I/3rd tà ˙. ˙. w˙˙ .. I C dn œ ) œ œ (# œ œ ) œ œ 4 œ ( œ œ ) œ œ (#YT: œ dnE6lV3nKg-nc &4 Figure 10.7.1 George Frideric Handel, Rinaldo, “Lascia ch’io pianga” (1711) (C-E-G) dn 24 Here is an example of an anticipation in popular music. 25 G A Dm F (G-B-D) pt pt (A-C˜-E) (D-F-A) (F-A-C) & b 44 œj œ œ ( ) ( ) ant nt ant j j ntœ j ant œ œ œ œ œ œ œ Ó ‰(# œ ) œ ( n œ ) ˙ œ œ ant I know where you're com &b 29 ( ) ( ) ∑ - ing from ( ) ( ) Call me ∑ YT: StKVS0eI85I on the line Call me ∑ Figure 10.7.2 Debbie Harry and Giorgio Moroder, “Call Me” (1980) Sometimes syncopation will lead to an anticipation of a note in a chord in the following measure, as occurs at the ends of bars 1, 2, and 3 of the “Call Me” example. 10.8 Pedal Point A pedal point is a note that is held through changing harmonies, starting as a chord tone before becoming a non-chord tone. Pedal points are often in the bass voice (the term “pedal” relates to the foot pedals on an organ). CHAPTER 10. NON-CHORD TONES 281 94 19 C7 F/C Dm7/C (C-E-G-B¯≤) (F-A-C) (D-F-A-C) & 44 ‰ ‰ ‰ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œ b œ œ œ œœœœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ≈ j ≈ j ≈ j ? 44 œ . œ œ. œ œ. œ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ C pedal (in bass) starts as consonant note (in the chord) 283 G7 (G-B-D-F) C (C-E-G) œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ( œ ) œ www & ‰ pt. ≈ ped. j ? (œ .) (œ ) (˙ ) ˙ (˙ ) w w ( ) ped. pt. pedal point (in bass) is now a non-chord tone ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ & ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑YT:∑ W4271Rm9TSU 285 Figure 10.8.1 Bach, J.S., Well-Tempered Clavier, Book I, Prelude 1 in C major BWV 846 (1722) 14 130 130 ?Here ∑ is∑ an∑ example ∑ ∑ ∑ from ∑ ∑ the∑ Romantic ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑era.∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ b & b 68 Gm D7 F˜o7 Gm (G-B¯-D) (D-F˜-A-C) (F˜-A-C-E¯) (G-B¯-D) b & b 68 ‰ p ben legato. œœ j œ œœ .. œ˙ .) V7 (i) ( œ ped. pt. B¯m7 E¯ ‰ #œ œ ped. pt. ( ) g: i œ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ J j œœ (bass note is still sounding) viio7 i Fm7 inc. nt. YT: jYgW5PhsQOE bbb 6 œ œ (œ ) b œ œ . beide” (1844) & 8 J No. œ2,. “Sie liebten sich Figure 10.8.2 Clara Schumann, Op. 13, J da - 132 œ #(œœ ). œ ? b b 68 œ˙ . œ 132 3-2 sus. œ bb b b 6 œœœ & 8 - - re - Por - œ œ œ œ J - - ta œ ( œ) J ( ) œ inc. nt. Ros - œœ .. œœ .. - - - sa œœ œœ .. œœ .. œœ 281 283 283 (C-E-G-B¯≤) (F-A-C) (D-F-A-C) ≈ ≈ j ≈ j ? 44 œj. œ ‰œ . œ ‰œ. œœ ˙ & 4 ˙‰ 10. NON-CHORD œ œ œ œ ˙ ˙ ˙ CHAPTER TONES 95 œ bœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœœ œœœœœœœœœœ (in bass) starts as consonant (in the chord) ≈ jC pedal ≈ note The Clara Schumann ≈example above also j jhas a suspension (“3-2 sus.”); ? 4 œ œ section.œ . œ suspensions inœ the . next 4G7 œare. discussed C˙ When a pedal point is in the bass, it is not necessary to specify ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ the inversion (G-B-D-F) (C-E-G) of the chord because the bass pedal point obscures the inversion. œ œ starts œ asœconsonant pedal (in bass) (in the chord) You‰ mightC also pointœ in note voice, as well as a “douœ œencounter œa pedal & œ œ œa higher œ ( œ ) œact aswww pedal points. ble pedal point,” where two notes (often a fifth apart) 7 G ped. pt. (G-B-D-F) C (C-E-G) ≈ j 10.9 ? Suspension œ & ˙‰ (œ œ.) œ (œ ) œ œ ( ˙œ ) œ œ ww œ œ œ w œ œ ˙ ) downbeats. A suspenSuspensions are accented non-chord ( ) tones occurring( on ( ) sion is approached by the same note and resolves down by step. A suspension ped. pt.pt. ped. is made up of a preparation, suspension, and resolution. Sometimes the prepa(in bass) is now a non-chord tone ration is tied pedal to thepoint suspension. ? ≈ j (œ .) ˙ G ( ) ( œ) (G-B-D) ped. pt. 285 285 (C-E-G) Preparation & 44 G˙˙˙ ?4 & 44 ˙ (˙ ) w w ( ) C Suspension Resolution œ˙ ) ˙C Prep. Sus. ˙˙˙ œ pedal point (in bass) is now a non-chord tone (no tie) ( (G-B-D) (C-E-G) ˙ (œ ) ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ Preparation ˙˙ ˙˙ Suspension Resolution C: V œ I Prep. œ˙ ) ˙ Res. Sus. Res. ( œ ˙ (œ ) ˙˙ (no tie) C: V œ I ˙ ˙ ˙ ?4 ˙ 4∑ ∑ ∑ ∑are∑classified ∑ ∑ ∑by∑numbers ∑ ∑ ∑(9-8,∑ 7-6, ∑ ∑4-3,∑ 2-3, ∑ ∑and∑ sometimes ∑ ∑ ∑ &Suspensions 287 Figure 10.9.1 Introductory Suspension example with and without tie 6-5) that distance of the suspended noteI and its resolution C: V C: Vspecify the interval I to the bass note 287 G∑ ∑ ∑C ∑ G/B C ∑ ∑ ? ∑G ∑ C∑ ∑ ∑ Dm/F ∑ ∑ C/E∑ ∑ C∑ ∑ sus. ∑ ∑ ∑ F∑ ∑sus. sus. & ˙˙˙ ?˙ C: V (œ ) œ ˙˙ sus. 7 - 6 9 - 8 ˙ I œ œœ ( œ) œ œœ ii/3rd I/3rd œœ œ œ I œœ œ œ 4 - 3 ( ) œ V œœ œ œœ œ œ ( ) I œ œ 2 - 3 sus. V/3rd 6 - 5 ˙˙ ˙ ( ) IV I ˙ œ˙ œ ˙ ˙ Figure 10.9.2 Examples of the 9-8, 7-6, 4-3, 2-3, and 6-5 suspensions In the example above, the notes in the 4-3 suspension are an 11th and 10th higher than the bass. Reduce all intervals larger than an octave to the numbers 7-6, 4-3, and 6-5. Here is an example with a 4-3 suspension. 292 ? # 44 ( ) œ (œ ) œ G D/F˜ D œ pt # pt 2-3 œ œ sus. (œ ) œ & 44 œœ10. NON-CHORD CHAPTER TONES œ œ œ G: I V/3rd 294 296 296 D œ œ I V ˙ ) pt œœ ( œ ) ˙˙ V 96 pt ˙ (œ ) œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ( ) œ œ œ œ œ ( ) ? # 44 ( ) œ ( œ ) sus. pt ˙ nt pt 4œ - 3 bb b œ4 W & bb 2 ww 2 - 3 pt (Wœ ) n œ ( œ ) pt œ œ ( œ ) œ ( œ ) ∑ w sus. nW W G: I V/3rd V I V π E¯≤m7 F ? b b 4 ∑ bbb 2 Wsus. w pt nt pt 4 - 3 W bb b 4 W w ( œ ) n œ (œ ) œ œ (œ ) œ (œ ) & bb 2 ww W ∑ w nW W 7 F˜m G/B Em A D Em/G π sus. sus. 9 - 8 7 - 6 nt ? b b b 42 ∑ 7 - 6 nt pt YT: b8G9vRqq3RI b b ( œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ( ) œw(œ)œAdagio œ œ forœWStrings œ (œ )œ(1936) # 3 œ Samuel œ œ œ œ ( œ˙ )) œœ ((œœ ))œœ ˙ Figure# 10.9.3 Barber, œ œ ˙ & 2 œ œ œW w ˙ Here is an example with 7-6Œand 9-8 suspensions. nt Œ ˙ F˜m G/B Em A7 D Em/G ? # # 32 œ œ œ ˙sus. Œ œ œ œ ˙ œ œ Œ œ sus.˙97 -- 86 ntŒ 7 - 6 nt pt ) œ œ œ œ (IVœ˙ )/3rdœ (œ)œ iiœ œ œ Vœ7 (œ )œ œI œœ œœ œœ ((iiœœ/3rd )œ # # D: œ ) œ (œ iii 3 œ œ (œ ) œ ˙ œ ˙ & 2 œ œ ˙ Œ nt Œ ˙ 300 ? # # 32 ∑ œ œ ∑œ ˙ ∑ Œ œ∑ œ œ ∑ ˙ ∑ Œ œ ∑ œ œ ∑ ˙ ∑ Œ & pt 294 ( G ? ## D: iii ∑ E¯≤m7 ∑ IV/3rd ∑ F ii ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ V7 pt ∑ I ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ii/3rd ∑ # # ∑ ∑ ∑ YT: ∑HawWrnUGH_0 ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ & Figure 10.9.4 George Frideric Handel, Suite No. 2 in D Major, HWV 349: 300 II. Alla Hornpipe (1717) ? ## ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ The 2-3 suspension is the “bass suspension” and is measured against an upper voice. Again, you may encounter the literal intervals 10-9 but should label the suspension as 2-3. G: I V/3rd V I E¯≤m7 294 20 292 b & b b b b G42 # 4 œ & 4 œ ? bb 4 bbb 2 F˜m 296 300 F sus. 4 - 3 CHAPTER 10. NON-CHORD TONES W w ∑ pt ww D/F˜ π ( œ ) œ œ œ ∑ œ pt w œ œ ? # 44 œ ( ) œ w( œœ ) œ œ G/B V nt 97 œ ) n œ (œ ) œ œ ( œ ) œ ( œ ) W D W nW G œ œ œœ ( œ ) ˙˙ œ œ pt W pt œœ Wœ œœ (( œœ )) œœ œ ˙˙ ( ) pt pt ( D ptD A7 2 - 3Em pt sus. sus. 7 - 6 nt V/3rd V Em/G sus. 9 - 8 # # 3 œœ œ œœ ( œ˙ ) œ (œ)œ œœ œ œ œ (œ )œ œ œœ œœ œœ (( œœ˙ )) œœ ((œœ ))œœ ˙ & 2 œ œ œ Œ ˙ nt Œ 294 ˙ # YT: VKNcvMcGlvI ∑ ∑ Bach, ∑ J.S., ∑˙ Chorale ∑ ∑ 238, ∑ “Liebster ∑ ∑ Jesu, ∑ ∑wir ∑sind ∑hier,”∑ BWV ∑ & 10.9.5 Figure œ œ ˙ œ œ ˙ ? ## 3 œ Œ œ Œ œ œ œ Œ 373 2 When a chord is inverted, you will sometimes encounter non-standard sus/3rd3-2. ii ? # numbers pension ∑D: iii∑ like ∑ 5-4∑IVor ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ V∑7 ∑ I ∑ ∑ ∑ ii/3rd∑ ∑ G: I Ipt G7/F C/G sus. 5 - & ˙˙˙ œ˙ ˙ ( ) ? ˙ œ sus. 3 - ˙˙ ˙ ˙ ( ˙ V7/7th C: I/5th G7/F F 4 V 7 - 6 nt œ˙ ) ˙ 2 œ ˙ V7/7th C: IV Figure 10.9.6 Non-standard suspension numbers because of inverted chords You will sometimes encounter decorations of suspensions where other notes occur before the resolution, as in the following example. 324 D7/C & b 43 # œœ (œ) ˙˙ pt pt ? b 43 n œœ . (œ) # ˙(b œ ) œ œ J app &b A7 Gm/B¯≤ sus. œ œ (œ ) œ (œ ) (œ ) œ œ œ (# œ ) # œœ œœ ret. ( ) res. œ œ œ œ app nt œœ 327 YT: fTwkVsECg9w Figure 10.9.7 Bach, J.S., French Suite No. 1 in D Minor, BWV 812, Sarabande (1722) ?Theb “ret.” in the tenor part in the second measure is a retardation, which &b 348 23 21 B¯≤7 Cm/B¯≤ B¯≤7 Cm/B¯≤ CHAPTER 10. NON-CHORD TONES 302 Ÿapp œ œ (œ) œ (œ ) œ . œ ( ) section. is & covered b b c inœ the®œnext J pt 9-8 B¯≤ Aø7 B¯≤ Aø7 /B¯≤ /B¯≤ F7 /B¯≤ B¯≤ Ÿ œ pt œ . ret. j ®œ. œ ( ) œ (œ ) œ œ́ ≈ œ . œ œ́ ≈ œ (œœœ) œœ ‰ œ R R (œ ) ( ) 98 app j ≈ œ œœ bb c ? œœ œ meaning œ œ œœ ‰ œ bœ œ œ œ ( # œ ) œ non-chord œ œ œœtone, A& retardation œ œœ œœ œ œœ it occurs on a œ˙ œ is usuallyœ anœ˙accented app 10.10 Retardation 4 9 - 3 sus. (8) downbeat. A retardation is approached by the same note and resolves up by step. G/B 304 Am/C # 3 œ ( œ) œ ( # œ ) œ œ œ œ. & 4 ≈ app app app G nt œ (œœ) œ ( œ) œ ((œœ)) œ 9 - 8 sus. ret. 4 - 3 sus. œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ (œ˙ ) œ œ ? # 43 œ œ œ œ G: I/3rd D7 G/D ii/3rd I/5th V7 Œ .. Œ .. I # Figure Piano Sonata in C major, K. ∑ ∑ 545, II (1788) & 10.10.1 W.A. Mozart, YT: hSqwR_dsecg 307 Classical composers like Mozart often used retardations and suspensions at cadences in slow movements. ?# ∑ 10.11 Incomplete Neighbor ∑ Because composers are notorious for “breaking the rules,” you will encounter examples in the real world that either defy explanation or have multiple valid explanations. One “utility” non-chord tone is the incomplete neighbor. b b 8 œ˙ . œ ( ( ) ped. pt. CHAPTER g: 10. i NON-CHORD V7TONES i B¯≤m7 E¯≤ 132 b œ & b b b 68 da - 132 œœ bb b b 6 œœ & 8 - œ œ J - re - Por - œ œ œ œ J œ J inc. nt. ( ) - - ta œ ( œ) J ( ) œ˙ .) ped. pt. (bass note is still sounding) viio7 i 99 Fm7 œ. Ros - œœ .. œœ .. - - œ. - sa œœ .. œœ .. œ œœ œœœ ? b b b 68 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ ≈ b œ œ A¯≤: V inc. nt. ii7 vi7 b ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ & b b b ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑YT:∑ Sf-tjXevlyQ 134 Figure 10.11.1 Giacomo Puccini, Gianni Schicchi, “O mio babbino caro” 134 (1918) b b ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ &Youb bmay∑ also find incomplete double neighbor figures, especially in late Romantic music and jazz. Keep an open mind when analyzing music. ? b b b Adding 10.12 ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ Tones ∑ ∑ ∑ to ∑ ∑a ∑Chord ∑ ∑ ∑ Pro∑ ∑ b ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ Non-Chord gression Here are ideas for how to add non-chord tones (or “embellishments”) to the melody or inner voice part of a chord progression: 1. Repeated note: add upper or lower neighbor 2. Step down: (a) Add a suspension by delaying the resolution of the note (b) Add an escape tone by moving by step in the opposite direction of the original stepwise movement, then leap (c) Add a double neighbor (d) Add a chromatic passing tone (e) Add an anticipation 3. Step up: (a) Add retardation by delaying resolution of the note (b) Add a double neighbor (c) Add a chromatic passing tone (d) Add an anticipation (e) Add an appoggiatura by leaping one step beyond the note of resolution, placing the appogiatura on the beat, displacing the note of resolution to occur after the beat app 304 G/B Am/C G/D Am/C TONES G/D CHAPTERG/B 10. NON-CHORD # 3 œœ (œ) œ (# œ ) œ œ & # 43 of≈ 3rd:(œ) œ (# œ ) œ œ œ œ . 4. Leap œ œ. & 4 ≈ app app D7 app D7 nt app nt G G 100 œœ9 - œ8 sus. Œ .. œœ œ Œ .. (a) Fill inapp the 3rd with a passing tone 4 - 3 sus. ret. app œ œ œ (b) Add an appoggiatura by leaping one step beyond ( 4the ) - note œ3 sus.of resoœ œ œ œonœtheœ beat, œ displacing œ œplacing œ œtheœ appogiatura ˙ ? # 43 lution, œ œ œ œ œ œ œ (œ˙ ) œ the Œnote ..of œ œ œto occurœ after œ ? # 43 resolution œ the œ beat œ Œ .. œ œ œ 304 œ (œœ) œ ( œ) œ œ (œœ) œ ( œ) œ 9 - 8 sus. ( ) ( ) (ret. ) ( ) G: Iof /3rd4th or larger: ii/3rddo not embellish I/5th V7 now) I 5. Leaps (for G: I/3rd ii/3rd I/5th V7 I Here is a basic framework with all possibilities labeled. # &# & 44 44 G G ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙ ? # 4 ˙˙ ? # 44 ˙ 4 307 307 step down step step down down step down repeated note repeated note leap of 4th leap of 4th D D ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ step down step down step down leap of 3rd leap stepofup3rd step up G: I V G: I V Here is one possible solution: G D esc. G D # &# & 309 309 ?# ?# 4 44 4 œ˙ œ˙ œ 44 ˙œ 44 ˙ G: I G: I œ (œ ) (esc. ) œ ( œ) nt ( nt) ˙(œ ) œ ˙(œ4-3) sus œ œ œ˙ ˙ 4-3 sus ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ C C repeated note repeated note repeated note step up step up leap of 3rd leap of 3rd vi vi Em 4-3 sus Em ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ IV IV C nt C œ˙4-3 sus œ (œnt) ˙˙ (œ ) œ (œ ) ˙˙ ˙ ( ) pt œ (œ ) œ (œ ) pt V V Em Em ˙œ ˙œ vi vi œ œ (œ ) (œ˙) œ (œ ) ˙ pt app (app ) pt œ œ IV IV Notice that, when non-chord tones are added to different voices on the same beat, consonant intervals (3rds, 5ths, 6ths, or 8ves) are made. If consonant intervals can’t be made, the voices are staggered rhythmically (as occurs on beats 3 and 4 in measure one of the example above). 10.13 Practice Exercises 1. Fill in the blanks in the following table. Non-Chord Tone Type Approached by same tone step leap 2. Left by step up leap in opposite direction step in same direction Analyze the harmonies with lead-sheet symbols above the staff and Roman numerals below. Add the following non-chord tones: two suspensions, one passing tone, and one appoggiatura. Do not add non-chord tones to the bass. CHAPTER 10. NON-CHORD TONES 101 22 b & b 44 ˙˙ Lead-sheet: _____ _____ ? b b 44 ˙ ˙ 311 Rom. num.: b & b 44 313 3. 139 139 ˙ ˙ ˙˙ ˙ ˙ _____ _____ _____ ? b b 44 315 317 ˙˙ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ above the_____ Lead-sheet:the Analyze harmonies with lead-sheet symbols staff and Roman numerals4 below, then analyze the non-chord tones. &b 4 ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ In the Name ˙ Dozier, Eddie˙ Holland, “Stop! (a) Brian˙Holland, Lamont of Love” (1965) 16 ˙ ? b 44 ˙ _____ ˙_____ 4 Œ œ ‰ œj œ ( œ .) j &_____ 4 œ ˙ _____ Rom. num.: 44 &b & 4 4 Œ œœ ‰ œœj œœ œ œ œ Stop! in the _____ name ( Œ œ) œ œ _____ ( of love be - fore you j œ .) œ ˙ œœ .. œœ ˙˙ ˙ Fmaj7 _____ Œ (œ ) œ œœ œœ œœœ j œ. œ ˙ _____ ( ) break ( my heart j œœ ..) œœ ˙˙ œ. œ ˙ œœ ? ? 4 œœ œœ œœ œœ b 4 44 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ( ) C C: _____G 319 C _____G C (Dm implied) _____ ____ _____ Dm I (ii implied) ii œ j∑œ œ œ œ ∑ œ . j œ∑œ œ œ œ∑. œ œ ∑(# œ œ ) œ ∑œ(œ œ )œ œ∑(# œ œ ) c ∑œ . 4 œ . &4& œ œ J p YT: dn dn dn 143 ˙˙ œœ œœ œœ œœ ˙˙ œœ tuei1XUAGRo ∑ Dichterliebe, ∑ ∑ Op. ∑ c ∑œ ? 44Robert &œ ∑Schumann, Ó ∑48, 1. ∑“Im ∑wunderschönen (b) 143 Monat Mai” (1840) ? C: I ∑ V ∑ I ∑ V ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ 151 ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ 151 & ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ? ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ & 15 CHAPTER 10. NON-CHORD TONES ## 2 & # 4 134 C˜7 ∑ Bm/D # # # 2 ≈ (œ .) œ œ ( ) & 4 œ œ 134 œ ? # # # 42 œ f ˜: V 137 ## & # ( œJ .) Bm/D wun - 137 ## & # (œ ) 102 C˜7 ∑ Œ (œ ) œ #œ (œ ) œ œ œ _____ _____ œ œ œR œr œr ( ) R R œ ? ### œ œ - der - schö - nen Mo - nat œ œœ œ œ ( œ) j ≈ œ œ œ A: _____ _____ YT: L-Nkm8cBLgE Click here to download the homework. œ œJ _____ œ ≈ (œ ) œ #œ œ œ œ œ ‰ Mai, ( œœ .) œœ œ œJ _____ ≈ œ R Im #œ œ œ œ œ( ) œ _____ - ‰ ≈ œ R als œ œ (œ ) œ œ œ œ J ≈ œR Chapter 11 Melodic Analysis We will divide analysis of melodies into motives (which can be broken into fragments) and phrases (which can be broken into subphrases) in order to understand the construction of melodies. We will discuss periods and sentences in another chapter. 11.1 Motive A motive (or motif) is the smallest identifiable melodic idea in music. However, we will find times when it will be necessary to discuss a smaller fragment 21 (called a “germ” by some authors) from a motive. In the following example from the first movement of Beethoven’s Symphony No. 1, we find four motives within the first four measures of the primary theme. mot. 1 mot. 2 & C œœœœ ˙. ƒ 376 & 44 œ 382 œ. œ ˙. S œ. œ. œ œ œ . œ œ. œ. œ. œ. œ. œ. œ. œ. œ. . . mot. 3 mot. 2 mot. 3 mot. 4 mot. 1 (rhy. ch.) ‰ # œj œ œ YT:œ tFafjC-180E ‰ œj ‰ # œj œ œ œ mot. 1 Figure 11.1.1 Ludwig van Beethoven, Symphony rhythmic No. 1, Op. 21, I, Motives in Primary Theme (1800) change (same) 384 386 Later in the movement we find Beethoven extracting motives from this four-measure phrase sequences. mot.in 1 order to develop them through mot. 1 (inv.) Here is development of motive 1. & œ œ œ œ œ œ œ & œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ & 387 388 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ & 44 #œ œ bœ mot. 1 œ 103 7 illustration of mirror inversion œ bœ œ #œ mot. 1 (ret.) CHAPTER 11. MELODIC ANALYSIS 330 330 24 24 334 334 337 337 340 104 ˙˙ # ˙˙ ww # ww ww b ˙˙ ˙˙ w w & w w w w p œ œ œœ œ Œ Œ œœœ ? Ó Œ œ bœ œ œ œ Œ Ó Ó Œ œ cresc. p cresc. ww b ˙ # wwn ˙ ˙˙ ˙˙˙ # #˙˙˙˙˙ w ww b ˙˙˙ ww˙˙ ˙˙ ˙ ˙˙˙ & b˙˙˙˙ww b ˙˙˙ & w ˙ ˙ cresc. p œ œ œœ œ ? Ó Œ œ b œœœbœ œœ œŒ b Óœ Ó Œœ œ Œ Œ œœ œœ œœ œ ? œ œ Œ Œ Œ Œ œ Œ Œ cresc. œ p œ cresc. ˙˙ # ˙˙ b ˙˙ n ˙˙ ˙˙ √˙˙˙ b ˙ ˙˙ œ ˙˙ ˙ b ˙˙ ˙ ˙˙ # ˙ & ˙˙ ˙ œœ ˙˙ ˙˙ bcresc. ˙˙ & ˙˙˙ œ ˙ ˙ œ ˙ b œ œ œ bœ ƒ œ ? œ b œ Œ Œ œ œ œ Œ Œœ œ œœ œœœ œœ œ œ Œ Œ œ œœ œ ? œœ Œ Œ œœœ œ ƒ √ œœ ˙˙ # ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙ b œœ ˙ ˙ ˙ 340 & ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙ ˙ ƒ YT: tFafjC-180E & œ b œ œ œ œ No. œ1, œI, development œ ? œ 11.1.2 œ œ œ œ ofœ motive Figure Symphony Œ Beethoven, Œ œ œ œ1 Here is development of motive 2 ƒ ? Œ bœ. œ bœ Ó ∑ Œ bœ. œ bœ Œ Œ Ó & p b˙. Ó Œ bœ. œ bœ bœ. œ bœ ? Œ Ó œ bœ Œ bœ. Œ 344 & YT: tFafjC-180E Figure 11.1.3 Beethoven, Symphony No. 1, I, development of motive 2 ? Here is development of motives 2 and 3 together. CHAPTER 11. MELODIC ANALYSIS ˙. & ˙˙ .. f . #˙ ? #˙. 344 348 344 348 352 356 . . . . . . . . œ.#œ œ œ œ #œ œ œ œ œ Œ ∑ p Œ ∑ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . œ . # œ œœ œœ œ # œ œœ œœ œ œ œŒ . # œ œ # œ∑ œœ Œp ∑ ∑ pŒ Œ . . . .∑ . . . . œ.#œ œ œ œ #œ œ œ œ œ 105 œ œ # œœ pœ. Œ Ó b ˙˙ œœ ˙ œ œœ b ˙˙ œ #˙ 25 ∑ œœ œ . Œ œ Œ #œ Œ œ Œ ˙. œ Œ Ó ∑ b ˙ b ˙ œœœ ˙Œ Ó œœ œœ ˙ ∑ œœ & ˙˙ .. # œœ b˙ œœ œœ b# ˙ ˙ œœœ œ ˙ œ œ ˙ & f ˙˙ ... #œ ˙ œ œ #˙ œ. pœ.. #˙. .Œ ? #f˙ . p Œ œ Œ #œ Œ œ œ ? ˙. Œ œ Œ #œ Œ œ Œ #˙. ˙. œ Œ Ó b˙ b ˙ ∑ œ ˙ œ œ œ . œœ œœ # ˙˙ œœ & ˙˙ .. 352 # œœ ˙˙ Œ ∑ YT: ∑ ∑ tFafjC-180Ep. ∑ ∑ . & p Figuref 11.1.4 Beethoven, Symphony No. 1, œI, development of motives 2 and 3 ? ˙. Œ ∑ Œ œ Œ #œ Œ œ Œ excerpt leads directly into the next, which features develop. ?The# ˙previous ∑ 4. ∑ ∑ ∑ ment of motive . ˙. . . œ. œ w bœ b œ ∑ œ œ œ & b ˙˙ 356 ˙˙ b ˙˙ ˙˙ b ˙˙ ˙˙ b œœ œ œ b œœ ∑ @˙ ∑@˙ ∑@ @ @ ∑ @ & @˙ ∑ @˙ ∑ @˙ ∑ @˙ . . . . . . p . . . œ œ œ œ bœ nœ ? œ b œ œ œ œœ Œ Ó œ b œ ∑ œ b œ b œ ∑ œ ? ∑b œ œ œ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ . œ. . . ˙. . . œ. œ w bœ b œ Œ Ó b œ œ œ œ bœ 363 b ˙ ˙ b œ & b ˙˙˙ ∑ ˙˙˙ ∑ b ˙˙˙ ∑ ˙˙˙ ˙ ˙ œ ∑ ˙ ∑˙ ∑ @œ @œ ∑@œ & @ @ @ @ @ @ @ . . . . . . . . œ œ œ œ bœ nœ . œ. œ . œ b œ ? œ ∑ œ œ∑ œ Œ∑ Ó œ b œ ∑ ∑ ∑œ b œ b œ ∑ œ b œ œ. ∑ YT: tFafjC-180E In the next section, we will look at some of the various ways one can alter a melody Figure 11.1.5 Beethoven, Symphony No. 1, I, development of motive 4 25 CHAPTER 11. MELODIC ANALYSIS 106 11.2 Melodic Alteration While there are more than a dozen ways to alter a melody, we will focus on seven methods of basic melodic alteration at this point of the text. 11.2.1 Inversion 26 Inversion as applied to music means an idea is exactly upside-down or “mirrored” across a horizontal plane, like mountains reflected in a lake. First, listen to the following example. 360 & c ≈ ?c Ó m œœœœœœœœœ œ œ œ m œ œ œ œ œœœœœœœ ≈ œ œ ≈ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ Œ œœœœœ 21 œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ œœœœœœœœœœœ & œ #œ œ œ œ 362 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ # œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ. œ. &?C œ œ œœ œ ˙ . œ œ . œ ˙ . œ . œ œ. œ. œ. œ. œ. œ. œ. œ. œ. . . ƒ S mot. 1 376 mot. 2 mot. 2 mot. 3 mot. 3 mot. 4 mot. 1 (rhy. ch.) ∑ ‰ ∑ j ‰ ∑ j ∑ &44 œ∑ ‰ ∑# œj œ ∑ œ YT:œ E8EvUmq0Zao œ œ œ œ ∑ & # œ Figure 11.2.1 Bach, Invention No. 1 in C Major, BWV 772 (1723) 382 mot. 1 364 ? ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ rhythmic ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ The first seven notes in measure 1 are change inverted in measure 3, shown in the following example. (same) 384 386 mot. 1 &372 œ ∑œ œ ∑œ œ œ∑ œ & ? 387 ∑ ∑ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ mot. 1 (inv.) ∑ & œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ∑ œ ∑ ∑ ∑ œ œ œ œ œ œ & ∑ ∑ of ∑illustration inversion∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ & ∑ Melodic inversion can be real (where every interval is exactly the same qual& or tonal (where the intervals abide by the scale or key). For the majority ity) of this text, we will encounter tonal inversion until we discuss techniques of ? and∑21st-century 20th∑ music in∑ the final∑chapters of∑ this text.∑ ∑ 379 Figure 11.2.2 Melodic inversion in Invention No. 1 in C Major by J.S. Bach 388 413 & & 44 Œ & w ≈ R CHAPTER 11. MELODIC ANALYSIS A CG 24 25 w Dm 107 F (D-F-A) (F-A-C) dn œ œ ) œ œ 4 j( œ œ ) œ œjœ (œ# jœœ œjœ ) œ œœ œ Ó(# œ ‰ # œnt œ n œ ant ˙ œ œ & b4 44œ change Intervallic œ exact than inversion. With intervallic change, the œ œis less (C-E-G) (G-B-D) (A-C˜-E) 11.2.2 Intervallic Change ant dn ptdn pt nt ant ant œ rhythm is generally intact and the motive relates to a previous iteration, but ( ) I know where you're com - ing some of the intervals are different. G 29 25 mot. 1 (G-B-D) m3 ant pt pt ( ) ( ) ( ) ( ) ( ) from Call me 33 ) on the line Call me Dm (A-C˜-E) ( ) ( ) ( ) ( ) ( ) ( ) ( ) andonI the forline - get to do Call me Call me mot. 1 (int. ch.) P4 mot. 1 m3 YT: v9V98ECtsfY b b 4 ∑j j ∑ œ œ ˙ . ∑ b ∑ œ œ œ Ó ∑of‰You” V Figure 11.2.3 4 œ Rayœ Noble, “The˙ .Very∑ Thought œ œ(1934) œ 33 360 ( mot. 1 (int. ch.) F P4 (D-F-A) (F-A-C) A - y you're thought I The knowver where com of- you ing from 26 ) b b b4 44 j œj œ œ œ œj œ œj˙œ.ntœj œ œantÓœant Ó ‰ ‰œ#jœntœ œœn œ antœ ˙œ ˙œ. œ V b & 4 œ œ œ œ ( ) 29 ( The nextTheexample twoofintervals changed, one of ver - y has thought you andwhich I for -includes get to do a change in contour. mot. 1 (int. ch.) m œ mœ œ M2 ↑ œ œ œ œ œ m3↓ c ≈ œ œ œ &# # # # œ œ œ œœœ œœ œ œœ œ œ nœœ œ œ œ œœ n œ Œ ‰ Œ Ó Œ ‰J Œ Ó V J œœœœœ œ so don't for - get œ itœ ? c Ó I'm not in love œ œ œ ≈ œ œ œ œ ≈ œ Œ mot. 1 362 & STugQ0X1NoI œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œYT: œœœœ œœœœœœœœœœœ œ #œ œ œ œ Figure 11.2.4 Eric Stewart and Graham Gouldman, “I’m Not In Love” (1975) œ œ œ œ œ œ œ #œ œ Diminution 11.2.3 œand ? œ Augmentation œ œ œ œ Augmentation usually refers to an exact doubling of the duration of every rhythmic value in a motive or phrase. 364 œ œ œœœœœ œ œœœ mot. 1 inv. mot. 1 & ≈ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ? ∑ mot. 1 inv. œœœœœ œœœœœœœœœœœ œ œ œ #œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ frag. a aug. frag. a mot. 1 inv. mot. 1 inv. frag. a aug. œ œ œ #œ œ œ œ frag. a aug. & ext. ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ YT: ∑ E8EvUmq0Zao ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ & Figure 11.2.5 Augmentation of fragment “a” in Invention No. 1 by J.S. Bach 367 We will discuss extension and fragmentation of motives later in this chapter. Diminution is the opposite of augmentation and usually refers to the exact halving of the duration of every rhythmic value in a motive or phrase. ? ∑ 379 & ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ CHAPTER 11. MELODIC ANALYSIS 108 Score However, diminution can also refer to the use of shorter rhythmic values, as in the following example. mot. 1 U w. ? 6 w. 4 ƒ ?6 4 ?6 4 bU w. bw. U w. U w. w. (Trumpets & Trombones) ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ w. w. w. Ó ˙ b ˙ ˙˙ w . ˙ b˙ w. ƒ (Tubas) ∑ ∑ mot. 1 (dim.) 2 ∑ ∑ ∑ ˙. œ Œ Œ ˙. œ 2 ∑ mot. 1 (dim.) Ó. bœ œ œ œ ƒ 4 ∑ (Timpani) 8 8 8 ? ∑ ? ? ? ? 15 ? 15 ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ YT: aDFGmiXnLjU ∑ mot. 1 & ∑ C œ œ œ œ ∑˙ . ƒ ∑ mot. 2 11.2.4 Rhythmic Change ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ 21 Figure 11.2.6 Diminution of the first four notes in “Uranus” from The Planets, Op. 32, by Gustav Holst (1916) ∑ 376 15 ∑ ∑ œ. œ ˙. S ∑ ∑ ∑ . . ∑œ œ œ œ ∑ œ œ œ. œ∑ œ œ . œ . . œ. œ. . . œ. œ. . . mot. 2 mot. 3 mot. 3 mot. 4 Similar to the inexact nature of intervallic change, label a motive as having rhythmic change when some but not all rhythmic values of the motive are varied. 382 ∑ ∑ ∑ & 44 œ 384 ∑ ∑ & ∑ mot. 1 ‰ ∑# œj œ ∑œ œ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ mot. 1 (rhy. ch.) ∑ ‰ j ∑‰ j ∑ ∑ œ #œ œ œ œ ∑ ∑ rhythmic change YT: vCadcBR95oU ∑ ∑(same) ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ Figure 11.2.7 Hurby Azor and Ray Davies, “Push It” (1987) Imagine the effect if there had been no rhythmic change and the first measure was merely repeated. In the next example, from Beethoven’s “Pathétique” sonata, motive 1 has dotted rhythms during the introduction of the piece. 392 & 399 & 406 & 413 ? 364 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ frag. a aug. frag. a ∑ frag. a aug. œ œ œœœœœ œ œœœ œ CHAPTERmot. 11.1 MELODIC ANALYSIS mot. 1 inv. mot. 1 inv. & ≈ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ 367 & b b bfrag.c a mot. 1 œ œ #œ œ œ œ frag. a aug. & ext. mot. 1 inv. mot. 1 inv.109 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œmot. œ œ1œ œ œ œ œ œ #œ j ‰frag. a aug. œœœ œ œ n œœœ œ œ Í œ ≈ . Kr œ J œ j a .aug. & ext. ‰ œ œ œ œ œœœ frag. œ .. œ œ . œ œ œœ œ œ. #œœ œ œ. œ œœ œ œ œ . œœ n œœ .. œœ n œœœœ ∑ 21 Í . œ œ œ . œ œ œ ≈ . œ ? b b c œœœ œœœ ... œœ œœ .. œœ # œ b œœ œœ . J RÔ mot. 1 œ œ .. mot. 1 mot. 2 mot. 4j mot. 2 mot. 3 mot. 3 b b b mot. c 1 j ‰ ‰ œ œ . & œ œ œ œ . 369 œœ .. œœ n œœœ œœ œœ œœ .. œœ œœ .. œœ œœ œœœœ. œ. . œ œ œ n n C & b b œ œ œ∑œ ˙ . ∑ ∑ ˙ . ∑ ∑ œ œ ∑ œ œ∑ ∑œ œ ∑œ. ∑ & b Í œ. œ œ . œ . K. œ.Íœœ. . .œ .œ. œœ. . . ƒ S YT: SrcOcKYQX3c œ . œ œ œ ≈ . œ ? b b c œœœ œœœ ... œœ œœ .. œœ # œ œJ ≈ . r b œ œ œ J (1799) RÔ Figure 11.2.8œ Beethoven, 13, I, Introduction ... 1 Pathétique Sonata, Op.mot. œœmot. 1 (rhy. ch.) œ ?In bthe b b development ∑ ∑ section, ∑ Beethoven ∑ ∑ changes ∑ j the∑rhythm∑ of motive ∑ 1 then ∑ j j 4 abbreviates it in the following measure when it is sequenced up a step. ‰ #œ œ œ œ ‰ œ ‰ #œ œ œ œ &4 œ ? 367 376 382 frag. a aug. œ ´ œ´ ˙ # œ # œ œ œ œ & C Œ œmot.Œ 1 Œ œ # œ œ ˙ # œ œ œ p ÿ f &? œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œœœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œC œ œ rhythmic mot. 1 (rhy.change ch.) 369 384 386 387 # œ´ Œ mot. 1Œ (inv.) #œ œ œ œœ œ œœ bœ œ´ œ´ œ´ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ œ œ illustration of & œ œ œ œ œ œ œ mirror inversion YT: œ œSrcOcKYQX3c œ œ œ œ œ Figure 11.2.9 Beethoven, & Pathétique Sonata, Op. 13, I, development section # œ œ means œ b œ the b œ œ or#embelœ notes in a motive Ornamentation 7 can be œornamented lished & 44 with passing tones, neighbor tones, and the other non-chords tones we mot. 1 11.2.5 Ornamentation 388 mot. 1 (rhy. ch.) (abbrev.) (same) mot. 1 (ret.) studied in the previous chapter. Here is an example of the ornamentation of a 4-note motive. 397 ## & # # # 44 400 & #### # mot. 1 œ. Œ œ . œ œ mot. 1 (orn.) œ. Œ œ œ ‹ œ œ. œ. œ œ œ nt nt YT: s6fPN5aQVDI Figure 11.2.10 Stevie Wonder, “Sir Duke” (1976) mot. 1 (orn. & ext.) n œ . œ. n œ œ œ œ œ . n œ. œ. . . nt j ‰ #Cœj œœœ œ œ ‰ œ ‰ # œj œ œ œ œ. œ. & œ œœ ˙. œ ˙ . œ . œ œ. œ. œ œ. œ. œ. œ œ. œ. œ. . rhythmic œ . . 110. CHAPTER 11. MELODIC ANALYSIS change ƒ S (same) 4 &4 œ 11.2.6 Extension mot. 1 382 mot. 1 (rhy. ch.) œ œ œ œ œ œj œ j j ‰ œ ‰ #œ œ œ œ & œ cœ œ œ œ‰ #œœ œ œ œ œ œ & 384 mot. 1 mot. 1 (inv.) Extension of a motive needs little explanation: additional material is added to the end of a motive upon its repetition or reoccurrence at a later point in a piece. Refer to the “Sir Duke” example directly above and to therhythmic final measure of change the J.S. Bach Invention in C Major example in the section on augmentation. 386 & (same) œ œ œ œ œ œ œ illustration of 11.2.7 Retrograde inversion mot. 1 (inv.) 1 œ œ mot. œ œ œ œ œ 384 While rare in tonal music, it is worth mentioning retrograde, œ which œ isœ an œ œ œ exact reversing of the& order of notes, as can be seen in the following example 387 & œ œ œ œ œ œ œ from popular music. #œ 386 388 387 & 44 œ bœ mot. 1 œ 7 œ #œ mot. 1 (ret.) & œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ & 397 & œ bœ œ illustration of mirror inversion YT: ECVbVwEzY2E #œ œ bœ œ bœ Figure 11.2.11 Melodic Retrograde mot. 1 in “Toxic” by Cathy Dennis, Christian Karlsson, Pontus Winnberg, Henrik Jonback (2003) 388 &c œ 7 We will not consider transposition of a motive (also known as a sequence) to be a motivic alteration worth labeling since it is so common. œ #œ mot. 1 (ret.) 11.3 Fragment #### 1 smallest identifiable mot. 1 melodic (orn.) idea in a While 397 the motive is usually definedmot. as the composition, “compound” motives can be broken into fragments (sometimes called “germs”). In J.S. Bach’s Invention 1 in C Major I, the opening 7-note compound motive can be divided into two overlapping four-note fragments that nt can each nt be developed independently. & 400 # c œ. Œ œ . œ œ mot. 1 œ. Œ œ œ ‹ œ œ. œ. œ œ œ n œ . œ. n œ œ œ œ œ . n œ. œ. . . nt mot. 2 & c ≈ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ frag. a mot. 1 (orn. & ext.) frag. b Figure 11.3.1 Fragmentation of motive 1 in C Major Invention Here again is the example of development (in augmentation) of fragment “a.” œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ? œ œ #œ œ œ œ CHAPTER 11. MELODIC ANALYSIS 364 œ œ œœœœœ œ œœœ mot. 1 inv. mot. 1 & ≈ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ? frag. a aug. ∑ 111 mot. 1 inv. œœœœœ œœœœœœœœœœœ œ œ œ #œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ frag. a mot. 1 inv. mot. 1 inv. œ frag. a aug. œ œ œ #œ œ œ œ frag. a aug. & ext. ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ YT: ∑ E8EvUmq0Zao ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ & Figure 11.3.2 Development of fragment “a” in Invention 1 367 ∑ ∑ In the following example Bach develops an inversion of fragment “b” leading into a cadence in G major. 374 ? ∑ &c œœ & ∑ ?c œ ? ∑ 379 & ∑ ? ∑ 377 ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ m œ œ j œ œ œ œ #œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ‰ ∑ a aug. &∑ext. ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ frag. œ œ ≈ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ #œ œ. œ œ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ frag. a inv. frag. b inv. frag. b inv. frag. b inv. ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ YT: E8EvUmq0Zao Figure 11.3.3 Development of fragment “b” in Invention 1 11.4 Phrase Musical form is full of sections, and the phrase is the smallest category of section. Unlike a motive, a phrase gives the sense of completing a formal unit. 385 In classical music, phrases always end with cadences; if you have encountered a cadence, you have just witnessed the completion of a phrase. In popular music, a phrase might be completed by a melody reaching four measures in length or by completing a line of lyric instead of by a cadence. To generalize (or perhaps over-generalize), most of the phrases you encounter will be four measures in length and will end with one of the four cadence types (authentic cadence, half cadence, deceptive cadence, and, less commonly, the plagal cadence). While four- and eight-measure phrases are the most common, you will also encounter phrases that are five, six, and seven 392 measures in length. Less commonly, you will encounter three-measure phrases. Here are examples of four-measure phrases. Notice that these phrases have a sense of completion even though they do not end with cadences. & ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ? ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ & ∑ ? ∑ 27 3 112 CHAPTER 11. MELODIC ANALYSIS phrase “a” pickup notes C F C F œ . œ. V 44 J ≈ œJ œ œ œ . œ œ œ . œ œ œ œ œ œ . œ w 37 I've got sun - shine on a phrase cloud “a” - y day pickup C: I notes C 37 42 IV F 37 42 53 CI IV F Fm pickup I'm notes man IV - it's all in Ime IV phrase “a” bbbbb 4 ∑˙ V & b 4 46 C ∑ ∑ œ . ∑ ∑ ∑ œ œ œ œj œ œ œ œ œ ˙. œ . phrase “a” ev - 'ry wo - man it's all F in C me ∑∑ 3 F b œ . œ. ∑ Ó Œ ‰ œ∑ œ V 44b b J ≈ œJ∑ œ œ œ∑. œ œ œ . œ∑œ œ œ œ œ .∑œ w b I've got sun-shine ∑ a cloud - y day when it's YT: ∑ onvNAq7Cv34l4 ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ & b b C:∑ I IV I IV Figure 11.4.2 Nickolas Ashford and Valerie Simpson, “I’m Every Woman” 59 phrase “a” (1978)b b ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ b VHere is an Fm example of a five-measure phrase. Notice that the final chord j discussed (a minor be mode mixture) b b b 44iv ˙chord,œwhich œ . œ inœ the ∑ & œ œwilldeceptive œ chapter ˙ .on has œ œ . cadence, œ œphrase is partb of a half cadence or yet the a feeling of ∑ ev - 'ryconsidering ∑wo - manits∑ relation ∑ me ∑ before and∑ after & b b I'mespecially completion, it's all to in the phrases 65 it. b ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ V b b E¯≤: ii∑ E¯≤: ii 53 46 when it's phrase “a” œ . œ. Ó Œ ‰œ œ V 44b J ≈ œJ œ œ œ . œ œ œ . œ œ œ œ œ œ . œ w œ. œ œ œ œ ˙. ∑ V b bI've˙ got sunœ -shineœ œ œj YT: onnz80onuEhHE a cloud - y œday when it's œ . and Ronald White, “My Girl”(1964) Figure 11.4.1 Smokey Robinson I'm C: Iev - 'ry wo 42 Ó Œ ‰ œ œ3 phrase “a” 46 bb b4 ‰ œ∑ b ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ & b & 4 71 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ b V b b You must not know 'bout me You ∑must not know - 'bout me I can have an B¯≤ 59 F B¯≤: I b (phrase∑ “a” continued) ∑ & b bCm 65 48 &b 51 ∑ ∑ ∑ b œ œ œ‰œ œ œ œ‰ œ œ œ œ œ œœ. œ. œ œ bœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ b & b bii b & b ∑ 71 ∑ V E¯≤m oth - er you by to - mor - row So don't ∑ ∑ ∑ ev - er for a sec - ond get to think - ing iv ∑ ∑ you're ir - re - place - a - ble ∑ YT: 2EwViQxSJJQ ∑ ∑ Figure 11.4.3 Shaffer Smith, Mikkel Eriksen, Tor Erik Hermansen, Espen Lind, Beyoncé Knowles, “Irreplaceable” (2006) &b b ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ &b b ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ 59 65 œ j & c œ œ œ #œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ‰ ? c œ œ œ œ œ #œ œ œ œ. ≈ œ œ œœ frag. a inv. frag. b inv. frag. b inv. frag. b inv. œ Here is an example of a six-measure phrase that ends with m aœ V7 - i cadence œ in G minor. œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œj ‰ & c œ œ œ # œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ phrase “a” frag. a aug.ANALYSIS & ext. CHAPTER 11. MELODIC 374 7 Gm/D D/F˜ G7/Ffrag. C/E E a ¯≤aug. & ext. D7 377 377 C˜o7 ? cb 3œ œœ ˙ œ œœœ œœœ œœœ ##œœœ œn ˙œ . Œœ œ œ .˙œ œ œœ œ œ œœ # œœ œ œœ ≈œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ ˙. œ œ œ œ œœ Œ œ œ & b 4 œ nœ œ # œ œ p #œ nœ nœ bœ œ œ. œ. Gm/D G7/F E¯≤7 D7 phrase # œ “a” œ o7 œ ∑ ∑ œ Œ œ œœ œ Œ Gm ∑ œ Œ œ ∑ phrase “a” œ œœ œ A˜o7/G G œ. # 3 œœ œ œ œ. œ œ# œ œ . œ 4 ˙ œ Œ œ Œ bb ∑ ∑ & p œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ # œ# œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ?# 3 œ œ œ œ œ 4 G D7/A G C/G & 391 ? bb ∑ ∑ not a cadence (phrase “a” continued) D7/A 388 Gm œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ Dœ7 # œ œ D/F˜ C/E Gm/D C˜ Gm/D Œ Œ Œ Œ œœ œœ œ œ # œ œ œ Œ œ ˙œ œ œœ# œ œ œ œ ˙ b 3 œ œ œ œ œ œ n ˙˙ .. œ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ & b 4 œ nœ œ # œ 384 b #pœ∑ n œ ∑ b ∑œ. PbwJhFGUiFc ∑ n œ b œ œ œ. YT: & # œ ∑œ œ œœ œœ∑ œœ ? b 3 # œœ œœ b 11.4.4 4 Figure W.A. Mozart, Symphony No. 40, œK. 550, IIIœ (1788) Œ Œ œ Œ Œ ? b 3 b 4 is an example of an 8-measure phrase. ?Here bb ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ 384 D7 113 27 & # œ. œœ œ œ œ G Em G/B œ. œ œ Œ C C/E G/D D œ œ˙ œ œœ œœ œ œ # œ n œ œ œ œ œ .œ œ œ œ # œ n œ œ œ œ œœœ œ œœœ œ œ œœœ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ ?# œ ˙ œ ˙ œ Œ œ œ œ œ I/5th V half cadence YT: 1vDxlnJVvW8 Figure 11.4.5 W.A. Mozart, Piano Sonata in C Major, K. 545, II Examples of seven-measure phrases are rare and often involve elisions, which will be covered in a later chapter when we discuss how phrases are combined to create small forms like periods and phrase groups. œ You must not know 'bout me You œ must not know - 'bout me B¯≤: I CHAPTER 11. MELODIC ANALYSIS I can have an - V 114 (phrase “a” continued) E¯≤m 11.5b Cm Subphrase œ œ œ‰œ œ œ œ‰ œ œ œ œ œ œœ. œ. &b œ œ bœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ 48 51 Subphrases are smaller than phrases but larger than motives. Most of the oth - er we you byencounter to - mor - row So will don't beev -two er for measures a sec -ond get tolong. think - Subphrases ing you're ir - reare -placecalled - a - ble subphrases ii iv “phrase segments” and “phrase members” in other texts. We will label subphrases with letters (a, b, etc.). When a subphrase repeats phrase “a” but has slight alterations, we will put an apostrophe after the letter (e.g., a’) subphrase “a” subphrase “b” and refer to it as “a prime.” If another alteration to subphrase a occurs, we will mot. 1 mot. 1 (int. ch.) label it as a” and refer to it as “a double prime.” If the subphrase is merely transposed (in a sequence), we will label it as a, not a’ in our analysis. We are including analysis of subphrases in this text because many compositions have melodic units that are two measures long. Analyzing subphrases Stran - gersthe construction wait - ing up and down the bou - le - vard Their helps us understand of melodies. E: IV I In the following example, notice that subphrases a and a’ have the same 4 4 4 first six notes (G –F –B–C –E–E). # ## 4 & # 4 œ . œj Ó j œ. œ Ó Ó œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ Phrase: 55 a subphrase a subphrase a' 3 3 3 3 3 3 #### 4 Œ Œ 3 j Œ Œ j & 4 œ œ j œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ j œœ œ œ œ œ œ Œ œ œ œ Don't stop think - ing a-bout to - mor-row Don't stop it - 'll soon be here YT: OvSbZEYlfnM Figure 11.5.1 Christine McVie, “Don’t Stop” (1977) Here is an example of a four-measure phrase with subphrases a and b. Phrase: a subphrase a 4 œ œ Fm 59 ? bb 4 Œ bb 4 E¯≤ D¯≤ œ . œ ˙D¯≤ Fmœ œ œ œ œ ˙ J œ œœ œ œ œ œ Œ E¯≤ Par - ty rock is in the house to - night f: i ? b b ∑ bb 63 subphrase b VII ∑ ∑ Ev - 'ry - bod - y just have a good time VI ∑ i ∑ YT: KQ6zr6kCPj8 VII ∑ ∑ ∑ VI ∑ Figure 11.5.2 Stefan Gordy and Skyler Gordy, “Party Rock Anthem” (2011) Notice that we are not looking at the motives within these subphrases. This is because we are looking for melodic segments that are repeated. For some compositions it is more informative to look at subphrases and less informative to identify motives if motives are not extracted and developed. There will be times when you will notice important melodic ideas happening at three levels of analysis (motive, subphrase, and phrase), as in the following example. &b of the b œ œhome œ‰œ œ œ œ‰ œœ. œ. œ œ œ œ œ brave. œ œ bœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ 7 C - er you by to - mor - row So don't Em oth ev - er for a sec -ond get (C-E-G) (E-G-B-D) CHAPTER 11. MELODIC ANALYSIS ii iv 7 to think Fmaj - ing you're ir - re-place - a - ble . œ. œ ptœ ptœ œ œ . . œ. œ(esc œ .) œ œ œ œ 4 w w Phrase: Œ ≈ Ra &4 subphrase a subphrase b 20 (F-A-C-E) 115 ( ) ( ) # # # #C 4 j & (C-E-G) 4 œ . œj Ó œ . œ Ó Ó œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ dn œ œ dn œ dn - gers ) œ œ # œ Stran wait ing up and down the bou le - vard Their ( œ ) œ 4 œ (# œ & 4 œ (œ ) œ 51 mot. 1 24 mot. 1 (inv.) E: IV Phrase: 55 25 I a A Dm F YT: 1k8craCGpgs subphrase a subphrase a' (G-B-D) (A-C˜-E) (D-F-A) (F-A-C) Figure 11.5.3 Cain, “Don’t3 Stop3 Believin”’ antJonathan 3 3 3 antNeil ant Schon,3 nt pt Steve pt Perry, nt3 ant G ## 4 Œ Œ j j j j & 4 4œj œœ œœ œœj œ œ œ œœ œœ œœj œ œœ œœ ŒÓ œ ‰(Œ# œœ)jœ( nœœœ) œ ˙œ œ œœ œ œœ Œ There is ambiguity between motive and subphrase. Reconsider the follow- # (1981) & b# 4 ( ) ( ) ( ) ( ) ( ) ( ) I Don't know where you're com -on from me stop think - ing a -ing bout to - mor-Call row change: Don't stop ing example from the section intervallic E: I 29 mot. 1 m3 b j V b b 44 œ œ œ œ The ver - y IV œ ˙. thought of you I Ó onit the- line 'll soon beCall hereme mot. 1IV (int. ch.) P4 ‰ œj œ œ œ œ ˙ . and I for - get to do YT: v9V98ECtsfY b b ∑ b ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ V Figure 11.5.4 Ray Noble, “The Very Thought of You” (1934) 33 ∑ When you listen to the music of “The Very Thought of You” you will hear that each motive lasts for two measures. The difference is that motives are typically short—two to seven notes—whereas subphrases will usually contain six or more notes and occupy two measures (half of a four-measure phrase). 11.6 Practice Exercises Day One: 1. For the following examples: • Analyze motives using numbers (1, 2, etc.) • Label lead-sheet symbols and Roman numerals when blanks are provided • Label non-chord tones for notes in parentheses (Note: Even though there are 11 blanks for motives, there are only six motives in this example due to motivic alteration.) ˙ ____ ____ ____ ____ CHAPTER 11. MELODIC ANALYSIS 116 Motives: b 4 j œ. œ. œ. œ œœ & b 4 œ (œ) œ . œ œ œ (œ ) œ .(œ)œ œ œ œ(œ)œ (œ) (œ) (œ) (œ) (œ) œ . œ œ (œ)œ ˙ 147 Ah 147 28 393 Ah b 4 & b 4 œœ œ ? b 4 b 4 œ Lead-sheet: j œœ œ j œ __ __ __ œœ .. œ. œ. B¯≤: __ __ __ Ooh j œœ .. œœ œ. œ j œ . œ __ ˙˙ ˙ ˙ __ __ __ j œœ œ j œ __ __ œœ .. œ. ˙˙ ˙ ˙ œ. __ __ j œœ œ j œ __ __ œœ .. œ. ˙˙ ˙ ˙ œ. __ __ ˙˙ ˙ ˙ # & C œ (œ ) œ. (œ)œ # œ (œ) œ œ )# œ œ.(n œ)n œ . YT:œ (#RgKAFK5djSk . . . Figure 11.6.1 Charlie Puth, Cameron Thomaz, Andrew Cedar, Justin œ œ œ œ œ ( ) œ œ œ ( ) ( )œ ? # C“See You Again” ( )œ œ Franks, (2015) œ œ œ œ. œ. œ. œ. œ. œ œ. œ œ œ œ œ œ œ . example, alter the given . motives For the following . . . Also, J . . as. specified. Motives: 2. 28 provide e:lead-sheet and Roman __ symbols __ __ numerals and analyze __ non__ # ___ ___ ___ C œ (œ ) œ œ œ ___ & œ œ œ ( ) 2 1 aug. 1 1 # œ. ( ) œ (# œ )# œ . (n œ)n 2œ aug. Motives: . . œ œ œ œ œ. œ & c œ (œ)œ(œ)œ œ (œ)( )œ œ (œ )œ ( œ) ?# C œ œ˙ œ w œ œ œ w œ œ œ ? c www œ œ. . . .ww . œ. œ. œww. . . ˙˙. . 393 chord tones. Motives: Lead sheet: 398 e: C: ___ 398 3. __ __ __ ___ Lead sheet: ___ ___ For 402 the following example: ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ 2 inv. œ . œ (œ)(œ) œ œ œ˙˙ œ œ .˙ . J __ __ ___ ___ &• Write the lead-sheet symbols œ (œ)(œ)œ œ c & œ • Writeœ œthe (œ) chords as whole œ notes in œthe bass clefœ staff œ( ) w www including ? • Analyze ˙˙ write ˙ ? ∑ ∑ tones, ∑ ∑wwthe ones ∑ you c ∑www non-chord ˙ ∑ ˙˙ ∑ 2 1 Motives: 1 aug. 2 aug. 1 2 inv. • Alter the given motives as specified to fit the harmony C: ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ • Specify the cadence 410 & ___ Lead sheet: 402 ___ b ˙ & b c∑ œ œ (œ∑) ? 1 Motives: ? b c b g: i œ∑ iv ___ 1 int. ch. ∑ œ i ___ 1 inv. ∑ œ ∑ 1 inv. ∑ V7 Cadence: ____________ &b Day Two: 406 b ? bb CHAPTER 11. MELODIC ANALYSIS 4. 117 For the following example: • Analyze the motives using numbers (1, 2, etc.), noting motivic alterations when applicable • Analyze subphrases using letters and primes (a, a’, b, etc.) • Label lead-sheet symbols and Roman numerals when blanks are provided • Label non-chord tones for notes in parentheses 22 Lead-sheet: ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ Subphrases: 401 # 2 œJ (œ)œ(# œ)œ œ . œ œ . œ œ . œ œ œ œ j (œ) œ œ œ & 4 J J ( ) œ # œ . (œ) œ . J Í Motives: e: 410 & # i iv i iio V i iv V YT: Dbb_VGJXaSU Figure 11.6.2 Robert Schumann, Album for the Young, Op. 68, No. 16, “First Loss” Click here to download the first assignment for this chapter. Click here to download the second assignment for this chapter. Click here to download the Unit 2 Practice Test. Chapter 12 Form in Popular Music The overall form of a piece of popular music usually can be broken down into smaller 4-, 8-, 12-, or 16-bar sections. The material in this chapter is informed by John Covach’s essay “Form in Rock Music” from Engaging Music: Essays in Music Analysis (ed. D. Stein). 12.1 Verse-Chorus Form The Verse-Chorus form is arguably the most common musical form of present day popular music and is probably familiar to most readers of this text. In Verse-Chorus form, the chorus contains the “hook”—the memorable refrain—while the verse typically contains less memorable melodic material. A clear example can be found in the 1985 song “We Are the World.” Table 12.1.1 Michael Jackson and Lionel Richie, “We Are The World” (1985) 0:00–0:26 Introduction, 6 bars 0:26–0:53 0:53–1:18 1:18–1:49 Verse 1, 8 bars Verse 2, 8 bars Chorus, 9 bars 1:49–2:14 2:14–2:41 Verse 3, 8 bars Chorus, 8 bars 2:41–3:08 Bridge, 8 bars 3:08–3:35 3:35–4:02 4:02–end Chorus, 8 bars Chorus, 8 bars ending with key change Chorus, 7 times in F major with fade out YT: 9AjkUyX0rVw Common additions to the Verse-Chorus form, beside the bridge, are the pre-chorus and post-chorus. 118 CHAPTER 12. FORM IN POPULAR MUSIC 119 Table 12.1.2 Kurt Cobain, Krist Novoselic, and Dave Grohl, “Smells Like Teen Spirit” (1991) 0:00–0:25 0:25–0:42 0:42–0:58 0:58–1:23 1:23–1:31 Introduction, 12 bars Verse 1, 8 bars Pre-chorus, 8 bars Chorus, 9 bars Post-chorus, 4 bars 1:31–1:39 1:39–1:56 1:56–2:12 2:12–2:37 2:37–2:45 Interlude, 4 bars Verse 2, 8 bars Pre-chorus, 8 bars Chorus, 12 bars Post-chorus, 4 bars 2:45–3:02 Guitar solo, 8 bars 3:02–3:10 3:10–3:26 3:26–3:42 3:42–4:37 Interlude, 4 bars Verse 3, 8 bars Pre-chorus, 8 bars Chorus, 21 bars YT: hTWKbfoikeg It is worth noting that there may disagreement about labeling sections in a form. One person may call a section a “pre-chorus,” another may call it a “first chorus,” while another may call it “verse part b.” There is ambiguity in naming sections and disagreement is to be expected. There are “simple” and “contrasting” verse-chorus forms. A simple versechorus form has the same harmonic progression for the verse and chorus (e.g., “All About That Bass”). The chord progressions for the verse and chorus are different in a contrasting verse-chorus form like “We Are the World.” 12.2 AABA Form The AABA form is associated with the hits from Broadway musicals in the 1930s and remained one of the most popular forms of popular music until the 1950s, when Rock ‘n’ Roll became popular. Each section (A or B) is typically 8 measures long. The A sections contain the primary melody we associate with the song while the B section provides contrast and is often called the “bridge” or “middle eight.” CHAPTER 12. FORM IN POPULAR MUSIC 120 Table 12.2.1 George Gershwin, “I Got Rhythm” (1930) 0:00–0:10 Introduction, 8 bars 0:10–0:18 0:18–0:26 0:26–0:35 0:35–0:45 A A B A 0:45–0:53 0:53–1:02 A section, 8 bars (instrumental shout chorus) Introduction, 8 bars (shout chorus continues) 1:02–1:10 1:10–1:19 1:19–1:27 1:27–1:35 A A B A 1:35–1:54 Coda, 12 bars section (A1), 8 bars section (A2), 8 bars section, 8 bars section (A3), 10 bars section (A1), 8 bars section (A2), 8 bars section, 8 bars section (A3), 8 bars YT: Q_jKTPsh54Y It is common for one or more of the A sections to be instrumental, and it is also common to eliminate an A section on the repeat of the entire AABA form (AABAABA, for example). Other well known songs with AABA form include “Over the Rainbow” from The Wizard of Oz as well as many famous songs from the Great American Songbook by George Gershwin (“Let’s Call the Whole Thing Off,” “Someone to Watch Over Me”), Cole Porter (“Anything Goes,” “Love for Sale,” “I Get A Kick Out of You”), Irving Berlin (“Blue Skies,” “Puttin’ on the Ritz”), and Jerome Kern (“The Way You Look Tonight,” “Smoke Gets In Your Eyes”). The AABA form continued to be dominant into the 1960s (including Beatles songs like “Yesterday,” “Norwegian Wood,” and “Hey Jude,” to name a few). The AABA form is less common in the present day but can be found in songs like The Cure’s “Friday, I’m in Love” (1992) and Norah Jones’s “Don’t Know Why” (1999). A note on terminology: the entire 32-bar AABA form is sometimes called a “refrain” or “chorus,” and some AABA songs are preceded by a “verse.” This means a song like “Someone To Watch Over Me” begins with a verse and is followed by a “refrain” (which could also be called a “chorus”). Other synonymous terms you may encounter for “verse” in the context of AABA form are “prelude” and “introduction.” 12.3 ABAC Form Many popular songs from the 1930s–1950s were in the 32-bar ABAC form. Well-known examples include “White Christmas,” “Someday My Prince Will Come,” and “When I Fall In Love.” “Star Dust” is an example of an ABAC form that is usually performed with a verse preceding the refrain. CHAPTER 12. FORM IN POPULAR MUSIC 121 Table 12.3.1 Hoagy Carmichael, “Star Dust” (1927) 0:00–0:13 0:13–1:13 Introduction, 4 bars Verse, 16 bars (8 bars + 8 bars) 1:13–1:41 1:41–2:07 2:07–2:32 2:32–2:57 A B A C 2:57–3:12 Coda, 4 bars section, 8 bars section, 8 bars section, 8 bars section, 8 bars YT: hWkoFj14HkE The ABAC form may also occur as ABAB’ where the B’ section begins the same as the B section but ends differently. 12.4 The 12-Bar Blues Associated with the Blues genre, which originated in the early 1900s, the 12-bar blues was also popular during the Swing Era of the 1930s and 1940s, (examples include “In The Mood” and “One O’Clock Jump”), as well as during the early years of Rock ‘n’ Roll in the 1950s (“Johnny B. Goode,” “Hound Dog,” “Rock around the Clock”). The basic 12-bar blues progression is shown below. Table 12.4.1 Chuck Berry, “Johnny B. Goode” (1958) Bars 1–4: I I I I Bars 5–8: IV IV I I Bars 9–12: V IV I I YT: Uf4rxCB4lys 12.5 Harmonically Closed and Open Sections A harmonically closed section ends on the tonic chord ( I ). A harmonically open section typically ends on a non–tonic chord like V , but could also end on IV . In an AABA form, the A sections are usually harmonically closed, ending on I , and the B section (or bridge) is usually harmonically open, ending on V . In verse-chorus form, sections that leads into the chorus (verse, pre-chorus, and bridge) are usually harmonically open, while choruses can be harmonically closed or open. If you compose a piece in AABA or verse-chorus form, placing harmonically open and closed sections appropriately is important to the flow of the music. For example, the verse and bridge on “We Are the World” are harmonically open (ending on V ) while the chorus is harmonically closed (ending on the tonic chord, I ). CHAPTER 12. FORM IN POPULAR MUSIC 122 12.6 Practice Exercises 1. For each song, fill in the beginning time for each section, label each section type (verse, pre-chorus, chorus, post-chorus, interlude, introduction, A, B, or C section, etc.), and the number of bars in each section of the form. Table 12.6.1 Tom Bahler, “She’s Out of My Life” (1980) (a) Time: Time: Time: Time: Time: : : : : : Section Section Section Section Section Type: Type: Type: Type: Type: , , , , , bars bars bars bars bars , , , , , , , , , , bars bars bars bars bars bars bars bars bars bars YT: 6DQJPL9Yuq0 Table 12.6.2 Lennon-McCartney, “Penny Lane” (b) Time: Time: Time: Time: Time: Time: Time: Time: Time: Time: : : : : : : : : : : Section Section Section Section Section Section Section Section Section Section Type: Type: Type: Type: Type: Type: Type: Type: Type: Type: YT: S-rB0pHI9fU Click here to download the homework assignment for this chapter. Chapter 13 Phrases in Combination35 478 13.1 The Perfect Authentic Cadence & w bw We will now distinguish between two types of authentic ( V – I ) cadences: the Perfect Authentic Cadence (PAC) and the Imperfect Authentic Cadence (IAC). The Perfect Authentic Cadence must meet three requirements: ? w w 1. V – I 2. Both chords in root position 3. Tonic scale degree (1̂ ) in the highest voice of the tonic chord ˙˙ & 479 1̂ in highest voice ˙˙ ˙ ˙ ˙˙ ? C: V I both V & I are in root position If at least one of these requirements is not met (one or both of the chords are inverted, tonic is not in the highest voice, or vii◦ occurs in place of V ), the cadence is an Imperfect Authentic Cadence (IAC). 13.2 The Sentence ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ A sentence ∑ ∑ in∑ music∑ is ∑a phrase ∑ with ∑ a ∑specific∑ melodic ∑ ∑construction: ∑ a melodic idea (motive 1 or subphrase a) is either repeated or sequenced then followed by either related or unrelated material leading to a cadence. In this first example, Mozart sequences motive 1 from measure 1 up a step in measure 2. Measure 3 contains related material and measure 4 contains cadential material. 123 ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ 124 35 CHAPTER 13. PHRASES IN COMBINATION 36 489 related material frag. b frag. b ### 6 œ . œ œ œ œ œ . œ œ œ œ j œ œ œ œœ œ œ œj & 8 J J œ œ J J œ œ p frag. a frag. b frag. a frag. b j j j j j j œ œ œ œœ œœ œ œ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œ ? # # # 68 œ . œ J œ. œ œ J œ œJ œ œJ œ œ œ . J mot. 1 A: I 479 mot. 1 I/3rd V7/5th V/3rd vi7 & ˙˙ V/3rd1̂ in highest I ii/3rdvoice I/5th V Half Cadence ˙˙ phrase a 493 480 497 485 ˙ # # # œ . œ œ œ œ œ .YT: vp_h649sZ9A œ œ ?œ ˙˙ œj œ œ œ œœ œ œœ œj œ œ & J œ J K. 331, I J ˙ J Figure 13.2.1 Sentence Structure in Mozart, In thepnext example, changes C: j V of subphrase j Beethoven j j jthe intervals j I a in meaœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ rootsubphrases sures 3–4 toœ fit the dominant harmony. He extracts motive 2 from both V & I are in position œ lead œ toœ a half œ . œ œ 7–8 œ œ . œ œ œ 5–6.œJ Measures ? #a’# #in œmeasures œ a and cadence. J œ œ. J J J b & #b b#b & # ? bb b b ? ### subphrase a . œ . œ œphrase œ n œ œ. a'Œ . œ C œ œ . œ . œœ œ .œmot. 1œJ œ . œ œmot.œ32 œJ œ p œ œœ Cœ Œ œj œ ∑œj œ Œ œœœj œ œœœj œœœ œ . œ œ œ œJ œ . f:œ œi œ œJ œ related material œ . œ œ n œ œ. Œ S 3 œœœ œœœ ? b b b Œ œœœ b bb &bb mot. 2 j œ i . . n œ. œ œ œ. j œ œ œ mot. 1œœ Jœ œ n œœœj œŒ Ó œ œ œ7/3rd V J J œ . œ œ œ œ.(HC) Œ j 3 œœ mot. œ œœœ œœœ2 ‰ œœ œœ œœ Œ n œœ œœ œœ œ jœ ‰ œ subphrase a' ˙˙˙ œ œ œ œ œ . œ œ œ œ. j œ Œ ˙ S 3 œœ n œœ œœ œœ ƒ œœœ œ Œ œ œ œ Œ Œ mot. 2 viio/3rd i/3rd iio/3rd I/5th V V7 I (PAC) nœ œ œ œ œU Œ p œ œU Œ Œ V Half Cadence YT: G8yuCJGWS20 Figure 13.2.2 Sentence Structure in Beethoven, Op. 2, No. 1, I In the next example, unrelated material follows subphrase a and its repetition. & b œœ Œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ CHAPTER 13. PHRASES IN COMBINATION I V 510 .. œ ‰ 125 (PAC) I b œ œ . . œ œ . . œ. œ. œ. œ. n œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ &b c Í Í Í b & b c œ œœœœœ œ œœœœœ œœ œ œ œ œœœ œœœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ #œ subphrase a B ¯≤: V7/3rd I/3rd œ œ . . œ œ . . bb œ œ œœ œœ œ œ œœ œœ & Í Í bb & œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ . . œ œ œ. œ. œ œœ nn œœ œ œœ œ œ œ œ Í subphrase a 512 V7/3rd 514 b˙ b˙ ˙ ˙ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ #œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ I/3rd (not a strong cadence) œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ bœ œ œ ‰ ‰ b ˙ &b ˙ ˙ ˙ p ? b ‰ œ œ œ ‰ œ n œ œ ‰# œ n œ œ ‰ œ œ œ Œ b unrelated material new phrase œ & bœ ii/3rd œ œ ˙˙ ˙ ˙˙ I/5th V7 I (HC) YT: PmO3Wlono6w Figure 13.2.3 Sentence Structure in Mozart, K. 333, I (1783) 13.3 The Period In music, a period consists of at least two phrases with the final phrase ending in a more conclusive cadence than the first phrase. 13.3.1 Conclusiveness of Cadence Because period form involves “more conclusive” and “less conclusive” cadences, it is important to distinguish between inconclusive and conclusive cadences. Conclusive cadences end on the tonic chord, while inconclusive cadences do not. Inconclusive Cadences Deceptive Cadence ( V – vi ) Half Cadence (ends on V ) Conclusive Cadences Authentic Cadence ( V – I ) Plagal Cadence ( IV – I ) CHAPTER 13. PHRASES IN COMBINATION 36 489 126 In addition, the perfect authentic cadence (PAC) is more conclusive than the imperfect authentic cadence (IAC). While the plagal cadence (PC) occurs less frequently than the other three cadences listed in the table above, it will sometimes occur in root position at the end of a phrase after an inverted imperfect authentic cadence (IAC) has concluded a previous phrase, with the related material more conclusive understanding that a root position PC could be considered mot. 1 mot. 1' frag. b frag. b than an inverted IAC. Generally, a period will either contain a phrase ending in a half cadence (HC) followed by a phrase ending in an authentic cadence (IAC or PAC), or it will contain frag. a phrase endingfrag. in aan IAC following by a phrase ending in a a frag. b frag. b PAC. ### 6 œ . œ œ œ œ œ . œ œ œ œ j œ œ œ œœ œ œ œj œ œ & 8 J J J J œ œ p j j j j j j œ œ œ œœ œœ œ œ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ. . œ œ Conclusive-More ? # # #Examples 6 œ . œ of the J œ“Less J œ œJ œ œJ Conclusive” 13.3.2 8 J Cadential Formula A: I I/3rd V/3rd V7/5th vi7 V/3rd I ii/3rd I/5th V In the first example, a HC concludes the first phrase and a PAC concludes the Half Cadence second phrase, making a period. phrase a 493 535 497 539 a # # # œ . œ œ œ œ . œ œphrase j œœ œ œ œj œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ & J J J J œ œ j p j œ .j jœj œ j œ œœ j n œœ j œ . n œ œ ? b b b 42? œ# œ# œ œœ . œœ œœœœœ œœ œœœœ œœœœ. œœœœœœ œœœ œœ œ œœœ œ œœ œœœ œœ œœœœ œ œ œ œ œ œ J b J œ œ. # J J J p I/5th V ? b b b 42 œ œ œ (HC) œ b œ œ phraseœ a' œ œ œ jV j A¯≤: # # # œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ œ ‰ . . œœ(HC) & J œ œ J œ œJ œ œ œœ j j j j j œ œ œ œœ œœ œ phrase œ œœ b œœ œ œ œ ? ### œ . œ J œ. œ œ J œ œJ. œ. .œ . œ j œ 1̂ ‰ œ œ œ b œ b œœ œ nœ œ œ b œJœ œœ œ7 œ. . œ. œ œ œ . œ œ œ œ ? bb b œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œVœ œI œ b (PAC) 501 3 ### ? bb b & œ œ b bœ œ j œ YT:œvp_h649sZ9A œ œ œ Figure 13.3.1 Mozart, Piano Sonata K. 331, I # 7 ? ## V ∑ diagram ∑ of the∑ above example. ∑ ∑ ∑I ∑ Here is a formal (PAC) a a' HC PAC Figure 13.3.2 Diagram of Mozart, K. 331, I, mm. 1-8 Notice that one or more phrases within a period can be a sentence, as in 39 CHAPTER 13. PHRASES IN COMBINATION 127 the example above, since sentences are phrases with specific melodic structure. In the next example, the first phrase concludes with an IAC and the second phrase concludes with a PAC. 501 phrase a œœœœ œ œ œ 2 & b 4 œJ œ œ & b 42 ‰ œœ F: Œ I œœœœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œœœœœ œ œ œœ3̂ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ V I (IAC) 506 &b œœœœœœœœ œ & b œœ Œ phrase a' 1̂ œœœœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ I &b œœ V œœ œ I (PAC) ‰ .. ‰ .. 510 ?b YT: hmu-6FJT5Bw ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ Figure 13.3.3 Joseph Haydn, Piano Sonata in F Major, Hob. XVI:9, III. Scherzo In the next example, the first phrase ends with an IAC and is followed by a second phrase ending with a PAC. 37 CHAPTER 13. PHRASES IN COMBINATION 38 128 phrase a 3̂ œ # œ œ # œ œ œ n œ œ œj ≈ œ œ ≈ 3 œ ≈ œ #œ œ &8 # œ œ J œ œœ J π œ œ #œ ? 38 ‰ ∑ œœ ≈‰ œ œ ≈ ‰ œœ ≈‰ 518 a: i V i (IAC) phrase a' 523 œ #œ œ œ nœ œ j ≈ œ œ œJ & œ œ ? ∑ œ i œ œ ≈ ‰ œ ≈ œ œ œ œ 1̂ œ #œ ≈ ‰ V œ œ œ ≈ i (PAC) phrase a = "antecedent" 527 GwcyH-aWUc8 # # # 6 œ . œ œ œ œ œYT: j œ œ œ œœ œ œ œj œ œ œ . œ Figure 13.3.4 Beethoven, Bagatelle in A minor, WoO 59, “Für Elise”œ œ œ œ & 8 J J J J Another example with a less conclusive cadence followed by a more concluj on Me”j by Bill jWithers. j j j p sive cadence isœ“Lean œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ . ? # # # 68 œ . œ œ œ œ J J œ œ. J J J YT: fOZ-MySzAac Figure 13.3.5 “Lean on Me” (1972) by Bill Withers HC (less conclusive) j ## œ . œ œ œ œ œ . œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œœisj called œ œœcadence œœ ‰ the In & a period, the phrase Jending with the Jless œconclusive œ œ cadence œ “antecedent” and the phrase ending with the Jmore conclusive is j jThese canj be thought j of jas being in a “question and called the “consequent.” œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ answer” #relationship. ? # # œ . œ œ œ œJ œ . œ œ œ œJ œ œJ œ œ œ j ‰ J œ œ phrase a' = "consequent" 531 13.3.3 #Antecedents and Consequents PAC (more conclusive) œ i V CHAPTER 13. PHRASES IN COMBINATION 527 531 ### 6 œ . œ œ œ œ . & 8 J œ j j p œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œ ? ### 6 . J œ. 8 ### œ . œ œ œ & j œœ œ œœ œœ ? ### . œ J j œœ J i (PAC) 129 phrase a = "antecedent" œœ œ j œ œ œ œœ œ œ œj œ œ œ œœ œ œœ œœj J J J j j j œœ œ œ œ œ œœ J œ œJ œ œJ œ œ. J HC (less conclusive) j œ œ œ œ œœ J œ J j j œœ œ œ œœ J œ œJ œ J phrase a' = "consequent" œ. œ œ œ j œ œ œ œœ œ. œ œœ œœj œ ‰ œ œ œœ œ j ‰ œ œ PAC (more conclusive) YT: vp_h649sZ9A Figure 13.3.6 Antecedent and Consequent in Mozart, Piano Sonata K. 331, I 13.3.4 Parallel and Contrasting Periods Periods are labeled as “parallel” or “contrasting” based on the melodic material. In a parallel period, the melodies in both phrases begin similarly. In a contrasting period, the phrases begin differently. The three preceding examples are parallel periods The apostrophe mark (’) is called “prime” and is used to show a phrase is similar to a previous phrase but ends with a different cadence. Therefore a’ is called “a prime” and a” is called “a double prime.” If you are analyzing a piece that requires triple and quadruple primes, it is clearer to use a1 , a2 , a3 , and so on. Below is an example of a contrasting period. CHAPTER 13. PHRASES IN COMBINATION 130 39 phrase a j j a œ œ œ œ. phrase . œ n œ œ n œ œ œ œ ? b b b 42 œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ b j j œ n œœ œ . p . œ œ n œ œ œ œ œ ? b b b 4? 2 bœb bœb œ42 œ œœœ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œœœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ b œ 535 535 p ? b b b 42 b œ 539 A¯≤: œ œ œ œ phrase b œ œ œ V (HC) œ œ . . . V. 1̂ (HC) œ œ œ œ œ bœ bœ œ œ œ œ . œ œ œ œnœœ œ œ œ b œ œ œ œ œ œ. œ. œ. ? bb b œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ b phrase b A¯≤: . . .. ?œ b b b 1̂j œ œ b œ b œ b œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œnœœ œ œ œœ b œ œ œœœœ œ œœ. œ. œ. ? b b b œ œ œ œb œœœ .œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ b V7 I 3 539 ? bb b œ b 543b œ ? bb b b œ 3 (PAC) œ œ œ YT: SrcOcKYQX3c œ V7 j œ œ I (PAC) Figure 13.3.7 Beethoven, Piano Sonata in C minor, Op. 13, (Pathétique), II ? b b b ∑ b a∑ ∑ ∑ HC ∑ ∑ ∑ b ∑ ∑ ∑ PAC ? bb b b Figure 13.3.8 Formal diagram of the example above (2nd movement of Beethoven 553 Pathétique sonata) 13.3.5 Repeated Phrase ? bb b b ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ If you encounter a section consisting of the same phrase occurring twice, call it a “repeated phrase.” 39 40 CHAPTER 13. PHRASES IN COMBINATION 131 phrase a 543 ? bb b b 535 548 539 ? bb b b ? bb b b 3 j 3 1̂ phrase a œ # # # 2 œf . œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ & 4 œ . œ œ . œ œœ œœœ œœœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œœ # œœ œ . œœœ ... œœ f j j œ n œœ œ . . œ œ f œ œ œn.œ œ œ œ ? 24 #œ# #œ 42œ œ‰œœ œ œ Œœ œ œ‰œ œ . œœ œ œ œœ œœ œJœ œ œ œJ œœ œœ œœœ œ œœœ ..œ œ œ .œœœœ p f E: V7 I 24 œ œ (PAC) œ œ œ œ phraseœa œ œ œ 3 3 j 1̂ A¯≤:# # V œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œ # œ œ (HC) œ œ œ & œ œ . œ œœœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œœ # œœœœ œœ .. œ. phrase b ? # # # œœ œœ œœ œ . œ œ œœ œ œœJ œœ œœ. . .œ . œ . œ œ œ 1̂ œ b œ b œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œnœœ œ œ œ b œ œE: Vœ7 œ œI œ. œ. œœ. œ œ œ .œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ (PAC) ? bb b ### œ b &b œ œ 552 3 œ œ œ YT: Qy8NLd7d6VE œ œ j œ ? # # # ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ (PAC) ∑ ∑ ∑ Figure 13.3.9 Robert Schumann, Album for the Young, Op. 68, No. 17, V7 I “Little Morning Wanderer” a 566 & a ### PAC PAC Figure 13.3.10 Formal diagram of the example above (“Little Morning Wanderer”) ? ### ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ In following two sections, we will examine periods containing more than two phrases. 13.4 The Asymmetrical Period Asymmetrical periods consist of three or five phrases. In an asymmetrical period, there will be an unequal number of antecedents and consequents, hence the “asymmetry.” In the example below, there is one antecedent and two consequents. 39 CHAPTER 13. PHRASES IN COMBINATION 132 phrase a 552 b & b b c œœ œœ œœ .. œœ œ œ œ œ ƒ ? b c œœ œ n œœ œœ bb œ œœ œœ œœ nœ. œœ b œœ œœ .. b œœ n œ n œ œ . œ b œœ œœ œœ # œœœ n œ n œœœ œœ œœ b œœœ œœœ nn œœœ b n œœœœ œœ œ # œœ n œœ œ b œ œ œœ œ œ œœ n œœ œ œ œ œ œ bœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ V (HC) phrase b 556 b œ œ œ œ & b b œœ œœ œ œ .# œ œœ œœœ p œ ? b œ œ nœ bœ nœ bb nœ bœ nœ œ œ # œœœ n œœœ ... n œœ n œœœ œœ b œ œ . œ b œœ œœ œ œœœ b œœ b œœ œ . n œ œ œœ bœ bœ n œœœ œ œ œœ # œœ n œœ .. n œ œ œœ b œ œ . œ œ œœ œ . œ n œœ œ b œœ œœ œœœ b œœ b œœ œ . n œ œ cresc. nœ bœ œ nœ œ œ œœ œœ n œœœ œœ œ nœ bœ œ nœ œ œ nœ œ œ nœ œ œ bœ œ œ bœ œ U bœ œ bœ œ nœ nœ œ œ nœ œ œ nœ œœ œ œ ritenuto œ œ phrase b 560 b œœ & b b œœ œœ œœ œ . # œ œœœ π œ ? b b œ œ nn œœ bb œœ b œ œœ œ œ V7 i (PAC) ww ww U w w V7 i (PAC) YT: UPptFNwQppA Figure 13.4.1 Frédéric Chopin, Prelude Op. 28, No. 20, in C minor 13.5 The Double Period The Double Period. A double period consists of at least 4 phrases and is comprised of an antecedent group and a consequent group. The first two phrases in a double period are the antecedent group and the final two phrases are the consequent group, which ends with a cadence that “answers” the less conclusive cadence (or “question”) that ended the antecedent group. The melodic scheme of abab’ (four phrases) is commonly encountered in a double period. A double period with this melodic scheme would be described as a “parallel double period” because both the antecedent group and consequent 41 CHAPTER 13. PHRASES IN COMBINATION 133 group begin with the same melody. 42 42 42 42 565 565 565 565 b & bb b bb bb 422 œœ & b b b 42 œ & b b b b 42 & b 4 ppœœ ? 2 pœ ? b bb b bb 42 pœœœœ ? bb b b b A442¯: œœ ? b b b b A42¯: œ b œ T T T T œ. œ. œ. œ. œ œ œœœ œœœ œ œ œ œ œ œ b & bb b bb bb & bb b & bbbb & b ? ? bb bb b bb ? bbb b ? bbbb b œ œœœ .... œœ œ œœ .. œ œ œœcresc. .. œ œ œœcresc. œ œœœcresc. cresc. œœœ œ œ œ .. œœ .. œœ .. œœ .. œœ œœ œœœ œœ œ A¯: A¯: 569 569 569 569 573 573 573 573 577 577 577 577 œ .. œ .. œ .. œ .. œ œ œ œ œ T bbb œ T œ. b & bb œœ . œœ & bb b b b œœ T & b b b b p T œœ .. œœ b œ & ? b b b pp œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ? bb bb œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ? bbb b p œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ? bbbb œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ b œ œ b & bb b bb bb & bb b & bbbb & b ? ? bb bb b bb ? bbb b ? bbbb b j œj œ j œj œ œ. œ. œ. œ. œ. œ. œœœ .. œœœ .. œ. œ. œ gg œœœ œ gg œœ œ gg œœ œ ggÍœœ gÍœ ggÍ œœœ gggÍ œœ gg œœ gg œœ phrase a phrase a phrase a j a phrase ‰ ‰ ‰ ‰ phrase b phrase b phrase b œphrase œ b œœ œ œœ œœ œœœ œœœ œ œ œ œœ œœ œ œ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œ phrase a phrase a T a Tn jphrase n phrase œ j nœ œ a T n T n œj nœ œ n œ. œ .. œ. j œ . œ œn œœ œœ œ .œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œœœ œ œ œ .. œ œ .. œ .. œœ œjj œœ .... œ œ .. œ œj œ .. œ œ .. œ œj œ œ œ œ ≈ œœ œœ œœ ≈ œ œœ œœ ≈œ œ ≈œ œ ≈œ œ ≈œ œœ ≈ ≈œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ n œj n œj n œj nœ œ œœœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œœ œ. œœ . œœœ .. œ œœ . œ. œ. œ. œ b œœ .. œœ b œœ . œ bœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ b œœœ . œœ œœ œœ œ œœœœœœœœ œœœœœœœœ œ œ phrase b' phrase b' phrase b' phrase œ œ b' œ. œ. nœ œ n œœ œœœ œ. n œ œœ Sœ . nœ œ S S œ nœ œ œ œ S≈ œœ .œœ œ n œ œ œ œ ≈ œœJœ .œ œ n œœ œ œ œœ ≈ Jœœ .œ œ n œ œ œ ≈ œJ . œ J j œj œ j œj œ T Tnn œ . Tn œ . b œ œœ œœ . Tn œ . b œ œœœ .. œ b œ œ . b œ œ œœœ . œ œ ... œ œ œœ œœ . œ œ œœœ ... œ œ œ œ. œ œ œ V Vœ . (HC) j n œj n œj n œj nœ ‰ ‰ ‰ ‰ (HC) V V (HC) (HC) Ÿ 3 Ÿ œ œŸnœ œ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œœ3 œ œ œ œŸ œ œ 3 œ œ œ nnœœ œœ œ œ ‰‰œœ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ nœ œ œ œ ‰ œ œ œ œ œ œj ‰ œ j œ œœœœJj ‰‰ œ Jœœj ‰ œV œœJ ‰ V (HC) J V (HC) V (HC) (HC) œ œœœ œœ œœ œœ n œ œ nœ œ œ nœ œ œ nœ Vœ V (HC) (HC) V V (HC) (HC) œ œ œ œ 3 Œ Œ Œ Œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ bbœœ œ bœ œ bœ j b œœœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œj ‰‰ b œœ œ œœ œj œ bpœœ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œJj ‰ Jœ ‰ bpœ œ œ œœ pœ n œ b œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œJjj Jœ pœœ n œ b œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ j‰‰ œœ n œ b œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œœœ . œj ‰ œ n œ b œ œ œ œ œ œ œ. œ‰ . œ œ 7 (PAC) œ . V7 I (PAC) V V7 antecedent group consequent group antecedent group consequent group V7 consequent group aantecedent group b a aantecedent group b a consequent group a b HC a HC HC HC HC a b HC a HC HC HC YT: VlfL9LWtCls HC HC HC Figure 13.5.1 Beethoven, Piano Sonata Op. 10, No. 1, II (PAC) (PAC) b' b' b' PAC b' PAC PAC PAC I I I œœœ œ œ n œ œ œ œ œœ n œ b œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ ? b b? œ œ # b b # #≈ ∑ ≈∑œ ∑ ≈ ∑œJ . œ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ œ∑. CHAPTER 13. PHRASES IN COMBINATION antecedent group 699 ### a œ ∑ ‰∑ (PAC) V7 134 I consequent group b a b' & Figure 13.5.2 Formal diagram of a double period (Beethoven, Op. 10, No. 1, II) ? # # ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ # HC HC HC PAC A double period will typically have one of the following cadential schemes: antecedent group phrase 1 consequent group phrase 2 phrase 3 phrase 4 Scheme 1: HC HC HC PAC Scheme 2: IAC IAC IAC PAC Scheme 3: IAC HC IAC PAC Figure 13.5.3 Possible cadential schemes in a double period Notice that the first two phrases of an antecedent group can consist of an IAC followed by a HC (“Scheme 3” in the above example). This may seem confusing if you are focused on analyzing phrases solely in groups of two instead considering how many phrases are in a section before analyzing the cadential scheme and the form. 13.5.1 Repeated Period You may encounter a section consisting of four phrases that is not a double period but instead is a repeated period. ∑ CHAPTER 13. PHRASES IN COMBINATION 135 phrase a 581 # ˙˙ &c ˙ # # œœœ # œœ # œ # # # ˙˙˙ & c # ˙˙ # # œœœ # œœ # # # ˙˙˙ dolce e molto ligato. E: 585 œœ # # œœœ n #˙˙˙ #˙ ˙ œ #œ # œœ # œœ n # # ˙˙˙˙ cresc. ? # ˙˙ # ˙˙ ˙. # # ˙˙ œ # ˙˙ w # # ˙˙ S & V (HC) phrase a' # ˙˙ # # œœ œ œ # # œœ ? ˙ # # # ˙˙˙ p ? # ˙˙ # # # œœœ # œœ #œ # n œ˙œ # ˙˙ ..# œ # ˙˙ ˙ cresc. # # # ˙˙˙ # ˙˙ nw nw & œ #œ #œ œ #œ p œ Œ œ 3 œ #œ nœ #œ œ #œ #œ ‹œ 3 3 3 Ó V7 I (PAC) phrase a (with ornamentation) 3 3 3 # œ‹ œ œ œ œ œ œ# œ œ œ œ # œ œ œ # œ œ œ #œ & ˙ # œ˙# œ œ œ˙œ œ 3 589 3 3 3 dolce & # ˙˙ # # œœœ # œœ ? 3 # ## ˙˙˙ # ˙˙ 3 œ #œ œ #œ œ #œ˙‹œ œ œ œ œ##œœ#œœ œœ œ œ œ˙‹œ#œ œ œnœ #œ œ#œ#œœ 3 3 cresc. S œœ # # œœœ 3 #n ˙˙˙ #œ # ˙ ? #œ#œ & # ˙˙ # # œœœ œ ˙ 3 3 3 3 3 #œ œ œ # œ œ œ #œ #œ œ # œ˙#œ œ œ˙œ œ œ # œ œ # œ œ œ œ œ œ œ # œJ f cresc. œ # ˙˙ ###˙˙˙ nw œ nw 3 & #œ ‹œ œ œ œ œ œ #œ œ œ ? ˙ œ #œ p ? # ˙˙ # # # œœœ # œœ 3 3 3 3 3 V (HC) phrase a' (with ornamentation) 593 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 V7 I (PAC) repeated parallel period parallel period parallel period a YT:a' lbblMw6k1cU a HC Piano Sonata PAC Op. 53, I HC Figure 13.5.4 Beethoven, a' PAC Examine the difference between these two formal diagrams, noting the cadence after the second phrase in each: 43 p ? # ˙˙ 577 # # # œœœ # œœ ###˙˙˙ # phrase ˙˙ b' CHAPTER 13. PHRASES IN COMBINATION bb &bb ? bb b b j œ œ .. œ j œ .. œ œ œ. cresc. nw nw V (HC) œ œ œ œ n œ œœ b œœ œ repeated parallel period p parallel period S parallel period a'œ œ n œ œ œ œ aœ n œ b œ œ œ œ œ a'œ œ œ œa œ œ œ œ œ ≈ ≈ œHC ≈ œ . PAC œ HC J j œ V7 f œ œ 136 I (PAC) j œ œ‰ œ œ œœœ œ J j œ œ ‰ œPAC . Figure 13.5.5 Formal diagram of a repeated period (Beethoven, Op. 53, I) V7 (PAC) I antecedent group a consequent group b HC a HC b' HC PAC Figure 13.5.6 Formal diagram of a double period (Beethoven, Op. 10, No. 1, II) In the next section we will examine phrase combinations that are not periods. 13.6 Phrase Groups and Phrase Chains Phrase groups and phrase chains are not periods. In phrase groups and phrase chains, the final cadence is a half cadence. A phrase group consists of at least two phrases whose melodies begin similarly and has the final phrase ending in a half cadence. The terminology in this section draws from Douglass Green’s Form in Tonal Music. 44 CHAPTER 13. PHRASES IN COMBINATION . # # 3 œ œ. & 8 p # & # 38 œ œ . . 597 601 . . # # œ œ. œ & f ? # # œ. œ. œ. œ. œœ phrase a œœœœœœ œ. œ œ œ œ œ œ œ. œ. œœ 137 œ. œ. œ3̂ œ œ œ œ V phrase a' œ œ œ œ œ œ œ. œœ I (IAC) œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ‰? œ. œ. œ œ V (HC) YT: oh6ByhUep0s ## & Figure 13.6.1 Franéois Couperin, 5 Pièces de Clavecin, 605 4. Le Petit-Rien (Ordre XIV, 8) ? ## ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ A phrase chain also ends in a half cadence and consists of at least two phrases with contrasting melodies. 45 CHAPTER 13. PHRASES IN COMBINATION 605 œ œ œ & b 42 .. ? b 42 .. phrase a œ p œ œ œ œ 138 œ #œ œ œ # œ. œ. œ œ œ œ œ #œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ i (IAC) V/3rd phrase b (is a sentence) subphrase a 609 œ œ œ œ &b ? b œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ˙ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ phrase b (continued) œ œ œ œ &b f œ œ œ ?b œ œ œ œ œ related material 613 œ œ œ œ ˙ crescendo œ subphrase a œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ dim. œ œ œ œ &b œ #œ œ œ ‰ . . J # œœ J ‰ .. V (HC) 617 ?b YT: O93GspATPzs Figure 13.6.2 Beethoven, Sonatina in F, Anh. 5 No. 2, II. Rondo ∑ ∑ 13.7 The Elision ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ An elision is a special device for joining phrases together in an overlapping manner. In an elision, the final bar of one phrase is simultaneously the first bar of the next phrase. CHAPTER 13. PHRASES IN COMBINATION 46 617 measure number in phrase: # & c ˙˙ ?# c measure number in phrase: 621 & # ˙ ˙ ?# measure number in phrase: 625 # & ˙˙ S ?# œ ˙˙ 1 p 1 & 2 œœ œœ œœ œœ j œœ J . .2 . . œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ .. .. ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙˙ ∑ j œ ˙˙ ˙˙ ∑ j j œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œj ‰ œœ ‰ œœ ‰ Œ œ œ œJ J J j œ œ œ j œ œœ œ œ œ œ œœ ‰ œJ ‰ Œ J 3 4 3 4/1 Ÿ elision . . œœ œ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ ˙ œœœœœœ œ œ œ ˙˙ œœ œ œ œ œ œ p S œ œ œœ œ œ œœœœœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ 3 Ÿ œœœœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ cresc. p œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœœœœ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ 2 1 628 j œœ J 139 2 # 3 4 1 2 3 4/1 2 3 œœœœ œœœœ 4 œ œ œ œ 4 YT: TpPuLwtDQrY Figure 13.7.1 Mozart, Eine kleine Nachtmusik, K. 525, I. ?# ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ CHAPTER 13. PHRASES IN COMBINATION 140 13.8 Summary of Phrases in Combination Table 13.8.1 Number of Phrases 2 phrases 3 phrases Form Parallel Period Melodic Scheme a a’ Contrasting Period ab Phrase Group Phrase Chain Repeated Phrase Asymmetrical period a a a a a a a a a a a a a a Phrase group 4 phrases Phrase Chain Double Period Repeated period a’ b a a b or bb a b or bb bc b a b’ or a’ a a" or a’ a b b a b or b a c or a’ a a’ Cadence Info Less conclusive then more conclusive Less conclusive then more conclusive Ends with HC Ends with HC Same cadence twice Ends with most conclusive Ends with HC Ends with HC HC–HC–HC–AC or IAC–IAC–IAC–PAC or IAC–HC–IAC–PAC Less conclusive then more conclusive formula repeated 13.9 Practice Exercises For the each excerpt below, do the following: • Label chords with Roman numerals at the ends of phrases to determine cadences • Label cadences by type (PAC, IAC, HC, PC, DC) • Examine the motivic structure to determine if a phrase is a sentence • Create a diagram of the form using cadence abbreviations (HC, DC, PC, IAC, and PAC) and letters to designate melody (a, a’, b, etc.). Use the “prime” symbol (’) to show if a melody ends with a different cadence. In this chapter, the prime symbol should not be used to represent embellishment of the melody or changes in the harmonization or register. • Name the form of the excerpt (sentence, parallel period, contrasting period, asymmetrical period, parallel double period, repeated phrase, repeated period). 1. Mozart, “Ein Mädchen oder Weibchen,”The Magic Flute. CHAPTER 13. PHRASES IN COMBINATION 48 48 & & bb 648 648 j œœj ‰‰ 4422 ? b 422 ‰‰ ? b 4 F: F: œœ œœ & & bb œœœœœ ‰‰ JJ ? ? b œœjj ‰‰ b 653 653 œœ .. œœ œœ .. œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ .. œœ œœ .. œœ œœ ‰‰ œœœ œœ œœœ œœœ Œ œœ ‰‰ œœ ‰‰ œ Œ œ ŒŒ JJ JJ œœ ‰‰ œœJ ‰‰ œœ œœ ŒŒ ŒŒ JJ J œœ œœ œœœ œJ ‰‰ J j ‰‰ œœj ‰‰ œœ œœ œœ JJ œœJ J 141 œœ ‰‰ ____ ____ ____ ____ œœ .. œœ œœ œ œ . œ œœ .. œ œ œ œ œ . œ œ œ œ œœ . œœ œœ .. œœ œœ œœ ‰ œœ . ‰ œœ ŒŒ œœ ‰ œœ ‰ œ JJ JJ jj ‰ jj ‰ Œ Œ œ œ ‰ œœ ‰ œœ j œœ œœ œœj ‰‰ œœ Œ œœ Œ 3 3 œœ œœ œœœœ ‰‰ JJ j œœj ‰‰ j œœj ____ ____ ŒŒ œœ ____ ____ 47 47 47 47 YT: CI0hJLioGF0 Figure 13.9.1 632 632 632 632 636 636 636 636 640 640 640 640 644 644 644 644 2. Mozart, Piano Sonata K. 333, jI. bb & œœ œœ .. œjj œœ œœ & bb bb cc œ . œœ œ œ & & ? ? ? ? & & & & ? ? ? ? & & & & ? ? ? ? bb cc œœ .. œœ .. bb b cc œœ˙œœ .... bb bb cc ˙˙œ . ˙˙ b ˙˙ B B¯¯:: œœ œœœ œœ œ œœ .. œœ .. nn œœ œœ œœ nn œœ œœ œ œ œ œœ œœœ œœœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œœ... œœ. bb bbb bb b bb bbb bb b bb bbb bb b j ## œœjj # œj #œ œœœ ... œœ ... œœ .. ‰‰ ‰‰ œœ œœ œœ bb bbb œœ œœ bbb œœ bb bbb & & bb & &b ? ? ? ? B B¯¯:: bb bbb bb b ÓÓ ÓÓ ÓÓ ÓÓ . œœœ... œ œœ. œœ.. . œœ. œœ.. . œœ œœ ŒŒ ŒŒ œœ œœ œœ... œœ. œœ œœ œœ .. œœ œœ .. ŒŒ ˙˙˙ ŒŒ ˙˙ ˙˙ œœ. œœ.. . jj œœj œj œ œœ .. œœ .. ‰‰ ‰‰ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ œœœ œœ œ œ œ. œœ œœœ œœœ ... œœ ˙˙ ŒŒ ˙˙˙˙ ŒŒ ˙ œ œœ .. œœœ nnn œœœ œœœ œœœœ œœœ œœœœ œœœ œœœœ bbb œœœ œœœ œ œ bœ œ œœ .. œ n œ œœ œœ... œœ.. œœ œœ œœ . œ ‰‰ œœ œ œ. œœ. œœœ... œœ œœ ‰‰ œ œ. aa aa œ œœj œœ œœ œJœJœ JJ œ n œœ nn œœœœ œœ nœ œœ JJœœ JJ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ jj j jj œœ œœœ œœœjj œœœ œœjjj œœœjj œœœ œœjjjj œœ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ ŒŒ œœ œ œœ ŒŒ œœ œœ œ œœ œ œ œœ ____ œœ œœœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ jœ œœjjj œJœJœ œœ JJ œœœ œœ & & & & œœ œœ j œœjjj œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ ŸŸ ŸŸ bb œœ .. bb œœ .. œœ œœ œœ œœœ œœœ œœ œ œ ŒŒ ŒŒ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ œ n œ œ ŒŒ œœ œœœ nnn œœœ œœœ ### œœœ œœœ œœœ nnn œœœ œœœ ŒŒ œœ œ n œ œ # œ œ œœ œœœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ ŒŒ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œ ŒŒ œœ œ œœ œœ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ œœ œ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœœ œœœ œœ œœ œœœ œœœ nnn œœœ bbb œœœ œœ œœ œœœ œœœ œ œ œ n œ b œ œœ œœ œ œ œœ œ œœ œ nn œœœ nn œœ œœ œœ œœœ œœ œœ œœ œœœ œœ œœœ œœ ____ ____ ____ ____ œœ œœœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœœ œœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ ŸŸ œ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œœ œ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œŸœŸ.. œœ œœ œ œœœœœ œ œ œ œœ .. œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œœ œœ IAC IAC in in B B¯¯ IAC in B¯ œœ œœœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ ____ ____ ____ ____ œœ œœ ____ ____ ____ ____ œœ œœ ŒŒ ŒŒ ŒŒ ŒŒ œ œœ œœœœ nnn œœœ œœœœ œœœ œœœœ œœœ œœœœ œ œœ n œ ____ ____ ____ ____ CHAPTER 13. PHRASES IN COMBINATION 142 YT: PmO3Wlono6w 217 217 217 Figure 13.9.2 3. 250 250 250 338 388 .. œ œ . œœœ œœœ ... .. œ œœ .. ppœ dolce grazioso grazioso p dolce dolce graziosoœ œ œ œ œ œœœ .. œœœœœ œœœœœ .. œœ œœ œœœ œ œ œœ œœ .. œ œ. ## œœ œœjjj œœœ ... #œ œ & & & ? 3 ? ? 38838 œœ œ œ œœœœœœ œœ œ œœ .. œ. œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œœ œ œœ^^^ .. œ. œœ œœ œ œœœœ œ œœ œœœ œ C: C: C: 256 256 256 262 262 262 œœ œ Edmond Dédé, Chicago, Grande Valse à l’Américaine. & & & ### œœœ ff f ? ? ? œœ œ & & & ? ? ? ## œœ ## œœ ## œœ ƒ ƒ ƒ œœ œ œœ .. œ. œœœœœ œœœ œœœœœ œœœ œœ .. œœœ ... œ. œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ j œœjj œ œœ .. œœ .. œœ .. ^^ ^ œœ .. œ. œœ œœ œœœ œ ___ ___ ___ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œœ œœœ ... œ œœœ œœ 1. 1. 1. œœœœ œœ œœœ œ œœœœœœ œ >>œœ >œœ œœ >>œœ >œœ œœ ## >>>œœ ## œœ ## œœ ## ### œœ>>>œœœ # œœ > œœ>>œœœœ œ >>œœ >œœ œ œœœœ œœ œœœ œ œœ .. œœ .. œœ .. œœœ œœ œ ___ ___ ___ œœ œœœ ... œ œ œœ œœœœ œ œœœœœœ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ ff f ≈≈ œœœœ œœœœ ≈ œœ œœ œ œœœœœœ œ .. .. .. .. œœ œœ œ œœ .. œœ .. œœ .. nœ œœ nn œœœœ œ ##2.2.œœ ## œœ ## œœ j œœjj œ œœ .. œ. œœœœ œ œœ œœœ œ œœ œœ .. œ œ. œœ œ 2. œœœ œœ œœ œœœ œ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœJ JJ œœ... œJœ JJ œ œœœœœœ œ œœ œœ œ ‰‰ ‰ ‰‰ ‰ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ 268 268 268 & & & Figure 13.9.3 ? YT: gBeigjxviQc ? Click here ? to download the first homework assignment for this chapter. Click here to download the second homework assignment for this chapter. Click here to download the Unit 3 Practice Test. PDF versions of the textbook, homework exercises, and practice exercises can be found at musictheory.pugetsound.edu Chapter 14 Accompanimental Textures In this chapter we will focus on common accompanimental textures. This chapter does not make an attempt to catalog every known accompanimental texture. Instead, it is meant to encourage you to listen to texture more closely and increase your musical awareness. 14.1 Texture We will consider texture in terms of vertical and horizontal elements. The vertical nature of texture relates to the number of notes occurring simultaneously as harmonies. It could also relate to the number of voices or instruments performing melodies simultaneously in a contrapuntal texture. The horizontal element of texture relates to rhythmic activity: is the most common rhythmic value in a passage a slow or fast one? To illustrate, here is a texture with chords (vertical elements) containing five voices with a melody (a sixth voice) above. Notice that the texture has slow rhythmic values on the horizontal plane. 705 b & b b b b 42 W ∑ π ? b b b 42 ∑ bb E¯m7 F ww w œ nœ œ œ œ œ œ œ W nW W w w W W YT: b8G9vRqq3RI ### 6 & 8 Figure 14.1.1 Samuel Barber, Adagio for Strings (1936) 707 Our second example is an excerpt for four instruments—a string quartet. While this a four-voice texture, it is full of rhythmic activity. The most common rhythmic value is the sixteenth note, and the syncopated figures in measures 3–4 of the Violin I part and measures 5–6 of the Viola part add to the textural complexity. ? # # # 68 ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ 143 ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ 51 CHAPTER 14. ACCOMPANIMENTAL TEXTURES Violin I Violin II Viola Cello 5 Vln. I Vln. II Vla. Vc. 9 Vln. I b &bb 144 œ œ œ œ nœ œ nœ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ bb 2 œ J œnœœ œœ j J J & b 4 œ f bb b 2 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ n œ œ œ ‰ j‰ & 4 J œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ nœ œ œ f œ œ œ œ œ nœ œœ œ b 2 œ œ œnœ B b b 4 œœ Œ ∑ œœœ f ? b b 42 œ œ Œ Œ Œ Œ œ b œ f œ œ œ œ nœ œ œ nœ œ œ œ œ bb œ œœ œœ J n œ œ œ œ œj J J & b œ œœ œ b œ n œ œ œJ ‰ &bb œœœœœ B bbb j œ œ ? bb œ Œ b ∑ ∑ œ œ œ J J œ ∑ Œ ∑ nœ J ‰ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ n œ œ œj œ œ œ œ œ nœ œ œ œ œ œ œ nœ œ œœ Œ œ ∑ YT: rLLYRLqUl68 ∑ Œ œ ∑ ∑ ∑ Figure 14.1.2 Mozart, String Quartet K. 428, IV (1783) Vln. II Vla. Vc. b &Inb bthe ∑following∑ sections, ∑ we will ∑ examine ∑ fairly ∑ straightforward ∑ ∑ melody∑ and-accompaniment textures in classical and popular music. In later chapters we will explore more complex textures. B bbb ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ 14.2 Chorale Texture ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ? b b textures Chorale are every) ∑ ∑ those ∑in which∑ there is∑ a chord∑ for every ∑ (or nearly ∑ ∑ b note. melody A familiar example of chorale texture is the “Star-Spangled Banner.” © 7 Score V œ .. A: œ œ œœ ? œ. œ œ ## œœ 7 Wie - sen, von "Amazing # Grace" 167 & 12 ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ 172 7 # œ . œ ___œ Mai; ˙ œ ich träum-te von grü-nen ˙ œœ ˙ ___ œœ ˙˙ ˙ œ . œ œœ œœ # œœ # œ . Lyrics: œ John Newton, ˙ œjU‰ œ Harriet BeecherœStowe ___ œ lu - sti - gem Vo - gel - ge - schrei, vom ˙ ˙ œ ‰ œ ‰œ œJ ‰˙ ‰ œJ œ‰ ‰ œj ‰˙ ‰ J œ ˙ œ ˙ YT: uBS-F944zYc lu - sti - gem Vo - gel - ge - schrei. Tune: œ œ C "Newœ œBritain" œ G (traditional) œ.œ œ J . œ ‰ ˙ .‰ œJ ‰ ‰ ˙ .œœœ .. J ˙. ˙. œœ U‰ œV J ∑ ∑ ?# 3 œ # #4 œ And ∑ ˙˙ grace ∑ will ∑ lead œœ œ ˙˙ ∑ me ∑ home. ∑ ∑ ∑ ˙˙ .. ∑ ˙ .. ˙ ∑ when example we byfirstSchubert, be - the gun. melodyA at times MEN. In the Than following moves in a slightly different rhythm that the chords below. 3 ‰ & # G:4 I/3rd ∑ ∑ ∑ vi ∑ ∑ I/5th ∑ I/5th œ. œ œ. ? # # # 43 œ œœ . œœ œœœ ... n œœJ œœ .. J p ? V #œ# #.. 43œ ‰ œœ. œœ œ˙˙j œ œ œ œ. œ. O 7 wie sie wohl blü-hen im ___ ___ ___ Was Francis blind, Scott but Key now I Stafford see. Figure 14.2.1 and John Smith, “The Star-Spangled The hour I first be lieved. Banner” (1814) 172 ?# ∑ so œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ G/B Em G/D G/D D7 G 3œ ? & # # # 4œœ ‰œ ‰ Œ . J 12 Blu - men, U # O# œ say can you see, œ œ the by œ œ dawn's œ œ ( œ .)œear œ - œ ly. œ œ light, œ ‰‰ ‰ & # œ J œ ‰ œ œ .# œ œ œ . œ œ œ œ 167 # ∑ V ˙ # # G:6 I/3rd vi I/5th I/5th V7 I IV œ I œ œ œ œ œ œ œ plagal œ œ & # 8 ‰ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ TEXTURES œ œ œ œ œ œ cadence CHAPTER 14.œ ACCOMPANIMENTAL 145 p ? # # # 68 ‰ œJ ‰ ‰ œJ ‰‰ œ ‰ ‰ œ ‰ ‰ œ ‰ ‰ œ ‰ ‰ j ‰ ‰ œJ ‰ ‰ œœ ‰ ‰ Œ . J J œ œ Jœ . J J˙ œ œ ˙ œ œ Ich träum -te von bun -ten 161 say can you ? œ . œ œ œœ œ œ see, ∑ œœ ∑7 V ∑ ˙ ˙ I ∑ ∑ ∑ IV ∑ ∑ I ∑ ∑ œœ œœ .. œœ # œœ . œ œ . T œœ œ œœ . œ œ .. œ œ. œ œ œ. œ œ œ. J J π œœ . œœ j œ œ œ j ˙˙ 4 œ œ œ œ œ.. œ œœ œœ .. œ œœ &œœ .. 4 by plagal cadence the dawn's ear - ly light, ˙ 4 4 ˙ Figure 14.2.2 Franz Schubert, Winterreise, D.911, “Die Nebensonnen” (1828) ˙YT: 2n2YIxXJXac œ. œ œ ˙ #œ. œ œ œ # œœ œ Chorale textures are also described as “homorhythmic” because all of the parts move in the same rhythm. 12 & 44 œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ . ‰ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ. œ œ œœ œœ Some nights, I stay up cash - ing in my bad luck 12 ? 4 œœ 4 Some nights, I call it a draw œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ œ . ‰ œ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œ œ œ œœœ œ œ œ YT: Z0WDRq0xNtQ Figure 14.2.3 Jeff Bhasker, Nate Ruess, Andrew Dost, Jack Antonoff, “Some Nights” (2011) 705 b b b b b 42 W œ nœ œ œ œ œ œ œ & ww W CHAPTER 14. ∑ACCOMPANIMENTAL TEXTURES 146 w nW W π In the next section we will examine arpeggiated accompaniments. ? bb 4 ∑ bbb 2 W w 14.3 Arpeggiatedw Accompaniments W E¯m7 F 14.3.1 Arpeggios One way to express chords rhythmically is through arpeggios in one part and a bass line in octaves in a lower part, as in the following example from Beethoven’s Moonlight Sonata. & #### & #### C œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ3 œ œ3 œ œ3 œ œ3 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ simile sempre π e senza sordini ? #### C w w w w 709 ? #### œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œnœ œ œ œ #œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ww w ˙ ˙ YT: 4Tr0otuiQuU Figure 14.3.1 Ludwig van Beethoven, Moonlight Sonata, Op. 27, No. 2, I (1802) 54 The next example has descending arpeggios. 746 # 3 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ & 4 œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ Cmaj7 ? # 43 750 ˙. 3 Bm7 3 3 ˙. 3 3 3 3 3 ˙. 3 3 3 # 12 œœ œœ &Notice8that in œboth œ œthe Beethoven œ œ œ œ œandœ Alicia Keys examples there œ œ œ œthe œ œ œ œ œ (an octave plusœa third) betweenœ the bass is(lowharmonious interval of a tenth YT: Ju8Hr50CkwkAm G Figure 14.3.2 Alicia Keys, “If I Ain’t Got You” (2004) ? # 12 8 œ. œ. j œ ˙. œ ˙. est) voice and the soprano (highest) voice. 752 ˙. 3 12 Fmaj7 œ œ œ. œ. Am œ œ j œ ˙. œ ˙. œœ ? # 12 8 œ. œ. œ œ œ œœ j œ ˙. œ ˙. œ œ œ. œ. œ œ CHAPTER 14. ACCOMPANIMENTAL TEXTURES œ j œ ˙. œ ˙. 147 The following examples have arpeggios that ascend and descend through a chord. 752 54 746 12 &b 8 ? #b & ?# Fmaj7 œœœœœ œ Cmaj7 12 œ œ œ 438 œ œ œ œ œ œ ˙3 . 3 3 ˙. 34 œ œœœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ . œ 3. 3 œ 3 ˙. Am œœœœ œ œ Bm7 œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ . ˙3 3 3 ˙. œœœœ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œ œ. œ . œ 3 3œ 3 ˙. & b 14.3.3 James Pankow, “Colour My World” (1970) Figure 754 750 ? #b 12 & 8∑ G YT: cWkXmx-0phc Am ∑ ∑œ ∑ ∑ œ∑ ∑ ∑ œ ∑œ œ ∑ ∑ œ ∑œ œ ∑ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ ? # 12 8 œ. œ. œ œ j œ ˙. œ ˙. œ. œ. œ œ j œ ˙. œ ˙. # YT: zA-upjFaHvw & Figure 14.3.4 Fred Ball, Joseph Angel, and Robyn Fenty, “Love on the Brain” 752 (2016) ?# ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ Notice in the above example that there is also an organ playing block chords to create a sense of legato in the texture. The next two examples are from more recent popular music. # œ (œ)œ œ œ œ & 42 J (# œ) œ . J œ . J œ . œJ œ œ œ (œ) œ œ (œ) œ # œ . (œj) œ . CHAPTER 14. ACCOMPANIMENTAL TEXTURES 148 Í Motives: 401 A E ### 4 ≈ 4 œ œ œ œ œœœ œ œ œ œ 410& # Ne-ver mind I'll find some-one like & ## & # 44 œ œ œ œ œ œ 1œ 2 3 œ œ œœ œœ œ œ Bœ¯ ? # # # 44 ˙ ˙D F ˙ E e: 122 122 i iv G A: I 124 iio VF˜m i i V iv V D œ œ. ˙ œ œ you I wish œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œœœ œ ˙ ˙ ˙ vi 1 2 34 9 IV j b œF œ A œ. œ ˙ J.S. Bach & b b b 44 œ œ œ œ YT:œhLQl3WQQoQ0 Figure 14.3.5 Adele Adkins and Dan Wilson, “Someone Like You” (2011) Fm D¯ A¯ E¯ Menuet, BWV Anh. 116 - lo œ from œthe oth - er sideF˜m/Cœ˜ œ œ œ # 3 D Hel œ œ œ œ & b b b4b 44œ œ œ œ j œ œ œœ & j œ ˙ . . œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ? # # 44 œ œœœœ .. œ œ œ œ œ œœœ œ˙˙ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ ..œ œ œ œœœœ œ ˙˙˙œ œ œ œ œ Œ Ó Œ Ó ? # 43 4˙œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ˙œ œ œœœœœœ ? bb b b 4 j j œ . œ œ ˙ Bm_____ G_____ _____ _____ ._____ _____˙ G: œ 1 3 2 4 5 6 A¯: vi IV I V œ œ œ œ _____ œ _____ œ _____ _____ _____ _____ œ ? # # œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œÓ œ œ œ œ ( œ) Œœ ( œ) ˙Ó. Œ & œ A F˜m/A B7/A E/G˜ œ Amaj7 E/B B7 E pt pt nt ant # # # # 3 œ œ (œ) (œ) œ œ œ ‰ œ 415 œ œ ? # & J œ œ (œœ) œ œ ((œœ)) œ ˙ œ. ( œ) œ ? ## œ 4 œ œ3 œ œ E che so - YT: spi qHm9MG9xw1o - ri la li - - - ber - tà _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ # # Figure# 14.3.6 Œ 8 “Secrets” œœ œœœ (2009) ‰9 œj 10œœ (œ)11œœ œ12 œ ˙ . & #7 43 œœœRyanœœœ Tedder, œ arpeggios in Cadence œ in 44 with sixteenth notes.( ) "No Below Scrubs"is an example ant _____ _____ _____ nt type: _______________ _____ ˙˙˙ .. œ œ œ œ œœ ? b#b#b#b b#b b 3c œ œ Œœ .œ œ Œ & 4 œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ nœ _____ _____ _____ 135 124 411 413 139 126 126 _____ _____ _____ Lead-sheet symbols: 143 ? bb b b c œ bbb E: IV ii/3rd Roman numerals: a¯: _____ 1 V7/7th I/3rd œ œ _____ 2 YT: FrLequ6dUdM 13 IVM7 I/5th V7 I œ _____ 3 _____ 4 Kevin Briggs, Kandi Burruss, Tameka Cottle, Lisa Lopes Figure 14.3.7 Kevin Briggs, Kandi Burress, Tameka Cottle, Lisa Lopes, “No Scrubs” (1999) CHAPTER 14. ACCOMPANIMENTAL TEXTURES 10 149 14.3.2 Alberti Bass Score Alberti bass accompaniment patterns involve arpeggios that do not arpeggiate Piano Sonata K. 545, upward I Amadeus Mozart chords in a simple or downward motion, but in aWolfgang “low–high–middle–high” ( ) _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ pattern as you can see in the examples below. ( ) 145 œU œ bw. bw. mot. 1 U & c w˙. Allegro U œ w. . œ œ œU Œ w. w. w. œ œ ˙ œ Ÿœ œ œ œ Œ ∑ ∑ w. ? 6 w. 4 w. ƒ (Trumpets & Trombones) mot. 1 (dim.) 2 c œ & œ œ œ œ œœœ œ œ œ œ 2œ œ œ œ œ œ ? 46 œ ∑ œ œ ∑œ œ ∑ œ ∑œ œÓ ˙ b ˙œ ˙ œ w . œ œ ˙ . œ œ œŒ Œ ˙ b˙ ˙ w ._____ ˙ ._____œ _____ C: _____ _____ _____ _____ ƒ (Tubas) ? 46 1 ∑ 2 ∑ ∑ 3 4 ∑ YT: 5NkzTTkqTB4 5 ∑ ∑ 6 mot.7 1 (dim.) Ó. bœ œ œ œ ƒ 4 Cadence type: _______________ Figure 14.3.8 Mozart, Piano Sonata K. 545, I (1788) (Timpani) The nextOp. example example Piano Sonata, 10, No. 1,uses II the same Alberti pattern as in the Mozart Beethoven above, but transposed _____ register. _____ _____to E minor _____ and in a lower _____ 8 149 8 8 ?# 12 12 & # ?# 12 ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ _____ j Elec. Gtr. j b . ? & #b b b4 42 œœ ∑ (œœ .) œ œœ .œ œ ( n œœ) œ œœœ œ œ œ œ(œœœ) b œœ œ œ œœœ.. œ œ (œn œ ) 4 œ . œ J J p Keyboard œ. œœ œ œ œ # . œ œ 4 œ ? 2 œ œœ . œ. ‰ w ‰ & b b b b4 4 w œœ . w w œ w w w w g w_____ _____ ggg ww_____ ggg _____ ggg ww _____ ww Agg¯:w _____ 2 1 3 4 6 5 ? # 44 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ_____ œ _____ _____ œ œ _____ œ œ _____ œ œ_____œ œ œ__________ œ œ œ œ Elec. Bass 3 Ÿ œ œ œ .. bb œ .. œ œ œ œ( )(œ )œ œœ œœ œ . œ œnœœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ & b b œœ .. œ œœ œ œœ ggg œ œ œ œ œ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ YT: ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ‰ ∑ Í∑ L6zR7qJ9frA don't include cresc. œœ œœ œ œœ“Pipeline” j these œœ and . œ œ notes in g Figure 14.3.9 Brian Carman Bob Spickard, (1962) œ œ œ œ œ gg œ œ œ œœ your‰analysis ? bb b œ œ œ b ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ J ∑ ∑ Elec. Gtr. 153 T T __________ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ 14.4 Block Chord Accompaniments 7 10 12 13 8 9 11 ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ This section contains the following subsections below: • The “1 (2) &” rhythm • The “Barbara Ann” Rhythm • Repeated 8th-note Chords • Repeated Quarter-note Chords _____ 14 Cadence type: _______________ ∑ ∑ ∑ 12 & b 8 14. ACCOMPANIMENTAL CHAPTER œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ TEXTURES œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ 150 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ 14.4.1 The “1 (2) &” Rhythm ? 12 In thisb section, we will discuss some accompanimental rhythms that occur 8 frequently in popular music. The firstœsuch rhythm has two chords per measure, œ. . on the upbeat œ . after . on beat œ1 .and the. second˙chord with the first˙chord beat Fmaj7 752 Am 2. E¯ b & b b c œœœ ... 754 756 ? bb c b œ. # c D & œœ .. œ. j œœ ˙˙ œ ˙ Gm7 j œœ ˙˙ œ ˙ A¯ B¯ œœ .. œ. j j Em C D D Em œ ˙ . œ j œ ˙ j j œœ ˙˙ ww œœ .. œœœ ˙˙˙ œœ .. œœœ ˙˙˙ œ ˙ w œ. œ. j j YT: x6QZn9xiuOE ? # c œ . œj ˙ œ . œ ˙ œ œ . Ed Townsend, “Let’s Get˙ It On”w(1973) Figure 14.4.1 Marvin Gaye and w œ. œ ˙ œ. œ ˙ œ. œ ˙ You will find a similar rhythm and bass line in the next example. 760 & ## c ? ## c D œœ .. œ. œ. D/F˜ G j œœ ˙˙ j œœœ ˙˙˙ œœœ .. . j œ ˙ # & # G/A j œ ˙ œ. 762 YT: fdz_cabS9BU Figure 14.4.2 Ed Sheeran, “Thinking Out Loud” (2014) ? ## ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ The “1 (2) &” rhythm is also found in “Don’t You (Forget About Me),” a song associated with the film The Breakfast Club. 55 CHAPTER 14. ACCOMPANIMENTAL TEXTURES # & c 756 D5 œœ .. ? # c œ. œœ . . 760 ## C5 j œœ .. œœ ˙˙ j œœ .. œœ ˙˙ œ. œ ˙ D5 D5 j œœ .. œœ ˙˙ j œœ .. œœ ˙˙ œ. œ ˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙ D/F˜ D E5 G ww ww w G/A j YT: CdqoNKCCt7A j œ œ ˙ œ œ ˙˙˙ About Me)” . . œœ .. You œœ(Forget Figure 14.4.3 œœ .. Keith Forsey œ and ˙ Steve Schiff, “Don’t Score (1985) ?Below # # care five more examples of block chord accompaniment in the “1 (2) j j &” rhythm. œ ˙ œ. œ ˙ œ. Voice & c j œœ j œœ œ E5 151 bb 4 &bbb 4 œ 762 ## &b œœ ˙ b 4 œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ ˙˙˙ b b & b 4 Keyboard Nev - ? b# #b 4 œœ∑.. ? b b b 4 œ. œœ ˙˙∑ œ ˙ J Elec. Gtr. ? b b b 44 bb Elec. Bass. 4 b & b bbb ∑ er j œ ˙ œ. ∑ ∑ œ œ œœ ˙ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ ˙˙ œœ œ œœ ˙ nev œœ .. œ. - œœ ˙ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ ˙˙ œœ œ œœ ˙ er nev ∑ œœœ ˙˙˙ ∑œœœ .. j œ ˙ ∑ ∑ YT: zWzy5q_M5Ho er œœ ∑ ˙˙ œ ˙ J . J œ. - j œ ˙ œ. ∑ ∑ ∑ Figure 14.4.4 Holly Knight, Gene Bloch, Ann Wilson, and Nancy Wilson, bb b “Never” ∑(1985) ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ & bb ? bb bbb ? bb b bb ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ © 55 CHAPTER 14. ACCOMPANIMENTAL TEXTURES 4 D5 & b# 444 œ . œ & 4 œ. ? 4 œ. . b 4 œ œ Keyboard 1 756 Œ ‰ j . C5 œ œ œœ œ œœ ˙˙ œœ .. j Œ ‰ œ œ œ œ.œ œ œ œ œj E5 j ? Keyboard # 44 œ . 2 œœ ˙˙ >œ . > ? 4 œœœœ . ‰ œœœœ Ó ˙ b 4 756 760 ? b# 44 >œ œœ J 152 D5 E5 œjœ œ œ . œ . œ œ œ Œj‰ œj œ . œ œœ ˙˙ œœ .. œœ ˙˙ œ œ œ œ . œ . œ œ œ Œ ‰ œj œ . œ D5 œœ œœ œœ. ww œœ œœ œœ. j j œœ ˙˙ > œœ .. > œœ ˙˙ > ww>œ œÓ ˙ œœœ œ .‰ œœœ œÓ ˙ œœœ ‰wœœ Ó J J J œœ .. >œ œ .‰ œœ 55 55 ‰ jÓ ‰ jÓ D ‰ j Ó D/F˜ G ‰ j Ó G/A 4 j j # j œ & # 444>œœ . œ>œ ˙ j >œ . > œ ˙ >œ œ . >œ œ j˙ >œ >wœ & œœœ. .. œ ˙ œœ ˙˙œœ . œ ˙ œœ .. œ . œ œœ˙ ˙˙ w œ. œ ˙ œ. j j j ? ## 444 œ . œœ ˙˙ ww œœ ˙˙ œœ .. œœ ˙˙ ? .. iP6XpLQM2Cs # 4 œœ .. œ ˙ j œœœYT: j œ ˙ ˙ œ . Benny Blanco, w“Tik Tok” . œ Gottwald, œ ˙ Lukasz œ . Kesha Sebert, Figure 14.4.5 œ ˙ œ. D5 E5 C5 D5 D5 E5 (2009) 760 762 A¯13sus # # 4 E¯m9 j b b 4 j & b b b4 4œ . ‰ Óœ ˙ ‰ j Ó & œœ .. œœœ œœœ œ ˙œœœ œœœ œ œ œ œ© ? ## 4 4 j ? j b b b b b4 4œ . œ ‰ œj Óœ ˙œ ‰ œ Ó D/F˜ D D¯: (ii E¯m9 bb bb bbb b 44 œ ‰ œj Ó & & b b œœœ œœœ 762 766 V A¯13sus G Fm7 œœœœ.. œœ. G/A ‰ œj Ó œœj œœ œ j œœœ˙˙˙œ ‰ œœœœ Ó B¯9sus ‰ j Ó j œ ‰ œj Ó œœ. œ œ ˙ iii Fm7 ‰ œj Ó œœ ‰ œjœ Ó œ œœ œœ œœ PMivT7MJ41M œœ YT: vi) B¯9sus j œœœœ ‰ œœœœ Ó ? b b 4 ‰ jÓ ‰ œj Ó ∑ ‰ jÓ ‰ œj Ó ? bb b bb b 4 œ œ œ œ œ œ bb Notice that the example above (“That’s What I Like”) has the same pro- Figure 14.4.6 Bruno Mars, Philip Lawrence, Christopher Brown, James Fauntleroy, Johnathan Yip, Ray Romulus, Jeremy Reeves, Ray McCullough II, “That’s What I Like” (2017) (ii V Wind, and Fire. iii gression as D¯: “September” by Earth, 766 b & b 44 œ . œj œœ .. œœ j ? b b 44 œ . œ Gm B¯ B¯: vi I ˙˙ ˙ ˙ E¯ œœ .. œ. œ. IV j œœ œ j œ B¯ I ˙˙ ˙ ˙ j œœ œ j œ Gm B¯ œœœ .. . œ. vi I vi) ˙˙ ˙ ˙ j œœ œ j œ œ. E¯ œœ .. œ. IV B¯ I ˙˙ ˙ ˙ YT: RgKAFK5djSk Figure 14.4.7 Charlie Puth, Cameron Thomaz, Andrew Cedar, Justin Franks, Dann Hume, Josh Hardy, and Phoebe Cockburn, “See You Again” (2015) CHAPTER 14. ACCOMPANIMENTAL TEXTURES 2 8 153 (notated at pitch in grand staff) bb 4Ac.‰Gtr. r‰ j r r . & 4 œœ œ ˙ ‰ . œ ‰ œj ˙ ‰ . œ ‰ œj ˙ ‰≈ œr‰ œj œ œ œ . œ ˙ œ œ ˙ œ œ ˙ œ œ œœ ? b b 44 œœ .. œj ˙ j œ . œ ˙ œ . œj ˙ œ . œJ ˙ b 4 Organ b & 4 ww ww ww w ww w w ? b b 44 w w w w B¯: I &b 12 b V ∑ vi IV ∑ ∑ YT: 0yW7w8F2TVA ∑ Figure 14.4.8 James Arthur, Neil Ormandy, Steve Solomon, “Say You Won’t Let Go” (2016) ?Theb b example∑below has the “1∑(2) &” rhythm in∑ dimininution. ∑ 56 770 equivalent to: #### 4 j j Œ Œ & b 4 œ. œ œ. œ œ. œ Œ Ó C œ. œ Ó œ. œ Ó ∑ ∑ ∑ &b ? #### 4 œ Œ œ Œ œ Œ Ó 4 ? bb ∑ C ˙ ∑ Ó ∑ ˙ Ó j œ .∑ œ Ó ˙ Ó ∑ YT: oyEuk8j8imI #### 4 & 14.4.9 4 Justin Bieber, Benny Blanco, and Ed Sheeran, “Love Yourself” Figure 775 (2015) # ? # # The # 44 “Barbara ∑ ∑ Ann” ∑ ∑ Rhythm ∑ ∑ 14.4.2 ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ It is easier to describe the next block chord accompaniment pattern as the “Barbara Ann” rhytm than the “1 2 3 (4) & (1) & (2) & 3” rhythm. Below are six examples of pieces that use this rhythm, whether with block chords or 785 in the bass line. solely & #### ? #### ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ## & ## 791 ? #### F TEXTURES A CHAPTER 14. ACCOMPANIMENTAL b b D4 ∑ ∑ & b b bb 4 ? # # 44 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ? b b b œ4 œ œŒ œ . œÓ œ œ œ ˙ bbb 4 J J J 411 Bm Baa, baa, baa, baa, 154 j j j œœ œœ œœ .. œœ œœ œœ œœ ˙˙ œ œ œ œ œBaa,œ baa,œ baa,œ œbaa,œ œ œBar -œbar' œAnnœ œ œœœ œœ Œœœ .. œœ Óœœ œœ œœ ˙˙ J J J F˜m/C˜ Bar - bar' Ann, G Baa, baa, baa, baa, Bar - bar' Ann 5 ? # #b bœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ∑ ∑ & b b œb b Œ ∑ Ó YT: -bSnI-a0BSc Œ∑ Ó œ Figure 14.4.10 Fred Fassert, “Barbara Ann” (1961) 413 ??bb b b44b b b 415 9 b & b bbbb ∑ ∑ ∑ ‰ ‰ ∑ j ‰ j‰ j j j j œ œ œ. œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ. œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ∑ ∑ ∑ YT: w6MQrdfj638 ∑ ∑ ∑ ? bb b b ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ bb ? ## # j Œ‰ j ‰ equivalent jÓ Cto: j Ó j ‰j Ó j ‰ j j Ó ## # 4 Œ Œ . . œ. œ 15& œ. œ œ 4 œœ œœ œœ. œ œœ . œ œ œ œ œ bb b b . b . ∑. . .∑ œ. ∑ œ. œ. ∑ œ . œ. ∑ œ. œ. œ ∑ œ & b 423 ?? #### # # 44 œ Œ œ Œ œ Œ Ó C ˙ Ó ˙ Ó ˙ Ó YT: yRYFKcMa_Ek ? bbb ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ b b14.4.12 Figure Sara Allen, Daryl Hall, and John Oates, “Maneater” (1982) b Figure 14.4.11 Brian Holland, Lamont Dozier, Eddie Holland, “You Can’t 23 Hurry Love” (1966) 419 56 770 ? # #b b 4 & 4 œ œ œ. œœ œœ œœ .. ? b b 44 437 ? ## œ œ œ. 431 775 ‰ œj ‰ œj ˙ œœ œœ ˙˙ j ‰ j‰ j œ œ œ ˙ B¯ B¯: I b ?&# # 779 443 E¯ j œœ œ F E¯ IV V IV b j œœ œœ œœ .. œœ œ œ œ. œ ‰ œj ‰ œj ˙ œœ œœ ˙˙ ‰ ‰ œ œ œ . œj œj œj ˙ YT: iPUmE-tne5U Figure 14.4.13 Kimberley Rew, “Walking On Sunshine” (1985) ? bb ∑ ? ## 449 bb & 455 ? ## ? b 791 ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ? b 4 b 4 j ‰ j‰ j œ œ œ ˙ œ œ œ. j ‰ j‰ j œ œ œ. œ œ œ ˙ CHAPTER TEXTURES B¯:14. I ACCOMPANIMENTAL IV V A œœ 4 # # V #4# # œœœc & œ. Elec. Bass ? 44 ? #### c œ. Elec. Gtr. 56 779 770 œœ œœ .. œœ œœ .. œœœ . œœœŒ.. . C j j j . œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœœ œœ ‰ # œœ ‰ equivalent œ œ œ œ œto: œ œœœ. œ Œ œœ . œœœŒ œœœÓ œœœ œœœCœœœ œ œœ. . .œ œ - ‰ ‰ œ Œ œ j Œ œj Œj Ó œ. œ . œ. œ. œ- œ œœ. œœ .. œœ œœ .. œj œ . œœ Ó œ . C ˙ Ó œ œ. œ. œ . IV œœ. œœ. œœ- œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ ‰ œœ ‰ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ jœ œ œ œ œ œ œœ. œ œÓ œ œ .œ œœj Óœ œ J J J ‰ j‰ j Ó ˙ Óœ . œ. œ- œ ˙œj 23 783 V bb c j ‰ YT: j ‰ tuK6n2Lkza0 j j ‰ j‰ j ?&# # 14.4.14 œœ œœ œœ“Are .. jœœYou œ œ œœ ˙˙ Muncey, œœ‰ jœœ Be ˙ My Figure Nic Cester and œœ œœ œœ ..j œœ‰ j ‰œœ jCameron œ œ œ . œ ‰ jGonna œ ˙ œ œ ˙˙ Girl” (2003) œ œ œ . œ œ œ . œ. œ. œ. œ œ œ. œ. œ . œ. œ. œ. œ œ ? ∑b .c ∑.version ∑ of∑ this ∑j ‰ ∑joccurs ∑ in∑ Deep ∑ Purple’s ∑ j ∑‰“Smoke ?A slower j∑ ‰rhythm j∑‰ j∑ on ∑the b Water.” œ œ œ . œ œ œ ˙ œ . œ œ. . œ œ bœœ ˙ . œ ˙ œ. ? b b 44B¯:œœ. I œœ œ . œœIV ‰ œœ ‰ b œJ ˙ Vœœ. œœ œ . IVœœ ‰ œœ .. ˙˙ J J J A C j j j . . . . Elec. Gtr. œœ œœ œœ .. œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœœ œœœ œœœ ... œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ 427 c # œ œ œ . œ ‰ # œ ‰ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœ œœ œœ .. œœ ‰ œœ ‰ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ ?Vb b œœœ œœœ œœœ ... œœœ œœœ YT: œ- œ_zO6lWfvM0g œ œ œ œ œ œ . œJ œJ œJ œ œ œ œ . . . . Figure 14.4.15 Ritchie Blackmore, Ian Gillan, Roger Glover, Jon Lord, and Elec. Bass Ian? Paice, “Smoke on the Water” (1973) c j ‰ j‰ j j ‰ j‰ j 437 œ œ. œ. œ . œ. œ. œ- œ œ œ. œ. œ . œ. 8th-note œ. œ- œChords 14.4.3 ? b Repeated b B¯ 775 419 423 779 E¯ F E¯ Repeated 8th-note chords occur regularly in “classical” music textures. 783 155 &c ? bb 443 ?c ? b b r #œ œ œ .œ œ œ . r œ œ #œ f œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ ˙ œ . œ œ œ .œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœœœ œœœœ œœœœ œœœœ œœœœ œœœœ œœœœ œœœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ r œ #œ YT: bZZqSZqJz4Y Figure 14.4.16 W.A. Mozart, Piano Sonata K. 310, I (1778) ? bb œ. œ œœœœ œœœœ œœœœ œœœœ œœœœ œœœœ œœœœ œœœœ 449 455 ˙ 19 CHAPTER 14. ACCOMPANIMENTAL TEXTURES 177 177 177 177 180 180 180 180 & b 42 &b &b ? & bb ? &b 2 Œ 244 œ . p . 24 Œœœ œ . p 2 œœ. 4 &b œ &b œ ∑ ‰ œ ∑ . ‰œ. œœ . œœ. œ . œœ. œ . œœ. ∑ Íj œ œ . Íj œœ. œ . œœ. j œ j œœ œ ∑ > ? b œœ œœ œœ œœj œ &b œ j >œœ œ œ > ∑ œ œ œ œ œœ. œ . œœœ œ œœ. œœ. ∑ œœ œœ 156 ∑ > œœ œ . ∑ # œœ œ œœ œœ. >œœ. œ œ # œœ . œ œœ œ œ œœ. œœ. œœ œ œœ . œœ . .. .. œœ œ œ œ œ œ # œ œ ∑ m œ œ ∑œ œ œœ œœ œœœ œœœ œ œœœ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ m œ œœ œ œ œœ œœ # œœ œœ œœ .. .. ? b œœ∑ œœ ∑ œœ ∑œœ ∑œœ œœ∑ œœ ∑ œœ ∑ œ∑ œ ∑ œ ∑œ ∑.. œ œ œ œ œ & œ œ œYT:œ5kaA3X2qSPU > 184 > # œœœ Í >œ œ # œœœ Í >œ ∑œ ∑œ œœ ∑ œœ 19 œ œœ œ.∑ œπ œ œœœ. œœ œ œœ π. œ ∑œœ. œ œ œ. œœ œ. œ. œœ ∑. Figure 14.4.17 Franz Schubert, Winterreise, D. 911“Gute Nacht” (1828) 184 184 184 b ∑ & &c Ó ? ∑F ∑ ‰ œj ∑ ∑ & cb œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ >œ œ œ œ >œ œ F ?c Ó ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ œ. œ ˙ ∑ Ich grol- le nicht, ˙ ˙ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ‰ œ œ œ b˙. und wenn das Herz ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ œœ ˙ auch bricht. ∑ Ó ∑ ∑ ∑ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ >œ œ œ œ b >œ œ œ œ >œ œ œ œ >œ œ œ œ # >œ œ œ œ > ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ YT: lOdjXYp13-Y Figure 14.4.18 Robert Schumann, Dichterliebe, “Ich grolle nicht” (1844) The next example is from the musical Annie. Note the “1 (2) &” rhythm in the bass line. 20 CHAPTER 14. ACCOMPANIMENTAL TEXTURES b & b œ.œ œ œ 188 It's a hard - knock b &b ‰ 188 Œ ? b ‰ b &b 191 b for us, œœœ œœœ œœœ . . . j œ‰‰ œ > Œ ∑ j œ ‰ œ œ ‰ œ. œ œ œ. j‰ œ ‰ œ . œ œ œ œ œ life ∑ It's a hard - knock œœœ œœœ œœœ . . . j œÓ œ > œœœ . life ∑ for us œœ œœ œœ œ. œ. œ. j œ ‰‰ œ > œœœ . YT: R5wAGQIt39E 157 ∑ 'Stead of treat - ed œœœ œœœ . . j œ Ó œ > œœœ . œœœ . ∑ œœœ . ∑ Figure 14.4.19 Charles Strouse and Martin Charnin, Annie, “It’s the Hard 191 Knock Life” (1977) bb ∑eighth notes∑ are a standard ∑ accompanimental ∑ ∑texture in rock. ∑ &Repeated ? b b c ∑œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ∑œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ ∑œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ∑œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ∑œœ œ œ œ œ∑ œœ œœ bb œœœœ F5 787 787 791 E¯5 D¯5 B¯5 C5 E¯5 ? bb c bb œœœœœœœœ œœœœœœœœ œœœœœœœœ œ œ œ œ œ œ F5 E¯5 D¯5 B¯5 C5 E¯5 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ? b b 4 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ 4 œœœœ 791 b b ? bb b YT: 9JtlCuIqcrM b Figure 14.4.20 Geoff Gill and Cliff Wade, “Heartbreaker” (1979) ? b b b 44 The brepeated eighth-note rhythm is also common in recent popular music. œ œ œ œ œexample œ œ œ œ œ œ œtheœ œ1950’s œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ(i.e., œ Note ? that bb b b the∑ following ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ uses ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ progression ∑ ∑ ∑ œ ∑œI –œ∑viœ –œIV ∑œ – ∑V ). F Am/E Dm7 œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ Piano œ œœœœœœœœ œœœœœœœœ œœœœœœœœ œœœœœœœœ 4 b & 4 ? b 44 œœœœœœœœ œœœœœœœœ œœœœœœœœ œœœœœœœœ Elec. Gtr. Elec. Bass œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ &b 795 YT: Sv6dMFF_yts Figure 14.4.21 Nate Ruess, Andrew Dost, Jack Antonoff, and Jeff Bhasker, “We Are Young” (2011) ? b ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ 57 ∑ ∑ 57 CHAPTER 14. ACCOMPANIMENTAL TEXTURES 158 14.4.4 Repeated Quarter-note Chords F5 E¯5 D¯5 787 447 787 791 452 791 795 795 457 799 462 Test 2 Review Analysis œ œ œ œ œchords œ œ œ are œœ œœaœœcommon œœ œœ___œœ œœ œœaccompanimental œœ œœ œœ ___ œœ œœ œœ___ œœ œœ___ œœ rhythm Repeated quarter-note inœ “clas?Lead-sheet: 4 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ___ ___ ___ b b œ 4 sical” band music. ( ) ( ) œ œ œ œ b popular ( ) 3 ## 3 & 44 ˙ . œ ? œ œ œ œB¯5˙˙ .. C5 E¯5 D¯5œ œ œ b b b b 4 p œF5œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ E¯5œ ˙ . œœœœœœœœ œ ? b b b 44 œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ ? # #b 43 Fœ œ œ œ Dm7 œ œœ œ œ œœœ œœœœ œœœœ œ œœœ œœœœ œœœœ œ œœœAm/E œ œœœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœœ œœ œœœ œœ œœœ œœ œ œ œ Piano œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ .œ œ .œ œ .œ œ œ. œ .œ œ. œ œ œ. œ œ. œ. œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ. œ œ. œ œ. œ 4 b ? b b 4b 44 & b œ œ œ œ œ œ ___ œ œ œ œ œ œ ___ œ œ œ œ œ œ ___ œ œ œ___œ œ___ œ œ œ___ D: ___ œœœœ ? b 44 ___œF œ œ œ œ œ œ___ œ œ œ œ œX9yTjXM6m50 œ ___ œAm/E œ œ Dm7 œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ___ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ___ œœ œœ___ œœ œœ___ Elec. Gtr. œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œYT: œ œ œ œ œ œ # œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœœ œœ œ œœ œ œœ Elec.Piano # 14.4.22 .œœ œœ œœ George . . “Ombra mai fu,” Xerxes, Figure Frideric Handel, & bBass œ œ 40 œ HWV 4 œ̇ œ (1738) & 4 œ œ œœ œ̇œ œœ œœ œ̇œ œœ œœ œ̇œ . œœ œœ œ œ œ F ? 4 ? 4b# # 4 œ œ œœœ œœœ œ œb œ œ œ œ œœ. œœœœ œœ œ œœ œ œb œœœ œœœœœ œœœœœ.. œœœ œœœœ œ & 4 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ . œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ Elec. Gtr.. . . . . . œ. œ . œ . œ. .œ œ . .œ œ . Elec. Bass œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ? 4 ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ 4 œ. œ. œ.___œ. ___œ. œ. œ. œ___ œ. œ.___œ. ___ œ___ œ. œ. ___ . œ. ___ . œ. ___ & 44# # œœœ . œœ jœœ. œœ. b œœ. œœ. œœ .. œœ œœ. œœ œœ œœ. œœ. b œœ. jœœ. œœ .. œœ œœŒ. 799 & .œœ .œ (œ ) œœ ( œœ)# œ (œœ ) œ (œœ ) œ œ̇ . n œœ. œœ. œœ œœ œœ. œ (œ ) ˙ œ ( )œ ˙ ? 44 YT: b2rBhpVDzO8 & Figure 14.4.23 œ. œ. œ.Joeœ.Raposo, œ. œJon œ.Stone, œ. andœ. Bruce œ. œ.pHart, œ. œ “Can œ. œ.Youœ. Tellœ. Me ? # . œ Œ How to#Get to Sesame Street?” (1969) ˙ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ˙ ? ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑G ∑ ∑ œEm∑ G7/D G D/F˜ # œœœ œœ___œœ ___œ ___ ___ ___ & 44___œœœ œœœ ___œœœ œœœ(skip œœœthis œœœbar)œœœ ___ œ œ œœ œœœ œœœ œœœ n œœœœ œœœœ Lead-sheet: ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ . 424 œœ (œ ) ∑ œœ (œ) œœÓ (œ) œœŒ (œ‰) œj(œœ )˙ œ œœ (œ ) ˙ œ (œ ) œœ œœ ? b 42 œœ (œ) œœ (œ) œœ œ ? & #b YT: uuumirxhmAw Figure 14.4.24 “She’s ___ Got a Way” F: ___ Billy ___ Joel, ___ ___ (1971) ___ B¯5 C5 E¯5 œ̇ œ (œ ) œ ˙ ˙ ( ) ˙˙ ___ 57 33 57 CHAPTER 14. ACCOMPANIMENTAL TEXTURES bb 4 & b b b b 4 œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ E¯sus4 E¯m 58 803 ? bbb bb bb & b b bbb 58 803 ? bb b b b & & b bb bbb b 58 803 807 E¯sus4 E¯m 159 A¯m/C¯ C¯ A¯m/C¯ C¯ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ E¯m E¯sus4 E¯m 4 E¯sus4 4 œ Œœ œÓ œ Óœ œ œ‰ j œ 4 œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œ Œ œœ œ A¯m/C¯ C¯ Ó Ó ‰ j œ œœœ œœœ œœ œœœ œœœ œ œœœ A¯m/C¯ C¯ œœ œ 44 Œ Ó Ó œ ‰œ j œ œ Œœ Ó Ó 44 œœ œœ œœ œœ YT: œœ œœ œœ œœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œ œ œ œ œœœ œœmjwV5w0IrcA œ œ E¯sus4 E¯m E¯sus4 E¯m A¯m/C¯ C¯ Figure 14.4.25 Lou Gramm and Mick Jones, “Cold As Ice” (1977) E¯ Dm ? 44 Œ Ó Dm/F ? bbbbb b bb b bb Gm ∑œj j j ∑ j Ó j ‰j∑ jj j ∑jŒ jÓ j ∑ Ój j 4 b & b 4b œ ‰ œ ‰ œ ‰ œ ‰ œ ‰ œ ‰ œ ‰œœ œ‰ œœœ ‰œ œœ ‰ œœ ‰ œœ ‰ œœ ‰ 807 œœ œœ œœ œœ . . . . ? b 44 Gm j 813 b bb b 4b ‰j‰œ œ.j‰ Ój‰ j‰ & b b 4b b œœ œœ œœ œœ & œ. œ. œ. œ. ? b 4 ‰ j Ó 811 ? bb b 4b b œ œ.∑ b 807 & b ‰ j œœœ œ œœœ A¯m/C¯ C¯ j ‰‰ j∑j‰ j‰ œœœ œœœœ œœœœ . . . œœ œœ œœ œœ œ. œ. œ. œ. œ. . . . . Dm/F E¯ ‰ j Ó ‰j j j Ój j Dm ‰ Ó j ‰œ œ.j‰ j‰ j‰ œ ‰œ œœ ‰ œ ‰ œ ‰ œj ‰œj œj ‰ œj ‰ œj ‰ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ. œœ.. œœ. œœ. œœ œœ. œœ œœ . . . . œ. œ. œ. œ. ‰ j Ó ‰ j Ó ‰ j Ó œ. 3T1c7GkzRQQ œ œ.∑ ∑ œYT: ∑ ∑ œ œ. ∑ Figure 14.4.26 Gordon Sumner, “Roxanne” (1978) 811 ? b b ∑4 & b bbbbb 4 &bbb 819 D¯ œœ œ. ∑ œœ œœ œ. œ. ∑ œœ œ. G¯maj7 œœœ . 3 j > 819 œ œ ? 4 œ b œ Œ Œ Ó ? bb & bb bb b bb b 4 œ∑ œJ œ œ.∑ œœœ . ? bb bbb ∑ b & b ∑ œœœ . ∑ œœœ œ. E¯m9 œœœ œ. œœœ œ. ∑ ∑ œœ œœ œ. œ. D¯/A¯ A¯ œœœ œ. ∑ œœœ œœœ . . 3 3 3 j 3j j œ œ. . j œ œ œ Œ œ∑ œ œ Ó ∑ Œ œ œ œ∑ Œ Œ œ Œ œ∑ œ J œ œ. > œ œ. > J 3 3 815 œœœ . ∑ ∑ YT: zS-_wGmn8jk ∑ 3 ∑ ∑ Figure 14.4.27 Michael Bublé, Alan Chang, and Amy Foster-Gillies, “Haven’t Met You Yet” (2009) ? bb b ∑ bb ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ˙ ? #### œ Sara Bareilles "Love Song" nœ œ ˙ œ #˙ CHAPTER 14. ACCOMPANIMENTAL TEXTURES F/A B bsus2 &b œ œ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ ? j j b œ Œ ‰œ ‰œ œ œ œ Gm 67 71 & www C C œœœ œœœ œœœ œœ jœ j Ó ‰œ ‰œ œ œ Dm ∑ w ∑ 160 D/F # "second inversion" E w wC ˙ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œ #œ Ó ‰ j‰ j #œ œ #œ ww wG Figure 14.4.28 Sara Bareilles, “Love Song” (2007) ? ˙ F œœœ œœœ œœœ œœ œ j œj Ó ‰œ ‰ œ œ "first inversion" ww w ˙ C/E ww ww wYT: qi7Yh16dA0w w "root position" œ ∑ www w In the next section, we will examine accompanimental textures consisting E of afterbeats and offbeats. G David Foster, Jay Graydon, Goodrum fifth of chordRandy is lowest note "Who's Holding Donna Now" 77 of chord is lowest note third of chord is lowest note 14.5rootAfterbeats and Offbeats# Badd2 D m7 G m7 #### 4 œ ˙ œ ˙ j j œ ˙ # 4 œœ . 14.5.1 & Afterbeats œ œ œ J œœ ˙˙˙ œ .. œ œœ The term “afterbeats” is from Fundamentals ofœ.Musical Composition by noted . œ ? # # # #and4 pedagogue w j are repeated composer Arnold Schoenberg.œ “Afterbeats” 4 w # œ occur ˙ after the J notes) that chords (usually eighth notes, sometimes quarter # downbeat. b & b bb C 815 sempre piano e dolce w ˙ œ n œ œ œ œ œ b œ Œ œ. ˙. ˙ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ ? b b b C Œ œ œ œ Œ œ œ œ Œ œœ œœ œœ b 820 b œ . & b bb œ œ Œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ˙ T œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ Œ œ œ œ Œ œ œ œ œ œ ˙. œ œŒÓ œ œ œ œ œ œ ? b b b Œ œœœ œœœ œœœ Œ œœœ œœœ œœœ Œ œœ œ œ Œ œ œ œ Œ œ œ b 825 829 YT: ˙ pfwIAozfjoI œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ 2 j ˙ & 4 14.5.1 œ Ludwig van Beethoven, Piano Sonata Op. 2, No. 1, IV (1796) Figure In thepnext example, the afterbeats are not repeated chords but instead are passing-tone figures harmonized in thirds. œ œ #œ ‰ œ œ ‰ & 42 ‰ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ &œ œ œ #œ œ &œ ? ˙ f ‰ œœ œœ œœ ˙ ‰ œœ œœ œ 59 ? b b b Œ œœ œœ œœ Œ œœ œœ œœ Œ œ œ œ Œ œ œ œ Œ œ b CHAPTER 14. ACCOMPANIMENTAL TEXTURES 825 829 2 j &4 œ p & 42 ‰ ˙ ˙ ‰ œ œ œ œ œœ ‰ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œ & œ œ œ #œ œ & œ ? œ 161 œ œ ˙ f ‰ œœ œœ œœ œ #œ ˙ ‰ œœ œœ œœ YT: ZixdOZh7zo4 Figure 14.5.2 W.A. Mozart, Piano Sonata K. 279, III (1775) 14.5.2 Offbeats Offbeats are typically chords that occur regularly on upbeats, avoiding downbeats. While there are many styles of music that use chordal offbeats, in this section we will consider only polka and reggae styles. 14.5.2.1 Polka The polka, which originated in Bohemia, has connotations with Germary and Oktoberfest. The polka in the United States is often associated with Frankie Yankovic, who was known as the “Polka King.” 60832 b œ œ. œ. œ. & b b 44 œ œœ. ‰ œœ ‰ œœ ‰ œœ J J J . . . . ‰ œœœ ‰ œœœ ‰ œœœ ‰ œœœ J J J J Accordion ? b b 44 œ b œ Piano & Ac. Bass œ œ œ œ b &bb œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ 834 YT: jF-5zBjEIDM Figure 14.5.3 Jaromír Vejvoda, “Beer Barrel Polka” (1927) ? b b ∑Reggae ∑ ∑ b 14.5.2.2 ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ Reggae is associated with the island of Jamaica and, in terms of texture, is characterized by offbeats, often played on an electric guitar. Bob Marley is CHAPTER 14. ACCOMPANIMENTAL TEXTURES 162 closely associated with reggae music. 17 # # 4 œœ .. & 4 œ œœ œ ≈œœ Ó Clavichord √ j œ œ ? # # 44 œ œ ≈ œ ‰ . œ œ œ œ œ œ R ? ## 4 4 j j j œœ ‰ œœ ‰ œœ ‰ œ œ œ ‰ ‰. Elec. Bass. 60832 œœ Accordion b b b 44 œ œœœ 19& # # ∑ ∑. & r ‰ ‰. œ œœ . . ‰ œœœ ‰ œœœ ‰ ∑J ∑ J ∑ œ≈œ œ œ œœ Ó œ œ ≈ œ ≈ œ ≈ œ œ œ œ œJ ‰ Muted Elec. Gtr. Gtr. # #Elec. 4 ‰ & 4 œ. œ. j œœ œ ‰ œœj ‰ œœj ‰ œœj ‰ œ œ œ ‰ ‰ ≈ r ‰ r œ œœ œ œœ .œ .œ .œ . œœ ‰ œœ ‰ œœ ‰ œœœ ‰ J∑ ∑J ∑ J ∑ J ∑ YT: g3t6YDnGXAc œœ. œ J∑ ? b b 44 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ b By the lateœ 1970s,œBritish bands like The Police and UB40 were recording œ œ œ∑ ∑œ ∑ style. ? #that ∑ reggae ∑ accompanimental ∑ ∑ ∑œ ∑ œ ∑ songs # ∑used the Piano & Ac. Bass Figure 14.5.4 Bob Marley, “Could You Be Loved” (1980) 834 Œ j œœ œ #b# 4 ∑Œ & & 4 j j j j j œ ‰∑ œœ ‰∑ œœ ‰∑ œœ ‰ ∑œœ ∑ ‰ œœ ∑ ‰ œ. œ. œ. œ. œ. Dm Elec. Gtr. ∑ ? #b 44 ∑ ∑ ∑ ? # œ. œ œ ˙ . Elec. Bass &b B¯/C ∑ ∑ œ∑ ∑ ∑ . œ œ ˙. j œœ ∑‰ œœ . ∑ j œœ ‰ œœ ∑ . j œœ œœ ∑ . ∑ ∑ C ∑ ∑ œ. œ œ 837 YT: mbv-LcdLY-Y Figure 14.5.5 Gordon Sumner, “Walking on the Moon” (1979) ? b ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ? b 44 œ Elec. Bass œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ. œ œ ˙ . C œ œ œ163 œ. œ œ ˙ . j. j j j j j j j œ ‰ œœœ ‰ œœœœ & b 44 Œ D¯ ‰ œœœ ‰ G¯œœœ ‰ œœœ ‰ œœœ A¯/E¯‰ œœœœ ‰ œœœœ G¯/A¯ Elec. Gtr. . . . . . . . . bb b b 4 ‰ œj ‰ œj ‰ œj ‰ œj ‰ œœj ‰ œœj ‰ œj ‰ œj & b Elec. 4 Bassœœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ ? b 44 œ. œ œ ˙ . Elec. Bass œ. œ œ ˙ . œ. œ œ ? b b b 44 œ œ bb œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ . œ œ . D¯ G¯ A¯/E¯ G¯/A¯ . Elec. Gtr. œ. œ j jœ j œ j bb b b D¯:4 I‰ œj ‰ œj IV‰ œj ‰ œj V/5th ‰ œœ ‰ œœ & b 4 œœ œœ œœ ‰ œœœ ‰ œœœ IV/5̂ œœ œ œ 839 b b b b bBass & Elec. ? bb 4 œ œ œ œ YT: GVVZ_O0_vUc bbb 4 œ œ œ œ . œ œ in 1983 œ . Diamond, œ Figure 14.5.6 Neil “Red Red Wine” (recorded by . œ œUB40) œ œ . ?Reggae ∑ ∑ is fairly ∑common ∑in the IV/5̂ ∑ ∑ as accompanimental texture present day, b b b b b D¯: I IV V/5th 834 Dm B¯/C CHAPTER 14. ACCOMPANIMENTAL TEXTURES Elec. Gtr. 837 837 can be heard in the following examples. E 839 Gtr. # # # # Elec. 4 ‰ j‰ & 4 œœ œ. ? # # # # 44 Elec. Bass œ F˜m/C˜ j j œœ ‰ œœ ‰ œ. œ. œœ≈œœ œ . . . Œ E F˜m/C˜ j j j j œœ ‰ œœ ‰ œœ ‰ œœ ‰ œ. œ. œ. œ. œ œœ≈œœ œ . . . ‰ j œœ œ. œœ YT: luzciaIHL04 Figure 14.5.7 Gwen Stefani and David Stewart, “Underneath It All” (2001) CHAPTER 14. ACCOMPANIMENTAL TEXTURES j Gtr. j # # # # Elec. 4 œ œ ‰ œ ‰ œ V # 4 œ. œ. ‰ Elec. Bass ? # # # # 44 Œ ≈ # œ œ œ B 841 843 V #### ? #### 845 2 V #### # œ œ Œ ≈ # ‰ œœj ‰ œœj ‰ œœj ‰ œœj œ. œ. œ. œ. ‰ Œ ≈ ‰ j œ œ œ œ ‹œ œ # œ œ œœ ‰ j Œ #œ œ œ ≈ œœ œ œ YT: BFG0aiDrmUk ? #### # ∑ G¯ A¯ ? b b b 44 bb D¯ Elec. Bass œ. D¯: IV V B¯m A¯ j j j j ‰ œœœ ‰ œœœ ‰ œœœ ‰ œœœ . . . . j j œœ ‰ œœ œ. œ. Œ œ œ œ . œ ∑ œœ ‰ œœ œœ œœ œœ ‰ œœ œ ‰ œ œ œ œœ ‰ œœ œœ œœ œœ ‰ œœ œœ œœ Elec. Gtr. b b b 4 ‰ œj ‰ œj ‰ b & b 4 œœ œœ . . 12 j j œœ ‰ œœ œ. œ. Figure 14.5.8 Jason Mraz, “I’m Yours” (2007) b & b b b b 44 12 F˜ . . . j j j j E œ. # ‰ œœ ‰ œœ ‰ œœ ‰ œœ ‰ œœ ‰ œœœ ‰ œœœ ‰ œœœ œ. œ. œ. œ. J J J J G˜m Muted Elec. Gtr. 12 164 ≈œ œ Œ œ œ . œ œ œ œ. I ‰ vi V œœ b ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ & b b b b ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ YT:∑ PIh2xe4jnpk 14 Figure 14.5.9 Nasri Atwey, Adam Messinger, Mark Pellizzer, Ben Spivak, Alex Tanas, “Rude” (2013) 14 b & b bbb ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ 14.6 The 3–2 Son Clave ? bb b ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ bb 14 The 3–2 son clave (and the 2–3 son clave) are essential rhythmic elements in Afro-Cuban music. In this section we will see how cross rhythms implied by the 3–2 son clave can be viewed as a possible source of cross rhythms in popular music. Here is a video demonstration of a 3–2 son clave. b & b bbb 30 b & b bbb 30 ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ 61 CHAPTER 14. ACCOMPANIMENTAL TEXTURES 165 YouTube: https://www.youtube.com/watch?v=dxVeiPQ1juo 419 419 421 421 423 425 Here is rhythmic notation of a 3–2 son clave. Notice there are three attacks 23 in the first measure and 2 attacks in the second bar. 23 ã 44 Û ã 44 Û ‰ Û Œ Û Œ Û J ‰ Û Œ Û Œ Û The 1 rhythm 2 3 underlying 1 J 2 the 3 first 1 bar2 is 3+3+2. > > > 1 Û 2Û 3 Û 1 Û 2 Û 3 Û 1 Û 2 Œ Û Û ã > > > Û ã 44 Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Œ Û Û Û Û Œ Œ Œ Œ 423 ã ã 44 Û The 3–2 son clave has also been called the “Bo Diddley Beat” because of 3+3+2 eighthsin note in sixteenth notesabove as you its use by Bo in Diddley the 1950s. Look at3+3+2 the rhythms shown listen to the following examples. 440 ‰ Û Œ J Û 44 Û ≈ Û ‰ Û Ó J 3 1 2 ã 1> 2 3 1> 2YT: 9kAhqaPMsdQ > Figure 14.6.1 Willie Dixon, “Pretty Thing” ã 44 Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Ó 447 ã ã 426 YT: 5OOcnPVdKrs Figure 14.6.2 Bert Berns, Bob Feldman, Jerry Goldstein, and Richard Gottehrer, “I Want Candy” 454 ã YT: LKdHy18rZcI ã 14.6.3 Russ Ballard, “New York Groove” Figure 454 YT: oOmUCbDofo4 Figure 14.6.4 George Michael, “Faith” YT: z8rQ575DWD8 Figure 14.6.5 U2, “Desire” 419 419 421 421 421 423 423 423 425 425 425 426 426 430 432 23 4 Û ‰ Û Œ Û Œ Û Û Œ ã4 23 J CHAPTER 14. ACCOMPANIMENTAL TEXTURES 166 Û Û Œ ã 44 Û1 2 ‰ 3 Û 1 Œ2 3 Û 1 2 Œ 4 J Û> ŒRhythm Û> Œ Û Û Œ 14.6.1 ã 4 Û> The ‰3+3+2 4 Ûexamples J Û 3theÛ first Û Œ Û Û Œ Inã the 41 2 Û 3 Ûbelow, 1 Û 2only 1 Û bar 2 of the 3–2 son clave is used. Below, the >3+3+2 rhythm> is shown in both eighth notes and sixteenth notes. The >1 2 1 2 version 3 1 is known 2 3 as tresillo. sixteenth-note Û Û Œ ã Û >Û Û Û > Û Û Û > Û Œ 4 Û3+3+2Û in eighth Û ÛnotesÛ Û Û Û 3+3+2 Œ in sixteenth Û notes Û Œ ã4 44 Û ≈ Û ‰ Û Ó Û ‰ Û Œ Û ã 443+3+2 in eighths Jnote 3+3+2 in sixteenth notes J Û 3+3+2 ‰ in eighths Û Œnote Û Û 3+3+2 ≈ Ûin sixteenth ‰ Û notes Ó ã The example below shows the sixteenth-note subdivisions in the 3+3+2 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 44 Û ≈ Û ‰ J Û Ó ‰ J Û Œ> Û rhythm. ã 44 Û> 4 Û Û ÛJ Û Û Û Û> Û Ó J ã4 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 4 Û1> Û2 Û3 1Û> Û2 3Û Û>1 Û2 Ó ã4 > 4 Û Û Û Û> Û Û Û> Û Ó ã4 44 Û ≈ Û ‰ Û Ó 44 Û ‰ Û ‰ Û Ó 44 Û . Û ‰ Û Ó 44 Û . Û . Û Ó ã Below are different ways of notating the sixteenth–note version 3+3+2 426 J J J rhythm. ã 3 + 3 + 2 3 + 3 + 2 3+ 3+2 3+ 3 +2 ã 44 Û1 ≈2 Û3 ‰1Û2Ó3 1 244 1Û2‰3Û1‰ 2Û 3Ó 1 2 44 Û . Û1 ‰2 3Û 1Ó2 3 1 244 1 Û2 .3Û1. 2Û 3Ó1 2 J J J ã 44 Û . Û Û Û Û . Û Û Û 44 Û . Û . Û Û . Û . Û 454 The first example, by the Rebirth Brass Band, uses a “second line” drum430 ming ã pattern, which is associated with second line parades in New Orleans. ã 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 > > > > > > 4 Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û ã4 YT: cczwRUBxNL8 Figure 14.6.6 Reggie Calloway, “Casanova” (1987) The well-known 3 + introduction 3 + to “Eye 3 of the + Tiger” 3 uses+the 23+3+2 + rhythm. 2 434 > > > 4 >Û Û Û >Û Û Û YT:>Û btPJPFnesV4 Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û ã4 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 1 2 Figure 14.6.7 Frankie Sullivan and Jim Peterik, “Eye of the Tiger” (1982) In the following example from Cyndi Lauper’s “Girls Just Want to Have Fun,” the lead electric guitar riff emphasizes a 3+3+2 rhythm in 16th notes on each downbeat. CHAPTER 14. ACCOMPANIMENTAL TEXTURES Elec. Gtr. 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 123 123 12 j bb 4 Œ & b b b b 4 œœ .œ œœ ‰ œœ œœ Û ‰ Û patch) Œ Û Œ (Polysynth ã 44Keyboard j J bb 4 œ ‰ œœœ œœœ Œ & b b b b 4 œœ . 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 > > > Organ .. .. .. .. 4 ã&4 b bÛb b b b Û44 Û‰ œœœÛœœœ ‰ Û œœœ œœœÛ‰ œœœÛ œœœ ‰ Û œœœ œœœ 419 421 167 œœ .œ œœ ‰ œœj œœ Û Û Œ ∑ œœ Œ‰ œœ. œœ.Û‰ œœ. œœ.Û‰ œ œŒ‰ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ .. Muted Elec. Gtr. . . œ. œ. œ. notesj . œ. œ. ≈ œ.note œ. œ. œ. ‰ ‰ œ 3+3+2 ? b3+3+2 4in eighths œ œ œin≈sixteenth b ≈ ≈ b b 4 J œ.Ó ‰ œJ bb ‰ Û Œ 4 4 Û Û Û ≈ Û ‰ Û ã4 4 J Elec. Bass J ? b b b b 44 j2 3 1 2 j 1b b 2 3 1 œ œ > > > œ œ ˙ œ œ . . 4 ã4 Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Ó 423 425 430 œœ œœ œ. œ. ‰ bbb ∑ ∑ Want∑ to Have∑ Fun” (1983) ∑ ∑ &4 b b 14.6.8 b Figure Robert4∑Hazard, ∑“Girls Just 4 4 . . . Û ≈ Û ‰ Û Ó Û ‰ Û ‰ Û Ó Û Û ‰ Û Ó Û Û Û Ó ã 4Below is an example4 showing the 3+3+2 4 rhythm (in 16th4 notes) immediJ J J ately repeated. The rhythm is shown in two possible notations below. bb ∑ 3 + 3∑+ 2 3∑ + 3 +∑2 & b b 3b b + 3∑ + 2 ∑ 3 + ∑ 3 + 2∑ 3 426 23 YT: PIb6AZdTr-A ã 44 b bÛ .b b Û ∑Û Û ∑ Û . & bb Û Û Û ∑ ∑ ? b ã b bbbb ∑ 1 23 1 2 3 12 123 1 2 3 12 44 Û . Û . Û Û . Û . Û ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ 12312312 12312312 The following three examples all use the (3+3+2)+(3+3+2) rhythm as a 432 rhythmic ostinato or groove. ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ? b 14.6.9 ∑ ∑ Toby∑ Gad, “All ∑ of Me” ∑ (2013)∑ 443 Figure and b b b b b ∑John Stephens ã Notice that this progression is from the Best-Seller progression. YT: 450p7goxZqg 450 ã ∑ ∑ YT: lY2yjAdbvdQ Figure 14.6.10 Shawn Mendes, Teddy Geiger, and Scott Harris, “Treat You Better” (2016) J 4 Û> ã4 425 > Û J > Û 1 2 ACCOMPANIMENTAL 3 1 2 3 1 2 CHAPTER 14. TEXTURES Û Û Û Û Û 168 Ó YT: jVCxZlpj8dw 4 4 4 4 ã 4 Û ≈ Û ‰ Û Ó 4 Û ‰ Û ‰ Û Ó 4 Û. Û ‰ Û Ó 4 Û. Û. Û Ó This rhythm J also occurs in theJfollowing classicalJpiece by Ligeti. 426 Figure 14.6.11 Ed Sheeran, Steve Mac, Johnny McDaid, Kandi Burruss, Tameka Cottle, and Kevin Briggs, “Shape of You” (2017) 3 + 3 430 + 2 3 + 3 + 2 3+ 3+2 3+ 3 +2 44 Horn, . Û ÛGyörgy . ÛPiano, . Û Û Ligeti, Û . ÛTrioÛ forÛ Violin, Û . Ûand Û . IIÛ(1982) Figure ã 44 Û 14.6.12 1 23 1 2 3 1 2 1 2 3 YT: 1 2 W6HQ2Za75k0 3 12 12312312 12312312 The following examples have the (3+3+2)+(3+3+2) rhythm in 8th notes. > > > 4 Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û ã4 432 1 2 1 3 2 1 3 > > > Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û 1 2 2 3 1 2 1 3 2 434 ã YT: d020hcWA_Wg Figure 14.6.13 Guy Berryman, Jonny Buckland, Will Champion, and Chris Martin, “Clocks” (2003) 450 ã 24 YT: h_L4Rixya64 Figure 14.6.14 Grohl, Hawkins, Mendel, Shiflett, “Best of You” (2005) 3 + 3 + 3 + 3 + 3 + 3 + 3 + 3 +2+ 2 +2+ 2 > > > > > > > > > > > > ÛÛÛÛ ÛÛÛÛÛÛÛÛÛÛÛÛÛÛÛÛ ã 44 Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û ÛYT: PIh2xe4jnpk 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 435 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 1 2 1 2 1 2 Figure 14.6.15 Nasri Atwey, Adam Messinger, Mark Pellizzer, Ben Spivak, Alex Tanas, “Rude” (2013) 437 4 ã 4 Û. 1 14.6.1.1 3 + 3 + 4 + 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 Habanera and Reggaeton Û Û Û ‰ 4 3 1 Û J 2 + Û 3 3 Û. 1 2 3 The reggaeton beat is built from a 3+3+2 rhythm. We will see a relationship between the reggaeton beat with the habanera. First, let us examine the famous “Habanera” bass line from the opera Carmen. 438 440 ? 2 b 4 ?b œ. ≈ œ œ. œ. œ. ≈ œ œ. œ. YT: iqlUlr2yzY8 Figure 14.6.16 Georges Bizet, Carmen, Habanera (“L’amour est un oiseau rebelle”) (1870) ? 447 454 b b 4 œ . œ. œ. œ . œ. œ. CHAPTER 14. ACCOMPANIMENTAL TEXTURES 169 23 ( ) ( ) Compare the habanera pattern above to the reggaeton beat below, notated for bass drum and snare drum. ?b ≈ œ œ. œ. œ. ‰ Û Œ Û ã 44 Û Snare Drum J 4 ã 4 œ1 ≈2œ œ3 œ 1 œ 2 ≈ œ3 œ 1 œ 2 > Drum > > 4Bass Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û ã4 440 419 442 421 ≈ œ œ. Û Û œ. Œ œ. Œ œ œ œ œ œ ≈ œ œ ≈ œ Œ Û Û Œ Compare the “reggaeton” rhythm to the 3+3+2 of the first bar of a 3–2 444 son clave (refer to the second measure in the example below). ã 423 ã 44 Û 3+3+2 in eighth notes 4 Û> ã4 425 ‰ Û Œ J > Û 44 Û ≈ Û ‰ Û Ó J 3+3+2 in sixteenth notes Û > Û Here are examples of songs with a reggaeton beat. 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 Û Û Û Û YT: VQqwea8ZSbk Û Ó Figure 14.6.17 Wycliffe Johnson and Cleveland Browne, “Dem Bow” (1990) 426 430 ã 44 Û ≈ Û ‰ Û Ó J 44 Û ‰ Û ‰ Û Ó 44 Û . Û ‰ Û Ó J YT:J 6vjv9O4c1do 44 Û . Û . Û Ó Figure 14.6.18 Aubrey Graham, Paul Jefferies, Noah Shebib, Ayodeji Balo+ 3 Errol + 2Reid,3Kyla + 3Smith, + 2 Corey Johnson, 3+ 3+ 2 Dance” 3 + 3 (2016) +2 gun, Luke3 Reid, “One 1 23 1 2 3 12 123 1 2 3 12 12312312 12312312 ã 44 Û . Û Û Û Û. 44 Û . Û . Û Û . Û . Û Û Û Û YT: kJQP7kiw5Fk > > > > > > 4 Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Notice that the progression for “Despacito” comes from the Best-Seller ã 4 progression. Figure 14.6.19 Luis Rodríguez, Erika Ender, and Ramón Ayala, “Despacito” 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 (2017) 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 432 3 434 + 3 + 3 + 3 + 2 + 2 > > > > > > ã 44 Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û 1 2 3 1 2 3 YT: 1 8ELbX5CMomE 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 1 2 Figure 14.6.20 Bieber, Michaels, Tranter, Moore, and Tucker, “Sorry” YT: FjvxZO4BX38 Figure 14.6.21 Karen Marie Ørsted, Jonnali Parmenius, and Uzoechi Emenike, “Final Song” (2016) 426 ã 44 Û ≈ Û ‰ Û Ó J 44 Û ‰ Û ‰ Û Ó J 44 Û . Û ‰ Û Ó J 44 Û . Û . Û Ó CHAPTER 14. ACCOMPANIMENTAL TEXTURES 430 ã 44 Û . 3 + 3 + 2 3 + 3 + 2 Û Û Û Û. 3+ 3+2 170 3+ 3 +2 44 Û . Û . Û Û . Û . Û 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 1 2 3 YT: 1 2 DCBmhs4dYzc 3 12 12312312 12312312 Figure 14.6.22 Adam Levine, John Ryan, Jacob Kasher Hindlin, Justin Tranter, and Phil Shaouy, “Cold” (2017) Û Û Û In the next two sections, we will examine expansions of the 3+3+2 rhythm 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 > > 14.6.2> 3+3+3+3+2+2 > > > 4 Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û 4 section, we will see each number in the 3+3+2 pattern repeated,ÛgenInã this 432 1 2 3 1 2 1 3 2 erating the 3+3+3+3+2+2 pattern. 3 434 + 3 + 3 + 3 + 2 + 2 4 >Û Û Û >Û Û Û >Û Û Û >Û Û Û >Û Û >Û Û ã4 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 1 2 Listen for the 3+3+3+3+2+2 rhythm in the following examples. YT: co6WMzDOh1o Figure 14.6.23 U2, “Beautiful Day” (2000) YT: PKRuEY68BVA Figure 14.6.24 Aluna Frances and George Reid, “You Know You Like It” (2012) YT: cLyUcAUMmMY Figure 14.6.25 Janee Bennett, Jessica Glynne, Jack Patterson, and Ina Wroldsen, “Hold My Hand” (2015) 14.6.3 8 Groups of 3 Plus 4 Groups of 2 the 3+3+2 pattern can also be expanded to 8 groups of 3 sixteenth notes followed by 4 groups of 2 sixteenth notes, as shown in the example below. 24 3 + 3 435 + 3 + 3 + 3 + 3 + 3 + 3 +2+ 2 +2+ 2 > > > > > > > > > > > > ã 44 Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û Û 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 1 2 1 2 1 2 Listen for this rhythm in the examples below. # ã # 437 ? CHAPTER 14. ACCOMPANIMENTAL TEXTURES 1. c˜: N6 2. b: N 3. G: ¯VII7 4. d: viio65/V 5. F: N46 3 + 3 + 3 + 3 + 3 + 664 3 + 3 171 6. f˜: N6 + 3 +2+2 +2+ 2 123 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 123 1 23 1 2 3 1 2 3 12 1 2 1 2 1 2 > >œ œ > >œ > > > # # 4 œ . > >œ œ > >œ . > œ‰ J œ‰ œ ‰ J œ‰ œ œ #œ œ & 4 61 F˜ j Jr., “Ghostbusters” j j (1984) Elec. Gtr. j # # #14.6.26 j j j j Figure # # 4 ‰Rayœœ Parker, œ œ œ ‰ œœ ‰ œœ ‰ œœ ‰ œœ V 4 œ. ‰ œœ. ‰ œœ. ‰ œœ. œ. œ. œ. œ. Elec. Bass ? # # # # 44 Œ ≈YT: XjVNlG5cZyQ ‰ Œ ≈ ‰ j # œ “Raise œ Your Glass” œ œ (2010) ‹œ œ # œ Figure 14.6.27 œPink, Max Martin, Johan Schuster, œ œœ B 841 YT: Fe93CLbHjxQ . . . j j j j E œ. ‰ œœ ‰ œœ ‰ œœœ ‰ œœœ ‰ œœœ V # ‰ œœœ ‰ œœœ ‰ YT:œœœ IIkqOLvuQNo œ. J J J J . Many . Zooz, .“Warriors” Figure 14.6.28 Too (2016) ? #### Œ ≈ ‰ j Œ ≈ # Other 14.6.3.1 œ œ Combinations œ œ of 3s# œand œ2s œ œ œ œ œ You will also find other combinations of 3s and 2s (or 3s and 4s). #### 843 G˜m bb b 4 œœœ ... œœœ œœœ œœœ ‰ œœœ œœœ œœœ ... & b 4 J Fm 845 ? bb 4 b b 4 œ . œ œ œ ‰ œj œ œ . b & b b3b + 3 ? bb b b ∑ œœ .. œœ œœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ ... œ. œ œ ‰ J E¯ D¯ ‰ j œ œ œ. œ. œ œ œ 847 24 + 3 + 3 YT: + 3KQ6zr6kCPj8 + 3 + 3 + 3 +2+ 2 +2+ 2 1 14.6.29 2 3 1 2 Stefan 3 1 2 Gordy, 3 1 2 3Skyler 1 2 3Gordy, 1 2 David 3 1 2 Listenbee, 3 1 2 3 1 Peter 2 1 2 Schroeder, 1 2 1 2 Figure > (2011) > > > > > > > > > “Party 4 >Rock >Anthem” ã4 ÛÛÛÛÛÛÛÛÛÛÛÛÛÛÛÛ ÛÛÛÛÛÛÛÛÛÛÛÛÛÛÛÛ 435 ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ Notice that this progression is from the i–VII–VI–VII progression. The rhythm in the above example is dissected below. 437 ã 44 Û . 1 3 2 + 3 3 1 Û Û 2 + 3 4 1 Û 2 + ‰ 3 4 3 1 Û J 2 + Û 3 3 Û. 1 Listen for the 3+3+4+3+3 rhythm in the following examples. # ã # 438 2 3 bb 4 &bbb 4 œ œœ ˙ Voice œ œœ ˙ CHAPTER 14. ACCOMPANIMENTAL TEXTURES b b b 4 œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ ˙˙˙ b & b 4 Keyboard Nev - er œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ ˙˙ œœœ œœ ˙ nev - er œ œœ ˙ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ ˙˙ œœœ œœ ˙ nev - er 172 YT: SeIJmciN8mo œ ˙ œœ Falk, ˙˙ Rami œœ Wayne ˙˙ . .. œ œœ .. Yacoub, ? b b 14.6.30 œœ ˙˙NadirœœKhayat, Figure Maraj, Carl .. bb 44 œœOnika œ ˙ œ. œ ˙ œ. b Bilal Hajji, “Starships” Hector, and (2012) J J J Elec. Gtr. ? b b b 44 bb Elec. Bass. œ. j j œ ˙YT: iS1g8G_njx8 œ ˙ œ. j œ ˙ œ. Figure 14.6.31 Max Martin, Savan Kotecha, Ilya Salmanzadeh, Amethyst Kelly, Ariana Grande, “Problem” (2014) One also finds the 3+3+4+3+3 pattern in the second bar of “Tik Tok,” an example from earlier in the chapter. 4 & b 44 œ . œ œ œ Œ ‰ œj œ . œ œ œ œ œ œ œ . œ . œ œ œ Œ ‰ œj œ . œ œ œ œ œ œ œ . j j ? 4 . b 4 œ œ œ œ Œ ‰ œ œ.œ œ œ œ œ œ œ. œ. œ œ œ Œ ‰ œ œ.œ œ œ œ œ œ œ. Keyboard 1 > ? b 44 œœœ Keyboard 2 ? b 44 œ > >œ ‰ œœ Ó J ‰ jÓ œ > >œ œœ œ > >œ ‰ œœJ Ó ‰ jÓ œ > >œ œœ œ > >œ ‰ œœ Ó J ‰ jÓ œ > >œ œœ œ > >œ ‰ œœJ Ó ‰ jÓ œ > YT: iP6XpLQM2Cs Figure 14.6.32 Kesha Sebert, Lukasz Gottwald, Benny Blanco, “Tik Tok” (2009) Notice that this progression comes from a rotation of the i–VII–VI–VII progression. 14.7 Distinctive Bass Lines © Sometimes the identity of a song is in its repeated bass line (known as a “riff,” which is a short repeated pattern). Listen to the distinctive bass lines in the following examples. YT: KjuF89RvfIA Figure 14.7.1 Joseph Eastburn Winner, “Little Brown Jug” (1869) YT: eeFpUDCyTUo Figure 14.7.2 Lennon-McCartney, “Day Tripper” (1965) CHAPTER 14. ACCOMPANIMENTAL TEXTURES 173 YT: Er9xGRolrT4 Figure 14.7.3 Bernard Edwards and Nile Rodgers, “Good Times” (1979) YT: rY0WxgSXdEE Figure 14.7.4 John Deacon, “Another One Bites the Dust” (1980) YT: QYHxGBH6o4M Figure 14.7.5 Rick James, “Superfreak” (1981) YT: a01QQZyl-_I Figure 14.7.6 David Bowie, “Under Pressure” (1981) YT: JtpX8KBT768 Figure 14.7.7 Amethyst Kelly, Charlotte Aitchison, George Astasio, Jason Pebworth, Christopher Shave, Kurtis McKenzie, “Fancy” (2014) YT: a5qZOMQ1qys Figure 14.7.8 Ben Haggerty, Ryan Lewis, Jacob Dutton, Eric Nally, Joshua Karp, Joshua Rawlings, Darian Asplund, Evan Flory–Barnes, Tim Haggerty, “Downtown” (2015) 14.7.1 Distinctive Guitar Riffs You will also find distinctive riffs played by guitar in conjunction with bass, as in the following examples. YT: fTTsY-oz6Go Figure 14.7.9 Ray Davies, “You Really Got Me” (1964) YT: y8OtzJtp-EM Figure 14.7.10 Jimmy Page and Robert Plant, “Immigrant Song” (1970) CHAPTER 14. ACCOMPANIMENTAL TEXTURES 174 YT: 4c8O2n1Gfto Figure 14.7.11 Steven Tyler and Joe Perry, “Walk This Way” (1975) YT: pAgnJDJN4VA Figure 14.7.12 Angus Young, Malcolm Young, and Brian Johnson, “Back in Black” (1980) This chapter is meant to give you ideas about animating chords and chord progressions with accompanimental textures, including riffs. It is by no means meant to be exhaustive, but rather to encourage you to listen closely to texture and accompaniment. Chapter 15 Creating Contrast Between Sections In this chapter, we will explore how a composer or arranger can create contrast between different sections in a piece of music. 15.1 The Elements of Music Creating contrast usually involves varying one or more of the “Elements of Music,” which are listed and explained below. Table 15.1.1 The “Elements of Music” Melody Harmony Rhythm Timbre Texture Articulation Dynamics Register We all know what melody is, but don’t confuse melody with ostinato! Melody lives and breathes and has variety. In this section, we will associate harmony with key and mode (major versus minor). What the most common rhythmic value is in a section. The different tone colors of different instruments, and the different tone colors an individual instrument can produce. Described in the previous chapter as existing in the vertical plane (the number of voices) and the horizontal plane (rhythmic activity of the various voices). Staccato versus legato, or short, clipped notes versus long, sustained or connected notes. Loud versus soft. High versus middle versus low. In the next two sections we will look at how two different pieces exhibit contrast between various sections using the elements of music. 175 CHAPTER 15. CREATING CONTRAST BETWEEN SECTIONS 176 15.2 Mozart, Eine kleine Nachtmusik, K. 525, II. The second movement of Mozart’s Eine kleine Nachtmusik is a five-part rondo form (ABACA). Let us examine the elements of music in the first section (the A section). Vln. I Violino I Vln. II Violino II Vla. Vc. Viola Violoncello e Contrabasso 14 Vln. I & . œ œ œ œ œ œ . œ œ œJ œ œJ œ œ œ . J J‰ & C J ‰J ‰ p j j & C œj‰ œj ‰ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ . œ œj‰ œ. œ œ œ œ p BC Ó ∑ ∑ ?C Ó ∑ ∑ Figure 15.2.1 Vln. II Vla. ∑ Œ œ œ œ ∑ ∑ œ œ ∑ Harmony ∑Rhythm Texture ∑ ∑ ∑ Articulation Dynamics Register The key is C major The 8th ∑note is most ∑ common∑ rhythmic ∑value, ∑ though the phrase begins with quarter-note values The top two instruments are grouped together against a simple bass part ∑ legato ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ Generally Soft Neither extremely high nor low ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ & ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ B ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ? ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ 21 Vln. II ∑ YT: o1FSN8_pp_o ∑ ∑ Notice how Mozart expresses the various musical elements: ? Vln. I œ œ Œ œ j j œ. œ œ œ œ ≈ œ œ ≈ œ . œ œj‰ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ & ∑ Table 15.2.2 A Section, Second Movement, Eine kleine Nachtmusik B Vla. œ œ œ œ p œ. œ œ œ œ œ œ œ . œ œ‰ J J ≈ ≈ J & Here is the beginning of the second section (the B section): Violoncello e Contrabasso Vc. CHAPTER 15. 14 Vln. I Vln. I Vln. II Vln. II Vla. Vla. c. Vc. 14 Vln. I Vln. I Vln. II Vla. Vla. c. c. c. 17 Vln. I Vln. II Vla. œ. œ. &C p Violino I &C œ œ Violino p. II. . . BC œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ Œ œ Œ œ œ œ œ C p CREATING CONTRAST BETWEEN SECTIONS 177 ?C Ó œ. œ. &C œ. œ. C & .œ œ. œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ. œ. œ. œ. #.œ œ. œ. # œ. œ. œ ‰ œœ . œ ‰ œ ‰ œ . œJ œ œ œ œ œ . œ œJ ‰ J œJ œJJœ œJ œ œ ≈ œ œ ≈ œ . œ œ ‰ C J J J p œ. œ. œ. j ‰ œ œ œ œ œ œœœ œ j #œ ‰ ‰ œ n œ œ . . . . j œ j j ≈ .≈ j‰ œ œ ‰C j j œ œ œ œ œ œ œ. œ œ. œ .œ . œ. œ . œ œ. œ œ œ œ œ .œ . œ . œ œj œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ. œ. pœ Œ Œ p. . . B. C Ó œ œ œ œ œ ? C ?C Ó Violoncello e Contrabasso p Viola ∑ ∑ ∑ Œœ œ œœ. œœ. œ.œ œ. œ Œœ œ ŒŒ œ œ œ p ∑ œ. œ. œ. œ. œ C œ C . . ∑œ. œ. œ. ∑œ. œ ∑œ œ œ œ œ∑ œYT: ∑œ. œ. #∑œ . œ.o1FSN8_pp_o œ∑ ‰ ∑œ. œ. # œ∑ œ b b∑b C & œ C & J Figure 15.2.3 B Section, Second Movement, Eine kleine Nachtmusik p C ∑ are the∑ most ∑noticeable j ‰∑ œdifferences: ∑œ œ ∑œ œ œ œ∑ ∑ œ. œ.∑ œ. b b∑b C &Here œ œ œ œ œ œ Bœ Section, #œ Table 15.2.4 Second Einen œkleine . . Movement, . . œ œ. Nachtmusik p. . . . . œ. most Rhythm are rhythmic œ. œ. œ. œ. œ8th notes œ. œthe œ. common œ œ. œ.value, œ.∑ œ. b b∑b C B C Œ Œ with some 16th-note runs B ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ All four voices move in the same rhythm at the pTexture .œ œ. œ. œ. beginning of each subphrase œ. œ. œ. œ. ? CArticulation œFour Œstaccato b C Œ notes start each subphrase ? ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ œ. œ. ∑œ. œ. ∑œ ∑ ∑ ∑ b ∑b Now,plook at the beginning of the next contrasting section (the C section): T T T œ. n œ œ. n œ œ. œ bb b C Œ nœ J ‰ Œ Œ nœ J ‰ Œ Œ & p b & b b C œœ œœœœœœ œœœœœœœœœœ œœœœœœ œœœœœœœœœœ œœœœœœ p B bbb C œ œ n œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ n œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ n œ œ œ œ œ œ p T T . n j . n j œ œ ? bb C Ó Œ Œ nœ œ ‰ Œ nœ œ ‰ Œ b p 17 YT: o1FSN8_pp_o Figure 15.2.5 C Section, Second Movement, Eine kleine Nachtmusik The following elements are noticeably changed: œ œ œ #œ œœ j j j j œœ. ‰ œœ. ‰ œœ. ‰ œœ.178 ‰ œ ‰ œ ‰ œ ‰ œ ‰ # V œœ œœ œ œœ œ œ œ œ J kleine J Nachtmusik J J Table 15.2.6 C Section, Eine . . Secondœ. Movement, . This section begins in C minor ## ? # Harmony Œ accompaniment ≈ ‰ j Œ ≈ #Rhythm # œ œ The œ œ # œmovesœ in œ16th notes and œtheœ œ ornamentation of the second melody note (the œ #### G˜m E CHAPTER 15. CREATING CONTRAST BETWEEN SECTIONS 843 turn) in the outer parts sounds as four 32nd notes The middle two parts (Violin II and Viola) are E¯ D¯ paired together and the Violin I and Cello/Bass part engage in imitation The middle parts are played in a “separated” manner (more staccato than legato) and the motive in the outer voices starts with a staccato note bb b 4 œœœ ... œœœ œœœ œœœ ‰ œœœ œœœ œœœ ... b 4 & Articulation J TextureFm 845 œœ .. œœ œœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ ... œ. œ œ ‰ J ? bb 4 b b 4 œ . œ œ œ ‰ œj œ œ . œ . œ œ ‰ j œ œtransitional œ œ. Listen to how Mozart puts the entire form together, including material to smooth out the changes from one section to another. A B A C A legato 8th notes staccato 8th notes legato 8th notes staccato 16th notes legato 8th notes Vn1+Vn2 vs Bass C major All 4 together C major Vn1+Vn2 vs Bass C major Bass imitates Vn1 C minor Vn1+Vn2 vs Bass C major YT: o1FSN8_pp_o Figure 15.2.7 Formal Diagram of Second Movement, Eine kleine Nachtmusik 15.3 “Rude” by MAGIC! 2 Now we will examine contrast in recent popular music. Here is the musical example of the texture from the reggae section of this song, as seen in the previous chapter. b & b b b b 44 G¯ A¯ D¯ Muted Elec. Gtr. 12 œœ ‰ œœ œœ œœ œœ ‰ œœ œœ œœ Elec. Gtr. b b b 4 ‰ œj ‰ œj ‰ b & b 4 œœ œœ . . 12 12 ? b b b 44 bb Elec. Bass œ. D¯: IV Œ œ œ œ œ. V j j œœ ‰ œœ œ. œ. B¯m A¯ œœ ‰ œœ œœ œœ œœ ‰ œœ œ ‰ œ œ œ j j j j ‰ œœœ ‰ œœœ ‰ œœœ ‰ œœœ . . . . ≈œ œ Œ œ œ . œ œ œ œ. I vi ‰ V œœ In Verse 1 there is no bass drum, snare drum, or electric bass. All we hear are the voice part and the two guitar parts from the top two staves in 14 b & b bbb ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ b & b bbb ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ 14 14 CHAPTER 15. CREATING CONTRAST BETWEEN SECTIONS 179 the example above. There are fewer voices occurring on the vertical plane, creating a light texture. YT: PIh2xe4jnpk Figure 15.3.1 Verse 1 of “Rude” The bass guitar and drum groove enter in Verse 2, thickening the texture and adding the backbeat of the snare drum. YT: PIh2xe4jnpk Figure 15.3.2 Verse 2 of “Rude” In the pre-chorus, the guitars and bass have legato half notes and quarter notes while the drummer plays cross-stick eighth notes (if one is counting in a slow 44 ). Without the snare drum backbeat, the texture lightens. YT: PIh2xe4jnpk 419 23 Figure 15.3.3 Pre-Chorus of “Rude” ã 44 Û The chorus has approximately the same accompaniment as Verse 2 but the voice parts are in a higher register, repeating a 2-measure subphrase containing the “hook.” 421 ‰ Û J Œ Û Œ Û Û > > > 4 Û Û Û Û Û Û Û ã 4emphasizes a (3+3+2)+(3+3+2) rhythmÛ on allŒ instru-Û The post-chorus 1 2YT: PIh2xe4jnpk 3 1 2 1 3 2 Û Figure 15.3.4 Chorus of “Rude” ments (guitars, bass, and the bass drum, snare drum, and hi-hat of the drum set). 423 ã 44 Û 3+3+2 in eighth notes 425 ‰ Û Œ J 2 44 Û ≈ Û ‰ Û Ó J Û 1 3 Œ 3+3+2 in sixteenth notes > 4 Û> YT: PIh2xe4jnpk Û Û Û Û ã4 Figure 15.3.5 Post-Chorus of “Rude” 1 Œ 2 > Û 1 3 Û 2 Û Ó Below is a formal diagram of the first five sections of “Rude.” 426 430 432 ã 44 Û ≈ Û ‰ Û Ó J ã 44 Û . 3 + 3 + 2 2 3 2 3 1 2 44 Û . Û . Û Ó 3+ 3+2 3+ 3 +2 44 Û . Û . Û Û . Û . Û Û Û Û 12 123 1 2 3 1 44 Û . Û ‰ Û Ó J 3 + 3 + 2 Û Û Û Û. 1 23 1 2 3 1 44 Û ‰ Û ‰ Û Ó J 12 12312312 12312312 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 legato 8th notes A: I staccato 8th notes legato 8th notes Vn1+Vn2 vs Bass All 4 together Vn1+Vn2 vs Bass ? ### J staccato ii16th notes j œj œ œj Œ Ó ‹ œ . œ œ J legato 8th notes j œj œ œj Œ Ó œ. #œ œ Bass imitates Vn1 Vn1+Vn2 vs Bass C major C major C major C major E A C minor CHAPTER 15. CREATING CONTRAST BETWEEN SECTIONS 299 Verse 1 V Verse 2 ? ### 4 No bass/drums 4 w 303 16th notes A: I 308 D legato E whole notes IV Chorus Post-Chorus w All instruments legato elements A 3+3+2 rhythm I w All instruments w No snare drum A staccato staccato 8th notes Pre-Chorus 180 staccato E 16th notes V Open hi-hat V œ YT: PIh2xe4jnpk ˙˙˙ ˙˙˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ Figure 15.3.6 First 5 Sections of “Rude” ˙ ˙ & ˙ ˙ ˙˙ ˙ ˙˙ ˙ ˙˙˙ ? 44 ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ I This five-section unit repeats again with Verse 3, Verse 4, the Pre-Chorus, C: I and vi IV V versus I vi ii/3rd V Chorus, Post-Chorus. When you listen to the entire piece, you hear how the musicians designate G the form using the elements of articulation, C rhythm,Am texture, Fand dynamics. One element that changes very little during entire song is the chord progression, which we examined in the chapter on harmonic progression, and is a rotation C: I vi IV V of the 50s progression. 309 311 G¯≤ ? b b b 44 bb w D¯≤: IV ? bb b bb A¯≤ D¯≤ B¯≤m V I vi w w w While you are likely aware of successful songs in the which very few musical 315 elements change, it is worth considering how you can articulate the form of your compositions and arrangements using the elements of music. ? bb b bb 323 ? bb b bb 327 Chapter 16 Figured Bass 16.1 Historical Context In the Baroque era in music (roughly 1600–1750 C.E.), a shorthand was developed for writing chords. (Lead-sheet symbols are the modern shorthand for representing chords). Figured bass (also known as thoroughbass) consists of a bass line notated on a staff accompanied by numbers representing intervals to be played above the bass note within the key signature. (These figured-bass numbers are traditionally notated below the bass line.) Figure 16.1.1 George Frideric Handel’s handwritten manuscript of Recorder Sonata in A minor, HWV 362, I. Larghetto 181 20 j & œ . œ œ œ j‰ œ ‰œ œ . œ œ œ œœ ‰ œ œ œ ‰ œœ . œ œ œ . œ #œ œ œ . œJ œœ #œœ œ œ 3 Œ & 4 It's a hard-knock life for us, 6 It's a hard-knock life for us 'Stead of treat - ed 4+ 6 3 7 6 6 7 6 6 bb ‰ Œ 6 7 6 2 & œ œ œ œ œ œ œ . œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ. œœ œ œ œœ œ œœ ? 43 œ . œ œ œ œ œœ.œ .œœ.œœœ.œ .œœ.œ œœ. œœ. œ œœ. œ œœœ. . œ œ. œ. œ. œ. œ. œ œœ. . œ. œ. œ œ. j3 œj 3 ? b ‰ Œ 3 j‰ ‰ j Ó 3 œ ‰‰ Ó b œ œ œ >œin A minor, HWV Figure 16.1.2 George Frideric Handel, Recorder Sonata œ œ > 362, I. Larghetto, without > figured > bass realization bb 188 CHAPTER 16. FIGURED BASS 863 188 867 191 191 &3 & 4 Œ ?∑ & 43 œ J œ. œ œ œ œ œ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ œ ∑ ∑ ∑ œ∑ œœ œœ œ œ œœœ # œœœ œœœ œ œ œœ œœœ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ. œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ . . œ œ œ ? 43 884 œ œ. œ œ. œ œ. 3 6 3 3 & 4+ 7 6 6 ? & 195 œœ ∑ œ œ #œ 182 3 7 6 ∑ 3 3 ∑ 6 2 ∑ YT: ljj6URbK8Xg ∑ œ œ #œ œ 3 œœ ∑ œ œœ∑ œœ∑ œ ∑œ œ œ. œ œ œ œ œ œ. 7 3 6 6 3 ∑ Figure 16.1.3 George Frideric Handel, Recorder Sonata in A minor, HWV 195 362, I. Larghetto, with figured bass realization ∑ &Like lead-sheet symbols, ∑ ? ∑ figured bass allowed a keyboardist or guitarist freedom in choosing chord voicings. While some early music specialists perform from scores with the original notation, editions of Baroque compositions by composers like J.S. Bach and Handel that were originally notated with figured bass have been “realized” or written out in modern editions. In the present day, figured bass is taught in music theory courses primarily as a shorthand for chord inversion symbols (although many music programs also endeavor to teach students to perform at the piano music written with figured bass notation). ∑ 16.2 Figured Bass Inversion Symbols Following are the figured bass inversion symbols most commonly used for triads and seventh chords. (Remember that figured bass numbers represent intervals above the bass note within the key signature.) 63 Figured Figured BassBass "Bass Position Symbols", or "bps") (or (or "Bass Position Symbols", or "bps") CHAPTER 16. FIGURED BASS 3 + 3 + 183 4 437 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 For Triads: For Triads: 4 ã 46 Û6. 6 6 Û Û 4 4 Û + ‰ 3 1 Û J 4 Root is the 3rd of the triad 5th of the triad 3rd of the triad of the triadbass note. Root isbass the note. is the bass5th note. is the bass note. is the bass note. is the bass note. ? b 42 7 ≈ œ œ. 438 Figure 16.2.1 Figured Bass Inversion Symbols for Triads 7 ?b 440 For Seventh Chords: For Seventh Chords: 66 5 œ. 5 œ4. 34 œ. Root of the seventh chord Root of isthethe seventh chord bass note. is the bass note. ≈ œ ( œ. ) 3rdseventh of the seventh The 3rdThe of the chord chord is the bass note. is the bass note. The 5th of the seventh chord is the bass note. The 5th of the seventh chord is the bass note. Snare Drum 3 The 7th of the seventh chord is the bass note. 2 Figure 16.2.2 Figured Bass Inversion Bass Symbols Drum for Seventh Chords 572 & C ww w ww w C/E & ww w C/G Am7 C: ww ww www Am /C 7 iii w ww w www w Am7/E w www Am7/G vi www vi wwwwvi & w Bass versus Roman Numerals Figure 16.2.3 Roman Numerals with Figured C: 447 I C: I I6 I64 vi7 I/3rd I/5th vi7 vi65 7/3rd vi43 7/5th vi42 7/7th 579 with Modifed Slash Notation iii7used for seventh chords, ii56 the “7” are only Because the figures 65 , 43 , and 42 C: is omitted when labeling inverted seventh chords. & 451 589 & & C: wwww V765 Figure 16.2.4 “7” is not included when 7th chords are inverted ( œ ≈œœ œ œ The 7th of the seventh chord is the bass note. 444 Unlike original figured bass notation in the Baroque era, in music theory courses, figured bass inversion symbols are placed after Roman numerals. Compare figured bass symbols to the modified slash notation we have been 29 using in previous chapters. ≈ œ œ. 4 4 ã 4 œ2 ≈ œ œ œ œ ≈ œ œ œ 4 442 Û 3 ≈ œ œ. œ. 2 ww w ii6 wwww IM43 J J p Bass Drumfrag. a frag. b frag. a frag. b j j j j j j œ FIGURED œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ CHAPTER 16. BASS 184 ? # # # 68 œw. œ œ œ œJ œ . œ œ wwœ œJ œ œ œ œJ œww œ œ . & w w J J w Notice thatwit is essential with seventh chords to include symbols like “M” 444 ◦ 6 3rd I/5th V 7 figured Iiii I/3rd and V/3rd V/3rd bass I Iii/ (for a major chord) andV beforevithe C: A: seventh ii67ø/5th 4numbers and after the Roman numeral. Half Cadence 447 493 www phrase a w www www ww w w w w # # # œ .7 œ œ œ œ œ 6. œ œ œ œ M4 j œ œ œ œœ ø4œ œ œj vii 2 œ œ & C: iii J ii5 J œI 3œ J J Figure 16.2.5 451 p j j j j j j &? # # œœ . œ œœ œœ œœ œœ . œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ J J Chord œ œ. 16.3 #The Cadential Six-Four J J J & I/5th V A common term in music theory—the phrase a' “cadential six-four” (or cadential 6 6 (HC) )—is used to refer to the I that regularly proceeds the V chord in cadences. 4 4 497 ## œ œ œ. œ œ œ & # œ. œ œ J j j j œ œ œ œœ œœ œ œ œœ ? ### œ . œ J œ. œ œ j œ œ œ œ œœ J œ J j j œœ œ œ œ J œ œJ œ œ J A: ii6 œœ œœj œ ‰ œ œ œœ œ j ‰ œ œ I46 V7 I (Cadential 64 ) YT: vp_h649sZ9A Figure 16.3.1 Mozart, Piano Sonata K. 331, I 185 17 CHAPTER 16. FIGURED BASS F 152 152 b & b 43 œ œ b & b 43 œ œ O'er the B b/D F B b œ. land œœ .. ? b b 43 œ ( œ ) œ . œ ( œ) œ . B b/D G m C ø7/G b B b/F œ œ (œ ) ˙ J œ œ œ . ( œJ ) œ j œœœ œœœ ( œœœ ) ˙˙˙ of the œœ œœœ œœœ ... ( œœœ ) œœœ œ J free and the home 157 of the œ bœ œ. j œ bœ œ. œ œ œ œ j ˙ œ œœ ( œœ ) ˙ œ ( ) B¯: I64 V7 (Cadential 64 ) V7 B¯: I/5th 157 F7 I Bb ˙ brave! ˙˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ I dom. ton. b & b bbb c Œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ G¯ YT: LGvW6jHUHiY D¯ Figure 16.3.2 Francis Scott Key and John Stafford Smith, “The Star-Spangled Banner” It is worth remembering that the cadential 6 (or I64 ) has dominant function, Now that it's rain - ing more than ev4 - er Know that we still have each oth just like the V chord that usually follows it. Previously, we have called this chord “ I/5th .” We will use the term “cadential six-four” throughout the rest of this text, now that figured bass has been introduced. b & b b b b c ww w ww w ? bb c 16.4b Other Chords b b w Occurrences of Six-Four w 159 159 Second-inversion D¯: IVchords with the fifth of the chord I in the bass, also known as 6 chords, are special chords found only in four situations in classical89 music. 4 A¯ six-four (discussed in the previous B¯m section) 1. Cadential bbbbb œ œ & œ bass œ œ line œ œwillœ look 2. Passing six-four: œ the œ œlikeœ a œpassing-tone œ œ œ figure, œ œ œwith œ three stepwise ascending or descending notes, and the middle chord will You can stand un - der my um - br - el - la You can stand un - der my um - br - el be a 64 er chord b & b bbb w ww ? bb bbb w V & œœœ ?œ C: I & œœœ œœ œ œ ww w w vi œœ œ œ V64 I6 (passing 64 ) œœ œ œœœ ?œ œ œ CHAPTER 16. FIGURED BASS C: I V64 I6 œœ œ œœœ œ œ 186 3. Pedal six-four: the bassline will consist of 6three repeated notes, and the (passing 4 ) middle chord will be a 64 chord. & œœœ ? œ C: I IV64 I (pedal 64) 4. Melodic bass six-four: in this situation, the bass voice has the melody; when the fifth of the chord occurs in this bass voice melody, the result will be a 64 chord. 16.5 Additional Information Though we will not use them in our harmonic analyses, you will sometimes encounter figured bass symbols containing all of the intervals above the bass note in Baroque music containing figured bass. The common figured bass inversion symbols in the sections above are abbreviations of the figures given 25 in the examples below. 452 455 & www w 7 5 3 5 3 ww w ww w www & wwww 6 5 3 6 3 wwww 6 4 3 6 4 w www 6 4 2 Figure 16.5.1 “Full” Figured Bass symbols showing every interval above the lowest note Additionally, you may notice that figured bass numbers in actual music (but not in Roman numeral labeling) may be altered chromatically with the following symbols. & . #bb wwww œ œ 7œ#.# www6 œ 2œ œ œ bbœwww. œ œ œ# wwwœ œ . œ# wwœw œ œ ww œ w œ œ # # ww #w œ œ. #w ?& œ œ . . 43 C: œvii#œwo.7/ii œ œ o 7 ø7 vii /iii vii /IV viiø7/V viio7/vi o7/iii C: 16. viio7FIGURED /ii 3 vii CHAPTER BASS 867 543 543 547 547 b bbb wwEo 4 & n && 4 bb œœb # œœ n www n ˙˙ œ c: œviio/iv˙ o ## ˙˙nn wwww #˙ ow F˜o F˜o Eo c: vii /iv Dø7 Dø7 ? 44 b bœ & b bbb & b viiø7/IV 3 www œ ˙ ww wviiø7# /III n vii /V viio/V b www ˙ nb ww 6 now7 4+ Eo7 Eo7 3viiø7/V 870 558 558 863 o # ˙˙˙ vii /VI viio/VI w # nn wwww˙6 #w F˜o7 F˜o7 7 b 878 3. 870 16 ? b ? bb 542 5. b7 b 5/VI viiø7 viiø7/VII viiø7/VI viiø7/VII accidentals before a ____ affect that ____ number ____ above the ____ interval bass 6 4 n w 6. d: __________ #w w ## 6 b5 & # ? ? ## ww_____ w w 6 1. E: IV _____ Rom. num.: 1. D: _____ b 3. F: _____ 2. DAnalyze ¯_____ : IVM7/7th the chords. b ww _____ & w b b w2. c: iiø4 3 w 7. B: _____ _____ 2. b: _____ # key signatures. b Include b:_____ viio7/5th Lead-sheet: Write the1.specified ____ 7 3. _____ f ˜: Vwith chords # w ?# w # ww _____ 3. G: V56 _____ 3. e: _____ ____ accidentals_____ before a number affect 4that interval above the bass w w ## 8. D¯: _____ _____ 4. D: _____ bbbb & bbbb 4. E: iisymbols. /3rd _____ lead-sheet ww w w _____ 4. d: viio6 _____ 4. f: _____ _____ 2. g: Roman _____ Analyze the excerpt using numerals with figured bass inversion ? below and lead-sheet symbols ? symbols above. Analyze non-chord tones. ## & #1.#A: wwI6 _____ ww # ? # # ? # Lead-sheet: 550 4 # Rom. num.: 5. E: _____ _____ 874 4. 878 w ˙ n wwww #5 nw b˙wwww b ww C: ____ ____+ ____ C: accidentals ____ ____ without 4 with + and 6 with____ a _____ _____ _____ numbers refer to the 1 2slash through it mean3 Rom. num.: 1. c: _____ 546 viio/VII Aø7 Aø7 Gø7 Gø7 # # intervals # # # # w 3rd above bassb raise#those b b wwRoman nuww b b band above #the bass # the given chords using lead-sheet symbols above &Label w w w ww inversion symbols below. merals with figured bass Lead-sheet: _____ ww# _____ # # w _____ b # _____ ? # # # # bww w # # # b ww b b b#b w ww www b # &bb w w Lead-sheet: 538 Ao Ao www ww above www the bass www ww & www w ww w ww & w w w w w Figure 16.5.2 Figured Bass with Chromatic Alterations w w Lead-sheet:C: ____ _____ _____ _____ _____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ # C: ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ #œ# w ____ # #œ wœ ____ ____ œ b w____ œ œ ____ œ #œ œ b b b 3ww____ # œ ____ ____ œ . ____ ____ ____ w ____ œ & w œ w w J w w w Œ w w w w w www 16.6&&Practice Exercises ww wwww 4 ww wwww w6www w w w & 1. A¯: ww V /vi 62.#E:w V #7/IVw 3. wD¯:4 V /ii 7 4. wwc:6 V /III6 5.#wwg:7#V 6/Vww6 6www3 ? w 2 symbols 6 ____ 1. Analyze the triads ____ with lead-sheet above and b bC: ____ œ œœ ____ # #Roman œ œ ____ b b œ .w____ œ œ below œ œnumerals œ œ œ œ œ w . . withC:figured bass inversion symbols the ____ ____ ____ ____œstaff. œ____. ____ œ œ œ ? 43 ____ ____ 564 . œ œ____ œ œ____ . .w œ œ œ œ ____ ____ ____ ____ . 564 Rom. num.: 1. c: _____ 2. b: _____ 3. F: _____ 4. D: _____ ww ww 3 www 3 3 ww 3 & w ww w w Lead-sheet: _____ _____ _____ & _____ w ww 867 # # cC: ____ b b # ˙ ____ ˙b b b w____ ____ ˙ wwC: b____ œœ1 # œœ n ˙˙ ww ____ #ww˙˙ ____ b ˙˙ b ww____ & & # ˙˙˙4 2 #˙ 3 b # œ ˙ ˙ 2 3 4 w 1 œ 2. Analyze the seventh chords with lead-sheet symbols above and Roman w w w ____ ____ figured ____ ?numerals #? #symbols below thebstaff. 568 b bass w inversion b w____ # wc with ____ ____ ____ ____ b b 568 w w b œ w w œ ˙ ˙ w ˙ www ˙wwww ww www ˙ & w ww ww & 1. D: _____ 6 _____ b 7 4. f: _____ Rom. num.: 2. g: _____ww 6 3. e: w # 5w 4 874 w n www ˙ # ˙˙n w viio/VII bGGwwwo b w b ˙˙ wb ˙ o c: vii /iv viio7/V ø7/III o7/iv c: vii vii viio67with /V a accidentals without 4 with + and numbers the slash through it mean ____ refer to ____ ____ ____ 3rd above bass ____ raise those intervals ____ ____ ____ 552 552 3 187 viio7/vi _____ Rom. num.: 5. E:6 _____ 5. e: iv4 554 & b _____ ww w b w 2. F: ii42 _____ 6. d: _____ ø4 6. B¯: vii 3 _____ & _____ #### w b b b b4.b g:wwwviio6 # 3.wwb: V65 _____ _____ #### w b b bbb w # 7. B: _____ 6 7. f ˜: VII 8. D¯: _____M6 8. E¯: IV 5 63 CHAPTER 16. FIGURED BASS 64 882 Lead-sheet: ____ & 44 œ œ ? 44 œ œ C: ____ ____ œ œ œ ____ 188 ____ ____ œ(œ ) œ œœ ____ ˙œ œ œ ____ ____ œ œ œ ____ ww œ w w ( ) ____ ____ 884 & ? YT: 8QZ0WkwZ5Uc ∑ ∑ ∑ Figure 16.6.1 J.S. Bach, Chorale 175, “Jesus, meine Zuversicht” Click here to download the homework assignment for this chapter. PDF versions of the textbook, homework exercises, and practice exercises can be found at musictheory.pugetsound.edu Chapter 17 Secondary Dominant Chords So far we have studied diatonic harmony (chords without accidentals, with the exception of the use of raised 6̂ and 7̂ in minor, which are considered diatonic). In the following chapters, we will study chromatic harmony. 2 b 44 œŒÓ 44 V 17.1 Examples with Secondary Dominants ? 4 ∑ 4 b 4 4 Secondary dominants are common in classical and popular music. Here are 16 16 examples with the chromatic chords noted. We will examine these chords more closely later in the chapter. 17 4 Vb 4 œ I 17 ? 4 b 4 œ œ œ œ be - lieve œœ œœ œœ ‰ j œ œ in yes n œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œ - œ œ œ ter - day. Œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ Figure 17.1.1 Paul McCartney, “Yesterday” (1965) Vb ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ 19 ?b ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ 19 Vb 35 ? 35 189 ∑ ? 43 œ . œ œ. œ . œ œ œ. œ œ. 63 4+ 7 CHORDS 6 6 7 6 DOMINANT 6 CHAPTER 17. SECONDARY 2 b 4 &b 4 Œ 195 b & b 44 # œ n œ 195 ? b b 44 Œ 3 ‰ j œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ Don't know why I did - n't œ œ œ n œ œ œ œ b œœ ˙ 7 3 œ œ. come. œœ .. 3 190 Ó j œœ ˙˙ j œ ˙ œ. ˙ 6 6 21 YT: tO4dxvguQDk Figure 17.1.2 Jesse Harris, “Don’t Know Why” (2002) 198 198 198 198 ### 4 jœ ‰ œ œ œ & 4 œ ### # & ## & ? ### ### & 202 44 j œ #œ ˙ . ˙ ‰ œ œ . œ œ œ 4 44 shine up my old brown shoes. œœ 44 œ œ œ œ œ œ ˙œ . œ œ œ # œ ˙ . shine up my old brown shoes. I'll œ œ‰ œ œ œ ˙ J Ó 21 put on my brand new shirt Œ œ‰ n œ œ˙ œ‰ œ œ œ œ J J new œ œ I'll nputœ onœmy brand œ œ œœ œ n œ n ˙œ œ œœ œ œœ ˙w Ó œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ w shirt ? # # # 44 ∑ œ œ œ ∑ n œ œ∑ œ œ∑ œ œ œ∑ œ & œ œ œ∑ œ YT:œ∑ -qgpewMCVjs nœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœœœ Figure 17.1.3 Rick Nielson, “I Want You to Want Me” (1977) 202 ## ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ & 4# & 4 ˙. œ #œ ˙. œ nœ ˙. œœ ˙ œ œ ? 4# # # ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ & 4 œœ œœ œœ œœ ‰ œœj Œ œœ œœ œœ ‰ œœj Œ œœ œœ œœ ‰ œœj Œ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ # œœ # œœ œœ œœ n œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œœ 209 ? 44# # œ∑ œ œ ∑œ œ œ ∑ œ & # œ œ ∑œ œ ∑ œ œ œ ∑ œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ 209 206 ### ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ & ∑ & 202 202 ˙ Œ ‰ œJ YT: vL7Op9ZQ3E0 ?# # & #∑ ∑∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑∑ ∑ ∑∑ ? ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ 206 Figure 17.1.4 Robert William Lamm, “Saturday in the Park” (1972) ∑ ∑ ˙. œ #œ ˙ . œ nœ ˙ œœœ w œ ? # # # 44 ____ ____ œ œ œ œ œ 10œ œ191 n œ œ œ œ 9 œ ____ œ œ œ œ œœœœ nœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ & 44 œ‰ ‰ œœj œ œœœ œ ‰ ˙ j ‰ j & 4 œ œœ ˙˙ .. ( ) œ œœœ ˙˙ . œ ‰ œj ww˙ . œœ ˙˙ œœ ˙˙ ... œœ ˙˙ .. œ ˙. # n 4 œ ˙ >. & 4 ˙. > œ #œ ˙. > > œ n œ ˙ œ œ œ œ‰ (œ ) w ‰ j ˙ œ ? 4 œj œœ ˙œœ ‰ j œ 4 œœ œ œ œ œœ ˙ œ œj œ œ ˙ œ œ œ ˙ œ ˙ w 4 & 4 œœ. œ.œ> œ œ ‰ œjœ. Œœ. œœ œ ˙ œ ‰ œœ.j œ. Œ>œ œ ˙œ œ ‰ œ.œjœ. œŒ œ ˙œ œ œœ œœ œœ____œœ #____ œœœ # œœœ> œœœ ____ œœœ n œœœ ____ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœ > ____ œœ œœ œœ C: ____ E¯: ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ CHAPTER 17. SECONDARY Lead-sheet: ____ 1 ____ 2 ____ 3 DOMINANT 4 ____5 CHORDS 6 ____ 7 8 64 882 887 202 202 ? 44 ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ & œœ œ œ b b œ4 œ œ œ œ œawVi2QXC0ZE b œœ œ œ œœ œ˙œœ œ œ œœ œ & œ4 œ œ œ œœ œœœ YT: œœ œPhilip Lawrence, ( œ ) œ œand Ari œ œ Green, Figure Bruno Mars, œCeeLo œ œœLevine, ? 17.1.5 ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑œ “Forget You” (2010) j œ œ œ œœ ( œ) œœ . œœ . œ . . œ œ (œœ ) œ> ? #b # # 4 3œœ œ œ > ( ) œ . . œ œ œ œJ œJ œ R ≈œœ R≈œ & b #b 4# 8 œ . œ œJ œJ 892 884 206 206 Lead-sheet: # # # # 31 œ . 2œ œ. œ. 3 # œr œ4 œ 5 6 œ . 7œ œ. 8 œ. ‹9œr œ œ10 œœ ≈ œœ œœ ≈ œœ & # 8 R R 4 & 4 ‰ ‰ œœj ˙˙ ..œœ œœ ‰ œjœ ˙˙œ. œ ‰ œj œœ˙ .œœ ‰ œj œœ˙ œœ ? # # # # 38 œ # œ ˙ . œ œ # œœ œ ˙˙ œ... œ ‹ nœœœ œ˙˙ .. œ œœœ ˙˙ # > > > > ? 44 j œ ˙ ‰ j œœ œ œ œ ˙ ‰ œj œ œ ˙ ‰ œj œ œ. œ. >œ ˙ œ. œ. œ ˙ œ œ œ ˙ œ. œ. œœ ˙˙ . .> > 8uMb3CnP6L8 YT: > don - na____ è E¯: ____ La____ 887 mo - bil____ ____ qual piu____ - ma al ____ ____ to, ____ven -____ Figure 17.1.6 Verdi, Rigoletto, “La donna è mobile” (1851) 892 &b b ? bb 4 œj ‰ œœ. ≈ 4 œ. π œ. œœ. 44 J ‰ œ ≈ œœ . œœ œœœ œœ. . œ œœ œ n œ b œ. œ. œ. œ œ œ œ b œœ > . . > œœœ œœ œœ œœ œœœ >œœ œ œ. œ. n >œœ œœ ‰ J œ J ‰ YT: JRXIDEpquCg Figure 17.1.7 Tchaikovsky, The Nutcracker, “Miniature Overture” (1892) 17.2 Tonicization In this chapter and the next, we will study tonicization, which means treating a chord other than the I chord like a tonic by approaching it with its dominant. In diatonic harmony, the V chord (the dominant) resolves to the I chord (the CHAPTER 17. SECONDARY DOMINANT CHORDS 192 tonic). A secondary dominant is a major triad or dominant seventh chord that resolves to (or tonicizes) a chord other than the I chord. 896 & 44 œœ œ ? 44 œ G7/B ˙˙ .. ˙. ˙. I V56/ii ii V56/iii iii V56/IV IV V56/V V V56/vi vi V56 I œœ œ œ C: V56 œ n œœ œ C A7/C˜ Dm B7/D˜ Em C7/E F D7/F˜ G E7/G˜ Am G7/B œœ œ #œ œœ œ œ # œœ œ #œ œœ œ œ b œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œ #œ œœ œ #œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ C 901 & ? ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ Figure 17.2.1 25 the bass line of the example above and notice that a secondary chord, through its chromaticism, intensifies the drive to the next chord. 911Sing 452 455 & & ? www ww w ww w Principle 17.2.2 Secondary Dominants. The Roman numeral after the slash is the chord being tonicized by the V chord before . 4 the slash. 7 5 6 6 You may find that you want to analyze the D F in the example above 3 3 4 6 6 6 as . a II5 instead of a V5 V (which we pronounce as “ V5 of V ”), and the 4 7 E G as a III65 instead of V65 vi (“ V65 of vi ”). Notice, however, that a ii & ∑ ww ww ∑ ∑ wwww ∑ wwww ∑ ∑ ∑ w www chord is typically minor in a 6major key and diminished in a minor6 key ( ii◦ ), 6 7 918 4 4 is V/V . 5 5 making uppercase II a chromatic harmony for which the proper label 459 & &? #∑wwww In C major Label as V7/V Not as II7 925 3 3 3 D7 E7 w ∑ # www V7/vi III7 w # www ∑ A7 ∑ V7/ii VI7 # # wwww ∑ 2 B7 V7/iii VII7 b Cww ww 7 ∑ ∑ V7/IV I7 &While labeling D7 as II7 in C major makes the root clear, it does not communicate the function of the D7 , which is to progress to a G major chord & ?V chord, or the dominant (the ∑ ◦ in C major). ∑ Figure 17.2.3 464 Also, notice that the vii is not tonicized with its secondary dominant in the example above. Listen to the following example to understand why diminished chords such as vii◦ and ii◦ in minor are not tonicized. 472 & 479 & 486 & 65 ? 44 œ CHAPTER 17. SECONDARY C: V6 DOMINANT I V6/ii ii CHORDS V6/iii iii V6/IV IV 5 Ÿ & # # œœœ ... F˜7 901 452 & & 452 455 452 ww ww ww7 ww5 3 & & 455 5 3 C: 902 & E7 455 464 464 459 468 468 464 3 6 5 3 ww w ww6 w4 6 4 3 6 4 3 25 w www w www64 II & III A7 VI B7 2 6 4 2 25 VII # www3 www # E A 7 7 E A B7 w #V/ii ww # # www www # www # w V/vi w w ? # ww7∑ w∑ ∑ 7 7 Figure Triads inV/ii MajorA7 C D Dominant E C: 17.3.1 V/V Secondary V/vi ww w In C majorb w7 w # ww77 w 7 7 w & as VCwww7/V ww/ii ww/vi Label V#7D V#7E VA wwVII/iii7 7 7 w Not as b w II7 III VI w # ww w & C: Vwww7/IV # ww7/vi # www7/V V V V7/ii 925 & & ww & # C: ww 7 D 5 3 #D7wDww V/V # www 6E 5 3 6 A 4 C7 # # www2 B C7 # # wwwb www V/iiiw ∑ 7 V/iiiB w # # www7 VB w7/IV # # wwwI7 V7/iii A V7/ii B V7/iii # w w # w # ww & Dominant w & 17.3.2 # www 473 # www Secondary Figure Seventh Chords in Major the chromaticisms in the example above. The raised notes generally &Notice C: V/V V/vi V/ii V/iii 473 C: V7D /IV V7/V E ? & & 473 476 & bbb 492 & b www w 492 ∑ w # # www b &bb w # www n www # n www C D n www c: V/iv F V/V V/VII (same as IV) 7 C7Secondary Dominant D7 E¯in Figure 17.3.3 Triads Minor n wwww c: V7/iv ____ # n wwww V7/V ____ ∑ ∑ V7/vi # wwww # wwww ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ I B64 act as the leading–tone to the root of the chord being tonicized. In the major 7 D7 dominant with E7 a lowered Achromaticism 485 mode, theC7only secondary isB7V7 IV . The lowered note in V7 IV acts as 4̂ of the chord being tonicized in the same 485 way the last flat of a key signature is 4̂ . Below are all secondary dominant chords (triads and major-minor seventh C: inV7the /IV minor mode. V7/V V7/vi V7/ii V7/iii chords) 468 481 Not as I 25 ww ˙ w ww6 V7/viio viio 3 w (not recommended) 6 3 wwww wwww www65w wwww64 Figure 17.2.4 D7 459 # œ œ N ˙˙˙ b ww ww ww # ww7 ∑ ? w # w w w # w 7 7 7 ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ Ew A Bw ∑ C w w w & # w w # w w w & w b www w ww w # wwww w w # w # w w w w63 in Major and 6 &C majorSecondary # wwDominants # www 53 17.3 Minor In 4 Label as V7/V V7/vi V7/ii V7/iii V7/IV w 7 7 7 7 ww canVIIbe secondarywwdominant Both major triads and major–minor seventh chords Not IIw III ww VI I7 In Cas major w w w w 7 7 7 7 7 & w w Label /V 918 V /vi w V /ii V /iii V /IV chords.as V w 7 7 7 7 7 7 D7 5 3 459 193 V V6/vi vi V6 V56/V 5 5 5 Bo ? #˙ www www53 5 5 œ #œ œ œ œ œ #œ œ #œ œ #œ b ww ww V7/VI n wwww F7 V7/VII ____ www w B¯7 V7/III (same as VII7) ____ ∑ ∑ b &bb n www # n www C D n www F CHAPTER 17. DOMINANT c: SECONDARY V/iv V/V CHORDS 476 481 b &bb C7 D7 c: V7/iv V7/V www w F7 b www w # n wwww n wwww (same as IV) n wwww E¯7 V7/VI 194 V/VII B¯7 V7/VII V7/III (same as VII7) ____ ____ ____ Figure 17.3.4 Secondary Dominant Seventh Chords in Minor ____ ?Remember that both vii◦ (on raised 7̂ ) and the subtonic VII (on the lowered 7̂ ) occur in the minor mode. The subtonic VII can be tonicized with V7 VII ,1.while vii◦ , being2.diminished, E¯: V/ii g: V7/VI cannot. 3. e: V4/iv 4. A: V6/ii Notice that an F major chord in C minor can be2 V/VII or IV , depending on how it functions or progresses. If the F major chord progresses to a B2 G7/B C A7/C˜ Dm B7/D˜ Em C7/E F D7/F˜ G E7/G˜ Am G7/B 896 chord, label the F chord as V/VII . If the F major chord has pre–dominant 4 œœ œœ theœœ b œœ œœ œœor Bœœ◦ , label function and progresses chord (in œœ anyœœ inversion) &to4a Gœœ major œ œ # œ œ œ œ nœ F chord as IV . œ œœ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ 7 27 The B chord, on the other hand, can be labeled correctly asœ V # œ IIIœ orœ 4 ? œ #œ # œ œ # œto IIIœ inœminor. VII7 because both V7 III4 orœ VIIœ7 progress 16 C: V56 I V56/ii ii V56/iii iii V56/IV IV V56/V V V56/vi vi V56 17.4538Analyzing Secondary Dominants _____ _____ F˜7 _____ Bo 901 Ÿ ? When you encounter a chord with a chromaticism and suspect it is a secondary ... & # # œœœprocess. # œ œ N ˙˙˙ dominant, use the following 2. D¯: IVM7/7th 3. f ˜: V7 1. Stack the chord in ?thirds # ˙ to determine the root and quality. If the chord 542 quality is major (if a triad) ˙ _____seventh chord, _____or a major–minor _____ go on to step 2. If the chord quality is not major or major–minor seventh, the 7 o o ? C: V /vii ? & &vii chord is not a secondary (notdominant. recommended) 1. b: viio7/5th # #1.# #E: IV6 902 ww _____ & ? ? #### w & #w 6 546 1. A: I ? # ## ? E: ____ _____ 4 # www 2. c:(stacked iiø43 in 3rds) _____ ∑ 2. F: ii42 _____ 3. G: V56 _____ ? 3. b: V65 ? & _____ 550chord in question is an F major triad in first inversion. The 65 ˙˙ .. ˙. ˙. C I _____ 4. E: ii/3rd _____ 4. d: viio6 _____ 4. g: viio6 _____ & 2. Determine the note & #that would be&a perfect 5th below the root of the chord you are analyzing. If this note would be the root of a diatonic chord, the chord you are is a6.secondary 5. iv64 B¯: viiø4 dominant. 7. f ˜: VII6 8. E¯: IVM65 # e: analyzing 904 554 ? ## # #### & 906 #### ∑ # www 3 ∑ w F˜ down P5 is B; in E major, B is 5̂ 556&4 Since B is 5̂ , the F major chord in first inversion is tonicizing V . There fore the chord is?V6 V . ? #### ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ 17.5 Writing Secondary Dominants To write a secondary dominant, use the following procedure. ## # & 5. e: iv www # 6 w3 6. B¯:195viiø4 1.554 First determine the note that is the root of the chord being F down P5 is B;tonicized in E major, (the chord to the right of the slash). 556 556 &b &b d: V43/VI (6ˆ is B¯) 2. Determine the 557 root of the V7 in the key of B2 (the Roman numeral after the slash): F d: V4/VI 3. Build a major–minor seventh chord on F: 3 F–A–C–E 2 4. Invert the chord accordingly. in the bass. 557 4 3 &b &b (6ˆ is B¯) inversion means the fifth of the chord is b wwww 564 d: V43/VI &b 558 2 17.6 Irregular Resolutions16 of Secondary Chords 4 4 V b 4 œŒÓ 4 ? 4 ∑ 4 b 4 4 16 The roots of secondary dominants do not always resolve down a perfect fifth to the tonicized chord. In many of the examples of popular music with secondary dominants at the beginning of this chapter, the secondary dominants resolve deceptively. 17 4 Vb 4 œ Dm I 17 ? 4 b 4 œ F: vi7 G œ œ œ be - lieve œœ œœ œœ ‰ B¯ j œ œ in yes n œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œ V/V IV F - œ œ œ ter - day. Œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ I Figure 17.6.1 Paul McCartney, “Yesterday” (1965) 19 19 7. f ˜: V B is 5̂ #### w ˜ # ww & w b & F˜ down P5 is B; in E major, B is 5̂ CHAPTER 17. SECONDARY DOMINANT CHORDS 4 In “Yesterday,” the V/V resolves not to V but to IV , which sometimes acts as a substitute for the V chord (the dominant) in popularmusic. This progression also happens in “Forget You,” where a V7 V resolves to a IV chord. Vb ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ?b ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ bb 4 887 198 198 & 44 ‰ ‰ œœj œ > ? 44 j œ œœ œ. œ. >œ ‰ j œœ # œœ > ˙ ‰ œj œ ˙ œ œ œ . . œ > ˙˙ .. ˙. ˙ ˙ œ ____ 9 ‰ j œ ˙. n œœ ˙˙ .. > ‰ j œœ œ > ‰ j ˙ œ œœ ˙ œ. œ. œ > ‰ j œ œœ œ. œ. >œ IV ____196 10 C I ˙˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ > . . . . . j œ œœœ œ. œœ œ œ œ >œœ œ ‰ b 4 œ ‰ œœ ≈ œœ YT:œ awVi2QXC0ZE œ b œ & 4 œ. œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œJ Figure 17.6.2 Bruno Mars, CeeLo Green, Philip Lawrence, and Ari Levine, π “Forget You” . (2010) œ. œœ n œœ b œœ. œœ. œœ. >œ œ œ. œ. n >œœ œ œœ œ ≈ œ the œ V/V chord resolves to Want Me” by Cheapb Trick, ?In b“Ib Want 44 J You J ‰ to ‰ 2 a subtonic VII chord in A major. ## j & # 44 œ œ ‰ œ œ œ F˜m7 ### 4 & 4 ˙. ˙ Œ ‰ œJ œ œ‰ œJ œ œ ˙ B shine up my old brown G shoes. œ #œ ˙ . & 44 ˙ . I'll A V/V œ #œ ˙. Ó put on my brand new shirt œ nœ ˙ œœœœ œœœœ A: vi7 202 ˙˙˙ ... ˙. V7/V I ? # # # 44 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ 202 œ œ œ E¯: ____ ____ ____DOMINANT ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ CHAPTER 17. SECONDARY CHORDS 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 7 C D F C: 892 œ nœ œ nœ œ ¯VII œœœ w œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ nœ ˙. I œœ ˙ œœ 4 & 4 œœ œœ œœ œœ ‰ œœj Œ œœ œœ œœ ‰ 2 œœj Œ œœ œœ œœ ‰ œœj Œ œœ œœ œœ Remember, œ œ œhowever, œ # œœthat the œœ œœ nVII œœ in major œœ œœ can œœ actœ as a substitute œ œœ # œœ subtonic YT: -qgpewMCVjs Figure 17.6.3 Rick Nielson, “I Want You to Want Me” (1977) for the dominant (see the Harmonic Flowchart for Popular Music with Subtonic VII chord in Major). . 2 In “Baby Love” by the Supremes, a C7 B in C major ( V42 IV ) resolves to an A7 chord ( V7 ii ), which . 2then resolves to ii ( Dm ). In this example, 7 2 notice that the B in the C B is a lowered chromatic note that wants to resolve downward by half step to A. Instead of this A being the third of the IV chord (an F major chord), which is the traditional and expected resolution, it is the root of an A7 chord ( V7 ii ). ? 44 206 206 œœ œ œœ œ œ œ œœ œ œœ œ # ## 3 œ. . & # # 8 œ . œJ œJ # # # # 3 œ . œ œ. œ. & # 8 La don - na è œ œ ? # # # # 38 # œ œœ œœ # œ œ œ >œ R≈ r #œ œœ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ >œ R≈ œ . œ œ. œ. J J œ≈œ œ. œœ œœ R œ œ œ œ œ ‹œ mo - bil œ œ qual œ œ. œ. piu - ma al œœœ œœœ r ‹œ œ œ œœ ≈ œœ R œ œœ œœ ven - to, 21 22 CHAPTER 17. SECONDARY DOMINANT CHORDS C7/B¯ C 210 j & 44 œ œ œ ˙ œ œ Ba 210 & 44 ‰ ?4 ‰ 4 - by love, my ba œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œœœ œ œœœ œ œœœ & ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ & ∑ ∑ ∑ ? ∑ ∑ ∑ 215 Figure A7 j j œ œ bœ œœ œ œ J œœ ˙ œ œ by love, I œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œœœ need V42/IV Dm7 œœ œ ˙ Œ 3 you oh how # œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œ œ œ œ bœ œ œ œ bœ œ œ œ C: I 215 - 197 3 I n œœ œ need you œœ œœ œœ œœœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ V7/ii œœœ œœœ ii7 ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ YT: 9_y6nFjoVp4 17.6.4 Lamont Dozier, Brian Holland, and Eddie Holland, “Baby Love” (1964) Finally, a rather common deceptive resolution of a secondary dominant is V7 vi to IV , which can be seen in the following three examples. 227 ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ 227 & ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ? ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ & # 4 ˙ œ œ J œœ w ˙. D: _____ _____ _____ CHAPTER 17. SECONDARY DOMINANT CHORDS # j V 44 œ œ . G 228 œ œ œ œ 896 230 # & 44 ˙˙ ˙ ? # 44 901 902 to live œ # œœ n œœ # # œœ œœ œ # œ œ œ 4 œ & 4 œœ œœ œœ G: œ I œ œ ? 44 œ œ # œ # Cœ œ œ VC: V6 I V6/ii ˙ ˙˙ for And look like Ó œ œ Cœ œ œ œ œ œ œ ˙. œ œ #œ # œœœ œœœ b œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœ œœœ n œ ˙˙ .. V/vi œ ˙. # œ œ œ œ A# œ œ # œ œ œ œ Vb6/IV œ IVœ V56/VŒV V56‰/vi œvi œ Vœ 56 œ I œ œ V56/iii iii 5 C A7/C˜ Dm B7/D˜ Em C7/E F D7/F˜ G E7/G˜ Am G7/B G7/B 5 230 no - thing _____ _____ 198 œ œ œ œ œ ‰ ‰ œj œ œ B I've had 228 ˙ ˙ œœ œ œ œ ii 5 Ÿ & ## # œœœ˙... & ˙˙ ? #˙ ?# C: V7œ/viio Fno˜7- thin's gon - na Bocome my # œ œ N ˙˙˙ œ # œ n œ œœ œ n œ œ bœ ˙ œ viio œ œ bœ (not recommended) ## & # # ww # www IV way So I'm just gon' #œ œ œ œ œ œ Œ Ó œ œ œ œ œ œ V/V (stacked in 3rds) YT: rTVjnBo96Ug ? #### w # w Figure 17.6.5 Steve Cropper and Otis Redding, “(Sittin’ On) The Dock of the Bay” (1967) ? E: ____ 904 œ œ œ œ œ œ ? œœ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œœœ œ # œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œœœ œ # œœ œ œœ œ F G ?˙ ˙ ˙˙ C: IV V E 908 E7 C E F G ˙˙ I ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ V/vi V7/vi IV B7 C˜m V G˜7 œœ rAn-AWXtHv0 44 # ˙˙˙ # # œœœ #YT: # # # # ˙˙˙ & œ Figure 17.6.6 John Lennon, “Imagine” (1971) & 44 # ˙˙ dolce e molto ligato. E: I # # œœœ # œœ V vi # # # ˙˙˙ V7/vi C E ˙˙ ˙˙ E7 V/vi V7/vi I A #˙ ˙ # ˙˙ IV 65 ˙˙ ˙ ˙ ˙˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ B7 C˜m C: IV V I V/vi V7/vi IV V CHAPTER 17. SECONDARY DOMINANT CHORDS E # ˙˙ 4 &4 ˙ 908 & 44 # ˙˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ V/vi V7/vi 199 I G˜7 A # # œœœ œ # # œœ # # œœœ # # # ˙˙˙ # œœ #˙ ˙ V vi # # # ˙˙˙ # ˙˙ dolce e molto ligato. E: I V7/vi IV YT: lbblMw6k1cU Figure 17.6.7 Beethoven, Piano Sonata Op. 53, I (1804) There are two ways to conceptualize this progression. The first is that the progression of iii to IV (Em to F in C major) is not unusual, so E to F, which appears to be III to IV but is in fact V/vi to IV , is a chromatic modification of iii to IV . The other way to think of V/vi to IV is as V/vi to VI/vi , a deceptive progression within the submediant area. We can conclude that secondary chords do not always resolve strictly to the chords they appear to be tonicizing. 17.7 Practice Exercises Day One: 66 910 1. 26 26 Approach 4 each chord with its secondary dominant seventh chord (whose & lies 4 ˙˙a perfect 5th above ˙˙ root Label ˙˙ chord of resolution). ˙˙ the root of the ˙ ˙ chords ____ with numerals below and lead–sheet symbols above. ˙ Roman ˙ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ Am7 C ? 4˙ ? 4444 ˙˙˙ ˙ ? 4C:˙ I ____ 485 485 Dm7 ˙ ˙˙˙˙ ˙ vi˙7 ____ ____ ____ ____ ton. 7 C: ____ V /____ ton. ____ prol. V7/____ C: ____ V7/____ ____ V7/____ FUNCTION: ____ & 44____ ˙˙ ? 444 ˙˙˙ ˙˙ ? ?444 ˙ ˙ C 912 489 489 ____ ____ 2. 914 # ˙˙˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙ ˙˙ V7/____ ____ V7/____ ____ V7/ii C: ____ C: ____ C: I 493 493 A7 ____ ____ ____ ____ ˙˙ ˙˙˙7 ii˙ ˙ w ˙ www w V w ____ ____ pre-dom.7 ____ ____ V /____ dom. ____ V7/____ ____ D7 ____ ____ ˙˙ ____ ˙ www www ˙ V77/____ ____ n # ˙˙˙ ˙˙˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ V7/____ V7/____ G ____ ____ V7/V ____ ____ G V /____ ____ V ____ FUNCTION: ton. prol. pre-dom. Analyze the followington. secondary dominants. Include dom. lead-sheet symbols above. ? ____ ____ ? ## ww b # ww b b b & w w 501? # b 501 ? # #w b w b b ? Lead-sheet: b: _____ F: _____ 1 2 b ?& b b b ? b ww w w ____ # ____ ww # # ww c: _____ 3 G: _____ 4 ∑ ∑ #### bbbb ____ # ww w #### w ____ b ww w w bbbb E: _____ 5 f: _____ 6 920 508 508 ? bb bb 515 515 ? ? ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ 3 3 3 459 2 ww # wwww w # w # w w w w & 17. SECONDARY # wwDOMINANT CHORDS # ww CHAPTER D7 3. 464 920 468 924 473 E7 A7 B7 bCww ww 7 200 In C major On the empty staff below, copy 7the notes from the upper 7staff to Label as V7/V V7/vi V /ii V7/iii V /IV the adding the VI specified non–chord tones. I7(Note: 7 7 Not aslowerII7staff while III VII7 LNT = lower neighbor tone; UNT = upper neighbor tone.) Realize the lead–sheet symbols using quarter–note accompanimental texture. D E A Below the lower staff, analyze the chords using Roman numerals # Bww with w # # w w 67 w figured & bass # www # ww inversion symbols. w chro. DN PT C:b V/V LNT PT UNT j V/viPT PT V/ii 4 ˙ ˙ & b b C47 œ œ œ . Dœ7 œ œ ˙E7 A7 w # www &? b b wwww4 # wwww # wwww bb 4 C: V7/IV Cm bb &&b bb b 44 V7/V V7/vi Fm C n www # n www D D7/F˜ APP w V/iii # # wwww B7 V7/ii V7/iii G n www F V/VII DN ? b b 44 c: LNTV/IV APP PT UNT (same as IV) bb bb c j PT PTœ ˙ ˙ ˙ 7 œ & w B¯7 E¯7 F7 476 œC7 œ œ . Dœ_____ Rom. num.: _____ _____ _____ w ww b www b www w w n w n &?b bb n wwww # ww w w c Day Two: 928 b b b bc: V7/IV 7/III V7/V dominants. V7/VI IncludeV7lead-sheet /VII Vsymbols 4. Write following secondary & b the (same as VII7) 7 924 Cm key signatures. Fm D /F˜ G above. Include ____ ____ ____ ____ b 481 bb b c ? & b ? b ? b b 1.cE¯: V/ii 2. g: V7/VI 3. e: V24/iv 4. A: V6/ii b 933 5. For alter the given_____ motives as specified. Rom.the num.: _____ example, _____ _____ Add an b following b accompanimental texture of afterbeats. Analyze the Roman numerals b & chro. V/V PT 920 with figured bass inversion symbols below the staff. 928 ? b F œ œ . œ œ . œ œ Dm œœ œ & b bc ‰ J œœœ œœ œ ? b b c ‰ œœ œœ œœ ‰ œœ œœ œœ J & b J mot.1 mot. 2 œ ‰œ G7/B mot. 2 aug. C ‰œ mot. 1 mot. 2 œ 1 inv. 2. inv 939 ? b bb F: _____ 932 _____ _____ _____ _____ the first_____ _____ _____ Click here to download homework assignment for_____ this chapter. # # #second # Click here to download# #the homework assignment for this chapter. w b b w b wexercises,# and practice b b exercises & b b wwof the textbook, w homework w PDF versions # w w can be found at musictheory.pugetsound.edu # # # # ww ?b w w 1. F: _____ 937 & bbbb _____ n www ? bb b w b 2. E: _____ # nw w w # w _____ # # # www ### bbbb 3. g: _____ _____ ww # # # # ww 6. A¯:_____ 7. G: _____ F: V6/IV A¯: V6/vi V6/IV E: V/ii G: w bb n w 8. f˜:_____ g: V4/V f˜: V4/iv 4. b: _____ _____ b n www bbbbb w bb b b ww 5. c: _____ _____ b w nw #w b w 9. D¯:_____ 10. D:_____ b: V/iv D¯: V/ii c: V4/VI d: V7/V 67 Chapter 18 Secondary Diminished Chords 69 4 œ . œ(œ) œ œ . œj œ & b 4 œ . (œ)œ (œ) œ (œ) œ Lead-sheet: _____ 958 _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ nœ 18.1 Secondary Diminished Chords ? b 44 œ œ œ œ mot. 1 mot. 2 mot. 3 mot. 4 3 inv. mot. 4 _____ _____ ˙ 1 inv. The vii◦ chord has dominant function (see the Harmonic Function Flowchart). Since chords of dominant function typically resolve to chords of tonic function, diminished triads as well as half–diminished and fully–diminished seventh chords occur diminished chords. iv d: i as secondary III6 VI III V6/V Vsus4 V 4 962 Bø7 & 44 œœ œ ? 44 œ C: viiø7 G G˜o7 Am Bø7 C I viio7/ii ii viio7/iii iii viiø7/IV IV viiø7/V V viio7/vi vi viiø7 I C C˜o7 Dm D˜o7 œœ b œœœ œœœ # œœœ œ œ #œ œ #œ Em Eø7 F œœ œ œ F˜ø7 b œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œ #œ œœ œœœ œœ œœœ œ œ œ #œ œ œ ˙˙ .. ˙. ˙. 967 & ? Figure 18.1.1 A Harmonic Sequence with Secondary Diminished Chords in C major 968 & Below are some examples of pieces with secondary diminished chords. Notice that chromaticism is an “essential” part of secondary diminished chords (“non–essential” chromaticism refers to chromatic non–chord tones). ? 976 & ? 201 962 967 967 22 ? 4 B Cœ #Cœ˜ Dm œ Eœ œF #Fœ˜ Gœ #Gœ˜ Am Bœ C˙ œ #Dœ˜ Em 44 œ . œ œ &C:4 viiœœ ø7 Iœ viio7œœ/ii iiœœ vii#o7œœ /iii iiiœœviibø7œœœ/IV œœIV viiœœœø7/V œœœV viiœœo7/viœœœvi viiœø7 ˙˙I .. œ CHORDS b œ œ œ DIMINISHED œ œ 18. œœSECONDARY CHAPTER . 202 ˙ œ œ œ # œ ? 44 œ œ # œ œ # œ œ œ œ # œ 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 ø7 3 ø7 o7 o7 ø7 ø7 o7/vi vi vii œ œ C:# vii I vii /ii ii vii /iii iii vii /IV IV vii /V V vii I3 œ œ 4 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ & 4 œ .œ œœ œ . œ œ . œ . œ . œ œœ .œ œ œœ. œ œ .(œ) œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œ. 3 3 3 3 3 # 4 œœ 3 œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ 3 œ œ œ œ 3 œ 3 œ & # 44 œ .œ œœ œœœ . œ œ . œ . œ œ . œ œœ .œ œ œœ. œ œ .(œ) œœ œ œ œœ œ ? œ œœ œ œ #œ œ . 4 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ? # 44 œ œœ œ œ #œ œ œ œ œ œ 971 YT: 9ayLUAWmatk # Figure & 18.1.2 J.S. Bach, Herz und Mund und Tat und Leben BWV 147, X. “Jesus bleibet CFreude” (“Jesu,CJoy (1723) Dm7 7/B¯ of Man’s Desiring”) A7 971 210 3 j. j b œ œ j3 . . 4 œ œ œ œ . . . . œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ # œ & 4 2 œ œ ˙ œ œœ œœœ ˙œ œœœ œ œ # œœ œJ œ œ œ œ œ œ ˙ œŒ œœ œ œ œ œ &# 4 œœ ? f œp œœ œ 4 ‰ ? # 2 &4 4 œ ‰ œ ? 44 ‰ J œ Ba 210 - by love, my ba œœ œœ œœ œœœ Œ œœœ œ œœœ C: I - S œœœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ J ‰ by love, œ œœ. œœ œœ. f œ œœ J I need bœ œ œ œ bœ œ œ œ # œ. n œ.needœ.you # œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ n œœœ . œœœ œœœ œœœ œ œ œ œ œ. œ. œœ œ œ œ ‰ Œ œœ p you oh how I œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ 4/IV 7 VYT: 2 67maTrrSKjg V /ii œ œ œœœ œœœ ii7 Figure 18.1.3 Tchaikovsky, The Nutcracker, “Trepak” (1892) 215 215 # V # 44 Ó œ œ. œ œ. ˙ J J # & # 44 œœ .. œœj œœ œœ œœ .. œœj œ . œ œ œ # œœ .. œœ Don't go ? # # 44 ˙ chang - ing œ œ. ˙. J Œ‰ œj œ œ œ j j œœ œœ .. œœ .. œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ .. œ . œ œ œ to try and please œœ w œ œ. œ Œ J j œœ .. n œœœ ‰ œœœ .. œ . œ œ .. me ˙ ˙ # ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ V # ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ YT:∑ HaA3YZ6QdJU 219 Figure 18.1.4 Billy Joel, “Just the Way You Are” (1977) # & # ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ 219 ? ## ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ & b ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙ g: ____ V7/____ ____ V7/____ ____ V7/____ CHAPTER 18. SECONDARY DIMINISHED CHORDS ### 4 V 4 511 œ œ ˙ œœ #œ œ ˙ nœ œ ww ____ 203 œœ œœ œ œœ˙ œ œ œ œ œœ YT: Cw16cySo65Y Figure 18.1.5 Dewayne Blackwell and Earl Bud Lee, “Friends in Low Places” (1990) 18.2 Secondary Diminished Chords in Major and Minor 28 Below are the secondary diminished chords that occur in major and minor. 28 533 533 C˜o D˜o & #Cwww˜o &C: vii# wwwo/ii C: viiCo/ii ˜o7 538 & & 538 543 543 547 547 C: bCw˜o7 #b wwww # wwwo7/ii vii viio7/ii wo # #Dww˜ w #vii# wwo/iii vii /iii C: 18.2.1 Secondary Figure Eo b & bbb &bb b & bbb &bb c: c: w n wwEo w n wwo/iv vii c: Dvii ø7 o/iv www ww www/III viiø7 Dø7 c: viiø7/III viiø7/IV viiø7/V vii /vi ø7/IV Diminishedvii Triads # nFwww˜o # n wwwo/V vii F˜o o Eo7 vii /V bEwwwo7 bn wwww 7/iv viinow b & bbb b b that vii◦/III &Notice ø7 552 w #Gww˜o w #viiwwo/vi viio7/iv wwwø7 F # ww˜ # www and b wwwo bGwww Go w # nFwwww˜o7 w #viin wwo7/V viio7/V bGwwwwø7 b wwww viio/VI Gø7 viiø7/VI viiø7/VI ww #Gwww˜o7 w # wwo7 o7 vii G˜o/vi viiø7/V Chords Seventh viio/VI F˜o7 G˜o o7 vii F˜ø/V 7 viiEoø/IV D˜o7 viio7/iii w #Fww˜o w # ww viio/V bEwwwwø7 b wwww o 7 vii D˜o/iii www # # ww # # wwwo7 bEwwo w b ww o/IV viiw F˜o Eo 7/vi vii in oMajor o A nAwwwo n www viio/VII w nAwwwwø7 n www viiø7/VII viio/VII Aø7 viiø7/VII 552 Figure 18.2.2 Secondary Diminished Triads and Seventh Chords in Minor in minor is not included because it is ii◦ . Notice also that vii III has no accidentals—it is the same as iiø7 but functions differently. The iiø7 chord has pre–dominant function and progresses to V ø7 whereas the vii III chord progresses to III . Minor triads are tonicized by fully diminished seventh chords. Major triads are traditionally tonicized by half diminished seventh chords but can also be tonicized by fully diminished seventh chords. CHAPTER 18. SECONDARY DIMINISHED CHORDS 204 18.3 Analyzing Secondary Diminished Chords When you encounter a chord with a chromaticism and suspect it is a secondary diminished seventh chord, use the following process. 70 1. Stack the chord in thirds to determine the root and quality. If the chord quality is a diminished triad or a half–diminished and fully–diminished seventh chord, go on to step 2. If the chord quality is not a diminished triad or a half–diminished and fully–diminished seventh chord, the chord is not a secondary diminished chord. 975 # & # 44 ww #w w ? # # 44 w # www M3 m3 m3 ? D: _____ The chord in question is an G4 half–diminished seventh chord in first inversion. 977 & # 2. Determine the note that would be a minor 2nd above the root of the chord you are analyzing. If this note of resolution would be the root of a diatonic chord, the chord you are analyzing is a secondary diminished chord. ?# # & # 515 999 & # w # www w G˜ up m2 is A; in D major, A is 5̂ .517 4 515G ø7 B is analyzed as viiø65 V in D major. This # &? ## & ## ww # ww 18.4 Writing Secondary Diminished Chords ### 531 diminished chord, use the following procedure. To write a secondary && ˜ w 1. First determine the note that is the root of the chord being tonicized G up m2 is A; in D major, A is (the chord to the right of the slash). 517 b b & ?# g: viio42/iv b b & 4ˆ is C 2. Determine vii◦7 in the key of C minor (C is the root of the iv chord, ◦7 which is the Roman 518 numeral after the slash): B is the root of vii in C minor because it is a m2 below C. 3. Build a fully–diminished seventh chord on B: B–D–F–A2 5̂ &b CHAPTER 18. SECONDARY DIMINISHED g: viio42/ivCHORDS 4. Invert the chord accordingly. is the 518 bass note. 975 b b & 210 w b n www 3 1. 210 4ˆ is C inversion means the 7th of the chord (A2) o4 7 ## c C C7/B¯ g: vii 2/iv A Dm7 & j ww w M3 j www j m3 515 # œ œ œ m3œ œ b œ œ œ œ œ &#44 œ œ œ ˙ 519 œ ˙ œœ œ ˙ Œ œ œ J b # # w # # cw w Exercises 18.5&?Practice b Baw - by love, my & w ba - by love, I need you oh how I need you # ww ? 22 70 4 2 205 517 977 518 215 2. D: œ_____ œœ œœ diminished œœ œœ # œœœchords n œœ œœ œœ symœ Analyze the œœfollowing œ œœ œœœ secondary œœœœ œœœœ with œœœœ lead–sheet œbelow.œ œ œœ œ œ D major, œ with œ œA isfigured 4 ˜œupœ m2 isnumerals A; in 5̂ œ bass bols above symbols ‰ andGRoman &4 b b4# # ww b b # w &? & 4 ‰ w œ œ œn œww œ œœœ g: viio42/iv # w ? # # C: I b b 4ˆ isn wC b w g: _____ & b n#D:www_____ 1 2œ . V # 44g: viiÓ o4/iv œJ Lead-sheet: ____ ____ 983 3. 219 988 219 bbbœb b wwœ œ œ b b b b b bœ œ œ œ w b bVb 42/IVw b b b b b ____ E¯: _____ 3 œ œ. ˙ # # ‹w b nœww œ œ# # œ # ww œ b b bœ œn wwœ œ œœœ nœww œ œ œ # # w ii7b b b b ww V7/ii # # b ____ D¯: _____ 4 ____ c ˜: _____ 5 Œ‰ j œ œ œ œ ____ A¯: _____ 6 Œ œ IncludeF‹o7lead–sheet Write theAfollowing secondary diminished chords. ø7/F ˜o7 2 C ˜o/E J G Eo7/B¯ /EJ œ . œAo7sym/C o6/Vsignatures. bols above. key viio7Include /vi vii viiø4/IV viio4/iii viio4/V viio6/ii 44 j j j j j‰ ?& # # _____ œœ .. œœ #œœ _____ œœ œœœ .. œœœb _____ œœœ œœœ .. œœœ #.. œœœ# œœœ_____ œœœ œbœœ ..n œœœ_____ œ. . œ œ œ # œ .. bœ œ œ .. . # w bb . œn ww œœœ ... œ b b & 1.bA¯: ww viio7/vi # ww 2. c: viio65/V# ww 3. e: viiø4n3w/III 4. B: viio42/ii ? # # the 44 ˙following Analyze symbols wlead–sheet w above˙ andb ww˙Roman 523 œ n wexcerpt œ . ˙ . with œ # œ ? # w # # w Analyze w # below. J wbass inversion numerals ? b bb wwith figured b b n w symbols b b b b non–chord tones in parentheses. ____Don't go 519 215 27 3 chang -____ ing2 ____ to try and please 2 3 me ____ 5 2. e: _____ _____ ____ 3. B¯: _____ ____4. f ˜: _________ 5. A¯: ____ ____ j œ_____ j ‰ ‰ _____∑ œ œ œ œ œ _____ & b 68 _____ œ _____ ( ) œ. œ œ œ œœœ . ( ) # # # # bbb w b b # w # b w # # b b b b w We'll & w keep on fight # w- ing . till. #then wwend b b b n ww j j n w n w. j ? b 68 œœ . œœ ‰ ‰ œœ .. œœ ‰ œœ # wœœœ ... ‰ b œ œ # wœ ? b b b nœw. œ # # # # œww. œ# # #œ# w b b>œ bœ b # œ w >œ œ b>œœb wœœ . J J# b b >b > ? b 68 ‰ 9. e¯:_____ 10. g:_____ 6. f:_____ 7. c˜: _____ 8. B:_____ œ. œ œ #˙. ˙. ˙. (# œ ) œ >> > 1. d: _____ ____ F: ____ 1 ____ 2 ____ 3 ____ 4 ____ ____ 5 6 YT: 04854XqcfCY Figure 18.5.1 Freddie Mercury, “We Are the Champions” (1977) CHAPTER 18. SECONDARY DIMINISHED CHORDS 206 Click here to download the first homework assignment for this chapter. Click here to download the second homework assignment for this chapter. Chapter 19 Mode Mixture 19.1 Mode Mixture 24 Mode mixture typically consists of borrowing chords from the parallel minor during a passage in a major key. “Borrowed chords” refers to borrowing chords from minor and is synonymous with mode mixture. In the examples that follow, notice the lowered chromaticisms—26̂ is most common but 23̂ and 27̂ also occur in borrowed chords. ### 6 V 4 œ œ ˙ Ó 44 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ E D˜ø7 D Dm 232 B7 ## & # 46 œ œ ˙ n ˙ 44 ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ (œ ) œ # ˙˙ A: V viiø7/V IV iv V7/V All 232 A/C˜ your life you were on - ly wait-ing for your ? # # # 46 œ # œ n ˙ ˙ 44 ˙ ped. pt. ## V # 235 ### ∑ ∑ ∑ YT: 4J5FPNitDc8 A œ œ œœ ˙ mo - ment to ar - rive. n ˙˙ ˙˙ V7sus4 I ˙ ˙ I6 E7sus4 ∑ Figure 19.1.1 Lennon-McCartney, “Blackbird” (1968) ˙ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ? ### ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ### ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ 235 & Notice the emotional effect of switching to the minor mode. A famous example that progresses from the major I chord immediately to the minor i chord is Richard Strauss’s Also Sprach Zarathustra. 241 V ## & # 241 ∑ ∑ 207 ∑ 72 œ ˙ œœ œœ œ œ œ ? b 43 œ œ œ œ œ œ # œœ ˙ (œ) U̇ œ œ #œ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œ œ # œ b œ œ 3 b œ œ œ 7 o7 # ˙I 208 CHAPTER MIXTURE & 4d: œ19. MODE œ œ œ # œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ# œ œ # œV n œœ viiœœPicardy œ ˙ third œœ bœww œ œœ ≈ ‰œ Œ Óœ U̇ ˙ œ .. c & 3˙ œ ˙œ œ œ œ œœ # œw œ œœ œœ œ ? ˙ (œ) b 4 R R p p f 3 V 7 3 viio73 I 3 f d: ?c w w w œ œ œ œ œ œ œPicardy œ œ œthird œ œ C Cm w w w œœ ≈ ‰ Œ Ó ˙ œ .. œœœI b wwwi & cC: ˙ ˙ œ R R p p f 3 3 3 3 f & ?c w wYT: IFPwm0e_K98w œ œ œœœœœœœœœœ Figure 19.1.2 w RichardwStrauss, Also Sprach w Zarathustra, Op.30 (1896) Zarathustra, another borrowed ?Later C: during the opening of Also I Sprach i C Cm chord occurs. Dø7/F F & c œœœ œœœ œœœ ˙˙˙ & f ?c ? w C: IV & b œœœœ w iiø65 C/G œœ œœœ ˙˙˙ œ œ ˙œ œ œ Œ w w œœœ œœ œœ œ œ œ I64 YT: IFPwm0e_K98 Figure 19.1.3 Richard Strauss, Also Sprach Zarathustra, Op.30 (1896) ? The next three examples have the pattern 1̂ –27̂ –6̂ –26̂ in the bass line. # 4 4 ˙ ˙ A: V viiø7/V IV iv I6 CHAPTER 19. MODE MIXTURE 235 235 b & b b 44 Œ œ œ œ œ E¯ b & b b 44 Œ œœ Ev - 'ry day ? b b 44 w b œ œ V7/V ‰œ œ is so œ œ >œ œ 237 bb & b Cm ˙ V7sus4 œ. œ œ won - der - ful œœ œ bw I 209 ‰ . œr œ œ œ E¯7/D¯ 3 œ œ Then sud - den - ly œœ > œ œ V24/IV E¯: I 237 ˙ ‰. b & b b œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ? bb w b r œ œ œ bœ It's hard to breathe œœ > œ vi YT: f1zLSpzCh9E Figure 19.1.4 Linda Perry, “Beautiful” (2002) Fø7/C¯ ˙ Ó b œœ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ > bw iiø43 210 25 CHAPTER 19. MODE MIXTURE # & # 44 œ œ œ œ n œ œ œ œ # & # 44 ‰ nev - er 239 ? # # 44 ˙ 241 241 & ## ‰ j œ œ œ nœ ˙ I64 a G/B word he j œ œ n œœ n˙ œœ œ him œ œ œ a - drink œ œ j œ œ said ¯VI IV j œ B¯ j j b œ œœ œœ n œœ œ œ j œ. bœ sin - gle V24/IV D/A # & # œ ? ## un - der - stood D: I helped j nœ œ D7/C D 239 œœ œ œ œ But œœ œ ˙ œ his j œ wine œ œœ # œ œœ œœ nœ D #œ œ I œ I # & # ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ 243 YT: kyI1OImD7ow # ∑ ∑ bass This# same ∑ ∑line∑ can∑ be∑ found ∑ ∑ (in ∑ ∑the∑same ∑ ∑harmonic ∑ ∑ ∑rhythm) ∑ ∑ ∑in ∑“Part ∑ & of Your World.” Figure 19.1.5 Hoyt Axton, “Joy to the World” (1970) 243 ? # # ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ YT: ∑ ∑SXKlJuO07eM ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ Figure 19.1.6 Howard Ashman and Alan Menken, The Little Mermaid, “Part of Your World” (1989) In the next example by Radiohead, the iv chord (borrowed from minor) is preceded by the major IV chord. A7 Dm ____ ____ w ˙ # ˙˙˙ ˙˙˙ ø6 # ˙˙˙ w6 ˙˙ ? 44C: ˙˙˙˙wIV ˙ ii 5 ˙ I4 ˙˙ CHAPTER 19. MODE MIXTURE E7 ____ C ____ 583 I C: ____ G & # vi V7/____ vi ____ B #____ wwF C7 ww____ w wb ˙ ˙ ˙˙˙ ˙˙ ˙w w ww w ? 44 ˙˙˙˙ ?# w 587 Am ____ C ____ I C: ____ G: I IV V7/____ IV ____ V/vi ii V7/____ ww w˙ # ˙˙˙ w E7 ____ vi V7/____ ii ____ C ww____ wAm ˙˙ ˙ w˙ vi ____ IV D7 ____ # ˙˙˙˙ G w ____ ww ww V V7/____ V ____ Cm ww____ b ww____ 7 wD wG ww # ˙˙˙˙ w w ww V V7/____ V ____ iv 211 ww w w 591 F____ ˜o7/A F____ ˜ø7/C B____ ˜o7/A www YT: XFkzRNyygfk ? # www # ColinwwwwGreenwood, # # # # Ed O’Brien, w b n w b Figure b b b19.1.7 Thom Yorke, b b Jonnyn Greenwood, # n # www w Eo7 ____ Philip Selway, Albert Hammond, and Mike Hazlewood, “Creep” (1992) o6/V 1. A¯: viio7 2. in c: vii e: band viiø43/III Mode mixture is/vi also found the the Nirvana. 4. B: viio42/ii 5 music of 3. 595 D5 ? # # 44 ˙ ˙˙ D: I F˜5 B5 ˙˙ ˙ G5 iii vi IV ˙˙ ˙ ˙˙ ˙ n bb ˙˙˙ B¯5 ¯VI C5 n ˙˙ n˙ A5 C5 ¯VII V ¯VII ˙˙ ˙ n ˙˙ n˙ YT: pkcJEvMcnEg Figure 19.1.8 Kurt Cobain, “Lithium” (1992) In the example above for “Lithium,” the Roman numerals are analyzed as triads instead of “5” chords because the third of the chord is either implied or occurs in the voice part (not shown). In the next example from the third movement Brahms’s Third Symphony, the I chord alternates twice with a borrowed chord. There are three flats in the key signature because this movement began in C minor, but this section occurs later in the movement and is in C major. CHAPTER 19. MODE MIXTURE Bo7/C (ped.) C b & b b 38 œ n œ π dolce ‰ œ ? b b 38 œœ .. b 212 œ C: I Bo7/C (ped.) b b œ A œœ œ œ n œ b & œ œ nœ œ œ ‰ ? b b œœ b n œœœ ) b (J ped. pt. viio7 b &bb C œ Aœ œ nœ œ œ b n œœœ œ) ‰ œ (œ J ‰ œœ . . ped. pt. viio7 nœ œ nœ œ I C C/E F Bo œ œ œ nœ œ œ nœ œ nœ œ œ œ nœ J œ nœ œ œ œ œ nœ J ‰œ œ I I6 IV viio YT: UH324lgbxaI Figure 19.1.9 Johannes Brahms, Symphony No. 3 in F major, Op. 90, III. Poco Allegretto (1883) alternation between the I chord and a borrowed chord (2 VII ) ?A similar happens b b bin “Inchworm,” from the movie Hans Christian Andersen. Notice the 26̂ 7 special quality of the borrowed in the upper melody. 73 CHAPTER 19. MODE MIXTURE 23 b & b b 43 œ œ Two and œ two ? b 3 Œ œ œ bb 4 œ ˆ (6) bœ ˙ are four, b 3 & b b 4 Œ ˙˙ ˙ ? b 3 ˙. bb 4 E¯: I œ œ four and ˆ (6) œ bœ four are Œ œ œ œ Œ œ œ œ œ œJ 3 Inch - worm, E¯ 213 3 Inch - worm, meas - ur - ing the ˙ eight, œœ œ Œ 3 œ mar - i - golds, D¯7 b b ˙˙˙˙ .... E¯ b˙. Œ ˙ ˙˙ ˙. b b ˙˙˙˙ .... ¯VII7 I ¯VII7 D¯7 b˙. b &bb ∑ ? b bb ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ b &bb ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ? bb ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ 27 ∑ YT: 6dd6e14ov2c ∑ ∑ ∑ Figure 19.1.10 Frank Loesser, Hans Christian Andersen, “Inchworm” (1952) A famous example of mode mixture occurs in the “Waltz of the Flowers” from Tchaikovsky’s Nutcracker. b ? b ‰œœ b n œœœ bb( J ped. pt. ) œ œ œ œ nœ J CHAPTER o7 MODE MIXTURE vii19. I # & # 43 ? ## # & # 239 443 4 D dolce cantando p œœ D œœ D: I # D & # 44 ‰ # & # ? ## P 44 ˙ ? # # D:œœ I œ # # D/A & nIœ œœ œœœ 239 241 241 & ## ? ## helped œ ˙ I6 C˜o7/D (ped.) ˙ b ˙˙˙ > viio7 un - der - stood j œ œ œœœ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œ - 214 œ œ I his j œœ >œr œ œ. word he IV j bn œœ œ j bœ said nœ But œœ œœ> œ œ ˙˙ ˙ ˙ f. œœ ‰ ¯VI j ‰ J Dœ . j I œ wine œ œœ œœ D œœ # œ YT: Kw0wLLVEMaA œ 25 œœ œœ B¯ œœ œœ œn œj œ œ œj œ œ œ sin - gle drink ˙˙ .. ˙. G/B ‰ j œ - œ >n œptœ œ bn ˙œœœ ( œ˙˙ .. ) bœ œ V24/IV œ œ œ ( ) ped. pt. j œ viiœo7 œ œ a nœ J viio IV œœ ... œœ ˙˙ .. œœ . œ ˙ . C˜o7/D (ped.) him œœ a œ D œœ œœ D7/Cœœ œ œœœ œ œ œ (nœœ)ped.œpt. œ nev - er œœ n œ œ #œ >œœœ œœ I œœ. ‰ J œ Figure 19.1.11 Tchaikovsky, Nutcracker, “Waltz of the Flowers” (1892) A similar melody occurs in “One Day I’ll Fly Away,” which, though it has a different Iharmonization, still uses mode mixture. 6 I 4 243 243 # 3 & # 4 D œ One # # 3 ˙˙˙ ... & 4 ˙. ? # # 43 ˙ . ˙. D: I œ day œ I'll Gm ˙ ˙. b ˙˙˙ ... fly ˙. ˙. iv œ œ a D - ˙. ˙˙ .. ˙˙ .. way. ˙. ˙. I YT: I8eNaVEEtC8 Figure 19.1.12 Joe Sample and Will Jennings, “One Day I’ll Fly Away” (1980) CHAPTER 19. MODE MIXTURE 215 19.2 Harmonization of Borrowed Scale Degrees Let us examine the ways 26̂ can be harmonized as root, 3rd, 5th, and 7th of a borrowed chord. 30 30 b b www & b www b ww w b www w b ww ww b b www b www b ww w b www w b ww ww bw b ww b www b b www b www b www C: ¯VI ˆ ¯6 as: Root 599 & & iv 3rd iio 5th iiø7 5th viio7 7th b ww b ww ¯VII7 7th b ww b ww Figure 19.2.1 Harmonization of 26̂ 605 Here are the ways 23̂ and 27̂ can each be harmonized as root, 3rd, and 5th of 7 C: ¯VIchord (notice iv some of these iio chords are iiø7 duplicates viio7from the ¯VII a borrowed previous ¯6ˆ as: Root 3rd 5th 5th 7th 7th example). 599 & 613 30 C: ¯III ¯3 as: Root b b www i 3rd ¯VI 5th ¯VII ¯7 as: Root v 3rd bw b ww ¯III 5th b www b ww b ww b ww b ww & w23̂ 27̂ ww ww b ww Figure 19.2.2 Harmonization of and &It C:is not 611 ¯VI iv iio iiø7 viio7 ¯VII7 necessary to memorize the chords in this section so much as to ˆ Root 3rd of diatonic 5thchords will5th realize the quality be altered7th when a scale7th degree &¯6 as:that from the minor mode is included in the chord. bw 627 www b ww b www b www b b www Chords bw b & 19.3 & Analyzing and Writing Borrowed 615 b ww ¯III i ¯VI ¯VII v ¯III & C:secondary Unlike chords, you merely note the root, quality, and inversion of a 605 620 599 605 ¯3 as: Root 3rd 5th ¯7 as: Root borrowed chord in your Roman numeral analysis. So, for the following chord: 611 622 & 615 & # b wwww ? G: ____ # b wwww A is root when stacked in 3rds; A is 2ˆ b wwww 3rd M3 m3 m3 quality is ø7 (m3-m3-M3) 5th b wwww iiø65 G: ____ (bass note is 3rd of chord) Notice that the root is A when you stack the notes in 3rds, and A is 2̂ in G major. The quality is half–diminished since the 3rds stack as m3–m3–M3, making this a iiø7 chord. Since C, the 3rd of the chord, is in the bass, the correct analysis is iiø65 . To write a borrowed chord from a Roman numeral, be sure to pay close attention to the quality of the Roman numeral. 622 A: 2 VI 2 VI is built on 26̂ . Determine 26̂ in A major, which is F6, then stack 3rds in the configuration M3–m3. The resulting triad contains F6–A–C6. & # A is root when quality is ø7 stacked in 3rds; (m3-m3-M3) A is 2ˆ 216 ? G: ____ CHAPTER 19. MODE MIXTURE ### 615 & nw n ww A: ¯VI Be careful of flats before Roman numerals. Flats mean to lower a root a m2 in the key signature, not to literally put a flat in front of the root of a chord. # # # Cadence with 2 VI 19.4 The Deceptive & 616 26 The V –2 VI deceptive cadence is a deceptive realization of a deceptive progression. This V –2 VI cadence ties into the 2 VI –2 VII – I progression to produce an “epic” (although somewhat clichéd) ending to the “Star Spangled Banner” as performed at the Super Bowl and Presidential Inaugurations by artists such as Whitney Houston, Beyoncé, and Lady Gaga, among others. b & b b b 43 œ œ Dø7 B¯7/D A¯/E¯ 246 And œ. home ? b b b 43 n œ œ b nœ œ of the j œ œ œ œ œ. œ. A¯: viiø7 V56 I64 F¯6 œ œ œ . 44 w J esc. j œœ .. ( œœ ) œœ œ . œ œœ the b & b b b 43 n œœœ œœœœ œ 246 E¯7 V7 G¯add9 brave! 44 ˙ b ˙˙ 44 b ˙ b˙ ¯VI U A¯ w U b ˙˙˙ ˙ ww w U w b˙ b˙ w ¯VII I vi 250 250 #### 4 & 4 œ œ ˙. Am Bsus4 B E/B C D E œ w J Figure 19.4.1 John Stafford Smith and Francis Scott Key, “The Star-Spangled ## & # # 44 n œœ (œ ) œ ? # # # # 44 n œ nœ œ YT:wKbkWuVUkPmYw ˙ .. œ w˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ w n n ww n www ww w Vsus4–3 ¯VI ¯VII I home of the brave, at the 1991 Super the brave! Banner” (1814)And as the performed by Whitney Houston Bowl E: iv6 256 & #### ## & ## 256 ? #### ˙w. w ( ) œ ˙. œ ˙. I46 œ ˙. œ ˙. n˙. œ n˙. œ œ w n˙. œ n˙. œ œ w ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ iiø G: ___ (bass n 3rd of b œ . ofœj the œ nAnd œ theœ home esc. ø7 V6 b b b b A¯: œœœ5œ œœœI64... ( œœœ ) œœœVœ7 & 43 viiœMODE œ CHAPTER 19.n œ œ vi MIXTURE j ? b#b #b 43 n œAm œ E/B œ . œBsusœ 4 B b & # # 44 n œœ œ œ ˙ . œ . œ œw œ 246 250 A¯: viiø7 V56 250 250 256 of the D˜m G˜ø7/D F˜/C˜ U b ˙˙˙ ˙ wwI w ¯VII b˙ b˙ 44 bC˙ b˙ w ¯VI C˜7 #### # 4 & ? # # ## 4 œ œ ˙. œ œ ∑ j œ home of the # ## # 4 & # # 4 œœ n œœœ œ œ ˙˙ .... ˙ .. j œœ ww œ w ? # # # # # 44 # œ nœ œ nœ w w # 256 V7 44 ¯VI ˙ b ˙˙ U w 217 wœ w J D ˙ .. ¯VII E I # # # # 4 vi & 4 n œœ (œ ) ˙w. (œ ) w˙ ˙ ww n Dwww n wwwC 4 ˙B w ˙ Am E/B Bsus E œ n w #### 4 œ w & .. ? # # # # 444 n œœ œ ˙œ . ˙ . œ wœ ˙ . n w˙ . œ n ˙˙ . œ Jœ w w nAnd œ the home n brave, ˙ . œ n ˙ . œ theœ brave! œ ˙ . of theœ ˙ . # # 4–3 ¯VI ¯VII I & # # 44E: nivœœ6 (œ ) I˙w46 . (œ ) Vsus w ww ˙ w w ˙ n n w w ˙ ˙ w œ w nw w 256 # # ∑ ? & # ## # ## 44 n œ œ ˙ ∑. n˙. œ n˙. œ œ w ˙. YT:œ qGDH18R7GfA . œ n˙. œ œ w n œ œ ˙ . Smithœ and ˙ . Francisn ˙Scott Figure 19.4.2 John Stafford Key, “The Star-Spangled 256 6 performed 6 4–3 at the # # #(1814) Banner” as by Beyoncé 2013 Presidential E: iv I Vsus ¯VI ¯VII I 4 ∑ ∑ Inauguration & # And the home 250 I64 w b brave! ˙ b˙ And F˜: vi the iiø43 I46 ˙ œ œ œœ ˙ w w V7 brave, the brave! D w > >œ> Œœ œ n n www > Œ >œ œ >œ brave, nw nw ¯VI E ∑ ˙. F˜ œ w > >œ> Œœ œ Ó˙ n ww ˙˙ w > Œ >œ œ >œ Ó ˙ nw ˙ nw ¯VII the brave! I YT: GbXSZBnBOQ4 Figure 19.4.3 John Stafford Smith and Francis Scott Key, “The Star-Spangled Banner” (1814) as performed by Lady Gaga at the 2016 Super Bowl This same V –2 VI deceptive cadence with 2 VI progressing to 2 VII followed by I occurs in epic fashion at the end of the animated film Beauty and the Beast from 1991. CHAPTER 19. MODE MIXTURE 218 19.5 The Picardy 3rd It is rare to borrow from the major mode during a passage in a minor key. The major tonic usually functions as V/iv if it’s not the last chord of a piece, and raised 6̂ and 7̂ occur naturally as part of the melodic minor scale. In minor, the one place to borrow from the major mode is at the end of a piece in minor, with the use of the major I chord instead of minor i . U̇ œœœœ œ #œ œ œ œ 3 œ œ # œ & b 4 œœ œœ œœ œœœ œœ b œ œœ œ œœ# œœ # œœ œ # œœ n œœ œœ œ # ˙˙ 72 ? b 43 œ œ œ œ bw b www & d: b ww 30 599 &b C: ¯VI ¯6ˆ as: Root iv 3rd b b www œ œ # œœ b ww w iio 5th œœ œœ œ œ œ b www b ww7 w Vw w iiø7 5th viio7 7th U̇ œ ˙ (œ) b ww viio7 bIw w Picardy 7 ¯VIIthird 7th b www YT: fTwkVsECg9w b www b www bw b b www & b ww Figure 19.5.1 J.S. Bach, French Suite No. 1 in D Minor, BWV 812, Sarabande ?While ¯VI ¯VII v ¯III the¯III Picardy 3rdi (the major third above the tonic) was most comb ¯3C:as: Root 3rd 5th ¯7 as: Root 3rd 5th 605 monly encountered in the Baroque era, it has been used from then until now, though with less frequency. 611 &b C˜o7/B¯ 1. 615 # w 616 634 2. 622 646 b wwww M3 m3 m3 ? ? # ww b b ww # w # # w b w b # ## b ww b b b b w # # www # # # n www b b ww # n w & n ww D: ____ A:1 ¯VI 628 b wwww ø7/G A˜o7/G A is root C˜lead–sheet E¯m/G¯ D/F˜ andø6Roman 31 when ø76 above Analyze theC¯following with symbols ? ¯III chords quality is iv o4/iii ø4 6ii/V5 G: V____ viio42 G: ____ vii ii 2 in 3rds; stacked 3 numerals with figured bass inversion symbols below. (m3-m3-M3) (bass note is ˆ ____ 628 640 w b www 19.6&Practice b www Exercises 3. A is 2 ____ ____ A¯: ____ 2 G: ____ 3 ____ B: ____ 4 ____ 3rd of chord) ____ B¯: ____ 5 b b b # n www c: ____ 6 b &the b ww symbols. analyze with lead–sheet w # # www b b www ? staff, # # # # and n www b b wwww____ # # ww____ b b b b ww____ # # ____ w b ____ ____ ### w b b ## # b b F:b ____ D: ____ E¯:b ____ bB¯: & E: ____ A: ____ ____ ?b ____ ____ ____the chord ____ on Given the____ Roman numeral, key,____ and key signature, notate 1 A: iv D¯/F ____ ____ 2 f: V34/V A¯/E¯ ____ ____ 3 D: ¯VI o/E¯ C ____ ____ 4 F: iiø65 D/F˜ ____ ____ 5 e: viio42/iv Ao/C ____ ____ 6 B¯: ¯III C ____ ____ Analyze the symbols above and Roman ww following ww lead–sheet ### b w excerpt #b# #with # ww that w ww #notes bb bb b with b b b bAnalyze b # ? w # numerals figured bass inversion symbols below. w b b b # n w w # w # nw & b b b b ww are non–chord tonesb wby putting parentheses around them and specifying them E¯: by ¯VII type. 7 ø4 6 o6 ¯III b: V56N/iv g: viio7 A¯: G:Niio6 N6 iiA: N6/V viio6ii/VI 3 4 c: ____ e: ____ B¯: ____ c˜: ____ d: ____ b: ____ # ____ & # # ____ b ____ # ____ b ____ # ____ w b w w b w # b ww b b ww & # # # www b b b ww n # www b b ww w w 1 f˜: ____ 1 2 3 f: ____ 2 e: ____ 3 4 B¯: ____ 4 5 D: ____ 5 6 d: ____ 6 CHAPTER 19. MODE MIXTURE 74 219 __________ __________ œ. b & b b 12 8 œJ œ œ œ œ. __________ œ b . œ œ œ J œ œœœ œ œ œœœ œ œœœ œœ b œœœ œ œ œ. .œ .œ œ. * ° * ° * ° ° E¯: __________ ? bb __________ espress. dolce ? b b 12 b 8 ‰ b &bb __________ nœ œ ° œ J œœ œ * __________ & 44 www Lead-sheet: ____ Tbn __________ ___________ œ œ. ° œ œ œœ œ ___________ ____ ____________ œ bœ. J * __________ œ ° b œ œœœ œ ____ YT: bVeOdm-29pU __________ ___________ œ. œ * ° ____________ * œœ œœ œ * ___________ ww w ____ Figure 19.6.1 Nocturne in E-flat major, Op. 9, No. 2 Rom. num.: ____ Frédéric Chopin, ____ ____ ____ (1832) ? 44 w w Function: Tonic Mode mixture Tonic __________ (with ¯6) ____ ____ ____ ClickL.S.: here____ to download the homework assignment for this chapter. PDF versions of the textbook, homework exercises, and practice exercises can be found at musictheory.pugetsound.edu & www ? w www www w R.N.: ____ ____ ____ w Func.:__________ Secondary of V __________ __________ ____ Chapter 20 The Neapolitan Chord 20.1 The Neapolitan Chord The label “Neapolitan” is used in classical music for the 2 II chord and is labeled as “ N ” instead of 2 II . For example, when the Neapolitan chord occurs in first inversion—its most common inversion—it is labeled as N6 . Being a chromatically altered ii chord, the Neapolitan has pre–dominant harmonic function. Notice the special character of the Neapolitan and how composers sometimes alter texture, register, and dynamics when the Neapolitan occurs, as in the first movement of Beethoven’s Symphony No. 7, Op. 92. & ### ? ### œ œ œ œ œ œ 6 œœœœœœœœœœœœ 8 ƒ œ 68 œ. œ œ. œ œ œ. A A: I œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ Bm7/D œœ j ≈œ œ œ . œ œ œœ œ. œ. œœ œ. œœ ii65 # # # œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ b œ .. nœ. œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ b œ & #œ. cresc. π œœ œœ n œœb œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ n œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ ? ### ≈ œ . œ œ œj B¯/D N6 ## & # E7 V7 YT: -4788Tmz9Zo Figure 20.1.1 Beethoven, Symphony No. 7, Op. 92, I (1812) ? ### & ### 220 œ A ƒ œ œ I 75 cresc. ƒ π œœœœ n œœb œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ n œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ ? ### ≈ j œ œ NEAPOLITAN œ . THE CHAPTER œ20. CHORD 221 œ 20.2 Examples of the Neapolitan Chord 6 7 N ## & ## C C˜m 3 3 3 V C˜m/B 3 3 3 I 3 3 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ sempre π e senza sordini ? #### C w w w w c˜: i & #### ? #### i42 A D/F˜ G˜7 C˜m/G˜ G˜sus4 G˜7 C˜m œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ nœ œ œ œ #œ œ œ œ œ œ #œ œ œ œ œ 3 ˙ ˙ VI 3 3 ˙ ˙ N6 3 3 ˙ ˙ V7 3 i64 3 ˙ ˙ V4 3 œœ œ 7 3 i YT: bT6WmWVYPhI Figure 20.2.1 Beethoven, Moonlight Sonata, Op. 27, No. 2, I (1802) For comparison, play the example above from the Moonlight Sonata and 4 4◦. 4 ◦6 try other pre–dominant chords in its place, like iv ( F m ) or ii ( D F ), while noting the difference in effect. The next example is a well-known movie theme. CHAPTER 20. THE NEAPOLITAN CHORD 76 & 44 œ . œ œ. œ ˙ œœœ ‰ ‰ œœœ œœœ œœœ ‰ Œ J J ? 44 Œ C: 76 I C V7 G7 (no 3rd) D¯ œ. œ bœ œœœœ b œœ ‰ ‰ œœ œœ œœ œœ ‰ Œ J N D¯ œ. œ ˙. œ. œ . œ œœ ‰ œ œœ œœ œ œœ œ œ. œ bœ œœœœ Œ b œœ ‰ ‰ œœ œœ œœ œœj ‰ Œ J Œ N œœ ‰ œœ Œ 7 & 44G œ(no. 3rd) œ œ. œ ˙ œ œœ ‰ œ œœ œœ ‰ & œœ œ œœœ ‰ ‰ œœœ œœœ œœœ ‰ ? 44 Œ œ J Œ œJ ? C:Œ I œ œ œ & œœ ˙. œ. œ C 222 œœ ‰ œ œœ œœ ‰ œ œœ œœ. œ œ œ. œ YT: ML-RqsAG09o œœ ‰ œ œœ œ j & œ œ œ œ ? Œ Œ ‰ pre–dominant As with theœ example from the œ MoonlightŒ Sonata, œ try other œ Œ Figure 20.2.2 John Williams, Raiders of the Lost Ark, “Raiders March” (1981) ? chords V (like IV , iv , or iiø65 ) in place of the Neapolitan chord in the example 7 above, and notice the difference in effect. The next example shows the harmonic progression from main theme of the recent Star Trek movies. & b 44 w ww Dm ? b 44 w w d: i ww w w w B¯ ww w w w VI ww w w w E¯ b ww w bw bw N ww w w w A # ww w w w V ww w w w &b Figure 20.2.3 Michael Giacchino, Star Trek, “End Credits” (2009) (chords YT: EO1FZEUbZJE only) ?b b 4 w w w w w w bw w w w d: 20. i THE NEAPOLITAN VI N CHAPTER CHORD 4 ww & 4 # ww G˜o7/D Am/C C˜o7/B¯ www C¯ G˜o7/B Am w # www ww w w w V B¯/D b ww w Am/C ww w A˜o7/G C˜ø7/G E¯m/G¯ ¯III viio42/iii iiø43 iv6 E # ww w D/F˜ 223 ww w ? 44 w w____ w ____w ____w w ____ w ____ ____ w w w ? # #w b wwww wb b b b b www # w# ww # # w# # wwww b b ww b b w b A˜o7/G # Cw˜wø7/G #E¯m/G¯ n w 6 6 b D/F w ˜ 6b # n ww C˜o7/B¯ C¯ 6 o4o4 a: vii vii i6 ¯III viio6viio4/iiii N i iv V V /V iiø4 628 viio42 23 D: ____ ____ 1 628 634 5 A¯: ____ ____ 2 2 G: ____ ____ 3 3 B: ____ ____ 4 31 V6/V B¯: ____ ____ 5 c: ____ ____ 6 www b b ____ bw ? # # b w____ www b b ____ ww b b b ____ # wwww # # # # #____ b b b ww # #____ n www n w b w # b ww # # wwww b b www ? # # #D:# ____ # # G:rD5wQROo_bs www b A¯:b ww____ w YT: w b b b B:b www____ # #B¯: w n ____ ____ b c: ____ w 2 and Antonius Figure 20.2.4 w Hans Zimmer Tom Holkenborg, Batman v Su1 3 4 5 6 perman: Dawn of Justice, “The Red Capes are Coming” (2016) (chords only) 634 640 E: ____ ____ 1 F: ____ ____ 2 “ N ” instead6 of II . 646 2. N64 G:____ ____ 2 iio6 B¯: ____ ____ 3 N6 c˜:____ ____ 4 viio6/VI d:____ ____ 5 & ? 658 664 664 N b:____ ____ 6 4 # ww ____ f˜: ____ 1 1. E¯: N6 ____ b ____ b ww w n # ww ____ b ww ____ f: ____ e: ____ B¯: ____ 2 3 4 2. a: N 3. D: ¯III 4. c: viio7/V ____ ____ ____ w ____ D: ____ 5 5. B¯: iiø4 ____2 ____ ____ ____ Click here download the homework____ assignment for this chapter. & to ____ 658 B¯: ____ ____ 6 o6/VI D: ____ f˜: Roman ____ f: ____ e: ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ N6 the N6 numeral, iio6 please N6theB¯: viiof N andd: ____ ____ ____ ____ Given write notes the chord lead–sheet # 1 2 3 4 5 6 # # # symbol. # Include # w key b b b signatures. ww b b b w # b www b b w & 652 A: ____ ____ 5 bw ? b b ww # b ww b b b www # # # # n ww b b www # # n www ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ b ____ w # # # # w b b bbw # ww b b bww # # b www b b w & c: ____ ww d: ____w b: ____ w n # ww c˜:b ____ # ww G:b____b www B¯: ____ w6 1 2 3 4 5 N ____ c: ____ 1 640 652 E¯: ____ ____ 4 ww # # ww b b www # b ww b bD/F w ˜ # ____ A#ow /Cw C b b ____ b ____ b ww ww and b www____lead–sheet # # ____ www ? b b E:the w____following # F:b ww____ # #E¯: # #B¯:Roman Analyze chordsb D: with A:babove ____ ____ n wwwsymbols w n b b b numerals with symbols to6 use 1 figured 4w below.o Remember 5 b w 2bass Cinversion o/E¯ 3 D¯/F D/F˜ A /C C 2A¯/E¯ ?# # w b wwww # C____ ow # #____ n wwww bExercises D¯/F A¯/E¯ /E¯ 20.3 Practice ____ 1. 646 D: ____ ____ 3 ? 3. D: ¯III 1. E¯: N6 2. a: N 1. c˜:____ N6 7 2. b:____ N 3. G: ¯VII ____ w w ____ d: ____ 6 6. G: N6 ____ ____ 4. c: viio7/V 5. B¯: iiø4 6. G: N6 o6/V 4. d: vii ____ 5 5. F:____ N46 6. f˜: ____ N6 2 3 + 3 + 3 + 3 + 3 + 3 + 3 + 3 +2+2 +2+ 2 3 + 3 + 3 + 3 + 3 + 3 + 3 + 3 +2+2 +2+ 2 123 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 123 1 23 1 2 3 1 2 3 12 1 2 1 2 1 2 > #1.# c4˜: N>œ6. >œ ‰2. b:>œ N œ >œ 3.‰ G:>œ¯VII . >œ7 ‰4. d:>œviio65œ/V>œ ‰5. F:>œN46>œ >œ6.#fœ˜: Nœ 6 & 4 J J 123 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 123 1 23 1 2 3 1 2 3 12 1 2 1 2 1 2 # # 4 >œ . >œ ‰ >œ œ >œ ‰ >œ . >œ ‰ >œ œ >œ ‰ >œ >œ > >œ œ #œ & 4 J J 31 Chapter 21 Augmented Sixth Chords 21.1 Augmented Sixth Chords Augmented sixth chords are a special class of pre-dominant chords with notes that approach the dominant (5̂ ) from a half-step below (44̂ ) and from a half-step above (26̂ ) simultaneously. 705 707 ˜4ˆ ? #˙ b ˙ ? C: ¯6ˆ 5ˆ ˙ ˙ 5ˆ ˜4ˆ b b b # ˙˙ c: ¯6ˆ 5ˆ ˙ ˙ 5ˆ Figure 21.1.1 In minor, 26̂ doesn’t require a flat because 6̂ is lowered in the minor key signature. ? 714 of Augmented Sixth Chords 21.2 Types There are three general types of augmented sixth chords—the Italian augmented sixth chord (“ It+6 ”), the French augmented sixth chord (“ Fr+6 ”), and the German augmented sixth chord (“ Ger+6 ”). These geographic labels have persisted 722 throughout the years despite the fact that no reasoning has been found for these designations. 1 All types of augmented sixth chords contain scale degrees 26̂ and 44̂ . To these two scale degrees, the It+6 adds 1̂ . The three notes of the It+6 (26̂ , 44̂ , and 1̂ ) form the foundation of the Fr+6 and Ger+6 . The Fr+6 adds 2̂ to the 26̂ , 44̂ , and 1̂ , and the Ger+6 adds 23̂ to the Italian augmented 730 sixth chord’s 26̂ 44̂ Italian’s , , and 1̂ , as is shown in the example below. ? ? 1 The 1964 Harvard Dictionary of Music states these chords are “rather pointlessly. . . distinguished as ‘Italian,’ ‘German,’ and ‘French’ sixth. . . ” ? 738 224 33 C: ¯6ˆ c: ¯6ˆ 5ˆ 5ˆ CHAPTER 21. AUGMENTED SIXTH CHORDS #w b ww 707 & 705 711 5ˆ ˜4ˆ C: It+6 711 714 718 1 ¯6 # w b www ˜4 2 1 ¯6 ˆ Fr˜4+6 ? # ˙ ˙ bb # ˙ ˙ bb ˙ ˙ # ww b ˜4 ˙ ˙ # www w ¯61 w &bb ˆ C: ¯6ˆ 707 ˜4 b &bb & 714 ˜4 2 1 ¯6 5ˆ c: ¯6 Fr+6 5ˆ c: It+6 #w b ww 5ˆ # w b www 225 b # www b w ˜4 ¯3 1 ¯6 Ger+6 # www w # b # wwww ˜4 ˜2 33 1 ¯6 EnGer+6 ˜4 Ger+6 ¯3 1 ¯6 b b # wwww # b # wwww Figure 21.2.1 The Three Types of Augmented Sixth Chords in Major and Minor ˜4 ˜4 ˜4 ˜4 2 ¯3 +6 +6 ˜2 The final chord on the German1 or EnGer —respells 1 first line—the Enharmonic 1 6 +6 1 the 23̂ as a 42̂ because ¯6 the EnGer+6 resolves ¯6 only to major¯6I4 . The EnGer ¯6 does not occur in+6minor. +6 +6 +6 b C: It Fr Ger & bb b Analyzing 21.3 ˜4 Sixth ˜4 # w ˜4 Augmented # w # ww Chords 729 EnGer 2 ww 1 www ww ¯31 bb & 1 ¯6 Since our process for analyzing chords has been to stack them up in thirds to ¯6 ¯6 determine the root and quality, it is +6 worth examing these four augmented sixth c: It+6 Fr Ger+6 735 chords as stacks of thirds. b &bb & b & bb b &bb 741 # b www o3 C: It+6 # www # b wwww o3 Fr+6 # wwww b #b wwww o3 Ger+6 www #w # # b wwww o3 EnGer+6 (don't forget about the key signature when in minor) c: It+6 o3 Fr+6 o3 o3 Ger+6 b b that all augmented sixth chords contain a 3 when stacked in 3rds. Notice b & None of the chords we have studied so far contain diminished thirds. Figure 21.3.1 Augmented Sixth Chords Stacked in Thirds 721 ◦ Principle 21.3.2 Augmented Sixth Chords. When you encounter a chord with a diminished third, it is an augmented sixth chord. ◦ 741 Once you determine the chord you are analyzing has a 3, analyze the scale degrees to determine which type of augmented sixth chord it is. b &bb 21.4 Lead-Sheet Analysis of Augmented Sixth Chords When using lead-sheet symbols for augmented sixth chords, we will treat them as major-minor seventh chords built on 26̂ , since that matches the sonic quality of the augmented sixth chords and is similar to how they occur and are spelled in jazz and popular music. The chords in parentheses are enharmonic respellings of the three augmented sixth chord types. www ww o # ww 3 # w o3 CHAPTER 21. AUGMENTED SIXTH CHORDS & 721 bbb w # ww (don't forget about the key signature when in minor) o3 c: It+6 #w & b ww C: It+6 Fr+6 b ww (b w ) A¯7 (no 5th) 226 Ger+6 # www ∫ b www b w ( b w) b b www ( bw b # www b w A¯7(¯5) Fr+6 A¯7 Ger+6 ) b &bb Figure 21.4.1 Augmented Sixth Chords Stacked in Thirds 727 In the example above, we see a disagreement between “classical” analysis and lead-sheet analysis. The fundamental concept of lead-sheet analysis is to show root, quality, and inversion. The “classical” spelling and the classical analysis of augmented sixth chords show the direction of resolution (with the chromatically raised notes), which necessitate the need for original labels, since we don’t have a Roman numeral or a lead-sheet symbol that would communicate a chord containing a diminished third above the root (that is then inverted!). Therefore, when you are asked to provide lead-sheet symbols for augmented sixth chords, analyze each one as if it is a dominant 7th chord with a misspelled 2 2 4 2 2 2 7th (A –C–E –F instead of A –C–E –G ). 21.5 Examples with Augmented Sixth Chords 21.5.1 The Italian Augmented Sixth Chord The first examples, from the first movement of Beethoven’s Fifth Symphony, shows an Italian augmented sixth chord ( It+6 ) in C minor with the “classical” spelling. bb 2 œ œ œ b & 4 ˙ ‰ œ œ œ ˙ ? b b 42 ‰ Œ b b b œ œœ œœ b & œ œ j œ cresc. ? b b n œ n œœ œœ b b &bb œœ œ œ œ i ˙ n˙ ˙ œ˙ œ œ œ A¯7(no 5th) Cm œœ œ f œ œ œ œ œ œ Œ # œœœ Œ Œ œ œ U̇ G nœ œ œ œ Œ It+6 Œ u U Œ V YT: _4IRMYuE1hI Figure 21.5.1 Beethoven, Symphony No. 5, Op. 67, I (1808) ?Theb b next example from popular music has an It b +6 b &bb spelled enharmonically 77 CHAPTER 21. AUGMENTED SIXTH CHORDS 227 29 as a major-minor seventh chord with the fifth omitted. 279 78 279 # c Em Œ œ œj œ . & # c &# & c Œ œ Œ ‰ œj œ thing if it 283 283 & # C7 ∑ ## b ˙ ∑ & & 7 Em œ ain't got that swing Em 3 3 ?# c ? # c Œœ # # œœ œœ. œ‰ # ##œœœ ˙˙ œ œ œ˙ œ J e: i 3 3 j B œ œ œ j ∑ 3 b ˙˙ 3 3 œ . 3n œœœ œœœ3 j Œ œj œ Œ j œ ‰ œ œ ‰# œ .œ. ‰ œ œ ‰ œ # œ œ. . #œ . . . Don't mean a ∑ Œ bœ. C7 ∑ ∑ e: i ∑ œ Œ# œb œ œ It˙+6 V7 ∑ 3 b œ œ. œ b œ œ œ ‰b œ J 3 i ∑ YT: LYfF9VKMp4w œ œ œ∑ Ó œ (œ ) œ ∑ 3 ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ œœ œœ œœ œ. # œ. œ. ∑ œ. œ. œ. ∑ ∑Gm ˙˙œ # œ n œ œ œœœ ∑ ∑ œ ˙ 3 Figure 21.5.2 Duke Ellington, “It Don’t Mean A Thing (If It Ain’t Got That ( ) Swing)” (1931) ? # ˙˙ ∑ 21.5.2 The French Augmented Sixth Chord ˙ ∑ ˙ ∑ The next example contains an example of a French augmented sixth chord ( Fr+6 ). Notice how the French augmented sixth chord has pre-dominant funcGer+6 tion and intensifies the drive toward the V chord. # & b &b 289 # & ? bb 289 ?# &b ∑ 2 œ 4 œ π ∑œ 24 œ‰ g: b ∑ ∑ ∑ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œj ‰ . . . . œ. œ. œ∑. œ. œ œ∑j œ œ œ œ œ. œ œ Gm i ∑ ∑ F˜o7/E¯ E¯7(¯5) D # œœœ . œ. ∑ viio42 Fr+6 ∑ V ∑ i YT: xti0xkrIZjQ ? bb Figure 21.5.3 Schubert, Winterreise, D. 911, “Der Wegweiser” (1823) 21.5.3 The German Augmented Sixth Chord The following example, from Rossini’s William Tell Overture, has a German augmented sixth chord leading to a chord of dominant function, the I64 chord. ? bb b nœ œ œ œ œ œ Œ Œ It+6 CHAPTER 21. AUGMENTEDi SIXTH CHORDS n˙ œ œ nœ œ # n ˙ œ œ nœ œ ## # 2 & 4 S j ˙ œ n˙ nœ ? # # # # 42 n ˙œ œ œ œ n œœ ‰ Œ J C/E E: ¯VI6 œ œ Œ V #˙ #˙ E S ˙ # ˙˙œ œ œ œ I 228 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ j œœ œœ ‰ Œ J œ nœ œ œ œ ˙ œ #œ œ œ #˙ œ nœ œ œ œ œ #œ œ #˙ #### ˙ J œ & S S j j j ˙ œ œ # œœ ? # # # # # ˙˙œ œ œ œ # œœœ ‰ Œ n n n ˙˙œ œ œ œ n n œœœ ‰ Œ œ J J J C˜ V/ii C7 Ger+6 E/B I64 YT: oGPys3sKBHw Figure 21.5.4 Gioachino Rossini, William Tell Overture (1829) John Coltrane’s minor blues, “Mr. P.C.,” contains a German augmented sixth chord (spelled as VI7 in minor) progressing to the V chord. (Note: The bass line in this example is a jazz “walking” bass, which doesn’t stick strictly to chord tones.) bw w IV7 ¯VI CHAPTER 21. AUGMENTED SIXTH CHORDS 229 b j & b b c œ œ œ b œ ‰ œ . œ . b œ ‰ œ œj œ œ A¯7 Cm 275 275 b &bb c Ó G7 b ˙˙˙˙ .... ? bb c b œ œ œœœ n œœœ œ œ œ œ œ œ B¯ Œ œ Œ œœ Cm œ œœ ˙ j œœ .. œœ œ. œ ˙˙ ˙ œ œ nœ œ Ger+6 c: i Cm œ œ nœ bœ V i VII i YT: oHDsywpCHj4 Figure 21.5.5 John Coltrane, “Mr. P.C.” (1959) The next example is a movie theme and features a German augmented sixth chord spelled as a major-minor seventh chord ( VI7 ). In this particular case, the third of the chord doesn’t occur until the fourth beat of the measure. 78 # & c Œ Em Œ 3 3 3 j Œ œj œ Œ j ‰ œ œ ‰ œ œ. ‰ œ ‰ œ œ. # œ œ. . # œ œ. . . ? # c Œ # # œœ œœ ‰ # # œœ ˙˙ J ˙ 3 3 3 3 e: i ˙ 3 3 b œ œ. b œ Œ b œJ œ ‰ b œ 3 3 C7 # & b˙ ? # ˙˙ Ger+6 & # œ ( œ) œ œ œ Ó (œ ) 3 ˙ 3 ˙ YT: KEt_FkMkaO4 Figure 21.5.6 Henry Mancini, “The Pink Panther Theme” (1963) Fiona 3Apple’s “Criminal,” from 1996, features German augmented sixth ? # #Œœ#œœj & # CHAPTER 21. AUGMENTED SIXTH CHORDS 28 271 chords in the verse ( F7 in the key of A minor) as well as in the pre-chorus, seen in the example below. C I've come to you ?c œ œ œ œœ œ C: I 273 273 A¯7 B¯ & c ‰ œj œ . œ œ œ b œ œ œ œ . &c ˙ ˙ 271 230 'cause I b ˙˙˙ bœ œ bœ œ ¯VII need œ œ F7 & bœ œ œ œ œ œ œ. œ œ œ œ don't & b www ? w w IV7 know where I can be - gin G œ œ œ bœ œ œ. œ œ œ gui - dance to be true b b ˙˙˙ n œœ .. œ. b˙ b˙ ˙ ˙ Ger+6 A¯ œ bœ. œ w bw j # œœ And I just V ‰ bœ œ œ œ œ bœ Ooh bw bw ¯VI &∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ 275 YT: FFOzayDpWoI Figure 21.5.7 Fiona Apple, “Criminal” (1996) 275 A repeating ∑ ∑ ∑progression ∑ ∑ ∑of Am ∑ – F∑7 – E∑ ( i∑– Ger∑+6 –∑V in∑ Roman ∑ ∑ numerals) ∑ ∑ & occurs in “Friend Like Me” from the movie and musical Aladdin. ?∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ YT: 0HdwdptrmQQ Figure 21.5.8 Alan Menken and Howard Ashman, Aladdin, “Friend Like Me” (1992) 21.5.4 The Enharmonic German Sixth In the following example an “Enharmonic German augmented sixth” chord 2 2 2 2 2 occurs. While a G 7 chord would normally have the notes G –B –D –F , the F2 is respelled as an E6, creating the interval of an augmented sixth, while the fifth of the chord, D2, is respelled as a C4, creating the interval of a doubly 284 b œœœ b & b Christina Perri jar of Hearts œnœ œ œ œ œ œ. œnœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œn œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œn œ231œ œ œ CHAPTER 21. AUGMENTED SIXTH CHORDS œ œ œnœ œ œ œ bœ œ œ œnœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œnœ œ œ œ bœ œ œ œnœ œ œ œ œ ? b bb augmented fourth. In fact, some music theory textbooks refer to the Enharmonic German augmented sixth chord as “the chord of the doubly-augmented fourth.” The spelling is this way because the C4 will resolve upward to a D6, the third of a major I64 chord. 288 288 b 6 &b 8 G¯7 b 6 & b 8 ≈ œ nœ #œ p ? b b 68 b˙. B¯: B¯/F ∑ Œ F7 ‰ Œ œ œ bœ EnGer+6 p j œ œJ . œR œJ ≈ nœ #œ œ bœ ≈ œ œ œ œ ≈ œ œ œ œ œ. I46 B¯ Am œ. œ V7 leuch - ten - den ≈œœ œ œ. œ œœ I YT: PMFUeLdhhuM Figure 21.5.9 Robert Schumann, Dichterliebe, Op. 48, “Am leuchtenden Sommermorgen” (1840) 21.6 Distingushing Between Chromatic Harmonies The following table provides a brief synopsis of what to look for when analyzing chromatic harmonies. Table 21.6.1 Distingushing Between Chromatic Harmonies Chromatic Chord Type Secondary Dominant Secondary Diminished Mode Mixture Neapolitan Augmented Sixth Chord What to look for QUALITY—M triad or Mm7 QUALITY— ◦ , ◦7 , ø7 ACCIDENTALS—lowered notes 2II ◦ 3 interval Chord Labels V/ , V7/ vii◦ / , viiø7 / , vii◦7 / ii◦ , iiø7 , iv , vii◦7 , 2 VI , etc. N It+6 , Fr+6 , Ger+6 , EnGer+6 21.7 Descending Chromatic Bass Lines A common musical pattern is the descending chromatic bass line (1̂ –7̂ –27̂ –6̂ –26̂ –5̂ ). Composers harmonize descending chromatic bass lines with all manner of harmonies, including secondary chords, borrowed chords, augmented sixth chords, and rarely-used diatonic chords. Below are some examples from the past four centuries. CHAPTER 21. AUGMENTED SIXTH CHORDS 232 30 23 291 291 b & b b 3243 ˙œ œ˙ ˙œ b œ˙ ˙ ˙ n ˙ œ œœ . œ œ . œœj # œ . b œœj # w ˙ J 7 ˆD /F˜ (6) Gm G7/F C/E D7 Cm/E¯ ˆ (6) b ? œœ œ & bbb 3243 wŒ œ œ ˙œ Œ w œ ˙œ Œ w˙œ œ œ œ œJ w œ w ˙ œ ww Œ b ww ˙ 3 π Inch - worm, w Inch - worm, meas -3ur - ing the mar - i - golds, ˙ # w7 n ˙˙ n ww ? b b 32 E¯ b ˙˙ D¯7 ww D¯ E¯ b 3w Œ ˙ & b b 4 Œ ˙˙ ˙ ˙˙ .. 7 . ˙˙ 6 b ˙ . 6 4 b ˙ g: i ˙ V ivb6b ˙ ˙ .. V2/iv IV ˙ .. V 295 ? b 3 ˙. ˙. b˙. b˙. & b b ∑4 ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ Two andI When two am are laid,four, am four and laid four in are eight, earth, 3 E¯: I ¯VII7 I ¯VII7 21.7.1 Henry Purcell, Dido and Aeneas, Z. 636, “When I am laid in earth” (Dido’s Lament) (1688) YT: s-F19lgB0Ow b &b ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ 295 Figure 27 # 3 Ó ˙ ˙ ˙ ? & b b 2 ∑ œ œ∑ ˙˙ ∑# ˙Ó ∑ ∑˙Ó ∑n œ˙ œ∑# ˙˙ ∑ # œw∑# œ ∑ #∑˙ ∑ ˙ . ∑ # ˙ ∑œ ˙˙∑ cru - ci - fi fi - xus, b ? & #b 32 ∑ ∑ 310 b & #b & 32 ? #b b 3 ? 2 310 - xus cru - ci ∑ ∑∑ - e - ti - am pro - no fix us - e ∑. ∑ ˙ ˙ ∑˙ Ó - - ti - am ˙˙ ∑ ˙˙ cru cru - ci - fi bis - - A˜o7/E∑ B/D˜ Dm7∑G˜o7/D A/C˜ ∑ Am/C C7(¯5∑) Em/B B ˙˙ ∑ ˙ ˙˙ n ˙ n ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙ # ˙˙ ˙˙ # ˙˙ ˙ ˙˙ # # ˙˙ ˙ # ˙ ˙ n˙ ˙ Em ci xus, ∑ B˙7 ˙˙˙ ∑ œ œ œ œ∑ # œ œ n œ ∑œ œ œ ∑ ∑ ∑ #œ œ nœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ e: i viio43/V V6 vii7 viio43/iv IV6 iv6 Fr+6 i64 V 7 YT: hY7CGrR6sPc Figure 21.7.2 J.S. Bach, Mass in B minor, BWV 232, Crucifixus (1733) 705 718 4ˆ œ Itœ+65ˆœ œ n œ œ œ œ bFrœ +6œ˜4ˆœ œ n œ 5œˆ ? b b˜ 44C: ? # ˙b ˙ b b # ˙ ˙ œ œ n œ œ œ œ b œ œ œ+6œ EnGer n œ œ œ +6 œ Ger b ˙ (don't b ˙ ˙ key signature when in minor) bb b ˙ wwforget about the w & #w # wwww # www CHAPTER 21. AUGMENTED SIXTH6 CHORDS c: i V6 i24 IV i V6 ˆ o3 c: ¯6 o3 5ˆ C: ¯6ˆ 5ˆ o3 +6 G/B C7/B¯ GerF/A c: Cm It+6 Fr+6 707 721 727 714 718 730 (b w ) ¯6 ? bC: b It43+6C:˙˙˙ ...It+6 n ˙˙˙ ... b A¯7 b w 5 ( b w) ¯6 ˙. b n ˙˙˙ ... +6 Fr+6 . +6 ˙Ger n ˙˙ .. b¯61 w Cm/G ( bw ) Ger#+6 ˙˙ .. EnGer+6 b ˙˙ .. 1 ¯6 j œœ ‰ œœ 7/G˜ ˜4 ˜4 # www VAm/G #IV Fmaj7i6 6 4/iv b Amc: #i ww ˜V14C+maj www6 D/F˜ Ger+6 ¯3 4 2 2 b b w w w & 1 1 ¯6 œ ¯6 œ œ œ+6 œ¯6 œ ‰ œ +6 œ c: It Fr œGer+6## œ˙ œ œ œ n œœœœ V&44b b b˙ œ #˙ œ n˙ YT: UoWXRlw9vBA b w IVWoO w w M4 6 Figure III+ 3 32 i4 inb C & a: i21.7.3 o3 o3 2 # b wwBeethoven, # b wwwVariations # wwwminor, o3 #80# b wwww(1806)o3 VIM7 +6 +6 ? b b C: It+6 Fr+6 Ger EnGer Gm/F C7/E E¯ j j b Gm œœ ‰ forget œ œabout œœ œœ œ when Œin minor) œœ œœ œ Œ œœ œœ œ œ œ theŒ key‰ signature b 4 (don't œ œ œ b b w V b b 4 œ œww o œ œ œ wwœœ o œœ œœ nwwœœ œœ o œœ œœœ b œ œœ œ œœ & #w 3 # ww 3 #w 3 g: c: i It+6 721 233 IV6 œ œ. b 3 Œ œ .. A¯ œ 7 (no œ. ‰ 5th) œ n œ. ‰A¯œ ..7(¯5) œ n œ œ # œJ. ‰ œ œA¯b œ7n œ œJ ‰ œ œ b n œ ‰ R b n œ J . & 4 # w R 4J œ #œ w J # ww b ww b ww ˜1 b www# www ˜∫124bbbwww# wwww œ . b ¯3˜4# www ##bœ#.wb wwwb www ˜˜24 & b w 711 i42 #w & b ww 4 +6 iFr 2 b ww (b w ) A¯7 (no 5th) 6 Ger IV+6 5 # www ∫ b www b w ( b w) A¯7(¯5) YT: VJDJs9dumZI VI b b # wwww b bb wwww ( A¯7 ) +6 C:21.7.4 It+6 George Harrison, Fr+6 GerWeeps” Figure “While My Guitar Gently (1968) Am 727 C+maj7/G˜ Am/G D/F˜ œ ‰ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ## œ˙ œ œ œ V 44 ˙ œ #˙ œ n˙ a: i III+M43 i42 IV6 Fmaj7 œ n œœœ VIM7 730 V YT: iXQUu5Dti4g Figure 21.7.5 Jimmy Page and Robert Plant, “Stairway to Heaven” (1971) g: viio42 i Fr+6 V i CHAPTER 21. AUGMENTED SIXTH CHORDS 30 291 291 234 D¯maj7(˜11) Fm G7/F C/E b & bb bb b3 c œœ œ˙œœ œ ˙œœ œ œœ œ˙ n œœ˙ œ nœœ˙ œ b œœ œœ. œœœœœ & 2 ˙ J . Fm Gm Cm/E¯ Dø7 D7/F˜ œœj œœ œœœj œœœ Ó œœœ œ œ# œœ. œ œ# ˙ œ When I am # # # # c Cœ˜mœ Œ V laid, am laid in Œ ## V ## œ C˜7/B on a what 297 I V7 Sun - day af - ter - noon V6 œ iv6 ‰ œ œ # œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ . ‰ œj c˜: i 297 earth, G˜/B˜ r # # # # œ œ . œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ c œ œ‰ œ ≈œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ V œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ #œ œ t # # # # c œ œ ‰ . œr ≈ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ #œ œ Wait - ing 295 D7 ? b b b3 c j j j & b 2 wœ . œ ˙œ . œ w n œ . ˙ œj b œ .w˙ œj œ . œ œ . wœœ œ w w ˙ w ww ˙ 6 ø7 M7 f: i v ˜vi VI i π w ww ˙ # w n ˙˙ n ww ? b b 32 b ˙˙ w 89dGC8de0CA 6 g: i VYT: V24/iv IV6 Figure 21.7.6 Steven Tyler, “Dream On” (1973) 295 Cm/E¯ nœ œ œ œ œ œ #œ read be - tween # # # # œ œ ‰ . œr ≈ œ œ V œœ œœ œœ # œœ œœ the lines For ‰ . # œœœ ≈ œœ œœ œœœ œœœ œœ œ R œœ ‰ . œr ≈ œ œ œ œ œ œ A˜ø7 j œ œ. Œ r œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ ‰ ≈ œœ ≈ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ nœ œ œ œœ r t # # # # œ œ ‰ . œr ≈ œ œ œ œ œ #œ œ ‰ ≈ œ ≈ œ œ œ œ œ ˜viø7 V24/iv YT: yjJL9DGU7Gg Figure 21.7.7 Robert DeLeo and Scott Weiland, “Interstate Love Song” (1994) CHAPTER 21. AUGMENTED SIXTH CHORDS 235 79 Cm b œ & b b 44 œ ? b b 44 b G/B œ œ nœ œ œ Cm/B¯ F/A Cm œ œ œ œ œ œ œnœ œ œ œ G/B œ œ nœ œ œ Cm/B¯ F/A œ œ œ œ œ œ œnœ œ œ œ œ œ nœ œ œ œ bœ œ œ œ nœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ nœ œ œ œ bœ œ œ œ nœ œ œ œ c: i V6 b & b bb i24 IV6 i V6 i42 IV6 YT: 8v_4O44sfjM Figure 21.7.8 Christina Perri, “Jar of Hearts” (2010) ? bb b b Below is a table comparing the harmonizations of these descending bass lines. Table 21.7.9 Bass Line Purcell Bach Beethoven Beatles Led Zeppellin Aerosmith S.T.P. Perri 1̂ i i – vii◦43 V i i i i i i 7̂ V6 V6 V6 III +M V6 V6 27̂ iv vii7 – vii◦43 iv V42 iv i42 i42 i42 4 V2 iv i42 V42 4 3 6̂ IV6 IV6 IV6 IV65 IV6 4 viø7 4 viø7 IV6 26̂ 6 iv iv6 – Fr+6 Ger+6 VI VIM 7 VIM 7 ( VI ) For the harmonization of scale degree 6̂ , remember that the concept of 4 vi◦ was introduced when Roman numerals in minor were introduced. The notes of the 4 viø7 chord belong to the melodic minor scale. 21.8 Chromatic Pre-Dominant Chords The table below shows how our study of chromatic harmonies in recent chapters includes the chromatic expansion of the pre-dominant harmonic function category. Table 21.8.1 Ton. I Ton. Prol. iii vi Pre-Dom. IV ii V/V vii◦ /V iv iiø7 N6 +6 It , Fr+6 , Ger+6 Dom. vii◦ V Ton. I 5̂ V i64 – V6 i64 bb w b b b n www ww # # www b n ww # Ger+6 e: ____ N6 It+6 Fr+6 g: ____ B¯: ____ c˜: ____ CHAPTER 21. AUGMENTED SIXTH CHORDS 672 32 1 ____ 672 684 699 2. ____3 ____4 # w # www Include sheet ? # symbol. b ww signatures. # b www b b key # b ____w b b ∫ ____ w D: ____ 1 A¯: ____ 2 G: ____ 3 1. c˜: Fr+6 2. F: It+6 ____ 5 1. E¯:7 It+6 2. a: 8Ger+6 ____ ____ ## # # # # # n # www ____ b b www # n w b b # b n wwww b____ w ____ B: ____ 4 3. G: EnGer+6 B¯: ____ 5 4. a: viio65/V c: ____ 6 5. d: Ger+6 # b n wfirst Click here #to download homework assignment www ____ #____#this # ww____ w b b bthe b b b ww for wwww chapter. b #____ nw ____ & w b w Click here to download the second homework assignment for this chapter. w w b www w ? here to download the Unit 4 Practice Test. Click f˜: ____ f: ____ G: ____ g: ____ b: ____ F: ____ ? & 1. 6. c˜:f:FrN+66 1. E¯: It 1. E¯: N6 F¯/A¯ ____ ? b b b ww bb w 1. E¯: N6 3. 9D: EnGer+6 10 4. c: V43/V 11 ____ B¯ ____ ## n w b b b # n wwww w n w 2. a: Ger+6 3. D: EnGer+6 2. a: N 3. D: ¯III 7. A¯: viiø7/V B¯ ____ w b ww 2. a: N 4. c: ## n w n ww 3. D: ¯III +6/iv 10. viio4 5. cF:˜: Ger 2 ø7/B¯ C ____ b w b b www 9. F: ¯III46 F˜o7 ____ b b b # n wwww ____ A¯/C ____ # b b www 4. c: V43/V 5. B¯: Fr+6 ø4 5. B¯: ii 2 6. G: N6 viio7/V 8. b: Fr+6 F ____ o66/V 9. a: F:vii ¯III 4. 54 F˜o7 ____ F ____ 12 5. B¯: Fr+6 ____ ø7/V 3. G: 7. 2. A¯: 8. b: Fr+6 +6 F:vii It+6 EnGer ? ? b b b ww w b b w b ww +6 F¯/A¯ ____ 6. f: N6 699 ____ 2 1 2 3 4 5 6 f˜: ____ f: ____ G: ____ g: ____ b: ____ F: ____ Given the 7Roman numeral, please9write the 10 notes of the11chord and lead8 12 ? 694 c: ____ ____ 6 # ww ww ww # # # w____ ? b b w____ ‹ www b n #____ w # n www ____ b b n ww____ # # # # ____ w w w b w ### # w bb b n w # w bb # # # www b n w www e: b____ww B¯: ____ ww & g: ____ w # b____ www b www c˜:b____ d: ____ b: w ____ 1 & 678 689 ____ numerals D: with ____ figured A¯: bass ____ inversion G: ____ symbols B:below. ____ B¯: ____ 678 694684 3 ____ viio65 b: ____ 236 6 ____ 21.9 Practice Exercises# w ? # # b # wwww b b b ∫ b www # b www # # # # n # www b b # n www b b ww b # w above ww b w and bRoman 1. Analyze the following chords with lead-sheet nsymbols 666 689 2 viio6/V d: ____ 4 5 ____ ____ ww 4. c: viio7/V 10. c˜: viio42/iv ø7/B¯ C ____ b w b b www 5. B¯: iiø42 A¯/C ____ # b b www 6. G: N6 Chapter 22 Modulation 22.1 Modulation At its simplest, modulation is a change of key that happens within a composition. In popular music, the change of key will often be called a “key change” instead of a “modulation.” Those who study classical music theory typically reserve the term “modulation” for the slower and more subtle change of key that occurs in many classical pieces, although there are similarities between “key change” in popular music and the classical music term “direct modulation,” which we will study later in this chapter. Here are examples of key changes in popular music. YT: Ob7vObnFUJc Figure 22.1.1 Beyoncé Knowles, Terius Nash, and Shea Taylor, “Love on Top” (2011) YT: Siz-xBfIqpg Figure 22.1.2 James Horner and Will Jennings, “My Heart Will Go On” (1997) YT: lDK9QqIzhwk Figure 22.1.3 Jon Bon Jovi, Richie Sambora, and Desmond Child, “Livin’ on a Prayer” (1986) 22.2 Tonicization versus Modulation Studying modulation will require us to distinguish between tonicization, which we studied recently, and modulation. Tonicization, involving secondary chords, can be as short as two chords ( V/V to V , for example) but can sometimes encompass several measures as in the following example. 237 CHAPTER 22. MODULATION 299 299 299 299 299 299 302 302 302 305 305 305 305 305 305 bb œœ œœ œ ‰ œœ œœœ œœ œœ œœ n œ œ œœ œœ œœ ‰ œœ b b œ œ œœ ‰‰ œJJ œ œ œ nn œœ œœ œ œ œ œœ ‰‰ œJ bb & & & b bb œœœ J œ JJ trau trau -- rig rig ge ge -- seh'n, seh'n, trau - rig ge - seh'n, bb b b b œ b & & & b bb œœ œœ œœœ œœ œœ œœ j ? ? ? bbb bbb bb œjjj ‰‰‰ œœœjj ‰‰‰ b œœ E¯: E¯: II E¯: I so so kann kann so kann es es auch auch jetzt jetzt nicht nicht beim beim es auch jetzt nicht beim œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ j j jj ‰‰‰ œœjj ‰‰‰ jj ‰‰‰ œœjj ‰‰‰ œœj œ œœj œ œ œ œœ œ œœ œœœ œœ œ jj ‰‰‰ œœjjj j œœ œ œ Ab Ab -- schied schied ge ge -- scheh'n, scheh'n, so so Ab - schied ge - scheh'n, so œ œœ œœ œœ œ œ jj ‰‰‰ œœœ œœj œ œœ œ œœœ œœ ‰‰ ‰ 7 V V77/vi /vi V /vi vi vi vi vi vi vi jj ˙ . bbb b œœœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ b ‰ œ b ‰ & œ œ œ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ ‰ œœj ˙˙ .. & & b bb œ kann kann kann 302 302 302 238 es es auch auch jetzt jetzt nicht nicht beim beim es auch jetzt nicht beim bb bbb bb & & & b b œœœ œœ œœœ œœ œœ œœœ ? j ? ? bbb bbb bb jjj ‰‰‰ œœjj ‰‰‰ b œ œ œœ IV IV IV bb b œœ b b b & & & b bb œ mun mun mun -- bb bbb bb œœ œ & & & b b œ œœ œ jj ? ? ? bbb bbb bb œœœj ‰‰‰ b œ ii ii ii 7 V V77/IV /IV V /IV œœ œœ œœœ œ œ tre, tre, du du fröh fröh tre, du fröh œœ œ IV IV IV -- œ nn œœœ œœ œœœœ nœ cresc. cresc. cresc. j œœ œœ œœjj ‰‰‰ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ V/ii V/ii V/ii ii ii ii ‰‰ œœœJ ‰ JJ Ab Ab -- schied schied ge ge -- scheh'n, scheh'n, A A -- de! de! Ab - schied ge - scheh'n, A - de! œœ œœ œœœ œœœ œ œ œœ œ ‰‰ jj ‰‰ œœœ ‰ j ‰ œœ œœ œ œœ bb œœ œœ œ bœ œ œœ jj ‰‰‰ œœJœ œœj JJ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ ‰ Œ œ œ ‰‰ ŒŒ œ œJJ J œœ œœ œ œ lili -- che che li - che nn œœ œœ nœ œ œ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ V/ii V/ii V/ii œ œœœ œœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œ œ œ j œœ œœjj ‰‰ ŒŒ œœ œœ ‰ Œ œœ du du du œœœ nnn œœœ œœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œ œœ œ œ j j œœjj ‰‰‰ œœ œœ œœjj ‰‰‰ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œ ii ii ii ˙˙ .. ˙. œœ œ V/ii V/ii ii ii V/ii ii œœ œ V/ii V/ii V/ii œœ œ nn œœ œ œœ œ (( œœœ )) œœ œœ œ œ œœ n œ œœ œ œœ ( ) œœ œ œœ œ œ œ œ Stadt, Stadt, Stadt, j œœjj ‰‰‰ œœ ii ii ii A A A œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ V/ii V/ii V/ii j œœjj ‰‰‰ œœ ii ii ii œœ œœ œœ V V V -- de! de! de! œœ œjjj ‰‰‰ œœ œœ œœ II I YT: Wod-JellQ88 Figure 22.2.1 Schubert, Schwanegesang, D. 957, “Abschied” (1828) Below is a reduction showing the underlying diatonic progression of the example above. 31 31 31 test ? 1. F: V5622. /IV MODULATION 2. c˜: N6 CHAPTER ? b w bb (with tonicizations) 757 E¯: I 766 ˙ ˙ w vi ii w w IV E¯: I ? bb vi IV 4. e: viio42/V 5. D: Fr+6239 œœœœ œœœœ œœœœ w ˙ ˙ w tonicizations) ? b b (without w w w w b 775 3. A: iv6 ii V w I ˙. œ w V I b Figure 22.2.2 Reduction of Harmonies from “Abschied” A modulation to a new key requires an eventual cadence to confirm that new key. This cadence will often (though not always) have the following cadential formula: Table 22.2.3 Cadential Formula to Establish a Key ii6 Pre-Dom. I64 Dom. V Dom. I Ton. Figure 22.2.4 Audio Realization of Cadential Formula to Establish a Key In his book Form in Tonal Music, Douglass Green defines a V – I authentic cadence with a pre-dominant prefix as a “full cadence.” The cadential formula above is found in the following example. œœ b n œœœ ? ? bbbb œœ œœ œœ b œœœ œ nœ bœ œ œ œ b œœœ bbœœœ # œœ # œ œ n œœœœœ ˙˙ œ n œœ œœœœœ œœ œ ˙˙ CHAPTER 22. MODULATION 240 g: ______ ______ ______ ______ ______ ______ ______ B¯: ______ ______ ______ ______ ______ ______ ______ ______ ______ ______ Lead-sheet: ______ ______ ______ ______ œ .m 3 b b & & b 4 œœ m j j ret. œ ˙ b œ n œ œ œ ˙ œ œ œ œœJœ œœœ. œœœœJ. œ( n œ) œ˙˙œ. œ œ (œ ) œœ(b œœ ) ˙œ (œ )œ œ(œœ) #œœœœ. œœ(œn) œœw ( n œœ )œœ ˙˙˙ .. ( ) ( ) œ œœ œ œ b œ ˙œ œœ ? ? b b 43œ œ œœ œ b n œœœ . œ œ œ œ b nœœœœ œ ˙œ# œ. œ œn œœœ œœ˙˙œ œ œ œ œ b œ œ g:F:______ I V7 I______ ______ ______ modulating... m j œœ. œ n œ œ˙˙. œ œ m 3 b & & b 4 œœ œœ œ œœ j bœ œ œ œ ˙˙˙ œ ret. œœœ ˙ œ ˙˙ .. n œ œ œ œ œ n œ (n œ)œ ˙ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ˙˙ ( ) .. ______ ______ ______ C: I6 ii6 I64 V I ret. YT: 9WQbN91tpWI Figure 22.2.5 English Suite No. 4 in F Major, BWV 809, Saraœ œ J.S.œ Bach, œ ˙ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œœ ˙ . ? (ca. 3 1715) œ œ œ.bœ œ ˙ bande . ?b b 4 ret. nœ œ œ. œ œ Notice that this cadential formula establishes a key more strongly˙ than the simple V – I 7of an authentic cadence. This means there will be ambiguity F: I V I modulating... between a tonicization and a short modulation ending 6 iian 6 I6authentic C: Iin V I cadence, 4 especially in music with fast harmonic rhythm, like Bach chorales (usually in quarter-note harmonic rhythm). # & c œœ ? # c œœ œ œœ œœ œ # œœ œœ œ sus. 4 - œ œ œ œ œœ œ œœ (ptœ) œ œ G: I vi IV6 V7 I V42/V V6 G: I vi IV6 V7 I D: IV V42 I6 (œ ) #œ œ (œ ) œ œ pt 3 œ œ œ œ œœ V/V V7/V V (as a tonicization of V) V V7 I (as a modulation to D) YT: tVJy904MiIY Figure 22.2.6 J.S. Bach, Christmas Oratorio, BWV 248, “Ermuntre dich, mein schwacher Geist,” (Chorale) (1734) To determine pivot chords and the new key, listen to the music to hear the cadence in the new key, then work backward from the cadence to see if the dominant in the new key was approached by pre-dominant chords ( ii or IV ) in the new key. Then, analyze from the beginning of the phrase until you reach the new key. Finally, look for a logical pivot point. Sometimes two successive chords could logically be pivot chords. If so, include two chords on either side of your pivot bracket. CHAPTER 22. MODULATION # # # 2 œf . œ œ œ œ & 4 œ . œœ œ . œ œœ 241 j 3 œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œœ œ œ œœ œ # œœœ œœœ œœœ œ 3 fœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ. œ J f ? # # # 42 ‰ V6 IV6 I46 V7 A: I I IV I I œœ œœ œ œœ .. œ. œ. œ œ œ V6 I E: I6 IV # & c 83 I64 V7 œ I YT: Qy8NLd7d6VE Figure 22.2.7 Robert Schumann, Album for the Young, Op. 68, No. 17, “Little Morning Wanderer” (1848) ?Before # c we start analyzing and writing modulations, we will examine key relationships and pivot chords. 22.3 Key Relationships & # In the Baroque and Classical eras, composers typically modulated to the dominant (when starting in a major key) or to the relative major (when starting in a minor key). In the Romantic era, composers experimented with modulating to more remote (or perhaps adventurous) key areas, described as “foreign” to the home key. “Closely related” keys have key signatures one degree “sharper” or “flatter” than the starting key. For any major or minor key, there are five closely 35 related keys, including the relative major or minor of the home key. ?# & # ?# 775 Home key D & ## b one degree "flatter" A ### one degree "sharper" f˜ E #### c˜ (relative keys with same key signature) Figure 22.3.1 Closely Related Keys with A Major as Home Key Key signatures that are not closely related are said to be “foreign” or “distantly related.” We will see that some types of modulations from the Romantic era, like common-tone modulations, exploit foreign key relationships to dramatic effect. 22.4 Modulations with Diatonic Pivot Chords Modulations with pivot chords will be analyzed using a pivot bracket, as we’ve seen earlier in the chapter. ## & ## 778 œ ? 3 œ œœ œ b 4 œ œ.bœ œ ˙ œ ˙ œ œœ œœ œ œ œ nœ œ œ. œ œ œ œ œ ˙ ˙ .. CHAPTER 22. MODULATION 242 F: I V7 I modulating... C: I6 ii6 I64 V I In a diatonic common chord modulation, the pivot chords will be diatonic in both keys. # & c œœ ? # c œœ œ œ # œœ œœ œ œœ œœ 3 œ # œœ œ (œ ) œ œ œ œ œ œœ V7 I ( ) œœ œ œ œ œœ œ œœ (ptœ) œ vi IV6 V7 G: I sus. 4 - pt I D: IV V42 I6 V both I and IV are diatonic Home Homekey key (as a modulation to D) I V42/V V6 V/V V7/V V one degree YT: tVJy904MiIY one degree D E one degree (as a tonicization of V) one degree D E "sharper" Figure 22.4.1 J.S."flatter" Bach, Christmas Oratorio, BWV 248, “Ermuntre dich, "flatter" "sharper" mein schwacher Geist,” (Chorale) (1734) G: I ### & & # 775 775 vi IV6 V7 AA ### ## # ## # # ## f˜ c˜ b f ˜ Chords Between c˜ Keys 22.4.1 Determining Common b (relative keys with same key signature) In order to compose a diatonic common modulation, you need to deter(relative keys with same chord key signature) mine which chords are diatonic—having the same root and quality—in both keys. G major: G Am Bm C D Em F˜o o G major: G Am Bm C D Em F˜ D major: D Em F˜m G A Bm C˜o o D major: D Em F˜m G A Bm C˜ Figure 22.4.2 Diatonic Common Chords in G major and D major We can repeat this process with Roman numerals, aligning the roots of the chords in the two keys. R. N.: I ii iii IV V G major: G Am Bm C 778 & 785 & 778 #### #### ## D major: G R. N.: A IV V D Bm C˜o D vi viio I vi viio Em F˜o Em F˜m ii iii Figure 22.4.3 Roman Numerals for Diatonic Common Chords in G major and D major 3535 CHAPTER 22. MODULATION 243 If you are a composer wanting to write a diatonic common chord modulation, you need to determine the best place within a progression to pivot to the new key. To do this, you need to consider the 3harmonic 3function of the pivot chords. # # # 2 œf . œ œœ œ œ & 4 œ . œ œ . œ œœ œœœ œ j œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œœ œ œ œœ œ # œœœ œœœ œœ .. œ. 22.4.2 Harmonic Functions of Diatonic Pivot Chords fœ function, In terms of harmonic composers œœ œœ doœœ not œuse a pivot chord œ new œ œœkeyœ typically # œ œœ œœinœthe ? # 2 . that has dominant function because such a modulation ‰ # 4 J œ . œ œ might œ sound abrupt and unconvincing. Instead, the pivot chord in the first key often œ f has tonic or tonic prolongation function. A: I V6 IV6 I46the V7 pivot I IV I Isimultaneously V6 I In the following example, chord has tonic function 6 IV in the first key and pre-dominant function in the key. a E: Isecond I64 This V7 creates I more seamless and less jarring progression to the second key. # & c œœ ? # c œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œœ œ œœ (œ) œ Harmonic function in G: G: I œ # œœ œœ œ & # ?# œ œ œ œ œ V V7 I Ton. vi IV6 V7 œœ I D: IV V42 Harmonic function in D: œ # œœ œ (œ ) ( ) I6 Pre-Dom. YT: tVJy904MiIY Figure 22.4.4 J.S. Bach, Christmas Oratorio, BWV 248, “Ermuntre dich, mein schwacher Geist,” (Chorale) (1734) The pivot chord in the first key, G, has tonic harmonic function, while in the second key, D major, the G chord has pre-dominant function. Observe the harmonic function of the pivot chords in the following examples from Bach chorales. 83 vi IV6 V7 G: I CHAPTER 22. MODULATION Harmonic function in D: & #### œœ œ ? #### œ œœ œ œœ œ œ D: IV V42 I6 œ œ œ œ œ nœ œ œœ œœ Ton. V6 V7 I A: V Harmonic function in A: V7 V I 244 Pre-Dom. œœ Harmonic function in E: E: I I œ œ œ œ œ œ J œ J j œ œ œœ n œ œ œ œ ¯VII6 IV6 viiø7 I 7 V I Dom. YT: gl4FNanCrbc Figure 22.4.5 J.S. Bach, Chorale 4, “Es ist das Heil uns kommen her”, BWV 9 84 b & b b c œœ œœ œœ n œ œœ ? b b c œœ n œœ b œœ b U jœ œ j œœ œ œ œœ. œ œ œ ˙ ˙ J œ œ œ œ œœ . œj œ œ œ œ b œ ˙ œ bœ œ œ bœ œ œ œœ œ ˙ U j . œœ œ n œ œ œ œœ œœ .. œ bœ œ œ u Harmonic function in f: f: i Harmonic function in A¯: b &bb iiø65 V7 i i u Ton. i A¯: vi viio64 I6 I ii56 V 7 I Ton-Prol. YT: NE-uciPxYFE Figure 22.4.6 J.S. Bach, Chorale 8, “Freuet euch, ihr Christen”, BWV 40 ? bb 22.5 bHow to Recognize a Key After a Modulation Look for the following cues when examining music containing modulations: 1. Look for recurring accidentals, then add them to the key signature to determine the new key (a) Lowered notes (like flats) usually create 4̂ (as do the flats in key signatures) (b) Raised notes (like sharps) often create 7̂ , the leading tone CHAPTER 22. MODULATION 245 i. If there are multiple raised notes, look for the “sharpest of sharps” (in key signature order) to determine which sharp is acting as 7̂ 2. If accidentals are canceled out, they indicate tonicizations or chromatic non-chord tones E¯ is lowered note acting as 4ˆ bœ ˙ & b 43 œœœ. œ ˙˙ œ ? b 43 œ F: I œœ œœ ˙˙ œbœ ˙ ˙ ˙ V7/IV œ œ ˙ ˙ IV En cancels out E¯, which means E¯ represented a tonicization m œ œœ œ œ œ n œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ V42 V24 I I6 V7 œ œ I Bn occurs 3 times and isn't canceled out, representing a modulation m j & b œœœ. œ n œ œ˙˙. œ ? b œ. bœ œ ˙ F: I viio42/V j bœ Bn is a raised note acting as 7̂ œ œ œ ˙˙˙ œ n œ œ œ œ œ n œ (n œ ) œ ˙ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ˙˙ ( ) œ ˙ œœœœœ œœ ˙ nœ œ œ. œ œ œ œ œ œ ˙ V65/V multiple secondary chords destabilize F major .. .. V6 C: I6 ii6 I64 V I cadential formula affirms new key YT: 9WQbN91tpWI Figure 22.5.1 J.S. Bach, English Suite No. 4 in F Major, BWV 809, Sarabande (ca. 1715) 22.6 Modulations with Chromatic Pivot Chords You will sometimes encounter examples where the pivot chord is a chromatic chord in at least one (and sometimes both) of the keys involved in the modulation. 22.6.1 Secondary Common Chord Below is an example where the pivot chord is a secondary chord in both keys. 85 32 CHAPTER 22. MODULATION b œ &bb 308 Œ 246 Ó ∑ ∑ œ œ b & b b œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ ? bb j ‰ œ ‰ j ‰ œ ‰ j ‰ œ ‰ Œ ‰ œj ‰ j ‰ œ n œ j b œ J œ J œ J œœ œ œ œ nœ 308 311 311 E¯: I b &bb ∑ ∑ 314 ∑ b & b b œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ n œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ ? b b j ‰ œj ‰ j ‰ œ œ j ‰ œ ‰ j ‰ œ ‰ j ‰ œ ‰ Œ b œ J œ J œ J œ œ E¯: V 314 ii6 b &bb A¯: IV œœ V7/ii I A¯: V7/vi ∑ œ œ œ œ b œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ bœ œ ? b b j ‰ b œ ‰ j ‰ œœ œœ b bœ J œ b &bb œ œœœ œœœ Ó œœ œœ œ J I64 Œ ‰ œj œ A - de! bœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ b œœ œœ œœ ‰ œJ ‰ œJ ‰ œJ ‰ œœœ ‰ J V7 I64 V I YT: Wod-JellQ88 Figure 22.6.1 Schubert, Schwanegesang, D. 957, “Abschied” (1828) 22.6.2 Borrowed Common Chord In modulation by borrowed common chord (or mode mixture), the pivot chord will be a borrowed chord in one of the keys involved in the modulation. In the following example, a borrowed chord, i6 in D2 minor, rewritten as a 4 C minor chord, is reinterpreted as vi6 in the second key, E major. iiø65 f: i CHAPTER 22. MODULATION Harmonic function in A¯: œ b b 3 œ. &bb 4 V7 i i i A¯: vi viio64 I6 I ii56 V 7 I 247 Ton-Prol. œ J œ ˙ dolce b & b b b 43 œ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œ b œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ V43 D¯: I & bbbb œ. œ œ J œ œ. œ J cresc. #œ œ. œ J dim. b œœœ œœœ œœœ & b b b b œ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ n œ # # œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ D¯: V42 & bbbb #œ I6 nœ. œ J i6 E: vi6 œ nn n n # # # # œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ π p j b n ## & b b b # œ # n œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ n n n # # œ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œœœ ‰ E: V6 V56 I YT: H3S8slvoHoU Figure 22.6.2 Beethoven, Piano Sonata No. 31 in A2 major, Op.110, I, (1821) 22.6.3 Neapolitan Common Chord A particularly adventurous and imaginative pivot is the Neapolitan, which can bridge the gap between two foreign (or distantly related) keys. 34 330 CHAPTER 22. MODULATION 248 b œ nœ œ œ #œ œ œ ‰ œ b˙ & b 42 J œ. œ bœ œ J b 2 œœœ ‰ n œœ œ ‰ œœ œ ‰# n œœ œ ‰ œœ ‰ œœ b ˙˙ b & 4 œ œ 3 3 3 π œœ n œœ œœ # n œœ œ œ b ˙˙ œ œ œœ ? b b 42 œ b ˙˙ ˙ ˙ i V fol - gen auf luf - ti - ger Bahn. 3 330 d: i iio6 i46 V Wo - hin? ∑ wo - hin? 3 b b ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙ ˙ ˙˙ N56 i a¯: V56 b ∑ Schubert, Figure D. (1828) ∑ Schwanegesang, ∑ ∑ 957, “Frühlingssehnsucht” ∑ ∑ ∑ & b 22.6.3 YT: IvjZiYVZUIY 337 In the example above, Schubert bridges the tonal distance between D minor and A2 minor with N65 (note the dominant-seventh quality of the Neapolitan in 337 this instance), which acts as a V65 in A2 minor, a tritone away from D minor. b ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ? bb ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ &b 22.6.4 Augmented Sixth Common Chord In the next chapter, we will examine how Augmented Sixth chords are enharmonically reinterpreted in a process known as enharmonic modulation. 22.7 Modulations Without Pivot Chords bb ∑ ∑ & • Direct Modulation ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ • Common-Tone Modulation ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ 22.7.1 ? b Direct Modulation ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ 344 This section contains the following subsections below: bb ∑ Modulation ∑ • Sequential & 344 b ∑ ∑ Direct modulation (also known as phrase modulation) is a type of modulation where a composer decides to move suddenly to a new key without using pivot chords or preparing the new tonic with its dominant. a¯: V5656 i V CHAPTER 22. MODULATION # 2 & 4 œJ 337 337 brin brin -- r r œ œ œj ge ge Grü Grü œ œ R R -- sse sse des des œ J Fer Fer -- #œ œ œ R R nen nen ihr ihr zu. zu. # œ œ œ œ œ œ & 42 œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œœ # œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œ 337 337 ≈ œ. œ. œ. ? # 42 œ 339 339 339 339 die die 249 & # e: i œœ JJ ∑ All' All' œ ≈ œ. œ. œ. o7/i ped viio7 i œœ œœ œjœj rnrœnrœr œ œœ œ œ œRœ œœ œ ‰ ‰ c R R RJ J œœ RR RR - reBluBlu- -men men - flegt, ihih- re im im GarGar- -ten ten gepgep -flegt, # # œ œ œœ œ œœœ œ œœœœœœ œ œœœœ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œœ œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œœ œœœœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœœ œœœœœœœœ œœœœœ œœ œœœœœœ œœœ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œœ œœœ œœœ nœœnœœœ œœœ œœœœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œc #œ œ . .. .. . . . . . œœœœ ? # œœ . ‰‰ ≈ ≈ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ ≈ ≈œœ œœ œœ œœ c & o7/i ped e: viio7 i C: I V77/I ped I YT: uTWQRjGkprQ Figure 22.7.1 Schubert, Schwanegesang, D. 957, “Liebesbotschaft” (1828) In the example below from the second song of the same song cycle as the example above, Schubert does not attempt to change gradually from C minor to A2 major, but instead stops on a half cadence in C minor and begins on the tonic in A2 major in the next bar. ? #### c ‰ ˙ ˙ CHAPTER 22.E:MODULATION vi 346 346 b & b b 43 b 3 & b b 4 œœœ ...... ? b b 43 b œ .. œ .. c: i64 349 349 ? bb c b Vsus4 ∑ r j œœ œœ ‰ œ œ r j œ œ ‰ œ œ schneller. bb b Etwas & c Ó ? bb c b ˙ ˙ IVadd9 vi64 ∑ œ .. œ .. V Wie U c c c ˙. ˙. V j œ œ. œ hab' A¯: vi250 ? ˙˙ .. n˙. i ‰ œj œ Œ 43 nœ ∑ U r j œœ œœœ ‰ œ r œj ‰ œ œ œ œœ .... n œ .. bbbb ich oft so œœœœ œœœœœ œ œœœœ œœœœœ œ œ œ œ œ 3 œ A¯: I 3 3 j œ ‰ œ 3 3 j œ ‰ œ 3 3 j œ ‰ œ 3 j œ ‰ YT: mLTyrvgKDUo Figure 22.7.2 Schubert, Schwanegesang, D. 957, “Kriegers Ahnung” (1828) Direct modulation is the most common type of “modulation” found in popular music. At the beginning of this chapter we defined this type of modulation in popular music as “key change.” 251 35 CHAPTER 22. MODULATION 342 342 & #### œ œ c œ #### c ‰ & C˜m b & b bb 346 ˙˙ ˙ ˙ E: ∑ Aadd9 C˜m/G˜ Bsus4 ˙˙ ˙ ? #### c ‰ ˙˙˙ ˙˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ Vsus4 vi ∑ bœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ . œ œ œ œ . œJ bbbb ∑ ˙ IVadd9 vi64 ∑ YT: Siz-xBfIqpg ∑ ∑ b b b b n b œœ n b œœ Fm bbbb nœ ∑ ∑ A¯: vi Figure 22.7.3 James Horner and Will Jennings, “My Heart Will Go On” (1997) 346 b b b bdirect∑ modulation, ∑ composers ∑ ∑do not ∑make any∑ attempt ∑ to connect ∑ With & two different keys through any pivot chords or common tones. In the next sec? bb b b ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ tion, we examine how composers connect two keys through a common tone. 22.7.2 Common-Tone Modulation In common-tone modulation, two chords are connected through a single note 354 to bridge the distance between two keys. In the following example, the note C4 acts as a hinge between a C4 major chord ( V in F4 minor) and an A dominant seventh chord ( V7 in D major). b & b bb ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ b & b bb ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ? bb b b ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ 354 CHAPTER 22. MODULATION 90 90 SS r SS r r r œ ˙ œ œ œœ ‰‰œ .. œœ ˙˙ œ ## # 4 œ # œ ‰‰œ .. œ ˙ œ #œ œ œ & & # 44 ##!œœ ! !œ ##!œœ !œœ !œ !œœ !œœ !œœ ! !œ !œ !œœ !œ !œ !œœ ! !! ! !!!! !!!! !!!! r ? ? ## ## 444 œœ ŒŒ ŒŒ ‰‰ .. œœr œœ ŒŒ ŒŒ ‰‰ .. œœR R f ˜: V f ˜: V ## # & & # ? ? ## ## f ˜: f ˜: r œœ œ ‰ . œœr ˙˙ ‰œ .œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ !!œ !! !! !!œ !!œ !! !!œ !!œ œœ Œ Œ ‰ . œœ Œ Œ ‰ . RR i i pœ ## # pœ ŒŒ ÓÓ & & # ww pp ? ? ## ## ww ww pp i i ƒ r œœ # œ ŒŒ ŒŒ ‰ .ƒœœr # œ ## œœ œ # œ œœ ‰œ .œ œ #œ œ œ ## œœ ! ! !! !! ! ! !! !! !! !! r œœ ŒŒ ŒŒ ‰‰ .. œœr ƒ V ƒ V 5ˆˆ in f ˜ 5 in f ˜ ww ww ww 7ˆˆ in D 7 in D ww pp cresc. ww cresc. w ww 252 Sr œœ ‰ .Sœœr ˙˙ # œ ‰œ . œ ## œœ # œ œ ## œœ œœ œ œœ œœ !! !! !! !! !! !! !! !! œœ ŒŒ V V r ŒŒ ‰‰ .. œr œ r r œœ ‰ . œœr œœ ‰ . œœr œœ # ‰œ . œœ ‰œ . ## œœ # œ œœ œ œ œœ !! !! !! !! !œ ! ! ! !!!! ƒ ƒ r r œœ ‰‰ .. œœr œœ ‰‰ .. œœr ww ww SS ww ww A: V7 A: V77 œœ œœ pp œœ œœ I I YT: bEiYmeeV6sI Figure 22.7.4 Beethoven, Symphony No. 2 in D major, Op. 36, I. (1801–1802) In the next example, the note A acts as a hinge between an A major chord ( V in D minor) and an F major chord ( I in F major). CHAPTER 22. MODULATION bb c œœ .. b & &b c 47 47 253 nnœœ œœ .. œœ œœ .. œœ œœ .. œœ œœ p bb b c #pœ . ?? ## œœ œœ .. œœ œœ .. œœ œœ .. œœ & & b c #œ. pp bb b c œ & & b c œ .. œœ ## œœ .. œœ œœ .. œœ œœ .. œœ ppœ . ? b ? bb b cc œ . nnnnœœœ œœ .. œœœœ œœ .. œœœœ œœ .. œœœœ œ nnœœ œ œœ œ œœ ÓÓ ŒŒ ÓÓ ŒŒ ÓÓ ## œœ dim. nnœœ b œ n œ œdim. ## œœ œœ ## œœ nnœœ œœ ## œœ œœ ## œœ œ b œ n œ œ d: d: V V bbbb & & 49 49 œœ ŒŒ ∑∑ ? ? bbbb ∑∑ ∑∑ 55ˆˆ in in dd & & ww pp jj ‰ Œ Ó œ œ # œ ‰Œ Ó œ # œ œ n œ œœ œœ nnœœ œœ ## œœ œœ## œœ n œ œ # œ œ # œ π π ? b ∑∑ ∑∑ ? bb b bbbb & & ∑∑ 3ˆ in F œœ œœ.. œœ.. œœ.. ˙˙ ∑∑ ∑∑ 3ˆ in F π π ∑∑ œœ œœ œ œœœ œ œœœ œœ œœ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œœ π π ww ww F: F: II YT: qSRRbOvpaXg Figure 22.7.5 Schubert, Piano Trio No. 1 in B-flat major, D. 898, I. (1828) 22.7.2.1 Chromatic Mediants In a common-tone modulation, the two chords connecting the two keys are typically in a chromatic mediant relationship. Chromatic mediants are chords with roots a third apart that share only one common tone and have the same quality (both are major or both are minor). 37 E C C˜ A A F 811 2 &4 812 824 & &b b # n www n www • one common tone—A • roots are a 3rd apart • both chords are major Figure 22.7.6 Chromatic mediant relationship in Figure 22.7.5 C˜ A A F ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ b b œ œ # n wwwœ œ œœ œ nœwww œ œ & œ # 4 œ œ ( ) œ (œ) (œ) ( ) & 4 œ (œ) (œ) (œ) (œ) œ (œ) (œ) • one common tone—A( ) (œ) 787 LSS: ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ 811 CHAPTER 22. MODULATION 254 Any major or minor triad will have four• chromatic mediants, roots are a 3rd apart as shown in RN:example G: ___ below. ___ vi ___ ___ ___ vi the • both chords are major 812 795 D:___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ Cm E¯m 6 Dom Cm ____ DomCm TonEmPD Cm CadAm Ton A¯m 4 www # ww www b ww www b b www www # www b www b ww b www n ww b www n www b www b b www w bw w & w___ ___b ___ LSS: ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ # 4 œ• root œ of second n œ œis a third œ chord # œ lowerœor #higher œ œthan# œstarting œ #chord œ œ & 4 • second chord is same quality as starting chord HF: C RN: E C Ton Dom E ¯ C ____ A¯ PD C A /V Dom • the two chords within each bar share only one common tone e: ___ ___ ___ N6 ___ ___ i 37 Figure 22.7.7 Chromatic mediants of the C major and C+6minor triads 820 b:___ E ___ ___ Fr ___ C ___ ___ Below are examples chromatic mediantsC˜that do not involve modulation. A64 Dom HF: Ton Dom Ton ___ /V Dom ____ Dom Ton ___ Cad Ton In fact, the progression in the following three examples are found in the last A F bar of Figure 22.7.7, the progression from i to 2 vi (shown as Cm to A2m in 811 the example above). 42 & 803 812 G˜m &b Em b G ˜m œœœ n œœœ # # ˙˙˙ œ E¯ C A¯ # n www n www • one common tone—A G ˜m Em B (no 3rd) • roots are a 3rd apart • both chords are major j ˙ œœ .. # œœ # ˙˙ ˙ n œœ .. # œ # ˙ Cm Em œCm Am ˙ Cm˙˙ A¯m b www b b www b www n www Jb www n www b www b b www Em œœœ n œœœ # # ˙˙˙ œ Cm E¯m A #˙ ? 42C #E ˙˙ C C www # wwp www b ww www b b www www # www bw & w • root of second chord is a third lower or higher than starting chord • second chord is same quality as starting chord • the two chords withinYT: eachmeGuEnjERxc bar share only one common tone Figure 22.7.8 Richard Wagner, Das Rheingold, Scene 3 (1854) Gm 820 ? b b 44 œ˙˙ . ˙ .. ? bb œ œ E¯m œ. b œœ œ Gm œœ n œœ E¯m œ. b œœ Gm œ ˙ ˙ n ˙˙ 822 YT: AL2N4Bfl4Ec Figure 22.7.9 John Williams, Star Wars: Return of the Jedi, “Main Title (The Story Continues)” (1983) CHAPTER 22. MODULATION # & 44 Œ 255 œ œ bœ nœ œ nœ bœ œ œ Œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ # 4Choirœ œ ˙ . œœ b œœ ˙˙ .. w ww & 4 œ œ ˙. w J Em 44 44 Cm Trumpet Horn œœ œœ ˙˙ .. ?# 4 4 Kor - ah, 44 7 B G E œ œ 3 ww 3 D B¯ G œ ˙ .. œ ˙ J w w Syahd - ho, 91 B¯ (arrows show common tones) G¯ (roots are a 3rd apart) YT: E¯ ZTg6hg1miFg & ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ b 44 48 & b 43 ∑ œ ∑ ∑ >œ ∑ b∑œ ∑ ∑ ∑n œ ∑ ∑>œ ∑ b ˙∑ ∑ ∑ & ∑ Sequential 22.7.3 Modulation > > > > ? 3 4 Modulation a œsequential modulab 4 can also be accomplished by sequence. 48 4 œ areIn repeated œ œ tion, and its accompanying harmonies . ? ba∑ melody b∑œ ∑ ∑ ∑ œ ∑ ∑œ ∑ bat˙∑ a new ∑ n œ ∑ ∑ œ to∑ a new ∑ pitch ∑ level to establish or lead key. œIn the following > example, the sequence n œ b œ b ˙ . > > in the> new key. > of the original>idea occurs > 48 Figure 22.7.10 Williams, of the Fates” Em JohnGm E¯mThe Phantom Menace, “DuelE¯m (1999) 63 & ∑ ∑ 3ˆ 4ˆ 2ˆ ∑ 3ˆ 1ˆ 1ˆ 7ˆ 1ˆ ˆ2 ∑ 4ˆ ˆ3 3ˆ b & b b b 43 œ œœ œ Œ œ œ œ n œ œ œ œ œ œœ & ∑ œ. ∑œ œ œ ∑œ œ œ œ ∑ ˙ . p 63 œœ œœ œœ n œœ ˙˙ Œ ? 3 œ b b Œ Œ Œ Œ Œ ? b b∑ 4 ∑ ∑ ∑ 63 f: i iiø42 i V43 i V6 ∑ ∑ ∑ same melodic pattern in A¯ 4ˆ 2ˆ 3ˆ 1ˆ 1ˆ 7ˆ 1ˆ 2ˆ 4ˆ 3ˆ œœŒ œœœ œ œœ œœ œ∑œ œ œ ∑œ œ œ œ ∑ ˙ œœ œœ œœ œœ ˙˙ œ Œ∑Œ œ Œ Œ ∑ ∑ i A¯: I ii42 I V43 I V6 I same Roman numeral pattern in A¯ b & b bb YT: M9SzCHQCNGY Figure 22.7.11 Beethoven, Piano Sonata Op. 2, No. 1, III. (1795) ? bb b b In the following example, an idea in C major is repeated up a step in D major, then up another step in E minor before reaching an F4 ◦ chord, a chord with dominant function in G major. CHAPTER 22. MODULATION 14 14 14 Oboe Oboe Oboe 14 14 14 Violin I Violin II Violin 14 14 14 Violin II Violin II II Violin & 4242 & 2 & 424 & 2 2 & 4 &4 . œœ œœ œ.œ. œ.œ. œœ œœ œœ. œœ ˙˙ 256 3 33 same melodic pattern in D major same melodic melodic pattern pattern in in D D major major same . œ.. . œ.. . . . . œ œ. . œœ œœ œ.œ. œ.œ œœ## œœ œ œœ. ## œœ œœ œ.œ## œ.œ. œœ œœ œ.œ œ ## œœ œœ œ.œ œœ. œœ œ œ. œ.œ œœ œœ œ œœ ## œœ œ j j ‰ œ ‰ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ # œ œœ # œ ## œœ ˙˙ ‰ œ œœ ‰ JœJ œœ ## œœ œ œ # œ œ œ #œ establishes F˜, destabilizes C major establishes FF˜˜,, destabilizes destabilizes C C major major establishes . . . œœ.. œœ œœ œ.œ œœ.. œœ œœ œœ. œ.œ œœ œœ ## œœ.. œœ.. œ œœ œ.. œœ.. œ.. œ. œ. . œ œ œ œ. œ. œœ. same melodic pattern in E minor same melodic melodic pattern pattern in in E E minor minor same .. œœ ## œœ œœ.. œ.. œœ œœ œœ. œœ. œœ ## œœ œœ.. œ & & 18 18 18 18 18 18 & ˙˙ & & œ œœ œœ # œ & œ #œ 18 18 18 œœ œœ ## œœ œœ ‰‰ œœ E minor, affirms F˜ and movement E minor, minor, affirms affirms FF˜˜ and and movement movement E away from C major away from from C C major major away 22 22 22 22 22 22 22 22 22 œ œœ œ.œ. & œ & & œœ & & œœ & . œ œ.œ œœ œ ŒŒ ŒŒ arrival on G as tonic arrival on on G G as as tonic tonic arrival . # œ.. œ.œ # œ . œ.œ ŒŒ ŒŒ . œœ. œœ ## œœ .. œœJ ˙˙ J G: viioo G: vii viio G: . œ.œ . œœ. œœ œœ œœ ## œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œœ œ œœ ##œœ V7 V77 V dominant function in G major dominant function function in in G G major major dominant Ÿ œœŸ ŸŸ j ‰‰ œœj œœ œœ œœ ##œœ fœœ f ‰‰ j j œ #œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ # œ œ œ œ ffœ YT: jD9_dShQbN8 Figure 22.7.12 Mozart, Oboe Concerto in C major, K. 314, III. (1777) In the next example, after a cadence in G minor, an idea in F minor is repeated down a whole step in E2 minor to achieve the change of key to E2 major, which is the starting key of this aria, as can be seen in the key signature. CHAPTER 22. MODULATION 36 36 351 351 bbbbb cc œœ ˙˙.. & & b g: i646 g: i4 bbbbb ÓÓ & & b 354 354 - bbbbb ŒŒ & & b V V va, va, ŒŒ œœ œœ bb œœ œœ œœ bb œœ œœ œ œ ŒŒ ÓÓ i œœ œ i pal pal - œœ œœ œ œ - - - œœ œ - bb ˙˙ tan tan - œœ œ - œœ œ - e¯: iioo e¯: ii œœ œ - - f: iioo f: ii same pattern down a whole step same pattern down a whole step œœ bb œœ œœ œœ b œ œ b œ ? œ b bœ œ bœ ? b bb œ bb ŒŒ ÓÓ f: i f: i ŒŒ bb ˙˙ mi mi bbbbb cc ‰‰ œ œœ œ ‰‰ # œ n œ œ & & b œ œ œ n #œ nœ œ œ œ n œ œœ ? ? bbbbb cc œœ ŒŒ œœ b 354 354 œœ ## œœ cor cor 351 351 257 - œœ ŒŒ - œœ œ V77 V ŒŒ œœ Œ œ Œ Œ œ Œ - - pi - pi - ŒŒ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ nn wœw œ Œ Ó Œ Ó V77 V U U œ œ œœ U œ U œ œœ - ŒŒ - do! - do! U U œœ V566 V5 YT: VEmnmVXEqqM Figure 22.7.13 Mozart, Don Giovanni, K. 527, “Mi tradi quell’alma ingrata” (1787) While this is by no means an exhaustive list of modulatory techniques, it should give you a sense of some of the different means composers use to change keys. 22.8 Practice Exercises Day One 1. For each given key, list the five closely-related keys. (a) d: (b) D2: (c) f: 36 36 785 &# #### G major: G Am Bm C D CHAPTER 22. MODULATION # & # # 2. 785 Em F˜o 258 For each progression, analyze the Roman numerals with D major: DC7/B¯ EmF/A F˜mDm GC/EA Dm/F Bm lead-sheet C ˜o G 7 C Fsecond C/G ____ Lead-sheet ____ ____key. ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ symbols andsymbols: specify the Lead-sheet symbols: ____ Roman numerals: F: 811 I Roman numerals: ____ F: I V42 ____ V42 bb ____ I6 I6 E ____ C vi ˜ A ____ ____ ____ # n www C ____ A F n www vi C : ii ___ I6 ii6 I46 V7 6 6 6 7 ___ : ii I ii I4 V I E C o C˜ IV V R. N.: I ii iii viA vii • one common tone—A Lead-sheet symbols: ____ ____ ____ A ____ ____ ____ F ____ ____ a 3rdFapart 811 G major: G Am Bm C• roots D are Em ˜o ww # ww Day Two& w w C E C 812 3. 812 iv nw ww are major iv6 • both chords ___ •: one ii6 common viiø7/V tone—A I6 V7 I 4 GA¯ AC ABm Care ˜oEa¯D Em • roots 3rd Cm apart Cm m Em F˜m Cm Am • both chords are major b ww Vww ww vi b wwviiob wwI b wwiin ww iiib ww n ww www R.b wwN.: www b IV w w #w w w w w C D major: E¯ C E # n www bw bw w I b www b b www Cm A¯m Borrowed Chord List w the wclosely related keys to ww chord www # ww major www bkey, ww Modulation. www b b wwwspecify www # wwwisthe wwand www b bthe bparallel ww b blower ww minor b wwworn wwwhigher n www itsstarting bclosely • root of second chord a third than starting then keyb w w w b w & E¯related keys. • second chord is same quality as starting chord # ###### # B && F˜ 787 787 b &i b V6/iv g: Roman numerals: & 37 D¯ c˜ C E¯ A¯ C C A Cm E¯m Cm Em Cm A¯m Cm Am theoftwo chords each barorshare common • •root second chordwithin is a third lower higheronly than one starting chord tone • second chord is same quality as starting chord • the two chords within each bar share only one common tone E¯m Gm E¯m Gm Gm D Gm E¯m Gm E¯m Gm œ ˙ to parallel œ # # œ œ œ œ ? 4 # 820 ## # b œ œ . . ˙ œ # œ œ minor . # && œ ? bbb 444 œ˙˙ ˙˙. .. œ n ˙˙˙ œœ . b œœ œœœ n œœœœ . b œœ˙˙˙ ˙ .. bœ nœ bœ n˙ 820 789 789 # # # ##4. & ## # 809 809 & 817 778 & #### & # ## # 817 & 825 #### For each progression, analyze the Roman numerals with lead-sheet symbols and specify the second key. #### 7/G Dm/F B¯7 Dm/A A________ C A A A7 Lead-sheet symbols:________ ____ ____ ____ ____________ Lead-sheet symbols: ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ Roman numerals: Roman numerals:A: A:I Lead-sheet symbols: ___ : V42d i6 Ger+66 ___ : V42 i ____ ____ ___ 6 : I6 i i ____ ____ ii6 viio7/V N6 A¯ : I6 ___ ____ ____ 7 i64VI V7 ____ Fm ____ I64 viio7/vi vi ii6 viio7/V I64 viio7/vi vi Determining Diatonic Common Chords. For each of the two keys in each example, list the diatonic chords as lead-sheet symbols and as Roman numerals then circle those diatonic to both keys 822 Roman numerals: ? bb 6. ____ 6 i4 +6V Ger Gm i6 Gm/B¯ Eo7 Lead-sheet symbols: ____ ____ B¯m/D¯ ____ ____ A¯/E¯ ____ ____ Roman numerals: g: i ____ N6 A¯/C Roman numerals: g: 5. VI24/IV V4/IV 2 Do7 825 & #### Day Three & I ¯III ¯IIII d: ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ Lead-sheet symbols in Dm: ___ ___ Lead-sheet symbols in F: ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ Roman numerals: ___ ___ ___ ___ F: B¯ ____ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ Referring to the Harmonic Flowchart, fill in lead-sheet symbols, Roman numerals, and Harmonic Functions for the following example—be sure to put some of the chords in first inversion for variety; create a VI 37 LSS: ___ ___ ___ ˙ ˙ w ( ˙) ( ˙ ) (w) w # 4 ˙ ( ˙˙) (w) & 4 CHAPTER 22. MODULATION RN: 795 G: ___ ___ vi ˙ ˙ ˙˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ w ( ) ˙ ( ) ( ˙ ) ( ˙) ( ˙ ) ( ˙) ( w) 259 ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ vi melody by adding embellishments (non-chord tones) and try to create D:___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ repeating motives and/or subphrases; LSS stands for lead-sheet symHF: RNTonstands Dom ____ PD /V Dom Dom Ton PD Cad64 Dom Ton bols, for Roman numerals,____ and HF stands for Harmonic Function # ˙ ˙ & 44 LSS: RN: w n˙ ˙ #w ___ N6 ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ e: ___ ___ ˙ #˙ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ˙ #˙ ˙ #˙ w i b:___ ___ ___ Fr+6 ___ ___ ___ HF: Ton Dom Ton ___ __/ V Dom ___ Cad64 Dom Ton ____ Dom Ton Day Four 7. List the four chromatic mediants for each chord. G ˜m Em G˜m Em G ˜m Em (a) Fm: 803 (b)2 ? 4 #˙ D#2: ˙˙ (c) G: p (d) G4m: i Day Five 8. œœœ œ n œœœ # # ˙˙˙ Em D˜o/F˜ Em/G viio6 i6 œœœ F/A A˜o7 viio7/V V PD PD œ. n œœœ ... œ n œœœ # # ˙˙˙ j # œœ # œœ J B (no 3rd) # ˙˙ # ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ Em F˜7 Bm/D G7(¯5) Bm/F˜ F˜ Bm B iv V7 PD i6 i6 V PD i 4 Analyze lead-sheet symbols, motives (with numbers, noting melodic alteration when it occurs), Roman numerals, and harmonic function. 96 96 CHAPTER 22. MODULATION LSS: LSS: Motives: Motives: 260 ___ ___ ___ ___ & bb 433 œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ ˙ & 4 ˙ ? b 43 Œ ? b 43 Œ œ œ RN: RN: HF: HF: LSS: ___ LSS: ___ Motives: Motives: œ & bb œ & ?b œ ?b œ RN: RN: HF: HF: ___ ___ ___ ___ œœ œœ œ œ œœœ œ œœ œœ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ œ œ œ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ by G.K.B. ___ by G.K.B. ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œœ œœ œ œœœœ œœœœ œ œœœœ œœœœ œ œ ___ ___ œ œ ˙ œ œ ˙ nœ œ œ n œœœœœ œœœœœ œ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ œœ œ œœ œœœ œ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œ nœ ˙ œ nœ ˙ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ œ œ & bb & ? ?b b 22.8.1 Figure Compose an eight-measure example using the motivic structure and harmonic function in the example above. Create a new melody 97 with new motives but the same sequence of motives. You may use a different time signature, mode, and accompanimental texture. LSS: ___ ___ ___ ___ RN: ___ ___ ___ ___ HF: ___ ___ ___ ___ Motives: &b ?b LSS: ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ RN: ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ HF: ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ Motives: &b ?b RN: b ___ CHAPTER HF: 22. MODULATION ___ LSS: ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ RN: ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ HF: ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ 261 Motives: &b ?b Click here to download the first homework assignment for this chapter. Click here to the second homework assignment for this chapter. b download & to Click here download the third homework assignment for this chapter. Click here to download the fourth homework assignment for this chapter. Click here to download the fifth homework assignment for this chapter. ? to download the Unit 5 Practice Test. Click here b PDF versions of the textbook, homework exercises, and practice exercises can be found at musictheory.pugetsound.edu Chapter 23 Enharmonic Modulation 23.1 Enharmonic Modulation In an enharmonic modulation, the pivot chord is almost always misspelled in one of the keys and therefore must be reconceptualized enharmonically by the analyst. In this regard, an enharmonic modulation is a harmonic pun. Here is a pun from Shakespeare’s Richard III, Act 1, Scene 1: Now is the winter of our discontent Made glorious summer by this sun of York 107 The “sun” of York is the son of York, King Edward IV. Here is a simple enharmonic modulation: œ & 43 œœ Dm/F G7 ? 43 œ œ œ C: I ii6 C œœ œ Bm/F˜ œœ œ # œœ œ (# œœ) œ (œ) V7 b: Ger+6 #œ i46 F ˜7 #œ # œœ Bm œ V7 œ œœ œ i Figure 23.1.1 Enharmonic Modulation from C major to B minor & Like a verbal pun, this harmonic pun is effective because the third chord ( G7 ) has two “meanings”—in the context of C major, G7 is V7 and the root wants to cadence down a fifth to C, but the G7 is a Ger+6 in the context of B minor, where the root of the G7 wants to progress down a half step to a chord of dominant function, i64 in the example above. ? 262 # CHAPTER 23. ENHARMONIC MODULATION 872 & P5↓ C: V7 resolves to enharmonic respelling b b & & 874 Figure 23.1.2 876 & ? ### # www w m2↓ b: Ger+6 ww w 41 I # ww # # # ww resolves to V respell top note: B¯ becomes A˜ b www w # www w Notice that the G7 can only be spelled correctly in one of the keys—either as a dominant seventh chord on G (G–B–D–F) or as a Ger+6 on G (G–B–D–E4), hence the term “enharmonic modulation.” The analyst must envision the other spelling (the one not shown) to understand the double context, in the same 7 C: beVenvisioned Ger+6 way “sun of York” must as “son b: of York.” 872 We will encounter two sonorities used in enharmonic modulations: the bottom three notes respelled dominant seventh sonority and the diminished seventh sonority. b b b wwww # # #wwwwwww & P5↓ 23.2 The&V7 andw Ger+6 as Pivot ww Chords w 878 ˙˙ & # ˙˙ www w 263 b: V7 modulation,B¯: Ger+6 In this first type of enharmonic the pivot to the new key will 7 V I as a Ger+6 , or the Ger+6 consist of the V7 beingC: enharmonically reinterpreted resolves to enharmonic 7 being enharmonically reinterpreted as V . Secondary dominants, like V7 IV , respelling V7 Vrespelled , etc., will also be reinterpreted harmonically as Ger+6 chords (and vice enharmonically 874 versa) in enharmonic modulations. m2↓ As we saw in the previous section, the dominant seventh chord and the Ger+6 chord have the same sound but are spelled differently. This involves a fairly straightforward b:enharmonic Ger+6 respelling. MostVcommonly, the top note of resolves to the enharmonic alternative. the chord is enharmonically respelled to envision o4 i c: vii 2 i 876 ˙ #˙ ˙˙˙ # www & ˙˙ w ˙ b ˙˙ #w # # # www b ˙˙ ˙ ˙ a: viio7 respell top note: B¯ becomes A˜ enharmonically respelled enharmonically respelled ˙˙ b ˙ &b ˙ ˙ 878 e¯: viio43 b www # www w w ˙ b ˙ b ˙ b ˙ ˙ ˙ b˙ ˙ b b ∫F:˙˙˙V7 e: Ger b b+6b ˙˙˙ Figure 23.2.1 bottom three notes respelled www5 a key based on itsb spelling: Each the o6 b winww major, i chord above G¯:implies I dominant seventh # #vii chord occurs & diatonically only on the 5̂ scale degree while the Ger b w # w chord most commonly occurs with the lowest note on the lowered 6̂ scale degree. & +6 Less commonly, the b: bottom be respelled and the upper+6 V7 three notes could B¯: Ger most note could be retained as a common tone. ˙˙˙ & #˙ enharmonically respelled #˙ ˙ ˙˙˙ ˙ b ˙˙˙ a: viio7 i c: viio42 enharmonically respelled enharmonically respelled b˙ ˙ ˙ b ˙˙˙ i 0 & & b ww ww & # # # wwww CHAPTER 23. ENHARMONIC MODULATION C: V7 b: 878 # www w Ger+6 264 b b b wwww bottom three notes respelled b: V7 B¯: Ger+6 Figure 23.2.2 Remember, you will not see this respelling in the music you are analyzing. You must be able to visualize the enharmonic respelling in order to analyze the enharmonic modulation correctly. The examples below illustrate some of the ways this enharmonic modulation occurs in pieces from the literature In the first example from Tchaikovsky’s Nutcracker ballet, a D7 is spelled on the staff as D–F4–A–B4 so that it sounds like a V7 IV in D major but is spelled and resolves as a Ger+6 in the key of F4 minor. CHAPTER 23. ENHARMONIC MODULATION ## # & & # ? ? ## ## 3 443 4433 D D œœœ -- œ-œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ D: I D: I F˜m/C˜ F˜m/C˜ ## # œ œ jj ‰ & & # œœ œ ## œœ œ œœ ‰ Œ œ œ ? ? ## ## Œ˙˙ .. œœœ œœœ f ˜: i664 f ˜: i 4 F ˜m F ˜m ## # œœ ## œœ & & # ŒŒ˙ ? # ? # ## ˙˙ ˙ f ˜: i f ˜: i C˜o7 /D ped. C˜o7/D ped. œ bb œœœ-œœ œœœ ...... - >>œ .. bb œœ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ r œœr œ >>œ 265 D77 D D D > ˙˙> j œj ˙ œ viio7 /I ped. viio7/I ped. I I œœ œœ C˜77/B C˜ /B F˜m/A F˜m/A V442 V2 i66 i œœ œœ D77 D i442 i2 Ger+6 Ger+6 œœ œœ œœ ## œœ ## œœœ œœœ œœ œœ V77/IV (D-F˜-A-C) V /IV (D-F˜-A-C) f ˜: Ger+6 (D-F˜-A-B˜) f ˜: Ger+6 (D-F˜-A-B˜) ŒŒ ‹ œ # œ œ œœ œœ œœ ## œœ œœ œœ ‰‰ JJ ‹œ #œ œ ŒŒ œœœ œœœ ŒŒ œœ œœ ˙˙ . ## œœ œœ ˙ . œœ œœ ˙. . F˜m77/E F˜m /E ŒŒ pp ŒŒ ˙˙ . . œœ œ-œœ œœ C˜77/G˜ C˜ /G˜ ŒŒ ## œœ œœ ## œœ ## œœ F FŒŒ # n œœœœ œœœœ #nœ œ ˙˙ .# # œ œ . F˜m/C˜ F˜m/C˜ V443 V3 C˜77 C˜ F ˜m F ˜m œœ # œ œ œ œœ # œ # œ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ # œ œ œ œ # œ œJ #œ œ œ #œ #œ œ œ J œœœ œœœ ŒŒ # œœœ ŒŒ œœœ n œœœ œjj n œ œ nœ œœœ ˙˙ # œœ ˙˙ .. œ ## n œœ œœ nn œœ œœ ˙ œœ ˙ ˙ ˙ .. i664 i4 V77 V i i YT: Kw0wLLVEMaA Figure 23.2.3 Tchaikovsky, The Nutcracker“Waltz of the Flowers” (1892) In the following example from the second movement of Beethoven’s Fifth Symphony, the same pivot chords are used as in the example above— V7 IV in A2 major is enharmonically respelled and resolves as a Ger+6 in C major. 99 99 102 CHAPTER 23. ENHARMONIC MODULATION A¯ 266 Ao7 œœ . œ b œœœ œœ . œ J J πœ nœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ? b b b 38 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ J œ ‰ b b 3 & b b b 8 œœ .. œœ œœ 3 3 œœ œœ œœ 3 3 3 3 A¯: I b & b bb b œœœ ? bb b ‰ b nœ œ. œ. viio7/ii A¯7 œ # œœœ ... œ # œ. ƒ bœ. bœ. V7/IV C: Ger+6 n œœœ ... œ. C/G n œœœ œ. I64 œœ. nœ œœ. œ œœœ œ. . n n œœœ nœ G7 œœ œ. V7 C œ n œœ ‰ J œ n œœœ œ œ I YT: DdL2e4pE-uA Figure 23.2.4 Beethoven, Symphony No. 5, Op. 67, II (1808) In the following example from Les Miserables, a Ger+6 in E minor is spelled as a V7 chord in F major and resolves to the I chord F major. CHAPTER 23. ENHARMONIC MODULATION 356 # & # c E¯ bœ # & # c b œœ bœ And al 356 ? ## c b œ bœ 359 359 & & ## ## ? ## œ. - though œ n n œœ nw nw ˙. œ n œœ ˙ ˙ e: iv7 œœ œ I know that he œœ œ œœ œ is œœ œ ˙ ˙ ˙. œ œ blind Still I w w V œ œ œœ œ B # œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ e: i Am7 say ≈ œr œ œ œ œ Em œ 267 there's a œœ œ C7 œ œ œ way for ˙ b ˙˙ us n˙ n˙ Œ Ó Ó nœ nœ I love F b œ him b œ œœ œ b œ Ger+6 F: V7 I YT: VjfmP7h3gBw Figure 23.2.5 Music by Claude-Michel Schönberg, lyrics by Alain Boublil, Herbert Kretzmer, John Caird, Trevor Nunn, and Jean-Marc Natel, Les Miserables, “On My Own” (1980) In the next section we will examine how the fully diminished seventh chord can be enharmonically reinterpreted. 23.3 The Fully Diminished Seventh as Pivot Chord Each diminished seventh sonority implies four different keys. Play and sing through the example below. & # # # wwww b b b wwww b: V7 CHAPTER 23. ENHARMONIC MODULATION 880 ˙˙ & # ˙˙ enharmonically respelled ˙ #˙ ˙˙ ˙ ˙ b ˙˙˙ B¯: Ger+6 a: viio7 i c: viio42 enharmonically respelled enharmonically respelled ˙ & b b ˙˙˙ 884 ˙ b ˙ b b ˙˙˙ e¯: viio43 i ˙ ˙ 268 b ˙˙˙ i b b ∫ ˙˙˙˙ ˙ b˙ G¯: viio65 ˙ b b b ˙˙˙ I Figure 23.3.1 The Four Resolutions of a Diminished Seventh Sonority In the example above, each note of the vii◦7 chord was treated in turn as scale degree 7̂ and resolved up by half step. In the example below, each note of the chord resolves as if it were the 7th of the chord, moving down by half step to the root of a dominant seventh chord. 42 888 ˙ & # ˙˙˙ ˙ ˙ & b b ˙˙˙ b˙ ˙ b ˙˙˙ b˙ ˙ b b ∫ ˙˙˙˙ ∫˙ b ˙ b b ˙˙˙˙ enharmonically respelled ˙ ˙ # ˙˙˙ a: viio7 V65 c: viio42 enharmonically enharmonically respelled respelled 892 e¯: viio43 b ˙ b ˙˙˙˙ V42 G¯: viio65 ˙˙ ˙˙ V7 V43 896 & Figure 23.3.2 Resolutions of a Diminished Seventh Sonority to a Dominant Seventh Sonority This means that for any diminished seventh chord, you should be able to imagine the other three respellings in the same way you can imagine other spellings of words like two (i.e., to and too) or there (their and they’re). In the following examples, a vii◦7 chord is enharmonically reinterpreted in a new key. 4 . In the first example, Beethoven enharmonically reinterprets F ◦7 C in G 4 . minor ( vii◦43 ) as vii◦42 in E minor ( D ◦7 C ), which resolves to a V7 chord in E minor. ii6 ii6 V7 V7+6 b: Ger i46 +6 b: Ger i46 CHAPTER 23. ENHARMONIC MODULATION C: I C: I Gm Gm/B¯ D/A Gm C˜o7 D Gm Gm/B¯ D/A Gm C˜o7 D b & bb bb cc œœ & b œœ Íœœ ? bb c Í ? b bb c œ b œ g: i g: i b & bb bb & b F˜o7/E¯ F˜o7/E¯ # nn œœœœ #Íœ Íœ ? bb œ ? b bb b g: viio42 g: viio42 œœ .. œœ # n œœœ ... œœœ n œœœ œœ .. œœ # n œœ .. œœ n œœ œœ .. œ nœ. œ #œ #œ œ. œ nœ. œ œ. j œœ j ‰ œœ ‰ œ Jœ ≈ . œ J ≈ . RÔœ RÔ œœœ .. œœ ... œ. œ. Em/B Em/B œœœ œœœ .. # œœœ œœœ n nn œœ œœ œœ ... # œœ œœ n nn œœœ p œ œ . œ pœ n œ œ œ œ . œ Jœ n œ Jœ J J V V e: e: viio43 o4 viio4 3 vii 2 viio42 V7 V7 i46 i46 i i 269 F˜o7/E¯ F˜o7/E¯ # nn œœœœ #Íœ Íœ œ i6 V64 i viio7/V V i6 V64 i viio7/V V D D˜o7/C D D˜o7/C V7 V7 D F˜o7/C Gm/B¯ D F˜o7/C Gm/B¯ œœœ .. œœœ œœœ .. œœœ œœœ œœ ... œœ œœ ... œœ œœ œ. œ œ. œ œ. œ. œ œ. œ œ. viio42 viio42 B7 B7 V viio43 V viio43 Em/B Em/B œœœ œœ i6 i6 B7(¯9) B7 B7(¯9) B7 # # nn œœœ n n n œœœ œœœ œ # # œœ n n œ n œœœ # œœ n œ n œ # œœ cresc. π œ cresc. π Jœ n œ œ J nœ œ nœ nœ V7 V7 i46 i46 ≈. œ ≈ . RÔœ RÔ V7(¯9) V7 V7(¯9) V7 j œj œ YT: mlxF5I1MfbM Figure 23.3.3 Beethoven, Pathétique Sonata, Op. 13, I (1798) In the next example from the second movement of Beethoven’s Fifth Symphony, Beethoven modulates from C major to A2 major by enharmonically . 2 reinterpreting an E◦ 7 chord in C ( vii◦7 IV ) as vii◦42 in A2 ( G◦ 7 F ). Notice the unusual resolution of the vii◦42 chord to a Ger+6 chord by leading all three of the upper voices of the vii◦42 up by half step to the Ger+6 , which itself is unusually spelled in the key of A2 major (E–A2–C2–D instead of F2–A2–C2–D). 100 100 CHAPTER 23. ENHARMONIC MODULATION C b & b bb b & b bb 38 38 ? b b b 38 b ? b b b 38 b C: C: n œœC^ œœ ..n œœ œœ^ n œœ ..n œœœ nœ œ. Sœ œ n œ nœ. œ œ Sœr œ n œ œ n œ œ . œ œœ . œœr n œ œœ . œœ œI œ. œ I n œœ .. œ. n œœ .. Sœ . Sœj ‰ ‰ j œœ ‰ ‰ œ œœ bœ.œ œœœ œJ b œœ . œ œπ J π ∑ ∑ 270 Eo7 b œœœ Eœœo7. œ œœœ œœ . œ œœœ .. . b œœœ œœJ . œ œœœ œœJ . œ œœœ .. . J J jœ n œœj. ‰ ‰ p‰ n œ ‰ n œ n œœ . œ œ o7/IV (E-G-B n œ ¯-D¯) p n vii o4 A¯: viio72 (G-B¯-D¯-F¯) vii /IV (E-G-B¯-D¯) A¯: viio42 (G-B¯-D¯-F¯) E7 A¯m/E¯ Do7 Go7/D¯ A¯/C D¯ b b b b n œE7œœ. . Ab¯m/E œœœ .. ¯ Dœœœo7.. b . . . & bb b b b n œpœœ. . b œœœ .. œœœ .. . . . & . . . ? b b b b œœp. b œœ . n œœ . . . b . ? b b b b œœ . b œœ . n œœ . b .. ¯ Aœ¯./C E¯œ7/D œ œœ.. œ. œ. œ. bœ. œ. b œ .. œœ.. bœ. œ. œD.¯ œ .. œ œ. œ. œœ.. œ. A¯: Ger+6 i64 viio7/V viio43 I6 IV A¯: Ger+6 i64 viio7/V V42 I6 IV E¯ A¯ V I œE. ¯‰ ‰ œ ? œœAœ¯ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ. Jœ ‰ ‰ œ ?Jœœ œ œœ œ œ œ‰œ œ œ fœJ œ. f pJdolce ‰ fjœ. œ. ‰f ‰ œpj dolce ‰ œ œ. œ. ‰ ‰ œ j œœ ‰ œœ j œ œ . œ œ V. Iœ . œ YT: DdL2e4pE-uA Figure 23.3.4 Beethoven, Symphony No. 5, Op. 67, II (1808) ? bb b b 4 In the final example of this section, Schubert reinterprets a G ◦7 in G 4 4 minor as an E ◦7 chord in B minor ( vii◦65 V ). The G ◦7 chord in G minor is analyzed as vii◦42 iv , meaning it could resolve to a C minor chord, but it could also have been interpreted as vii◦43 VI , or as tonicizing an E2 major chord. Because the chord never resolves in G minor, one cannot be certain of the intended resolution. Remember that diminished triads are not tonicized, 4 so the G ◦7 would not be considered as tonicizing the note A (the root of the ii◦ chord) or F4 (the root of the vii◦ chord). ? bb b b 38 38 CHAPTER 23. ENHARMONIC MODULATION b & b 43 œ œ Œ Gm 362 362 362 362 b &b 43 tra - gen, ˙˙ .. ˙ . B¯+/F˜ 366 366 366 366 Œ ‰ œj œ . œj œj œj # œj. œr œ ‰ œj Œ Ich œ œ œ œ ˙ # œœ œœ œœ œœ ˙˙ j œ ‰œ œ œ III+64 b j r œ & b # œ . # œ n œJ # œR œR J b &b o7 G˜o7 Gm ? b b 43 . œr ‰ œ œ #œ œ œ œ #œ g: i bre - chen will mir mir das Herz Herz 271 i tra - ge Un - er - träg - li - ches, und ˙˙ .. ˙ . j œ. œ œ œ #œ . œ œ ‰ œ œ. œ œ œ #œ. œ œ œ cresc. viio42/iv b: viio65 /V F˜sus4 F˜ #˙. #œ J im Lei Lei -- -- Bm nœ Œ Œ -- -- -- ∑ œœœœœœœ œ #œ œ œ œ ƒ n ˙˙ # ˙ # œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ ? b # # œ œ b #œ. #œ nœ #œ #˙. #œ #œ. #œ nœ #œ œ # ˙. n ˙˙ ˙. n n ˙˙ .. -- be. be. ˙ b: Vsus4 V b &b 369 369 ∑ # ˙˙ .. n ˙ . n˙. n˙. i ∑ ∑ YT: 6PetvUTrUPY Z ∑ Figure 23.3.5 Schubert, Schwanegesang, D. 957, “Der Atlas” (1828) bb ∑ ∑ ∑ ? bb ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ Exercises & b Practice 23.4 369 369 Day One 1. Notate the specified chord, resolve it, then notate and resolve the enharmonic respelling(s). CHAPTER 23. ENHARMONIC MODULATION &b 42 ˙ & # ˙˙˙ 888 b ˙ bb & 272 ˙˙_____ b˙ ˙˙˙˙ g: ˙ Ger#+6 resolve b ˙˙ respell a: viio7 V65 c: viio42 enharmonically enharmonically respelled respelled 892 826 2. ˙˙ & b b ˙˙ # b˙ & & Roman numerals: 828 # ____ V7 b ˙ b b ˙˙˙˙ ∫˙ ____ ____ iv V 7 IV V /V ___: Ger+6 __ : ____ i64 V42 viio7/iv _____ resolve bb b& b b b b ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ & ____ 7 f: V /VI _____ b œœ resolve œ b œœ & b 44 œœœ # œœœrespellœœ b œœ œ b b œ #œ 3. 830 Analyze with lead-sheet symbols and Roman numerals and label the enharmonic pivot chords in the examples below. 897 832 &bb 834 ? b 4 b 4 œ g: ____ # # # # 4 œœ & 4&œ œ ____ # # ____ œ ____ 836 ? #### 4 œ 4 & ## E: ____ Figure # 23.4.1 ____ # & # _____ ____V7____ ____ ____ ____ G: /IV ____ resolve _____ E¯: respell I ¯VI b &bb 896 838 b ˙ b ˙˙˙˙ resolveb b ∫ ˙˙˙˙ __ : ____ ˙ For the following Roman numeral progressions, label the chords with e¯:symbols, viio43 V42 key, and G¯: notate viio65 lead-sheet specify the new all of the chordsV43 in the appropriate inversion on the staff below. The enharmonic pivot chord can be spelled correctly in only one of the two keys. Lead-sheet symbols: 104 ˙˙˙ ˙ enharmonically respelled # œœ ____ ____ œœ œ ____ ____ # & # ? ## ____ ____ œ _____ b˙ ____ ____ ____ œœ œ ____ œ # œœ ____ ____ ____ œ ____ œœ œ nœ #œ resolve ____: ____ ____ __ & # 44 œ œœœ # œœœ œœ Day Two ? # # the 44 œspecified chord, 4. Notate œ œ enharmonic respelling(s). b: ____ resolve ˙˙ ˙ ____ D: Ger+6 œ œ respell ____ œ œ __œ : ____ ____ ‹ # œœœ _____ ____ œ ˙˙ ˙ ˙ ____ ____ _________ ____ ____ resolve n œœ œ n œœœ œ n˙ ˙˙ n˙ resolve it, then notate and resolve the ____ ____ ____ ____ 39 CHAPTER 23. ENHARMONIC MODULATION b &bb 838 b &bb 840 E¯: viio7 respell b &bb 842 844 & 273 bbb _____ resolve __ : ____ resolve respell __ : ____ resolve respell __ : ____ _____ _____ _____ resolve 5. Analyze with lead-sheet symbols and Roman numerals and label the 846enharmonic pivot chords in the examples below. 105 ### 3 & & b 4 œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ ___ ___ ___ ? b 43 œ # œ # # #œ & ___ ___ b œœœ b œœœ b b œœœ f ˜: viio7 respell 848 bœ ## ## œœ #n œœ & # 44 & œ œ ____ ____ ? # # # 44 œ 852 & # # #œ œœœ ˙ ___ resolve ____ b n n œœœ ___ respell œ ____ ____ œ __ : ____ ____ ____ ___ b œœœ b b b ˙˙˙ ... œ b˙. _____ ___ _____ ____ n b œœœ __ : ____ resolve _____ A: ____ ____ Figure 23.4.2 b b ˙˙˙ œ bœ ____ ____ respell œœ œ ___ resolve ___ __ :___ _______ d: ___ ___ ___ 850 ___ bœ œ ____ ____ _____ ____ ___ ____ n ˙˙ ˙ n˙ ____ b b b b b 44 œœ the first œœ # œœ assignment n œœœ homework & download n œœœ for ˙˙ Click here to # n œœœthis chapter. œ œ n œ ˙ chapter. Click here to download the second homework assignment for this ____ ____ ____ resolve Click here to download the Unit 6 Practice Test. ? b b b 44 œ bb b¯: ____ b & b bbb ? bb b bb œ œ œ ____ ____ ____ nœ ____ œ ____ ____ n˙ ____ Chapter 24 Binary and Ternary Forms 24.1 Binary and Ternary Form In this chapter we will compare the following: Sectional versus Continuous Binary versus Ternary Rounded Binary versus Ternary 24.2 Sectional versus Continuous 39 39 We apply the descriptor “sectional” to a binary or ternary form when the first section (the A section) ends on the tonic. (Note: We use lowercase letters to refer to phrases and uppercase letters to refer to sections.) Introduction First Section Introduction First Section Zart bewegt Phrase 1 Zart bewegt Phrase 1 b 3 & bb bbb 43 ‰‰ & 4 369 369 b & bb bbb & ? b ? bb bb b 369 369 374 374 374 374 378 378 ∑ ∑ 3 j 43 œœœj 4 pœ 3 p‰ 43 ‰ 4 œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œ b œ & bb bbb œ & œ .. œ ? bb ? b bb œ b œ œ œ œ œ b & bb bbb & jœ œœ j œœœ œœ Ro - sen Ro - sen œœ œœ b & bb bbb œœ œœ œœ œœ & un - ter die un - ter die œ Jœ J be be œœ Jœœ J j ‰ œœ j ‰ œœ œ œ Œ Œ œjj œjj œ .. œjj œ Œ Œœ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œ j œœ j œœ Gu - ten Gu - ten ‰ ‰ œ œ 2 œ œ œPhrase œ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ dacht, mit Näg - lein be dacht, mit œœ œœ œ j Nägj - lein be œJœœ œ œœœ œœœj œœœj œœœ œ œJœœ J œ œ œ œ J œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ Phrase 2 - j j œœ jœ œœ j œœ œœ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ A - bend, gut A - bend, gut Second274 Section Second3Section Phrase Phrase 3˙ œŒ j j œ Œ œj œj ˙ œ œ Deck: mor - gen früh, Deck: mor - gen œ Œ œœ œ Œ œœ j j œœ jœ œœ j œœ œœ œ œœ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ Nacht, Nacht, mit mit œ ŒŒ œ œ œ œ œ steckt schlupf œœ Jœœ J steckt œœ Jœœ J schlupf œœ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œjj ˙ œjj j œ œ œ Jœ œ ˙ œ œ j œ œ œ J œ wenn Gott will, wirst due wie - der ge - früh, wenn Gott will, wirst due wie - der ge - œ J J œ ? b œ œ b b œ24. BINARY œ AND œ CHAPTER TERNARY FORMS œ œ œ 378 Second Section Phrase 3 b & b b œœ œ œ un - ter die 378 40 383 383 œ œj ˙ J œŒ j j ˙ œ œ Deck: mor - gen œ œ œ œ J 275 j œ œj œ œ œ früh, wenn Gott will, wirst due wie - der ge - œ œœ b œ œ œ. j & b b œœJ œœ œœ œJ œJ œ œœ b œœ œœ œ œ . œœJ œœ œœ œœ .. œœ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œ œœ J œ œ œ œ ? bb œ œ œ œ œ b œ œ œ œ œ œ I = “Sectional” bb & b b &bb ? bb b b &bb j œ œ œj ˙ J j j ˙ œ œ Phrase 4 ˙ - weckt, mor - gen früh, wenn Gott will, j œ œj œ œ œ œ œ ˙ wirst due ‰ .. wie - der ge - weckt. œ œ œ. j ˙ ˙˙ ‰ b œœ œœ œ œ . œœ œœ œœ œœ .. œœ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ ˙˙ ‰ .. J J œ œ œ œ œœ ‰ . œ œ œ œ . œ œ œ œ œ œ ∑ ∑ ∑YT: 6kh51bIA2q8 ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ Section∑ b First Phrase 1 ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ 388 Figure 24.2.1 Johannes Brahms, Fünf Lieder, Op. 49, No. 4 “Wiegenlied” (1868) b &bb 388 The term “continuous” is used the first section of a binary or ternary form does not end on the tonic chord. While this often means the first section ends in a new key, it can also mean the first section ends on the dominant chord in a half cadence. 112 ? bb & 42 œ œ œ. œ. 396 bb bp. . &2 ? 4 œ Œ Andante b &bb 396 ten. ten. œ. œ. œ œ. œ. œ œ . . œ. œ. œ ∑ ∑ Œ œ Œ œ Œ œ ∑ Phrase 3 ∑ & ? bœb j ‰ œ ∑œ œ œ œ œ œ b œ π ? œ Œ œ Œ œ Œ œœ Phrase 2 j‰ œœ œ. œ. œ œ œ # œ œ œ œ œ. œ. . . ∑ Œ œ Œ œj ‰ œ ‰ J œ ∑ ten. ten. œ∑ œ œ œ œ œ œ Œ œ œ Œ Second Section Phrase 5 (contrasting material) ≈ ≈ Phrase 4 ∑œ œ œ œ œ Œ ? 242 œœ ŒŒ ? 44 œ Œ ŒŒ œ ŒŒ œœ Œ œœ Œ œ œœ ŒŒŒ œ ŒŒ Œ œ œœ CHAPTER 24. BINARY AND TERNARY FORMS & & œœœ & ? ?œ ? œœ jj ‰‰ œœj ‰ œ Œ ŒŒ Phrase 3 Phrase 3 Phrase 3 œœ œœ œ œ π π π œ œœ & œœ œœ œ œœœ œœœ ## œœ œœ & & œ œ œœ #œ œ ? ? œœ ŒŒ œjjj ‰‰ œœ ‰‰ ? œ Œ œœ ‰ œJJJ ‰ & & & ? ? ? œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ .. ## œœ œœ .. # œ j œœjj ‰‰‰ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œœœ Œ œ Œ ŒŒ œœ ŒŒ ten. ten. ten. 276 Phrase 4 Phrase 4 Phrase 4 ten. ten. ten. œœœœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœœ œœœ œœ œ ŒŒ œœ ŒŒŒ œœ Œ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œœ ŒŒ œ Œ Second Section Second Section Phrase 5Section (contrasting material) Second Phrase 5 (contrasting material) jj‰ œœ Phrase material) ≈≈ œœj‰ œœ nn œœ ≈≈ œœ5 (contrasting œœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œ ‰ ≈ ≈ œ œ œ œ œœ n œœ œœ œœ œœ œ. œ. œ œœ œœ œ œ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ pp œ œ œ.. œ.. œ œ œ œ œ ƒ ƒ jj‰‰ ƒ pœ œ jj ‰‰ ŒŒ œœj‰ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œœj ‰ œœ Œ œ œ œ œœœ œ V Vtonic” = “Continuous” “notV “not tonic” = “Continuous” “not tonic” = “Continuous” Phrase 6 Phrase 6 Phrase 6 œœ œœ... œ œœ œ ŒŒ œj ‰‰ œœ ‰‰ œœ Œ œœj ‰ œJJ ‰ J œœ œœ... œ œœ œœ œœ... œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ.. . œ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œœœ.. . œ œœœ.. . ten. ten. ten. œœ œœ œœ œœrr œ œœ œœœr œœ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œœ ‰‰ œœ ‰ œ ‰‰ j ‰ œ œ œj œœ œœ œœ YT: lLjwkamp3lI Figure 24.2.2 Joseph Haydn, Symphony No. 94 in G major, Hob. I:94, II (1791) In naming any binary or ternary form, use the terms sectional or continuous before binary or ternary, for example “sectional binary,” “continuous binary,” “sectional ternary,” or “continuous ternary.” Other descriptors include “two-reprise,” which means both the first section (the A section) and second section (the A’ or B section) are repeated, and “rounded,” used in conjunction with binary (“rounded binary”) to specify that the opening material returns after the contrasting section. In the following sections we will discuss three types of binary forms: 1. Balanced Binary 2. Rounded Binary 3. “Simple” Binary (usually called “binary”) 24.3 Balanced Binary A balanced binary form, according to Douglass Green in his book, Form in Tonal Music, features a binary form with a first section (the A section) ending in a new key, and the second section ending with essentially the same cadence, now transposed to the original key, as in the following piece by Bach. CHAPTER 24. BINARY AND TERNARY FORMS First First Section Section First Section 3 b ‰‰ œ œœ œ œœœ œ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœ œœœ œœœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ 3 & 4 3 b œ œ œ œ œ œœ & b 44 ‰ œœ œ œœ œœ & ? 33 œœ œœœ œœ œœœ œœ ∑ ‰ ? b 4 ∑ ‰ ? bb 434 œ œ ∑ ‰ œ œœ œ œœ œ 277 113 113 113 œ œœ œœœ œœ œœ œœœ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œ œ œ œœ œœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œ œœœ œ These bars major These 9 bars modulating modulating from from F major to to C C major major are are transposed transposed in in the the last last 999 bars. bars. These 99 bars modulating from FF major to C major are transposed in the last bars. œœœ œœœ œœœ bb œœœ œœ œœ œœ œœœ œœ œœ œœ œœœ œœ œœ œœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ nnœœ œ œœœ œœ œœœ œœœ & & b n œ œœ œ & ? b œœœ œœœ œœœ ? & ? & bb œœœ œœ œœ œœ œœœ œœ œœ œœ œœœ œœ œœ œœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœ œœœ œœ œœœ œœ œœœ œœ œœœ œœ œœœ œœ œœœ ? & œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ nœ œ œ b & & bb œœœ œœ œœ nnœœ œœ œœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ & œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œ n œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ n œ œœ œ œœ ? nœ œ œ ? bb ? b œ bb ‰‰ œœ œœœ œœœ œœ œœœ & œ &b ‰ & œ nœ œ œ ? ? b œœ nnœœ œœ œœœ œœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœ ? œ bb œ bb œœ œœœ bbbœœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ & œœœœœ & &b œ œ ? ? b œ œœœ œœ œœœ œœ œœœ ? bb œœ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ bb œœ œœœ œœ œ œœ œ œœœ œ œœœ œ œœ œ & œ œ & &b œ ? ? bb œœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œ œœœ ? œœ b 114 œ œ œœ œœœ œœ œœ œ œœ nnnœœœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œœ œ œ n œ œ œ œ œœ œœ nn œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ œœœ œ œœœ œ nnnœœœ œ œœ œœ œœ œœœ œœ œœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœ œ œœ œ Second Second Section Section Second Section œœ œ ŒŒ Œ ŒŒ Œ ‰‰ œœ œœœ œœ œœœ œœ ‰ œ œ œ Cadence in C major Cadence Cadence in in C C major major œœ nnœœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ n œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ b œ œ œœœ œ œœœ œ œœœ œ œœœ œ œœœ œ œ œ œœ bb œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ bœ œ œ œœ œ œœœ œœ bbœœ ##œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œœ œ #œ œ œ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œœœ œœ œœ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ bbœœ œ œ bœ œ nn œœ œ œœ œ œœœ œœœ n œ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ # œ œœ œ œœ œ ## œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œ œœœ œ œ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ nnœœ b œ œ œ œ œ n œ bb œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœœ œœ œœœ œœœ œ œœ œ œœ œœ œ bbœœ œ œ œ œ œ nœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ b œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ nnœœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œ œ œ œœœ œ œœœ œ œœœ œ œœœ œ œœœ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœœ œ œ œœ œœ œœœ œ œœ œ œœ œœœ n œ œœœ # œ œœœ œ œœœ œ œœœ œ œ œ œœœ œœœ n œ œœœ # œ œœœ œœœ œœ œ b œ œ œ œ œœ œ nnœœ ## œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ nnœœ ## œœ œœ œ œœ bœœ œœ œ œœ b œ œ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œœ n œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ nnœœ œœœ œœ œœœ ## œœ œœœ œ œœ #œ nœ œœ œ œœœ œ nn œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ These 9 bars are modulating from B¯ major to F major. œ œ œ b œ œ œ bœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ &b œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ bœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ? b œœœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ & b œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ bœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ? b œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ œ œ œ œœœœœœœœœ œ œœ Œ Œ œ œ Cadence in F major &b Œ Œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ b œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ œœœ œœ œœ ? b œœœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ CHAPTER 24. BINARY AND TERNARY FORMS 278 & b œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ bœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ? b œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ œ œ œ œœœœœœœœœ œ œœ Œ Œ œ œ Œ Œ Cadence in F major &b ?b These 9 bars are modulating from B¯ major to F major. œ œ œ b œ œ œbœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ &b œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ YouTube: https://www.youtube.com/watch?v=HFeLqgVLxBM œ œ œ œ œ œ b œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœœœ œ œœ œœ œœ œ œ ? œœ œ œ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ Invention No. 8 in F major, BWV 779 Figure 24.3.1 b J.S. œ œBach, 114 Because the first section These of a9 bars balanced binary ends in a new key, it is are modulating from B¯ major to F major. a continuous binary form. œ & bb œœ œœœ œœ œ œ œ œbœœœ bœ œ œœbœ œœœœœœœœœ œœœœœ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ Œ Œœ œ œ œ œ œ œinœ œ movements œ œ Baroque era, œ œ œ from œ œ œœ the Balanced & binary form can be œfound œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ b œ œ œ œby œ œ œ œ œ œHandel, œœ œ œ œ œand œœ œ œothers. œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œThe œ œ œ œ œ œmovement ? œ œ œ œ including dance suites Bach, below œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ Œ œ œ Œœ œ œ œ ? bb œœœ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ shows the endingsœ ofœ œthe first and section sections of theœ Courante from J.S. Bach’s French Suite No. 6 in E major, BWV 817.Cadence in F major 114 inherently œ Œ Œ & b # œ# œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ bœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœœ œ œ œ œ œ œ jœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœœ j . # 3 œ œ # œ j œ œ œ œ ‰ ≈ œ # œ & 4 œ œ œ œ œ œœ. . ? b œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œœœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ J œ JŒ Œ œ .. œ in F major œ . Cadence ? # # # # 43 œ œ œ œ œ ≈œœœ J .. œ j j ## & # # 43 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ # œ œ ‰ ≈ œ œ œœœ.j.. .. œ # # # # œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ‰ ≈ J œ œœJjj.. . œ œ & # œ J œ œ œJ œJœ.. . ? # # # 43 œ œ œ YT:œ jrHP6Fp1yUY œ ≈œœœ J .. œ 6 in E, BWV, . Courante, bars œ œ Figure 24.3.2 J.S. Bach, French Suite No 817 œ œ œ œ œ ? #### œ œ J œ .. ≈ 15–16 œ j # ## œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ‰ ≈ œ j. & # œ œ J œ œJ œ œJœ. . .. œ. œ œ œ œ œ œ ? #### œ œ J .. œ ≈ œ YT: jrHP6Fp1yUY Figure 24.3.3 J.S. Bach, French Suite No 6 in E, BWV, 817 Courante, bars 31–32 24.4 Rounded Binary In a rounded binary form, the material at the beginning of the first section returns, often shortened, after a contrasting phrase at the beginning of the & # œ œJ œ œJœ. . CHAPTER 24. BINARY AND TERNARY FORMS œ œ279. œ œ œ œ ? #### œ œ J ≈ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ J second section. A generic phrase diagram of rounded binary form is shown below. First Section a b a (opening melody returns) Below is an example of a rounded binary form. First Section First Section PhraseSection 1 First Phrase 1 CC œ œœ C œœ œ pp CC pÓÓ & C Ó & & ## # & ## & & # ## # & # ## & & œœ œ Phrase 1˙ ˙ œœ˙ œ˙˙ ˙˙ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œœœœœ œœœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœœ œœ œœœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œ œ œœ œ œœ œ Phrase 2 2 œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœœ œœ ## œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ . œœ Phrase Phrase˙2 œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ # œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœœ .. œ œœ.. œœ.. ˙˙ œœ œœ œ . ffœ. œ. œ f ? œ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ # œ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ # œ ˙ Ó ? œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ # œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ œœ ## œœ ˙˙ .. œœ ÓÓ ? œ œ œœ œ œœ # œ œ œ œ œ ˙˙ .. œ Second Section Second Section (contrasting material and texture) Phrase 3Section Second Phrase 3 (contrasting material and texture) Phrase 3 œ œ œ #texture) Phrase œ # œ œ œ 3 (contrasting œ œœ # œ n œ œmaterial œ œ œ œœ n œ œ œ œ œ and j œ œ œœ ## œœ œœ nn œœ œœ œ œœœ œœœ œœ œœ ˙˙˙ . œœjj ‰‰‰ Œ œ œ œ œ ## œ ˙ . œ ŒŒ #œ ˙. ff pp ‰‰ f p œœ œ œ œ œ œ ˙ œ jj ‰ ŒŒ œ œ ˙ œ œ œ ˙ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ˙œ œ œ œœ ˙ . œj Œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ˙˙ . œ . Phrase 4 (opening melody returns) 4 (opening melody returns) œœ œœœ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ Phrase ˙4 (openingœ melody returns) ## # Ó Phrase œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ .. œ œ ˙ # & # Ó œ œ & œœ œœ œ ... œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ & # Ó fœ œ ˙ œ œ f œ ˙ œ f ## # ? œœœ œœ œœ ˙˙ ∑ œ œ & œ œ # ## œ œ ˙˙ .... œœ œ œ œœ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ ? ∑∑ œ œ ? œ & œœ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œœ œ œœœ . & œ œ œ œ ## # & # ## & & ? ## # ? ? # ## .. œœ ## œœ œœ œœ .. pp .. pÓÓ .. Ó .. Second Section a ## # & ## & & # ? # ? ? ## ### .. œœ œœ # œ œœn œ œœ œ œ # œ œn œ œ œœ ## œœ œœ œœ nn œœ # œœ œœ œœ nn œœ & œ nœ & & 115 115 115 j j.. œ œ œ œ œ 280 œ J J. œ œ. œ J ≈ œ œ #### œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ‰ œ & œ24. BINARY AND TERNARY FORMS J CHAPTER ? #### œ œ œ œ œYT: zHtXRBi91dA œ ≈ Figure 24.4.1 Mozart, Piano Sonata in D major, K. 284, III. /: First Section :/: A: PAC a D: Second Section a' HC b a'' D: HC PAC :/ Because both the first section (the A section) and second section (the B section) repeat in the example above, this form would be called “two-reprise continuous rounded binary form.” Another example of a rounded a a binary formbis below. a 116 116 First First Section Section . 343 œœ . œœ œœ œœ œ œ 4 pp ? b 433 ŒŒ ? b 4 œœ œœ & & bb Phrase Phrase 1 1 œœœ œœ (opening melody returns) Phrase Phrase 22 œœ˙˙ œœ œœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ ... # nn œœ œœœ ... œœ ˙˙˙ #œ œ ˙˙ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ n œ œœ œœ œ n œœ & b œœ˙˙ œ ? ? bb ˙˙ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œœ œœ œœ .. ## œœ œ .. œœ ˙ b & œœ Œ œœ Œ Second Second Section Section œœ .. œ œœ œœ œœ ... ... Phrase Phrase 33 ˙˙ ˙˙ œœ œœ .. œœ œœ œœ . & & .. œœœ œœœ œœœ œ œœ œœ œ .. œ œœ œ œœ œœ (melodically (melodically related related to to first first phrase) phrase) ... œ .. œ œœ œœ œ œ œœ œœ œœ ˙˙ œ œ œ ˙ (different accompanimental texture and register) (different accompanimental accompanimental texture texture and and register) register) (different Phrase (opening melody melody returns) returns) Phrase 44 (opening ? ? & & bb œœ œœœ .. ## œœ œœ .. œœ œœœ œœ Œ &b œœ œœ œœ œœ .. œœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœ˙˙ œœ œœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ ... œœ œœ œ œ œ œœ ˙˙ ˙˙ œœ œ œ œœœ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ ... ... YT: 2vs-CrxwOmE Figure 24.4.2 Schubert, 20 Minuets, D. 41, No. 18 in F major ?b • “Two-reprise” means both the first and second sections repeat This form of the example above would be called “two-reprise continuous rounded binary form” because: • “Continuous” means the first section does not end on the tonic chord • In a rounded binary form the opening melody returns after contrasting material .. .. CHAPTER 24. BINARY AND TERNARY FORMS 281 Rounded binary form is often encountered in compositions during the Classical era (1750–1825) in music by Haydn, Mozart, and Beethoven, especially as the form of a theme from a theme and variations, and as the minuet and/or trio section in a Minuet and Trio. 24.5 Simple Binary “Simple” binary is a term used to describe a binary form that does not have features like the similar endings of a balanced binary or the return of opening material like the rounded binary. You will encounter this type of binary form in music especially throughout the Baroque era, as well as in the early Classical 117 117 era. 117 First Section Section First First Section œ œ œ œ œ ˙ œ œœ œ bb bb CC œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ ## œœ œœ ˙ œ & & œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœœ œ b ? œ ? bbb CC œ œœ œ (starts in G G minor) (starts (starts in in G minor) minor) b œœ œœ œ œœ ## œœ œ bb b œ œ & & œ œœ œœ ? œ œ b œ ? bb b & bb bb & ? b ? bb b œœ .. nn œœ JJ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ 1. 1. 1.jj j œœœj œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ ... ˙˙ œœ œœ œœ œœ ... (ends in B B¯ major) (ends (ends in in B¯¯ major) major) 2. 2. 2.jj j œœœj ˙˙ œœœ œœ œ œ œ (develops melody and and motives from from first section) section) Second Second Section Section (develops (develops melody melody and motives motives from first first section) œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ nn œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ nn œœ œœ ... œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œ ˙˙ œ œ œ . œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ nœœ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ .. œ œ œ n œ œ . (begins in B B¯ major) (begins (begins in in B¯¯ major) major) b œ nœ œ œ œ œ œ œ nœ œ bb b œ n œ ##œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ n œ œœ œ & & œœ ? ? bb bb nn œœ œ nn œœ ## œœ œœ œ œœ bbb ˙ & &b ˙ ? ? bb bb œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ # œ œ œ œ œ # œ œœ œœ mwmw œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ nnœœ œœ # œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ #œ œœ nnœœ œœ œ nnœœ # œ ˙ œœ œ œœ œ œœ # œ œœ ˙ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œ bb œœ œ œ œ bœ œ œœ œ b œ œ œœ nnœœ œ œœ œ œœ œœ œ MM m M mww Mœœ ˙˙ œœ bbœœ œœ Mœœ Mœœ œœ b bb œ œ œ œ œ œ & & b œ œ œœ œ œ œ œœ œ œœ nnœœ ## œœ œœ œ œ œœ ? b œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ ##œœ œœ œ ? bb b œ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ M M Mœœ ˙˙ Mœœ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ # œ œ œœ œœ #œ œœ ˙˙ œœ œœ œœ œœ (back in G G minor) (back (back in in G minor) minor) œœ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ ## œœ œœ œ nn œœ nn œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ ## œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œœ (opening melody does does not return return—not not rounded binary) binary) (opening (opening melody melody does not not return— —not rounded rounded binary) ŒŒ n œ nœ ŒŒ ? bb œ MM œ bœ œ œ œ mw Mœ Mœ ˙ Mœ œ ˙ ˙ CHAPTER 24. BINARY AND TERNARY FORMS b & b œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ nœ #œ œ œ œ œ ? b œ œ œ œ œ #œ œ b 118 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ? bb # œ &b œ œ nœ #œ œ œ œ œ œ b &b b Œ #œ œ œ œ 282 (back in G minor) œ œ œ œ œ œ œ #œ œ œ nœ nœ œ œ œœœ œ œ œ Œ (opening melody does not return—not rounded binary) b &b œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ? b b œ œœœœœœœ œœœœ nœ Œ œ nœ œ nœ bœ œ œ œ Œ œ Œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ # œ œ #œ œ œ œ œ #œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ m œ œ œ œ œ œ Œ nœ œ œ œ ˙ ˙ .. .. (different ending than first section—not balanced binary) ? bb YouTube: https://www.youtube.com/watch?v=KMrJxhYj3tc b Figure 24.5.1 J.S. Bach, English Suite No 3 in G minor, BWV 808, Gavotte I. Notice in the example above that the first section and second section can begin similarly in a binary form, resulting in the large-scale form AA’. The second section often features development of the primary idea from the first section. We will discuss development in the next chapter. &b ? bb 24.6 Binary Principle Binary principle, as defined by Peter Spencer and Peter Temko in their book A Practical Approach to the Study of Form in Music, states that the first section of a binary form modulates to a new key and the second section modulates back to the first key. We find this principal exemplified in a high percentage of binary forms in the Baroque era, and diagrammed in the example below. &b b ? bb /: :/: A: PAC a a' D: HC b a'' D: HC CHAPTER 24. a BINARY AND a TERNARY bFORMS First Section PAC :/ 283 a (opening melody returns) Second Section Major: I modulation V V modulation I Minor: i modulation III (or v) III or (v) modulation i Original key New key Original key Figure 24.6.1 Diagram illustrating Binary Principle 24.7 Ternary Form b & bbb & bbb & ? bbb bbb ? & bb b b ? bb bb ? b bbb & bbb & bbb & bbb ? bbb ? & bb b bb ? b bb ? b bbb & bbb & bbb & ? b bb b b ? & bb b bb ? bb bb ? bb bb & bbb & bbb & ? bb bb b & b b bb ? ? bb b b bb ? & bb b b b ? bb b œ 24 œ . œ œ œ œ . œ œ œ œ . b œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ 24 œ . œ œ œ œ . œ œ œ œ . b œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ . b œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ F œœ œ œ œ œ nœ œœ 422 Fœœœ . œœ œ œœ . œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ 42 œ . œ œœ œ œ . œœ œ œœ . b œ œ œ nœ œ œ œ œ œ œ 442 Fœ œ œ œ œœ œœ œ œ nœ œ œ 2 œœ œœ 4F œ œ œœ œœ œ œ nœ œ œ 2 œœ œœ 4 œœ œ œ œ œ œ. bœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ. œ. œ . œ œ œ œ . œœ œœ œ œ . b œ œ œ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œ p . œ œœ œ œ . œ œ œ . b œ œœ œœœœœ œ œ œ œ œ œ p œ œœ œ œ œ œœ œ œœ . b œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œœ œœ œ. œ œ œœ pœœ . œœ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ p œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œœœœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ fœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœœ œ œ œ œœ œ œ fœ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ fœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ f œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œœœ U œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ Uœ œ pœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ U U œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ pœ œ œ œ œ œ œ U œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œU œ œ œ œ p œ œ œ U œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ p œ œ œ. œ œœ œ œ. œœœ œœ œ œ . œb œ œ œœ œœ œ œœ œ œ œ œUœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ f œœ œœ œ nœ œ œœ œœ œ 119 Ternary form is usually diagrammed as ABA and is described as “statement, 119 digression, restatement.”Green, Douglass M. Form in Tonal Music: an Intro- 119 duction to Analysis. 2d ed., Holt, Rinehart and Winston, 1979, p. 84 A piece 119 in a rather simple and straightforward ternary is shown below. 120 b œ œ œ œ. œ œ œ & b b œ. p œ œ œ œ . b œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ Uœ œ œ œ œ poco rit. U 120 ? b œœ bb œœ œœ p ? b b œœ b œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ nœ bb œ . œ œ œ œ . œ œ œ œ . b œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ b & 24. BINARY AND TERNARY FORMS CHAPTER 284 œ œ f ?b b bœ . œœœ œ œœœ œ . œœœ œ œœœ œ . œb œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œnUœœ œ & bb b œ œ œœ œ œ œ U poco rit. œ œ . b œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ Uœ b œ œ œ œ. œ œ œ & b b œ. œ œ p œœ œœ œœYT: BJviMnAB_jg œ œ œ b ? & b œ Figure 24.7.1 b b Mozart, Andante in E-flat major, K. 15mm bb œ poco rit. Below is a diagram of K. 15mm by Mozart. ? bb b E¯: A B a a' HC b PAC œ A b HC U a HC a' HC PAC bbb &Character pieces from the Romantic era with titles such as “Nocturne,” Figure 24.7.2 Diagram illustrating Binary Principle “Intermezzo,” and “Song Without Words,” among others, by composers such as Schubert, Chopin, Mendelssohn, Schumann, and Brahms, are often in a larger ternary form where each section might be longer than eight bars. Below are examples from a larger ternary piece, Rachmaninov’s Prelude in C-sharp minor, Op.3 No.2. 121 ? bb b # # # # Lento c & œ > ƒ ? #### c œ œ > & #### ? #### œ > œ œ > w > w w > ‰ j‰ œœ œœ # œœ n n œœ # œj œ- œ- œ- n œ n œ- œ # œœ˙ ∏ . . -œ œ- ‹ œ- # œ- # œ‰ œ œœ # œ ‰ # œ ‰ œ ‹ œ n œ # œJ # œœ œ J ˙ n œ. œ. ˙ ‰ ‰ œœ œ˙ ‰ œœ œ ˙ ˙ œœ œ ‰ n œj ‰ # œj œ- # œœ- n n œœ- # œœ nœ œ . . œ- ‹ œ- ‰ # œ- ‰ # œœœ # ‹ œœ # # œœ œ n œ J œ # œJ n œ. œ. YT: sCtixpIWBto Figure 24.7.3 Sergei Rachmaninoff, Prelude in C-sharp minor, Op. 3 No. 2, First A section bars 1–13 & #### ? #### & #### ‰ œ œœ # œ ‰ # œ ‰ ‰ œ œœ # œ ‰ # œ ? #### c ‹ œ # œ # œœ œ œ ‹ œ n œ # œJ œ œ n œ J œ J œ œ w ˙ - - - n œ. - œ. - ˙ - - - n œ. CHAPTER 24.> BINARY > w AND˙ TERNARY FORMS ˙ > #### - - & œ œ œ œnœ #œ œ œ ‹œ #œ œœ 3 F 3 3 -3 ? #### Œ - #œ nœ œ w w Agitato & #### ‰ œ œ # œJ œ. -285 - - œ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œnœ # œ œ œ ‹œ #œ œ œ œ œ œ œ -3 -3 œ #œ nœ w 3 -3 œ 3 3 cresc. 3 3 œ œ œ œ YT: sCtixpIWBto Figure 24.7.4 Rachmaninov, Prelude in C-sharp minor, Op.3 No.2, B section bars 14–42 ? #### >œ >œœ # >œœ # n >œœ œœœ œœ ‹ œœ # n œœ ‰ ‰ J & # # # # Ï pesante & #### nœ & ˙˙ nœ ˙˙ > ? #### > >œœ >œœ ‹ >œœ n # >œœ ? # # # # ‰ œœ œœ # ‹ œœ ‰ # # œœ J Ï pesante ? #### nœ ˙˙ nœ ˙˙ > > 55 ## & ## ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ Tempo primo 53 #### >œ >œœ # >œœ # n >œœ # >œœ œ œ ‰ # # œœ ‰ œœ œ ‹ œœ ‰ # n œœJ J sÎ nœ œ ˙ nœ œ ˙˙˙ > > > >œœ >œœ ‹ >œœ n # >œœ # >œœ œ # œ ‰ # œœ ‰ œœ œ # ‹ œœ ‰ # œJ J sÎ nœ œ ˙ nœ œ ˙˙ > ˙ > > ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ YT: sCtixpIWBto # >œœ ‰ # # œœ J œ œ > # >œœ ‰ # œœ J œ œ > ∑ ∑ #### ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ & Figure 24.7.5 Rachmaninov, Prelude in C-sharp minor, Op.3 No.2, Second A section bars 45–61 ? #### ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ 24.7.1 Compound Ternary A compound ternary is a ternary form in which one of the sections (the A or the B) is itself a binary or ternary form. Examples can be found in the minuet and trio as well as the da capo aria. ? #### ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ In the next section, we will examine the differences between rounded binary and ternary. CHAPTER 24. BINARY AND TERNARY FORMS 286 24.8 Distinguishing between Rounded Binary and Ternary In homework and on the test, you will encounter pieces that are five or six phrases long that could be rounded binary or ternary. While other authors have their own means to differentiate rounded binary from ternary, this text offers the following criteria to consider: 1. Proportion: consider the proportion of the contrasting section to the other sections. If the contrasting section is too small to stand alone, the form is more likely to be rounded binary. 2. Nature: consider the nature of the contrasting section. (a) If the melody is built from motives from the first section, the form is likely to be a rounded binary. Ternary form will have a contrasting melody in the contrasting section. (b) If the harmony consists mostly of a dominant pedal, or a V chord alternating with a I or I 64 chord, the form is likely to be a rounded binary. 3. Era: consider the era when the piece was written. A piece by a Baroque composer (J.S. Bach, Handel, Scarlatti, Couperin) or Classical composer (Haydn, Mozart, and Beethoven) is more likely to be in rounded binary form, whereas a piece by a Romantic era composer (Schubert, Schumann, Chopin, Mendelssohn, and Brahms, among others) is more likely to be in ternary form. Note that these are generalities. Baroque and Classical composers wrote compositions in ternary form and Romantic composers wrote pieces in rounded binary form. Consider the following piece by Beethoven: 122 122 Vivace moderato. & 433 ‰ œ œ &4 ‰ œ œ œ pœ . œœ ?3 . ? 43 œ. œœ 4 œ. Moderato œ œ œ œ œœ. œœ. œ. œ. œ. œ . # œ ‰ œœ œ # œ œ ‰ ‰ ‰ F F . . œ. # œœœ. œœœ. œ. œ. # œ œ œ. &‰ œ œ œ &‰ œ œ œ œœ. ? . ? œ. œœ œ. & & ? ? .. .. .. .. œ œ œœ. œœ. œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ. œœ. . . œ. œœ œœ œ. œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œœ. œœ. œœ. œœ. œ œ œ.. œ œ œ œ œ œœ. œœ. œœ. œœ. ˙ ˙ bœ ˙Œ ˙ b œ Œ œ. œ. .œ b œœ. œœ. bœ œ œ. . œ˙ b œ. # œ.. œ˙˙ b œ n # œœœ ˙ n œœ b œœ.. n œœ.. œ b œœ n œœ œ œ. œ . # œ ‰ œœ œ # œ œ ‰ . . œ. # œœœ. œœœ. œ. # œ œ ˙ n ˙˙ .. n ˙˙ .. p œ. œ. . œ. œœ œœ œ. œ. œ . n œœ. n œœ Œ Œ Œ Œ . # œ. #œ œœ. œœ. Œ Œ Œ Œ U. œ œ Uœ. ‰ œœ œ œ œ ‰poco rit. œœ #U œ œœ #Uœœœ poco rit. œ. œ. .. .. .. .. œ œœ.. n œœ.. œ.. œœ.. œ.. œœ.. b œ œ ? œ BINARY œ œTERNARY œ œFORMS œ bœ nœ ? CHAPTER œœ. 24. œœAND . .. . . œ.. œ œ . . œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ## œœ œ œ œœ œ œ ## œœ . ‰ ‰ ‰ œ œ œ . & .‰ ‰ ‰ & F F . œœ.. œ.. œœ.. . # œœ.. œœ.. œ . # œ œ . . ? .. œ. # œ œ œ. œ œ œ. # œ œ ? œ œ .œ & ‰‰ œ œœ œ & œ tempo pp aœa tempo œœ.. ? ?œ œ œ.. œœ œœ.. œ œ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ.. œ œœ.. œ œ œ œ œ ‰ œ œ & œ œ œœ. œœ. œœ. ? œ. œ. & œœ œœ.. œ œ œœ. ˙˙ ˙ ŒŒ ˙ œœ.. b . bœ œœ. bb œœ œœ.. œ . œ˙ b œ # œ. ˙ n œœ œ . . b œœ n œœ . œœœ. ŒŒ ŒŒ 287 .. . œ U œœ œ Uœœ.. œ œ ‰‰ œ poco rit. poco rit. U U œ œœœ . œœ. ## œœ . ## œœ. ˙ nn ˙˙˙ .. . œœ.. œœ.. n . œœ. n œ œ . œ œœ p œ. œ 123 Œ Œ .. Œ Œ .. YT: hpQBbomOMj0 Figure 24.8.1 Beethoven, Eleven Bagatelles, Op. 119, No. 9 ? In terms of proportion, bars 9–12 contain contrasting material to bars 1–8. Because the contrasting material lasts for half as long as the open section, we consider the proportion as pointing toward rounded binary. In terms of the nature of the contrasting section, the melody is built from the contour of the first four notes of the first measure, and the harmony alternates between V and I 64 . Both the harmony and melody point us in the direction of rounded binary. Finally, consider the era in which Beethoven lived. Is he considered a Classical or Romantic composer? This is a difficult question to answer, as Beethoven is a unique figure who is a bridge between the Classical and Romantic eras. However, it’s generally safe to consider Beethoven as belonging to the Classical era, and therefore as likely to write a rounded binary form. You will encounter examples on homework and the test where these three criteria are not unanimous and you will have to weigh the evidence to come to a conclusion. & ? & ? CHAPTER 24. BINARY AND TERNARY FORMS 288 24.8.1 Written-Out Repeats Occasionally you will encounter an example where the repeats are written out. When you encounter such a piece, put the repeats in your diagram even though there are not in the score. 24.9 Practice Exercises 134 134 134 134 134 Day One 1. For Handel’s Gavotte, HWV 491, please fill in the blanks below the staves and diagram the form. Also, name the form. You will need to determine which notes are non-chord tones in order to determine Allegretto RomanAllegretto numerals. œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ ## Allegretto 44 œ œ œ œœ œœ œœ ˙˙˙ .. Allegretto œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ˙. œ & &# & ? ? ## ?# ## & &# & ? ? ## ?# ## & &# & ? ? ## ?# ## & &# & ? ? ## ?# ## & &# & & ? ? ## ?# 44 œœ œ 44 Fœ œ F 44 FŒ 44 ŒŒ 4 œœ œ œœ œ œ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œ œœ œœ œ œ .. œœ œœ .. œ œ .f f .. fœœ .. .œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œ ˙˙... œœ œ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœœ œ œœ ˙˙ .. ˙˙ . œ ˙ .. œœ œœ # œ œ œœ œ ## œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œœ ˙˙ .. œ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ ˙ . œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œœœ œœœ œœ œœ œœ œ ˙˙ .. ˙. œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œ œ œœ œcresc. œœ œ cresc. cresc. cresc. œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œœœ œœ œœœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ F F F œœ œ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ ˙ . œ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ ˙˙˙ ... ˙˙ .. œ œœ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œœ œ ___ ___ œœ œ ## œœ #œ œœ œ œœ œ œ œ œœ P œœ P Pœœ œ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ œœ ˙˙˙ ... ˙. œœ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ ___ ___ œœ # œ œœ œœ œœ #œ œ # œ œ œ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œœ œ ___ ___ ___ œœ œ œ œœ œœ œœ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœœœ œœ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ ___ ___ ___ ___ YT: IHEwWbK2fBw .. .. . œœ œ ... œ œ .. œ œœ œ ˙˙ .. œ ˙˙ .. œœ œ ˙˙ .. pp œœ œœ pœ œ œœ œ œœ œ ___ œ ___ ___ ___ ___ œœ œ ˙˙ .. ppœ œœœ ˙˙ . œœ œœ pœ œœ œœ œœ œœ ___ œ ___ œ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ œœœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œœ œœ œ œ ___ œ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ œœ œ œœ Œ œœ ŒŒ œ ___ ___ .. ˙˙ .. .. ˙˙.. . ˙˙ . œœ˙ . œ .. œ œœ œœ ... œœ . ___ ___ ___ ___ & œ ____ œ p . œ. .œ ____ .œ .œ œ. œ b œ n œ œ. 289 œ TERNARY œ œ œ CHAPTER 24. BINARY FORMS ? AND œ œ. œ. œ Œ Œ LSS: ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ Motives: œ œ b œ Handel, œFrideric Figure œ24.9.1 HWV 491 œ œGeorge œ œ œ œGavotte, b œ œ œœœœ ˙ Menuetto diagram: b œ & ForJ the piece complete the following J above, J Jdiagram based on ˙your A analysis. Include section labels using uppercase letters, phrase labels NCTs: œ œthe œ abbreviations œ œ œ œ œ PAC, œ œ œcadences a œ œ œ and using lowercase b œ :/œ: œ using ? œ œ /: b œ œ œ œ œletters, œ b diagram: œ DC, PC. œ œ ˙ :/ IAC, HC, Trio RN in B¯: ____ HF: ____ RN: HF: /: ____ ____ A ____ ____ ____ ____ a ____ ____ :/: ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ :/ Circle all of the terms that apply to the name of the form: TWO-REPRISE SECTIONAL 2. CONTINUOUS ROUNDED BALANCED BINARY TERNARY For the theme from first movement of Mozart’s Piano Sonata in A major, K. 331, please fill in the blanks below the staves and diagram ## # ## 6 œAlso, jj the form. œ the œ œ œ œ œ œ jj œ . œ œ œ œ . œ œ œname . œ form. & #### ## & & & # ? ## # ## ? # ? ? ##### # ## # ## & #### ## & & & # ? ## # ## ? # ? ? ##### # 6868 œ . 868p œœ .. pp œ 668p œœ .. 8686 œœ .. 8 œœ .. œœ .. œœ œœ .. œœ .. ## # ## œœ & #### ## œ & œ & & # SS ? ## # ## SSœœœ ? # œ ? ? ##### # œ ## # ## & #### ## & & & # ? ## # ## ? # ? ? ##### # œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ jj œœ œœœjj œœœ œœ œ œœœ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œj j œ œ œœ œœjj œœœ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ.. œœœ œœ.. œ SS Sœ ‰‰ Sœœœ ‰‰ œ j œœjj œœ œœjj œœ œœjj œœ œœj œ JJœ œœ JœJ œJœ JJœ Jj œœjj œJœj JJœœ J œœ JœJ JœJj œœjj JœJœj JœJ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ... œœ. ‰‰ ‰‰ j œœjj œœj SSœœ SSœ œJœ JJœ J œœ . œœ .. œœ œœ .. œœ .. œœ œœ œœ œ œœj œ j œœ œœœœjj œœœ œœ œ œœ œ j œœjj œœ œœj œœ j œœjj œœ œœj œ œJJœ œœ JJ œœ œœ SS SSœœœ œœ œœ œœ œ ppœœ ppœ œœ œ œœ œœ œJœ JJœ Jj œœjj œJœj JJœ J jj œœœjj œœœ œœ œ SSœœ ppœœ SS pp œœ œœ JœJ œœ JœJ œœ œœ. . ## œœ.. ## œœJ œJœ JJ œœ œœ œ œœ .. œœ ... œœ .. ___ j œœjjœ œœ œœœj œœ œœœœ œœ œ ‰‰ ‰‰ j ‰ œœjj œœœ ‰‰‰ œœj ___ ___ œ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ jj œœœjj JJœ JœJ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ j œœœjj œœœ œœj œœ .. œœ œœ .. j œœjj œœœ ... œœj œ . œœj œœ œœj œœ j œœjj œœ œœj œœ JJœ œœ JœJ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ j œœjj œœj œ œœ .. œ. ppœ . ppœœ œœ .. œ .. œœ œœ œ ffœœœ ffœœ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œœ œ œœ JœJ œœ œœ JœJ œ .. œœ .. œœœ œœ .. œœ .. œ œœ . œ œœ .. œœœ œœ œœ .. œ œ . œœ œœ œœ JœJ JœJj œœjj œœJj œJœ JJ .. .. . .. .. . œœ œœ œœ œ œj j œ œœ œœjj œœ œ œ j œœjj œœj JJœ JœœJ œœ JœJœ JœJ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ JœJ JœJ œœ œœ œœœ œœ ## # ## & #### ## & & YT: vp_h649sZ9A & # # ? # # ? ### ? ? ##### # 24.9.2 Mozart, Piano Sonata K. 331, I Figure œœ œœ œœ œœ JœJ JœJ œœj œ . œ œ œœ œœj œœ . œœ œœ œ œœ . j œœ œ œœjj œœ œœ .. œœ œœj œœœ œœ .. œœ .. œ .. œ œ œ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ œœ œœœ œœ œ œœ JJœ JœJj j œœœjj JJœ JœJ œœ JœJ JœJ œœ œœ œœ .. œœ .. œœ œœ .. œ. œ. œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ .. œœ .. œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œœ œœœ œœ œœ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œ œj j œ œœ œœœjj œœ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œJœ JJœ Jj œœjj œJœj JJœœ J œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œ JœJœ œœ œœœ œJœœJ œœ œœ œœ JJœ œ JœJ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ œœ.. œœ.. œœ œœ œœ JœJ JœJj œœjj œJœj JJœ J ‰‰ ‰‰ ‰‰ ‰‰ .. .. . .. .. . For the piece above, complete the following diagram based on your analysis. Include section labels using uppercase letters, phrase labels using lowercase letters, and cadences using the abbreviations PAC, IAC, HC, DC, PC. 137 137 137 137 .. œ &b J œœ. œœ. œœ. œJœœ.œ œJ œ œb œœ.œ n œœ. ˙ œ. ˙ œ œ. œ œ. œ œ Œ Œ NCTs: œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ? b24. œ œ œ œ œ AND œTERNARY œ œ b œ FORMS œ b œ BINARY CHAPTER œ œ œ œ ˙290 RN: HF: /: œ ?J ____A ____ ____ ____ a ____ ____ ____ ____ :/: ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ .. :/ Circle all of the terms that apply to the name of the form: A a /TWO-REPRISE : B :/: a' SECTIONAL CONTINUOUS bROUNDED BALANCED c BINARY d TERNARY :/ Day Two 3. Menuetto For this diagram: Polonaise in F major by Mozart, please fill in the blanks below -- œform. œœ œ œœ... œœthe œ œ œ œ . œthe œ œœœ œœform. œ œ œ. œ œ.. œ œ œ œ œ the staves œ œ œœ... name œ œœ œœ œ #Also, Trio diagram: 3 . œ-andœœ œdiagram 150 bb & & b & &b ? ? b ? ? bb b 4433 œJœœ.. œœœ-- œœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœ œœœ œJœœ.. œœœ-œ D: PAC JœJ. 443 pJœJ.G: HC Jœ m. J œ œ œ 4 m. p 3 œ œ œœ œ œœ œ œ8 œœ œ 4433 ppœœœ œœ œœœ œœ œœœ œœ œœœ œœ œœœ œ œ 443 œ œ œ bb & & b & &b ? ? b ? ? bbb œ́œ́ Jœ́J ffœ́JJ ffœœœœ œœ bb & & b & &b LSS:? ? b ? ? bbb Motives: œœ-œœ-œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œœœ œœœ œœ œœ œœ œœœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœœ œœ œ œœœ œœ œ . œ œ œ œ. ... œœ ... œœ œœœ œœœ.. .. œ . œ . pp˙ œ ... pp˙˙œœ____ œJœœ ˙ JœJ .. œ J . œœ.. œœ.. œ́œ́ Jœ́J œ́J Jœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œœ œœœ œœ œœœ œ œœ œœ ‰‰ ____ ‰‰ œ œœ-œœ-œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœœ ## œœ œœœ œœ. œœ œœ œœ. # œe: PAC œ œœ œœ m. 12 œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœœ œœ œœœœœ œ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ # œ œœ œœ ### œœœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ. . œœ œœœ œœœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ... œœ.. œ œ œ œ œœ œ œœ. œœœ œœ____ Œ ____ ŒŒ œ ŒŒ ŒŒ Œ œ œœ œ œœœ œ œ b J JJ J & b c -œJ œ œJ -- œ œ œ œ # œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ bb œ́Jœ́ œœ--- œœœ œœ œœ œœ œœœ œœ œ́Jœ́ œœ-- œ œœœ œœœœ œœœ œœ ## œœ œœ NCTs: & & b œ́Jœ́J œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œœ œœ́Jœ́J œœ œ œ œœ #œœ œœ ?& &b bb c ffJ œœ œœ œ œ œJ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œ œ œ ? ? bb ffœœœ œœ œœœ œœ œœœ œœ œœœ œœ œœœ œœ œœœ œœ ? ?b œ œ œ œ œ œ RN in bB¯: ____ HF: ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ œœ.. œœ.. œœœ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ G: HC œœ œœm. 16 œ œœ œœœ œœœ œ œœ œ œœ... œœ œœ œœ. œ œœ œ œœ œœ œ . œœ . œœ œœ œœœ.. . œœ .. œœ œœ œ. ˙˙œ œœ œœ ˙˙____ JœJ œ œJ J œ ˙ œœ.. œœ.. œ œœœ œœ œ œœ œ œœ... œœ œœ œœ. œ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œœ.. œœ.. œœ.. œœ.. œœ œœ.. œœ.. œœ œ œ œ œœ œœœ œœ œœœ œ nn œœ ‰‰ n œœ ‰‰ n œœ œ œœ œ œœ... œœ œ œœ... œ.. œœœ œœœœœœ.œ œœ œœœœœœ. œœœœ.. œ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ... œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ. œ œœ œ ____ ____ œœ... œ œœ œœ œœ.. œ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ-œœ- œœ-œœ-- œœ œ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œ œœ œœ œ PAC œœm.-20œœœ œœ œœ-- œœœœœ œœ- œœ œ œ œ œ œœ œœœ œœ œœ œœ œœœ œœ.. œœ.. œœ œœ.. œœ.. œœ œœ œœ œœ ˙˙˙ ˙˙ ˙ œœ œœ œ œœ____ œœ œœœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœœ œœ œ 131 131 131 131 ... .. . ... .. . œœœ JœœJ ‰‰ œJ ‰‰ J œ bœ œ œœ œœœ bbb œœœ œœ œ œœ œ œ ˙ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œœœœœœ œœ œœœ œœœ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œœ.. œœ.. œœ œœ œœ.. œœ.. œœ œœœ œœ œœ œœ œ ____ .. œ.... œ ... .. . . ____ . . bb œ œ 1621 & b œ œ œ & bb œ 6J2OpIjODTU LSS:& œ œ ____ ˙˙____ n # œœœ ____ œœ Œ Œ ‰ œ ____œ œYT:____ & ____ &____ Motives: ? œ œ œœ ? bb ? œ Figure 24.9.3 Mozart, œ b œ œ inœ F major ? bb œ œ œ œ . œ Polonaise œœ. œ œ œ œ œ.œ œ. ˙ p. ˙ b . . œ œ œ & bForJ the piece b œ n œ œon your Jœ Jdiagram œ complete œ theœfollowing ?J above, œ letters,based Œ Œ analysis. Include section labels using uppercase phrase œ œ œ labels NCTs: œ œ . . œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ andœ cadences œ using & ? œ œ œ œ œletters, œ theœ abbreviations œ œ œ PAC, bbbb œlowercase œ b œ œ using & b œ ˙ & b IAC, HC, DC, PC. & ? ? ?b RN: ? bb ____ b ____ HF: /: a ____A ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ :/: ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ :/ Circle all of the terms that apply to the name of the form: A a /TWO-REPRISE : B a' SECTIONAL :/: CONTINUOUS bROUNDED BALANCED c BINARY d TERNARY :/ Menuetto diagram: Trio diagram: G: HC m. 4 D: PAC m. 8 e: PAC m. 12 G: HC m. 16 PAC m. 20 123 .. .. CHAPTER 24. BINARY AND TERNARY FORMS 4. 25 25 25 25 For this Allegro in B-flat major (K. 3) by Mozart, please fill in the blanksAllegro below the staves and diagram the form. Also, name the form. Allegro œ b Allegro 242 œœJœJ œœœ œœ œœ œœœ & bbbbbb Allegro 2 & 4 œ 2 J & & b 44 ppJ œ œ œœ œ p œ ? bb 22 p‰ œœœ œœœ ? b 4 œ ‰ ? 2 b b 4 ? b b 42 ‰‰ b 4 œ œœœ œ œœœ b & bbbbbb & & b & ? b ? ? ? bbbbbbb œ œœœ œ œœœ 8 8 8 8 150 291 LSS: Motives: œ ‰ œœœ œœœ ‰‰‰ œ œœ ‰ œœ ‰‰ ‰ ____ bb &b bbbbbb cœœœ && & &b œ NCTs: ? bbb œœ ? ?? ?b bbbbbb cœœ 15 15 15 15 jj œœœjj œ œ œœJœJ JJ j œj œj œœj œ #œ œœœ ### œœœ œ œœœ ____ œ œœœ jj œœœjj œ œœ œ ‰‰ JJœJ ‰‰ J ‰ ‰‰‰ œ œœœ... œ.. œœœ.. œ œœœ... œ.. œœœ.. ‰ jj œ œœœ œœœ ‰‰‰ œœœjj œœ œ œœœ ‰ œœœJ ‰‰‰ JJœJ ____ œ œ œœœ... .. œœœ... œ œ œœœ œ œœœ œ œ œœœ... .. œœœ... œ ___ ___ ___ ___ 22 in B¯: ____ RN22 b 22 j 22 & bbbbb œœ ____ HF:& œ ‰‰ œjj ___ ___ ___ ___ ____ œœ. œœ. b œ ‰ œœ. œœ.____ & & b œ œœœ ‰ œœœj œœ... œœ... œœ... œœ... œ œ œœ.. œœ.. œœ.. œœ.. œ. œ. . . ? bbb ____ œœœ ‰ œœJœJ ____ ? LSS:? ‰ JJ œ œ œœ. œœ. bbb ‰ ? b ‰ Motives:b b œœ œœœœ & b bJ J œ œœœ... œ.. œœœ.. . ... . .. ... esc. esc. ____ œ ‰ œjjj œ œ œœ. ____ œœ. œœ œœœ ‰‰‰ ____ œœœj œœœ... œœœ... œœ... œœ... œœ œ œœ œœ... œœ... œœ.. œœ.. œœ œœœ ____ œJ œ. œ. .. œœ.. œœ œ ‰‰‰ JJœJ œ œ œœ____ œ ‰ ____ œ œœœ... œ.. œœœ.. esc. (œ) n œ . œ # œ œ œ œ esc. œœœ ### œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ (((œœœ))) nnn œœœ ... œ œ. œœJœJ œœœ... œœœ ... JJ œ . œœ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œœ œJ œœœ ‰‰‰ œœJœJ Jœœœ œœœ œœœ JœœJ œœ J‰‰‰ œ œ œœ œœ ‰ ‰ JJ œ œœ œ œ œ œ nœœœ œ œ œœœ œ ŒŒŒœ œ œ ∑∑∑œ œ œœœœ œ œœœ n œ œ œ nnœœ œ Œ ∑ œœ œœœ Jœœ œœ jj œœœjj œ œœ œ ‰‰ JJœJ ‰‰ J ‰ ‰‰‰ V ___ V ___ ____ ___ V ___ ___ V ___ ___ ___ œ œœœ... .. œœœ... œ œ œœœ... .. œœœ... œ ___ ___ ___ ___ . œœ ... œJJœJJ .p pp ... p‰‰ .. ‰‰ œj ˙ œ œœjjj œœœ œœ œœœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œœœœ œœœ œ œœ ___ ___ ___ ___ œ œœœ œ œœœ œ ___ ___ ___ ___ ‰ ‰‰‰ œ œœJœJ JJ œ œœJœJ JJ œ œœœ œ œœœ œ nœ œœœ nnn œœœ œ œœœ œ œœœ œ j œœœ œœœ œœœ nn œœ nn œœ ‰‰ œœjjj œ œ nn œœ nn œœ ‰‰ œ œ œ œ ∑ œœœ œœœ ∑∑∑ ____ œ œœ ‰œ œœ œ œœ œ˙ œ œœ ‰‰ œJJœJ œœ œœ œœœ œœœ ‰ J œ œ œ œ œœ ŒŒœ œ œ œœœœ œ œœœœœ œ œ œ Œ œœ Œ ___ ___ ___ ___ j œj œ œj œ n œ œ œ œ ‰ œ ‰‰‰ œœœJ ____ œœj œœ nn œœ œœ œœ œœ ‰‰ œœJ œ œ ‰ JJœ nœ œ ‰ JJœ J J œ œ œ œ ‰œ ‰ œ ____ œ ____ ‰‰‰ œœJœJ œœœ œœ œœ ‰‰‰ œœJœJ J JJ ___ ___ J ___ ___ ____ ‰ ‰‰‰ 127 127 127 127 ____ œ œ œ b œ___ ___œ___ ___ œ esc. (œ) œ nn œœ œœ œœ œœesc. . esc. (œ) b œ œœœ____ nn œœ œœ œœ œœ ((œœ)) bbb œœœ ... ____ œ. œœœ ... ____ esc. œ œœJœJ œœœ... JJ œ . V ___ V ___ V V ___ ___ ___ œ œ œ œ œ œ ˙ ___ ˙ J J b & bbbbb & NCTs: & b & œ t5R0ORjKloE bœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ? b b œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œYT: œ œ ˙ ? bbb ? ___ ___ .. ... . ... . ? ? bb bb b 24.9.4 Mozart, Allegro in B-flat major Figure RN: HF: ____ ____ ____ section On scratch paper,____ create a____ diagram____ of the ____ form. Include ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ labels bbb using uppercase letters, phrase labels using lowercase letters, & b b b & bbcadences and using the abbreviations PAC, IAC, HC, DC, PC. & & Circle all of the terms that apply to the name of the form: ? b ? ? ? bbbbbb b TWO-REPRISE SECTIONAL CONTINUOUS ROUNDED BALANCED BINARY TERNARY Day Three 5. Please fill in the blanks below the staves and diagram the form of “After the Ball” from Alexander Gretchaninoff’s Children’s Book, Op.98. Also, name the form. # œ œ ˙ œ ˙ & # 43 œ˙ .˙ # œ˙ .˙ œ.#œ œ. J œ œ œ˙ . œ. #œ œ. J ˙. # œ˙ . F ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ? ## 3 œ ˙ œ #˙ œ ˙ œ œ ˙ œ #˙ œ ˙ 4 œ Tempo di Mazurka __________ ________ __________ ___ # j j j j j œ œ œ. j & # .. œ œ . œ œ . œ œ œ œ . œ ˙ œ œ. œ œ œ œ. œ ˙. p œ. f . œ. œ. . œ # ˙˙ .. .œ œ. Œ œ œ. .œ œ. Œ œ œ. ? # # .. œ œ œ. œ Œ Œ œ˙ . . . _________ _____ # & # œ˙ .˙ ˙ # œ˙ . œ œ ˙ œ.#œ œ. J œ œ œ˙ . ______ ˙ # œ˙ . ___ œ œ. #œ œ. J ˙. rall. .. 129 ? ## 3 4 F ˙ œ ˙ ˙ œ #˙ ˙ œ ˙ œ ˙ ˙ œ #˙ ˙ œ CHAPTER 24. BINARY AND TERNARY FORMS 150 LSS: Motives:# # __________ ________ ____ ____ ____ ____ ## ____ ˙ LSS: ____ Motives: œ ____ j j œ . œœ œ œœ œ . œ œ ˙ . ˙ .œ œ. Œ Œ œ˙ œ # ˙˙ .. œ œ œœœ œœœ œ ______ œ___ œ œ ˙ ˙ œ œ œ˙____ # œ œ . Jœ œ____ # œ œ . Jœ ˙ . œ . ____ œ .____ . # œ˙ . rall. ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙ ˙. ˙ ˙ # # œ œ œ œ œ œ ˙. ˙ ˙ # œ˙____ . # œ˙____ RN& in B¯: . HF: ____ p ? ## 292 __________ ___ j j j j œ & b .. œ œœ. œ œœ . œ œœ œ œœ œœ . œœ œ˙ œ œ œœ œ . œ œ œ ˙ J œ. J J J p œ. & b c fJ . œ. J . œ œ œ. œ. . . œ. Œ ? # # .. œ œ Œ œ œ œ NCTs: . . œœœ œ œ . œœœ œ ? b b c œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ _________ œ_____œ ˙ œ ˙ œ œ ____ ____ ____ œ œ œ bœ œ œ __________ ________ b œœ œœœœ &&b # # J J ____ ____ .. .. ____ __________ ___ œœ œœœœ ˙ ˙ J J YT: 3AeFVFC1zy0 NCTs: œœœ œœœ œ œ œ œ œ ? # ? bb # œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ bœ œ œ œœœœ˙ Figure 24.9.5 Gretchaninoff, Children’s Book, Op.98, No. 13, “After the Ball” RN: On ____ scratch paper,____ create a____ diagram____ of the ____ form. # ____ HF: & #____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ section Include ____ labels using uppercase letters, phrase labels using lowercase letters, and cadences using the abbreviations PAC, IAC, HC, DC, PC. ?Circle ## all of the terms that apply to the name of the form: TWO-REPRISE SECTIONAL 6. 138 138 CONTINUOUS ROUNDED BALANCED BINARY TERNARY For the theme from Brahms’s Variations on a Theme of Haydn Op. 56a (the theme is also known as “St. Anthony’s Chorale”), please fill in the blanks below the staves and diagram the form. Also, name the form. & b b 42 œœ .. œ. p ? b 2 œ b 4 œ b &b œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œœ œ œœ > > œœ œ œœœ œ œ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ j œ. nœ œ nœ œ #œ nœ œ. œœ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ b &b ? bb ˙ œ œœ œœ. œ œ f œ˙ . œ b œ œ œ Œ œ œ œ ___ ___ œœœ .. œ. f œ œ œœ œ œ œœœ œ œ œœ œœ œ œœœ > > œ œ ___ ___ œ œœ œ œj ‰ .. .. œ œ œ œ œ œ œ b œ˙ . œ œ œ œœ œœœ œœœ œœ ˙˙ . œ b n ˙˙˙ . ˙ œ œœœ p œ ˙ ˙ ˙ . . œœœ œ œ œœ œ œœ . . ˙ ˙ ˙ œœœ œ œ ___ ___ œœ .. œœ œ œ œ œœ π ? b b œ œœ œœ œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ .. œœ œœ œœ œœœœ œ œœ ? bb œ # œ œ n œ œ œ #œ œ nœ œ b &b œœ œ œœ . œ. œœ . œ œ œ œ. œ œ œ œ œœ œœ œ ___ ___ œ œœœ .. œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ n œœ œ ___ ___ œœ œ œœ œ ‰ œJ œ ˙œ . œ œ œ ˙ œ œ œ ˙ œ œ œœ. œ œ ___ ___ œœ .. œœœ œœ œœ .. œ œœ f œ œ œ œ ˙œ . œ œ œ ˙ œ œ œ. œ œ œ œ œ œ. œ bœ œ œ. œ œ œ œ œ ˙ ˙ ˙ ___ (tonic (tonic prolongation prolongation follows follows cadence) cadence) ___ œœ œœ œ. œœ œœ. >œ œœ œ ___ ___ >œ >œ > œœ œ œ œœœ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ. œœ œœ. ___ ___ œ. œœ œœ. dim. dim. smorz. smorz. œ #œ œ #œ œ. œœ œœ. ˙ ˙˙ π ˙˙ 1. 1. œœ. œ œ œ œ. œ œ œ œ nœ œ œ nœ œ 2. 2. œ œœ ___ ___ U › › › › π U .. › › .. œ œ œ œ œœ œfœ œ ˙ œ œ œ œ J œœ n œœ J ‰Jœ J œ #œ œ nœ œ ˙ œ œ J œ œ œ œ œ œ #œ œ nœ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ NCTs: œ œ œ œ œ œ œ293 CHAPTER 24. BINARY AND TERNARY FORMS œ ___ ___ œ œ œœ ? bb c œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ___ œ œœ œœœ œœœ œ Jœ b π œ &?b b b cœœ œJ œœ œœ b ˙œœ.____ œ œœ œœ RN in bB¯: & HF: ____ f ? b b œ˙ . œ b œ œ LSS: ____ Motives: ˙œ œ œ ˙ œ œ œ ˙œ œ œ œ. œ. . œ œ œ ____ œœ. œ œ ____ œ œœ œœ ˙____ ˙ . œ œ ____ œ. œ. œœ œœ ˙ ˙˙____ .. ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ dim. smorz. π œ . œ œ œ œ œ œ . œ b œ œ œ . œ œ œ œ œ œ. œ. œ. œ. ˙ . ˙ ˙ œ œ ˙ ____. ____ ____˙ ____ ____œ œ ____ b œœ œœœœ & b bJ J b 1. œ œ œ bœ œ œ U › › › π 2. U › › œœ œœœœ ˙ ˙ J J & NCTs: œ 3EbkqX94ng8 bœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ??b b œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œYT: œ œ ˙ bb ___ (tonic prolongation follows cadence) Figure 24.9.6 Brahms, Variations on a Theme of Haydn, Op. 56a RN: HF: ____ ____ ____ section On scratch paper,____ create a____ diagram____ of the ____ form. Include ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ labels using uppercase letters, phrase labels using lowercase letters, and cadences using the abbreviations PAC, IAC, HC, DC, PC. Circle all of the terms that apply to the name of the form: TWO-REPRISE SECTIONAL CONTINUOUS ROUNDED BALANCED BINARY TERNARY Click here to download the first homework assignment for this chapter. Click here to download the second homework assignment for this chapter. Click here to download the third homework assignment for this chapter. Click here to download the review sheet for material studied prior to this chapter. PDF versions of the textbook, homework exercises, and practice exercises can be found at musictheory.pugetsound.edu Chapter 25 Sonata and Rondo Forms # 3 œ & 4 .. œ œ œ ˙ . œ œœ œ œ 25.1 Sonata ? # 43 .. œ œForm œ œ œ 139 œ œ œ œ œ œ ˙. m.1 .. .. Sonata form,G:also knownV6as “first-movement form,” is vi“[t]he most important I V7 I I principle of musical form, or formal type, from the Classical period 7 I into D: ii I64 Vwell the 20th century,” according to the Grove Music Online. The purpose of this mm. 7-8 in aspects G major mm. 9-10 and harmonic chapter is to serve as an introduction to formal, thematic, # . œ We will œfocus on sonata form as it existed during the height. of sonata form. œ ˙ . & . ˙ of the Classical era. Further and more detailed study of sonata form occurs in higher-level music theory courses. ? # .. 6 G: V5 IV I 25.1.1 Diagram ofI Sonata Form V7 I6 vi 4 V7 .. I Below is a generalized diagram of sonata form, which serves as our starting point. Real-world examples will contain differences and elaborations. EXPOSITION PT transition DEVELOPMENT RECAPITULATION ST (CT) Fragmentation & sequencing Retransition PT transition ST (CT) In major: I modulating V V V modulations V pedal I tonicizations I I In minor: i modulating III III III modulations V pedal i tonicizations i i PT = Primary Theme ST = SecondaryTheme CT = ClosingTheme It is fairly common for a piece in sonata form to have multiple secondary themes (ST 1 , ST 2 ). In some sonatas, the development section features new material. Some sonatas will not have a closing theme. As we work with real world examples, you will see the ways in which composers realize sonata form. While the diagram above designates three large sections (exposition, development, recapitulation), repeat signs in sonatas from the classical era designate the sonata as a two-reprise form—the exposition repeats, then the development and recapitulation repeat as a single unit. Douglass Green, in his book Form in Tonal Music, notes the sonata’s evolution from and synthesis of rounded binary and balanced binary: 294 CHAPTER 25. SONATA AND RONDO FORMS 295 The typical sonata form, as it appeared in the 18th century, is a combination of rounded and balanced binary. It begins the return with a restatement of the opening of part one, as in the rounded binary, and it closes with a restatement of the final sections (second and closing themes) of part one transposed to the tonic, as in the balanced binary. 25.1.2 Sonatina Form While “sonatina” is sometimes understood to mean a short sonata or an easy sonata for beginners, in terms of form, sonatina form is sonata form without the development section. Sonatina form is sometimes encountered in the second, slow movement of a larger work like a symphony, as well as in overtures. A familiar piece in sonatina form is the “Miniature Overture” from The Nutcracker by Tchaikovsky. YouTube: https://www.youtube.com/watch?v=JRXIDEpquCg Figure 25.1.1 Tchaikovsky, The Nutcracker, “Miniature Overture” (1892) Exposition PT 0:00 ST 0:49 CT 1:28 Recapitulation PT 1:40 ST 2:30 CT 3:09 25.1.3 Sonata Principle Important to sonata form is sonata principle, which Charles Rosen discusses in his book Sonata Forms. The exposition of a sonata form presents the thematic material and articulates the movement from tonic to dominant in various ways so that it takes on the character of a polarization or opposition. The essential character of this opposition may be defined as a largescale dissonance: the material played outside the tonic (i.e., in the second group) is dissonant with respect to the center of stability, or tonic. Sonata style did not invent this concept of dissonant section, but it was the first style to make it the generating force of an entire movement.1 Rosen continues: The dominant is conceived as a dissonant tonality in the exposition....The polarization, in fact, leads to the concept of a dissonant section, which raises the dissonant interval or chord to a higher power: that is, a simple reintroduction of the tonic key will no longer serve as a resolution, but the section outside the tonic needs to be resolved as a whole.2 1 Sonata 2 Sonata Forms, Revised Edition, 1988, p. 229 Forms, Revised Edition, 1988, p. 244 CHAPTER 25. SONATA AND RONDO FORMS 296 25.1.4 The Monothematic Sonata Haydn was especially fond of restating the Primary Theme in the dominant where the Secondary Theme would normally occur. This reinforces the idea that the tonal design of a sonata was as important as thematic design. 25.2 The Four Structural Functions in Music In the “Structural Functions” chapter of A Practical Approach to the Study of Form in Music, Peter Temko and Peter Spencer enumerate four structural functions. 1. Expository function 2. Transitional function 3. Developmental function 4. Terminative function 25.2.1 Expository Function Music expressing expository function maintains a stable tonal center and clear melodies, usually with well-defined phrases. The vast majority of the music we encountered in binary and ternary form in the last chapter was expository in nature. Additionally, the primary and secondary themes in a sonata form are usually have expository function. Below is the secondary theme from the first movement of Mozart’s Piano Sonata, K. 333. 632 632 632 636 636 636 bbbbb cc œ . & & & b c œœœ ... œœ .. ? ? ? bbbbb ccc ˙œœ˙ .. b ˙˙˙ ˙ bbbbb & & &b ? ? ? bbbbb b 640 640 640 644 644 644 j ## œœjj #œ œœ ... œ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œœ.. œœ.. œœ. . œ. œ.. ÓÓ Ó nn œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ n œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ Œ ‰‰ ‰ œœ œœ œœœ œœ ŒŒ œœ œ œœ œœ œ ŒŒ Œ j œœjj œ œ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œ bb œœœ ... œœœ nnn œœœ œœ œ œ œ œœ œ bbb œœœ œœ b bb & & &b œœ œœ... œœ.. œ œ œ. . œœœ œœœ œ ? œ b œœ.. ? ‰ ? bbb bb ‰‰ œ œ j œœjj œœœ œœœ œ œœ œ bb b œœ .. œ. œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œ œ œœ œ œ ‰‰ œ Œ ‰ œ œœ œœœ œœ ŒŒ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œ.. œ. . œ œ. œ œ œ œœ. œ.. œœ.. œœ œœ œœ .. œ œ œ ˙˙ œœ ? b ˙˙ œ ? Ó Œ b Ó Œ ? bb b œœ Ó Œ ˙˙ b œ œ. bbbbb œœœ .... & & b œœ .. & œœ ... œœ . œ. ˙˙ ˙˙˙ ˙ aa a œœ œœœ œœœ JœJ J œœ œ & & & b' b' b' aa a ŸŸ œœ jj œœ jj œ b œŸ. œ JœJ œœ œœj JœJ œœ œœj œœ bb œœ .. œœ œœ œœ œœ œœœ œœœ J œ œ J œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ nn œœ œœœ œœ œœœ œ ŒŒ nœ œ Œ IAC IAC in in B B¯¯ IAC in B¯ j œœjj œœ œ œ j jj œœjj œœœj œœœ œ ŒŒ j œœjj œœ œœ nn œœ œœœ ### œœœ œœœ œœœnnn œœœ œœœ Œ œ œ œ nœ œœ œœœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ ŒŒ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ Œ œ œ œ œœ œœœ HC HC in in B B¯¯ HC in B¯ œœ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœœ nnn œœœ bbb œœœ œœ œœ œœœ œœœ œ œ œ œ œ œ nn œœœ nœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ ŒŒ Œ ? ? ? IAC IAC in in B B¯¯ IAC in B¯ œœ œœœ œœ œœ œœœœ œ œœ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœœ œœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ ŸŸŸ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œœ .. œ œœ œœ ŒŒ œ œ œ.œœ œ Œ œœ œ œœœ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ nnn œœœ œœ œœ œœ œœœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ PAC PAC in in B B¯¯ PAC in B¯ 47 47 47 ? bb œ œ Ó ˙ ˙ Œ œ & n œœ œ œœ CHAPTER 25. SONATA AND RONDO FORMS œœ œœ œ œ Œ ? 297 IAC in B¯ b' 644 œ œ . œ n œ œ œ œ œ œ b œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ Ÿœ œ œ . œ b &b œ œ. œ. ? bb ‰ œ B¯:25.2.1 Figure œ. œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ Œ œ œ œnœ œ œ œ œ œ PAC in B¯ YT: PmO3Wlono6w ____ ____ Mozart, Piano Sonata, K. 333, I, Secondary Theme Notice the perfect authentic cadence that closes off four-phrase par____this ____ allel double period within the larger sonata form. Cadences are important demarcations within a form. ____ ____ 25.2.2 Transitional Function ____ ____ Music of transitional function moves from one tonal center to another and often features a contrasting accompanimental texture more rhythmically active than preceding expository material. Tonicizations may also occur within a transition. Transitions are sometimes called bridges. Mozart and Haydn often ended their sonata form transitions with a half cadence followed by a rest to signal that the secondary theme was about to commence. Again, notice the importance of cadences to demarcate the form. Allegro con brio Allegro con brio Allegro con brio Primary Theme œ.. œ œœ.. œœ œ.. œœ œ.. œ.. œœ.. œ . œ œ œ œ œ. œ Z œ. Z œœ. œ Œ Ó Œ Ó Œ Ó Œ Ó œ.. œ j Primary Primary Theme Theme œjj œœ C œ . œœ & & C œ. p ? C pŒ ?C Œ . & œœ. & œœ.. œœ.. & & & & œ.. œ œœ.. œœ œ œœ.. œœ.. œœ œ . .œ . Œ ŒŒ œ . œœ œœ. œœ . œ œœ. œœ .. œœ Œ œ. œ.. œ œœ.. œœœ œœ.. œœ.. œœ œ Œ Ó Œ Ó & & & œœ ŒŒ œœ ŒŒ œ.. œ.. œ.. œ .. œœ œ. œ œ œ. œ.œœ ŒŒ œ. œœ.. œœ ŒŒ œœ.. . . . œjj œ . . . œ . œœ œœ. œœ. œœ. œœj œ œœ. œœ. œœ. œœ œœ œœ œ œ.. œ.. œ.. œ.. œ. œ œ œ œ œ Z Z 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 33 œ œ33 œ œ33 œ œ33 œ œ33 œ œ33 œ œ33 œ œ33 œ œ33 œ œ33 œ œ33 œ œ33 œ œ œ33œ œ œ33œ œ33 œ œ33 œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ (Primary Theme repeats with triplet accompaniment) œœ.. œ ŒŒ ŒŒ œ & œ œ œ œ & œœ œœ œ œ œ.. œ.. œ.. œ.. (PAC) (PAC) (PAC) . .. œ ŒŒ ŒŒ œ . œœ œœ. & œ & œ. & & œ.. œ œœ.. œœ œ (Primary Theme Theme repeats repeats with with triplet triplet accompaniment) accompaniment) (Primary œœ œ.. œ œœ .. œœ F F 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 33 33 33 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 ŒŒ ÓÓ b ˙ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ ˙ b˙ œœ. œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ w˙w . œœ œœ (PAC) (PAC) (PAC) .. œ .. œ. œ .. œ . transition .œ. œ . œœ . . œ transition œ. œ. œ. œ œ œ œ œ œ. œ. œ. œ œ œ œ œ œ œ . n œ. œ .. œœ œœ.. œœ .. œœ œ œ œœ œ. œ œœ œ.. œ . œ transition nœ œ œ œ œ. œ. œ. œ œ œ œ œ œ œ. œ. œ œ œ œ œ 5 pp 3 3 3 5553 5 53 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 b ˙ ˙˙ ˙ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ˙˙ ˙˙w b ˙ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œœ ˙w ˙˙ ww œ w w œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œœ œ .. œ (tonic prolongation after cadence) (tonic (tonic prolongation prolongation after after cadence) cadence) œœ.. & & œ.. œ 3 33 œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œ œ.. œ 3 33 3 33 5 55 3 33 œœ .. œ œ.. œ œ œœ.. œœ.. 3 3 3 œœ œ.. œ œ .. œ œ.. œ œ.. œ œœ.. œœ.. ˙˙ .. (rhythmic motion resumes and is unceasing) (rhythmic (rhythmic motion motion resumes resumes and and is is unceasing) unceasing) œœ.. 3 3 3 œœ.. # œ œœ œ œ œ #œ œ œ œ 3 3 3 5 5 5 3 3 3 œœ.. cresc. cresc. cresc. 3 3 3 œœ.. œœ.. 3 3 3 œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œœ 5 5 œ ? #œ œ œ ? #œ œ 5 3 3 3 141 141 141 œ œ . œ œ . œ œ. œ. . œ œ œ. œ. ˙ . Fœ . & & œ Œ Œ œœ . œ F 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 F 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 Œ Ó b ˙ & 3 3 3œ 3œ 3œ 3œ 3œ 3œ 3 3 3œ 3œ ˙ b ˙ Œ Ó œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œœ œ w˙ b ˙ 298 & œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œœAND œœ œ œœ œœRONDO CHAPTER œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœFORMS œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ w˙ & œœ.. Œ Ó 25. œœSONATA œ œ œ œ œ œ œ w œ. œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œœ œ œ œ(PAC) (PAC) (PAC) transition œ. .. . . œ œ œ œ œœ.. œœ .. œœ n œ. œ . œ œ. œ . œ œœ.. œœ .. œ œœ.. œœ .. œ œ. œœ .. œ transition œ œ . . . œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ transition & œ. œ . œ nn œœ.. œœ .. œœ œœ.. œœ .. œœ œ. œœ œ. œ . œœ œœ.. œ . œœ œœ.. œœ.. œœ.. œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ. œœ.. œœ.. œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ & 5 & pp 3 3 3 553 5 3 3 3 3 5 5 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 p b ˙ ˙˙ ˙ & œ œ œ œ œ œ œ 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 ˙ ˙ ˙˙w bb ˙˙ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œ3 œœ ˙ & w w œ ˙ ˙ ˙w ˙ & ˙ww w˙w œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œœ œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œœ œ ˙ w (tonic prolongation after cadence) (rhythmic motionœresumes and is unceasing) œ (tonic prolongation after cadence) (rhythmic motion resumes and is unceasing) (tonic prolongation after cadence) (rhythmic motion resumes and is unceasing) œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ .œ. . . . ## œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ.. œœ.. œœ.. œ œ œ œ . . œ œ œ . . . œ œ œ œœ. œ. œ. œ œœ œ œ œ œœ. œœ. œœ. # œ œ œ œœ œ œ. œ. œ. œ œ œ œœ œ & . œ. œ 5œ œ œ & œ 5 5 cresc. & 5 5 5 œ cresc. 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 53 5 5 cresc. ? # œ œœ œœ 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 ? # œ & œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ3 œ3 œ3 œ3 œ3 œœ3 œ œ bb œœ3 ## œœ œ œ3 œ œ œ3 œ œ œ3 œ ? # œ 3œ œ3 & & œœœ œœ œœ œœœ œœ œœ œœœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœœ œœ œœ œœœ œœ œœ œœœ(accidental œ œbe œœreaffirmed œ # œ œto œœnewœ key œœ œœwill 3 œ œ œœ b œleading repeatedly) œ œ œ 3 (accidental leading to new key will be reaffirmed repeatedly) (accidental leading to new key will be reaffirmed repeatedly) . .œ. . . œ œ œ œ œ.. . . . œ œ œ . œ œ œ . œœ. œœ.. œœ.. œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ. œœ.. œœ.. œœ œœœ œœ œœ.. œœ .. œœ œœœ.. œœœ .. œœ œœ.. œœ .. œœœ œœ... œœ œœœ œœ . œ œ. œ œ & œ œ œ œœœ œ œ œ & 5 3 3 & œ œ œ 5 œ 3 3 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ 3 5 3œ 33 3 3 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œœ# œ œ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œœ # œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œœ ? 3 3 3 3 ? # œ # œ œ & œ 3 3 3 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ # œ œ œ 3 œ 3 œ 3 œ 3 # œ 3œ œ 3œ œ 3 œ 3 & œ œ # œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ3 œœ ? œ 3 œ 3 œ 3 # œ 3œ & œ œ#œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 œœ œœ œœ œœ 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 142 & & œ œ œ œ ‰≈ r œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ#œ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œ œ œ #œ œ œ œ œ œ #œ .œ . œ œ #œ œ 3 3 œ- 3 & ‰ . œr# œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œœ & œ ? ‰ .œR # œ œ œ œ 33 33 33 & œ . œ œ TI œ . œ TI œ œ œ . # œ œ œ. œ œ . œ ‰. R œ T œ. œ œ T œ. œ œ T œ. œ œ #### 33 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 Secondary Theme œ. œ. œ. œ. œ-œ- ŒŒ ??œœ.. œ.œ. œ.œ. ŒŒ ÓÓ && ÓÓ Œ Œ œ œ œ #œœ#œ œ Œ Œ œ œ œ#œœ# œ œ J J 5 5 5 5 œ-œ33 33 33 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 ŒŒ jj ŒŒ ÓÓ && œœœœ œœœœ œœœœ œœ œ# œ# œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œ# œ#?œ œœ.. œ.œ. œ.œ. œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œ (half cadence followed by rest) D major, the dominant of C G major) major) (ST in G œ Closing Theme (tonic andYT: dominant harmonies emphasized) Lfq9P-zT_0I œ Hob.œ XVI:35, œ I. c œ Joseph Œ Haydn, Œ Piano œ . Sonata Figure & 25.2.2 œ ‹ œin C major, œ œ œ 140 œ. œ. œ. p ? ## ## # #c cg œœ Œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ. œ‰ jœ œ œœ # œ œ œ Œœ œ‰ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œ œ‰ œœ.œ œœ.œœœ. & œ. (œ. ) œ. œ œ œ(œ) gg œœ œ œ œ œ œœœ œ œ œ .œ œ. œœ œ œ œ (œ)œ œ œ (œ) œ ped. pt. p f p & f . . œ. œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ g ˜ : i V œ œ œ ? ## c œ Œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ‰ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ J œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ & . . . œ œ œ œ. œ ‹œ # ## ˙ . œœ œœ œœ &6 # œ transition # # œœ œœœ œœ ‰ œœ. œœ. œœ. œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ # œ œ œ œ œ œ n œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ & # œ nœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ # œ œ œ œ œ œ œœœ œ˙ œ œœœ œn œœœ ? & # # # #f p f œ œ œ œ ped. pt. œ œ( œœ) œ œ œ œ (œœ)œ # œ œ œ œ (nœœ)œ f (œ) p ? ## œ œ œ œ œ œœœœœœœœ Œ Ó V & œ œi œ œ œ Primary Theme ˙ ˙ ## # # # œ œ ‹œ œ & # & & œœ . œ œ# œœ œ œœ Œ ˙˙ (cadence from V to I closes PT) ˙ ˙ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ‹œ œ œ œ˙ . œ œ œ œ œœ ‰ J œ œ œ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ (increased rhythmic activity) 10 œœ œœ œ œ œ œœ œ ggg œœœ œ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œ.. œœ.. . . œ œ œœ œ œœ œœœ œœ œœ fff ? # # c œ Œ œœ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œœ... œ... œœœ.. ‰ œ œœ œ œœ œ œ œ œ ? ? ## ## cc œœœ ŒŒ œ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ ‰‰ œœJJ œ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ CHAPTER FORMS J œœ 25. SONATA AND RONDO & # & ## ### & & 6 6 66 6 ?# ? ? ## ### # & ## ### & & 10 10 10 10 10 ?# ? ? ## ### 14 14 14 14 ##### & & & # 14 ?# ? ? ## ### # & ## ### & & # & ## ### & & 17 17 17 17 17 # & ## ### & & # & ## ### & & 20 20 20 20 20 œ.. œ.. œ.. œœœœ œœœ œœœ ‰‰ œœœ. œœœ. œœœ. œœ ‰ p ff f œ œ ppœ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œœœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœœ œœœ## œœ œœœ œœœ œœ œœœ œœœnn œœ #œ nœ ff f Œ Ó ÓÓ œœœ ŒŒ ‰ ‰‰ . . œœœJ.. nnn œœœ.. JJ œ. œœ.. . œœœ.. . œœœ.. . œœœ.. œ. œœ.. œ # œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ ## œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœœ œœ œœœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œœ legato legato legato legato legato œ. œœ.. . œœœ.. œ. œœ.. . œœœ.. œ œœ œœœ œœœ œœ œœœ œœœ œœ œœ œ œœ . œœœ.. œ ˙ œœœ nn œœ ˙˙ f pœ n œ ffœ œ œ œ ppœ œ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ (cadence (cadence from from V V to to II closes closes PT) PT) (cadence from from V V to to I closes closes PT) PT) (cadence (cadence from V to IIactivity) closes PT) (increased rhythmic (increased rhythmic activity) (increased rhythmic rhythmic activity) (increased (increased rhythmic activity) activity) . œœ œ œœœ.. œœ œœ œœœ œœœ œœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ ### œœœ œ œœœ œ œœœ œ œœœ œ œœœ œ œœœ œ œœœ œ œœœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ nœ œœœ bbb œœœ nnnn œœœœ œœœ bb œœ n œ & œœœ œœœ & bœ & œœœ œœ ‰ ‰‰ . œœœJ.. JJ œ. œœ.. . œœœ.. . œœœ.. œ. œœ.. œ # œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ ## œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœœ œœ œœœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œœ Secondary Theme Secondary Theme I Secondary Theme Theme Secondary œ œ œ mmIIœ œ œ . mmœ œ. œ. œ œ œ œ Œ Secondary œ œœœ ## œœ œœœTheme œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ Œ œœ # œ œœ œœ œœ mœœ œœ œœ .. mœœ ### œœœ œœ.. œœ.. œ Œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœœ œœ œœœ œœ œœ œœ œœœ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œ œ œ œœ œœœœ transition transition transition transition transition œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ fff œ œ œ œœœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œœœœ œœœ ˙˙˙ ˙ p fffœ œ œ œ ppœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœœ œ œœœ œ œœœ œ œœœ œ œœœ œ œœœ œ œœœ œ œœœ œ œœœ œ œœœ œ œœœ œ œœœ œ œœœ œ œœœ œ œœœ œ œœœ œ œœœ œ nœ œ œ œ œ œœœ œ n œ œ œœœ œœ nn œœ œœœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ nn œœ œ œœ œœœ œœ œœ œœœ œœ fœœ œœ œœ ff œ œ pppœ œ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ 299 œœ œ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœ## œœ œœ œœœ œœ nnœœ œ œ œ # œ œ œ nœ œœ œœ œ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœ## œœ œœ œœœ œœ nnœœ œ œ œ # œ œ œ nœ œœ œœ . œœœ ‰ œœ œœ˙˙œ˙ .. œœ œœ œœ œœœ œœœ ‰‰ JœJJ œ œ. œ œ œ œ Œ œœ .. œœ œœ## œœœ œœ œœœ ŒŒ œœ # œ œ œœ œœœœœœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ ... pœœ.. œœ.. œœ.. œœœ p œ œ pœ œ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ ŒŒ œœ œ œœ œ œœœ œ œœœ œ œœ œ œœœ œ œœœ œ œœ œ œœ œœœ œœœ Œ œ (half œ œ œ cadence œ followed œ (half cadence followed (half cadence followed (half cadence followed by rest rest concludes transition) by concludes transition) (half cadence followed by rest rest concludes transition) by by rest concludes concludes transition) transition) ∑∑∑ # œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ ## œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ (ST is in V—A major) (ST is in V—A major) (ST is is in V—A V—A major) (ST (ST is in in V—A major) major) YT: 34stw2rF0t8 Figure 25.2.3 Mozart, Piano Sonata, K. 284, I. 25.2.3 Developmental Function Music with developmental function often contains sequences and fragmentation of earlier melodies. In addition, developmental music modulates through multiple keys. Phrase lengths may be irregular and elisions may be used by the composer to keep the listener off balance. It can sometimes be difficult to distinguish between transitional and developmental music. A development section is typically longer than a transition and therefore will contain more sections of a varying nature and as well as a greater number of modulations. CHAPTER 25. SONATA AND RONDO FORMS 300 Examples from a development section can be found in Section 11.1 of this text. Note the fragmentation and sequencing of melodic ideas as well as the different keys expressed in the examples throughout that section. 25.2.4 Terminative Function Terminative function is typically expressed through a rather emphatic alternation of tonic and dominant harmonies, usually to affirm a tonal center. The closing theme of a sonata has terminative function. 142 142 142 & & & Vn. I œœ T œœœ.. œœœ œœ œTœ #œœ. 4 T œ&T4 œ . ‰ œ œœ T T œœ .. œœ œ œ œ ‰œœ œœœ T T T œ œ œ œ # œ œ œ -œ œ œ œ œœ . œœ œœ œ œ #œœœ.. œ œœ œT ..œ œœ‰ œœœT I œ I T T ‰ ‰ œ œ T T . œ . I œ œœ II œœ . œ œœ I œœœ ... œœ‰ ### œœœ-- ‰ .. œœ œœ . œ œœ ‰‰ . RœR Rœ œ œ # œ # œ Œ œ3 3 Œ 3 œ 33 Œ33 œ 33 Œ33 œ œ œ33 33 œ 33 œœ 3 œ 3 œœ 3 œ 3 œœ ‰ ≈ rœ œ œ œœœ .. œœ œœœŒ... œœ œœ . œœœ œ œ œ #œ 4 œ œ œ Œ 3 &33 4 œ 33œœ 33 Œ 33œœ 3 œ œ 3 3 3 3 3 & ## œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ # œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œ ‰‰ ≈≈ œrr ## œœ .. œ œœœ ... œœ œ œ œ œ œ & œ œ œ œ œ & # œ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œœ œœ # œ œœ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ ## œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ # œ . œœ œ œ œ Œ # œ œ 4 œœœœ œœ œ œœŒ œœ Œ œ œ œŒ œ Œœ Œ œ Vla. # œB 4 œ œ Vn. II & & & Vc. C.B. & & & œœ--œ ?‰4. rœ œ 333 333 ‰‰4..œrr## œœ œ œœ œœœ œœ œœœ œœ # œ œœ œ œ -œ- ? G: I# œ œ œ œ œ ‰ .œ œ œ œ œœ- ? ? ‰‰ ..œRœ ## œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œ & RR ∑ 3 33 ∑ & 3 3 3 Secondary Theme . . Secondary Secondary Theme Theme . . œ œœ œœ œ#œ œ œœœŒ.. œ œœœ.. Œ œ œ œœœ œ# œ Œœ œŒœ--- œŒ ? . œ œ œ Œ Ó Ó Œ Œ Œ œ Œ . . ? œ . œ. œ. Œ Ó & Ó ŒŒ œœ œ œœ##œœ œœ ŒŒ œœ œ œœœ## œœ œœ œ ŒŒ ? œ . œJJ œ Œ Ó & & Ó 5 5 J I -œ- V V I 5 V I 5 53 53 3 3 3 3 3 3 œœ- Œ ? 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 Œ Ó 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 ? j & œœ œœ œœ œ # œ œ œ œ # œ Œ Œ Ó ? œ œ œ œ j & œ œ œ œ œ œ Œ Œ Ó œ œ œœ .. œœ. j∑ œœ. ∑ &∑ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œ∑œœ œœ œ œ œœ ## ∑œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ∑œ œœ œœ œ œ œœ ∑## œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ . . . (half cadence .followed . by rest) (ST in D major, the dominant of G major) (half cadence followed by rest) (ST in D major, the dominant of G major) (half cadence followed rest) (ST in D major, the dominant of G major) YT:byjVPDANe91d4 ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ Figure 25.2.4 Mozart, Symphony No. 41, K. 551, I., Closing Theme ∑ Theme ∑ (tonic ∑ dominant ∑ ∑ ∑ ## # Closing œ∑ Closing Theme (tonic and and dominant∑ harmonies harmonies∑emphasized) emphasized) ## #B œœ œœ œœ . c œ Œ Œ œ # # # & œ # c œ ŒŒ ŒŒ œœ .. œ ‹‹ œœ œœ œœ œœ & & #?# c pœ∑ œœ.. ∑ œœ.. ∑ œœ.. ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ œ ‹œ ∑ . . . pp ## œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ # œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ? # ? ## ## ## ## cc œ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ (œ)# œ œœ œ (œ) œ œœ œ (œ) œ œœ œ (œ) œ œœ œ ? # # c œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œped. pt.((œœ)) œ ((œœ)) œ ((œœ)) œ (œœ) œ ( ) ped. pt. Closing Theme (tonic and dominant harmonies emphasized) & g˜:∑i g˜ : i & ## # ## # # # # ## & & & #B ? # ## # ? # ## ? ## ###? ## # ## # #### & & & ## ? ## ? ? ## ### ## ### ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ œ. ∑ ∑ œœ .. œœ ‹‹ œœ œ ‹œ g˜ : i ˙ .. œ˙ ˙. œ œ œœ œ ∑ped. pt. ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑œ.. œœ. œœ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ œ.. œ ∑ ∑ œ.. œ œœ. œœ ∑ œœ. œœ ∑ ∑ ∑ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ## œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ∑œ œœ œœœ œœ∑ œœ œœ œœœ ∑œœ œœ œœ œœœ∑ œœ œœ œœ ∑œœœped.œœ pt. ( œœ∑)# œ œœœ œ ∑(œœ) œ œœœ œ∑ (œœ) œ œœœ ∑œ (œœ) œ œœœ∑ œ ( ) ( œ) ( œ) ( ) œ œ œ œ ped. ( ) ( ) ( œ) pt. ( œ) ped. pt. i ii œ œ œœ œœ ∑ V V V ˙˙ ˙ V V V ‹œ œ ‹œ ‹œ œœ ˙˙ ˙ œ œ œ œœ œ œœ ## œœ œ œœ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ (œ)# œ œœ œ( œ) œ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœped. pt.( œ ) (œ ) œ œped. ( œ) pt.( œ) ped. pt. i ii V V V œ œ œœ œœ ˙˙ ˙ ‹œ œ ‹œ ‹œ œœ ˙˙ ˙ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ œœœ œœ œœ œœ œœœ œœ œ œ cresc. cresc. cresc. œ œ œ œ œ œ ## œœ œ œœ œœ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ (œœ)# œ œœ œ( œœ) œ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ ( œ) pt. ( ) œ œped. œ œ ( ) ped. pt. ( œ) i ii ped. pt. V V V i ii j ## œ œ œ œj œ œœ œœ œj œ ‰ .. & # œ. œ œ J œ œ œœœ œœ j j j œ œ œ œœ AND œœ œ RONDO œ œœ S p FORMS CHAPTER 25. SONATA ? ### œ . œ J œ œJ œ œ j œ ‰ .. J œ ___ ___ .. œ . œ œ œ œJ œ œœœœ .. œ # # œ œ . œ œ œ. YT: œ aOzWTNaQRxQ œ œ œœ œœj œ . œ œ œ œJ œ & # J pOp. 27, No. Figure 25.2.5 Beethoven, Moonlight. Sonata, j j S S S Theme (1802) . œ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œ # œ œ œ œ œ œ ‰ . ? ### œ œ. ‰Exercises Go to the Practice at the J end of this chapter Jto fying these four structural functions aurally. ___ ___ j œœ œ . œ œ œ œ œ. œ œœ œ œ œ 301 œ. œ œ œ j œ œ œ œœ œ. œ œ J j œœ J practice identi- 2, III, Closing j œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ ‰ .. œ œ J J S p œ œ œ f œ œ œ œ œ œ A rondo is a?piece (anœ A section) that alternates œ œ with # # # œthatœbegins œ a refrain œ œ œ with œ ‰ .. j œ J œ œ œ . J episodes (B and C). The 5-part J rondo, J we encountered œ an exampleJ of which j j j ## œ œ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœ œœœ 25.3 Rondo & # œ Form . j ___ ___rondo in an earlier chapter, has ABACA form or ABABA form. The 7-part typically has ABACABA form, although other designs exist. A diagram for 7-part Classical form is shown below. Major: A I Minor: i transition B V retransition A I III transition i C retransition i,vi, or IV A I I,VI, or iv i transition B I retransition A I i i The refrain (the A section) is always in tonic. The first episode (the B section) was typically in a closely related key—the dominant (V) if in major or the mediant (III) if in minor. There was greater variety of keys used for the second episode (the C section), including tonic minor in a major sonata or the submediant (vi or VI). A retransition in this case is defined as a transition returning to material previously heard. Note that the B section being first stated in the dominant then later in tonic is an example of sonata principle, a principle which occurred in many Classical era pieces (see Charles Rosen’s Sonata Forms for more on sonata principle). An example of Classical seven-part rondo form is found below in the third and final movement of Beethoven’s Pathétique Sonata, Op. 13. 148 Allegro . . œœ b b C . œ. œ. œ . œJ œ . œ ˙ œj œ n œ œ œ œj œ œ œ œ œ œ ˙ . b & œ J œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ n œœ œ œœ œ n œ œ œ œ œ œ p œ œ n œ œ œ œ œ œ ? bb C ‰ Œ œ œ œ œ œœ b œ œ œ œœœœ nœ œ œ œ YT: 05Xyc2FHHRI œ œ n œ œ œ ˙ bbb œ Œ n ww w Í Beethoven, Pathétique Sonata, œOp. œ13, IIIœ (1798), ˙ .. Refrain Figure 25.3.1 ? bb w ˙ nœ œ œ Œ Ó Œ b sequential œtransition follows, leading œ A brief to the mediant (E2 major). w œ œœœ œœœœœœœœ œœœœ. . œ bb œ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ & b œ. ˙ dolce œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ? bb œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ b & b &bb ? b œ œœ œœ œœ œœ . . . . p œœ. œœ. œœ. œœ. ˙˙ .. ˙˙ .. œœ œ ˙ .̇ .̇ n ˙˙˙ . b ˙. ˙˙ .. ˙. ˙. œ & œ J œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ n œœ œ œœ œ n œ œ œ œ œ œ p œ œ ? bb C ‰ Œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ n œ œ œ œ œ b 25. SONATA AND RONDO FORMS CHAPTER 302 148 148 œ œ œ œœœœ bb nœ œ œ nœ œ œ b œ œ Œ & nw œ ˙ œ ww Allegro. . . ˙. j j œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ Í b œ œ . . . œ œ œ œ œ ˙ œ œ . nœ nœ œ œ ? bb bb Cw œ ˙. J Œ JÓ & Œ b œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ wp œ œ œ œ œœ n œœ œœ n œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ n œ œ œ œ œ œ ? bb C ‰ Œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ . . b b œœœ œ œœœœœœœ œœœœœ œ œ œ b ˙ œ œ œ œ & b œ. YT: 05Xyc2FHHRI œ œ œ dolce œ œœ œ œ b bAllegro n œœ œ œ13,n œ III, œ. . ˙˙ .œ œ Œœ œ œ œ b œ œ j . Figure 25.3.2 Beethoven, Pathétique Sonata, œ œ & bbb Cnœwwœ. œ. œœ œœ .œ œJœœ . œ œœ ˙œ œœ œ n œœ œ œœ œœjOp. œ œ œ œœ œœœ œœTransition œœ œœœœœ ? b &The J œ is in the mediant, Eb major, w œ episode (the B section) b b first the relative . Ípminor. The primary purpose œ œ œ ˙ œ œ œ œ œ œ major of C of this first episode to establish œ n œ œ œœ n œœœ œœ ˙œ.n œ œ œ œ œaŒœkey ? bb w œ œŒkey. œ œthatœ the n œ Ó œ œ œ different the starting Notice themes during this episode are ? b b b Cthan œœ œœ œ œ œ œ˙ . ˙˙ .. œ b w ‰ Œ œtuneful. ˙ n ˙˙˙ not &particularly œ œ œ œ . ˙ œ œ œ œ œ ˙ . .̇ . œ . . . . p œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ .̇œ œ œ b ˙. œ œ œ˙œ. . . œ . . . . bb b œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ˙ . œ œœ œœ ˙ œ œ œ œœ œ œœ œ ˙œ. œ n œ œ œ n œ œœ ? b & œ œ Œ & b b œn.Œw œ ˙ œ wwdolce œ œ œ Í œ œœ œ œœ ˙ .œ ? bb œ‰wŒœ œ œ œ œ œŒ œ Ó œ œ œ œ œ œn œ œ œ œŒ œœŒ ˙œ œ˙ . œ œ ˙œ œŒ œ? & b ˙œ œ œ bœ ˙ ˙ b œ œœ œ œ ˙ w ˙ œ œ p b b ? bbbb œ œ ˙œœ b ˙œœ œœ˙ œœ˙œ œ œ˙˙œ..œ˙œ œ œ œœœ bœœœn ˙œœ œœ œ n ˙˙˙œ œb ˙œ˙˙˙ œ... . ˙œ. & œ ˙œœ œœ & b bb œpœ. ˙ p. .œ . œ œ. YT: 05Xyc2FHHRI .̇ œ œ. ˙ .̇ b ˙. dolceœœ. œœ. œœ. œœ. ˙˙ .. Sonata, œ ? b b 25.3.3 Figure Beethoven, Pathétique Op. 13, œ First˙ œ.EpisodeŒ Œ œ œ œ. œ œ œ œ . œ œ œ œ œ. œ œ œ . œ œ œ III, œ œ b œœ first episode œ œ ofœ aœ parallel ?The œ ≈of œthe œ is≈œ clearly œ in ≈theœ form œ≈ melody œ œ œœ œ œ œ ≈ œ ≈ b b b final œ & œ. œnœ œ œ œ œ œ period. œnœ ˙ œœ . ? bb b ‰ Œ & ˙ bb ˙ ˙ . b‰œ œ œ œ ‰˙œ Œn ˙ Œ ‰œ˙œ. œ ˙ œb‰œœ ? ˙ b ˙ ‰ ‰ b œ &bb œ ˙ œ œ œ œ ˙˙n..œ œ œ p œ.œ n œœ. œ. œœ. œ ˙ . œ œ œ .̇ œ œ ˙. . ? b b œ. œ œ ˙pœ. b ˙œ. œ. œ˙. œ˙. œ. ˙œ ˙ œ œ. b œ n œ.̇ œ bœ.˙. b ˙ ˙ . ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ .. œ ? b b b pœŒ œ œ œ œ œ Œ b bb b ‰≈ Œ œ œ. ≈ œ œ. œ. ≈ œ œ œ. Œ≈ Œ ˙ ? ? œ b ≈ œ œ & b b œnœ œ. œ ≈ œ œ˙œ œb. œ œ ˙ ˙ œ ˙ ˙ œ˙ b œ œ œ œ œ & œ œnœ œ YT: 05Xyc2FHHRI p ? Figure Op. III, Conclusion of First ‰ b ˙ ˙ ‰Pathétique ‰œ 13, ‰œ ‰œ œ ? bb bb b 25.3.4 œ ˙ ‰Sonata, n œ œ ˙Beethoven, œ b œ n b ˙ œ œ ˙ œ ˙ œ Episode œœ œœ œ ˙ b œ .˙ œ nœ œ œœ œ œ œ p . . . . . A retransition follows and leads to a half cadence on a G major chord. The ? b b ≈ n œ œ œ. b œ . ≈œ œœ œ refrain follows in C minor. ? bb Figure b . ≈œœœœ . ≈œ œ œ œ œ. œ. & ≈ œ œnœ œ . 25.3.5 ‰Beethoven,‰ Pathétique‰ Sonata, ‰Op. 13, œœ œœ œœ Second Refrain œ n œ œ. œ. YT: 05Xyc2FHHRI œ. ≈ œœ œœ . ‰ œto œ III, ‰œ Retransition nœœ . w œ b . . & bb b b œ œ˙˙ ..œ œ œ œœœ œ œ ˙.̇œ œ œ n œ˙˙. ˙œ œ œ˙˙˙ œ... œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ˙ œ œ œ œ303 . . . AND . RONDO FORMS & b œ. 25. SONATA CHAPTER p dolce . b œ˙. œ œœ.œ œœ. œœ. œ ˙˙ .. œ œ œ .̇ ˙ œ. œ œ ?The bb b second episode (the C section) follows immediately after the Œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ refrain. œŒ œ œ œ œminor. ? second bb œ episode is in Aœ2 major,œ the submediant œ œ œ The (VI) of C b b Œ Œ ˙ œ. œ ˙ & bb b bb ‰ Œ ˙ . ˙ ˙ œ ˙˙ . œb œ b œ ˙ ˙ œ & ˙ œœ ˙ . œ œ œ n ˙˙˙ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ˙ . .̇ . œ p. . . . p ˙ ? b b œ œ œœ. b ˙œœ. œœ˙. œœ˙. ˙œ . ˙ œ b œ n œ.̇ œ b ˙. b ˙ ˙ . ˙. œ ? b b b œŒ ˙ ˙Œ œ ˙ b p . . . . b ? & bb b bb ‰≈ Œœ n œ œ œ ˙ ≈ œ œ œ œ ˙ ≈ œ œ œbœœ ≈ œ œ œ œ & Œ≈ Œ ˙ œ œ ≈ œ ˙œ œb œ ˙ œ œ œ œ ˙ YT:˙05Xyc2FHHRI œnœ œ . œœ . p Figure Op. 13, III, Second Episode ˙‰Beethoven, ? b b 25.3.6 ˙ ‰Pathétique œ ˙ ‰Sonata, ‰œ œ œ b ˙ b œ n‰œ œ on a˙ half b‰œ ˙ cadence n œ œ ˙ ˙on œ ˙ œ b œ A retransition follows the second episode, ending G œ œ œ . œ nœ œ œ œ œ œœ œ. œ major. pœ. . . . ? b b ≈ n œ œ œ. b œ ? bb b œ. ‰ . ≈œœœ œ œ nœ œ . ‰ . ≈œœœœ œœ œ. ‰ . ≈œ œœ œ œœ œ. ‰ & œœ ≈ œ. œœ œnœ . ≈ œœ œœ . ‰œ n œ œ ‰œ œ . YT: 05Xyc2FHHRI Figure 25.3.7 Beethoven, Pathétique Sonata, Op. 13, III, Retransition to Third Refrain An abbreviated version of the refrain follows, leading directly to a restatement of the second episode (the B section), this time in tonic major (C major). YT: 05Xyc2FHHRI Figure 25.3.8 Beethoven, Pathétique Sonata, Op. 13, III, Third Refrain and Second Episode restated in tonic Following the Second Episode is brief retransition that develops final motives of that episode through sequences. YT: 05Xyc2FHHRI Figure 25.3.9 Beethoven, Pathétique Sonata, Op. 13, III, Retransition to Final Refrain After one last statement of the refrain in C minor, the Coda begins immediately after the cadence closing the refrain. CHAPTER 25. SONATA AND RONDO FORMS 304 YT: 05Xyc2FHHRI Figure 25.3.10 Beethoven, Pathétique Sonata, Op. 13, III, Final Refrain . œ œ nœ œ œ œ . œ œ nœ œ œ œ . œ œ nœ œ œ œ œ. # œœ bb œ Œ ‰ b œ Œ ‰ Œ ‰ & b 3 3 3 3 3 3 S S p ƒ cresc. œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ . n œ b œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ. œ œ œ ? bb œ œ œ œœ b b &bb œœ. n œœ. œœ n œœ œœœ œœ œ. n œœ. YT: 05Xyc2FHHRI Figure 25.3.11 Beethoven, Pathétique Sonata, Op. 13, III, Coda ?Tob review a simple, five-part rondo form, see the section on the second b b of Eine kleine nachtmusik in the chapter on Creating Contrast Bemovement tween Sections. 25.3.1 b b Sonata Rondo Form & b Sonata rondo form is a rondo in which the second episode (the C section) is replaced by a development section, resulting in a design of A-B-A-Dev.-A-BA.? b b b 25.4 Rondo Character Rondo b b bcharacter is characterized by quick tempo in duple meter with & character, typically achieved through the use of staccato articulation. light This duple meter could be either simple ( 24 ) or compound ( 68 ). During the Classical?era, the final movement of a multi-movement composition, e.g. a sonata, b b b or symphony, was often in rondo character. Not all pieces in rondo quartet, form are in rondo character. Listen to the following six examples to develop familiarity with rondo character. b 1. &bb ? bb b YT: kmiuh_OL2Zg Figure 25.4.1 Joseph Bologne, Chevalier de Saint-Georges, Violin Concerto No. 9 in G major, Op. 8, III. 2. YT: ysB5SeaJp6s Figure 25.4.2 Haydn, Piano Sonata in D major, H. XVI:37, III. 149 CHAPTER 25. SONATA AND RONDO FORMS 305 3. YT: QYUANirkakg Figure 25.4.3 Haydn, Symphony No. 104 in D major, Hob. I:104, IV. 4. YT: YhGkLPqWjBc Figure 25.4.4 Haydn, String Quartet in E-flat major, Op. 33, No. 2, IV. 5. YT: hwxNp-LzDYo Figure 25.4.5 Mozart, Symphony No. 36 in C major, K.425, IV. 6. YT: H0x_dCrKd4w Figure 25.4.6 Mozart, Symphony No. 39 in E-flat major, K.543, IV. 7. YT: zuMs8kD5Des Figure 25.4.7 Mozart, String Quartet No. 19 in C major, K.465, IV. 25.5 Standard Forms in a Multimovement Classical Piece Below are the forms commonly encountered in the various movements of Classical symphonies, string quartets, and sonatas. 1. First movement: Sonata form 2. Second movement: Ternary form (ABA), sonatina form, or five-part rondo 3. Third movement: Minuet and Trio (Compound Ternary) 4. Fourth movement: Rondo form, sonata form, or sonata rondo form 25.6 Practice Exercises 1. Identify the structural function of each excerpt below as expository, transitional, developmental, or terminative. Aurally identify the tonic CHAPTER 25. SONATA AND RONDO FORMS 306 and determine if the key is maintained or if other keys occur. Listen for cadences to demarcate the form. (a) Haydn, Piano Sonata No. 59 in E-flat major, Hob. XVI:49, I. YT: je74Fhokrxg (b) Beethoven, Symphony No. 5 in C Minor, Op. 67, I. YT: W2qW6fOtAMY (c) Mozart, Piano Sonata No. 18 in D major, K.576, I. YT: rUgMSF49YE4 (d) Mozart, Symphony No. 40 in G Minor, K. 550, I. YT: kWBCjaxVaeE (e) Mozart, Piano Sonata No. 7 in C major, K. 309, I. YT: ZbWsNTiaebY (f) Haydn, Symphony No. 104 In D major, Hob. I:104, I. YT: 21o-aldOI08 (g) Mozart, Piano Sonata No. 7 in C major, K. 309, I. YT: V_i_FMMPKPc (h) Mozart, Piano Sonata No. 18 in D major, K.576, I. YT: rUgMSF49YE4 (i) Mozart, Piano Sonata No. 8 in A minor, K. 310, I. YT: U4K2mz_rPcs (j) Haydn, Piano Sonata No. 60 in C major, Op. 79, Hob. XVI:50, I. YT: EhJ-G0Lp8bI (k) Mozart, Piano Sonata No. 14 in C Minor, K. 457, I. PT = Primary Theme ST = SecondaryTheme CT = ClosingTheme CHAPTER 25. SONATA AND RONDO FORMS EXPOSITION DEVELOPMENT transition ST1 PT 307 RECAPITULATION ST2YT:CT sBYfP1gbTkE Retransition PT transition 0:00 (l) Mozart, Symphony No. 40 in G Minor, K. 550, IV. ST2 CT 4:45 5:12 139 # 3 œ œ œ œ œ œ ˙. . œ . & 4 .. œ œ œ ˙ . YT: B5fqVYXVDwU œ œœ œœ œœ 1:27 3:13 3:48 4:19 3:37 Cadences œ œ 0:48 Listen to ?the pieces below and fill in the diagrams. and # 0:30 œ 1:01 .. 43 .. textural1:36 changes will designate the form—listen carefully for these. 2:07 2:24 2:37 3:04 m.1 (2nd time) 2. ST1 V6 G: I V7 EXPOSITION transition ST ? # .. (2nd time) G: 0:51 V65 I vi D:RECAPITULATION ii I64 V7 I DEVELOPMENT # & .. œ ˙ 0:00 PT I œœ˙ CT I 0:08 0:22 0:58 1:12 V7 I mm. 7-8 in G major CT transition ST .. I6 4 vi 0:45 1:35 EXPOSITION PT transition mm. 9-10 PT IV V7 .. I 2:03 1:40 DEVELOPMENT 2:11 RECAPITULATION ST (CT) Fragmentation & sequencing Retransition PT transition ST (CT) In major: I modulating V V V modulations V pedal I tonicizations I I In minor: i modulating III III III modulations V pedal i tonicizations i i PT = Primary Theme YouTube: https://www.youtube.com/watch?v=Rxsrsp7dLCg ST = SecondaryTheme CT = ClosingTheme Figure 25.6.1 Mozart, Piano Sonata K. 545, I. EXPOSITION PT DEVELOPMENT transition ST1 ST2 CT RECAPITULATION Retransition PT transition ST1 ST2 CT 3:48 4:19 4:32 4:45 5:12 0:00 (2nd time) 1:36 0:30 0:48 1:01 2:07 2:24 2:37 1:27 3:04 3:13 4:32 3:37 YouTube: https://www.youtube.com/watch?v=wPKFdj5V3Bw Figure 25.6.2 Mozart, Eine kleine nachtmusik, K. 525, I. Examples for Assignment 36, Section 1 3. For each excerpt below, identify the structural function as either expository, transitional, developmental, or terminative. (a) Haydn, Piano Sonata No. 59 in E-flat major, Hob. XVI:49, I. YT: je74Fhokrxg 2:31 2:54 CHAPTER 25. SONATA AND RONDO FORMS (b) Mozart, Piano Sonata No. 7 in C major, K. 309, I. YT: ZbWsNTiaebY (c) Beethoven, Symphony No. 5 in C Minor, Op. 67, IV. YT: fOk8Tm815lE (d) Mozart, Piano Sonata No. 8 in A Minor, K. 310, I. YT: U4K2mz_rPcs (e) Mozart, Piano Sonata No. 14 in C Minor, K. 457, I. YT: sBYfP1gbTkE (f) Haydn, Symphony No. 104 in D major, Hob.I:104, IV. YT: QYUANirkakg (g) Mozart, String Quartet No. 17 In B-flat, K.458, IV. YT: nHtaGz8sqTw (h) Mozart, Piano Sonata No. 18 in D major, K.576, I. YT: rUgMSF49YE4 (i) Mozart, Piano Sonata No. 8 in A minor, K. 310, I. YT: U4K2mz_rPcs (j) Haydn, Piano Sonata No. 60 in C major, Hob. XVI:50, I. YT: EhJ-G0Lp8bI (k) Mozart, String Quartet No. 17 In B-flat, K.458, IV. YT: nHtaGz8sqTw (l) Mozart, Piano Sonata No. 14 in C Minor, K. 457, I. YT: sBYfP1gbTkE 308 CHAPTER 25. SONATA AND RONDO FORMS 309 Click here to download the first homework assignment for this chapter. Click here to download the second homework assignment for this chapter. Click here to download the Unit 7 Practice Test. Chapter 26 Voice Leading Triads 26.1 Voice Leading Voice leading, also known as part writing, refers to rules about melodic motions of voices involved in harmonic progressions. The primary concerns behind voice leading rules are independence of parts, voicing of chords, and economy of melodic motion for the sake of singable parts. “SATB” voice leading refers to four-part chords scored for soprano (S), alto (A), tenor (T), and bass (B) voices. Three-part chords are often specified as SAB (soprano, alto, bass) but could be scored for any combination of the three voice types. SATB voice leading will also be referred to as “chorale-style” voice leading. 152 Soprano Alto & c ˙˙ 152 ?c ˙ & c ˙˙ ?c &c ˙ ˙ ˙˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ Tenor Soprano Bass Alto ˙˙ ˙ Soprano Bass Alto Tenor ˙ ˙ ˙˙ ˙ Figure 26.1.1 Soprano, Alto, Tenor, and Bass voices on the grand staff in Tenor “chorale-style” voice leading Bass Soprano “Piano-style” voice leading means the three upper parts are in the upper staff (the right hand part) and the bass is the only Alto voice in bass clef (the left Tenor hand part). ?c &c ˙ ˙˙ ?c ˙ & ˙ Bass ? 26.2 Types of&Motion Figure 26.1.2 “Piano-style” voice leading ? Definitions must be set out regarding types of motion between two parts. 310 CHAPTER LEADING TRIADS ˙ Soprano c ˙ 26. VOICE 152 & ˙ ˙ 311 Alto • Contrary motion occurs when the two voices move in opposite direc? ction˙˙ to each˙ other by Tenor step or leap. ˙ Bass • Oblique motion occurs when one voice stays the same and the other voice moves up or down by step or leap. 152 • Similar motion occurs when both voices move in the same (or “simiSoprano ˙˙ direction—both ˙˙ up (by step or leap) or both down (by step or leap); & clar”) Alto ˙ motion ˙ is also Tenor similar called “direct” motion ˙ ˙ Soprano • c Parallel a specific type of similar motion and occurs when & ? ˙˙ voicesmotion ˙˙ move inis the Alto cboth Basssame direction by the same interval—both up by step, or both down by a third. ˙ Tenor ? c ˙˙ Bass motion ˙ contrary motion oblique similar motion parallel motion ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ & ˙ ? & c˙ ˙˙˙ ? same note ˙ ˙˙˙ ˙ Soprano Alto Tenor ˙ ˙ up (by 3rd) ˙ up (by 2nd) up (by 6th) c 26.2.1 ˙ Figure The ˙ four types Bassof motion ˙ ˙ up (by 2nd) 43 & 917 oblique motion motion parallel motion 26.3contrary Objectionable Parallels # # # ww similar˙nmotion ˙ w ˙ ˙ w ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙& ˙ n ˙ ˙n b b ˙˙˙ n n ˙˙˙ ˙ n ww n ˙ & ˙ ? writing in three or four parts, avoid having any two voices move in parWhen I ¯VI ¯VII up (by 2nd)twelfths C: V allel fifths or parallel octaves (and theirA: octave equivalents—parallel ˙ ˙ and unisons). In˙the Renaissance, Baroque, Classical, G: I ˙ and ¯VIRomantic ?parallel ˙ ¯VII I ˙ ˙ ˙ objectional eras, these parallels were thought to destroy the independence of 921 (by 6th) n wwupconsidered # # # were n ˙ up (by 2nd) Parallel the voices. Parallel 3rds, 4ths, and 6ths acceptable. b ˙ w n w n b ˙˙ b ˙˙ n n ˙˙˙ n ˙˙˙ ww & 2nds and 7ths generally were not used. same note ˙ & ˙˙ ˙ par. 5ths ˙ ˙ ? ˙ ____ ˙ up (by 3rd) ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ par. 5ths ˙˙ ____ ˙ ____˙ n ww # n ww b b b b ww w ˙˙ ˙ ˙ ¯VI ¯VII par. 8ves IV ˙˙ A: ¯VI˙˙ ¯VII par. 5ths ˙ ˙ ____ ˙ par. 5ths____ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙# # ˙ b w b w # # ww b b b ww & b b wwww w Figure 26.3.1 Objectionable parallel fifths and parallel octaves # w 925 1. F: ____ 2. e: ____ & Voice Ranges 26.4 ____ ____ 930 prac test C: I 3. E¯: ____ 4. A¯: ____ ____ I 5. A: ____ ____ ____ For ??the purpose of music theory class, we will set out restrictions for voice ranges that are likely more limited than those found among vocalists in the class. These voice ranges are based on those most commonly found in J.S. ø4 Bach’s1.371 B¯: iiChorales. 2. E: viio42/V 3. f˜: Ger+6 4. b: V56/VI 5. F: EnGer+6 3 Soprano 935 &˙ #˙ Alto & ˙ #˙ ? b˙ Tenor #˙ ? Bass ˙ Figure 26.4.1 Voice ranges for soprano, alto, tenor, and bass voices 939 & ˙ ¯VI ¯VII A: I ¯VI ¯VII G: I # # n ww & # nw I n b b ˙˙˙ b n ˙˙˙ n n ˙˙˙ n ˙˙˙ www CHAPTER 26. VOICE LEADING TRIADS 921 26.5 Rules of Melody C: V ¯VI ¯VII C: I 312 IV Rules of melody have been included in books on composing, writing counter¯VII point, and music theory for centuries. The purpose of the rulesA:of¯VI melody asI described in this text are to aid in the construction of singable melodies and to ____ ____ reflect a____ summary of____ melodic practice____ in music. (Remember that each part in an SATB composition is considered na w melody.) Because these rules of melody # # n wwon the bmelodies b b b wwwfound inb b bJ.S. www 371# #Chorales, b b Bach’s are based b b wwstylistically # www you w w & w w will no doubt w be familiar with exceptions that have occurred in music#composed 152 since1. Bach’s in____ 1750. F: ____ death 2. e: 3. E¯: ____ 4. A¯: ____ 5. A: ____ 925 &c ˙ 930 prac test ˙ Soprano ˙ Bass ˙ resolve: ˙ 7̂ goesAlto 1. Tendency tones should to 8̂ and, to a lesser extent, 4̂ goes____ to 3̂ (other tendency tones are 6̂ and 2̂ , both of which should resolve ____ ____ ____ ____ ˙ Tenor down by step) ? c ˙˙ ? 2. Avoid augmented intervals 3. 1. Leaps larger than a o4 4th of +6diminished should change 6/VI +6 B¯: iiø4 2. E: vii /V and leaps 3. f˜: Ger 4. b: Vintervals 5. F: EnGer 3 2 5 direction after the leap Soprano Tenor & c ˙˙˙ Alto ˙˙˙ Alto Consecutive # ˙ leaps should outline a triadTenor Soprano 935 & 4. #˙ #˙ ? b˙ & ? Bass ˙ The ˙following example how difficult a melody can ˙ be to sing ? demonstrates c˙ ˙ Bass when these rules are broken˙ 939 & œ +5 #œ Figure 26.5.1 941 & contrary motion 7ˆ not resolving &œ ˙ ? œ˙ large leap ?˙ ˙ consec. leaps not outlining triad oblique motion œ ˙ ˙ œ ˙ ? note same ˙ œ˙ ˙ œ˙ similar motion ˙ up (by 3rd) up (by 6th) ˙ ˙ ˙ parallel motion up (by 2nd) ˙ up (by 2nd) 26.6 Rules of Spacing par. 8ves ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ (soprano, ˙ and tenor) ˙˙ & ˙˙ voice parts ˙ ˙ Generally, the upper three alto, are kept close ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ together. The general rule par. is to keep the distance between 5ths soprano par. 5ths 5ths ˙ 5ths ˙˙ of spacing ˙˙ within ˙anpar.octave ˙ ˙˙ par. and alto as well as the?distance between alto to tenor ˙ ˙ of each ˙ other. Allowing a distance greater than an octave between ˙soprano˙and alto ˙ ˙ (or between alto and tenor) is considered spacing error. The distance from the bass to the tenor can be greater than an octave. & ? w w w w Soprano Spacing an 8ve or less Alto Tenor an 8ve or less more than an 8ve okay Bass Figure 26.6.1 In terms of spacing chords, one should consider the spacing that occurs in the overtone series. CHAPTER 26. VOICE LEADING TRIADS & ? & œ ˙œ œ œ œ œb œ ( 313 œ ( bœ ) œ œ œ ) 153 œ ? 26.6.2 Figure œ Overtone series starting on C2 ˙ spaces between notes occur lower in the overtone series. Consider the Larger voicings of the following chords. Some “ring” or resonate better than others. Notice that all of the notes fall within the voice ranges specified above. & w w ww ? &c ?c w w ww ww ww w w ww w w ww w w w w Figure 26.6.3 26.7 & Voice Leading Root Position Triads in Four & Parts œ œ œ ( b œ ) œ ? We?are writingœin four parts but triads have three notes. We will double the œ root of every root position chord. (The root is in the bass when a triad is in ˙ root position, so we are doubling the bass note in an upper part.) Principle 26.7.1 Doubling rule for root position triads. Always double the root in root position triads. & w To move from one chord to the the interval that occurs w next, consider & w in the bassw line between ww chord andwsubsequentwwone. w melodically the current w ? ? 26.7.1 w w w w w w wBass w w w of a 3rd w or 6thw movement ofwthe interval In the upper three parts (soprano, alto, and tenor): retain the two common tones and move the other voice by step & & ? ? ˙˙ Root ˙˙ 5th 3rd Root Bass moves by 3rd C: I ˙˙ ˙˙ iii Root 5th 3rd Root ˙˙ ˙ ˙ 5th 3rd Root Root ˙˙ ˙˙ Root 5th 3rd Root Bass moves by 6th C: I & vi Figure 26.7.2 ? 26.7.2 Bass movement of the interval of a 4th or 5th In the upper three parts, do one of the following: & ? 153 ˙ Root Root ? ˙˙˙ 5th 5th ? ˙ Root ˙ ˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ 5th 5th 3rd 3rd Root Root 3rd 3rd Root Root Root Root Root CHAPTER 26. LEADING TRIADS Bass moves by 6th BassVOICE moves by by 3rd 3rd Bass moves by 6th Bass moves C: II C: iii iii C: II C: ˙˙˙ 5th 5th 3rd 3rd Root Root 314 vi vi 1. Retain the common tone and move the other two voices by step & & ? ? ˙˙˙ ˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙˙˙ ˙ ˙˙˙ 3rd 3rd 5th 5th Root Root Root Root Bass moves by 5th Bass moves by 5th C: I C: I ˙˙˙ ˙ ˙˙˙˙ 3rd ˙˙˙ 3rd ˙ 5th 5th ˙˙ Root Root Root ˙˙ Root 5th 5th Root Root 3rd 3rd Root Root Root Root 3rd 3rd 5th 5th Root Root Bass moves by 4th Bass moves by 4th C: I IV C: I IV V V 2. Move all of the upper voices in the same direction (each upper voice will move by a 2nd or 3rd to the nearest chord member in the second chord) 154 & & ˙˙ ? ˙ ˙? Root˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ 5th 3rd & ˙ 5th Root ˙˙ Bass moves by 5th ˙ 3rd ˙ Root V ? ˙ C: I ˙ Root Root Root ˙˙ ˙ ˙ 3rd Root 5th 5th Root 3rd ˙˙ ˙ ˙ Root 5th 3rd Root Bass moves by 4th C: I 3rd Root 5th Root IV 26.7.3Bass Bass of the interval of a 2nd movesmovement by 2nd C: I ii Move the three upper parts in contrary motion to the bass line. 154 & ˙˙ ?˙ ˙ & ˙˙ ˙ ˙3rd 3rd ?˙ ˙3rd Root * exception: 3rd of V resolves up by step; Root3rd results in doubled * 5th 3rd 5th ˙ ˙ Root ˙˙ ˙ ˙ 5th 3rd Root Root Bass moves by 2nd 5th C: I Root ii Root Bass moves by 2nd C: V 26.7.3 vi Figure Exception: the bass by the interval of a 2nd in the deceptive 3rd of V chordWhen is not in& melody, canmoves resolve down progression in the minor mode (V–VI in C minor), always move the 3rd of & ˙ Root up by step˙˙while the V˙chord the other notes (the 5th and the doubled root) ? 5th 5th 3rd move in contrary motion to the bass. In this situation, two voices move in an ˙ Root 3rd upward and two voices move in a downward direction. This results ? ˙ direction in a doubled ˙ Root 3rd in the˙VIRootchord. In the major mode, use this voice-leading solution if 7̂ is in the soprano voice (because it is a tendency tone). C: V vi b & b b n ˙˙ ? bb ˙ b ˙ ˙ ˙ 3rd 5th ˙˙ Root Root c: V bad n˙ ˙ 3rd 3rd ˙ ˙ 5th Root VI c: V aug. 2nd ˙ ˙ ˙˙ VI ˙ 3rd to deal with Roottwo possible˙ways two examples &The˙˙ following ˙˙ 5th demonstrate˙˙ the 3rd 5th Figure 26.7.4 Voice leading the deceptive progression in minor the deceptive the major mode.3rd Root Root progression in ? ˙˙ 5th Root ˙˙ 3rd Root ˙˙ 5th Root ˙ ˙ Root Root repeated root: change chord member while maintaing correct doubling (Root, Root, 3rd, 5th) C: I I I I ˙ 3rd ˙ Root Root ?˙ ˙˙˙Root ˙˙ 5th & Root 3rd 5th Root ˙ Root Bass moves by 2nd ˙ ˙ 3rd Root CHAPTER 26. VOICE LEADING TRIADS Bass moves by 2nd ? C: I ii ˙ ˙ Root C: I ii Root ˙ 3rd ? ˙ Root & ˙˙ 315 Bass moves 3rd by 2nd * exception: of V resolves up by step; results iniidoubled 3rd * exception: 3rd of V up by step; C:resolves I * results in doubled 3rd 3rd * *3rd exception: 3rd of V resolves up by step; 5th 3rd 3rd 3rd ˙ ˙ results in doubled 3rd ˙˙* 3rd 5th ˙ 3rd Root &˙ ˙˙ ˙ 3rd ? Root & ˙˙ 3rd 5th ˙ ˙ Root ? Root ˙ 5th Bass ˙ ˙ Root Root ˙ Rootmoves by 2nd vi˙ 5th C: V ? Bass moves by 2nd ˙ ˙ Root C: V vi 3rd ofRoot V chord is not in melody, can resolve down 5th & ˙˙ ˙˙ & ˙˙ Root ˙ ˙5th ˙ Root 5th ? Root &˙ ˙˙3rd3rd ˙˙ 5th ˙ Root 5th Root 3rd ˙ ˙ Root ? 3rd ˙ ˙ Root C: vi 3rd ?˙VRoot ˙ Root ˙ Root aug. 2nd ˙ Root bad C: V vi b C: V vi ˙ 3rd n˙ & b b n ˙˙ 3rd ˙ aug. 2nd ˙˙ ˙bad3rd aug. 2nd bad 5th b n ˙ 7̂ in an inner ˙ ˙voice in the deceptive Figure n˙˙ 3rd progression & b b 26.7.6 n ˙˙˙ in major ˙ ? bb bb b˙ n3rd Root 3rd ˙ & 5th ˙ 3rd ˙ 5th ˙˙ 5th ˙˙ b 3rd ˙ Root ˙ Root 3rd 26.7.4 bass note ˙ Root ? ofb ˙c:the ? b b Repetition ˙ Root ˙ V VI c: V VI 5th ˙˙ 5th ˙ b b ˙ ˙ b ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ Root ˙ ˙ Root Root Root Repeat the upper three notes or arpeggiate the upper notes to different chord ˙VI3rd members while maintaining the voicing of a doubled the root, one 3rd and one ˙ VI c: VRoot c: V V & ˙˙VIc:3rdV ˙˙c:VI ˙ 5th 5th 5th. ˙ 3rd Root Root ˙ Root 3rd ˙˙5th 3rd Root ˙ ?˙ ˙˙ 5th 3rd Root & ˙ ˙˙ Root 5th ˙ 3rd & ˙˙ 3rd ˙ 5th ˙ Root 5th Root 5th ˙ ˙ ˙ Root 3rd Root ˙repeated Root 3rd Root Root root: change chord member while maintaing correct doubling (Root, 3rd, 5th) ˙I Root, Root ˙ I˙ ˙ 3rd I ˙5th ?C: I˙˙ 5th Root 5th ˙ 5th ˙ ˙ ˙ Figure 26.7.5 7̂ in the soprano voice in the deceptive progression in major Bass moves by 2nd C: V vi 3rd of V chord is not in melody,Root can resolve down 5th 5th 3rd can resolve down 3rd of V chord is not in melody, ? ˙ Root ˙˙ 3rd Root Root ˙ Root Root ˙Root Root I I Root repeated root: change chord member while maintaing correct doubling (Root, Root, 3rd, 5th) repeated root: change chord correct doubling (Root, C: I member while maintaing I I Root, 3rd, 5th) I C: I I Figure 26.7.7 Repeated notes in the bass line 26.8 Voice Leading First-Inversion Triads Instead of focusing on the intervallic distance the bass part travels between roots of chords, voice leading first inversion triads requires focusing on the doubling or voicing of the chord itself. When approaching or leaving a first inversion chord, move as smoothly as possible while avoiding objectionable parallels, spacing errors, and melodic errors. 26.8.1 Voicing a First Inversion Chord In contrast to the doubling rule for root position chords (i.e., “double the bass”), do not double the bass note for first inversion triads. Instead, double the root or fifth, depending on which can be approached and left most smoothly. ? # ### #c & # cw www w CHAPTER 26. VOICE LEADING TRIADS A: ____ ____ w w w w ____ ____ ____ 316 ____ ? # # # B¯c F/A Gm wC/E Fw w5th w 3 ˙ œ b œ˙ œ 5thRt œœ & 4 ˙A: ____ œ____ Rt ____ ____ œœ GmœCm/E¯ 5th œ F/A Rt œ ? b 43 ˙œ B¯œ œ 3rd œ 3rd œ F b œœ 5th œ˙ œ Rt œœ & b 43 ˙˙ 5th Rt w ____ œœ œ Rt œ 5th œ ˙ œ œ ? b b 43D œ Bm D/F œ œ 3rd˜ G # # c YT:œ8ZKxI8d4VbM œ 3rd œœ I œ Vœœ 5th viœ ii V & Figure 26.8.1 J.S. Bach,B¯: Chorale 237, “GottRtlebel noch”, BWV 320 5th ˜œ Gœ ? # # c œœ D œœ Bmœ œ D/F ## c œ œœ œœ œ 3rdœœ 5th œœ & Rt D: I vi I IV ? # # c œœ œœ œ œ 5th œ œ B¯ E¯ œ 3rd Aœ/C B¯ F: IV I6 ii V6 6 w ____ I 6 6 o F/A œ b c D:œœ I vi œ I IV 3rd ( œ) œ œ b œ œ & œ Rt œ ## œ œ œ 5th œ œ & ? b b c œ YT: 3B9KD9CJ3tA œ (œ) œ 3rd œ œ Figure 26.8.2 J.S. Bach, Chorale 153, “Alle Menschen müssen sterben”, BWV 262 ? # inversion If the 3rd of a first#B¯: is doubled, I IV it will beviiin one ofI the following V 6 o6 6 situations: 1. Diminished triads in first inversion—always double the third (the bass), not the root or fifth w w ____ 1. ____ w ____ w .. w .. ____ 2 ____ .. w __ œœ œ œ 5th œ œ œ 3rd œ ? # # c œœ D: ILEADING vi I6 IV CHAPTER 26. VOICE TRIADS B¯ E¯ b & b c œœ œ ? b c b œ œœ œ œ B¯: I 317 Ao/C œœ œ œ ( œ) IV B¯ Rt 5th 3rd viio6 œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ 3rd F/A ( ) I V6 YT: Lul-S82JIeM Figure 26.8.3 J.S. Bach, Chorale 103, “Nun ruhen alle Wälder”, BWV 392 2. Consecutive first inversion chords—alternate between doubling the third and not doubling the third E/G˜ ## & # c œœ œ ? ### c œ œœ A 158 5th œ œ Rt 3rd V6 A: I 158 Rt D/F˜ œœ œ œ C˜m/E œ Rt œ 3rd Rt œœ 5th œ 3rd œ 3rd iii6 ii6 Rt 5th 3rd 3rd IV6 Bm/D œœ 5th Rt E/G˜consecutive D/F˜ 1st C˜m/E inversionBm/D triads ## & # c œœ # ### œœ ? # &# c œœ A œœ Rt œ Rt œ 5th 5th œ Rt œ 3rd œ Rt œ 3rd œ 3rd œ 3rd YT: QSv7SkXmhFI Rt œœ 5th œ 3rd œ 3rd Rt 5th Figure 26.8.4 J.S. Bach, 6Chorale6 106, “Jesu Leiden, Pein und Tod”, A: I V IV iii6 ii6 BWV 245 # ? ## consecutive 1st inversion triads 3. Approached in opposite direction in both parts & b c œœ œ ?b c œ F: ii &b œœ . 3rd œ œ J œœ œ 3rd ˙ œ ˙ ˙ œœ œ œ 3rd ˙ œ I6 ii6 I6 viio6 œœ œœ 3rd IV ii7 YT: 7OQrWJvezT4 Figure 26.8.5 Palestrina, Missa Aeterna Christi Munera, Sanctus ? b never double the third of the V chord because it is the Note that you should leading tone (7̂ ). œ. œ ?b c œ œ œ J œ œœ œœ 3rd CHAPTER 26. VOICE LEADING TRIADS œ ˙ œœ œ ˙œ ˙ 3rd œ 318 26.9 Voice Leading Second Inversion Triads F: ii I6 IV ii6 I6 ii7 viio6 When a triad is in second inversion, double the fifth (the bass note). b &b c B¯ E¯ D Gm œœ œ œœ 3rd œœ 5th ˙. ˙. ˙˙ .. œ œ Rt # œ œ œ œ 5th œ œœ ? b c œ b œ g: III &b Gm/D VI b i64 V i YT: ivm4RACsrBU ? bb Figure 26.9.1 J.S. Bach, Chorale 204, “Wer weiß, wie nahe mir”, BWV 166 26.10 Special Situations Avoid parallel fifths when the roots of triads are a second apart, as in the following examples: 1. ii6 to I64 (see the first measure in the examples below) 2. I to vii◦6 (see the second measure the in examples below) & & ? ? ˙ ˙ 5th ˙ ˙ Root ˙ ˙ Root ˙ ˙ 5th || 5ths || 5ths C: ii6 C: ˙˙ 5th ˙˙ 5th ˙˙ Root ˙˙ Root I64 ii6 I64 ˙˙ 5th ˙ ˙ Root ˙ Root ˙ ˙ 5th || 5ths || 5ths ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙ ˙˙ ˙ 5th 5th Root Root C: I viio6 C: I viio6 Figure 26.10.1 Parallel fifths when roots are a 2nd apart & & ? ? ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙ ˙˙ ˙ C: ii6 ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙ ˙˙ ˙ ii6 I64 Root 5th Root 5th C: || 4ths || 4ths I64 Root Root 5th Root 5th Root 5th 5th ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙ ˙˙ ˙ || 4ths || 4ths ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ C: I viio6 C: I viio6 Root 5th Root 5th & 26.10.2 Parallel fourths as a corrective when roots are a 2nd apart Figure & In any such situation where the roots are a second apart (even if the chords are?inverted), revoice each chord so the 5th of the chord is below the root of the?chord in the upper voices & & ? ? 165 165 œ ?b c œ œœ œœ 3rd ˙ œœ œ œ 3rd ˙ œ ii6 viio6 CHAPTER 26. VOICE LEADING TRIADS I6 F: ii IV I6 ii7 319 26.11 Types of Six-Four Chords When you are harmonizing melodies and writing music, there are three situabb c & œ use a œœ64 Rtchord. ˙˙ .. # œœ tions where it is appropriate to œœ œ œ B¯ E¯ Gm/D D Gm œœ œ œœ 3rd œœ 5th V ˙. ˙. typically occurs in the patterns I–IV 64 –I 5th 1. Pedal 6 4 6 2. Passing ? 4 3. Cadential The pedal 6 4 œ bb c œ 6 4 g: III i64 VI & œœœ œœ œ œœœ C: I IV64 I ? œ œ œœ œ œ œ C: V i œœ œ or V–I 64 –V. œ œœ œ œ I64 V Figure 26.11.1 Examples with the Pedal Six-Four The passing 64 typically occurs in the patterns I–V 64 –I 6 (or its retrograde) and IV–I 64 –IV 6 (or its retrograde). & œœœ œœ œ œœ œ C: I V64 I6 ?œ œ œœ œ œ œ C: IV œœ œ œœ œ I64 IV6 œ œ Figure 26.11.2 Examples with the Passing Six-Four In an earlier section we discussed the Cadential that section to review the cadential 64 chord. 6 4 chord. Please refer to & 26.12 Summary of Doubling Rules for Triads ? To generalize, here are the doubling rules for voice leading triads in root position, first inversion, and second inversion: • Root Position Chords: DOUBLE THE BASS • First-Inversion Chords: DO NOT DOUBLE THE BASS ◦ Exception: vii◦6 and ii◦6 : DOUBLE THE BASS ◦ Exception: Consecutive first inversion chords—alternate between DOUBLE THE BASS and DO NOT DOUBLE THE BASS • Second-Inversion Chords: DOUBLE THE BASS 26.13 Practice Exercises Day One 159 ? bb c œ b œ Rt œ œ # c œ œ E¯: I vi IV TRIADS ii CHAPTER 26. VOICE LEADING 1. 156 HW e: III 5th Rt œ œ œ iv V VI 320 For bass movement of a 3rd or 6th, in the upper voices hold two common tones and move the other voice For bass movement # # cbyœ step. 5th Rt b c œœmove of& a 2nd, the upper voices in contrary motion to the bass with œ 3rd 5th the exception of the deceptive progression, which has special rules. œ Rt doubling by specifying whichœ voice 3rd Keep track of has the œ root,œ third, ? # œ c c œ # or fifth for each chord. œ Rt œ cb œ Rt œ & b œ œ 5thRt5th # c œ 3rd b b c œœœ 3rd & œ HW d:œ III3rd Rt iv V VI D: I Rt iii IV ii 156 PRAC EXER ?c œ ˙ œ Rt œ œ œ 5th œ Rt & ? #b b# # œc 5th # 5th œœ RtRt œ œ œ œœœ 3rd c b œ ____ œ ____ b b cc œ____ œ ____ œ & œ Bass moves by: ____ ____ Rt HW 5th Rt œ 3rd III VIœ iv VI ? ca: i œ VII ˙ œe: III Vœiv œIV HW E¯: Rt I 3rdœ vi ii V VI œ U œ ? # # #3 c œRt œ œ œ œ b œ c œ and b œhold For bass of tone Rt Bass ____ ____œeither ____(1)œ ____ one common ____ Bach chorale #2222. &moves 4by:movement œœ ____ œœ a 4th, ˙˙ œ 5th ( nRtœ ) move a:the by III step, orVI(2) moveivthe upper Nun preiset alle ??? i two voices VII V voices VI in the same A: iii IV V vi B¯: V vi IV ii direction. Keep track of doubling by specifying which voice has the U # œ œ ˙ 3rd œ # 5th œœ each chord. # cœ œ Rt c3 œœ or root, ? œ) for & #bthird, Bach chorale #222 & 4 œœ 5thRtRt3rd (fifth œœ œ # œœc (5thn3rdœ ) ˙˙ 3rd b b Nun preiset alle ??? b c œ œœœ 3rdRt œ u œ b œ Rt & œ HW HW œ 5th Bass moves by: ____ ____ ____ œ œ ? b c œœ œ3rdRt ____ # œ ˙ œ œ œ c œ # œ ? # G: 3 ____ (œ)œ ____ ____ ____ Rt ____ œœ œ PRAC EXER ? b 4b cœ RtRt # œc œœ 5th u˙ œ œ bb Rt œ IV œ HW œ Rtiv œ V____ VI œ ____ D: I ____ iii ii Bass movesd:by:III bb œ f:Rt i ____ ˙ III œ G: vi ii ____ V I œœ ____ & # #G:œ____ ˙ iv ____ VII 5th œ b____ 5th Rt # œ œ c b c œœ 3rd & œ 3rdœ ˙ œ (œ) œ̇ # Rt Day Two ? b œ Rt( ) 5th5th ˙ œ # œœ œ œ c œœœ œœRtœ 3rd3rd˙˙ œ œ œ b cœœ 5th œ HW 3. & œ œbass b symbols, Given the bass line and figured the Roman 5th analyze # œ ? # œ œ œ œ HW c œ c # œ œ in b numerals alto, and tenor parts Bass moves by: ____ add soprano, œ____RtRt ˙the____staffœ and 3rd œœ below (œ ) œ̇ œ Rt ˙ ? œ # “chorale-style,” following good# voice Choose the becA: œRt(iii) Rt ____ cB¯:œV leading. œ œrulesviof____ œV____ B¯: IV vi IV iiœ Rt œ b b ____ ginning register for each upper part carefully, considering the number c œœ b b bcb____ &B¯: œ # c 3rd œœ Rt œ # œ c œœ 5thœ Rt œ of the a 2nd.VII iii V interval of b: iv Basstimes movesB¯: by:the ____bassvimoves ____ ii by ____ PRAC EXER 4. HW ? b b cb cœ & b œ 3rd ____ Rt 5th ____ œœ œœ œ œ ____ ____ Rt ____ œ œ ˜ III œ œœ VI œ œœ f: i iv VII III G: vi V I œ ii ____ œ œ œ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ? d:c ____ œ œ œ œ b # # cnumerals Givenb b the bass line, Roman below the staff and 5th œ the c œœ œ analyze ˜ œœ œ & œ 5th œ (allœ threeœ upper 3rd add soprano, alto, and tenor parts in “keyboard-style” d: ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ voices in the clef), following rules of good voice leading. Choose œ treble Rt œ ?beginning the for considering the b c œ Rt register c œcarefully, œ œ eachœ upper# #part b Rt œ œ direction of the bass line. # vi ii V b: iv VII III VI & cB¯: iii ?# c œ G: ____ œ œ œ ____ ____ ____ ˙ ____ Day Three 5. Analyze the Roman numerals in the blanks below the staff and the doublings of the chords in the squares—specifying Root, 3rd, or 5th—for J.S. Bach’s Chorale 367, Befiehl du deine Wege. 155 ? # # c œœ PRAC EX œ 5 œœ R œœ 5 R TRIADS 3 CHAPTER 26. VOICER LEADING # & b # c œœ b c I D: ____ 160 & PRAC EX 6. HW œœ 7. R 3 R œ œ R R 321 viio6 ii ____ ____ I ____ ____ œœ œœ œœœ œœ œœœ œ œœ ? # #g: ____ HW œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ wœœ œ œ œ 6 6 ˜ œ g: ____ ____ ____ ____ œœ____œ ____ ? #b# cD:œœ ____ œ ____ œœ œ____ ____ ____ œ & b c œœ œœ w # œ # œ œ œ) w(analyze Givenb b the bass the Roman nuœœ line andœfigured œbass symbols, œ c & D:and œ œ____ œ tenor œ œadd soprano, merals and parts in chorale style. Review œ ____ ____ alto, ____ ____ ____ œœ ww ? b b# c rule for doubling œin diminished the special triads in first inversion. You œ œ œœ # œ (œ ) alterations. œ œ may wish to review figured bass with chromatic œ & ? b c #œ 6 6 ˜ bb i viio6 i6 V VI ____ ____ ____ ____ & b g:c ____ ? ?#b b## #c cœ & œ 160 IV ____ I6 5 ____ ____ ____ ? bb c œ œœ œœ œœ www & b œ b c & b (one of several 6 œ6 œ˜ ww possible solutions) œ œ ? b b g:c ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ œ œ œ ˙ œ ˙ ? bb c œ œ sureœ your progression follows the Harn œ 6 making b I the melody Harmonize V I ii6 V b ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ monic (analyze the harmonic function of each chord, ab6 6 Ω & b B¯:Flowchart Ton. Dom. Ton. Pre-dom. Dom. HF: ____then____ ____ ____ ____bass parts breviated as “HF”), add alto, tenor,____ and c: ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ in chorale style following rules of good voice leading. Use first-inversion chords ? b a smoother bass line. to make b# & b# c œ &b c ?# ? b b# cc PRAC EX œœ œ œ œ ˙ œ ˙ w D: ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ B¯: HF: ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ # ____ #HF: & # c œ œ œ____ œ œ œ ____ ____ ____ œ œ œ ____ œ Day Four ? # # # cthe figured bass symbols to specify Roman numerals with 8. Analyze inversion symbols below the staff. Add soprano, alto, and tenor parts 6 A: Istyle. VSpecify I root, third, IV6 V6 fifth for I every V chord. vi Addiin keyboard and tionally, specify the six-four chord type (pedal, passing, or cadential). # & # c ? ## c œ b: ____ 6 chord 4 9. type: 6 4 ____ œ 6 4 ˜ ˙ ____ ____ ____ œ œ 6 6 ____ ____ ____ For the given Roman numeral progression, provide soprano, alto, i V64 i6 iio6 i6 V i tenor, and bass voices in chorale style. Be4 careful not to exceed any cadential passing root, third, and fifth voice’s range. Specify for every chord. Additionally, specify the six-four chord type. 161 4 e: ____ 6 4 ____ ____ ____ chord type: ____ ____ ____ ____ CHAPTER 26. VOICE LEADING TRIADS 322 b &bb c ? bb c b c: i 6 4 chord type: b iv i64 ____ iv6 iio6 i64 V VI ____ b c Click here & to download the first homework assignment for this chapter. Click here to download the second homework assignment for this chapter. Click here ? to b download the third homework assignment for this chapter. Click here btocdownload the fourth homework assignment for this chapter. PDF versions of the textbook, homework exercises, and practice exercises can be found at musictheory.pugetsound.edu &b b ? bb Chapter 27 Voice Leading Seventh Chords 27.1 Voice Leading Seventh Chords There is one general rule for voice leading any seventh chord: resolve the 7th of the chord down by step. All other voices should move smoothly to the nearest chord tone in a voicing containing the appropriate doubling. Principle 27.1.1 7th chords. Resolve the 7th of a 7th chord down by step. ? bb bb ? bb bb ? bb bb ? bb bb œ œ 242 œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ 4 pp 242 œ œœ 4 œ Textural reduction: reduction: Textural ? bb bb 22 œœœœ ? bb bb 44 A¯ A¯ ? b bb 2 œ b 4 A¯: II A¯: œœ œœœœ œ E¯77/D¯ /D¯ E¯ A¯/C A¯/C œœœœ œ œœœœ.. œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ 7th 7th resolves down down by by step step resolves 6 V442 V II6 2 323 œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœœ œœ E¯/G E¯/G œ V66 V YT: SrcOcKYQX3c bbb b & Figure 27.1.2 Beethoven, Pathétique Sonata, Op. 13, II. ? b b bb j œœœj 7th œœœ 7th œœ E¯77/G /G E¯ V656 V 5 œœœ œ A¯ A¯ œ II 163 163 ? ? ###### ww ww ww CHAPTER 27. VOICE LEADING SEVENTH CHORDS 401 401 401 401 ### ## & & # ### ## & & # ? ? ###### ### ## & & # 686 jj œ œ 8 œœ œœ .. œœ œœ œ œJJ Ich träum - te von bun - ten Ich träum - te von bun - ten 686 ‰ 8 ‰ œœ p 686 ‰ pœJœ 8 ‰ J Textural Textural reduction: reduction: 406 406 406 406 j œj œ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œ ‰‰ ‰‰ œJœJ ‰‰ ‰‰ Blu - men, Blu - men, so wie sie wohl blü - hen im Mai; so wie sie wohl blü - hen im Mai; jj œœ œœœ ŒŒ Bm7/D /D A EEœ7 (œ ) œ A j Bm . j œ ( ) œ . œ œ . j œœ ‰ œœœ œœ . (œ( œ)) œœ œœ œœ ‰ œ œœ œœ œ ? b b 2 œœœ A: b b 4 A: œœœ II ? bb 2 bb 4 œ œ 7th œœ œ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œ j ‰‰ œJœJ ‰‰ ‰‰ œœj ‰‰ ‰‰ œ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœJ ‰‰ ‰‰ œœJ ‰‰ ‰‰ œœ ‰‰ J J JJ 686 jj œ œ 8 œœœœ œœ.œ. œœ œœ œœ œ œJJ œ ? bb 2 b b 4 Ich œträum - te œvon bunœ- ten œBlu - men, œ so träum - te von bun - ten Blu - men, so ### ## 6 Ich p ‰ œ. & œœœœœ..... œ œœœœœ..... ? & b b b#b 42868 œ‰ œœœœœœ...... œ œœœ ... œ. œ. pp œ. Textural œœ.. ? ? ##reduction: œœ.. A¯/Cœœ.. #### 6868 A¯‰‰ œ . E¯ /D¯ 7 324 j j œ (œ) œ œœ œœj ŒŒ œœj œœ .. ((œœ)) œœ œ .. (œ) œ œœ ‰‰ F˜˜m m F jœj œ œ. A A . .. ww œœ œ vivi œœ œ œ œ 7 7 œ œ œ œ wie sie wohl blü - hen im Mai; wie sie wohl blü - hen im Mai; œœœœ ... 7th7th œœœœœ.. ... œœ ..œœœ ... . œ .7th œœ . .. œœE¯/G 7th œ 7th 6œ iiii655œ œœ. . E¯7/G œœ 7 œV7 V œ .œ . A¯ II œ YT: 2GGPY3mhqLc resolves down by step A¯: I Schubert, Winterreise, V42 I6 V6 V56 I Figure 27.1.3 D. 911, “Frühlingstraum” (1823) The one exception to this is in the progression I – V43 – I6 , which closes the theme of the first movement of Mozart’s Piano Sonata K. 331. ### 6 œ & 8 œœ f ? # # # 68 œ œ j œœ œ J œ œ J œ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œ J E7/B A/C˜ V43 I6 œ œ œ œœ œ œ J œ œœ œ J ‰ ‰ ### 3 œ œœ 7th œœ YT: vp_h649sZ9A & 4 œ Figure 27.1.4 Mozart, Piano Sonata K. 331, I œ œ œ # example below, one can see that the 7th resolves up by step. ?In#the 3 # 4 œ œ œ A ## & # ? ### A: I .. .. 163 J J œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ J J J LEADING SEVENTH CHAPTER 27. VOICE CHORDS f ? # # # 68 œ œ ## & # 43 œœ œ ? ### 3 4 œ A E7/B A/C˜ V43 I6 .. ‰ 325 œœ œ œ œœ 7th œ œ A: I œœ Figure # # 27.1.5 The I – V43 – I6 progression with acceptable parallel fifths # &Notice that parallel fifths occur in this progression because of the upward resolution of the 7th. These parallel fifths may have been deemed less objectionable ? # # because they consist of unequal fifths (where one of the fifths is in a case #of parallel fifths is diminished). 27.2 Voice Leading Successive Seventh Chords Sometimes you will encounter a situation where there are successive seventh chords. This is especially the case in circle of fifth progressions. When voice leading a circle of fifths progression with root position seventh chords in four parts (SATB), alternate between incomplete seventh chords (without the fifth of the chord) and complete seventh chords, as can be seen in the example below from Vivaldi’s Concerto for Two Violins and Cello in D minor, RV 565. 32 32 32 32 32 32 String String Orch. Orch. Cello Cello solo solo 34 34 String String Orch. Orch. 34 34 34 34 Cello Cello solo solo & bb & ?b ?b ?b ?b & bb & ?b ? b 44 4 44 4 Dm Dm3rd œ œœ œœ œ œ 3rd 5th 5th 3rd 3rd Rt Rt Gm7 7 Gm7th œœ œœ œ œ œ Œ Œ Œ Œ 7th 3rd 3rd Rt Rt Rt Rt C7 C7 œœ œœ œ Œ Œ Œ Œ 3rd 3rd 7th œ œ 7th 5th 5th Rt Rt Œ Œ Œ Œ Fmaj7 Fmaj7 œœ œœ œ œ œ Œ Œ 7th 7th 3rd 3rd Rt Rt Rt Rt Œ Œ œœœ œœ œœœ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ 44 œ œ œ œ œœ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œœ 4 œ d: i d: i B¯maj7 B¯maj7 œœ œœ œ œ œ 3rd 3rd 7th 7th 5th 5th Rt Rt iv7 (inc.) iv7 (inc.) Eø7 Eø7 œœ œœ œ Œ Œ Œ Œ 7th 7th 3rd 3rd Rt Rt Rt Rt Œ Œ Œ Œ VII7 VII7 Am7 Am7 œœ 7th 3rd œœ 7th œ 5th 5th œ RtRt œ7 3rd Œ Œ Œ Œ IIIM7 (inc.) IIIM7 (inc.) Dm7 7 Dm7th œœ œœ œ œ œ 7th 3rd 3rd Rt Rt Rt Rt Œ Œ Œ Œ œ œ v i7 (inc.) 7 v i7 (inc.) ? b œ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œ ? œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ b VIM7 VIM7 iiø7 (inc.) iiø7 (inc.) ∑ ∑ ∑ Two Violins ∑ ∑ RV Figure 27.2.1 Concerto for and∑ Cello in∑ D minor, & bb Vivaldi, ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ & 565, V. 36 36 ?b ? b 36 36 ?b ?b 36 36 YT: qgJwavKDKgY ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ 5 5 CHAPTER 27. VOICE LEADING SEVENTH CHORDS 326 Principle 27.2.2 Voice Leading Successive Root Position 7th chords. Alternate between complete and incomplete voicings. If, on the other hand, you are asked to voice lead a circle of fifths progression involving inverted seventh chords, always resolve the seventh of each chord down by step and move the other voices smoothly. You will see the following pattern: two voices will remain on common tones (shown with ties) while the other two voices resolve downward by step. &b b & ? b ? b 164 164 44 œœœ 4 œœ 44 œ 4 4d: ivœ56 4 œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œ œ VII42 IIIM65 œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ VIM42 iiø65 œ ˙˙ ˙ ˙˙ ˙ # œœ œ # œœ œ œ œ ˙i6 V42 6 Figure d:27.2.3 iv56 Circle VII42 of fifths IIIM6progression VIM42 with iiøinverted V427th chords i6 (alternating 5 5 6 4 and ) 5 24 œ œ œ &b b & ?b ?b 164 4 œœ 44 œœ 44 œ 44d: ivœ 7 œ œ œœœ œœ œœ œ œ œ VII43 œœœ œœœ œœ œ œœ œ œœ #œ œ # œœ VIM43 iiø7 V43 œ IIIM7 œ ˙˙˙ ˙˙˙ ˙ œ ˙i 3 3 3 3 &4 Figure 27.2.4 Circle of fifths progression with alternating 7 and 43 chords œ œœ œœ 4 œ œœ œœ ˙˙ # œœ 3 &b 4 œ œ œ œ œ œ & 4 ˙ ? 43 ˙ ˙ 7 œ œ the œ Vœ to Iœ Progression 27.3 Voice œ ? 4Leading ˙ ? 43 ˙ ˙b 4 7 d: iv VII III VI iiø V i d: iv7 VII4 IIIM7 iiø7 VIM4 V4 i M6 M4 four parts, 6 4 must 6deliberately In voice leading the 56V to I42 progression in one 5 5 2 2 choose one of the following methods: 1. “Strict” resolution: b 4 œœ & 4 œ 7 œœœ œœ œ œœœ œœ œ œ # œœ ˙˙˙ (a) Complete V to incomplete I: resolve 7̂ up and 4̂ and 2̂ down. This œ œ 3rd of ? b 44resolving œ the Vœ7 chord (œ7̂ ) up and means the œ the˙7th and 5th 7 of the V chord down. For the sake of consistency in terminology, 4 the chord. d: iv7 VII43 label IIIM77̂ , 2̂VI,M43and the iiø7 7th Vof i the examples below The 3 incomplete I chord will have a tripled root and one 3rd. & c ˙˙ ˙ ?c ˙ 7̂ 7th 2̂ C: V7 complete ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ I incomplete ˙˙ ˙ ˙ 2̂ 7̂ 7th V7 complete ˙ ˙ ˙ I incomplete (b) Incomplete V7 (no fifth) to complete I. & c ˙˙ 7th ? c ˙˙ 7̂ C: V7 incomplete & c ˙˙ ˙ ?c ˙ 7̂ 7th ˙˙ ˙ ˙ ˙˙ ˙ 7th 7̂ ˙˙ ˙˙ I complete V7 incomplete I complete ˙˙ ˙ ˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ 7th 7̂ ˙˙ ˙˙ 7th 2̂ 7̂ V7 complete ˙˙ ˙ ˙ 7̂ 7th V7 incomplete ˙˙ ˙ ˙ I incomplete ˙˙ ˙ ˙ I complete ˙ 7th ˙ 2̂ ˙ ˙ ˙˙ 7̂ ˙ ?c ˙ ˙˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ 2̂ & cC: V˙˙ 7 7th7̂ 7th ˙ ˙I ˙˙I ˙ 7 2̂ V7 7̂ I V CHAPTER 27. complete VOICE LEADING SEVENTH CHORDS 327 incomplete complete incomplete complete incomplete ˙ ˙ 7th ˙ 2̂ ˙ ˙ ˙ 7̂ ˙ ˙ ˙ ?c ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ c ˙ 7 7 7 V & C: ˙V˙ 7th ˙˙I ˙V 7̂ ˙I ˙˙ 7th incomplete ˙˙I complete incomplete complete complete incomplete 7̂ ˙ 7th ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ? c ˙˙ 7̂ ˙ ˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ 7̂ & c ˙˙7 7th ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ 7th ˙ ˙I C: V I V V7 I ˙7 7̂ ˙ 7th ˙ incomplete complete incomplete complete incomplete complete ˙ ˙ 7̂ ˙ ˙ ˙ ?c ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ 2. “Free” resolution: c V˙˙7 7̂ C: I˙ V˙7 7th I V7 I ˙ ˙˙resolve itincomplete (a) If & 7̂ isincomplete not in the soprano part, down bycomplete the interval ˙ you can complete incomplete complete ˙ 7thto 5̂ . ˙ of a third ˙˙ 7̂ ˙ ?c ˙ ˙˙ ˙ ˙ c ˙ & ˙ 7̂ ˙ 7th ˙V7 ˙˙I C: V7 I ˙ 7th complete ˙ complete complete complete ˙˙ 7̂ ˙ ?c ˙ ˙ ˙ C: V7 complete V7 complete I complete I complete In piano music you will sometimes find “improper” resolution of the 7th of a 43 chord because it fits the hand better. This should be considered an exception and will not be acceptable in voice leading exercises completed for this class. 411 b b c >œ b & Ces 411 - œ œ J J sa, cru b & b b c œœ œœ n œœ œœ f >œ œ œ ? bb c b B¯: I6 b &bb V46 I - œ nœ œ œ œ œ. œ ˙ del, tan ri œ œ œ ˙ V24 I6 IV I46 - to - n œœœ œœœ œœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœ œœ œ œ V7 gor! œœ œ œ œ œ ˙ I 414 b &bb YT: -Hlk8EDA02M 414 Figure 27.3.1 Giuseppe Giordani, Caro mio ben (1783) 6 7 ? b Voice∑ Leading 27.3.1 ∑ I4 to V ∑ bb ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ When I64 resolves to V7 , beware of parallel fifths if the fifth is above the root in the I64 chord. If it is, move all upper voices upward to the closest notes of the V7 chord, or to an incomplete V7 (no 5th). b &bb 420 b &bb 420 ? bb b b &bb 426 ∑ ∑ ∑ CHAPTER 27. VOICE LEADING SEVENTH CHORDS 168 & ˙˙ ˙˙ ? & 5th ˙ ˙ C: I64 ˙˙ || 5ths ˙ ˙ ˙˙ 75th V ˙˙ ˙ ˙ solution: inc. V7 chord solution: upper voices ascend ˙˙ ˙˙ 5th C: I64 ˙˙ V7 || 5ths ˙˙ 328 5th ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ C: I64 V7 inc. ˙ ˙ ˙ Root ˙ ˙˙ Root ˙ Root ? ˙ ˙ ˙ & 27.4 The Special Resolution of vii ◦7 (and vii ø7 ) C: ii6 I64 C: I viio6 ? vii◦7 and viiø7 chords consist entirely of tendency tones (7̂ , 2̂ , 4̂ , 6̂ ). The Root || 5ths If one resolves all of those tendency tones correctly (2̂ –1̂ , 4̂ –3̂ , 6̂ –5̂ , 7̂ –8̂ ), ◦7 ø7 Root write Root ˙ on the voicing one might 5ths depending ˙˙ parallel ˙˙ Root ˙˙ Rootof the vii and vii & ˙ 5th 5th 5th chord. Therefore, be sure to memorize the following 5th principle: ˙ ˙ the 7th ˙ of a vii◦7 or viiø7 chord Principle ˙27.4.1 Resolving vii◦ 7 . When ˙ ? ˙ ˙ of the chord (scale degree is & voiced above the 3rd of the chord, resolve ˙ the 3rd 2̂ ) up by step while resolving all other tendency tones normally (4̂ –3̂ , 6̂ –5̂ , 7̂ –8̂ ). C: ii6 I64 C: I viio6 || 4ths ? & ? & ? 7th 3rd ˙ ˙ ˙˙ C: viiø7 || 5ths || 4ths ˙ ˙ ˙˙ I 7th 3rd ˙ ˙ ˙˙ 2̂ 3̂ ˙˙ ˙˙ 3rd 7th (solution) C: viiø7 I ˙˙ ˙ ˙ || 4ths C: viiø7 ˙˙ ˙ ˙ I Figure 27.4.2 Resolving viiø7 &The third measure above shows that revoicing the chord is another solution, since parallel 4ths are not objectionable in this situation. ?If the 7th of the chord is voiced below the 3rd of the chord, resolve all tendency tones normally. & 27.5 ? When to Use Seventh Chords In your harmonizations of melodies, it is best to use seventh chords to add & as you approach tonic function. Therefore, sevenths are added most fretension quently to chords of dominant function ( V and vii◦ ) and chords of pre–dominant function ? ( ii and, to a lesser extent, IV ). (See the harmonic flowchart.) For this reason, seventh chords like iii7 , vi7 , IVM7 , and IM7 are less commonly used and encountered. 165 ? ˙˙ ˙˙ || 5ths CHAPTER C: & vii˙˙ ø727. 5th Root # ˙˙ œ # #? & c œ œ ? # #7th# c˙ œ & ˙ ˙˙ ˙ (solution) Root || 4ths œ Root 5th ˙ ˙œ ˙ œœ˙ œ I6 ˙˙ || 5ths ˙ ˙ C: viiø7 I ### œ œ ˙˙ œ C: I 3̂ 2̂ ˙ ii56 ˙ vi œœ ˙ ˙˙ C: viiø7 I œ 3rd 7 ˙. ˙˙ ˙. ˙ I ˙ ˙˙ || 4ths ˙ ˙ C: viiø7 I 329 ˙˙ . . viio6 7th (solution) V ˙ ˙ 5th || 4ths 4 œ œ œ œ œ7th ˙ œ ˙ ˙ ˙ 3rd ? A:˙ ii ## & # ˙˙ ˙˙ø7 ˙˙ Root C: viiø7 VOICE CHORDS I ˙ C: viiSEVENTH I ˙ LEADING 5th C: ii6 3rd 4 I œ œœ œœ “Lobt Gott, œœ ihr Christen, ˙˙ . œ Chorale #27.5.1c J.S. Figure 342, allzugleich”, œ Bach, ? # #& . BWV 376 YT: 2dxuAKSxgw0 œ œ œ œ ? ### c œ œ œ œ 27.6 Practice Exercises 1. 6 ? # ˙˙ ˙ ˙ ˙˙ ˙ ˙ a: V7 inc. i comp. 7 D: V7 comp. e: V7 i comp. comp. I inc. B¯: V7 I comp. comp. 7 c˜ : V i A: V7 progression I f: V7 i root position E¯: V7 seventh I Voice lead this circle of fifths involving 167 inc. comp. comp. inc. comp. comp. comp. comp. chords. Include the key signature and analyze the figured bass symbols in order to place Roman numerals in the blanks below the staff. & & ? ? œœ œœ 7 7 A: ____ b: ____ 3. ˙. ˙. Example ? & 2. œ œ ii vi ii5 I Voice leadA:each V7 chord to the tonic usingVeither “strict” or “free” resolution as indicated by the terms incomplete (“inc.”) and complete (“comp.”). Include key signatures. & 166 œ œ 7 7 ____ ____ œœ œœ 77 ____ ____ œœ œœ 77 77 ____ ____ 77 ____ ____ œœ œœ 77 ˜ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ # Voice lead this circle of fifths progression involving inverted seventh chords. & & ?# ? G: IM65 IVM42 viiø65 iii4 vi56 2 ii4 V56 2 IM42 Click here btob download the homework assignment for this chapter. b b to download the Unit 8 Practice Test. & here & Click ? bb ? bb & # f: i42 œœ iv56 œœ VII42 œœ IIIM65 œœ iiø56 VIM42 œœ œœ V42 œœ i65 œœ 170 170 Chapter 28 & œ œ œ ? œœ œ œ œ 8ve œœ œ œ 5th 5th 8ve œœ œ œ 5th Voice Leading With Non-Chord & œœ œœ œœ œœ Tones C: I 8ve 5th V œ ? & œœ œ œœ œ 8ve vi p 5th œ 8ve œ œœ IV 5th 5th œ 8ve œ 5th œ œœ || 5 n C: œI Voice Leading V vi IVTones œ 28.1 With Non-Chord œ œ ? œ p œ œ œ œ Non-chord tones are common in J.S. Bach’s 371 Chorales, which are our model & œ œ œ œœ œ leading. œV œ for voice pœ C: I viœ IV || 5 p U || 5 n p œ œ œ œ œ œ œ (œ ) œ œ œ œ ? & bœ c œ œœ (œ)œ œ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ p V œ œœ sus (9 - 7) n p œ œ œ œ I6 œœ p œ œœ œœ (œ) p œ (œ ) œ œ œV6 œI V6 viœœ (œ) ? c œœ b &b c œ F: œ I C: I ? #c œœ b# & # c œœ || 5 vi p œ œ (œ)IVœ œ œœ œ ( œ) œ ( œ) U œ p œ p uœ œ œ œI IV IV6 ( ) sus (9 - 7) n (œ ) œ œœ œœ (œ) œ œ œœ œ œœ 9m0RWQbSOWA œœ YT: œ œ œ œ (œ) œ œœ œ œ () œœ œœ p p ( ) œœ uœœ 6 I V6 I V6 323, vi “WieI6schön leuchtet IV IVMorgenstern”, I Figure F:28.1.1 J.S. Bach, Chorale der BWV 172 œ ? ### c œ ## œ & # c œœ œ p œ ( ) p (œ ) ? ### c œ œ A: I œ œ œ œ œœ œœ œ p œ œ ( œ) œ I IV6 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ p œ (œ ) œ œ œ V ii viio6 œ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ œ p œ œ ( œ) œ I6 V œ U œ œœ œ œ u I YT: t5rs2a0Cvr4 Figure 28.1.2 J.S. Bach, Chorale 326, “Allein Gott in der Höh’ sei Erh’, BWV 104”, BWV 172 330 CHAPTER 28. VOICE LEADING WITH NON-CHORD TONES 331 28.2 Avoiding Objectionable Parallels 170 170 When adding non-chord tones, one must avoid creating objectionable parallels. To avoid creating parallel 5ths and 8ves when adding non-chord tones, first identify intervals of 5ths and 8ves between voices in your original voice leading. & œœ œœ œœ œœ 8ve 5th 5th 8ve œ 5th œ 5th 8ve œ ? œœ œ œ œ & œœ œœ œœ œœ C: I vi 5th 5th IV 8ve V 8ve œ 5th œ œ 8ve œ 5th p ? œ 28.2.1 Progression with 8ves and 5ths identified Figure œ œ œ &Avoid œœ adding non-chord œœ tonesœ that move œœ by stepœ into notesœœ separated by a 5thC:orI 8ve. V vi IV ? œœ & œœ œ œœ ? œœ & p œ œ œ C: I V C: I || 5 || 5 V œ œœ œ œœ p n œ œ vi œ œœ || 5 n || 5 œ œ IV œ p vi IV ? &It is best to avoid adding non-chord tones in two voices on the same beat Figure 28.2.2 Parallel 5ths and 8ves created by non-chord tones unless they are moving in parallel 3rds or 6ths. ? 28.3 Adding Non-Chord Tones to a Chord Progression Here are ideas for how to add non-chord tones (or “embellishments”) to one of the voice parts of an SATB chord progression. 1. Repeated note: add upper or lower neighbor & œ œ œœ œœ C: I V I repeated note ? œœ & ? & œ œ n œœ œœ V I œ œ œ œ œ œœ n || 5 œ œ œ œ œ V Figure 28.3.1 2. Step down: (a) Add a suspension by delaying the resolution of the note & œ ? œœ œ œœ œœœ œ & ? œœœœ œœœ œ œ œ œ œœœ œ œ œœ œ œ repeated note n || 5 n || 5 TONES repeated note CHAPTER 28. VOICE LEADING WITH NON-CHORD n œœœ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ(less common) n || 5 sus 6 - 5 repeated note n & C: œ ? & œIœ Vœœœ œœ œœIœ œ œœ Vœœ œœ Iœœœ œ œœVœœ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ (less common) œ œ step down 4 C: I V (b) ? ? œœ ? (c) I œ& œ ? V & step down C: I V C: I & n V œœ œ œ œœœ œ step down œœ œ œI œœV C: Iœstep down V œ ? œœ œ & œœ Figure 28.3.3 œ C: I V Add a double neighbor œ ? œœ œ &C: œœI œ V œ step down œœ œœ step down C: I V ? Figure 28.3.4 ? œœ œ œ (d) Add a chromatic passing C: I tone V step down & œœ ? œœ C: I Figure 28.3.5 (e) Add an anticipation sus 4 - 3 I step down susV4 - 3 I & œœ ? œœ & V I 332 V & œ ?œ œ œœ œ œ œœœ œ œ œ common) œ ?œ œœ œ œ œœ œœ œœœœ œ œ œ œœœ (less œ œ œ6 - 5 œ sus step down &C:œœ I C: œIV Vœ I susIœ4œV- 3 V Iœ IVœ œ V œ œœ œ œ œ œœ ? œ œ œ Figure 28.3.2 œ œ (less common) step down sus 6 - 5 sus 4 - 3 Add an escape tone by moving by step in the opposite direction of C: Vœ Iœ V Iœ Vœ & Iœœ stepwise œ ? œ œ the original œœ œœœ movement, œœœ œœœ then œœ œ leap œœ repeated note C: I V & I œœ œ œ V sus 6 - 5 n || 5 V esc œœ œ œ œœVœ œ esc œ œœ œ œ œ I œœV Iœ esc Vœ œœ œ œ œœ œ I V œœ œ œ œœ œI œ œ œœV I œ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ dn œœI dn I œ œ V V chro. p œœ b œ œœ œœ œ œ I V step up ret & œ WITH CHAPTER 28. VOICE LEADING œœ œœ œTONES œstep upœœ NON-CHORD & ? œœœ œœœ & œœœ œœœ œ œ ? ?C: œœVstep upœI & œstep upœœ &C:C: VœœI œœVœI step up Figure 28.3.6 ? œœ œœœœ & œœ œœ Step up: C: œV tone œI I (a) Add a chromatic? passing œstep upœ step up œ C: V && œœ œœI œ œ œ œ ?? œœstep up & œœ œœœœœ œœ step down & ? 3. ?C: œV œœI œstep up Figure 28.3.7 &C:& Vœ œœI (b) Add an anticipation œ C: V ?? œœ & œœ I œœ œœ Iœ œ V 333 ret ant œ œ œ œœœ œ œI œ œret dn œ œ œ œ œ IVœ œ œI Vœ œ œ dn œ œ œœ œœ œ œ œ œœœœ œ V œ V I œI œ dn œ chro. p œ œ œ œ œœI V œ œœ # œ œ œ œchro. p œœ œ œœ # œ œœ œœœœ. œ œœœœV 175 œV œ chro. p V œœ # œ 175 œI œ I œœI œœ . œ œ œœ œœ C: Vœ Vœ œœI ? œ step up œ ant œI œ . œ œI & Vœ C: V & œ œ œ œ Figure 28.3.8 œ œ œœ ?? œby leaping (c) Add an appoggiatura the note of reso& œ œ oneœ step beyond step up ant lution, placing the appogiatura on the beat, displacing the note of resolution to occurC:after V theI beat V I ? & œœ ?œ œ step up C: V Figure 28.3.9 (d) Add a double neighbor œ œ œœ I œ œ œ œ V app œ œ œ œœ I ? œ œ œœ œ œ œœ CHAPTER 28. VOICE LEADING WITH NON-CHORD TONES C: V I C: V I 334 dn step up & œœ ?œ œ V œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ I V I Figure 28.3.10 (e) Add retardation & by delaying resolution of the note (rarely used) 175 ? step up & œ œœ œ 6 4. œœ ret œœ œ œœ œ œœ ? œ œ œ ant & step down C: Vœ œV. œ I œ œI & œ œ dn œ œ Figure 28.3.11 ? step up œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ &?œœœœstep down ant œ œœ œ Leap of 3rd: œI œ œV toneœ œI . œ Vœœ (a) Fill in the 3rd with ?&C:aœœpassing œ œ œœ œleap ofœ 3rd œ œ œœ p œ & œœ ? C: Vœ Iœ & œ V œ œ œIœ ? C: I V I V œ œ œ œ &? leap p of 3rd œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœii œ œI iiœ ?&C: œI œleap of 3rd œ appœ œ ? œœ oneœœstep beyond œ œ œ the note of resoAdd an appoggiaturaœœby leaping & œ lution, placing the appogiatura on the œ œ beat,œ displacing the note of Figure 28.3.12 (b) I resolution to occurC:after theiibeat œ œ & ? leap œ of 3rd œ œ œ ? & œI C: œI œ ? œœ œ & ? & ? & ? & Figure 28.3.13 C: & I I I œ œ œI œ œ œ I ii œ œ œ œ œI app œ œ I ? 5. Leaps of 4th or larger: do not embellish (for now) Here is a basic framework with all possibilities labeled. ? # 43 œ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ œ œ œ ˙ G: I/3rd ii/3rd I/5th V7 I G: I28. /3rd VOICE LEADING ii/3rd I/5th NON-CHORD V7 I CHAPTER WITH TONES # &# & 44 44 G G ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙ ? # 4 ˙˙ ? # 44 ˙ 4 307 307 D D ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ step down step step down down step down repeated note repeated note leap of 4th leap of 4th Em Em ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ step down step down step down leap of 3rd leap stepofup3rd step up G: I V G: I V Here is one possible solution: G D esc. G D # &# & 309 309 4 44 4 œ˙ œ˙ œ ? # 44 ˙œ ? # 44# c˙ & œœ G: I G: I œ (œ ) œ esc ( œ) nt ( nt) .. 335 C C repeated note repeated note repeated note step up step up leap of 3rd leap of 3rd vi vi Em 4-3 sus Em ˙(œ ) œ ˙(œ4-3) sus œ (esc. ) Œ ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ IV IV C nt C œ˙4-3 sus œ (œnt) ˙˙ (œ ) œ (œ ) ˙˙ ˙ ( ) 4-3 sus pt œ œ (œ ) œ˙ œ (œ ) ˙ # œœ V œ œœ pt n œ œ œ ( ( ) œ ˙) sus œ (œ )ant ˙ œ # œœ pt IV ˙ vi œ app ˙œ ˙œ (app ) pt ˙ œ œ 171 œ œ œœ œ ? # c œœ œ œ œ voices˙ on the same Notice that, when non-chord tones are œ added œto different sus ant V p dn vi IV beat, consonant intervals (3rds, 5ths, 6ths, or 8ves) are made. If consonant p intervals can’t be made, the voices are staggered rhythmically (as occurs on e: ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ beats 3 and 4 in measure one of the example above). ## c & 28.4 Practice Exercises 1. ˙ the staff, ? # # cthe chordsœ with Roman numerals œ Analyze in below œ the blanks œ œ œ then add the specified non-chord tones, specifying suspensions with the 171 ˜ appropriate interval numbers. esc # c & œœ & b c sus ? # c œœ ?b c b: ____ e: ____ F: I & ____ # œœ œ œ ____ vi ant ____ œ œœ ____ IV ____ n p p œœ œ œ ____ V ____ œœ œ œ ____ vi sus dn ____ # œœ œœ ____ IV ant ____ ˙ ˙ ˙ I ____ # ?# 2. Analyze the figured bass below to write Roman numerals in the blanks below the staff. Then add the following non-chord tones: (1) 3 suspensions, # passing tone, (3) one neighbor tone, and (4) one anticipation. (2) one & ?# ?# c œ # & c œœ œœ œ œ œ œœ œ œ # œœ ˙ ˙ p ˙ ant sus CHAPTERe:28. VOICE LEADING WITH NON-CHORD TONES dn ____ ____ ____ p ____ ____ ____ ____ œ œ œœ œ ? # c œœ œ ˙ œ œ œ œ ## c & esc œ œ #œ œ œœ n sus ant p ? ## c œ ## c & e: ____ b: ____ 3. œ ____ œ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ œ ˙ œ ____ œ ____ ____ ____ ____ vi IV ____ 336 ˜ Voice the following Roman numeral progressionœ then add ˙ the follow? # #lead œ (1) a œneighborœ tone during œ beat one, (2) c œ tones: ing&non-chord a neighbor tone during beat two, (3) an appoggiatura on beat 3, ˜ (4) a suspension on beat four, (5) a suspension on beat 5, (6) an anticipation during b: ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ beat six, ? (7) # # a suspension on beat 7. and &b c ? c b F: I &b vi IV V I Click here to download the homework assignment for this chapter. ? b leap of 3rd & œœ œ ? œ œœ œ œ Chapter 29 C: I ii p œœ œ œœ œ œ œ œ I ii app leapLeading of 3rd Voice Chromatic Harœ œ œ œ œ monies & œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ? 29.1 Voice Leading Secondary Chords œ œ œ œ When voice leading secondary chords, one largely follows voice leading rules for seventh chords: C: I I I I 1. Resolve the 7th of a chord down by step. 7th & # œœ œœ C: V7/V V ? œœ œ 2. Alternate complete voicings with incomplete voicings when voice leading successive root position seventh chords . Note that with secondary chords, the 3rd of the chord, typically a raised note, will resolve down by half step to the 7th of the chord, which is a diatonic note that cancels out the chromaticism of the previous note. 337 CHAPTER 29. VOICE LEADING CHROMATIC HARMONIES # œ 3rd & c # œ 5th ? c œœ 7th Root nœ œ # œœ C: V7/iii V7/vi 7th Root 3rd Root #œ œ nœ œ 3rd 5th 7th Root V7/ii 338 nœ œ # œœ 7th Root 3rd Root V7/V complete incomplete complete incomplete 177 3. Follow the principle for resolving vii◦7 and viiø7 when dealing with secondary vii◦7 and viiø7 chords. & œœ œœ 7th 3rd ? # œœ C: viio7/ii œœ œ & œ 177 œœ 7th 3rd ? # œœ œœ ii (a) An important exception occurs when vii◦7 V or viiø7 V resolves to V. If the melody requires the 7th of the chord to be voiced above the 3rd of the chord, solve the example by writing parallel (unequal) o7 C: vii ii fifths instead of the doubling of the leading tone,/ii which is considered less acceptable. bb œ 7th n œœ & b n œ 3rd œ 7th n œ 3rd ? b # œœ bb # œœ c: viio7/V & ? doubled 3rd (avoid on V) n œœ V || 5ths œ œ unequal 5ths (preferable) viio7/V n œœ V 29.2 Voice Leading Borrowed Chords Borrowed chords, or chords making use of mode mixture, are handled similarly to their diatonic versions in terms of voice leading, e.g., iiø7 is handled similarly to ii7 . In any of the borrowed chords with 26̂ , resolve this tendency tone down by step whenever possible. &b CHAPTER 29. VOICE LEADING CHROMATIC HARMONIES ? b b 182 339 26̂ down by Principle____ 29.2.1____ Voice Leading Borrowed Chords. Resolve ____ ____ I46 V I step when it is a chord member of a borrowed chord. b &b & ? b b ? c œœ b œœ œ œ œc œ œœ b œœ ____ C: I ____ iv œœ Bb: ____ C: I iiø7 œ œ ____ V œ œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ V viio7 I œ œ œ œ Fr+6 C: I ____ I64 b œœ œ œ Figure b b 29.2.2 Resolving 26̂ down when voice leading borrowed chords & c situation where you may encounter a borrowed chord is the V –2 VI &Another cadence, which should be handled exactly as the deceptive cadence in minor is handled—resolve the 3rd of the V chord up by step and move the other two ? b b voices in contrary motion to the bass. ?c There are no specific rules for other borrowed chords such as 2 III , 2 VII , i , ____ ____ ____ I6 ____ V I and v ; simply voice lead them as smoothly 4as possible while avoiding objectionable parallels. œœ œœ œœ œœ b œœ b œœ b œœ & œœ 29.3 & Voice Leading the Neapolitan Chord œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ 6 œ œ ? œ There œare twoœ rules for voice leading the N chord in four œ œ parts: œ ? 1. Double theø7bass (the third) C: I ii V C: I I64 iv C: I viio7 œœ œ œ I 2. Resolve 22̂ down to the nearest note in the next chord. b & b b œœ ? bb œ b œ c: i b œœ œ œ N6 n œœ œœ V c: i œœ œ œ b œœ œ œ N6 œœ n œœ i6 V œ œ œœ œœ b œœ n œœ n œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ #œ œ c: i N6 viio7/V V Figure 29.3.1 Resolving 22̂ down when voice leading N6 &c 29.4 Voice Leading Augmented Sixth Chords ? c be helpful to review the three types of augmented sixth chords before It may discussing how one voice leads them. The salient accidental in all three augmented sixth chords is 44̂ , which almost always resolves upward to 5̂ . & ? CHAPTER 29. VOICE LEADING CHROMATIC HARMONIES & # œœ œœ ## œœœœ & #& œœ ? œœ œœœ ? ? œ a: It+6a: ItV+6 # œœ # œœœ #œ œ œœ œœ œ a: V Fr+6 œ œ V not used # œœ # œœ œ # œ # œœ ##œœœœ œœ || 5 œ œ œœ œœ œœœ œ +6 # œœ œ # œœ œ œœ 183 not used # œœ a: Fr a: 340 Ger+6 V V # œœ #œ || 5 œ œ || 5 œ œ œ +6 not used a: Ger V +6V V Figurea:29.4.1 It+6 44̂ toV5̂ in resolution a: Frto a: Ger+6 V The 44̂ scale degree also resolves to 5̂ when an augmented sixth chord resolves to the Cadential 64 chord. & # œœ œœ œœ œœœ ? & #œ ? œœ a: It+6 i46 a: It+6 # œœ œœœœ œ œ a: Fr+6 i46 œœ # œœ œ œœ œ œ #œ œœ i64 œœ œœœœ # œœ œœ œ œ a: Ger+6 i64 & # œœ n # œœ +6 6 a: Fr ? œœ œœ œ œ a: Ger+6 i64 i4 œ œ Figure 29.4.2 44̂ to 5̂ in resolution to Cadential 6 4 With the enharmonic German augmented sixth chord (abbreviated EnGer+6 , 7 a: Fr+6 V 26̂ 42̂ 44̂ 42̂ 44̂ containing , 1̂ , , and ), and resolve upward to members of a major I64 chord. & ? & ### # # œœ ? # # # n œœ œœ œœ A: EnGer+6 I64 Figure 29.4.3 42̂ to 42̂ resolving upward when in an EnGer+6 The exception to 44̂ to 5̂ occurs when an augmented sixth chord resolves to 7 V , in which case 44̂ resolves to 64̂ , which is the 7th of the V7 chord. 183 183 a: It+6 i46 a: Fr+6 i64 a: Ger+6 i64 CHAPTER 29. VOICE LEADING CHROMATIC HARMONIES 341 & # œœ n # œœ ? œœ œœ a: Fr+6 V7 Figure 29.4.4 44̂ to 64̂ in resolution to V7 If you voice lead an augmented sixth chord to something other than V , V7 , or i64 , move all of the voices smoothly while avoiding objectionable parallels and employing proper doublings. 177 29.5 Practice Exercises 178 œ œœ & œ Day One 3rd 1. Analyze the figured bass to provide Roman numerals in the blanks below the staff, then voice lead the progression. Include ? # œœ the key œœ signature. & C: viio7/ii ? œ œ 7th œ & bœb b n œœ 3rd œ n œœ n œ Ω Ω 7 A¯: ____ 2. 7th 7 ____ doubled 3rd 7 (avoid on V) 7 ? ____ # œœ bbb Ω ____ n œœ ____ ____ 7th ˙ n œœ 3rd ii || 5ths œ œ unequal 5ths (preferable) # œœ ____ n œœ Voice lead the following Roman numeral progression. Include the key b c: viio7/V V viio7/V V signature. tones: n œœ non-chord b œœ & b b b œœ Add the œœ following œœ 1 suspension, œœ ˙˙ 1 passing tone, 1 anticipation, and 3 neighbor tones. œ & ? bb b & b œ ? I ? nœ œ bœ œ V7/vi ____ A¯: ____ V7/ii ____ œ œ œ comp. viio7/ii A: I inc. ii nœ œ œœ œ œ V7/V V ____ ____ free res. 4 Vcomp I6 2 n œœ ˙˙ viio7/vi ____ vi ____ œ V65 /V ˙ V 4 ˜ ˜ Day Two & 3 & G: ____ ____ bass ____ ____ Roman ____numerals ____ in____ 3. Analyze the figured to provide the blanks be?the staff, then voice lead the progressions in chorale style. Include low the key signatures. Include one suspension in each measure. ? & & ? & ? 7 V42 /IV D: I œ œ F: ___ ___ & ? œ œ viio7/V ¯6 œ ˜ 7 ˜ nœ V viio7/vi œ œ ˙ œ a: ___ ___ ___ ___ G: ii7 viio7 4+ 2 ____ nœ 6 œ œ #œ œ 6 ___ b¯: ____ œ IV6 ˙ ¯ ? 7 6 ____ nœ ¯7 ¯5 ____ œ nœ œ œ œ œ œ ˙ I e: VI 7 Ω ____ ____ Ω ____ vi œ n˙ N6 V7 VI 179 œ & œ œ bœ nœ œ n˙ CHAPTER?29. VOICE LEADING CHROMATIC HARMONIES 184 342 Day Three Rom. num.: ____ ____ ____ N6 viio7/V ____ ____ & 4. Analyze the figured bass to provide Roman numerals in the blanks Harm. func.: ton. dom. ton. ____ ____ dom. ton. prol. Include below the staff. Voice lead the progressions in chorale style. the key signatures. ? & ? & ? œ nœ œ 4 6 Ω3 œ b œ ____ œ œ 6 4+ 3 ____ 6 4 3 œ œ n œ b œ____œ E: ____ D: ___ ___ ___ nœ 6 6 5 3 œ Ω7 6 4 œ b____ œ œ ____ 6 4 œ f: ___ ___ ___ œ G: V43/V EnGer+6 I64 œ nœ œ #œ Ω5 ____ œ œ œ œ ____ b: i6 It+6 V œ Day Four 6 6 7 7 ¯7 ¯7 ¯7 4 4 Ω Ω Ω 3 & lead the following 5. Voice Roman numeral progression. Include the key signature. following tones: an escape b¯: Add ____ the ____ ____ non-chord ____ ____ ____ ____ tone, ____ a 4-3 suspension, an anticipation, and a passing tone. ? & œ bœ ? A¯: vi nœ œ bœ Fr+6 V7 œ ¯VI œ bœ N6 œ viio7/V œ œ V œ vi Click here & to download the first homework assignment for this chapter. Click here to download the second homework assignment for this chapter. Click here ? to download the third homework assignment for this chapter. Click here to download the fourth homework assignment for this chapter. Click here to download4 the Unit 9 Practice Test.6 6 o4 +6 6 7 f ˜: i V2/V bb œ œœ & b b œœ œ nœ ? bb b œ bœ b A¯: vi Fr+6 esc, 4-3 sus, p, ant V vii 3/iv œœ œ œ bœ œ V7 A b œœ œ ¯VI IV b ∫ œœ Ger n œœ œ œ bœ nœ N6 viio7/V N V œœ . œ œ œ V vi œœ œœ 186 b &bb ? bb & b ### E¯: viio43/IV I IV6 EnGer+6 I64 viio7/vi vi c Chapter 30 ? ### c œ œ œ œ nœ œ ˙ Introduction to Counterpoint Ω A: ____ ____ 7 6 4 3 ____ ____ ____ Ω5 3 ____ ____ # & c 30.1 Species Counterpoint The ad Parnassum (1725), by Johann Joseph ?seminal # c œ composition # œ text, n œ Gradus # œ through n“species œ ˙ œ Fux, teaches contrapuntal composition counterpoint.” Species counterpoint uses simple rhythmic values and teaches composers how to write 7 4+ 6 6 ˜ 4 one, two, three, or four notes usually a whole note. In Ω against a larger value, 3 this text, we will focus on writing for two voices. In a semester-long college ____ one ____ ____ ____ voices. course e:in ____ counterpoint, typically learns to____ write for____ up to four Counterpoint can be thought of as the simultaneous sounding of two or more melodic lines. An example is shown below. ## # ˙ œ œ & # ## # c œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ Melody 3 œ œ ? # # # # # # c ‰ œJ œ œ œ œ # Melody 2 j œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œœœœ œ ‰ œ œœœ œ œ œ œ œ Melody 1 œœœ J œ YT: YGHj2CmNz0E Figure 30.1.1 Bach, J.S., Well-Tempered Clavier, Book I, Fugue 3 in C-sharp major, BWV 848 Textures made of counterpoint are called “contrapuntal” and can be contrasted with melody-accompaniment textures, which are called “homophonic.” 30.2 First Species Counterpoint In first species, we will write note-against-note counterpoint in whole notes. You will be given a melody, called the cantus firmus (abbreviated “c.f.”), against which you will write a counterpoint. 343 CHAPTER 30. INTRODUCTION TO COUNTERPOINT 4 &4 & 44 w ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ w w w 344 ∑ w c.f. (cantus firmus, a pre-existing melody) Figure 4 from Intervallic30.2.1 distance ∑ cantus firmus ∑ to counterpoint: ∑ &4 w ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ 8 Fux ____ enumerates several rules to follow to write in proper sixteenth-century style 4 (thewstyle of Palestrina). Since this is a brief introduction to writing in ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ & 4 counterpoint, species the rules below are slightly modified and simplified. You & 44 w w w w rules in a semester-long coursew in counterpoint. w would likely follow stricter 4 &4 ∑ ∑ ∑ 1. 4 Begin with an octave or unison. c.f. (cantus firmus, a pre-existing melody) &4 w w w Intervallic distancewfrom cantus firmus to counterpoint: 4 &4 w w w w 4 w ∑a pre-existing ∑ melody) ∑ Intervallic from cantus to counterpoint: firmus,firmus &distance 4 c.f. (cantus 8 c.f. ____ 8 ____ & 44 &w 44 ∑ ∑ ∑ Intervallic distance from cantus firmus to counterpoint: 8 ____ w w ∑ w & 44 c.f. w ∑ ∑ Intervallic distance from cantus firmus to counterpoint: &2. 44End w w w or unison. w on an octave 3. w w ∑ 6 ____ w w ∑ 7ˆ w w w 8 ____ w ∑ w ∑ 8ˆ w 8 6 8 ____ ____ &c.f.44 ____ Approach one of the 2ˆ w motion; 1ˆw w octave wor unison wby contrary ww the ending 4 parts & 4willc.f.end with 7̂ –∑8̂ while the∑ other ends∑ with w2̂ –1̂ . w & 44 &w 44 ____ 8 8 ____ ww w wwww 3 5 8 6 www 3 5 8 6 w w 7ˆ wwww 3 5 6 8 w6 ____ w Intervallic distance from 10 to counterpoint: 10 cantus firmus ww & 44 c.f. ∑ ∑ all possible consonances 6 ____ w w2ˆ ∑ 7ˆ & 44 w ____ w____ w ____ w 8 ____ 66 ____ 8 w 5 3 3 ____ 4 www 10 8 wwww 10 8 6 wwww 6 8 ____ & c.f.4 w4 w www 3 w5 6 w w3 5 ww 3 5 ww & 4 &w4 4 c.f. 2ˆ contrary “perfect” motion consonance 88ˆ ____ w ww 1ˆ 8 ____ w 8ˆ 88 ____ ____ ww 1ˆ 4 w (a) the is win G mixolydian, Dw dorian,____ A aeolian, use a w 8 example 8w ____ ____ & If44 & wwC4, and G6w4worrespectively). w w 4 w w 10 10 sharp to create the leading tone (F , w 8 4 w w 8 w 8 ww 6 w &4 c.f.c.f. & 44 &w #w all possible consonances www 3 5 6 ww 3 5 6 w 35 w w #w w all possible consonances #w w w w w Use a sharp to create the leading tone at the final cadence w c.f. & w c.f. G mixolydian w c.f. D dorian w w c.f. A aeolian w w w 4. Create consonant harmonic intervals in each measure (unisons, 3rds, 5ths, 6ths, and their compound versions—10ths, 12ths, 13ths, etc.). Disso∑ 7ths) are not allowed in first species ∑ nances & (2nds, 4ths, counterpoint. & ∑ ∑ 4 &4 w w w w 7 8 w w CHAPTER 30. c.f. INTRODUCTION TO COUNTERPOINT 2ˆ ww 10 w 10 wwww 3 5 8 6 www 3 5 8 6 & 44 w 8 ____ 4 & & 44 ww 8 ____ 5 ____ ww wwww 3 5 6 8 w 6 ____ all possible 3 consonances 3 ____ ____ ww 8 ____ w 6 ____ ww 345 1ˆ 8 ____ ww ww motion consonance 44 & w(3rds and w6ths) can be (a) “Imperfect” consonances w w approached w w in any c.f. contrary “perfect” manner c.f. i. Do not use more than three consecutive 3rds or 6ths (b) “Perfect” consonances (unisons, 5ths, 8ves, 12ths) may only be apw #w w to avoid direct 5ths wand direct # w in order proached in contrary motion & #w 8ves (you may wish to review the Types of Motion). Use a sharp to create the leading tone at the final cadence 5. Only 4ths, 5ths, ascending minor w following & the w leaps are allowed: 3rds, w sixths, and 8ves (review thewRules of Melody withw regard towdirection c.f.after leaps). c.f. changes c.f. G mixolydian D dorian A aeolian 6. Avoid melodically outlining a tritone by changing directions at two turning points in a melody. 4 &4 w & 44 w c.f. w w w w melody changes direction on B tritone w w w melody changes direction on F w w tritone w w w w w melody changes direction on B 7. Avoid repeating notes in order to create a flowing melody Following these rules may seem dry and uninspired, but these rules come from observations of note-by-note details in Renaissance masterpieces by composers ∑and can make any ∑composer better and more ∑aware of what & like Palestrina they are writing. Go to First Species Practice Exercises. ∑ ∑ & 30.3 Second Species Counterpoint ∑ In second species, one writes two half notes against a cantus firmus in whole notes. (Second species can also include writing three half notes against a cantus firmus of dotted whole notes in 32 .) The rules are generally the same as first species except that one simple dissonance is allowed in second species: the passing tone. Please see the details below. 1. Begin your counterpoint with a half note at the octave or unison on either the first or third beat of the measure; if starting on the third beat, put a half rest at the beginning of the measure. melody changes direction on B melody changes direction on B & 44 w w w w w w w CHAPTER 30. INTRODUCTION TO COUNTERPOINT direction on F c.f. Intervallic distance from cantus firmus to counterpoint: 8 ____ c.f. & 44 w & 44 Ó ∑ ˙ w w w ∑ w ∑ w 346 w ∑ ∑ 2. End with a whole note on an octave or unison, using one of these concluding formulas: (a) If the cantus firmus is in the lower part, approach the final octave with intervals of a fifth and sixth (6̂ –7̂ against 2̂ in the cantus firmus). (b) If the cantus firmus is in the upper part, approach the final octave or unison with the intervals of a fifth and third (5̂ –7̂ against 2̂ in the cantus firmus). (c) Phrygian mode has an exception: if the cantus firmus is in the upper part, approach the final octave or unison with the intervals of a sixth to a third (4̂ –27̂ against 22̂ in the cantus firmus). Concluding formulas: Int: 5 6 6ˆ 7ˆ & ˙ #˙ &w c.f. 8 w w cantus firmus in lower voice 5 c.f. 3 1 ˙ #˙ w w 5ˆ w 7ˆ cantus firmus in upper voice 6 c.f. w ˙ 3 1 ˙ w w 4ˆ 7ˆ cantus firmus in upper voice in phrygian mode 3. Of the two half notes you write in each measure, the first must always be a consonance & (unison, 3rd, 5th, 6th, 8ve, or∑ compound interval equivalent). If the second is a dissonance, it can only be a passing tone (approached and left by step). Otherwise, the second note must be a consonance. The only allowable leaps are the same as in first species. & ∑ 4. When crossing barlines, apply the following: (a) “Imperfect” consonances (3rds and 6ths) can be approached in any manner. (b) “Perfect” consonances (unisons, 5ths, 8ves, 12ths) may only be ap∑ to avoid direct 5ths and direct & proached in contrary motion in order 8ves. ∑ (c) Do not repeat notes across barlines 5. Avoid & 8ves on consecutive downbeats and avoid 5ths on consecutive downbeats unless there is the leap of 4th occurring after the 8ve or 5th on the downbeat & ∑ & ∑ 4 &4 Ó ˙ consonance ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ pt w ˙ #˙ consonance consonance ˙ ˙ contrary contrary Concluding formulas: CHAPTER 30. INTRODUCTION contrary TO COUNTERPOINT motion Int: 5 motion 6 8 w & ˙ #˙ 6ˆ 7ˆ &w 5 c.f. w 8 ˙ 4 &4 P4↓ motion 3 6 c.f. ˙ 8 1 ˙w ˙ w w w 5 w P4↓ w 3 w8 ˙w ˙ 5 4 & 4 w ˙ #˙ w c.f. 1 347 4ˆ 7ˆ 7ˆ cantus firmus in upper cantus firmus cantus firmus interval numbers Notice that dissonant (2, 4, tt, 7) are circled to highlight that voice in phrygian mode in upper voice in lower voice c.f. 5ˆ they must be handled in a special manner. & & 4 w &4 c.f. 8 ___ 6 ∑___ 7 ___ 5 ___ 3 ___ w w perfect consonance 4 &4 Ó ˙ ˙ ˙ 3 ___ 6 ___ w ∑ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ pt contrary motion 8 ___ 3 ___ 5 ___ 3 ___ w w 1 ___ ˙ #˙ w perfect perfect consonance consonance ˙ ˙ w contrary motion contrary motion Go to Second Species Practice Exercises. ∑ & Third Species Counterpoint 30.4 In third species, one writes four quarter notes to each whole note in the cantus firmus. Use the following rules. &1. ∑ Begin on an octave or unison. Write four quarter notes to each whole note in the cantus firmus except for the final measure. 2. End on a whole note on an octave or unison with the penultimate measure using one of the following formulas: & & ∑ (a) If the cantus firmus is in the lower voice, the penultimate measure of the upper voice can be: i. 4̂ –5̂ –6̂ –7̂ , or ii. 2̂ –1̂ –6̂ –7̂ (the cambiata—see 5.b. below) ∑ (b) If the cantus firmus is in the upper part, the penultimate measure of the lower voice is 7̂ –5̂ –6̂ –7̂ . Concluding formulas: Int: 3 4 5 6 8 8 7 5 6 camb. & œ œ œ #œ w pt 4ˆ 5ˆ 6ˆ 7ˆ &w c.f. 8 3 5 c.f. œ œ œ #œ w 2ˆ 1ˆ 6ˆ w w 7ˆ c.f. 4 3 w 1 w #œ œ œ œ w pt w 7ˆ 5ˆ 6ˆ 7ˆ 3. Each downbeat should be a consonance. 8 4 apply 3 5the8following: 6 5 4. When crossing barlines, ˙ ˙ (a) ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ #˙ w ˙ ˙ ˙ & 44 Ó ˙ consonances “Imperfect” (3rds and 6ths) can be approached in any & 44 w manner. c.f. & b 42 „ sus. sync. w w ∑ w 3 5 sync. w 6 5 sync. w 7 6 8 sus. w w ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙. œ œ œ ˙ w 3 34 56 5 3 8 5 tt 3 3 32 5432 8 ___ 5 ___ 3 ___ 6 ___ 7 ___ 3 ___ 6 ___ 8 ___ 3 ___ 5 ___ 3 ___ w w w 4 w w w & 4 30. INTRODUCTION TO COUNTERPOINT CHAPTER c.f. perfect consonance perfect perfect consonance consonance 1 ___ w 348 (b) “Perfect” consonances (unisons, 5ths, 8ves, 12ths) may only w be ap# ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ & 44 Ó proached ˙ in contrary motion in order to avoid direct 5ths and direct ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ 8ves. pt contrary contrary (c) Do not repeat notes across barlines motion motion 5. Allowable dissonances: 8 ˙ 4 &4 contrary motion ˙ ˙ 5 8 w 5 8 ˙ (a) Passing tones are allowable dissonances (but never on the first beat of the measure). P4↓ contour in third P4↓ measure of the exam(b) The cambiata (see the melodic ple below) is allowed but only with the second note of the measure as the only dissonant interval. 4 &4 w w c.f. w 6. Direct 5ths and direct 8ves are not allowed and occur when an 8ve or 5th on a downbeat is approached through similar motion. 8 5 13 5 6 78 5 4 3 4 34 5 6 8 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ 4 œ œœœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ #œ w œ œ œ œ &4 œœ pt 8 76 5 3 2 15 8 7 56 4 &4 w c.f. pt w camb. w pt w w w pt pt pt w w Go to Third Species Practice Exercises. 30.5 Fourth Species Counterpoint Fourth species deals with writing suspensions (and syncopations). Because this is only a brief introduction to species counterpoint, you will only encounter the cantus firmus in the lower voice in fourth species in this text. See the fourth species rules below. 1. Start with a half rest, then write a half note an 8ve above the cantus firmus. The half note on the 3rd beat of every measure but the penultimate one ties across the barline to a half note on the first beat of the succeeding measure. 2. End on a whole note at the interval of an 8ve above the cantus firmus. 3. The penultimate measure should contain a 7-6 suspension. 4. The half note on the third beat of each measure is always a consonance. 5. If the half note after a tie is a dissonance (4th or 7th), it is a suspension and must resolve down by step. (a) Allowable suspensions in the upper part are 4-3 and 7-6; 9-8 and 2-1 are not allowed. 6. If the half note after the tie is a consonance (1, 3, 5, 6, 8), it is a syncopation and can be left in any manner (by step or leap in any direction). &w w c.f. Int: 3 4 5 6 8 8 c.f. w #œ œ œ œ w w 7ˆ 5ˆ 6ˆ 7ˆ Concluding formulas: CHAPTER 30. INTRODUCTION TO COUNTERPOINT & 4w & c.f. 4 w 5 2ˆ 1ˆ sync. sus. 6ˆ sync. 7ˆ w wc.f. ww c.f. 8 œ œ œ # œ w5 ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ & 4œ œ œ ˙8# œ ˙4w ˙3 & 4 ptÓ 4ˆ 5ˆ 6ˆ 7ˆ 7 5 6 pt 8 6 w w 3 5 4 3 c.f. 5 7 6 349 1 w w8 6 ˙ ˙ ˙ #˙ w sus. #œ œ œ œ w w ˆ ˆ wˆ ˆ w 7 5 6 7 pt sync. Notice that all suspensions and syncopations are labeled and all dissonant intervals are circled. 8 4 3 5 8 6 5 6 5 7 6 8 Go to Fourth Species Practice Exercises. 44 Ó ˙ & ∑ & ˙ ∑˙ ˙ ˙ sus. ˙ ˙ sync. ˙ ˙ ˙ #˙ ∑ sus. sync. 30.6 Fifth Speciessync. Counterpoint w 4 w & w is a freew mixture ∑ counterpoint”) ∑ w∑ (alsowknow as w“florid wof first & 4species Fifth through c.f. fourth species. One can observe all species in the opening of Orlande de Lassus’ Expectatio Justorum. & b 42 „ & & b 42 w . & ∑ ˙ ∑ w 3 5 ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙. œ œ œ ˙ w 3 34 56 5 sync. 3 ∑ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙. œ œ œ ˙ w sync. ∑Species type: 2nd p ∑ 4th 4th 2nd 1st 2nd 8 5 tt Ó p ˙ 4th 3 3 32 5432 ∑ p p p œ œ œ∑ œ œ œ œ œ 1st 2nd 3rd & 30.6.1 Orlande∑ de Lassus, Expectatio Justorum ∑ Figure YT: wjqd3Mv_wgs 30.7 & Invention∑ Expositions ∑ J.S. Bach’s Two-Part Inventions were not only intended as instructional keyboard pieces but also as examples of how to compose. In this section we will wed our species counterpoint knowledge with our knowledge of harmony in order to write a four-measure invention exposition using Bach’s C major and E minor inventions as models. Note the I–I–V–V–I harmonic progression. CHAPTER 30. INTRODUCTION TO COUNTERPOINT m œœœœœœœœ œ œ œ œ Theme P5 higher 5ˆ Theme &c ≈ œœœœœ œ œ œ œ œ œ m ?c Ó &c ≈ C: 350 œ Theme 8ve lower than m. 3 œœ œ œ ≈5ˆ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ThemeŒ P5 higher≈ œ œ m œ œ œ œ œ œ œœœœœœœœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œI œ œ œ œ œ œ I m V V I Theme 8ve lower 5ˆ 187 187 Theme Theme 8ve lower than m. 3 Theme 5ˆ œTheme P5Œhigher œ ≈œ œœ œmœ. œ œ œ œ œœ ? c# Ó œ œ œ M ≈ œ œ m œ œ œ œ M œ. œœ #œ œ œ œ œ & c ‰ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ . œ YT: E8EvUmq0Zao# œ œ Theme 8ve lower 5ˆ FigureC:30.7.1 Bach, Invention No. 1 in V C Major, BWV V772 I I Theme 8ve lower than m.I 3 œ œ œ œ œ œ Theme P5 higher œ œ # œ # œ œ œ œ ? # c œ Theme ˆ œ 5‰ Œ M mœ œœ œ œŒ # œ œ œ‰ œ œ mœ . # œ M œ œœ œ œ . # œ & c ‰ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ. œ Theme 8ve lower 5ˆ e: i i V V i Theme P5 higher Theme 8ve lower 5ˆ 5ˆ œ œ # œ #mœ œ œ œ # M Theme œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ? # œ œ œ & & c c≈ œœ œ Œœ œ œ ‰ œ œ œ œ œœ œ Œœ œ œ œ œ ‰œ œ œ œ m Theme 8ve lower than m. 3 i Theme 8ve lower V 5ˆ V i ? # e: i œ œ œ œ ?c Ó ≈ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ThemeŒP5 higher ≈ œ œ œ endœon a 10th Theme œ œ bb b 2 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ YT: QHDx0uYaKkY œ œ & C:4 I œ œ œ œ œ œ I V V I # 30.7.2 Bach, Invention No. 7 in E Minor, BWVTheme Figure 778 8ve lower than m. 3 & Theme 8ve lower Theme P5 higher Theme œœœ œ 5ˆ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ m œ M œ ? b#b 42 œ m œ œ. Mœ . œ œ œ .œ œ # œ œ œ œ # œ œ œ œœ œ b c ‰ œ œ 30.7.1 How to Write an Invention Exposition &# œœœœ ? Theme 8ve lower than m. 3 Theme altered to end on tonic In the majority of examples, an invention in than them. Theme 8ve lower 3 E¯: I I you will be given V V theme I first measure, which you will Theme write 8ve anlower octave part in the second 5ˆ lower in the bass œ œ œ # œ œ #œ œ œ œ œ œ œthanœ the first measure, fifthœ higher measure in the third measure, ? # c then œ a perfect Œ ‰ Œ ‰ œ the fourth measure will betothe 5̂ third measure transposed down one octave, and, œleadsendnaturally œ bass part andœ3̂ in finally,b you will on the interval of a 10th—tonicœ in œ the 2 œ b œ œ œ œ b œ œ &upper e:4part. i œ œ Please V i the œ œ œ œ seei the exampleVbelow. end on a 10th Theme Theme P5 higher œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ ? b bb 42 œœœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœœœœœ & b bb 42 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ does not emphasize V chord Theme 8ve lower than m. 3 Theme 8ve lower œ œ œœœœœœ œ œ œ ? b b 42 œ œ œ œ œ b Theme altered to end on tonic E¯: I Figureb 30.7.3 &bb ? bb b I V V I 187 e: i i V V i œ351 end on a 10th CHAPTER 30. INTRODUCTION TO COUNTERPOINTœ b 2 & b b 4 œ œœœœœœ œ œ œœœœœœ b 2 & b b 4 œ œœœœœœ œ œ œœœœœœ œ Theme Theme P5 higher 30.7.2 Altering Themes to Fit the Harmonies Theme 8ve lower than m. 3 œ œ œ œI œtoœ Vœ œneeds its 1. You find that a theme thatœ œleads œ œ naturally from ? may 2 b œ œ œ œ b b altered 4 contour when progressing from V to I in measures 4 to 5 in order to emphasize the V chord and the dominant-to-tonic harmonic motion. Theme altered to end on tonic Modify E¯: the Icontour to emphasize the VV chord at the Vend of the measure, I I altering as few notes as possible. Theme 8ve lower leads naturally to 5̂ ? b b 42 b 188 188 2. œ œœœœœœ œ œ œœœœœœ œ does not emphasize V chord œ œ œœœœœœ œ b & b b 42 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ 188 œ œœœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ? b bb 422 œ œ œ œœœ œ œœœœœœ œ & b bb 4 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ note changed to emphasize V chord b œ œœœœœœ œ œ & b b 42 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ the œ œ downbeat ? b b 42 you may beœ given œ œ œ œ that land onœ3̂ on Additionally, themes œ œ œ b œ œ œand of theb bsecond 5̂ that occurred in theœ Bach œ œ œ œCœmajor b 2 measure, notœ the œ & œ ? œ b œ œ emphasize V chord E minor altertothe theme at the b b 4invention expositions.œ You will neednotetochanged end of measure 2 to emphasize the I chord as well as make the first bass note ? ofb the third measure 3ˆthe 5̂ scale degree.note changed to emphasize V chord b & bb b 43 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ b œ & b 43 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ? b 3 œ b 4 ? b 3 b 4 b &b b &b ? b b ? bb œ œœœœœœœœ œ does not V œ3ˆ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œemphasize œœ œ œnot œ œ œ œ œœ œ does œ œ œ œ œœœœ œ œemphasize œ œTheme œ œ œVœaltered 3ˆ œ œ œ œ œdoes œ œ œ not œ œ œ œdoes not œ to end on tonic œ3ˆ B¯: I I B¯: I I 43 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ 43 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ 3 œ 4 43 B¯: I emphasize I emphasize V does not emphasize I Vdoes not emphasize V V Theme alteredI to end on tonic V V I œ œœœœœœœœ œ œ œœœœœœœœ œ œ œœœœ œ œ œœ œœ œ œ œ œœœœœœœ œ œœœœœœœ œ notes changed toœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ emphasize harmonies œ I V notes changed toV emphasize harmonies I 3. Finally, b b when a theme in minor containing the 2̂ and 3̂ scale degrees in the & first two measures is transposed up a fifth in the succeeding two measures, b scale & bdegrees 2̂ and 23̂ will be transposed to ↑6̂ and ↑7̂ . The reasoning is ? that ↑7̂ is the 3rd of the V chord, and ↑6̂ is a step below, typically a b b tone. Another way to think of this is to use the melodic minor passing scale ? in b the 3rd and 4th measures. B¯: I b I V V I CHAPTER 30. INTRODUCTION TO COUNTERPOINT 352 189 2 & b 4 œ œœœ œœ œ #œ 3ˆ 2ˆ œ œ #œ nœ œ #œ œ œ ↑7 ↑6ˆ ↑7ˆ œ #œ nœ œ #œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ #œ œ œ œ ? b 42 2 ↑7ˆ ↑7ˆ ↑6ˆ 3ˆ d: i 3ˆ 2ˆ ˆ 3ˆ i V #œ ˆ ↑7 ↑7ˆ œ œ V i 2 œ œ n œ œTheme œ œ # the 30.7.3 to & b 4 Adding # œ œ œ Statements œb œ œ Counterpoint œœ &œ 33ˆˆ 22ˆˆ œ #œ œ ˆ ˆˆ ↑7 ↑6 ↑7ˆ ↑6 33ˆˆ ˆ invenAfter copying and transposing the theme throughout this four-measure ↑7ˆˆ ↑6ˆˆ ↑7 ↑7 ↑6 ↑7ˆ œ ˆˆ 2ˆˆ ˆˆ 3 3 n œ # œ œ 2 3 3 œ œ œ œ tion you will needœ to to accompany the# œstatements ?exposition, œ œ œadd œ third, œcounterpoint 42? b in the second, # œ and of theb theme fourth measures. Unlike species counterpoint, your counterpoint in these invention expositions must emphasize the V V ii harmonyd: d: inii each measure.ii V V b 2& not emphasizing emphasizing D-F-A D-F-A not & b 42 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ . #œ ?b ? b 42 ∑ œ œ œ œ #œ œ œ œ œ Œ ii V V 2 & b 4 œ œ œ #œ œ œ œ œ d: i ? b d: i 6 VI VI6?? V V strong beats beats emphasize emphasize the the harmony harmony strong œ. œ œ #œ nœ œ œ œ œ #œ œ œ œ œ #œ œ œ œ œ Œ Intervals: 55 33 44 33 44 33 66 Intervals: ∑ 33 ii 88 V V 33 œ œ 66 7 6 3 3 œ #œ nœ œ #œ œ œ œ 55 88 tt tt ?b 42& b œ œ œ. œ œ #œ nœ œ #œ œ œ œ Intervals: Intervals: 55 88 55 66 66 77 55 33 88 d: iib d: & ?b not emphasizing emphasizing A-C A-C˜˜-E -E not 66 7 6 3 6 III III6?? #œ. 3 ii œ œ 55 33 44 33 44 33 33 33 œ #œ nœ œ #œ œ œ œ V V ii You may find the need to create “microharmonies” within a measure with some & bthemes, such as a I–IV–I or I– vii◦6 –I progression even though the overriding harmony of the bar is the I chord. Examples are found in the first two measures of the C major invention. ?b 189 189 d: i i V V i CHAPTER 30. INTRODUCTION TO COUNTERPOINT &c ≈œœœœœœœ œ œ œ œ m ?c Ó C: I m œœœœœœœœ œ œ œ œ œ (IV6) V I ≈œœœœœœœ œ œ Œ I (viio6) I 353 V ≈œœ V œœœœœ œ “microharmonies” YT: E8EvUmq0Zao Figure 30.7.4 Microharmonies in the C Major Invention by J.S. Bach Given these pieces of information, you are prepared to begin writing tonal counterpoint in two parts. Go to the Invention Exposition Practice Exercises. 30.8 Fugue Analysis We will now turn to analysis of fugue. Let us set out definitions first. • A fugue is a contrapuntal composition whose form features sections called expositions and episodes • A fugue exposition is a section that contains at least one full statement of the subject of the fugue.1 • The fugue subject is the primary melodic idea and is stated by each voice in turn in the first exposition. • The answer, called “response” in some texts, refers to the statement of subject in the key of the dominant by the second voice to enter in a fugue. Sometimes this statement of the answer has intervals altered in order to start in the tonic before modulating to the dominant. When the intervals are altered in this manner, we call this a “tonal answer.” In contrast, a “real answer” contains no alteration of intervals. In the example below, notice that the third note of the subject in measure 1 descends a perfect fourth to the fourth note. In the answer in measure 3, the third note descends a perfect fifth to the fourth note. • An episode is a section that does not contain a full statement of the fugue subject, but instead develops the subject or other prominent ideas through fragmentation and sequencing. Here is the first exposition of Fugue 2 in C minor in Book I of the J.S. Bach’s Well-Tempered Clavier. In the first exposition of a fugue, all of the voices state 1 Some authors reserve the term “exposition” solely for the first exposition and use the term “middle entry” for later statements of the full subject. Grove Music Online includes the following in their definition of “Exposition”: “...In German the word Durchführung is used to refer to all groups of thematic entries in the body of the fugue, after the opening Exposition. Because there is no equivalent word so used in English, English speakers sometimes, but by no means universally, apply the word ‘exposition’ to these later thematic groups as well.” CHAPTER 30. INTRODUCTION TO COUNTERPOINT 354 193 the subject at least once. It is important to note that a answer is considered 193 equivalent to a subject because the intervallic alterations are so minute. EXPOSITION SUBJECT EXPOSITION EXPOSITION SUBJECT b SUBJECT & bb b c œ n œ œ œ∑∑ œ ‰ & b b c œ nœ œ œ œ ‰ ? b c ∑ ? bb b c ∑ bb b & bb b &bb 4 4 4 ? b ? bbb b b œ œ b œœ n œ ## œœ œœ b œœ n œ œ RESPONSE œ œ œ œ œ œ nœ œ œ ∑ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ n œ œ œ ∑œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ∑ ∑ ‰ œ ‰œ œ n œœ œ œ nœ nœ n œœ œ COUNTERSUBJECT 1 ∑ ∑ BRIDGE (can only occur within first exposition) HEAD EXT. SUBJECT HEADfirst BRIDGE (can occur exposition) SUBJECT HEAD BRIDGE (can only only occur within within first SUBJECT exposition) ∑ ∑ BRIDGE MOTIVE BRIDGE MOTIVE BRIDGE MOT. EXT. ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ BRIDGE BRIDGE MOTIVE MOTIVE BRIDGE BRIDGE MOTIVE MOTIVE BRIDGE BRIDGE MOT. MOT. EXT. EXT. œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œŒ œ œ œ œ‰ œœ œœ œœ œ‰ œœ œœ œ nn œœœ œœ œ œœ œœœ œ œ œ œ œœœ œœœœ œ Œ ‰ ‰ COUNTERSUBJECT 2 œ œ œ œ œ n œ œ22 œ œ œ œ œ œ COUNTERSUBJECT ? b b ‰ œœ n œ œœ œ œ œœCOUNTERSUBJECT œ œ œ œ nœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ n œ œ œ œ ? bb b ‰ b SUBJECT b & bb b &bb œœ œ œœ œœ œ œœ SUBJECT SUBJECT SUBJECT HEAD EXT. EXT. SUBJECT HEAD HEAD SUBJECT HEAD HEAD SUBJECT œ œœ œ œ œ HEAD œœ # œœ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ n œ œ œœ n œ œœ œ œœ n œœ œ b œœ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ # œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œ œ≈ œ œœ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œn œœœ œ œœ n œ œ œ œœn œœ œ b œœ œ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œ ≈œ œœ COUNTERSUBJECT COUNTERSUBJECT 1 1 7 7 œ œœ œ COUNTERSUBJECT COUNTERSUBJECT 1 1 COUNTERSUBJECT 1 7 #œ œ n # œœ œ œ œœ œ n œ œ œ œœ œ RESPONSE RESPONSE œœ œœ œ #œ œ #œ œ œ œ nn œœ n œ nœ œ SUBJECT SUBJECT b & bbb b YT: itvGdURMfbM b & Figure 30.8.1 First Exposition of Fugue 2 in C minor from WellTempered Clavier, Book I (BWV 847) ? b ? bb b b bridge, if it occurs, is a brief modulatory passage that only hap• bThe pens within the first exposition, usually to connect the answer to the subsequent subject statement. • bAb b countersubject is counterpoint that consistently accompanies each & bb of the subject. “Countersubject 1” is in the alto voice in & boccurrence measure 3 and in the soprano voice in measure 7. The alternative to using ? bab countersubject would be for a composer to write different accompanying (labeled as “CTRPT” in the examples) each time a subject ? bcounterpoint bb isb stated. Within the bridge (bar 5 in the example above), we see motivic fragmentation of the subject (“subject head”). Subjects, answers, and countersubjects can be fragmented into head motives and tail motives in episodes in fugues. In this fugue, we will see the subject, countersubject 1, and countersubject 2 fragmented. Below is the first episode, which contains motivic fragmentation of the subject and countersubject 1. œ œ œ œ nœ œ œ œ œ ? b ‰ œ nœ œ œ œ œ œ œ bb œ œ œ œ nœ nœ COUNTERSUBJECT 2 CHAPTERSUBJECT 30. INTRODUCTION TO COUNTERPOINT 355 EPISODE SUBJECT HEAD œ #œ œ ‰ b & b b œœ œœ n œœ J j nœ œ CTRPT ‰ œ œ œ SUBJECT HEAD j œ œ œ œ n œ œ œ œœ œ ‰œ œj œ nœ œ œ ‰ J CTRPT œ œœ œœœ œ ? bb œ n œ n œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ b œ œœœœœœœœœ b bœ œ œ œ œ CTRPT CTRPT SUBJECT HEAD CTRSUB. 1 HEAD CTRSUB. 1 HEAD SUBJECT HEAD CTRSUB. 1 HEAD CTRSUB. 1 HEAD YT: itvGdURMfbM Figure 30.8.2 First Episode of Fugue 2 in C minor from WellTempered Clavier, Book I (BWV 847) Below are the second exposition, the second episode, the third exposition, and the third episode. 194 194 194 b & bbbb bb b & & b 11 11 11 ? bb ? bbb b ? b bb EXPOSITION EXPOSITION SUBJECT EXPOSITION œ œœœ œœœ œ œ œœœ œ œœœ œœ œœ œœ‰ œœœœJ œœœ œœœ œœ œœœ œœ œœœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œœ œ ‰‰ œJJ CTRPT COUNTERSUBJECT 2 COUNTERSUBJECT 2 CTRPT COUNTERSUBJECT CTRPT œ œ œ ‰œ‰ œ œœ 2 œœ œœœœ œ œ œ b œ œ œ œ œœ œœ ‰œœ œœœœ œœœ œœœ œ œ œ œœ œœ bb œœ œœ œœ œœœ œœ SUBJECT SUBJECT COUNTERSUBJECT 1 COUNTERSUBJECT 11 COUNTERSUBJECT C. S. 1 HEAD EPISODE EPISODE EPISODE C. SUB. 1 HEAD C. S. 1 HEAD œœœ œœ œœ œœ ‰ ‰‰œ œœ œ œ œœ œœœ œœ œœœ C. S. S. 11 HEAD HEAD INV INV C. C. S. 1 HEAD C. S. S. 22 HEAD HEAD C. C. S. S. 22 HEAD HEAD C. C. S. 2 HEAD C. S. S. 22 HEAD HEAD C. C. S. S. 2 HEAD HEAD C. C. S. 22 HEAD bœ ? b b œœ bb œœœœ ? œ b b ? bbb b œœ b œœ œœœ œœ œœœ œœ œœœ œœ œœœ œœ œœœ n œœœ nn œœ EPISODE EPISODE EPISODE j ‰ j ‰ ‰ œ œœjj ‰‰ # œ ‰‰œ n œnn œœ œœ œœjj n ‰‰œ œ œœ œ≈ œ nn œœ ## œœ œœ nn œœn œœ œ œœ nn œœ nn œœ œœ nœ ≈≈ œœ n œ SUB HEAD SUB HEAD HEAD SUB SUB HEAD SUB HEAD HEAD SUB C. S. S. 22 HEAD HEAD C. œœ œœœ œœ œœœ œœ œœœ œœ œœœ C. S. 2 HEAD C. S. S. 22 HEAD HEAD C. COUNTERSUBJECT 11 COUNTERSUBJECT œ œ n œœ œœœ œ œœ œœ œœœ nn œœ œ n œœ # œ œœ œ n œœ œœ œœ n œœ ## œœ œ œœ RESPONSE RESPONSE ‰ Œ ‰ œ œ ‰ œ œœœJ RESPONSE ‰‰ œœ œœ nnn œœœ ‰‰ œœ JJ ‰‰ ŒŒ C. S. S. 22 HEAD HEAD C. œœ œœœ œœ œœœ œœ œœœ C. S. 2 HEAD C. S. S. 22 HEAD HEAD C. œœ œœœ œ œ œœ n œ œœ œœœ œœ œœœ nn œœ œœœ œœœ œ œ œ œœœ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ COUNTERSUBJECT 2 COUNTERSUBJECT 22 COUNTERSUBJECT CTRPT ‰ # œ n œ œjjjCTRPT ‰ ‰ ‰ œ œ œ ‰ n œ œ## œ nn œœ œ # œ ‰‰œ œ ‰œ‰œ b œœ n œœ œœjjj nn œœ œ œ œ ## œœ œœ œœ œ bb œœœ nn œœœ œœœ CTRPT b & bbbb bb œ œœœ‰ & b b œœ ‰ & œJœJ ‰ J BRIDGE MOTIVE BRIDGE MOTIVE BRIDGE MOTIVE MOTIVE BRIDGE MOTIVE MOTIVE BRIDGE BRIDGE œ œ ? b b œœœ nn œœ œœœ œ œ œœœ œœœ œœœ n œ œ œœ œœœ œœ # œ œœ n œ ? œ b ? bbbb b œ ## œœ œ nn œœ œ œœ œœ b œœ 17 17 17 œœ œœœ œ œœœ œ EXPOSITION EXPOSITION 1 EXPOSITION COUNTERSUBJECT INV œ C. S. 1 HEAD INV nœ œ nœ b b œœ C. S.œ1œHEAD n œ œœ b œ œ œ œœ œœ nnn œœœ nn œœ œœ nn œœ nnn œœœ œœ nn œœ œ œ œ œ œ b & bbb b œ œ œ œ œœ œœ nn œœ œ bb œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ # œ œ n œ œœ œ œ & b b œœ œœ œ œ & œœ ## œœ œœ œœ œ œœœ œ C. S. 2 HEAD C. S. 2 HEAD 14 14 14 C. S. S. 11 HEAD HEAD INV INV C. C. S. S. 11 HEAD HEAD nINV œ C. œ œ INV œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ œœœ œœ œœ œœ œœœ œœ œœ nn œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œ C. S. 2 HEAD C. S. 2 HEAD SUB HEAD SUB HEAD HEAD SUB ‰ ‰‰ œ œœ SUB HEAD SUB HEAD HEAD SUB ‰ j ‰ ‰‰ n œœ œœ œœjj ‰‰ œ nn œœœ œœœ œœœ n œ œœ nn œœ ‰ j ‰ ‰‰ n œœ œœ œœjj ‰‰ œ nn œœœ œœ œœœ n œ œœ œ nn œœ SUB HEAD SUB HEAD SUB HEAD HEAD SUB SUB HEAD HEAD SUB ≈ nœ œœœ ≈≈ œœœ nnn œœœ nn œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œœœœ œœ nnn œœœ œœœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œœ nnn œœœ œœœ œœ BRIDGE MOTIVE BRIDGE MOTIVE BRIDGE MOTIVE MOTIVE BRIDGE BRIDGE MOTIVE MOTIVE BRIDGE b ‰ EXPOSITION EPISODE & b b EXPOSITION œ œœ n œœ EPISODE œ SUBJECT SUBJECT HEAD HEAD SUBJECT SUBJECT 20 20 ‰ ‰ bbbb ‰ œœ nn œœ œœ œ œœ œœœ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ nn œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œ nn œœ œœ œ œœœ œ ‰œ b œ b & œ œ œ œ œ œ & œ œ œœ œœ œœ œ n œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œ œœœ ? b b œœ œ œœ œœ ‰œ ‰‰ nn œœJJ œ œ œœ œ nœ œ b J COUNTERSUBJECT 11 COUNTERSUBJECT ? bbb œœ ‰‰ œ‰œ‰ bb œœnnœœœ œœ œœ ? ‰ b bb JJ JJ œœ bb œœ œœ ‰ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ jj nn œœœ œ SUB HEAD HEAD CTRPT SUB CTRPT œœ œœ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œœ œœ œœ C. S. 2 HEAD COUNTERSUBJECT 2 C. S. 2 HEAD CHAPTEREPISODE 30. INTRODUCTION TO COUNTERPOINT 17 & j ‰ ‰ j ‰ ‰ j ‰ ‰ # œ œ n œ œ n œ j ‰ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ n œ n œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ #œ # œ b œ n œœ œ nœ nœ œ ‰ ≈œnœ œ J YT: itvGdURMfbM CTRPT bbb 356 ‰ j ‰ ‰ n œ œj ‰ n œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œ nœ œ nœ œ BRIDGE MOTIVE BRIDGE MOTIVE SUB HEAD SUB HEAD SUB HEADWellTempered Figure 30.8.3 J.S. Bach, from Clavier, œ œ œ Fugue 2 œinœ œC minor œ œ n œ œ ? bI (BWV 847) œ #œ œ œ œœ Book œ n œ œ œ œ œ ≈ œ œ b nœ œ œœ nœ b œ œnœ nœ In the four systems below, we see the fourth exposition, fourth episode, and BRIDGE MOTIVE BRIDGE MOTIVE SUB HEAD HEAD two subject SUB HEADstatements separated by cadential final exposition, which SUB includes material. EXPOSITION b ‰ & b b œ œ œœ n œœ œ SUBJECT 20 EPISODE ‰ j œ œ œ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œœ n œ œœ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œœ œ n œ œ‰ n œœ œœ œ œ œ n œœ nœ œ J SUBJECT HEAD CTRPT SUB HEAD COUNTERSUBJECT 1 ? bb œ ‰ b J œ bœ œ œ œ ‰ nœJ C. S. 1 HEAD SUB HEAD & & & ? 26 ? ? C. S. 1 HEAD C. S. 1 HEAD EXPOSITION C. S. 1 HEAD SUB HEAD SUB HEAD C. S. 1 HEAD C. S. 1 HEAD œSUB œ œ HEAD œSUBœ œHEAD œœ œœ ‰ ‰ œœ ‰SUB‰ HEAD J œ œ œ J J œSUBœ œHEAD œ œ ‰œ œ ‰œ CTRPT œ œœ ‰œ œ ‰œ œœJ ‰ ‰ œJœ Jœœ ‰ ‰ œJ J J≈ n œ n œ œ œ œ œ Œ CTRPT œ CTRPT Œ C.≈ S.n1œHEAD œœœ œ œ n œ œ INV Œ ≈ nœ nœ œ œ œ œ œ œ C. S. 1 HEAD INV n œœ J n œœ n œJœ J œ C. S. 1 HEAD INV COUNTERSUBJECT 1 œ œ œHEAD œEXPOSITION œ œ œ n œ n œ œ 1œœ œ œ ‰ œ COUNTERSUBJECT b b b œ SUB EXPOSITION œ œ œ œ œ ‰SUB‰HEAD COUNTERSUBJECT ‰ ‰ œ œ œ 1 œ œ œ œ œœ œ n œœ œœ œ œœ bb b J œ œ œ Jœ Jœ œ œ œ n œ n Jœ œ œœ œ œ ‰ œ œ œ ‰œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ œ‰ œ œ‰ œJ œœJœ œ‰ œ ‰œ n œ œJ œ œœ œCOUNTERSUBJECT b b b CTRPT œœ œœ n œœ œ œ œ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ 2œ n œœ œœ œ œœ Jœœ œ ‰ ‰ ‰ ‰ nœ œ J œ œ œ œ Jœ œ n œJ œ œ œ Jœ œ œCOUNTERSUBJECT b b b CTRPT n œ œ œ œ œ œ œ 2œ œ œ œ œ œ œS.œ1 œHEAD CTRPT 2 œ œ n œ SUBJECT œ œ œ œ œ œCOUNTERSUBJECT b b b œ œ C. nœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ nœ œ œ œ bbb œ œ œ nœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ C. S. 1 HEAD SUBJECT C. S. 1 HEAD SUBJECT CADENTIAL MATERIAL SUBJECT b n œ œ MATERIAL œSUBJECT & b bCADENTIAL œ œ œ œ œœ œn œœ œ œ œ œ‰ n œœ J b CADENTIAL MATERIAL SUBJECT 29 & b b b n œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ‰ n œœ œ œ œ Jœ & b b n œœ œ œœ œ œn œœ CTRPT ‰ n œJ ? b b œ œ œ œ n œ œ œ˙ b œ ˙CTRPT ? bb œ œ œ ˙CTRPT ? bbb œ œ œ œ ˙ b œ ˙ 29 œœ œœœ œœœœœœ œœœœœ ‰ j CTRPT œ œSUBJECT œ œ HEAD n œ œ œ œ œ œ œ nœ œ œ ˙ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ‰ CTRPT œ SUBJECT ‰ œ HEAD œ œj ˙ œ œ œ œ n œ œ Jœ œ œ n œ œ œœœœ œ œ œ œ œœ œ ‰œ CTRPT œ œ œSUBJECT œ ‰œ œœj HEAD ˙ œ œ œ n œ œ œ ˙œ CTRPT n œ J œ œ œ œ ˙œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ‰ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ ˙ œœœœœ J œ œ œ œ œHEAD œ œ œ œ œ œCTRPT nœ nœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ CTRPT œ œ œ SUBJECT SUBJECT HEAD CTRPT œ œ CTRPT œ œ œ œ œ œ œ C. C.œS.œ 1œ HEAD œ œC.œ S.œ 1œ HEAD œ œ œ œ œ œC.œS. 1œHEAD œ œ œS.œ1 œHEAD œ œ œ œ œ œ œ nœ nœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ nœ nœ œ œœœœ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œ C. S. 1 HEAD C. S. 1 HEADœ C. S. 1 HEAD C. S. 1 HEAD b &bb 23 b 23 & bbb &bb ? b bb ? b b ? bb bb 26 ‰ œ œ œ œ œœœ œ CTRPT SUBJECT HEAD CTRPT COUNTERSUBJECT 2 23 26 œ bœ œ 29 b &bb b & bbb & ? bb b b b ? bb ? bb bb œœ œœ œœ w w w w w œ n œ œ b n œœœœ ‰ J œ n œ œ b n œœœœ œ n œ œ‰ b n œJœœœ ‰ J œœœ œœœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ n œœœ ‰ Jœœ n œœœ œ ‰œ n Jœœœw ‰ J w w w w œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœœ œœ œœ œœ œœœ œœœ œœ J œœ Jœœ J œ‰ œ n ˙˙ ˙ œ‰ œ n ˙˙ œ œ n ˙˙ ‰ ˙˙ ‰ n œj ‰ œj ‰ n Jœ ‰ n œœj ‰‰ Jœœ JJ ‰ œ J ‰ œJ 195 195 195 &œ pt 4ˆ 5ˆ 6ˆ 7ˆ 2ˆ 1ˆ 6ˆ 7ˆ œ œ w #œ CHAPTER & w 30. INTRODUCTION w TO COUNTERPOINTœ w c.f. w c.f. pt 7ˆ 5ˆ 6ˆ 357 7ˆ Figure 30.8.4 ˙ from ˙ WellTempered 44 Ó J.S. ˙ Bach, ˙ ˙Fugue˙ 2 ˙in C ˙minor ˙ ˙ # ˙ Clavier, w Book I& (BWV 847) 8 4 YT: itvGdURMfbM 5 8 6 5 3 6 sync. 5 7 6 8 sus. sync. sync.you will be asked to analyze a fugue with In homework and sus. on the test, regard to 4expositions w (including the bridge, episodes, subjects, w if it occurs), &4 w w w fragmentation. w w answers, countersubjects, and motivic c.f. 30.9 Practice Exercises Species Counterpoint: Day w b 4 „ ∑ One 3 & 2 ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙. œ œ œ ˙ w 5 3 34 56 5 3 8 sync. First and Second Species Exercises p 4 1. & b 2 w. ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙. œ œ œ ˙ w sync. ˙ 5 tt Ó 3 3 32 5432 p p ˙ œœœ p p œ œœœœ For each exercise below, write first species (note-against-note) counterSpecies type: 2nd 4th 4th 2nd 1st 2nd 4th 1st 2nd 3rd point. Write the intervallic distance from the cantus firmus (“c.f.”) to the counterpoint in the blanks above the staff. Remember to begin and end with an octave or unison, to proceed to the last unison by step in both voices, and use only consonances (1, 3, 5, 6, 8, 10). Interval: ____ 4 &4 & 44 w c.f. Interval: ____ Interval: Interval: ____ ____ c.f. c.f. c.f. 444 www & & & 44 44 & & & 444 Int: Int: Int: ___ ___ ___ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ w w w w w w ____ ____ ____ www ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ www www ____ ____ ____ www ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ www www www ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ www ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ c.f. ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ c.f. c.f. c.f. ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ____ ____ ____ www ___ ___ ___ 44 & & & 444 44 w & & & 444 www www www www www ww www www www www www www www www c.f. c.f. 444 www www www www ww ww ww www www ww www www www www & w w w w & & 44 444 & & & 44 Int: Int: Int: 444 ___ & & & 44 444 & & & 44 www c.f. c.f. Int: Int: Int: ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ c.f. www www www www www www www www www www ? 44 4 Int: ___ ___ ___ ___ CHAPTER 30. 358 Int: ___ INTRODUCTION ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ TO ___ COUNTERPOINT ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ 2. 44 & 44 exercises below, write second species counterpoint—two half notes For &the in each measure except the3last.3 Each downbeat must be a3 consonance. 8 5 ___ 6 ___ 6 ___ 5 ___ 8 ___ 6 ___ 3 ___ 6 ___ 3 ___ 1 Int: ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ The only dissonance allowed is the passing tone. Write the intervallic 44 c.f. w w & 4 wfromwthe wwcantus distance w firmus ww ww(“c.f.”) ww towww thewwwcounterpoint ww ww wwin thew blanks & & 44c.f.the w w w w w w above staff. Circle all dissonant numbers (2, 4, and 7) and label w w w w ww c.f. w passing tones with “pt.” & 44 44 & & 44 Int: 444 & & & 44 Int: Int: ___ w ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ w w ww w www w ww w ww w ww ww w w w w ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ c.f. c.f. 1 ___ 2 ___ c.f. w 5 ___ 6 ___ 8 ___ 6 ___ w w 6 ___ 8 ___ w 6 ___ 8 ___ w w w ww ___ ___ 5 ___ 3 ___ w 1 ___ w __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ w__ __ ˙ __ & 444 __˙ __˙ __ __˙ __˙ __ ˙__ __˙ __ __ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ 4 & & 44 w ? Int: ? 4444 __ww __8 w__3 __2 ww__3 __5 ww__8 __7 __ww3 __5 ww__6 __7 ww__6 __3 ww__6 __3 ww__5 __6 ww__8 c.f. ˙ ˙ Ó ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ #˙ w & 44 c.f. Int: __ pt __ Int: __ __ __ __ __ __ __pt __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ pt__ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ c.f. w w ? 444 c.f. w w ww w w w w w & ww w w ww ww ww w ww ww ww ww & 44 c.f. w w ? ? 444 8 5 3 3 5 8 3 3 2 3 2 3 5 6 7 3 5 6 3 8 Int: 4 __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ c.f. & 44 w w w w w w w w wDaywTwo w Species Counterpoint: pt ? 44 Ó ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ pt˙ ˙ pt˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ w 3. For each exercise below, write third species counterpoint (quarter ˙ notes). pt Int: Int: Circle all dissonant interval numbers and label passing tones and cambiata figures. Int: __ __ __ __ & 44 ? 44 w c.f. & 44 w Int: __ __ __ __ ? 44 c.f. Int: __ __ __ __ 4 &4 ? 44 w c.f. Int: __ __ __ __ & 44 __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ w w w w w w __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ w w w w w w __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ w w w w w w __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ w __ w __ w __ ? 44 c.f. c.f. CHAPTER 30. INTRODUCTION TO COUNTERPOINT Int: Int: __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ 4 &4 ? 44 w Int: Int: __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ 4. __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ w c.f. c.f. 359 w w w w w __ __ w & 44 Int: __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ Int: __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ 4 w ? w w w w & w & 44 w w c.f. c.f. w ww ? 4 ww counterpoint ww (suspensions ww ww ? each 44 ww exercisew below,wwwrite fourth For species 4 Int: __ Int: __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ c.f. and syncopations). Circle all dissonant interval numbers and label sus4 c.f.with “sus” and syncopations with “sync.” pensions &4 Intervals: __ __ Intervals: __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ w 4 w ˙ ˙ w Ó w ? w & w & 44 wÓ ˙ w˙ c.f. c.f. ww ? 4 ww ww ww ww ww ? 44 ww ww 4 Int: __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ Int: __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ c.f. c.f. 4 w &4 w w __ __ w __ w __ Intervals: __ w __ w Intervals: w __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ c.f. c.f. 4 & & 4444 ? ww ww w ww ww ? ww ww ww ? 4444 w __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ c.f. c.f. Intervals: Intervals: 44 & & 44 __ __ ww ? ? 4444 ww __ __ __ __ ww c.f. c.f. Intervals: Intervals: 4 & & 444 ? ? 4444 ww c.f. c.f. __ __ __ __ __ __ ww __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ ww ww ww __ __ __ __ ww __ __ ww __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ ww ww ww __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ ww ww ww CHAPTER 30. INTRODUCTION TO COUNTERPOINT 360 Invention Expositions 5. 190 190 190 Complete these invention expositions by following the I–I–V–V–I harmonic3 pattern and transposing and modifying the theme accordingly. 3 & & 4443 & ? ? 44333 ? 4 œœ œ œ œ . œ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œœ œœ .œœ .œ œœœ œ œœ C: I C: I C: I ## & # & & I I I œ œ 44333 œœ œœ# œ## œœœ œ œ œ œœ œœ œœ 4 œ œ œœœ œ œ ? ? ### 4333 ? 44 e: i e: i e: i D: I D: I V V V i i i V V V I I V V ## # 2 2 & & # 44 œœ œœ œœœœ œ œœ œœ œ & ? ? ## ## 4422 ? V V V I I I V V V V V i i i I I b# # 43 ‰ œj œ œ & œ #œ œ œ œ & & ? ? b# # 43 ? d: i Fugue& Analysis b 6. i V V i For this fugue from the second Kyrie eleison of Bach’s Mass in B Minor ? b 232), specify formal sections (expositions and episodes), motives (BWV (subject, answer, countersubjects, and fragments thereof), and key areas for expositions only in the table below. This fugue contains more “counterpoint” (material not derived for subjects or countersubjects) than the C minor fugue in the body of the text. CHAPTER 30. INTRODUCTION TO COUNTERPOINT Alla breve. breve. ###### Alla C „„ & C & # ## & # ## CC „„ & # ## V # ## CC ∑∑ V Soprano Soprano Alto Alto Tenor Tenor „„ ? ## ### ? # ? # ? # #### Piano Piano „„ Ky - ri - e Ky - ri - e # ## & # ## & # ## & # ## & # ## V # ## V T T B B son, ? ## ### ˙ ww ? # ˙ - A T & ##˙˙ Ky Ky - ri ri ˙˙˙ ##˙˙˙ ˙˙... ˙˙. ˙˙.. - son, son, - Ky - ri Pno. & - ˙ œœ ##œœ œœ ##œœ ˙ e A T œœ œœ - le - - i # # ˙ œ #œ ˙ ˙ & # & ### - w son, e - le - i ˙ ˙ ## V # ˙ son, ˙. Ky - ? ### ˙ œ œ ˙ 13 e - le #˙ ri - ˙ # # # ˙˙ œœ # œœ ˙˙ # ˙˙ - œ - œ œ le˙˙ - ˙˙i - son, ˙˙.. œœ œ ##œœ œ œ - - - œœ œœ son, e - le - i son, lei - e - e - œ ˙ ˙ son, ˙ Ó w ˙ ˙ e - - - - œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ ˙ ˙ - le le œœ œœ - ∑ i - son, ˙ - i ˙. - Kyr „ œ n œœ œ ˙˙ ˙ - son, ˙ son, œœ œœ - e ˙ ri - e nœ œ ˙ #˙ le ii- œœ ##˙˙˙.. œ œœœ œœ ww #˙. - e - œ œœ ˙˙ œœ œœœ ˙˙ # ˙˙ ˙˙ n ˙˙˙ œ ˙ œ œ ˙ œ œ œ ˙ œ œ œœ ˙˙ œœ ˙ ˙ œ œœ ˙ ˙ - - œœ œœ ˙˙ ˙˙ le - i œ œ œ ˙ ˙ œœ œ œœ œ œ ˙ ˙ ˙ i - son, son, Ky - ri - e ˙ œ œ #œ œ œ œœ #œ œ œ ##˙œ˙œ..# œ ˙˙ œœ # œww œœ œ œ #œ „„ ˙˙ ˙ œ œ œ ˙e ˙ œ œ œ le - i - - le - i - - i i - ˙ ˙ ˙˙.. ˙ œœ œ˙œ œœ œœœ œœœ ˙˙˙ ˙˙˙ & & ˙ #˙ ˙ i - son, Ky e - lei - ˙˙.. ˙˙.. ˙˙ ˙˙ son, e - le œ œ #œ œ œ œ #œ ˙ - e - lei e - lei e - lei e - lei Ky - rie w ˙. - i - son, i - son, œ nœ œ ˙ ˙ œœ œ ##œœ n œœ œ ˙˙ ##˙˙ œœ ##œœ œœ ##œœ e e #œ œ œ œ ˙ œ œ ˙ son, ˙ le - i - son, ˙ n˙ #˙. le ˙ ˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ ∑ ˙ n˙ œ #œ œ . # ˙˙ ˙˙ # ˙œ œ n œ œ # œ˙ . ? ### œ œ œ œ w ˙ œœœ œw ˙ son, B - œœ œœ e son, e 13 S nnœœ œœ ˙˙ ##˙˙ e - le e - le ˙˙.. œ e ˙ ? ### ˙ ### e e e e œœ œœ ˙ n˙ #˙. ## V # #˙ 9 e e œœ ##œœ œœ œœ ##˙˙.. e e „„ „„ „ son, B - œ œœ ##œœ œœ œœ œ ##˙˙.. __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ ww ˙˙ ## & # „ ### ˙˙ „„ „„ son, e - le - i e - le - i 5 ˙˙ œ # œ 5 ? ## ### ˙˙ œ˙˙ # œ ? # ? ## ### ˙ ˙˙ ? # ˙˙ ˙˙ __ __ 9 S ˙˙ Ky - ri Ky - ri son, e - le - i - son, son, e - le - i - son, „„ „„ ˙˙ œœ ##œœ ˙˙ ˙˙ son, son, Pno. Pno. ˙˙ nn˙˙ ∑∑ - „„ ˙ ˙ n˙ œ # œ œ œœ œ ˙˙œ ˙œ œ ˙ ˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ CC ˙ n ˙˙ ##˙ww˙.. œ # œ˙˙ œ œœ ##œœ œ œœ ˙œ œ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ j CC ˙ ww œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ ˙˙ ˙˙˙ # œ œœj œœ ˙˙ œœ œ ˙˙.. ˙˙ ˙ ww ˙ œ œ œœ # œ ˙˙.. ˙˙ „„ 5 5 A A „„ „„ ∑∑ e - lei e - lei RN in f ˜: __ __ __ __ RN in f ˜: __ __ __ __ S S „„ ? ## ### C ˙˙ nn˙˙ ##˙˙.. œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ ˙˙ œœ œœ ˙˙ ˙˙ ? # C Bass Bass 361 ww ww œ #œ œ œ œ e e - lei - w. - œœ œ #œ œ œ #˙ œ . le iœ œ ˙ #˙ ˙ le i ˙ e - œœ œœ œ #œ ˙ #˙ - w. le e - lei - e - le - œ nœ œ œ œ #œ œ #œ ˙ œ - ri - e ˙ ˙ - # ˙œ . ˙ œ # œ˙ œ œ˙ œ #œ lei w. w. ˙ ˙ œœ ˙ œœ ˙˙ ˙ „ ˙œ œ # ˙œ - i ˙ - son, ˙ i œ #œ ˙ #˙ - œœ œw ˙ œœ ˙ ˙ œ CHAPTER 30. INTRODUCTION TO COUNTERPOINT # # ˙ œ #œ ˙ ˙ & # A T & ### - w son, e - le - i ˙ ˙ ## V # ˙ son, e - le A T ## & # ˙ ˙ & ### son, Ky œ˙ e ˙ œ œ #œ œ œ - le ˙ e ˙ e - lei - Ó - ∑ ˙ - i ˙. œ œ #œ œ œ œ #œ ˙ - - - i - son, - son, - „ ? ### „ le w. e - lei - e - le - œ nœ œ œ œ #œ œ #œ ˙ œ ri - e œ œ w „ ri - e e - lei - son, e - lei œ #œ #œ ˙ Ky - ri - e e - lei Ky - ri - e e - - ˙ #˙ ˙ son, Ky ˙ œ œ w „ lei - son, e - lei - - n˙ ri - - ## j & # œ ### lei ### son ? ### son ‰ Œ son, e e - lei - son, Ó - ˙ son, ˙ i - - e - son, e - le - i - ˙ - ˙ œ œ ˙ ˙ œ œ œœ œœœ œ #˙ w i i ˙˙ # ˙˙ # ˙ ˙œ œ œœ Ky - ri - e œ #œ œ œ œ #˙. „ - - - ˙ œ œ ˙ œ œ ˙ ## w & # ˙œœ ˙ ˙ œ # œœ # œœ ˙œ œ ˙˙ # œ˙ œ w˙ n ˙ # œ˙ . œ œ # œ œ wœ œ ? # # # ˙ # ˙ ˙ # ˙ ˙ œ œ œ œ œ # œ œœ œœ œœ # œœ œœ 21 S œ #œ ˙ #˙ - ˙ son, Kyr ˙ e ˙ 17 Pno. ˙ ˙ son, œ œœœ ˙ œ œ w ## œ V # ˙ #œ ˙ #˙ son, B - son, - son, e - le - i 17 S ri ˙. - #˙ nœ œ ˙ #˙ ## ˙ œ ˙ w œ # œ n œœ œ ˙˙ # ˙˙ ˙ œ˙ œ # ˙œ œ # œ & # ˙˙ œœ # œœœ ˙˙ . # ˙˙ œ ˙˙ . œ ˙. œ # œœ œ ? ### ˙ œ œ ˙ Œ œ œ #œ œ œ œ œ œ œ nœ œ œ #œ ˙ œ œ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙˙ - 13 Pno. - ? ### ˙ œ œ ˙ son, B ˙. Ky w ˙ 13 S 362 e ˙œ œ - „ le - i ˙˙ œœ œœ ˙˙ œ˙ œ œœ # œœ # ˙˙ n ˙w ˙ ˙˙ ∑ YT: aVYPtNeH7IQ ∑ 232, Kyrie eleison II & 30.9.1 ˙ J.S. Bach, Mass Óin B Minor, BWV A Figure T B V ## & # 21 Pno. ? ### ∑ w ∑ ∑ ∑ CHAPTER 30. INTRODUCTION TO COUNTERPOINT 363 Table 30.9.2 Mass in B Minor: Fugue Analysis Table FORM SOPRANO ALTO TENOR BASS KEY Meas. 1 2 3 4 l FORM SOPRANO ALTO TENOR BASS KEY Meas. 5 6 7 8 l FORM SOPRANO ALTO TENOR BASS KEY Meas. 9 10 11 12 l FORM SOPRANO ALTO TENOR BASS KEY Meas. 13 14 15 16 l FORM SOPRANO ALTO TENOR BASS KEY Meas. 17 18 19 Click here to download the first homework assignment for this chapter. Click here to download the second homework assignment for this chapter. Click here to download the third homework assignment for this chapter. Click here to download the fourth homework assignment for this chapter. Click here to download the fifth homework assignment for this chapter. Click here to download the Unit 10 Practice Test. PDF versions of the textbook, homework exercises, and practice exercises can be found at musictheory.pugetsound.edu 20 Chapter 31 Introduction to Jazz Theory This introduction to jazz theory focuses on the types of chords encountered in jazz, how these chords might be voiced, how to voice lead these chords in five-part harmony, and scales associated with these chords. 31.1 Jazz Chord Basics 1. Ninth chords are common in jazz. (a) Four of the five common seventh chord types in classical and popular music will have ninths added to them; the exception is the fully diminished seventh chord. i. The ø7 chord is also labeled as m7 (25) in jazz— Cø 7 is the same as Cm7 (25) . 44 b # b # # b E maj9( 5) B notation, 7 9( 5) (b) In lead-sheet adding “9” toE a chord symbol means the 7th 943 is also present. & (c) “9” is “2” an octave higher and always comes from the major scale unless otherwise specified. & wwwww b www ww C maj9 945 C m9( b5) b ww b www C9 b b b wwwww C m9 a. b. , 4, 2, + , m,b.–) are applied c. as follows:d. 2. Alterations (maj, ∆ C Δ9 C # m6 C # (add b 6) C + 7 C b9 C (b 9) C 7( b 9) 949 (a) “maj” or “ ∆ ” followed by 7, 9, 11, or 13 meansb the 7th of the chord w w b w b www not# the # www9th, 11th, # wwwor 13th. # b www b ∫ b www n n ww b wwww is&major, # w # w # w w bw n w w (b) Lowercase “m” or the minus sign (“–”) means minor and applies to the 3rd of the chord. (triangle still 954 956 applies to 7th) i. The minus sign (–) is equivalent to a w flat when placed in front w w & w w 2 ww same thing). “ C4 – 6 ” of 9, 11, or 13 (i.e., 9 and –9b w mean bthe w 4 4 4 (equivalent to “ C m6 ”) means a C minor chord (“ C –”) with 4 C 94). “ C C(add 13 C 9(13) the 6th from major (A –6),” which is equivalent to 4 w ww triadwwwith the 26 added “ C (add 26) ,” meanswa C4 major C mΔ7 & b ww b ww C mΔ9 b ww ww “augmented ww ww triad” or is equivalent (c) The plus sign ( + ) can mean to a sharp when placed in front of 9, 11, or 13. C + 7 means a C augmented ”) with a dominant (“7”), F dim7triad (“C + F dim7 B b7(13 ) B b7(13 b 9 seventh b 9 ) not a C 959 w w major ∫triad 7th. w with a major w w w & b b www C6 961 & wwww b n www C 7(13) b wwww w b b www bw 364 b n www bw enharmonic respellings b wwww w C 7(11) b www w C 7sus A b 7( #11) b bn wwww A b 7( b 5) b n www or A¯7(˜11) 44 943 E b maj9( # 5) B b 7 # 9(# 5) Eb CHAPTER& 31. INTRODUCTION TO JAZZ THEORY 44 945 943 & 945 & 44 (d) Chromatically altered chord numbers (affecting 6, 9, 11, 13) are maj9 C9 C m9( bwhether 5) usuallyC set apart by parentheses so asC m9 to clearly designate w w w ww the added # 9 (#minus, b ) plus, or sharp, or flat is affecting the chord or w b w b w b E b maj9 ( # 5) B b 7the 5 E & ww ww b www C(29) versus bC7( b www29). w example, consider w note. For C29 versus a. & 945 956 959 954 961 956 961 # # www # w C # (add b 6) # # # wwww c. d. C +7 C b9 C (b 9) C 7( b 9) b ∫ bb wwww n bn www b b wwww b w n wb w # b www w C9 C m9 954 C m9 ( 5) mΔ7 mΔ9 section). ( 5) B 7 9 ( 5) E maj9 b ww E b ww b. b. c. d. 4. m ∆ 7 Chord: In addition to the five common seventh chord types, jazz + # # b C Δ9 C m6 C (add 6) C 9C 7 C b9 C (b 9) C 7( b 9) C 13 956 includes use of the minor-major seventh chordC 9(13) (a minor triad with a www haveww a ninth added as well. major seventh). This chord will commonly w b w b b www www ( ∆ )wwwwused primarily You will see the “major” & symbol in jazz. Popular w music typically uses “maj” instead. &ww ww w www ww # # www # w w ∫w & b b www C9 b ∫ bb wwww n bn www b b wwww bw n w w # b www w # # # wwww F dim7 C maj9 959 b n wwww w b www w & w b ww b B b7( b 9 ) B 7( b 9 ) C m9 (triangle still F dim7 C mΔ7 C mΔ9 applies b wwwww to 7th) b n wwwww w b w bw bw b www b wwb w 13 w w enharmonic respellings 13 C m9 ( b5) b b b wwwww b b 6 C 7(13) C 7sus A b 7( #11) 5. 11th and Chords: 11thsC 7(11) and 13ths always come a. 961 b.C13th c. d. from Athe7( 5)major C 9 b. C 13 C 9 (13) scale unless otherwise specified. higher and “13” ww (“11” + 7 an octave b 6) biswwC“4” n w C Δ9 C # m6b ww C # (add C b 9 n w C (b 9) b w is “6” & an w octave higher.) ww ww w b b ww bw w www ww or A¯7(˜11) C 7( b 9) www ww w w w w w w b w b w b w b w∫ b w bw b w b b w # ww&w upwww to #the#highest (a) All #numbers wwwwww number #wwwb www are assumed. b b wwwC9 means n2n ww that www # w # w w bw n w w w the 7th is also included below the 9th. C13 means C–E–G–B –D–F–A—everything up to the 13th. For this reason, we will use C9(13)—to specify 13 13 F dim7 F dim7 B b7( b 9 ) B b7( 9 ) C–E–G–B2–D–A—instead of C13, which would be bused in the real (triangle still world to describe these notes. In the real world, a composer or C mΔ7 C mΔ9 to 7th) arranger writing C13 will assume the pianist orapplies guitarist knows to omit the unaltered 11th because it clashes with the major 3rd of the chord. In this music theory course we will be specific as to which enharmonic respellings notes are included and left out. C6 C 7(13) C 7(11) C 7sus A b 7( #11) A b 7( b 5) or A¯7(˜11) C9 C 13 C 9 (13) ∫w & b b www w b b wwww w bw b n wwww & b www w w b www b ww w& b www w b wwww w & www w 6. 959 b. C # m6 ww3. If a chord hasb wwa 9th but no 7th, buse ww the Cterm “add ww popular music, (triangle still 9.” In C applies www sometimes “2”www or “add 2” is bused www instead (refer btobtobthe www7th) Chord Labels w w w & w b w # b b # # & 949 & wwww w C maj9 & 954 b. C Δ9 949 a. 943 949 365 ww w b n wwww ww b w b www www b bn www ww b n ww b www b ww b www b ww w w 6 chord (C 6 ) instead chords: If a chord has a 6th and a 9th, call itb a 13 9 B b7(13 ) F dim7 F dim76 B 7( b99 ) b9 9 of a 6 chord. The major 9 uses the major third (C–E–G–A–D) while 6 2 the minor 9 uses the minor third (C–E –G–A–D). The “6” always comes from the major scale unless otherwise specified. (Refer to the Chord Labels section for examples.) 6 9 ∫w & b b www w b b wwww bw b n wwww w b n wwww bw 7. Enharmonic respelling: Jazz musicians willrespellings sometimes respell doubleenharmonic flatted notes and double-sharped notes enharmonically because for some b 7( #11than more fromCthe piano the ) C 6musicians theory C 7(13) was viewed C 7(11) 7susaspect of the A A b 7( b 5) staff. This may at times include enharmonically respelling notes like B4, C2, E4, and F2 (although these notes sometimes will be used). & wwww b www ww b www ww b www w b bn wwww bw b n www bw or A¯7(˜11) E b maj9( # 5) B b 7 # 9(# 5) C 13E b www ww w b w b w b www & www TO JAZZ www THEORY & 31. INTRODUCTION CHAPTER w 956 959 945 943 b b ∫ww wwww & & ww w F dim7 C maj9 a. B b7(13 b9 ) C m9( b5) www b w b bw w b www b ww w b bn wwwbwwww b wb ww enharmonic respellings c. d. b. or A¯7(˜11) (triangle still C mΔ9 applies to 7th) w 31.2 Chord Symbol Specifics & b wwww b wwww C mΔ7 956 959 1. “6” versus “13” rule: label the 6th of a chord “6” only if the 7th is not present; if the 7th is present, C 9 label the C 13 6th asC“13” 9(13) ww label theww 4th of a chord “sus” only 2. “11” versus “sus” (“sus” means “4”):w w b w b www blabel www the 4th an “11” (C7sus &if the www 3rd is present, if the 3rd is not present; w w has C–F–G–B2). (There is an exception to this in more advanced jazz theory, which is not within the purview of this text.) F dim7 F dim7 B b7(13 B b7(13 b9 ) b9 ) 411: If the chord has a normal 5th 2–F 4), call the F4 w w 3. 25 versus (C–E–G–B www www altered 5th b b ∫(because wwww a regularb nand n wwww have a chordb bwith a& “411” you bwon’t w b wthe F4 of C–E–B b ww 2–F4 a “411” at the same time). Otherwise, you can call or a “25.” enharmonic respellings C6 961 b. 366 B b7(13 b9 ) C m9 F dim7 C9 bb nwwwwwww ww C 9(13) b 9) +7 CΔ9 6 purposes C 7(13) Abb97( #11) 8. For the web 6)willCC7sus assume the Cbass note isb 7(the C C #of m6this text, CC#7(11) (add C (b 9)A C5)7( broot whenwanalyzing chords. While wwww example) b ww n wb bare www used wwwwslash #bchords wwb ww (E/C, www this chapter ∫tobnfor # w & # w # b n b w b in jazz, is meant as an introduction the fundamentals w w w # w w b w n w & ww www ww ww of #www w therefore# wwwwwill not include bb bwwwwof nslash wb chords. jazz harmony and the use bw bw 949 961 954 C9 & www w (no 7th) C 7(13) b wwww w b wwww w C 7(11) b www w C 7sus (no 3rd) A b 7( #11) b bn www b ww A b 7( b 5) b n ww b ww (no regular 5th) 31.3 Altered Dominant Seventh Chords Typically, a dominant seventh chord is considered altered if either or both the 5th or 9th are chromatically raised or lowered. (“G7alt” might mean a G7 with both an altered 5th and 9th, but is vague in that it doesn’t specify how the 5th and 9th are chromatically altered.) 1. Root, 3rd, and 7th of dominant seventh chord remain unchanged. 2. 5th may be raised or lowered (45 or 25, which can also be written with pluses and minuses as + 5 or –5) and can be respelled enharmonically (the 45 of a C745 could be written as an A2 instead of G4) for ease of reading because the chromatic spelling agrees with B2 (the 7th of the chord)—it is easier to read a chord where the accidentals agree (all sharps or all flats). 3. 9th may be raised or lowered (49 or 29, which can also be written in the lead-sheet symbol as +9 or –9). The 49 is often spelled enharmonically on the staff as 210 for ease of reading; therefore, a dominant seventh chord with a 49 will appear to have both a major and minor 3rd (C–E–G–B2–E2). You may be tempted to call such a chord a minor chord with a 211, but 211 is not used because it is the major third of a chord. or A¯7(˜11) CHAPTER 31. INTRODUCTION TO JAZZ THEORY 367 4. Both alterations of 5 and 9 may occur simultaneously (±9/±5). 5. 213 is the enharmonic equivalent of the 45. In this text, 45 is preferred to 213, but you will see both on lead sheets. Also, 213 implies that the unaltered 5th occurs in the chord, while 45 does not. 2. C 7( b 5) 3. C 7(# 5) b b www & b n b wwww w respell ˜5 to agree with ¯7 ? ∑ 2 C 7(# 9) C 7( b 9) b b www ww b b www n ww respell ˜9 to agree with ¯7 ∑ 4. 199 5. _ 9 C 7+ +_ b bb www 5 ¯5 ˜5 b b ww ˜9 n ww ¯9 C 7( b13) or C7(˜5) bw bw ww ∑ preferred If you are composing or arranging and want to know when to use altered chords, know that dominant sevenths are usually altered (with altered 5th or 6 9th or both) when they have dominant function (i.e., when the root is going & down by a fifth). Dominant sevenths are often unaltered when they to resolve have tonic function, i.e., the first chord in a blues. ? 31.4 Chord Labels The following list of chords is edited and condensed from The New Real Book 22 published by Sher Music Co. (Vol. 1), 45 964 964 964970 964970 970 975 970 975 975 981 & w & wwC w6 ? wwC w(add 9) b wwC wm (add 9) wwwC w b wwCwwm6 b wwCwwm w w w w www# wC 9 with added & CwwC6w7 31.4.1 Triads wwm6 www(add 9)notes wwmw(add 9)Cw9(13)Cwwww C 9( # 11) b C Cb13( b wwm11) C C C Figure w w ww w # ww w w # w w b wwww www# & bwwCwwCww67 wwCwbm6wwCww9 wwCw(addb 9)wwCww9(#11) b wwCwm (add 9)b wwCww9(13)wwwCw C b wwC m11) wwwb13( w w w #w w w w # & bwCwwww9 b wwww9(#11) CwΔ13(# 11)b Cwwww9(13)wwCwΔ7(# 5) b Cwwww13(wwCwΔ7( & bCwwCwwwwwΔ77 Cw Δ9 Cw Δ9(# 11)C b w w bwwwww w ww b ww #11)b 5) w w w w w w w # w # # w # w www b ww www b ww www b ww # ww w & bwwCwwwwwwCΔ77?31.4.2 Dominant wwwC 9(#11) CwwΔ13(# 11) wwwC 9(13)CwwΔ7(# 5) b wwwwCb13(wwCwwΔ7( #11)b 5) wwΔ9wwwC 9 seventh wwΔ9(# 11)chords C C Figure w # w # w # w # w www b ww www #b ww www # b ww # ww # b wwb ww # & bCwwwwwwwwΔ7C m7 www b 5) 11) C m11 C m7(11) C m13( C C 11)w 11) w wwΔ9C m9 wwΔ9( ww CwwΔ13( ww CwwCwΔ7(m135) www CwwΔ7( w # w # w w w w # w w w w wwb www wb www # wb w # & bwwwwCbΔ7wwCwm7 #bwwwwCb wwwCwΔ7(m13# 5) bbwwwwCb wwwCwΔ7(m13( wwC Δ9Cwwm9 bwwwC Δ9( wwm1111) bwwwC wΔ13( wwm7(11) C C 11) w& w www b 5) # 11) w # w # w w w w # wwwb ww wwwb ww C m9( b5) wwwb w ww # wwb Cwwwm13 m7( b 5) C m11( b 5) b w & bwwwwb CwwwCm731.4.3 # w w w w C m9 seventh C m11 C m7(11) C w w w w w w b w b w b w b Figure Major chords ww www w www www ww wwwwwm13( 11) wb w # & b b wwwwCw?m7( b5) b www b wwb wwwCwm9( b5) b ww bb wwb wwwCwm11( b 5) b www # & b wwC m7 wwC m9 b bwwwC m11 b wwC m7(11) b bwwwC m13 b wwC m13( 11) wwb w w w w # ww b 9 bw ww wwb Cwwwm9( b5) Cb13sus wwb Cwwwm11( 9 & b Cb9sus C 7sus w b b 5) b Cw13sus b b & bbCbbsuswwwwCwwwm7( b5) Cb7sus www w w w w b ww ww bw ww bw wwwww bww w b b b w b w b w b w b ww b 9 b www b www b wwwb 9 & bwCwbwsus w7sus w9sus wCw13sus w7sus b b w w w w w C C C C b b b b b C m7( 5) C m9( 5) C m11( 5) w w w ww13sus w ww w Figurew31.4.4 Minor seventh chords w w b w b w w #9 b CCwwb77sus bb#9 wCwww13susCb 97 b 9 #w9b w b9 wbCwww7( b5) bCCwww7(7sus w# 5) C 7(bbC9)wwwb9sus wb b wwwC 7(# 9) b wCww13sus & bCwwbsus w C7 b5 C 7 # b5 b w 5 w w5 w wb w w ww b b w w w b w b w b b www bbwwCw9susb ww # b wbwwCb 13sus ww # 9 b bb wwwCww#7sus b b wwb wCb13sus b b wwwb 9b 9 & bwwCbwsuswwCw7( b5) b bbwCwwwwCw7(w7sus 9 b 9 b w b 9 ww # 5) w n w n w n w w n Cww7 b 5 9) C 7( C 7( 9) C 7 C 7 C 7 # b # w w w w 5 5 w w w w w w5 w w w b w b w b w b w b w b w b w b & bwwbwCwww7( b5) b b Cbwwwww7(ww# 5) b Cwww7(bb 9)wwww b n Cwww7(# 9) b wb wwwb n Cwww7 #b 59 b b bn Cwwwww7##w95 b b Cww7wbb#95 wwwwb b#n Cwwww7 bb 95 w wC mΔ9 w C dimb ww w C 7 #119w C mΔ7 bCwwwo7 # 9 b b wwwC# dim(Δ7) b w b w b w b w b w b w b b & b wwwC 7( b5) b wwC 7(ww# 5) wwC 7( b 9) n wwC 7(# 9) b n wwC 7 b 5 b n wwC 7w# 95 b wwCw7b#b95b b wwwb b bn wwwwC 7 bb 95 & b wCwwwmΔ7 wb wCwwmΔ9 w b b wCwwdimb ww b # wCwwb wwwo7 bww# Cwwwdim(Δ7)b ww n wCww7 ##b119ww b b w & b bwwwww b b wwwwww b wwww b n wwww b b n wwww b b n wwwww b b wwwwb b b wwwb b# n wwww & b CwwwmΔ7 w b CwwwmΔ9 b b Cwwwdim b # Cwwwow7 b # Cwwdim(Δ7) n b Cwww7 #119 bw w C6 30 38 975 981 987 981 987 981 990 987 990 987 990 996 990 996 996 996 C m6 C (add 9) C m (add 9) 6 C9 6 C m9 6 9 6 9 6 9 6 9 6 9 6 9 45 45 45 975 981 975 975 981 987 981 987 981 990 987 987 990 996 990 990 996 996 996 # ww www www # www b # wwww # wwww bwwwwwC m7 b b www wC m13(# 11) ww Cbm9 & w w w C m11 m7(11) w # wC m13 & wwwCwΔ7 wwwC Δ9ww wwwC Δ9( wwwCCΔ13( # 11)w # 11) w w # w wb www#CwwΔ7(b 5) C Δ7( 5) w w w w w # wwwb www # TO JAZZ # wb w THEORY bw b ww b CwwwwΔ7(b 5) 368 wwb Δ9wwww CHAPTER # 11) & C bCwwΔ9( wwm1111) bCwwwwwCwwΔ13( b CwwwwCwwΔ7(m13# 5) & bCwwwwΔ7wCwwm7 31. INTRODUCTION wwwCwm9 # b bwwwCwwm13(# 11) C m7(11) # w # w w w w w w w w w wwb wC m7( b5) wwb ww wwb ww C m9( b5) wwb w wwb wwC m11( b 5) b ww# wwww & # wwwwC m9 wwb wwC m13(# 11) & bww wwwC m7 bwwwwwCbm11 bwwwwwC m7(11) b wwwwwCb wwwm13 w w ww b w w w w w # & b b Cwwwm7 b w b w w w w b w b w b Cwwm11 wm9( b5) b b Cwwwm7(11) b Cwwwm13 wm11( b 5) b b Cwwwwm13(# 11) C C & b wwwCwm7( b5) b Cwwwwm9 b w ww wwwwwb 9 # www b 9 ww b wwwwb wwwseventh chords b b b w Cb7sus Cb9sus Cb13sus C 7sus w w w & bbCbbsusbwwwwwwwC31.4.5 b w Figure Half-diminished b bww wwC m9( b5) wb ww b bwwwwC m11( b 5) bCwwww13sus wm7( b5) b w ww w w b b www b ww b b www b wwwwb wwwb b b b wwww b & w w w w b w b 9 5) & bCwbsusCwwm7( 5) Cw7sus wb9sus wb 7sus ww13sus 9 C C C b Cwwwwm9( 5) Cww13sus b Cwwwwm11( w & bwbwCb www7( b5) bCww7(w# 5) C 7(bb 9)wwwbwb b wwwC 7(# 9) b wwww C 7 #b 59 b bCwwwb7##bw95b wwwb 9 C 7bb#95b wwww Cb79bb 95 & wC susw wC 7sus b w wC 9susbww wCb13sus wC 7susw b w wC 13sus w b w b 9b b wwb b Cw ww b b wb Cwww7sus b ww b Cwww9susb ww b b bCwww13sus ww # 9 b b b wb Cww#7sus b b wwwb 9b 9 & b 13sus b 9 ww 9 & bCwwbwsus w w w w n w n w n w w # # w w w w b b Figure 31.4.6 Sus chords w w C C C w7( 5) Cww7( 5) Cw7( 9)ww Cw7( 9) ww Cw7 b 5 wb ww7# 5 w7# 5b ww n wCw7 b 5 b w b w b w b w w w b w b ww b w & w w bw w bw wb w & bwwb wwwwC 7( b5) b b wwwCww7(# 5) b wwwwC 7( b 9)ww b n wwwwC 7(# 9) wb bwn wwwwCo 7 #b 59 b b n wwwCww7## 95 b b wwwCw7b#95 wwb b#n11wwwwC 7 bb 95 C mΔ7 C mΔ9 C dim C 7 C dim(Δ7) C7 # #9 #9 b 9 b w b9w b 9 b w b w b w b w b w # # b b & b wwb Cwwww7( 5) b b Cwwwwww7( 5) b Cwwww7( 9)b w b n Cwww7( 9) b#bwn Cwww7 b 5 b b n Cww#7ww# 5w b b Cwww7w#b5b wwwb b# n Cwwww7 b 5 & bw bw b w b b ww b b wCwb wwo7 bbw w b b b www n wCw7b#b119ww & b Cwb wwwwmΔ7 b b wwwCwmΔ9 b b wwwww Cwdim www b n www b b n wwwwCwdim(Δ7) n ww b b wwb n www w Figure chords & b wwwwC mΔ731.4.7 Altered b wwwwC mΔ9 b b wwwC dim b # wwwCwo7 b # wwwCwdim(Δ7) b n wwwwC 7 ##119 b b Cwww7 ##11 o7 wwmΔ9 w w b C mΔ7 C C dim C C dim(Δ7) w & w w b w & b ww b ww b ww b # www b # www n b www 9 b b n www & b wwww b wwww b b www b # wwww b # wwww w & & & One finds that almost any combination of triad or seventh chord plus any perfect 11th with no 3rd = "sus" & alteration or combination of alterations is possible. lowered 9th lowered7th & major 6th is "13" when 7th is present b b b wwww & w Jazz Chords 31.5 & How to Write Figure 31.4.8 Other chords 46 no 5th (incomplete voicing is normal) no3rd root To & write a jazz chord after being given a lead-sheet symbol, begin with all of the major notes up to the 13th. major 13th Let’s work through this with the following label: Dm ∆ 11. perfect 11th Dm means D–F–A. The ∆ 11 means there is a major 7th, regular 9th, and major 9th major 7th11th. Remember, D11 would mean a regular 11th, not that there is a major perfect 5th D7 chord with the 9 and 11 (all chord members up to the 11th—D, F4, A, C, major 3rd E, G). D ∆ 11 would mean a D ∆ 7root chord with all members up to the 11 (D, F4, A, C4, E, G). b wwww & www www # & www D mΔ11 "11" means 7, 9, and 11 are present "Δ" means Δ7 "Dm" means D minor triad 411 Let’s try this with another chord: E7 449 . 5 E7 means & we have E–G4–B–D. When we look at the altered notes, we see 45, so we add a B4, then change it to a C6 because that agrees chromatically with the 7th, D. When we add 49, we add F5, which looks overly complicated, so we enharmonically respell it as G6, which agrees chromatically with the D (7th) and C (45). The 411 can be an A4, an augmented 2nd above the G (the & & www ww w b w b b b w b w CHAPTER 31. INTRODUCTION TO JAZZ THEORY 369 & w w w &w b w b w b w w b w b w b w w w # www w 2 w 4 2 w 4 987 981 & D mΔ11 ww C m7 C m7 ( b 5) C m9 ( b5) C m9 C m7(11) "11" means 7, 9, and 11 are present meansA Δ7 and B are acceptable, although 9), or we can respell it as a B "Δ" . Both the upper990 notes987 of D–G–B form"Dm" aC Gmeans minor triadtriad and therefore (Cb D )minor ( b5) m7 57sus m9 C2sus C 9sus are easyC to C 13sus sightread. w w b b bbwwwwwww ww b wwww w & #& w b b b wwww b www w 11 w #w9 www w w b ww b b www b ww b ww b ww b ww C m11( b 5) C m11 b C 7sus 9 b b wwww w C b bb # # b # b ww C Cb ˜sus C # C˜ 7susC b CC 9sus C 13sus C b C # CC 7# ww b w w ˜ b w b w w w b w & #&wwb&b www w˜w b b ww˜w b wwb wwww b n wwwb www b b n www b wwwb b n www b bbb wwwwwwww ww w ww ww w w w ww 996 990 E7 #5 9 7 5 9) 7( 5)11 spelled7as( B¯; 5) A is also 7( acceptable 7( 9) 9 respelled as ¯10 on staff 5 respelled as ¯6 on staff E7 is E-G -B-D C 7( b 5) C 7(# 5) C mΔ7 Jazz CChords mΔ9 31.6 How & to Analyze 996 & www b& w o C 7(# 9) C 7 C 7( b 9) C dim 9 7 5 7 #9 # C7 b5 C 7# C dim(Δ7) b b www w b b b www w b b b www nbww# www n wwb # www n ww b b wwww b wwwwb b wwww bbb bwwwwwww w w To analyze a jazz chord, on scratch paper write out all the major chord members up to the 13th. These include the major 3rd, perfect 5th, major 7th, major 9th, perfect 11th, and major 13th. & b wwww &&b bb wwwwwww C mΔ7 w b www & & b b www major 13th C mΔ9 perfect 11th major 9th major 7th perfect 5th major 3rd root ww b www C dim b b www In order to analyze the following chord, determine the following: major 13th perfect 11th 1. The quality of the 7th chord major 9th major 7th 2. The upper structure (9, 11, and 13) perfect 5th 3. Any alterations to any of the chord members major 3rd root 4. If any of the notes are enharmonically respelled w b w b w b & b www Work through each step (see the example below). Compare this chord to the scratch paper version with all the major notes up to the 13th. We have an E2 dominant 7th chord. The G2 can’t be the minor third because we already have a G6. If we consider the G2 enharmonically as an F4, we see we have a 49, which we noted earlier is often spelled as 210 so as to agree chromatically with the 27. The A is the 11th, but it is an A6, so it is a 411. It is not 25 because we would not have both a perfect 5th and altered 5th in the same chord. There is no C in the chord, so there isn’t a 13th. o C 7 b # wwww C b # www ww b & b ww w b w b w b & b www major 9th major 7th perfect 5th major 3rd CHAPTER 31. INTRODUCTION TO JAZZ THEORY root 370 no 13th raised 11th ¯10 = ˜9 lowered 7th perfect 5th major 3rd root 4 The final label is E27 411 9 . Let’s try another chord. 46 b bwwb b wwww b ww w & & w 46 www b w b www ww w & w & ww w perfect 11th with no 3rd = "sus" 9thno 3rd = "sus" perfect lowered 11th with lowered7th major 9th major 6th is "13" when 7th is present lowered7th no 5th (incomplete is normal) major 6th is "13" when 7thvoicing is present no3rd no 5th (incomplete voicing is normal) no3rd root root Again, work through each step. First, write all the major notes up to the 13th. 46 b b b wwww & &w & major 13th perfect 11th major 13th perfect major 11th 9th major major 9th 7th perfect 5th major 7th major 3rd perfect 5th root major 3rd root Compare the “all major and perfect” 13th chord above to the chord to be solved. & & b wwww& & & www perfect 11th with no 3rd = "sus" lowered 9th lowered7th major 6th is "13" when 7th is present no 5th (incomplete voicing is normal) no3rd root We notice we don’t have an A, and we remember that we might have a sus chord where the 4 (or sus4) substitutes for the 3rd. We see we have a B2, which confirms this. We also do not see a C,major but13th we remember that it is common to perfect 11th omit the 5th in a chord (see Incomplete Chords). Therefore we have F–B2–E2, major 9th making an F7sus chord. When we examine for upper structure notes (the 9, major 7th perfect 5th and a D (the 13). Remember, 11, and 13), we find a G2 (the 29 of the chord) major 3rd the B2 is the sus (the 4th), not the 11th, because we have no 3rd (see 11 versus root Sus). The final label is F13sus(29). “F13” means we have root, 3rd, 5th, 27th, 9th, 11th, and 13th. “Sus” is a modifier that means we have the 4th, which eliminates the 3rd as well as the 11th because “sus” and 11 refer the same note (B2). “29” means the 9th is lowered chromatically. & & 200 19 200 24 19 200 24 28 24 28 28 33 j j ‰ œj Œ ˙ & c b œœœ ... œœœ ‰ œœœ ... œœ .. œœ Ó ˙˙˙ b œœ .. œj w œœœ b ˙˙ b œ . œ œ . œœ .. œœ b œ . n œœ ww ˙ CHAPTER 31. INTRODUCTION TO JAZZ THEORY ?c ˙ j # ˙ n œ . œœ ww 371 Ó j b˙ c b œœ .. œjœ ‰˙ œœ .. œ . œj Ó ‰œ .œj Œ œ ˙œ . œ ˙œ . œb œœ .. Jj & 31.7 Jazz œœ .. œœœ .. Voicings œ œœœ b ˙˙ b œœ .. œœ Chord ˙˙ bJ œœ .. n œœœ www ˙ . œœ .± types of jazz In? this guide tones and learn about two E m7( c section ˙ b5) weA˙ 7 will bdefine ˙ C m7 Ó F 7 . Fjm7œ . œjB b7# ˙ n œœE. b 7œœ Awwb7 chord voicings. ˙ œ œ J # œ. œ &c ˙ j ˙‰ jŒ j J c Ó ‰ j & b œœœ ... œœœ œœœ ... œœœ .. œœœ œœ b ˙˙˙ . ˙ b œ œ ˙ b œ œ œ ˙ œ . Tones 31.7.1 œ . œ .. œ œ b œ b..±n œœ wwb w ˙ ? c EGuide b b m7( 5) A 7 m7 F7 F m7 E 7 b ˙B 7 ˙ the 3rd ˙Cand b ˙A 7 ˙of a chord.˙ In any . ˙ ˙ are ˙ Guide 7th circle ofn œbfifths progressions ? c Tones j # ˙ œ # ˙ Ó j œ . œ move by step. œ ww b˙ & ˙ ii–V–I˙˙and iii–vi–ii–V) œ (including theœguide . œ tones . J œ. œ J F maj7 A m7 D m7 G m7 C 7 F maj7 ? c G m7 C 7 ˙ b˙ ˙ b˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ b ˙ ± ˙ ˙ 3rd 7th ˙˙ b3rd ˙˙ 77th ww C m7 b7 5) A F 7b c ˙ 3rd F m7 B b 7 ˙ 3rd ˙E b7th 7 w & b cE m7( ˙ ˙ ˙ 3rd w A3rd 7th # ˙ 3rd 7th ˙ 3rd 7th 7th 7th &c ˙ ˙ ? b c ˙G m7 ˙C 7 wF maj7 wF maj7 c ˙A m7 ˙D m7 ˙G m7 ˙C 7 b ? ˙ 7th & cb c ˙˙7 3rd ˙˙ 7 7th wwM7˙ 3rd ˙ b c ˙˙ 73rd b ˙ ˙˙7 3rd b˙˙˙7 7th wwbM7˙3rd ˙ vi˙7 3rd F:˙ ii 7th V 3rd I 7th F: iii 7th ii 7th V 3rd I 7th 27, ˙ dominant˙ 7th chords (C7–F7–B Play through with ˙ ˙the entire w circle of fifths w 33? c c ˙ ˙ b b etc.) with Gthe the left hand Aand tonesC 7(3rd and m7 bass C 7 noteFin maj7 m7 the D m7guide G m7 F maj77th) in b hand the&right and observe how the 3rd and 7th are the same for bass notes a F: ˙ii7 3rd ˙ V77th w IM7 3rd b cF: iii˙˙ 73rd vi˙˙7 7th ˙˙ii7 3rd V˙˙ 7 7th wwIM73rd & b cfrom tritone each˙ other. ˙ 7th w 7th 3rd 7th 3rd 3rd 7th 7th C7 F 7 ˙ B b7 E b7 A b7 D b7 G b7 B7 E7 A7 D7 G7 ? ˙ ˙ ? bb6 c œ˙ b œ œ bwœ œ b œb c ˙ ˙ w & 4 bœ œ bœ œ bœ œ b b œœ # œœ n # œœ # n œœ n # œœ n œœ F: ii7 V7 IM7 ? 46 Cœ 7 Fœ7 b Bœb7 b Eœb7 A b7 b Dœ b7 œœ b œ œ b œ b œœ b œ 6 b œ bœ œ bœ œ &4 F: iii7 vi7 ii7 V7 IM7 3rd and 7th are enharmonically equivalent 33 tritone b b Gœ 7 n Bœ 7 œE 7 œA 7 œD 7 n œG 7 b b œœ # œœ n # œœ # n œœ n # œœ n œœ 27(49)—with the right hand ? 6 andœ 7(49)œ chords—C7(13)–F7( b œ b œ b œ 49)–Bc 27(13)–E chords & 4 b œ n œ b œ nœ a descending chromatically. This can be repeated with œall ofœ the bass œ notes 4 35 3rd and are enharmonically equivalent Also, you can7thplay through the circle of fifths alternating between 7(13) tritone away (starting on F in the left hand) and the qualities are exchanged tritone for?all the chords. 35 C 7(13) F 7(# 9) B b 7(13) E b 7(# 9) A b 7(13) D b 7(# 9) œœ b b œœ & 46 b œ œ ? 46 œ œ œ bœ b œœ b œœ bœ bœ œ nœ b œœ n œœ bœ bœ c G b 7(13) B 7(# 9) E 7(13) b b œœœ bœ A 7(# 9) D 7(13) G 7(# 9) œ #œ nœ nœ bœ # œœ # n œœ n # œœ # n œœ n œœ nœ œ œ nœ œ 31.7.2 Jazz Chord Voicings In this section we will examine two categories of voicings. 1. The first category (“spread” voicings) has 5-note chords with the root, 3rd, and 7th as the lowest notes with other chord members voiced above, often in the interval of a fourth or fifth. (The root will always be the lowest note, while the 3rd can be voiced above or below the 7th). 2. The second category (“close” voicings) has 5-note chords with the bass note in the left hand and the other four notes in “close position” in the CHAPTER 31. INTRODUCTION TO JAZZ THEORY 372 right hand, usually with the 7th or 3rd of the chord as the lowest note in the right hand. 201 “Spread” voicings 37 C 9(13) c ˙ voicings “Spread” & ˙ 13th 37 “Close” voicings ˙˙ C 9(13) C 9(13) 7th 3rd 9th Root ˙ b˙ & c ?˙˙ c 13th ˙˙ b ˙˙˙ 9th C 9(13) b ˙˙˙˙ 9th 13th 7th C 9(13) “Close” voicings ˙ 13th 9th 13th ˙˙ 3rd ˙˙ b9th 13th 7th 9th C 9(13) C 9(13) 3rd 7th (lowest) ˙ 13th 3rd b ˙˙˙ ˙9thRoot 7th 3rd (lowest) b ˙˙˙˙ 9th 13th 7th C 9(13) ˙ Root3rd b ˙ 7th b ˙˙ 3rd ? cchords 7thdo not have a 3rd, and some do not have or a ˙˙ 3rd Some (like sus chords) ˙ Root ˙ Root ˙ Root 6 6 Root (lowest) (lowest) 39 C Root 7th (like or C 9 ). In those cases, voice the sus4 like you would the 3rd, and likewise& voice the 6th as you would the 7th. 39 C 13sus & ˙˙? ? b ˙˙˙ 47 7th sus Root & 43 ˙˙ ˙˙ sus b ˙˙˙˙sus b ˙˙ C 13sus b ˙˙ ˙ C 13sus sus 7th Root ˙ 6 ˙ ˙ 6 C 13sus C9 C9 ˙ ˙˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙˙ 6th 3rd Root sus (4th) substituting for 3rd 6 3rd 6th Root ˙˙ ˙˙ 6th 6 C9 C9 (lowest) ˙ ˙˙˙ ˙ 6th ˙ 6th substituting for 7th ? Sometimes you will need to omit the fifth to maintain five parts. & 31.8 Standard Chord Progressions 61 # ww b www 202 #9 www ? w?II–V–I 31.8.1 63 67 w w b n www ˙ b ˙˙˙ # ˙ ˙ b˙ w # ˙˙˙ b n ˙˙ n˙ ˙ b˙ The is one of most common progressions in jazz, especially in tunes like &II–V–I 7 7 7alt. I7 Leaves,”VI“What I7 “Tune-Up,” ¯III7 II7 “Pent ¯II7 Up “Autumn Is iiThis ThingVCalled Love,” 3rd phrase House,” “Lady Bird,” and “Firm Roots,” to name just a few. In major the 63 25)–G7alt–Cm 69 . progression is Dmin9–G9(13)–C ∆ 9. In minor it is Dmin7( ? & D m9 & œœœœ? 71 ? &œ 69 #9 9(13) 7 # 5 focus only D m9 on the ii–V–I G7 #5 C 9(13) E b 9(13) D 9(13) D b 9(13) In? thisC55section we Awill progression and the iii–vi–ii–V progression. b w in Section˙ 9.3.n ˙˙ ˙ b˙ w mentioned & w& Bothn wwere w already ? G 9(13) C maj9 œœœ œ ˙˙˙ ˙ ˙ œ D m9 œœœ œ œ #9 6 Figure 31.8.1 Progression in Major D m9( b5)TheGII–V–I 7# C m9 D m7( b 5) b & b b n œœœœ ? bb œ b b &bb 71 ? b bb bœ b n œœœ œ 5 ˙ n ˙˙˙ ˙ œœœ œ œ G 9(13) C maj7 œœœ œ œ #9 G7 #5 b œœœ œ œ ˙˙˙ ˙ ˙ 6 C m9 n ˙˙˙ ˙ ˙ 201 œ 61 202 69 61 202 67 67 69 69 71 71 œœ ˙˙ œœ #9 ? œC 9(13) œ# 9 œ ˙ D 9(13) D b9(13) G7 #5 C 9(13) E b 9(13) œ A 7 # 5 ˙ D m9 œ CHAPTER n www wwwœ THEORY www TOb bJAZZ ˙˙˙ n ˙˙˙ ˙ # ˙˙˙ b n b ˙˙˙ 373 & www 31. INTRODUCTION #w w ˙ n˙ bw nw b˙ #˙ #9 #9 D m7( b 5) G7 #5 Cm ? bw D m9( b5) G 7 # 5 wC m b ˙ ˙ b˙ ˙ wb œ#œ9 #9 w & b Cb 9(13)n œœœœ ˙ b bAn7œœ# 5 ˙ œœœ E 9(13)n ˙˙D 9(13) D b9(13) D˙m9 G7 #5 œ C 9(13) b n ˙ œ 7 7 7 7alt. 7 7 œ I ii V I n wwVIw n¯III ˙˙˙7 ˙# II˙˙7 n ¯II b w b ˙ w w ˙ & 3rd phrase w w ˙ ww˙ b n ww œ b ˙˙˙ œ # ˙ ˙ ˙˙ b n ˙˙ ? bbwww œ #w b œ œ œ ˙ ? w b ˙ w ˙ b˙ ˙ D m9 G 9(13) C maj9 G 9(13) C maj7 w w D m9 Figure in 7 71 & œœœœI731.8.2 œœThe ˙˙˙ Progression œ 7II–V–I V7alt. œœœMinor œœI7œ ¯III7 ˙˙ II7 ¯II7 bb b œ VI ˙ ii 3rd phrase ˙ & ? œ œ ˙ 31.8.2 œ III–VI–II–V˙ œ œ œ D m9 Gprogression 9(13) C maj9 D m9 G 9(13) The is called a turnaround becauseC˙ maj7 it replaces the ? iii–vi–ii–V b staticbœharmony of the I chord in the last two measures of a tune with harmonic b œœœ # ˙˙ & œœœthat leads #9 œ œ ˙ ˙ motion to the I chord that will occur upon repetition 9 œ œ G7 #5 ˙ C m œ D m7( b5)œœ G 7 # ˙ C mto the top of D m9( b5) the form. This also applies to the I–VI–II–V progression. 5 ˙ b bœ b can ? œ so all œfour ˙ ˙ are dominant &One ˙ 7˙˙˙ 7turnaround n œœœœ modify b b7n œœœaœ iii–vi–ii–V œœ7œ chords œ b œ œ 7 7 7 seventh chords: III –VI –IIn ˙–V (or V /vi–V ˙˙ 7 –A 7 –D 7 –G 7 œ œœ /ii–V /V–V˙7n —E in ? lead sheet symbols). Turnarounds made solely of dominant seventh chords œ ˙seventh chord œ œ ˙ b b b employ can them tritone (substituting a dominant œ # 9 substitutions œ # 9 œ tones). ˙ m E 7 –A 7 –D 7 –G 7 b5) b 5) GFor a tritone away have D m9(because G 7 #they C m the same guide D m7( 7 # 5 example, C 5 7 7 7 7 b 2 2 becomes –D . & b b En œœœœ–E –D ˙ b bn œœœœ œœœ show tritone b œœœ substitutions n ˙˙˙ n ˙˙˙ arrows ? bEbm7 œA m9 D m9 G 9(13) E˙7 A 7 D 7 œG 7 œE 7 E b7˙ D 7 D b7 b œ œ & œœœœ œœœœ œœœœ œœœ # œœ # n œœ n # œœ œn œ # œœ b n œœ ˙ # œœ n œ œ œ œ œ ˙ 6 9 6 9 6 9 6 9 6 9 6 9 ?œ œ bœ œ bœ œ m9 Dœ m9 Gœ 9(13) Eœ7 Aœ 7 Dœ 7 Gœ 7 E m7 A E7 E b7 D7 D b7 œœœ œœœ œœœ # œ n œ # œ n œ & œœœœ 31.8.3 # œœ shown œœ Tritone n œœ œ #Progression b n œœ #with Figure œ The œ III–VI–II–V œ n œ inœMajor and œ arrows show tritone substitutions Substitutions substitutions, V7 . ?Because œ 2 œ of tritone œ œ the 72œII479 chord can œbe substituted b œ œ for œ b œ In C, D 9(13) is oftenœ substituted for G 45 . œ D m9 74 & c œœœœ ?c œ #9 G7 #5 tritone substitution C maj9 bœ b n œœœ n ˙˙˙˙ œ ˙ identical voicings D m9 D b 9(13) C maj9 œœœ œ bœ b n œœœ n ˙˙˙˙ œ bœ ˙ Figure 31.8.4 The 2II 7 substituting for V 7 in a Tritone Substitution 31.8.3 The Blues Progression Below are two choruses of a common jazz version of the blues progression. The first chorus uses the first category of voicings (“spread” voicings) while the ? c ˙˙ ˙ 3rd 3rd Root Root ˙ 7th 7th Root Root ˙ Root Root Root Root CHAPTER 31. INTRODUCTION TO JAZZ THEORY 39 39 39 C 13sus C 13sus C 13sus C 13sus 6 66 C C 999 C 13sus C 13sus sus (4th) substituting for 3rd 43 43 43 6 66 C C 999 &c ?c ww ww w F F 9(13) 9(13) ww b ww w 5th 5th 9th 9th 6th 6th 3rd 3rd Root Root 6 C: C: II996 49 49 374 ˙ ˙ ˙ 7th second with b ˙˙˙˙sus (“close” ˙˙˙ sus category & ˙chorus ˙uses the second ˙˙ voicings ˙ ˙˙˙the 3rd˙˙˙ or6th 6th sus sus as the ˙lowest note). b˙ ˙ 2 6th 4 6th Notice that˙ the voicings for the A7 495 and E˙ 93rd (13) are identical (not (lowest) sus (lowest) sus 3rd b ˙ b ˙ 2 7th 6th ˙ ˙ 9 7th 6th 7th ? ˙ 6th counting a tritone 7th because sus 6th substitution ˙ the ˙ Root ˙ the ˙ E (13) ˙˙is 3rd ˙ Root ˙ ˙ for the sus roots) 3rd 2 4 Rootis true for the G7 49 Root Root A7 495 . Root The same and theRoot D 9 (13) . The Roman 45 Root numerals below areforsimplified. sus the (4th) staves substituting 3rd 6th substituting for 7th C 13sus C 13sus C C 9(13) 9(13) & ww ? b www II77 C C 9(13) 9(13) ww b ww w 9th 9th 13th 13th 3rd 3rd 7th 7th Root Root 7 IV IV7 ##9 9 A A 77 ##55 nw w # ww w 7 VI VI7 II77 ##9 9 C C77 ##55 ww nw ww 7 ii ii7 ##9 b b ww n ww w 7alt. V V7alt. 6 66 C C 999 F F 9(13) 9(13) F F 13sus 13sus ˙˙ b ˙˙ ˙ 7alt. II7alt. 9 G G 77 ##55 6 66 C C 999 6th substituting for 7th b b ww b ww w 1st 1st phrase phrase D D m9 m9 6 66 C C 999 F F 9(13) 9(13) ˙˙ b ˙˙ ˙ 7 IV IV7 ww b ww w 7 IV IV7 2nd 2nd phrase phrase b 9(13) C C 9(13) 9(13) E E b9(13) ˙ ˙ b ˙˙ b˙ ˙ ˙ b˙ ˙˙ 7 ¯III ¯III7 II77 b 9(13) D D 9(13) 9(13) D D b9(13) ˙˙ ˙ # ˙˙ 7 II II7 b b ˙˙ n b n ˙˙˙ 7 ¯II ¯II7 3rd 3rd phrase phrase 55 55 6 66 C C 99 & www 5th 5th 3rd 3rd w 9th 9th 6th 6th ? w F F 9(13) 9(13) b wwww w 6 C: C: II969 61 202 C 9(13) & www bw ? w 7 IV IV7 C C 9(13) 9(13) w b www w ##9 9 C C77 ##55 (E respelled b b bb wwww(E asrespelled as F¯) F¯) w II77 F F 9(13) 9(13) F F 13sus 13sus F F 9(13) 9(13) b ˙˙˙˙ b ˙˙˙˙ 7alt. II7alt. b wwww w w 7 IV IV7 7 IV IV7 1st 1st phrase phrase #9 A7 #5 nw # www I7 w VI7 D m9 www w w ii7 2nd 2nd phrase phrase #9 G7 #5 b bn wwww w V7alt. C 9(13) E b 9(13) ˙˙˙ n ˙˙˙ b˙ #˙ ˙ b˙ I7 3rd phrase ¯III7 D 9(13) D b 9(13) # ˙˙˙˙ b n b ˙˙˙ n˙ ˙ II7 b˙ ¯II7 67 Notice that the voice leading is very smooth for each part with the exception of & the bass line. All voices move by step or by 3rd. 31.9 ? Scales In this section on scales, our primary concern will be understanding how scales relate to corresponding chords in order to allow one to improvise a jazz solo. Similarly, understanding chord-scale relationships can allow one to write & ? & ˜ 13. B9(13) 15. E¯7 ˜11 9 14. G¯69 16. A¯Δ9(˜5) ˜ CHAPTER 31. INTRODUCTION TO JAZZ THEORY 375 ¯5) 9(¯5) 11 A¯m95. D7 ¯9 5. D69 (˜11) B¯m9(¯5) 2. B7(˜5) 7. G3.Δ7(Em 1. 6. G9sus 4. C˜m8. ¯5 chordal solos (like a sax soli or shout chorus in a jazz ensemble piece) where ˜11)corresponding 6. tones GmΔ9come 7. A¯Δ9( 8. D¯69 scale.9. E¯Δ9(˜5) 10. FΔ7(¯5) non-chord from the ¯5 4 ¯3 j j j 13 7 9 œ œ 11. E ‰susœ ‰ b œ 12. ‰ D¯œ ˜˜5 ‰ j œ The blues scale is identical to the minor pentatonic scale (1̂ –23̂ –4̂ –5̂ –œ27̂ ) 31.9.1 The Blues Scale œ add94 œ 9. C˜mΔ7 10. F˜V 4 8ˆ ¯7ˆ 5ˆ ˆ ˆ ˆ except with an added 25̂ /44̂ (1̂ –23̂ –4̂ –25̂ –5̂ –27̂ ). 4 œ œ œ b œ 7 11 &69 4 œ ˜9œ œ G¯ 15. E¯ ˜ 8ˆ 13. B9(13) 14. ¯7ˆ 5ˆ ¯5ˆ 4ˆ ¯3ˆ 1ˆ 16. A¯Δ9(˜5) Figure 31.9.1 The Blues Scale (Descending)11 1. G9sus 2. B7(˜5) 3. Em9(¯5) 4. C˜m 5. D7 ¯9 ¯5 A well-known example of the blues scale occurs in “Sunshine of Your Love” 6. GmΔ9 7. A¯Δ9(˜11) 8. D¯69 9. E¯Δ9(˜5) 10. FΔ7(¯5) by Cream. & ¯5 4 ¯3 4 œ œ œ œ ‰ œj ‰ b œj ‰ j ‰ j V4 œ œ œ 8ˆ ¯7ˆ 5ˆ ˆ ˆ ˆ 1ˆ œ & 44 œ œ œ b œ œ œYT:œKWKXNoKgLQU & Figure 31.9.2 Jack Bruce and Eric Clapton, “Sunshine of Your Love” In the blues scale, the 25̂ and 23̂ are considered to be “blue notes” because they are not chord tones (of a major triad or dominant 7th chord). Blue notes are commonly used in jazz and popular music. In terms of using the blues scale as a soloist, you will find that some players use the blues scale over any and every chord, and that listeners’ ears often find this acceptable. 31.9.2 The Bebop Scale The bebop scale (known more specifically as the “bebop dominant” scale in jazz theory texts) is identical to the Mixolydian scale except is has an added ↑7̂ . The added chromatic note (↑7̂ ) occurs in descending passages (from 8̂ –7̂ –27̂ ) as a chromatic passing tone. The bebop scale is most often used over the dominant 7th chord. In the most rudimentary form of improvising, one can use the bebop scale in descending eighth notes beginning on the downbeat of a measure, starting on the root, 3rd, 5th, or 7th. 1ˆ œ 4 œ œ œ bœ &4 œ œ œ CHAPTER 31. INTRODUCTION TO JAZZ THEORY 8ˆ ¯7ˆ 5ˆ ¯5ˆ 4ˆ ¯3ˆ 1ˆ & 44 œ œ b œ œ œ œ œ œ w Root œœœœœ œ bœ œ w & 5th 376 œ œ œ œ bœ œ œœ w 3rd b œ7thœ œ œ œ œ œ nœ bw Figure 31.9.3 Descending C Bebop Scale starting on Root, then 3rd, then 5th, then 7th 31.9.3 Table of Scales The scales below are represented by scale degrees. Synthetic scales like whole tone, diminished, and diminished-whole tone have many acceptable enharmonic respellings. Table 31.9.4 Table of Scales CLASSICAL SCALES Major (“Ionian”) 1̂ –2̂ –3̂ –4̂ –5̂ –6̂ –7̂ Natural Minor (“Aeolian”) 1̂ –2̂ –23̂ –4̂ –5̂ –26̂ –27̂ Harmonic Minor 1̂ –2̂ –23̂ –4̂ –5̂ –26̂ –7̂ Melodic Minor 1̂ –2̂ –23̂ –4̂ –5̂ –6̂ –7̂ MODES AND HYBRID MODES Mixolydian 1̂ –2̂ –3̂ –4̂ –5̂ –6̂ –27̂ Lydian 1̂ –2̂ –3̂ –44̂ –5̂ –6̂ –7̂ Dorian 1̂ –2̂ –23̂ –4̂ –5̂ –6̂ –27̂ Phrygian 1̂ –22̂ –23̂ –4̂ –5̂ –26̂ –27̂ Locrian 1̂ –22̂ –23̂ –4̂ –25̂ –26̂ –27̂ Locrian 42 (6th mode Melodic Minor) 1̂ –2̂ –23̂ –4̂ –25̂ –26̂ –27̂ Lydian-Dominant (4th mode Melodic Minor) 1̂ –2̂ –3̂ –44̂ –5̂ –6̂ –27̂ Phrygian-Dorian (2nd mode Melodic Minor) 1̂ –22̂ –23̂ –4̂ –5̂ –6̂ –27̂ Lydian-Augmented (3rd mode Melodic Minor) 1̂ –2̂ –3̂ –44̂ –45̂ –6̂ –7̂ Mixolydian-26̂ (5th mode Melodic Minor) 1̂ –2̂ –3̂ –4̂ –5̂ –26̂ –27̂ JAZZ AND SYNTHETIC Blues 1̂ –23̂ –4̂ –25̂ –5̂ –27̂ Bebop Dominant 1̂ –2̂ –3̂ –4̂ –5̂ –6̂ –27̂ –7̂ Bebop Major 1̂ –2̂ –3̂ –4̂ –5̂ –45̂ –6̂ –7̂ Whole Tone 1̂ –2̂ –3̂ –44̂ –45̂ –27̂ Octatonic (Half-Whole) (“Diminished” scale) 1̂ –22̂ –23̂ –3̂ –44̂ –5̂ –6̂ –27̂ Octatonic (Whole-Half) (“Diminished” scale) 1̂ –2̂ –23̂ –4̂ –44̂ –45̂ –6̂ –7̂ Diminished-Whole Tone (also “Altered” scale or 7th mode Melodic Minor) 1̂ –22̂ –23̂ –24̂ –25̂ –26̂ –27̂ CHAPTER 31. INTRODUCTION TO JAZZ THEORY 377 31.10 How to Determine Chord-Scale Relationships To discover a chord-scale relationship for almost any chord, write all of the notes of the chord (including upper extensions and altered notes), then fill in the thirds with the most logical choices, avoiding augmented seconds and consecutive half steps. In the example below, we determine the scale that best fits G∆7 (411) by doing the following: 1. Identify the notes in the chord 2. Write all chord tones as a scale within the span of an octave 3. Fill in any gaps, avoiding augmented 2nds and consecutive half steps 4. Analyze the resulting scale Identify notes in chord G maj7 ( # 11) & # # www ww 49 Write notes as scale within an 8ve span œ root (gap) œ #œ œ 3rd ˜11 5th #7th œ (gap) Fill in gaps, avoiding aug. 2nds and consective half steps œ #œ œ œ # œ œ œ œ w w h w w w h Figure 31.10.1 How to Determine a Scale for a Chord & The G Lydian scale is the most correct scale to play over G∆7 (411) . Principle 31.10.2 Determining Chord-Scale Relationships. When constructing the scale, avoid augmented seconds and consecutive half steps 31.10.1 List of Chord-Scale Relationships & Below is a list of common chord-scale relationships. When there are two scales listed for a single chord, it is because the chord has a minor third that can be filled with half step then whole step or whole step then half step. This knowledge of chord-scale relationships ultimately becomes second nature to an improvising jazz musician. & CHAPTER 31. INTRODUCTION TO JAZZ THEORY 378 Table 31.10.3 List of Chord-Scale Relationships CHORD C∆7 C∆7 (411) C∆7 (45) Cm7 Cø 7 Cø 9 C◦ 7 Cm ∆7 Cm 69 C7 C7 (411) C7 (45) C7 (25) C7 (29) C7 (49) 4 C13 411 9 C7 alt CORRESPONDING SCALE(S) C major scale or C Lydian scale C Lydian scale C Lydian-Augmented scale C dorian scale or C natural minor C locrian scale or C locrian 42 C locrian 42 C Octatonic Whole-Half C melodic minor ascending C Dorian or C melodic minor ascending C Mixolydian C Lydian-Dominant C Whole Tone scale C Whole Tone scale C Octatonic (Half-Whole) C Octatonic (Half-Whole) C Octatonic (Half-Whole) C Diminished-Whole Tone This list is not exhaustive. Follow the process above (“How to Determine Chord-Scale Relationships”) for chords not listed in this list. Additionally, it is often important to look at the relationship of a chord to the overall key of a tune to determine the appropriate scale. For example, the Fmin7 at the beginning of “All The Things You Are” by Jerome Kern is the vi7 chord in A2 major, in which case it would be inappropriate to play an F Dorian scale because the D6 would conflict with the D2 in the key signature. One would play an F natural minor (or Aeolian) scale instead. Identify notes Fill in gaps, avoiding aug. 2nds Write notes as scale in chord 31.11 Harmonizing the Bebop Scale and consective half steps within an 8ve span Identify notes # ( ) G maj7 11 Fill in gaps, avoiding aug. 2nds Write notes as scale in chord 7th and consective half stepsfor harwithin an # 11) rootBook, In The GJazz Mark Levine provides a method 3rdauthor maj7 (Theory ˜118ve5thspan & # # www œ œ œ #œ œ œ œ (1̂ –2̂#7th ww the bebopœ major œ #scale 4ˆ5œ –#6̂œ–7̂ –8̂ ) with four œ # monizing – 3̂ – 4̂ – 5̂ – œ &# w w w# œ h œ 3rd ˜11 5th (gap)# œ root œ voices. w w w œ w# œ h œ œ # œ ww œ (gap) œ œ each part—soprano, œ tenor, then bass. Try singing through alto, w w h (gap) & 44 & 44 C6 o B 7 o B 7 (gap) C6 o B 7 o B 7 C6 o B 7 o B 7 w C6 w o B 7 o Bœ7 w h C6 www6 C6 Cœ6 b œ C œ # œ n œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœœ b œœœœ n œœœ b œœœ œœ œœ œ œœ ww œ œ œ œœ œœœ # œœœ n œœœœ b œœœ www œœœ b œœœ n œœœ b œœ œ œ œ Figure 31.11.1 Four-Part Harmonization of the Bebop Scale in Major & & C6 C m6 o o B 7 B 7 œœœ b œœœœ bœ œ œ b œœœ b œœœ C m6 C6 C m6 o o B 7 B 7 C m6 bn œœœ b œœœœ œ bn œœœ b œœœœ œ C m6 o o B 7 B 7 C m6 o o Bœ7 B 7 C m6 C m6 b œœœœ # œœœœ n œœœœ b œœœ œ b œœœœ # œœœœ n œœœœ b œœœ C m6 wC m6 b www w b www &Notice that all of the non-tonic chords are vii◦7 chords in various inversions. & Figure 31.11.2 Four-Part Harmonization of the Bebop Scale in Minor 49 49 CHAPTER 31. INTRODUCTION TO JAZZ THEORY 379 47 47 One hears a similar approach to harmonizing a scale (though without the # w w fully-diminished seventh example. ww w in the ##following b ww chords #aswwpassing chords) ## wwwww ww bb b b www b w ? ? 6 E¯m E¯m699 1. 1. _____ _____ ww bb www w ## wwww w ˜ A9 4. A9(˜11) 4. _____ _____ 7(11) 13sus¯9 Gm B 2. _____ 3. Gm7(11) B13tnLK5lMY97s sus¯9 2. _____ 3. _____ _____ YT: nw w ( 11) ## ww ## wwww F 5. F˜˜m m9(¯5) 5. _____ _____ w 9(¯5) Figure 31.11.3 Count Basie and bb #n wwwHis Orchestra, www“London Bridge wwwwwwis Falling ? # w w b bb w # www # ww Down” ? b ww ww bb ww ww 1. 2. 3. 4. 1. _____ _____ 2. _____ _____ 3. _____ _____ 4. _____ _____ 31.12 Practice Exercises w ww ww bb www ww b b ww b & b w w b www b ww b & Dayb ##One w Jazz Theory: b b w bb b wwww w b w 1. Given the following lead-sheet symbols, write the chords. Remember w 5. 6. 7. 8. 5. _____ _____ appropriate 6. _____ _____ 7. _____ _____ respell notes 8. _____ _____like C2, it is sometimes to enharmonically B4, F2, E4 and altered notes like 45 and 49. ? ? 9 1. 1. G G9sus sus & & Δ9 6. 6. Gm GmΔ9 Δ9(˜11) 7. 7. A¯ A¯Δ9(˜11) ? ? C 7( b5) C 7(# 5) Jazz Theory: Day Two 2. 2 2. 1. _____ ? ?& # ##wwwww w 6 ? 11 3. C 7( b 9) 9(¯5) 3. 3. Em Em9(¯5) 11 4. 4. C C˜˜m m11 7 ¯9 5. ¯5 5. D D7 ¯9 ¯5 6 8. 8. D¯ D¯699 Δ9(˜5) 9. 9. E¯ E¯Δ9(˜5) Δ7(¯5) 10. 10. F FΔ7(¯5) 4. C 7(# 9) _ 9 C 7+ +_ b www b bb www ¯5 ¯9 b ww following b ww chords busing b b wwwchords symbols. b & b nthe Label jazz ww ww ww n ww ˜5 # w w respell 5 to agree with ¯7 wrespell ˜9 to agree ww with ¯7 b b#wwwww˜9 ?? b b b wwww˜ ∑ # wwww n#wwww ∑ b www & w & 15 7(˜5) 2. 2. B B7(˜5) & & & # ww w w # www b w Em 6. _____ nw b w n b www # ww w 2. _____ # ww b b b www ww D˜ 7. _____ 7 9 5 3. _____ # www w w 8. _____ ww b ww b b n www bw 4. _____ b ww w ww 9. _____ ww w F ˜˜ 11 7 9 5. C 7( b13) or C7(˜5) bw bw ww # wwwpreferred ∑ # ww ww w w b wwb # ww w 5. _____ w w b www b b b www C 10. _____ E sus ¯5 5 Jazz Theory: Day Three # ww ˜ n w & w ww w 3. Voice lead w maintaining five voicesw w wthroughb wthe following progressions, out. Remember to spell notes In the b www when necessary. b w enharmonically ww use “close” voicing, b w &? example, first keeping all the upper notes as close bw together asw possible. In the second example, use Root–3rd–7th or 9. _____ always for10.the _____ 11.voices, _____ then realize 12. _____ Root–7th–3rd lowest three the rest of the lead sheet symbol with the upper two parts (“spread” voicing). w b www Use for 6th# wchords and Root–4th–7th for sus & Root–3rd–6th # www n b ww chords. w # w & b You may need to omit the 5th to maintain five parts throughout. ? & 19 & &? Δ9(13) w w 13. _____ #w w 14. _____ 9 b b www 15. _____ 199 o7 # www 16. _____ 47 ?c ˙ ˙ ˙ b˙ #˙ #w CHAPTER 31. INTRODUCTION TO JAZZ THEORY Db 9 6 79 & c b b ˙˙˙ b˙ ? c b˙ 50 50 50 79 #9 A7 #5 & c ˙˙ & #˙ ?c ˙ ? ˙ 76 82 #9 C7 #5 ˙ F 13sus ˙ E b 7(# 9) b˙ b˙ #˙ #w ˙ ˙ w F # 9sus G 9(13) #w ˙ #˙ #w ?1.c_________________________ b˙ ˙ 1. _________________________ ˙ bb œœ bb œœ bb œœ œœ bœ bœ bœ œ _________________________ 3. _________________________ &3. _________________________ œœ bb œœ bb œœ œ b œ œ œ b bœ bœ & & b œ bb œœ œœ œœ b œ œ b œ b œ &? b œ 5. 5. _________________________ 5. _________________________ 5. _________________________ Please & write the following scales. & & && 6 #˙ 5 ## œœ #œ # œ˙œ œ 203 C #m 9 ˙ & #œ ? ?& #cœ b bbœ˙˙˙˙ œœ œœ ˙œœ œœ ## œœ # œ˙ ?? # œ œ œ œ œ œ # œ # œ #œ œ 1. _________________________ 82 3. E maj9(13) ˙ Jazz Theory: Day Four 95 #9 6 the following 4. Please name scales. Db 9 C7 # F 13sus bœ bœ & & œœ œœ b œ bb œœ & œ œ bœ B 13sus 380 ## œœ # œ n œ# w b œ œ œ #œ nœ # œ # œ n œ bb œœ œœ œœ ## œœ 2. _________________________ # œ B 13sus E maj9(13) 2. _________________________ ˙ 2. _________________________ w bœ œœ œœ œœ ## œœ ## œœ bb œœ œ œ œ #œ #œ 4. _________________________ 4. _________________________ 4. _________________________ œœ œ bœ bœ bœ œ œœ bb œœ bb œœ œœ b œ bb œœ bb œœ œœ bœ bœ œ bœ 6. œ _________________________ 6. _________________________ 6. _________________________ 95 1. E Lydian-Dominant ? ? ? ? & & & Day Five Jazz Theory: 3. F Diminished-Whole Tone 6. 52 2. B¯ Phrygian-Dorian 4. E¯ Octatonic (Whole-Half) List the appropriate scale for the each chord by writing the chord tones then filling in the gaps. Avoid writing consecutive half steps and & augmented seconds when constructing the scale. & 7( ) &1. E¯ ˜ ; Scale: ____________________________ & 5 & &2. B¯7¯5˜9; Scale: ____________________________ & ? & &3. Fm7(¯5); Scale: ____________________________ & & 7(˜5) 1. 1. E¯ E¯7(˜5);; Scale: Scale: ____________________________ ____________________________ 1. E¯7(˜5); Scale: ____________________________ & & & CHAPTER 31. INTRODUCTION TO JAZZ THEORY 381 7˜9; Scale: ____________________________ 2. ˜9 Scale: ____________________________ 2. B¯ B¯7¯5 ˜¯59;; Scale: 2. B¯7¯5 ____________________________ ? ? ? 7(¯5) 3. 3. Fm Fm7(¯5);; Scale: Scale: ____________________________ ____________________________ 3. Fm7(¯5); Scale: ____________________________ & & & Δ7(˜5) 4. 4. A¯ A¯Δ7(˜5);; Scale: Scale: ____________________________ ____________________________ 4. A¯Δ7(˜5); Scale: ____________________________ ? ? ? Click here to download the first homework assignment for this chapter. Click here download the second homework assignment for this chapter. ? ? to ? Click here to download the third homework assignment for this chapter. Click here to download the fourth homework assignment for this chapter. Click here to download the fifth homework assignment for this chapter. Click here to download the sixth homework assignment for this chapter. ? Click here ? to download the Unit 11 Practice Test. ? PDF versions of the textbook, homework exercises, and practice exercises can be found at musictheory.pugetsound.edu Chapter 32 Impressionism and Extended Tonality 204 91 C m9 88 #9 & b ˙˙˙ #˙ b˙ 32.1 Impressionism ? ˙ ˙ n˙ F #mΔ9 B b 13sus E7 #5 B maj9(13) ˙ C #m 9 6 #˙ ˙ #˙ b˙ ˙ ˙ Impressionism is associated with Claude Debussy and #Maurice Ravel in France, Ottorino Respighi in Italy, Charles Tomlinson Griffes in America, and # 9 focus13on just 13 # 9 found 13 13 We will Frederick Delius threeE btechniques q = 40 inB bEngland. mΔ9 A7 b9 D7 b5 G7 #9 E b7 b 9 13sus A7 #5 in the music of Debussy and Ravel: (1) the use of modes, (2) the use of upœ œ ˙ c œœ the 7th b œ in chord œ b œ construction & above per extensions in tertian harmonies (9ths, bœ 11ths, and 13ths, which we saw in the chapter on jazz), and (3) parallelism, also known as “planing.” œ ? c bœ 93 97 1. Use of modes. Composers such as Debussy and Ravel sometimes wrote in the church modes (Phrygian, Lydian, etc.—see Scales) as an alternative to the heavily chromatic music of Richard Wagner (listen to the influential Prelude to Act I of Wagner’s Tristan œund Isolde). &c Œ œ œ b œœ ˙˙ .. œœ b œœ œœœ œœ b œœ Ó ˙ ˙˙ # œœ b œœ n œ of Debussy’s #˙. b œStringœ Quartet inœ G bminor, (a) The first #movement Op. 10, begins in Phrygian mode. Notice that the seventh chord that ˙˙˙ ... b œœœ b œœœ # œœœ # # œœœ in œœœPhrygian. ? c on œœœ n5̂œœœ scale b ˙˙˙ (The occurs is half-diminished Œ #the b b œœœ degree Ó penultimate chord in this example is not in Phrygian mode.) b &b c œ œ Gm ? bb c œ œ g: i &b 100 b ? b ø D 7/A b œœ b œœ vø43 œœ J Bb œœ œœ œœ œœ ø ø D 7/F D 7/A b 3 ø G m D 7/A b G m B b j œœ b œœ œ œ œœ œœ j œœ œ œœ b œœ œ III vø43 vø65 i vø43 j œ œ j œ œ i œœ œœ III A b 7( b 5) œœ #œ œ ¯II7(¯5) j œ ‰ œ j œ ‰ w Gm i YT: cEfhiCqlawI b œ32.1.1 œ œ Debussy, String Quartet in G minor, Op. 10, I. Figure (b) The second movement (“Danse profane”) of Debussy’s Danses begins in Lydian mode. 382 ? bb c œ œ b œœ # Strings & # 43 Œ π Harp ? # # 43 ˙ . -̇ . ˙˙ ˙ œœ œœ œœ œ œ j œœ b œœ . œœ œ Œ ˙ ˙ π ˙ ˙. -̇ . j œ œ œ œ j œ ‰ w #œ œ ø6 CHAPTER 32. IMPRESSIONISM TONALITY g: i vø43 IIIAND vø43 vEXTENDED i vø43 i III ¯II7(¯5) 5 100 . Œ #œ œœ ˙. -̇ . ‰ ˙. -̇ . .j œœ #œ . œœ œ 383 i . # œœœ œœœ YT: 5YFNOsSyv3I Figure 32.1.2 Debussy, Danses, II. Danse profane (c) The first movement of Ravel’s Piano Trio Ravel begins in the Dorian mode. Notice that the penultimate chord is outside of the mode. . œœœ. œœœ .. œœ œœœ .. # œœœ œœœ 8 . . &8 #œ J π œ. œ. ? 88 Œ ° 104 œœœœ œœœ. œœœ .. œœ œœœ .. . #œ . œ œ œ. œ. . œœ œj œ n œœ œ # œœ œ œ & 43 . YT: œœœœœœ. œœœ .. œœ œœœ .. # œœœ œœœ yiaGAWuY2PE œœœ. œœœ .. œœ œœœ .. œœ œ. j œ 8 . . . . & #œ œ n œœ # œœ J Trio, I. ? 843 32.1.3# œRavel, Piano Figure π œ. firstœ. movement œ of Ravel’s Piano œ. œ. Ravel œ transAt the end of the Trio, ? 88 the œ forms Œ theme by placing it inœ the Lydian mode. In this example, œ 120 final two chords are outside of the the Lydian mode. ° & .j . . . œ # œ œ œ œœ .. œœ œœ .. œœ œœ œœ œ œœ .. œœ œœ .. œœ œj b œœ œ œ ? œ œ. #œ œ. & œ œ . # œ œ . œ n œœ n œ J. J. . π lointain ?w ∑ 106 104 (d) 106 128 & ? 43 & 205 108 YT: yiaGAWuY2PE Figure ? 3 32.1.4 Ravel, Piano Trio, I. 4 2. Use of upper extensions in chords. Debussy and Ravel used chords containing ninths, elevenths, and thirteenths, sometimes with chromatic al128 to those upper extensions. terations (a) In&bar 15 of Debussy’s “Clair de lune” from his Suite bergamasque, 2 Debussy uses an E m9 chord with the 9th of the chord in the melody. ? 205 œœ . # œœœ #œœœ. . . œœ . # œœœ œœ . # œ œœœ n œœ n b œœœœ n œœ # œœ . . œ J . π . œ π lointain œ. œ. œ œ. œ ? ? w8IMPRESSIONISM CHAPTER 32. AND EXTENDED TONALITY 384 ∑ œ Œ & œœ 8 106 œœ œ Jœœ J. - œœ . ° œœ- œœ œœ- œœ-. œœ- œœ- œœ- œœ- œœ- œœ- œœ- œœ- œ. 98 ‰ œJ œ œ œœj œ - œ œ .œ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ .. . œœ .. 2 œ œœ .. # œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ .. œ œœ .. œœ j œ œπ œ œ . # œœ 2 œ . œ n œœœ n b œœ . # œœ œ . œ J œ . 2 2 J ?π 9 ‰ œj œ œ œ œ œ œ .œ œ œ œ œ . 205 bb b b lointain . 8 & œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ? w b ˙ . œ- œ œ- œ- œ- œ- œ- œ- œ- œ- œ- œ- ∑ œœ- .. . œœœ. œœœ ..˙ . œœ œœœ .. # œœœ œœœ œœœœœœ. œœœ .. œœ œœœ .. œœ œ. j œ 8 . #œ . . # œ . œ n œ # œœ &8 J œ 110 bπb[ E¯m(add9) ] œ- œ - - - - - - - - - b b œ œ œ & b œ. œ œ. œ œœ œ œ œœ œœ œ. œœ œœœ. œœ œœ œ œœ œ- . ? 88b b bŒb 9 ‰ œJ œ œYT:œœ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ .. & b 8 œ ? bb Yecu-mJ-EZo °2 2 bbb π Figure 32.1.5 Debussy, Suite bergamasque, III. Clair de lune 2 2 . . j .j . ? 9 b ‰ œ b œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ # œœ œœPuerta Bar 8œœb of œœ .. œœ“La .. 8 œœ & . œ œœII jofœ his œœPre- œœ .. œœœ œ delœ œVino” œ œ .œ from œ œ œBook b bœœœDebussy’s 2 7œ œœJ œ-œ œ- œ- œœ œ- œœ ..œ- # œœ œ- œœ .. œ- œœœ- n œœ œ-n b œœœ œ& œ œ ˙ # œ . . . œ the right œ- . ludes, contains a D in. the- left hand with the notes in J. ˙ . handπalternating between the 49 and. the 29. lointain ?w ∑ 7( 9) b.b b b & œœ b &œ [ E¯m(add9) ] 108 104 108 106 (b) 110 D¯ ˜ 3 bb 2 & b [bE¯m b 4 ]œ nœ-œ œœ œ œ- n œœ- bb b b 9 ‰ œœJ˜9 œœ œœ ¯9œœ & b 8 n ˙ ¯7 ? b b b 42π ˙ 3rd bb œ . j5th œ œ œ Root (add9) 108 2 ‰ nœ œœ-œ n ˙˙ œ. 3 œœœ ? b b b 98 ‰ & œœ œœ œœ œœ œœ b b ˙ œ- œ œ- œ- œ. ˙. 2 b & bb bb b b 2 114 110 (c) D¯7(˜9) œœ œ- j œ 3 œ-œ- œ œ-n œ œ- n œœ- . œ-œ œ œœ-œ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ˙˙ œœ œ œ œ œ . 2 œœ œ- œœ œ- œœ œ- œœ œ- œœ œ- 2 œœ œ- œœ- .. œ. n˙ ˙ œ œœ .. œ- . j Œ ‰ nœ œ œ œ & b b b 4 œ n œ œ œ n œ PuLpFaE9ZWo œ nœ nœ. œ œ œ Figure 32.1.6˜9Debussy, Préludes, Book II, No. 3, La Puerto del ¯9 ? Vino b n ˙ n ˙˙ ˙˙ n ˙˙ ¯7 b ? bbb bb b 42 ˙ 3rd b œ œ œ œ œ œ œ b of œthe In bar 70 œ piece, œ . Debussy œ also œ . includes œ theœ4.11œinœ the . 5thsame Root 3 3 YT:3 D¯7 ˜11 ˜9 b 11 & b b b b ‰ n˜ n œœ œœ œœ n œœ - 3 ˜9 ¯7 ? b b b n ˙˙ 3rd bb œ œ œ . 5th œ Root ‰ n n œœ œœ œœ œ nœ - 3 n ˙˙ œ. œ œ œ n n œœ .. ˙˙ œ. 3 œœ n œœ œœ œœ œ œ Œ œ. œ œ œ right hand, in addition to the 49 and 29. 114 œ œ œ YT: PuLpFaE9ZWo Figure 32.1.7 Debussy, Préludes, Book II, No. 3, La Puerto del Vino CHAPTER 32. IMPRESSIONISM AND EXTENDED TONALITY 385 3. Use of parallelism (also known as “planing”). In contrast to the prohibition against parallel fifths and octaves in traditional voice leading, both Debussy and Ravel would take a chord voicing and move all voices in parallel motion. (a) In Pavane pour une infante défunte, Ravel writes dominant 9th chords in parallel motion in bar 27. E9 206 > j ‰ œ œœ œ #œ œ # & c œ # œœœ 117 ?# c œ œ # & 44 Œ œœ ‰ œœ J > Em 44 119 œœœ œ Horn # & # 4Choir œ œ ˙. & 4 œ œ ˙. 44 ?# (b) 44 D9 C9 un peu plus lent > n œœœ f > œœ b œœ œ œ œ œ > œ œ D9 U > > œœ œœ n œœ œ œ # œ n n œœ # # œœ œœœ œ œœ œœ > > >Trumpet œ Cm U œ œ œ œ œœ b œœ ˙˙ .. J ww 3 GEUpQ5pCSOQ 7 œ œ bœ nœ œ nœ bœ œ œ Œ œparallel œ œ œvoicings œ w w YT: E9 Figure 32.1.8 Ravel, Pavane pour une œ infante œ ˙ . défuntew œœ œœ ˙˙ .. ww œ œ ˙. w ? # 4 J At 5 bars after rehearsal number 5 in Prelude to the Afternoon of 4 Kor - ah, Syahd - ho, a Faun, Debussy writes chromatically ascending dominant seventh 3 chords. 48 3 & 4 bœ . Horn G7 48 48 œ& 43 œ Strings ? 43 œœ œ œ. œ. A¯7 œœ b œœ bœ œ. œ. œ. bœ A7 b œbœ n b œœ nœ œ œ G7 A¯7 œœ œ b œœ bœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ A7 bœ bœ n b œœ nœ parallel voicings ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ & ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ YT: 50 9_7loz-HWUM &∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ 50 Figure 32.1.9 Debussy, Prelude to the Afternoon of a Faun (c) At 4 bars after rehearsal number 2 in the same piece, Debussy moves seventh chords in parallel motion. Notice that the chords are not 50 all?of the same quality. ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ? 3 œœ 4 œ 48 bœ nœ nœ b œœ bœ bœ nœ nœ b œœ bœ œœ œ CHAPTER 32. IMPRESSIONISM AND EXTENDED TONALITY parallel voicings 50 3 50 50 œ œ œ œ œ. . # # # # Flute 9 œ œ œ nœ nœ œ œ œ œ œ œ & 8 # ## 9 & # 8 n œœ œ .. Strings ? # # # # 98 n œ 3 3 nœ œ F˜ø7 # œœ œœœ #œ œ œ nœ 3 Bm7 Am7 F˜ø7 Bm7 Am7 œ œ œ n œœ n œ œ n œœ œ œœ œ œ 386 œœ œ œ œœ parallel voicings F˜ø7 j œœ nœ œ J YT: 9_7loz-HWUM Figure 32.1.10 Debussy, Prelude to the Afternoon of a Faun 32.2 Pandiatonicism Pandiatonicism refers to the use of all diatonic notes without the need for scale degrees or harmonies to progress or function tonally (V doesn’t need to progress to I, 7̂ doesn’t need to resolve to 8̂ , etc.). One often hears it as a wash of notes from the major scale, or as chords made of non-traditional combinations of notes from a major scale, often with at least one interval of a 2nd in a chord voicing. In the first example, notice how Stravinsky creates a wash of sound from the notes of the major scale. YouTube: https://www.youtube.com/watch?v=XkM4bKjggKo Figure 32.2.1 Stravinsky, Petrushka, Fourth Tableau: The Shrovetide Fair (Toward Evening) In the second example, Copland uses non-traditional pandiatonic chord shapes in non-functional harmonic progression. œœ ‰ œœ J > ?# c œ œ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œ > > > CHAPTER 32. IMPRESSIONISM AND EXTENDED TONALITY 119 & ### œ ? ### 120 & ### œ œ œœ œ œœ > œœ 387 parallel voicings œ œœ œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œœ œ œœ œ œ c ? ### c YouTube: https://www.youtube.com/watch?v=WVahuS9hk_s Figure 32.2.2 Copland, Appalachian Spring The third example is similar to the first, with Copland creating a wash of sound from the notes of the major scale, with no regard to the dissonant intervals occurring in counterpoint. YouTube: https://www.youtube.com/watch?v=WVahuS9hk_s Figure 32.2.3 Copland, Appalachian Spring 32.3 Quartal, Quintal, and Secundal Harmony Quartal harmony refers to chords stacked entirely (or mostly) in fourths. Quintal harmony refers to chords stacked entirely (or mostly) in fifths. Secundal harmony refers to chords stacked entirely (or mostly) in seconds. Contrast these concepts with the tertian (stacked in thirds) harmony we’ve encountered in the majority of this text. Alternative methods of stacking chords became more common after 1900 as composers sought ways to innovate and break with the past. The next three examples demonstrate quartal harmony. CHAPTER 32. IMPRESSIONISM AND EXTENDED TONALITY 388 YouTube: https://www.youtube.com/watch?v=m_hMVzPT9f4 Figure 32.3.1 Schoenberg, Chamber Symphony No. 1, Op. 9 YT: D5-bD372v5s Figure 32.3.2 John Parker, CHiPs Theme YT: AQFxpN30DMU Figure 32.3.3 Merv Griffin and Julann Wright, Jeopardy! Theme The following is an extended example of quintal harmony. YouTube: https://www.youtube.com/watch?v=IfOJCKN148M Figure 32.3.4 Bartók, Piano Concerto No. 2, II. 32.4 Polychords A polychord typically consists of two triads sounding simultaneously. A polychord could also consist of two seventh chords, or a seventh chord and triad. Additionally, a polychord could conceivably consist of more than two triads or seventh chords, since the prefix “poly” means “many.” Perhaps the most famous polychord is the “Rite of Spring chord,” an E2 7 chord sounding over an F2 major chord, which occurs during the “Dance of the Adolescents.” 206 ? ### un peu plus lent U > > > > > # c j ‰ & œœ n œœAND EXTENDED œœ œ CHAPTER 389œ œœœ IMPRESSIONISM œœ b œœ œœTONALITY œœ #32. n œ œ # œ # œ n œ # œ œ œ œ œ œ n œ # œ œœœ f E¯7 U œ ?# c œ œ ‰ œ œœ 120 œ œœ F¯œœ œ œœ œœ œ œœ J œ > > > > > 117 119 & ### œ parallel voicings œ œ œœ ? ### 120 & b b œœ b œœ œ œ œ œœ œœ ? b b œœœ b b œœ œ œ œ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œ 121 E¯7 F¯ & & b b œœ b œœ ? b b œœ b b œœhttps://www.youtube.com/watch?v=BKoO_3-I1dw YouTube: ? Figure 32.4.1 Stravinsky, Rite of Spring, “Dance of the Adolescents” Polychords are notated using a horizontal line between the chords instead of a slash. (The slash was used for slash chords.) 121 & ? A¯ A b b œœœ # œœœ (horizontal line means chord over chord) b b œœœ A¯/A (slash means chord over bass note) nœ nœ Also note that it is not necessary to specify the inversion of each of the chords in the polychord. In th example below, Copland voices an A major chord below an E major chord. œ CHAPTER 32. IMPRESSIONISM AND EXTENDED TONALITY 390 53 & ### A major triad œ œ œ œ œ E major triad E A œ œœ œœœ œ ## & # YouTube: https://www.youtube.com/watch?v=WVahuS9hk_s Figure 32.4.2 Copland, Appalachian Spring In the example below, features chromatically ascending dominant seventh chords in the left hand against a repeating three-chord cycle of G–F–C in the right hand. YouTube: https://www.youtube.com/watch?v=XkM4bKjggKo Figure 32.4.3 Stravinsky, Petrushka, Fourth Tableau: The Shrovetide Fair (Toward Evening) 32.5 Practice & c œœœ .. œœœExercises œœœ œœ œœ œ . œ œ œœ C 123 F C F C G 7/D C/E œœ œ D m/F G7 œœ œ œœœ C G 7/B C œœ œœ œœœ œ œ Day One ? of c modes. œ œ and chord symbols 1. Use the œ . œ œGiven œ melody œ forœ “London œ œ œ œ Bridge” in Phrygian mode, analyze the chords as lead-sheet symbols (“LSS”) and as Roman numerals (“RN”). LSS: ___ b & b b c œœœ .. . 125 ? bb c œ . b RN: 2. ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ œœœ œœœ œœ œœ œ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œ bœ œ œ œ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ b œœ œ b œœœ œœ œœ œœœ œ œ œ œ œ œ ___ ___ ___ ___ œ ___ Use of parallelism. Harmonize the opening of “London Bridge” so each note of the melody noteø7is the 9th of a dominant ninth ø7 ø7 chord. 127 b &bb ? b bb Cm i Fm Cm Fm Cm G /D¯ Cm iv i iv i vø43 i6 D¯/F N6 G vø7 Cm G /B¯ Cm i vø65 i 207 ? ### c ˙ RN: ˙ ___ ˙ œ œ ˙ D¯/F G ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ ˙ ˙ Fm Cm Fm Cm Gø7/D¯ Cm Cm ___ ˙ ___ ___ ___ ___ ø7 Cm Gø7/B¯ Cm 391 i vø65 i CHAPTER 32. IMPRESSIONISM AND i iv i EXTENDED iv i vø4 i6TONALITY N6 vø7 RN: LSS: 127 ___ ___ ___ ___ & œ c b œœœ œ œ œ ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ œ œ ? c œœœ ? c œœœ 135 F9 LSS: F9 & c b œœ 133 ___ 3 ___ œ ___ ___ ___ ___ nœ œ ___ œ ___ ___ ___ ___ œ ___ Day Two LSS: ___128 and ___Secundal ___Harmony. ___ ___ analyzing ___ ___given ___ ___ 3. Quartal, Quintal, After the chord as a lead-sheet & symbol, revoice it in four ways: &c (a) as a six-note tertian chord stacked only in thirds ? quartal chord stacked only in perfect 4ths (b) as a six-note ?c (c) as a six-note quintal chord stacked only in perfect 5ths (d) secundal chord RN:as a six-note ___ ___ ___ stacked ___ only ___in 2nds ___ LSS: ____ 139 & 149 4. 154 w ww (1) in 3rds (2) in 4ths (3) in 5ths ___ ___ ___ (4) in 2nds 209 b www ww ? b & w w LSS: ____ (1) in 3rds (2) in 4ths (3) in 5ths (4) in 2nds Polychords. b w Harmonize “London Bridge” using the specified poly? b wRemember that the chords can be in any inversion, but should chords. bw should be playable (i.e., without too big of a stretch for the hands of the pianist). D¯ E¯+ B¯ Cm D C¯ Dm ___ __ __ ___ __ ___ __ C¯ b œœ & c b b b b œœœœ D¯ E¯ œ œ A bœ B¯ œ F bœ Gm ˙ ?c D ¯ E ¯+ B Cm D C¯ Dm __ ___ __ ___ ___ __ __¯ Click here to download the first homework assignment for this chapter. C¯ D¯ E¯ A B¯ F Gm 156Click here to download the second homework assignment for this chap˙˙ ter. b œœ b œœ b œœ n œœ œ b b œœ & c b b b b œœœœ ?c 158 & ? œœ b b œœ nb b œœœ œ n œœ n # œœ (lower chords can be any inversion) # b n œœœœœ b n n œœœ b n ˙˙˙˙ œ Chapter 33 Set Theory 33.1 Set Theory Set theory is the analytical technique we will use to analyze expressionist music. The primary composers associated with expressionism are Arnold Schoenberg (1874–1951), Anton Webern (1883–1945), and Alban Berg (1885–1935). In this text, we will associate atonal music—music that avoids traditional harmonies and scales—with expressionism. Instead of scales and chords, intervals are the building blocks of Expressionist music. Although composers began writing atonal music in 1908, there was no widely-accepted systematic analytical approach that could show relationships between different pieces until Allen Forte published his seminal The Structure of Atonal Music in 1973, in which Forte applied set theory mathematics to music. However, our approach to normal form and prime form will follow the slightly-modified approach set out by John Rahn in his Basic Atonal Theory (1980), which is the approach followed by Joseph Straus in his well-known and widely-used Introduction to Post-Tonal Theory.1 33.1.1 Atonal Music Listen to the following example by Anton Webern. YouTube: https://www.youtube.com/watch?v=ELAKF8ZxDmg Figure 33.1.1 Webern, 5 movements for string quartet, No. 3. Sehr bewegt Gone are the triadic structures we have studied throughout this text. In this music, intervals are paramount. Let us examine the intervals we find. 1 Of the 208 sets that exist, only 6 are different between the Forte and Rahn methods for prime form. See https://www.mta.ca/pc-set/pc-set_new/pages/pc-table/packed.html. 392 CHAPTER 33. SET THEORY 162 210 & ? 393 n bn œœœ #œ n b œœ nœ m3 +5 m3 m6 œ Look at the intervallic structure of the first two chords,2 not including the C4 in the cello part. We see the interval of an augmented 5th below the interval of a minor 3rd in the first chord, and the interval of a minor sixth 163below the interval of a minor 3rd in the second chord. Notice that the names we use for intervals carry tonal implications. An augmented 5th would function differently than a minor 6th, but in atonal music, these intervals have the same sound, are separated by the same number of half steps, and have no tonal implications (they don’t have to resolve any particular way). Therefore, analysts like Allen Forte used integers to represent pitches and intervals to remove the tonal implications of staff notation. & ? 33.1.2 Integer Notation for Pitches One notable trait of set theory is that we will represent pitches with integers, as seen in the table below. Note name: Integer: C 0 C4/D2 1 D 2 D4/E2 3 E 4 F 5 F4/G2 6 G 7 G4/A2 8 A 9 A4/B2 10 It may be helpful to remember that the C major triad (C, E, and G) consists of integers 0, 4, and 7. Integer notation of pitches means we assume enharmonic equivalence of notes. For example, D, C5, and E3 are all represented as pitch integer 2. We also assume octave equivalence, which itself presumes the notion of pitch class. When we say Beethoven’s first symphony is in C, we refer not to any specific C (C1 , C2 , C3 , etc.), but to the concept of the pitch class C, which includes any and all Cs. Therefore, you would label the note C as pitch class 0, no matter the register in which it occurs. 33.1.3 Integer Notation for Intervals We will also measure intervals using integers, with each interval represented by the number of semitones (half steps) it contains. The following table contains the number of semitones in each interval. 2 Some authors call atonal chords “sonorities” to differentiate them from chords in the traditional triadic sense; we will continue to use “chord” in this text. B 11 CHAPTER 33. SET THEORY 394 Table 33.1.2 Interval Integers 162 210 162 210 163 163 Interval m2 M2 m3 M3 P4 TT & ? Number of Semitones Interval 1 P5 2 m6 3 M6 4 m7 5 m3 M7 6 +5 P8 n bn œœœ #œ Number of Semitones 7 8 9 10 m3 11 m6 12 n b œœ nœ œ In atonal music we will analyze sets of pitch classes, hence term “pitch-class b œœthetime m3 with integers set & analysis.” Let us return to the example by Webern,n this n œ m6 m3 n œ for pitches and for intervals. n œ bœ 33.1.4 Pitch-Class Sets ? & ? +5 #œ pitch-class numbers nœ 11 n œ 3 bœ 2 3 semitones 8 semitones œ 10 n b œ & œ 3 semitones 7 2 The first chord consists E , 3B,semitones and D, or pitch integers83,semitones 11, and 2. If 2 n nofœ œ œ 11 distance, 11 nbetween we examine the intervallic we find 8 semitones pitch integers bœ 1 #œ 3 semitones 8 semitones n b œœ nœ 10 7 11 pitch-class numbers 8 semitones 3 between 11 and 2. Note that we are working in 3 and 11, and 3 semitones 164 a modulo 12 system, meaning we restart our numbering after 11 (0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 0, 1, 2, 3, etc.). We are used to modulo 12 thinking 1 since we all deal with clocks. If a meeting ran from 11am to 2pm, it lasted 3 hours. Therefore, an interval from pitch integer 11 to pitch integer 2 spans 3 semitones. The second chord has the same intervallic construction. Now, let’s look at the two chords in the second half of the third measure. ? & 164 #œ ? & ? nœ n # œœ 9 0 8 #œ 9 semitones 4 semitones œ 3 0 4 b œœ nœ 3 semitones 8 semitones œ We see right away that the second of these chords has the same construction as the two chords we examined the in earlier examples (a minor 6th below a minor 3rd). However, the first chord in this example (G4, C, A, or 8, 0, 9) ap165 to be different, with a diminished 4th from G4 to C (an interval spanning pears 4 semitones, enharmonically equivalent to a major 3rd) below the interval of a major 6th from C to A (spanning 9 semitones). To see the relationship of this chord to the others, we need to learn about normal form and prime form. & ? CHAPTER 33. SET THEORY E A 395 triad Normal Form œ œœ # # # 33.2A major œ œ œœ œ & œNormal œform represents the notes of a pitch-class set (as they œœoccur in the E major triad & 54 & & ### ### music) in their most compact form. majorsteps: triad To determine normal form, follow E these œ #œ œ œ œœ œ 2 œ œœœ Ascending numeric order: > œ nœ n œ . œ # œ 2 3 7 œ œ n œœ bn#œœ n œ œ œ œœ b œœ 11œ œœ ? œ œ 6 & # œ &# œ 8 œ # œ n œn œ # œ b # œ b œ œ #œ œœ œœ œb œ b œb œ œ #œ #œ œ œ œ f œ œ & #œ 2 #œ #œ œ œ œ œ 11 œ œ . 3 n œ every 7 possible of the bnotes ? 2. Examine œ n œ “scale” ordering n œ nascending b œuntilœ you b œ n œ œ the # œ œ œ b œspans # œ œ bthat smallest # œfind œ bone & the most n œ compact form—thatœis, the interval from lowest to highest note. ? n2œ n œ n œ # œ n œ order: bœ bœ bœ bœ œ # œ n11œ œ numeric b œ œ . # œ Ascending œ œ 3 2 3 7 7 b œ11 3 7 11 2 7 11 2 3 11 2 3 7 b œ bœ œ & nœ œ 2 œ œ œ œ œ œ & œ11b œ œ œ œ n œ 7 3 œ .b œ bœ M7 m6 m6 AscendingM6 & (92 semitones) n3 numeric œ 7 11order:(11 (8 semitones) 3 semitones) 7 11 2 7(8 semitones) 11 2 3 11 2 3 7 œ œ (there œ forb œmost œcompact œ b œversion) isœ a tie œ œ & œ œ œ Ascending œ b œ numeric order:b œ 2 event 3 P5 7that 11two orderings 3 7 11 have 2 the7 same 11 o4interval 2 3 span 11 2from3 lowest 7 3. In the M6 M7 m6 m6 œthe b œ b œ to highest note, choose the set that has the smaller interval between œ œ œ (7 semitones) semitones) (9 semitones) (11 semitones) (8(4 semitones) (8 semitones) œ œ œ œ 1 œ & œ œ œ first œandb œpenultimateœbnotes. œ bœ œ œ is a tieœ for mostb œcompact version) (there &œ A major triad œ7 11 2 3 M6 to penultimate noteM7 m6 Measure first to break the tie: m6 (9 (11 semitones) (8 semitones) (8 semitones) 7 semitones) 11 2 3 11 2 3 7 o P5 4 (7 semitones) (4iscompact semitones) (there a tie forismost compact version) most Normal Form & & & & bœ œ œ &œ œ œ Measure first to penultimate note to break the tie: o4 P5 (7 semitones) (4 semitones) 7 11 2 3 11 2 &œ œ bœ 7œ b 3œ Form œ is Normal œmost compact bœ œ œ 4. In the of an absolute tie, 7 event 11 2 3 choose the 11 set that 2 begins 3 on the7 smaller number. We will use a different set of pitches to demonstrate a complete most compact is Normal Form tie. The normal form for the notes below is [2, 3, 8, 9]. P5 & œ bœ bœ nœ m2 2 3 tt 8 9 œ bœ bœ nœ 3 8 9 2 P5 bœ bœ nœ œ m2 8 9 tt 2 3 bœ bœ œ œ 9 2 3 8 In the event of an absolute tie, choose the set beginning on the smaller number. 1 The 53 E A œ # œœ 1. Put theœ notes set œfrom a piece of musicœœœin œ œofœ a pitch-class E œ œ œpitches.œœ œascending & # œ # œ # œ œ œ A numeric order (like a scale). Eliminate any duplicate œ œ œ E major triad A major triad 53 Forte method for determining prime form would have measured from first to second note to break the tie instead of first to penultimate note, which is method used Rahn’s Basic Atonal Theory. 53 CHAPTER 33. SET THEORY 396 5. Normal form is written in square brackets with commas. The normal form found in step 3 above was [11, 2, 3, 7]. 33.3 Prime Form Whereas normal form deals with the exact pitches as they occur in the music, prime form is usually a transposition and possibly an inversion of the normal form to its most essential form, much in the way an E2 major triad in second inversion belongs to the category “major triad,” or a G 7 /F belongs to the more general idea “dominant seventh chord.” Perhaps because of the primacy 7 2 ideas 3 2are demonstrated in their relation to the C of C in music 11 theory—many Ascending numeric order: >œ . major scale—all prime forms are to and start on C (pitch integer ntransposed n œ 2 3 7 11 11 7 2 3 2 0). b œ n >œ . Ascending numeric order: 6 œ œ & 8 n isœ thenprocess œ œ7 11 Following for determining primeœ2 form.b 3œ 54 54 6 œ bœ œ & 8 f then œnormal form—[11, 2, 3, 7] from 1. Transpose œ theb œnormalœform example in the previous section—so it starts on C (pitch integer 0): 0, 3, 4, 8 11 54 & 11œ &œ f œ 7 œ bœ 3 bœ œ2 œ 2 3 bœ 3 bœ œ œ 7 0 0 4 Normal form transposed to start on 0 n >œ . # 8œ # 8œ nœ 4 nœ 3 start up on 0now goes down). 2. Invert the transposed normal (what to went 11 7 Normal 2 form 3 form 2transposed & nœ &m3↑68 b œ &œ f 0 nœ nœ m2↑ 3 M3↑ œ bœ #œ 4 Ascending numeric order: 2 3 7 11 œ œ 0 m3↓ 8 bœ 9 œ m2↓ 8 #œ 4œ œ M3↓ œ œ # œ one of 3. Write this inverted form b œ in ascending œ form œ 0(4, 4b8,œ 9,8 0),n œ0then4 do œ 4 8 9 0 8 9 0 4 9 8 9 & the following: o4 11 2 3 7 0 3 4 8 œ #œ œ œ #œ œ œ no ties œ proceed to the transposed start on form, 0 (a) If there were when determining œ œform œ œtonormal & # œ Normal œstep# œ 4. œ P4 (b) If therem3↑ were ties, put this inverted version through 0 9 8every ascending 4 œ which first b œtie (break œ tie by#measuring to penultimate note) form from “scale” ordering ton determine is the most compact œ œ œ below, & note to penultimate note. In the example # œ we œsee that first m3↓normal form) is the most the second ordering 0 3 4 (the “tie 8 loser” from m2↓ M3↓ compact of the reorderings of the inverted normal form. m2↑ m6 & 4 8 9 0 & œ #œ œ œ P4 m6 M3↑ m6 8 9 0 4 œ #œ œ œ o4 m6 9 0 4 8 œ #œ œ œ œ œ œ #œ 0 4 8 9 tie (break tie by measuring first to penultimate note) & 4. Compare the normal form (transposed to 0) to the most compact inverted form (transposed to 0). The most compact form is the prime form. Prime form is written in parentheses with no commas: (0148). & œ #œ œ œ m6 #œ œ œ œ œ m6 œ CHAPTER 33. SET THEORY tie (break tie by measuring first to penultimate note) 3 4 8 # œ b œ n œ &œ 0 8 9 œ #œ œ 0 4 œ 0 most compact inverted form of normal form Normal Form transposed to 0 397 4 8 œ #œ 1 œ #œ most compact inverted form of Normal Form transposed to 0 Compare: Most compact version is Prime Form & (a) In the event the prime form reaches pitch integers 10 or 11, use T for 10 and E for 11; for example (013568T) 33.3.1 Application of Normal Form and Prime Form Let’s determine normal form and prime form of the first set from the Webern excerpt. The first chord contained E2, B, and D (3, 11, and 2). 3 11 3 11 11 11 & b œ33 & & bb œœ œ œ œœ 11 22 2 11 11 22 33 11 2 3 most compact form (Normal Form) œ bœ œœ 2 bœ 2 œ œ œ œœ bœ œœ 3 œ bb œœ 22 2 œœ nœ œ The 3]. mostBelow compact form 11 normal 2 form3is [11, 2, 0most 3 is the 4 calculation 0 compact form most compact form form. (Normal Form) (Normal Form) (Normal Form) 11 11 22 33 00 33 44 00 11 2 3 0 3 4 0 Normal Form Normal Form transposed to 0 Normal Form Form Normal Normal Form Form 8 8 Normal9 Form 0 9Normal 0 Normal 0Form transposed to 00 transposed to transposed to 0 &œ bb œœ œ & &œ œœ & b œ88 n œ9 œœ œ œ9 9 00 8 9 0 most compact inverted version of Normal Form & bb œœ & nn œœ bœ nœ bb œœ nn œœ œœ 8 bœ nn œœ œ 00 0 œœ 9 nœ œœ bœ œ bb œœ 88 8 bb œœ nn œœ œœ œ 99 9 inverted 88 8 bb œœ 8 bb œœ88 9 nn 9œ9œ bœ nœ bœ 1 œ bœ œœ inverted inverted 8 inverted 0 88 99 00 8 9 0 most compact inverted version of Normal Form bb œœ 11 11 11 to determine 9 8 prime œœ œ 11 33 3 00 0 0 3 n 9œ 4 nn œœ bb œœ 00 11 44 0 1 4 most compact inverted version transposed to 0 œœ œœ most compact compact inverted inverted most compact compact inverted inverted Normal Form Form most most Normal most compact inverted most compact inverted Normal Form version of Normal Normal Form version transposed to 00 transposed to 00 version of Form version transposed to transposed to most of compact is Primeversion Form transposed to 0 version Normalform Form transposed to 0Compare: œ & # œœ œ œ #œ 8 9 0 Compare: most most compact compact form form is is Prime Prime Form Form Compare: Compare: most compact form is Prime Form #œ œ œ The prime form is (014). 9 0 8 & & 9 9 œœ most compact inverted most 0 compact 3 inverted 4 most compact inverted version of Normal Normal Form version of Form version of Normal Form 00 33 44 0 3 4 Normal Form transposed to 0 &œ œœ & & bb œœ œ bœ 2 #œ œ œ mostand compact Now let’s determine the normal form primeis form for the third set we Normal Form 4 encountered: G , C, and A, or 8, 0, and 9. 8 9 0 0 1 4 0 11 8 & #œ œ Normal Form œ œ bœ œ Normal Form transposed to 0 œ œ inverted #œ 55 55 55 55 version ofb œNormaln œForm œ n œ to 0 version of Normal Form to 0 œ œversionb transposed bœ nœ & 0œ transposed 3 4 8 9 0 0 1 4 b œ33.Form n œ THEORY n œ 398 most compact inverted Normal b œ inverted CHAPTER SET œ is Primemost œFormcompact n œ form Compare:b œ most compact &œ version of Normal Form transposed to 0 version transposed to 0 8 inverted 9 0 most compact inverted most compact œ #œ œ œ œ œ & #œ #œ œ #œ œ œ most compact is 8 9 0 #œ 9œ Compare: most compact form is Prime Form Normal Form œ œ œ 0 œ œ œ &The #œ #œ 8#œ normal9 form œ is0 [8, 9, 0].0 81 9 4 0 0 8œ 11 8 # œinvert œ In 9the example below, we transpose the normal form to zero, then b œ most compact is œ œ œ œ œ œ œ 0 œ œ œ œ # œ # œ & # œ # œ # œ it. 8 Normal Form œ Normal Form 8Normal Form 9 0 0 1 compact 4 11 8 most is 0 inverted transposed to 0 b œ Normal œForm œ œ œ œ #œ œ & #œ 8 9 0 0 1 4 0 11 8 8Normal 11 Form 0 11 0 8 Normal 0 b œ8 Form 11 œ 0 3 4inverted 0 1 4 œ œ œ œ œ # œ to 0 & # œ œ œœ œ œ # œ transposed œ œ b œ n œ œ b œ# œ œ &In# œNormal the following put theForm inverted normal form through the Form example, we Normal inverted reorderings to find the most compact form, transposed to 8 11 0 11 0 8 0 8 110then0 compare 3 4 it to 0 the 1 normal 4 transposed to 0 Normal Form œ most compact form. # œ # œ transposed b œ n œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ b œ to 0 & inverted # œ8 11œversion 0 11 0 8 0 8 11 3 4 0 1 4 most compact œ 0 Compare: # œ # œ Normal œ n œtois0 Prime œ transposed œ Form most compact œ œ œ œ œ bversion œ bForm transposed to 0 &inverted # œ œversion 9Normal Form version of Normal Form version transposed to 0 0 transposed to 0Compare: most compact form is Prime Form 8 Normal Form Compare: compact transposed to 0most transposed version is Prime Form to 0 most compact inverted version Compare: most compact version is Prime Form We see that the third set has the same prime form—(014)—as the other sets in the opening measures of Webern’s Op 5, No. 3. Prime form can allow us to see relationships that may not be apparent on the surface of the music. 33.3.2 Segmentation What about the C4 in the cello part? Should it be included with the three notes from the chords? Will another similarity be revealed? Segmentation is the term for “segmenting” or determining which notes to group together and analyze in a passage. Usually, segmentation is based on the music—notes sounding together as a chord, or notes in a melodic line. However, analysts may look at every possible combination of notes to search for deeper layers of connection. Below, we examine the first two chords with the C4 included in each. & 10 semitones œ b œ œ #œ bœ nœ &œ œ 0 2 3 4 NF transposed to 0 11 semitones 11 semitones œ #œ œ bœ #œ œ œ bœ œ bœ œ bœ bœ nœ bœ œ inverted inverted form ascending (most compact) 4 semitones œ #œ œ bœ [11, 1, 2, 3] Normal Form 0 1 2 4 œ #œ œ œ inversion transposed to 0 Compare: most compact version is Prime Form (most compact) 11 semitones 6 semitones 9 semitones 11 semitones & #œ œ bœ nœ œ bœ nœ #œ œ bœ nœ #œ œ bœ # œ œ œ œ #œ œ bœ œ bœ # œ CHAPTER 33. SET THEORY & 10 10 semitones semitones 11 11 semitones semitones #œ œ bœ œ 11 11 semitones semitones #œ #œ œ & & #œ0œ œ2œœ b bœb3œœ n œ4œœ œœœ bb œœ œœ # œ bb œœ œœ # œ œœ bœ œ bœ bœ nœ bœ & #œ NF transposed to 0 00 22 33 44 œœ œœ bb œœ nn œœ & & inverted inverted form ascending œœ bb œœ œœ bb œœ bb œœ nn œœ bb œœ œœ œ bœ nœ #œ bœ nœ #œ œ #œ œ bœ (most (most compact) compact) [11,44 semitones 1, 2, 3]399 semitones Normal Form œœ ##1œœ œœ2 bb 4œœ œ #œ œ œ 0 [11, [11, 1, 1, 2, 2, 3] 3] Normal Form Normal Form inversion 00transposed 11 22to 044 œœ ## œœ œœ œœ Compare: most compact version is Prime Form NF transposed to 00 inverted inverted inversion (most compact) NF transposed to inverted inverted form form inversion The prime form of the first set, when including the C4 from the cello, is ascending transposed to 11 semitones 6 semitones 9 semitones 11 semitones ascending transposed to 00 (0124). Here is the second chord with the C4 added to it. & #œ œ bœ nœ œ œ #œ œ bœ Compare: Compare: most most compact compact version version is is Prime Prime Form Form (most compact) (most compact) [7, 66 semitones 10, 11, 1] 11 99 semitones 11 11 semitones semitones semitones semitones 11 semitones semitones Normal Form œœ # œ # œ b œ n œ b œ n œ b œ n œ # œ # œ bœ nœ & & #0œ 3œœ 4b œ n6œ œœ b œ n œ #œœ b œ n œ # œ œ[7, 10, 11, 1] [7, œ10,b œ11, b œ1] & bœ bœ nœ œ Normal Normal Form Form œœ bb œœ # œ œ #œ 3 6 0œ 2 œ œ bœ #œ œœ bb œœ nn œœ ## œœ & & œœ œœ bb œœ b œ b œ bb œœ nn œœ œœ œœ œœ bb œœ ## œœ bœ bœ Compare: most compact version is Prime Form & Compare: Compare: most most compact compact version version is is Prime Prime Form Form NF transposed to 0 00 33 44 66 NF NF transposed transposed to to 00 &œ & œ & #œ inverted inverted form ascending inversion 00 22 33 66 transposed to 0 inverted inverted inverted inverted form form ascending ascending inversion inversion transposed transposed to to 00 œ Œ The prime form of the second set, when including the C4 from the cello, is (0236). We do not see any relationship between these first two sets after including the C4 with each three-note set. One doesn’t know this until one examines this new segmentation. & & œ œ Œ 33.4 & b b œœInterval Vector & b b œœ Œ Ó An interval vector (also known as “Interval Class Content”) is a list of every possible interval occurring in a pitch-class set. Calculating an interval vector is rather straightforward. First, after determing normal form, measure from the first note to all the other notes. Second, measure from the second note to all higher notes (not back or down to the first note). Continue measuring from each successive note to the notes following and you will have completed the interval vector. Before demonstrating this, it is important to discuss the term “interval class.” An interval class (abbreviated “ic”) is the shortest distance between two notes measured in semitones. In the example below, C up to A is a major 6th. However, the shortest distance between C and A (measure downward) is a minor 3rd. Therefore, the largest interval class is 6 (the tritone), because any perfect 5th (for example, from C to G) has an interval class of 5 (a perfect 4th) because C down to G is a perfect 4th. ? bœ nœ bœ #œ ? #œ œ #œ œ 58 œ œ bœ œ œ œ CHAPTER 33. SET THEORY & 58 & œ œ Major 6th & bœ œ œ œ œ œ œ 400 œ œ œ œ œ Perfect 5th œ œ & œ b œ œ œ œ œœ Minor 3rd (shortest distance between C and A) œ œ œ Perfect 4th (shortest distance between C and G) 6th an intervalMinor Perfect 5th With this in mind, let’sMajor complete vector3rd of the a half-diminished (shortestorder, distance 7th chord on G. First, arrange the notes in ascending then measure from 58 the first note to the second, third, and fourthbetween notes. C and A) & & & œ œ œ œ œ œ & m7=ic2 & Major Perfect 5th œ5=ic6œ œ œ Minor 3rd b œ 6th œm3=ic3 (shortest distance œ C and A) between b œ b œ &œ œ m7=ic2 œ œ œ œ œ & 5=ic6 o o Perfect 5th œ b œ b œ (shortest distance Second, measure & fromœ the second note to the œthird and fourth notes. We b œ C and A) b œ add one tally each for 5. &interval œ class (ic) 3 andbetween & & Intervalm3=ic3 Class: 1 P5=ic5 2 3 4 5 6 Major 6th Occurrences m3=ic3 0 1 1 Minor 0 03rd 1 m7=ic2 P5=ic5 o5=ic6 & & œœ &œ bb œœ bœ m3=ic3 bb œœ bœ m3=ic3 1 2 3 4 5 6 P5=ic5 0 1 M3=ic4 2 0 1 1 m3=ic3 Finally, measure from the third note to the fourth note, and the interval vector will be complete. We add one tally for ic4; the complete interval vector is 012011, which tells us a half-diminished chord has zero half steps, one major 2nd (shown in this voicing as a minor 7th), two minor 3rds, no major 3rds, one perfect 4th (shown in this voicing as perfect 5th), and one tritone. & Interval Class: Occurrences œœ œ M3=ic4 & & œœ & & &œ & & & bœ bœ Interval Class: Occurrences œœ bb œœ bb œœ 1 0 2 1 œ M3=ic4 3 2 4 1 5 1 6 1 An interval vector always contains 6 digits. When an interval class does not occur (the way the minor second did not occur in the G half-diminished seventh chord), place a zero in the column for that interval class. & & & œ œ Perfect 4th (shortest distance between C and G) œ œ Perfect 4th (shortest distance between C and G) œ œ Perfect 4th (shortest distance between C and G) CHAPTER 33. SET THEORY 401 33.5 Forte Numbers When Allen Forte created a catalog of every possible 3-, 4-, 5-, 6-, 7-, 8-, and 9-note set in Appendix 1 of The Structure of Atonal Music, he labeled each prime form with two numbers separated by a hyphen. His labels (3–1, 3–2, etc.) are now known as “Forte numbers,” and are seen in the tables in the Lists of Set Classes, which include prime forms and interval vectors as well. 33.5.1 Z-Relations “Z” in a set label (for example, 4–Z29) stands for “zygotic” (“twinned”), and is used when different prime forms (for example, 4–Z29 and 4–Z15 have the same interval vector—111111). 33.6 Lists of Set Classes Below are lists of all set classes with prime form, Forte number, and interval vectors shown. Allen Forte published the original list of set classes in The Structure of Atonal Music in 1973. These lists use prime forms as calculated using the Rahn method. Prime forms of sets are ordered from most packed to the left to least packed to the left, as is found in the list of set classes in both John Rahn’s Basic Atonal Theory and Joseph Straus’ Introduction to Post-Tonal Theory. Sets are listed across from their complements. When taken together, complements can complete the 12-note chromatic scale when correctly transposed (and sometimes inverted). Table 33.6.1 List of Set Classes for 3- and 9-note sets (Trichords and Nonachords) Prime Form (012) (013) (014) (015) (016) (024) (025) (026) (027) (036) (037) (048) Forte Number 3–1 3–2 3–3 3–4 3–5 3–6 3–7 3–8 3–9 3–10 3–11 3–12 Interval Vector 210000 111000 101100 100110 100011 020100 011010 010101 010020 002001 001110 000300 Prime Form (012345678) (012345679) (012345689) (012345789) (012346789) (01234568T) (01234578T) (01234678T) (01235678T) (01234679T) (01235679T) (01245689T) Forte Number 9–1 9–2 9–3 9–4 9–5 9–6 9–7 9–8 9–9 9–10 9–11 9–12 Interval Vector 876663 777663 767763 766773 766674 686763 677673 676764 676683 668664 667773 666963 CHAPTER 33. SET THEORY 402 Table 33.6.2 List of Set Classes for 4– and 8–note sets (Tetrachords and Octachords) Prime Form (0123) (0124) (0125) (0126) (0127) (0134) (0135) (0136) (0137) (0145) (0146) (0147) (0148) (0156) (0157) (0158) (0167) (0235) (0236) (0237) (0246) (0247) (0248) (0257) (0258) (0268) (0347) (0358) (0369) 1 Forte Forte Number 4–1 4–2 4–4 4–5 4–6 4–3 4–11 4–13 4–Z29 4–7 4–Z15 4–18 4–19 4–8 4–16 4–20 4–9 4–10 4–12 4–14 4–21 4–22 4–24 4–23 4–27 4–25 4–17 4–26 4–28 Interval Vector 321000 221100 211110 210111 210021 212100 121110 112011 111111 201210 111111 102111 101310 200121 110121 101220 200022 122010 112101 111120 030201 021120 020301 021030 012111 020202 102210 012120 004002 prime form for 8–26: (0124579T) Prime Form (01234567) (01234568) (01234578) (01234678) (01235678) (01234569) (01234579) (01234679) (01235679) (01234589) (01234689) (01235689) (01245689) (01234789) (01235789) (01245789) (01236789) (02345679) (01345679) (01245679) (0123468T) (0123568T) (0124568T) (0123578T) (0124578T) (0124678T) (01345689) (0134578T) 1 (0134679T) Forte Number 8–1 8–2 8–4 8–5 8–6 8–3 8–11 8–13 8–Z29 8–7 8–Z15 8–18 8–19 8–8 8–16 8–20 8–9 8–10 8–12 8–14 8–21 8–22 8–24 8–23 8–27 8–25 8–17 8–26 8–28 Interval Vector 765442 665542 655552 654553 654463 656542 565552 556453 555553 645652 555553 546553 545752 644563 554563 545662 644464 566452 556543 555562 474643 465562 464743 465472 456553 464644 546652 456562 448444 CHAPTER 33. SET THEORY 403 Table 33.6.3 List of Set Classes for 5– and 7–note sets (Pentachords and Septachords) Prime Form (01234) (01235) (01236) (01237) (01245) (01246) (01247) (01248) (01256) (01257) (01258) (01267) (01268) (01346) (01347) (01348) (01356) (01357) (01358) (01367) (01369) (01457) (01458) (01468) (01469) (01478) (01568) 3 (02346) (02347) (02357) (02358) (02368) (02458) (02468) (02469) (02479) (03458) Forte Number 5–1 5–2 5–4 5–5 5–3 5–9 5–Z36 5–13 5–6 5–14 5–Z38 5–7 5–15 5–10 5–16 5–Z17 5–Z12 5–24 5–27 5–19 5–31 5–Z18 5–21 5–30 5–32 5–22 5–20 5–8 5–11 5–23 5–25 5–28 5–26 5–33 5–34 5–35 5–Z37 Interval Vector 432100 332110 322111 321121 322210 231211 222121 2221311 311221 221131 212221 310132 220222 223111 213211 212320 222121 131221 122230 212122 114112 212221 202420 121321 113221 202321 211231 232201 222220 132130 123121 122212 122311 040402 032221 032140 212320 Prime Form (0123456) (0123457) (0123467) (0123567) (0123458) (0123468) (0123568) (0124568) (0123478) (0123578) (0124578) (0123678) (0124678) (0123469) (0123569) (0124569) (0123479) (0123579) (0124579) (0123679) (0134679) (0145679) 2 (0124589) (0124689) (0134689) (0125689) (0125679) 4 (0234568) (0134568) (0234579) (0234679) (0135679) (0134579) (012468T) (013468T) (013568T) (0134578) Forte Number 7–1 7–2 7–4 7–5 7–3 7–9 7–Z36 7–13 7–6 7–14 7–Z38 7–7 7–15 7–10 7–16 7–Z17 7–Z12 7–24 7–27 7–19 7–31 7–Z18 7–21 7–30 7–32 7–22 7–20 7–8 7–11 7–23 7–25 7–28 7–26 7–33 7–34 7–35 7–Z37 Interval Vector 654321 554331 544332 543342 544431 453432 444342 443532 533442 443352 434442 532353 442443 445332 435432 434541 444342 353442 344451 434343 336333 434442 424641 343542 335442 424542 433452 454422 444441 354351 345342 344433 344532 262623 254442 254361 434541 In the table below, when no set is listed across from a six–note set, it is self–complementary (that is, it can combine with a transposed and possibly inverted set of itself to complete a 12-note chromatic scale. 2 Forte prime form for 7–Z18: (0123589) prime form for 5–20: (01378) 4 Forte prime form for 7–20: (0124789) 3 Forte CHAPTER 33. SET THEORY 404 Table 33.6.4 List of Set Classes for 6-note sets (Hexachords) Prime Form (012345) (012346) (012347) (012348) (012357) (012358) (012367) (012368) (012369) (012378) (012458) (012468) (012469) (012478) (012479) (012569) (012578) (012579) (012678) (013457) (013458) (013469) (013479) (013579) (013679) (023679) 5 (014568) (014579) 6 (014589) (023457) (023468) (023469) (023579) (024579) (02468T) Forte Number 6–1 6–2 6–Z36 6–Z37 6–9 6–Z40 6–5 6–Z41 6–Z42 6–Z38 6–15 6–22 6–Z46 6–Z17 6–Z47 6–Z44 6–18 6–Z48 6–7 6–Z10 6–14 6–27 6–Z49 6–34 6–30 6–Z29 6–16 6–31 6–20 6–8 6–21 6–Z45 6–33 6–32 6–35 Interval Vector 543210 4443211 433221 432321 342231 333231 422232 332232 324222 421242 323421 241422 233331 322332 233241 313431 322242 232341 420243 333321 323430 225222 224322 142422 224223 224232 322431 223431 303630 343230 242412 234222 143241 143250 060603 Prime Form Forte Number Interval Vector (012356) (012456) 6–Z3 6–Z4 433221 432321 (012457) 6–Z11 333231 (012457) (013467) (012567) 6–Z12 6–Z13 6–Z6 332232 324222 421242 (013468) (012568) (013568) (013478) 6–Z24 6–Z43 6–Z25 6–Z19 233331 233331 233241 313431 (013578) 6–Z26 232341 (023458) 6–Z39 333321 (013569) 6–Z28 224322 (014679) 6–Z50 224232 (023568) 6–Z23 234222 33.7 Transposition (Tn ) Transposition is an operation performed as Tn , where n is the number of semitones up a set is transposed. For example, [1, 2, 4, 6] at T4 is [5, 6, 8, 10]. 5 Forte 6 Forte prime form for 6–Z29: (013689) prime form for 6–31: (013589) CHAPTER 33. SET THEORY 405 59 all notes transposed up 4 semitones (T4) & 44 [1 #œ œ œ #œ 2 4 bœ œ 6] [5 6 bœ bœ 8 10 ] When working in a modulo 12 system, remember that numbers larger than 12 have to be reduced to a number smaller than 12 by subtracting 12 from the larger number. For example, 6, 8, 10, 11 at T9 would result in 15, 17, 18, 20, which, after subtracting 12 from each number, results in 3, 5, 6, 8. & Table 33.7.1 Pitch classes: at T9 : Result: Make numbers modulo 12: Result: & 6 8 10 11 9 9 9 9 15 17 18 20 – 12 12 12 12 all notes 3 transposed 5 up 64 semitones 8 (T4) + 4 & 4(Tn I) œ 33.8 Inversion #œ [1 #œ œ 2 4 6] 59 [5 6 Inverting a set using Tn I is a compound operation. The first step is to invert each note below C using C as an axis. For example, E is a major 3rd above C, so E would invert to A2, a major third below C. & 44 œ #œ & œ # œinversion at T0œI C is axis of œ bœ bœ bœ bœ The[ 1second step is to So,8 to calculate T3 I 2 of inversion 4 6 ] apply the [ 5 Tn interval. 6 10 ] & first invert E to A2 (this is T0 I), then transpose the for the note E, one would A2 up 3 semitones to B. (Theorist Joseph Straus simplifies the nomenclature to In instead of Tn I, but the outcome remains the same.) Let’s try inverting a pitch-class set, applying T7 I to [2, 4, 5] (or D, E, and M3 abovethe C inverts M3 below C at T0side I F). Inverting notes toto the opposite of C using C as an axis yields pitch œ 2 2 numbers 10, 8, and ˙7 (or B , bAœ , and G), which in ascending order is 7, 8, and & 10. Then transposing [7, 8, 10] at T7 raises each note 7 semitones, resulting in axis F). of [2, 3, 5] (or D, EC2, isand inversion at T0I pitches: 5 4 2 inverts to 10 int.: P4↑ M3↑ M2↑ M2↓ & œ œ œ ˙ 8 M3↓ bœ bœ C is axis of inversion at T0I 7 P4↓ œ Then transpose: [7 8 10 ] at T7 = [ 2 œ bœ bœ 8 10 ] 59 M3 above C inverts to M3 below C at T0I all notes transposed up 4 semitones (T4) ˙ bœ bœ bœ œ œ bœ œ 3 5] Therefore, [2, 4, 5] at T7I = [2, 3, 5] & 33.8.1 Identifying Tn I for Inversionally-Related Sets To determine n of Tn I for two inversionally-related sets, write the second set backward and add the notes of the two sets together. Each sum will equal n. Let’s use our two sets from the previous example above: [2, 4, 5] and [2, 3, 5]. & œ0 2 3 4 œ b œ œ b œ œ bœ nœ œ œ bœ & NFœ transposed to 0 œ binverted b œ n œ b œ œ œ0 # œ1 2 4 œ is Prime œcompact # œmostversion most œ compact Form bform œ œCompare: version is Prime Form b œinverted n œCompare: inversion (most compact) (most compact) ascending transposed to 0 6 semitones 11 semitones inverted 11 semitones inverted form inversion 9 semitones 11 semitones 6 semitones 11 semitones 406 9 semitones ascending transposed to 0 Compare: most compact version is Prime Form (most compact) most compact version is Prime Form 11 semitones 11 semitones Compare: 6 semitones 9 semitones [7, 10, 11, (most compact) [7, 1] 10, 11, 1] First set in order: 2 9 semitones 4 Normal 5 Form 11 semitones 6 semitones 11 semitones Normal Form œ œœ œ b œ œ b œ # œ # œ # b œ n œ b œ n œ b œ n œ œ b œœ n œ œ b œ n œ # œ b œ n œ # œ œ #œ & # œ &œ Table 33.8.1 #œ œ œ œ bœ n œ backward: & Second œ b œ set œ b œ n œ # œ+ b œ5 n œ3 # œ 2 œ œ # œ œ b œ #œ 0 2 30 62 n œ Tn[7,œI: b10,œ 0n11,œ 3#1]œ 40 #b 7œœ36 n œ47 # œ67 œ #œ & œ b œn of # œœ b œ3 # 6œ bœ nœ b œ œ #œ œ œ œ Normal Form œ b œ n œœ # œœ b œ b œ b œb œb œb œ nbœœ b œ n œ œ œ [7, &10, 11, & 1] This confirms the sets are related at T7 I. Normal Form 0 3 4 6 0 2 3 6 to 0 NF transposed toinverted 0 inverted inverted form inversion inversion # œ form b œ3 n œ4 # œ6 œ NF transposed b œ3 inverted œ ascending to 0 œ œ œ 0 0 2 6 ascendingtransposed transposed to 0 œ b œ b œ n œ & bœ bœ # œ # œ b œ n œ b œ œ 33.9 Practice Exercises œ œ œ œ œ b œ b œ b œinverted b œ nform œ & NF transposed to 0 inverted inversion NF transposed to 0 CHAPTER 33. SET THEORY Compare: most compact is Prime Form mostversion compact version is Prime Form ascending Compare: transposed to 0 inverted form inversion ascending transposed to 0 Compare: most compact version is Prime Form #œ Day One # œœ œ &œ & 1. Put each set into normal form and prime form. NF transposed to 0 (a) (b) (c) (d) &œ &œ & œ & bœ & bb bb œœœ & bb b œœœ ? bœ ? bœ ? ? bœ bœ #œ #œ œ œ nœ nœ #œ #œ (e) & œ #œ (f) & œ #œ (g) œŒ inverted Œ œ œ œ Œ Œ œœ œ& Œ& œ Œ œ œ b b Œœœ b b œœ Œ bœ Œ œ & b œŒ & b b œœ Œ Ó ? #œ b œ ? Œ nbœ Ó n œ ##œœ # œ #œ #œ œ #œ ? œ œ #bœœ ? # œ œ #œ œ b œ œ œ œ Compare: most compact version is Prime Form œ #œ œ &# œ œ œ #œ œ & œ #œ œ bœ nœ œ bœ nœ ? bœ nœ #œ ? œ bœ nœ #œ œ œ bœ Ó Ó 57 57 œ bœ Day Two 2. For each of the six sets&in the example below, determine the normal form, prime & form, Forte number, and interval vector. 211 # œ œ œ # ## œœœ # œ n n n œœœ & c # # # ˙˙˙˙ # œ & & #œ # # œœœ # œ ?c 2 1 168 Day Three 170 & ? & & & & 3 4 b b b œœœœ bœ 6 # œœ n ˙˙ œ ˙˙ n œ b b b œœ b b ˙˙ 5 ∑ CHAPTER 33. SET THEORY 3. 407 Transposition (Tn ) of Sets. Transpose the following sets as specified. , (a) Transpose [3, 6, 7] at T2 : [ , (b) Transpose [2, 4, 8, 9] at T7 : [ , , (c) Transpose [1, 2, 4, 7, 8] at T9 : [ 4. , , , ] , , ] Inversion (Tn I) of Sets. Invert the following sets. Write your answers in normal form. , (a) Invert [7, 10, 11] at T0 I: [ (b) Invert [0, 2, 4] at T4 I: [ 5. ] , ] , , ] (c) Invert [4, 6, 10, 11] at T9 I: [ , , , ] Specify the interval of inversion from the first set to the second set. (a) [2, 4, 7] inverts to [3, 6, 8] at what Tn I? (b) [1, 2, 4, 7] inverts to [4, 7, 9, 10] at what Tn I? (c) [6, 7, 10, 1, 2] inverts to [3, 4, 7, 10, 11] at what Tn I? Click here to download the first homework assignment for this chapter. Click here to download the second homework assignment for this chapter. Click here to download the third homework assignment for this chapter. PDF versions of the textbook, homework exercises, and practice exercises can be found at musictheory.pugetsound.edu Chapter 34 Serialism Serialism is a term that encompasses the twelve-tone technique of Schoenberg, Webern, and Berg, who were the major figures we associated with expressionism and atonality in the previous chapter on set theory. We will begin by discussing classic twelve-tone serialism before discussing non-twelve-tone serialism. 34.1 Twelve-Tone Technique YouTube: https://www.youtube.com/watch?v=bQHR_Z8XVvI Figure 34.1.1 Arnold Schoenberg, Suite for Piano, Op. 25 In a twelve-tone composition, every note can be accounted for as being a member of the original series or one of its permutations, providing unity to the piece as a whole. Additionally, a twelve-tone series is a repository of intervals and can be seen as an outgrowth of atonal music with its emphasis on interval over chord or scale. The basic premises of twelve-tone music are as follows: 1. All twelve notes of the chromatic scale must occur 2. No note can be repeated in the series until the other 11 notes of the chromatic scale have occurred (exceptions include direct repetition of a note, trills, and tremolos) 3. The series can be inverted, retrograded, and the inversion can be retrograded 4. The order of notes in a series remains fixed, without reordering. 408 CHAPTER 34. SERIALISM 409 34.1.1 Row Forms 60 A twelve-tone series is also commonly called a twelve-tone “row,” and we will use the term “row” throughout this chapter. The four types of row forms used in twelve-tone technique are prime (P), retrograde (R), inversion (I), and retrograde inversion (RI). The prime is the original row. The retrograde is the prime form backward. The inversion is the original row with all intervals in the row inverted (going in the opposite R1 (1 means it ends on C˜) RI7 (7 means it ends on G) direction of the original). Finally, the retrograde inversion is the inversion retrograded (and therefore might have more appropriately been labeled “inversion retrograded” since “retrograde inversion” sounds like it refers to the backward form inverted instead of the inverted form backward). œ œ bœ œ bœ œ œ œ nœ #œ #œ #œ #œ œ bœ œ #œ œ œ nœ œ œ & #œ #œ bœ nœ œ nœ œ bœ œ bœ bœ œ bœ œ nœ #œ #œ œ œ bœ bœ nœ œ œ & œ bœ R1 (1 means it ends on C˜) RI7 (7 means it ends on G) œ b œ œ œ = Prime with œ b œ =œInversion # œ œ œbackward Inversion Inversion b œ œintervals ninverted œ # œ # œ # œ #Retrograde œ œ nœ œ œ œ # œ &œ # œ œ #œ #œ œ œ #œ #œ nœ œ bœ bœ œ bœ nœ nœ & R1 (1œ #means itœ endsb œonn œC˜) RI7 (7 means it ends on G) œ n œ œ # œ œ #œ œ œ œ œ b œ œ œ œ œ n œ # œ # œ # œ #Retrograde œ b œbackward œ n œ Prime (Original) b œ = Prime œ œ # œ & #œ b œ n œ œ bœ bœ œ œ 34.1.2 Transposition Numbers œ b œ b œ n œ œ bœ œ nœ #œ #œ œ œ bœ bœ nœ œ œ & Each row form can be transposed to start on any note from the chromatic & (Original) Prime Retrograde = Prime backward scale. We will use the same pitch integers as in set theory. For primes and b œ n œ b œbackward Inversion = Prime with intervals inverted Retrograde Inversion œ œ toœ specify inversions, we will use P and I accompanied by a pitch œ b œ b œ ninteger œ =œInversion b œ n œ b œ œthe œ b œ n œ œ b œ œ œ & œ œnote. For example, # œ # œ œ starting Pœ0#is a twelve-tone row starting on C (pitch œ # œ n œ #œ 2 #œ œ b œ same ninteger œ ncase n œ starting œ b œThe &P3 is a# œtwelve-tone œ œ #isœ the n œ œ b œ b œrow 0), on E , and so forth. for row forms like I (starting on D), I (starting on F), on so forth. Inversion & = Prime with2intervals inverted 5 Retrograde Inversion = Inversion backward œ n œ the row on E¯) œ # œ nthe b œstarts nœ nœ b œ n œon œC)# œ # œ œ œP3# (3œ #means œœb row œ b œstarts &P0 (0œ means œ œ œ œ # œ b œ œ b bœ nœ œ nœ œ bœ œ œ bœ bœ œ nœ nœ bœ œ nœ #œ bœ nœ & œ bœ P (0 means the row starts on C) P3 (3 means the row starts on E¯) &I 0(2 means œ b œ b œ œ œstarts b œ n œ b œ bonœ F)œ n œ œ n œstarts the row Iœ5 (5 means the row œ b on œ bD) b n œ 2 œ bœ œ n œ œ &œ œ b œ #b œ œ œ œ b œ œ b œ b œ n œ œ # œ # œ nœœ œ # œ n œ b œ n œ & #œ nœ œ Prime (Original) 60 60 Retrograde = Prime backward & œ #œ œ œ bœ bœ œ œ œ bœ œ bœ bœ nœ œ #œ #œ œ n œ b œ n œ œ & #œ nœ œ bœ bœ bœ nœ œ #œ œ #œ #œ nœ œ bœ œ œ œ #œ #œ nœ œ œ b œ n œ &œ R1 (1 means the row ends on C˜) RI7 (7 means the row ends on G) œ & œ œ œ bœ bœ bœ nœ œ #œ #œ #œ nœ œ bœ œ œ œ #œ #œ nœ b œ n œ œ & & I2 (2 means the row starts on D) I5 (5 means the row starts on F) However, the retrograde (R) and retrograde inversion (RI) row forms use R (1 means the row ends on C˜) RI (7 means the row ends on G) the 1pitch integer of the last note in the row7 to designate their transposition level. Therefore, R1 ends on C4, and RI7 ends on G. & & & œ œ RI4 (ends on 4) & œœ œœ.# œœ #nœœ œ œb œœ bbœœ n bœœ bœœ# nœœ# œœ b œ ‰ b#œœj # œ n œ œ b bœœ bœœn œœ œœ n#œœb œn œb œn œn œ & œ bœ Inversion = Prime with intervals inverted 172 Retrograde Inversion = Inversion backward R8 (ends on 8) œ CHAPTER 34. SERIALISM 3 3 410 P1 3 0 bbœœ nœœ # œ œ œ . # œ Row Forms bœ œ 34.2 ? ‰ bœœDetermining œ œ n œ œ b œ # œ œ n œ b œ #bœœœnœœ # œœ. b #œœ b#œœ nœœ œœ œb œœ b œ J nœœ œ œ 11 P (0 Imeans the row starts on C) P (3 means the row starts on E¯) bœ œ nœ #œ & nœ 3 To determine a row form’s3 permutation and3 transposition, examine the inter3 3 3 vallic composition of each row form. In the example below, each row statement is Ibased on the form (2 means the prime row starts on of D) the row in the I (5previous means thesections. row starts on F) 5 b œ œ œ œ b œ œj œ b œ œ b œb œb œ nnœœ œ # œ # œb œ œn œ œœ. œ # œ œ n œœ b œ n bœœ b œ n œ œ # œ œ œ nœ bœ && # œ n œ œ b œ œ bœ ‰ bœ œ œ bœ 2 174 3 b œonœ G)œ . # œ #the œ œ œends œ n row #b œœ œ n œ b œ # œœRIœ7œ(7##œmeans œ J œ n œ b œ n œ # œ œ3 œ b œ 3 œ b œ œ 3 œ œ # œ3 # œ n œ œ 3 œ # œ 3 b œ n œ œ & œ b œ œ row œ . on # œ C˜) R? 1 (1 means the œ # œ œends 3 ‰ Let’s examine the starting intervals of each row form. P4↑ P0 m2↑ m2↑ M2↓ m2↑ R bœ bœ nœ œ nœ œ bœ bœ œ nœ 0 nœ nœ bœ bœ nœ œ œ œ bœ bœ œ œ & #œ #œ m3↑ m3↓ M2↑ m2↓ m2↓ P4↓ m2↓ œ œ #œ #œ nœ œ bœ bœ & œ nœ #œ nœ œ bœ bœ nœ œ #œ #œ œ œ #œ nœ nœ I0 RI0 In examining the first few notes in the upper staff in the short musical excerpt below, we see an ascending minor 3rd followed by a descending major 2nd. The only row form to start with these intervals is the retrograde. To 211 determine 1the transposition number, we3 look at the 6 note) 2 4 last note5 (the 12th in the first measure in the upper staff (A2), which gives us the transposition level (pitch integer 8), meaning this is R8 . The second measure in the upper staff begins with a minor 3rd followed by an ascending major 2nd, making this a retrograde inversion. The 12th note in this measure is an E (pitch integer 4), making this RI4 . In the first measure of the lower staff, we find a descending minor 2nd followed by a descending perfect 4th, making this I11 . Finally, the second measure in the lower staff begins on C4 with an ascending minor 2nd followed by an ascending perfect 4th, making this P1 . & # œ˙ # œ œ œ # ## œœœ # œ n n n œœœ # # # ˙˙˙ #œ # # œœœ # œ ?c &c 168 170 œ œ. œ #œ œ œ bœ bœ bœ nœ œ bœ &c m3↑ M2↓ 3 1 4 2 3 3 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 b b b œœœœ bœ # œœ n ˙˙ œ ˙˙ n œ b b b œœ b b ˙˙ ∑ M2↑ ‰ b œj œ œ b œ b œ œ n œ œ n œ b œ b œ n œ m3↓ 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 m2↑ ? c ‰ œ b œ œ œ # œ œ œ . # œ # œ œ n œ b œ # œ œ œ # œ . # œ # œ n œ œ œ œ b œ œJ œ m2↓ P4↓ 1 2 3 3 4 5 6 7 P4↑ 3 8 9 10 11 3 12 1 2 3 4 3 The row forms are labeled in the example below. 172 & ? 181 3 3 5 6 7 8 9 9 10 11 12 ? c ‰ œ b œ œ œ # œ œ œ . # œ # œ œ n œ b œ # œ œ œ # œ . # œ # œ n œ œ b œ œJ œ œœ m2↑ P4↑ 3 2 SERIALISM 3 CHAPTER1 34. 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 172 & œ œ. œ #œ 10 11 3 12 R8 (ends on 8) 3 3 œ œ bœ bœ bœ nœ œ bœ 1 2 3 3 3 4 3 5 6 7 8 9 9 10 ‰ b œj œ œ b œ 11 12 411 RI4 (ends on 4) bœ œ nœ œ nœ bœ bœ nœ P1 ? ‰ œ b œ œ œ # œ œ œ . # œ # œ œ n œ b œ # œ œ œ # œ . # œ # œ n œ œ œ œ b œ œJ œ I11 3 3 3 3 3 3 174 34.3 Writing Row Forms & To write specified row forms from a given prime form, write all four versions of the row: P, R, I, and RI. Then, simply transpose the specified row form to the correct pitch, remembering that P and I forms start on the pitch integer (P3 and I3 would begin on E2, for example) while R and RI forms end on the pitch integer (R3 and RI3 would end on E2). To write I9 and RI5 if given P0 : ? 61 1. Write all four row forms (P, R, I, RI). 0 b œ n œ œ bœ bœ œ œ œ b œ b œ n œ bœ œ nœ #œ #œ nœ nœ bœ bœ nœ œ œ &œ P0 R b œ n œ œ n œRIœ b œ bœ nœ œ œ œ bœ bœ œ b œ œ b œ n œ n œ b œ œ n œ & # œ #Rœ0 œ œ & œ n œ # œ n œ œ b œ b œœn œb œœb#œœn#œœ œ n œ œ# œb œ# œ n œ œ b œ b œ œ œ # œ n œ n œ b œ n œ œ œ œ b œ b œ œ bœ œ nœ #œ #œ nœ nœ bœ & I0 RI0 2. Transpose the specified row form to the correctœtransposition œ level. # œ # œ œ RI œ #œ #œ nœ œ bœ bœ œ œ #œ nœ nœ I0 n œ # œ n œ œ b œ b œ n œ & (a) In this example, transpose I0 up 9 semitones (a major 6th)0 to begin œ #œ #œ œ œ #œ #œ nœ œ bœ bœ œ & on A (pitch class œ9).n œ & #œ nœ œ bœ bœ nœ œ #œ nœ nœ P0 I0 P0 R0 0 I9 (begins on pitch class 9) & œI9#(begins œ # œ n œonœpitch n œ œclass # œ 9)œ # œ # œ # œ œ # œ 4th) so the & œ # œ # œRIn œ0 up œ # œ œ # œ(a# perfect œ n5œ semitones (b) To write RI5 , transpose RI5 class (ends on pitch class 5) last note is F (pitch œ # œ # œ 5). nœ œ bœ bœ œ nœ bœ nœ nœ class 5) & RIœ 5 (ends on pitch #œ #œ nœ œ bœ bœ œ bœ nœ nœ nœ & & & One tool analysts create to analyze a twelve-tone composition is a twelve-tone 34.4 Twelve-Tone Matrix matrix, which shows all 48 row forms in a 12-by-12 grid. Below is a matrix for the row we’ve been dealing with in this chapter. 61 61 CHAPTER 34. SERIALISM 412 Table 34.4.1 Twelve-Tone Matrix P0 → P11 → P6 → P5 → P7 → P10 → P8 → P9 → P2 → P3 → P1 → P4 → I0 ↓ C B G2 F G B2 A2 A D E2 D2 E ↑RI0 I1 ↓ D2 I2 ↓ G2 C G G2 A2 F C B D2 E2 B A B2 E2 E D F ↑RI1 D E2 A2 A G B2 ↑RI2 I7 ↓ G G2 D2 I2 ↓ D D2 A2 I4 ↓ E E2 B2 C D F E2 I5 ↓ F E B B2 C E2 D2 G A C B2 E A B2 A2 D G A2 G2 B ↑RI7 A ↑RI5 B E F E2 G2 A B D C C4 F4 G F A2 ↑RI2 ↑RI4 I3 ↓ E2 D A A2 B2 D2 I10 ↓ B2 A E E2 F A2 F4 B C F G2 G C D2 E G ↑RI3 B D ↑RI10 To construct a matrix, write the prime form from left to right in the top row, then write the inverted form from top to bottom in the left column. Table 34.4.2 P0 → P1 → I0 ↓ C B G2 F G B2 A2 D2 G2 G F D E E2 B2 A B G4 ←R0 A D E2 D2 E ↑RI0 From there, you can write the transpositions of the prime form, given the starting notes in the left column. One would continue with each transposition of the prime form until the matrix is complete. 34.5 Row Form Presentation in Music In a piece of music, twelve-tone rows may not be clearly presented. One manner of presentation is overlap, where the final note of one row is the starting note of the next row. I9 ↓ A A2 E2 D E G F G2 B C B2 D2 ↑RI9 I11 ↓ B B2 F E G2 A G A2 D2 D C E2 ↑RI11 I8 ↓ G4 G D C4 E2 F4 E F B2 B A C ↑RI8 ←R0 ←R11 ←R6 ←R5 ←R7 ←R10 ←R8 ←R9 ←R2 ←R3 ←R1 ←R4 CHAPTER 34. SERIALISM 413 64 4 œ œ. œ #œ œ œ bœ bœ bœ nœ bœ nœ œ bœ œ œ bœ bœ œ nœ œ œbœ & R8 RI 3 1 2 3 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 & Figure 34.5.1 Twelfth note overlapping with first note in successive row statements Rows may also be presented contrapuntally or harmonically. In the example below, the row is separated into three tetrachords and presented contrapuntally. 212 212 & 176 176 1 2 3 #œ œ ‰ & œ b œ≈ n œ ≈ œ R R & R. . . 51 2 6 73 P ? 0 b œœ . ‰ œ #n œ . bœ & 9œ n œ 10 11œ R ≈ R ≈ R . . . P0 4 œ ‰ ≈ b œR ≈ . 4 8 œ ‰ #œ ≈ b œR 12≈ . œ œ P0 1 ‰œ P0 œ bœ nœ bœ 2 œ5 1 3 4 œ bœ nœ œ œ # œ b œ œ œ‰ b œ n œ #œ 6 7 8 10 2 11 9 3 4 12 œ œ b œ n œ œ nœ . . œ # œ ?In the final example in this section,‰the two œrows #areœ bpresenting & ‰ in melodyœ #œ accompaniment texture, with P containing the melody and R occurring as 534.5.26Two examples 7 8 of tetrachords5 from 6a row presented 7 8 Figure contrapun178 tally ? chords. 178 9 10 11 0 12 >œ 0 9 6 10 11 12 9 10 11 12 œ œ œ œ. b œ b œ n œ. . & œ œ #œ #œ n œ. # œ 202 > -1 # œ . . . 5 #œ œ7 R 12 & ? Œ 0 œœ 3 2 # œœ 64 ‰ Œ œœ 8 9 ‰ b b œœœ 10 ‰ J J J 11 ?An analyst would first attempt to find a clear presentation of a twelve-tone P0 1 2 3 4 5 7 8 row somewhere in the composition in order to analyze harmonies. 180 & Non-Twelve-Tone Serialism 34.6 209 & ? Serialism also includes music that is not twelve-tone but does use a series of notes that maintains its order and employs inversion, retrograde, and retrograde inversion of the series. An example is found in Stravinsky’s Septet from 1953.1 ? 1 See 209 & ? Erwin Stein, “Strawinsky’s Septet (1953).” Tempo. Spring, 1954. CHAPTER 34. SERIALISM 414 64 64 64 4 œ œ. œ #œ œ œ bœ bœ bœ nœ œ bœ bœ œ nœ œ œbœ bœ nœ & R8 œ b œ œ RI4 3 œ . œ # œ 3 œ b œ bœ nœ YouTube: https://www.youtube.com/watch?v=ijSmRoPzMaY & 1 2 3 4 5œ œ6 b 7œ b œ8 9 n10œ 11œ b12œ œ œ b œ b œ œ n œ œ œ b œ 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 R8 RI Figure 334.6.1 Stravinsky, Septet 3 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 PR4 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 RI 8 4 œ #œ #œ # œ œ . œ œ # œ b œ & œœ œ n œ # œb œ œ n œ œœ œ b œ b#œœ n œ b œ n œ œ b# œ œ œ b œ nœ & P4 œ b œ œ œ œ œ #œ nœ # œ 3 # œ œ 3 œ & œ1 2 3 4 5 œ6 #7œ 8 9 10 11 12 n œ #œ #œ n œ œ Figure 34.6.2 Series from Stravinsky’s 1 Septet 2 3 4 5 n6œ 7 8 9 10 11 12œ œ & œP œœ œ œ # œ ## œœ ## œœ œ n œ ## œœ # œ n œ œœ n œ # œ œ & œ4 œ #œ nœ #œ #œ n œ pc: 4 11 & œ œ œœ9 œ7 # œ6 # œ8 # œ1 11œ n œ7 #6œ # œ8 nn œœ7 œ9 n œ0 # œ8 œœ9 Here P4 is the series with pitch-class integers (abbreviated “pc” for pitch class), and without registral displacement. Arrows connect repeated notes. P0 œ #œ œ œ & œP0 # œ œ #œ # œ8, œ nSeptet [ 4, 34.6.3 œ 6,Series from Figure œ0, n œ pitches & œœ9, # œ showing #11,œ n œ repeated #1œ ] œ œœ7, # œStravinsky’s &Weœœ notice# œœthatœB #(pitch # œ integer 11), A (9), G (7), F4 (6), and G4 (8) are pc: 4 11 9 7 6 8 1 11 7 6 8 7 9 0 8 9 pc: [ 4, 4 11 9 series, 7 with 6 8A, G,8, 1 and 11G4 79, 6 11, 8 three 7 times 9 each. 0 18]Below 9 is 7, 0, repeated in the6, occurring the normal form of the 8 pitch classes in the 16-note series. & &œ [ 4, #œ 6, œ 7, #œ 8, œ 9, œ 11, œ 0, #œ 1] Figure 34.6.4 Normal form of the 8 pitches in the series from Stravinsky’s Septet &Such a series could imply E or A as a tonal center. Note that Stravinsky’s Septet is not strictly serial but contains serial elements. Such an example shows us that serialism can be employed in ways other than the strict, original twelve-tone version. 34.7 Practice Exercises Serialism: Day One 1. Given the prime form of the twelve-tone row in pitch integers, write the specified row forms in the staves below. œ #œ #œ nœ œ bœ bœ œ bœ nœ nœ nœ & CHAPTER 34. SERIALISM RI5 (ends on pitch class 5) 52 415 P7: 1. 7 E¯ 107(˜85); 2Scale: 1 5 ____________________________ 3 4 6 0 9 11 R7 & & I7 62 RI 7 ˜9; Scale: ____________________________ 2. B¯7¯5 & ? 52 (a) P1 7(¯5) 3. Fm7( 5) ; Scale: ____________________________ P1 1. E¯ ˜ ; Scale: ____________________________ & & # œ& œ 62 62 62 œ bœ œ œ nœ bœ œ bœ bœ bœ œ œ nœ bœ œ bœ & œ œ # œ b œ œ œ n œ b œ œœ b œ & ? & œ œ ? ? # œ bœ bœ œ œ nœ bœ & bœ # œ ##Rœœ4 œœ œ b œ œ n œ b œ n œ n œ b œ Tone (c) I8? R7(7(¯5) 4 bœ œ nœ 1. Fm E¯ œE¯ Whole 3. Scale: ____________________________ #Rœ4˜ );;#Scale: I8? œ ____________________________ b œ b œ œ n œ bb œœ nn œœ n œ & b œ? # œœ # œœ œ b œ b œ œœ n œ b˙œ n œ b ˙ n œ œ ˙ b œ n œ n œ œ # œn œ & & b#I˙œ8 # œ œ # œ œ3rd bIœ8 œ œ Root ¯7th ˜5th œ #œ # œ n œ b œ n œ I b œ œ 8 (d) RI œB¯ Diminished-Whole & 10 7Δ7( œ ____________________________ Tone ˜9; 5) 2. Scale: œ 4. B¯ A¯ # œ n œ ¯5 ˜ ; Scale:œ____________________________ b œ bœ n œ œ ##b ˙œœ œ & RI? œ 10 # œ n œ b œ nœ#œ œ nœ ˙ ? b ˙ n ˙ b œ& b ˙œ b œ (b) P1 R4 P7Δ7( 1 5) ˜9;˜ Scale: 4. A¯ ; Scale: ____________________________ B¯P1¯5 ____________________________ R42. 5 2. ? œ bœ œ ˜9th# œ œ n œ¯5th œ b œ 3rd nœ ¯7th bœ bœ n œb œ œ œ œ œ œ nœ œ # œnn œœb œ œœ œ #œ œ #œ œ #œ bœ œ nœ bœ bœ œ 10 h form œw of œa twelve-tone Given ? thebRI prime œw n œrow,w œlabelb œwthen œrownn œœforms # œ b œ and hTone 7(10 5); bScale: œ E¯ Whole ˜ b œ 1. E¯ ____________________________ ? 7(¯5) bofœ theœpermutations œ b œ transpositions given on the staves below. œ # œ n œ n œ F Locrian (or F Locrian 2) œ bœ nœ bœ ˜ RI10 Root RI w ˜ œ bœ ?3. Fm ; Scale: œ____________________________ bœ œ & bb ˙œ n œ œb œ b ˙ œ b ˙œ # bœ˙œ œ œb œ n œ ˙ b œ b#˙bœ˙ b œœ b ˙ n œ œ ˙P10b œ b œb ˙ n œœ œ3rd ˙ b œœ b ˙n œ ¯7th part 2 PRAC EXER & b œ& Root œ P b œ ˜b5thœ n œ # œ œ n œ œ bPœ7109 b œ (whole part 2 PRAC EXER œ between E¯ œand Tone n œB¯step & F and between b œ b œ n œA¯ and# œB¯ œ n œ 10 Diminished-Whole ˜ œ 2. B¯ ; Scale: ____________________________ n œ whole part 2 PRAC EXER œ step œ & bb œœ¯5 b œ permit or half step b œ between F and G) #œ œ bœ nœ part 2 PRAC EXER ? œ œ n˙ (a) Row & b ˙form: ˙ bœ#œ nœ b˙ b ˙ b œ Δ7( 5) ˜ A¯ Lydian-Augmented 4. A¯ ; Scale: ____________________________ Root ¯7th œ 3rd ? & # œ b ˙œ n œb œ œw ˜9th œœ w# œ¯5th˙ # œw œœ œw # œ ˙ nwœ b œbbœœ ˙ RI10 œ œ & #œ h œ nœ œ #œ #œ h RI10 œ nœ bœ œ #7th 3rd œ œ &3. Fm #Root œ7(¯5); Scale: n œ____________________________ ˜#5th RI10 F Locrianœ(or F œLocrian 2)# œ œ ˜ œ œ # œ nœ bœ & #œ œ nœ œ œ #œ #œ RI10 # œ b œn œ b ˙ œ œ b ˙ b œ (b) Row form: b œ b ˙ b ˙ b œ b ˙ b ˙ & b œ œ bœ ˙ n œ n œ œ œ # œ ˙ # œ# œ œ œ b œ & & b œœ œœ (whole I1 b œ œ nnœœ # œE¯# œand F# œand between I1 A¯ and B¯ œ œ stepn œ between b œ # œ œ œ # œ bœ œ nœ & b œ œ permit I1 œ step # œ Fœand G) or# œ half step between œ nwhole œ # œ bœ œ nœ & I1 œ # œ œ A¯ Lydian-Augmented 4. A¯Δ7(˜5); Scale: ____________________________ (c) Row ? form: œ ˙ œ˙ b œ b œ R5 R5 & œ & bœ˙ bœœœ b œbb bœœœ b œb˙œ b œb œ œb œ œ œœ n œ n œ n œn œ œ œ b œb œ œœ b œ œ n œ n œ 7th R5 & œRoot œ b œ b 3rd œ œ R5 &œ b œ bb œœ b œ ˜5th nœ nœ œ bœ œ P10 & Serialism: & Day & Two & 3. Construct a 12 by 12 matrix for the prime form of the following twelvetone row, given in pitch integers: 3, 7, 11, 1, 5, 0, 2, 10, 6, 4, 8, 9. Include labels for all row forms including all transposition levels (P0 , R3 , I8 , RI6 , etc.). Use note names in the matrix, not integers. CHAPTER 34. SERIALISM 416 Table 34.7.1 I ↓ P P P P P P P P P P P P 184 5. I ↓ I ↓ I ↓ I ↓ I ↓ I ↓ I ↓ I ↓ I ↓ I ↓ ← ← ← ← ← ← ← ← ← ← ← ← ↑RI 4. I ↓ → → → → → → → → → → → → ↑RI ↑RI ↑RI ↑RI ↑RI ↑RI ↑RI ↑RI For the following excerpt, determine P5 and identify each row form 213 and statement. This example contains overlap. œ. . . . > . b œ . œ # œ n œœ b œ. # œ # bœ œ nœ nœ œ. bœ œ. bœ œ œ w & c ‰ œ bœ œ #œ > p . . # œ > w n œœ # œ n n œœ. > . b œ œ. . n œ. n œ. . ?c Œ # œ œ b œ œ b œ ‰ J œ œ nœ œ bœ #œ œ b œ œ bœ Referring to the twelve-tone row used to construct the matrix in the practice exercise above (3, 7, 11, 1, 5, 0, 2, 10, 6, 4, 8, 9), find the 187 normal form and prime form for each discrete three-note set from the & and provide an interval vector for each. row, (a) Set 1: 3, 7, 11. Normal form: ? Interval vector: Prime form: (b) Set 2: 1, 5, 0. Normal form: Interval vector: Prime form: (c) Set 3: 2, 10, 6. Normal form: Interval vector: Prime form: (d) Set 4: 4, 8, 9. Normal form: Interval vector: Prime form: Click here to download the first homework assignment for this chapter. Click here to download the second homework assignment for this chapter. ↑RI ↑RI ↑RI Chapter 35 Minimalism The rise of minimalism in the 1960s was a significant development in art music. While four artists are typically associated with minimalism—La Monte Young (b. 1935), Terry Riley (b. 1935), Phillip Glass (b. 1937), Steve Reich (b. 1936)—we will focus on just two techniques in this chapter. The first, additive minimalism, is associated with the early minimalist pieces by Philip Glass. The second, phase shifting, is associated with Steve Reich. 35.1 Additive Minimalism In Philip Glass’s version of additive minimalism as found at the beginning of his composition Two Pages (1969), he adds a repetition of a pattern but subtracts the final note in the repetition. Each addition to the pattern is another repetition with the final note of the previous repetition subtracted, as can be seen in the example below. (Note: The music notation below is a transcription and analysis meant to show the additive process and is not necessarily how the music is written in the score.) Pattern: Pattern: Pattern: 5 & & 885 A A A .. œ œœ œœ bb œœ œœ .. 855ˆ484 .œ . 8ˆ8 A A A + + + B B B œœ œœ œœ .. .. œ œœ œœ bb œœ œœ œ .œ . œ (B is A minus (B is minus (Bfinal is A Anote) minus final final note) note) B bb œœ œœ + œœ + Cœ œ . 55ˆ44ˆ33 .. œ œ œ œ œ & œœ œ œ œœ œ œ .. & 88ˆ88ˆ88 . œœ œ Pattern: Pattern: Pattern: Pattern: Pattern: Pattern: 55ˆ484ˆ383ˆ282 & 8 & 8ˆ8ˆ8ˆ8 88 & 4 &4 A A A A A A + + + + + B B B B B + + + + + C C (C is B minus (C is minus (Cfinal is B B note) minus final final note) note) C C C + + + D D D .. œ œœ œœ bb œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œœ .. .œ . œ œ œ (D is C minus (D is minus (Dfinal is C Cnote) minus final note) final note) 417 65 65 65 & 85ˆ48ˆ38 .. œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ .. (C is B minus final note) CHAPTER 35. MINIMALISM Pattern: A + B + C + 418 D bœ œ œ & 85ˆ48ˆ38ˆ28 .. œ œ œ YT: emeykTooD9c œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ .. (D is C minus final note) Figure 35.1.1 Glass, Two Pages (1969) The following example from Music in Fifths (1969) clearly displays additive process on its own, but is just one of dozens of steps in an additive process. b œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ & b b œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ Pattern: b &bb A A 65 + B b œ œ . 5 ˆ4 . œ œ b œ œ œ . . 88 .œ . & 85 .. œ œ œ œ œ œ (B is A minus final note) YT: 6V1hokSS4TU Figure 35.1.2 Glass, Music in Fifths (1969) To hear additive process listen Pattern:in Glass’s well-known A Einstein+on the Beach, B + to the following minute of music from Act 1, Scene 1, œ“Train.” Each chord in b œ œ œ œ lengthenedœby adding œ œ to the œ a five–chord cadential& progression 85ˆ48ˆ38 .. isœ gradually number of subdivisions given to each chord. C œ œ .. (C is B minus final note) Pattern: A YT: pRerJeYmUgY 5ˆ4ˆ3onˆ2the.. Beach œ Figure 35.1.3 Glass, Einstein &8 8 8 8 œ + B + C + D œ b œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ .. 35.2 Phase Shifting Minimalist composer Steve Reich conceived of phase shifting in his early work in tape music, noting that tape loops of slightly differing lengths containing the œœ œphase œœ œwhenœ œœ into œœback same idea went slowly outb bof phase and veryœ gradually œ œ œ œ œ œ œ b œ & œ(seeœ It’sœ Gonna œ Rain œ œfrom 1965 and Comeœ Outœ they were repeated incessantly from 1966). Reich applied this phase–shifting process to live performance in Piano Phase (1967), Violin Phase (1967), and Clapping Music (1972). ã œ œ œ ‰ œ œ ‰ œJ ‰ œ œ ‰ # & # 43 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ YouTube: https://www.youtube.com/watch?v=lzkOFJMI5i8 Figure 35.2.1 Reich, Clapping Music (1972) Below is the basic twelve–note pattern of Piano Phase along with a video demonstrating the phase–shifting. (D is C minus final note) œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ ã œ œ œ ‰ œ œ ‰ œJ ‰ œ œ ‰ CHAPTER 35. MINIMALISM 419 # & # 43 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ YouTube: https://www.youtube.com/watch?v=57TuvksMR70 Figure 35.2.2 Reich, Piano Phase (1967) During the phase–shifting process, one can think of the lower voices in the examples above as going through rotation. The example below shows rotation of a five–note pattern. The pattern rotates one note to the left, meaning the second note begins the pattern on the second line, the third note begins the pattern on the third line, etc., until the first note starts the pattern again to 66 complete the phase–shifting process. & 85 œ œ 2 œ œ & 85 œ œ œ 2 œ & 85 œ œ œ & 85 œ œ & 85 œ œ 1 3 4 5 3 4 5 1 3 4 5 4 5 œ 1 œ œ 5 œ 1 œ 2 œ œ 1 2 3 œ œ œ 2 3 rotating pattern one note to the right. 2nd note begins pattern, then the 3rd note begins the pattern, until the 1st notestarts the pattern again to complete the process. 4 In a piece of music,&the process would play out similar to the manner below, where one part maintains the original pattern while the second goes out of phase by continually rotating the original pattern one note to the left. In Piano Phase, Reich has the second pianist gradually increase in speed so the patterns go slowly out of phase, while in Clapping Music, Reich has the musicians change to the next rotation on the downbeat of a measure, without gradually speeding up. Figure 35.2.3 Rotation demonstrated with a five–note pattern P5 # œœ. # œ. 4 > 12 n . . n œ. n œ. w > . œ b œ 9 n œ œ . ?c Œ n œ # œ ‰ J œœ65 œ 8 b b œœ œœ b œ b œ œ n œ. œ b œ #œ CHAPTER 35. MINIMALISM 1 2 3 4 5/6 7 8/9 10/11 12 2 3 1 RI10 7 In phase 187 10 11 1 23 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 Out of phase 420 12 In phase & 85 .. œ œ œ œ œ .. .. œ œ œ œ œ .. .. œ œ œ œ œ .. .. œ œ œ œ œ .. .. œ œ œ œ œ .. œ œ œ œ œ .. 12345 12345 12345 12345 12345 12345 12345 23451 34512 45123 51234 12345 first rotation second rotation third rotation & 85 .. œ œ œ œ œ .. .. œ œ œ œ œ .. .. œ œ œ œ œ .. .. œ œ œ œ œ .. .. œ œ œ œ œ .. œ œ œ œ œ .. fourth rotation Figure 35.2.4 A short phase–shifting process piece 193 & One hears phase shifting in numerous works by Reich, including the second movement of his Three Movements. & YouTube: https://www.youtube.com/watch?v=XIuJ_my4_-k Figure 35.2.5 Reich, Three Movements, II. It is worth mentioning that composers like Stravinsky applied rotation to serialism, which Joseph Straus details in Chapter 6 of his Introduction to Post–Tonal Analysis (4th edition). 35.3 Homework Assignments Click here to download the first homework assignment for this chapter. Click here to download the second homework assignment for this chapter. Click here to download the Unit 12 Practice Test. Appendix A Answers to Practice Exercises 1 · Basic Concepts 1.6 · Practice Exercises 1.6.1. Answer. A6, 10. B7 1. A0, 2. F1, 3. D2, 4. G2, 5. B3, 6. E4, 7. A4, 8. G5, 9. 1.6.2. Answer. 1. E5, 2. D6, 3. F4, 4. G3, 5. A4, 6. E4, 7. G3, 8. A2, 9. E4, 10. E4, 11. G3, 12. C4 3 4 4 3 5 3 2 5 1.6.3. Answer. 1. G and E ; 2. D and F ; 3. G and B ; 4. G and E 2 · Major Scales and Key Signatures 2.4 · Practice Exercises 2 2 2 2 2 2.4.1. Answer. 1. D E F G A B C 4 4 4 2. A B C D E F G 2 2 4 2.4.2. Answer. 1. A ; 2. A; 3. G; 4. E ; 5. F; 6. D; 7. C ; 2 2 4 2 2 8. E; 9. B ; 10. D ; 11. F ; 12. B; 13. C ; 14. G 3 · Minor Scales and Key Signatures 3.4 · Practice Exercises 2 3.4.1. Answer. 1. e ; 2. b; 3. 4 2 4 8. f ; 9. a ; 10. a ; 11. d; 12. 2 4 c ; 4. g; 5. f; 6. e; 7. b ; 4 4 g ; 13. c; 14. d 3.4.4. Answer. (a) f 2 (b) e (c) E 2 (d) E 4 (e) a 2 (f) C 4 (g) d 421 APPENDIX A. ANSWERS TO PRACTICE EXERCISES 422 4 · Basics of Rhythm 4.7 · Practice Exercises 4.7.1. Answer. (a) Compound Duple (or Compound Quadruple) (b) Simple Quadruple (or Simple Duple) (c) Simple Triple (d) Compound Triple (e) Compound Duple (or Compound Quadruple 4.7.2. Answer. a. Time Signature: 12 16 ; Meter: Compound Quadruple b. Time Signature: 32 ; Meter: Simple Triple c. Time Signature: 38 ; Meter: Simple Triple d. Time Signature: 42 ; Meter: Simple Quadruple 4.7.3. Answer. 1. Dotted quarter note 2. Eighth note 3. Dotted eighth note 4. Half note 4.7.4. Answer. is simple quadruple (a) The meter of 4 2 (b) The meter of 9 16 (c) The meter of 3 4 is compound triple is simple triple 4.7.5. Answer. Example 1. 379 2. 381 3. 383 387 391 Incorrect ã 43 œJ . œ œ ã 68 œ œ œ œ. (œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ) 3 (œœ œœ œœ ã4 œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ) œœ œœ ( œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ) 6 œ˙ ã8 œœ œ J œ (œ œ 43 œ . Correct œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ) œ œ. 3 ( œœ œœ œœ 4 68 ( œœ 5 · Intervals ø7/C Ex. D _____ 1. ____ 5.6 · Practice Exercises ? ˜ & & ˜˜ ˜ 5.6.1. Answer. 1. 6, 2. 4, 3. 2, 4. 8, 5. 7 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ) œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ) (œ œ œ œ 68 œ . ( œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ) œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ) œ 2. ____ ? œ œ 3. ____ E: ii/3rd 1. f: V 2. D:6.IV/5th 3. b¯:viiº 5.6.2. Answer.Ex. 1. m6, 2. M3, 3. M2, 4. P5, 5. m7, +4 1. ____ 2.2 ____ 2 4 3. ____4 2 24. ____ 5.6.3. Answer. Upper notes: 1. D , 2. G , ? 3. A , 4. B , 5. F , 6. F ? & &4 4 4 2 2 5.6.4. Answer. Lower notes: 1. G , 2. A , 3. F, 4. G , 5. F , 6. B 6 · Triads ? 1. g: III 5. ____ 5. e: viiº/3rd 395 11 ø7/C D _____ 3. A¯: ii 2. A: vi & _____ 6. ____ ? 6. d: VII _____ # 7. ____ 7. C˜: IV _____ 4. b: iiº & _____ 8. ____ 8. G: I/5th _____ APPENDIX A. ANSWERS TO PRACTICE EXERCISES 423 6.7 · Practice Exercises 4 2 2 1. A ◦ , 2. Fsus4, 3. B + , 4. D , 5. Esus2 4 4 4 2 2 2 4 4 4 6.7.2. Answer. 1. BDF , 2. EG B , 3. A B E , 4. C E G , 5. DGA, 6. 2 2 FA C 4 . 4 2. 6.7.3. Answer. 1. Dm/F , 2. Gm/D , 3. A ◦ C , 4. F/A , 5. B F , 6. 6.7.1. Answer. Cm/G 6.7.4. Answer. 6.7.5. Answer. 4 2 2 2 (lowest to highest) 1. DGB, 2. DF B, 3. FA D , 4. B EG 4 4 4 2 2 2 2 2 1. F A C , 2. GB D , 3. A C E 7 · Roman Numerals and Cadences 7.5 · Practice Exercises 7.5.1. Answer. . 4 Bm F , ii/5th 4 4 . 4 1. F m , ii ; 2. D ◦ F , ii◦ /3rd ; 3. A , VII ; 4. G , V ; 5. 7.5.2. Answer. 6 6 2 1. C , CE G; 2. G/D , DGB; 3. A◦ , A CE 7.5.3. Answer. a. “Columbia, the Gem of the Ocean”: 1. G , I ; 2. D , V ; 3. G , I ; 4. C , IV ; 5. G , I ; 6. D , V ; Cadence type = Half Cadence (HC) b. “Could You Be Loved”: 1. D , I ; 2. Bm , vi ; 3. G , IV ; 4. D , I ; Cadence type = Plagal Cadence (PC) 8 · Seventh Chords 8.4 · Practice Exercises 8.4.1. Answer. 1. D7 , V7 2. G∆7 , IVM 7 4 3. D ø7, iiø7 4. Bm7 .D , iii7 3rd 4 5. C ◦7 E , vii◦7 3rd 8.4.2. Answer. 1. Bm7, B-D-F4-A 2. Aø 7 , A-C-E2-G 4 3. C ø7 , C4-E-G-B 4. G7 , G-B6-D-F 5. Emaj 7 /G4, G4-B-D4-E 2 2 2 8.4.3. Answer. a. “No Scrubs”: 1. D m7 , iv7 ; 2. A m , i ; 3. E 7 , V7 ; 4. 2 A m, i b. Mozart: 1. C , I ; 2. G7 D , V7 5th ; 3. C , I ; 4. F/C , IV/5th ; 5. C , I ; 6. G7 B , V7 3rd ; 7. C , I ; Cadence type: Authentic Cadence (AC) 9 · Harmonic Progression and Harmonic Function 9.9 · Practice Exercises Day One 9.9.1. Answer. In F major: 1. F-A-C 2. IV = B2-D-F 3. viiº = E-G-B2 APPENDIX A. ANSWERS TO PRACTICE EXERCISES 4. iii = A-C-E 5. vi = D-F-A 6. ii = G-B2-D 7. V = C-E-G 8. F-A-C #### b In B minor: & 1. B-D-F4 2. iv = E-G-B 3. VII = A-C4-E 4.b III = D-F4-A # &5.b bVIb = G-B-D 6. iiº = C4-E-G 7. V = F4-A4-C4 8. B-D-F4 558 563 17 bb ## ### bbbbb bbb b w w 9.9.2. ? # #Answer.ww 1. A3, 2. bA4, 3. wD,ww 4. C?4, 5.# G, ww6. G 568 ## &b b w w # & # 44 473 www _____ FUNCTION: _____ 9.9.4. Answer. 574 479 _____ _____ _____ Correct Cadence: _______ Incorrect 㜠œœ ? b 4 b 4 g: œœ œ_____œ . ≈ ww w œ œ œ œ_____ œ œ œ œ _____œ œ œ_____œ œ ≈ _____ i _____ VI 9.9.5. Answer. HC = V FUNCTION: _____ ã bDC = V-vi_____ PC = IV-I AC = V-I _____ _____ 485 _____ (œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ )(œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ) 576 b & b b 44 www iv iiø7/3rd V7 _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ V vi _____ _____ i _____ Cadence: _______ 9.9.6. Answer. E¯≤: FUNCTION: I _____ 9.9.7. Answer. 491 & b # ww w 9.9.3. Answer. 1. 4 flats in key signature, iv, B2-D2-F ø4 4-A 3. G: V6 2. 3 sharps 1. E: in IV6key signature,2.IV, c: iiD-F 4. d: viio6 5 3 3. 3 flats in key signature, iiº/3rd, F-A2-D _____ _____ _____ 4. 4 sharps_____ in key signature, vi,_____ C4-E-G4 _____ 5. 2 flats inIncorrect signature, viiº7, F4-A-C-E2 Correct ( œ6. œ 5œsharps œ œ œ in œ œkey œ œsignature, œ œ œ œ œ V7/5th, œ )(œ œ C œ 4œ-E-F œ œ4-A œ 4œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ) 7. 1œflat in key signature, i/3rd, F-A-D œ œ œ œ œ œ . ã J8. 1 D:flat in key IJ signature, vi7 ii7/3rd V I R iii iii,J A-C-E 14 572 424 # 4 & # 4 D: FUNCTION: D _____ ww w I ton. _____ In 1. 2. 3. 4. F major: F, I IV vi ii7/3rd Dm, Gm/B _____ 2, ii/3rd _____ C, V F˜m _____ ww w www w Bm7 _____ iii vi7 ton. prol. _____ ton. prol. _____ In 1. 2. 3. 4. E major: C4m, vi A,I/5th IV E,_____ I B, V Cadence: _______ 7/G Em _____ A _____ ii7/3rd pre-dom. _____ dom. _____ www w www V D _____ ww w I ton. _____ AC Cadence: _______ 10 · Non-Chord Tones b &bb 497 b &bb 503 APPENDIX A. ANSWERS TO PRACTICE EXERCISES 425 10.13 · Practice Exercises 10.13.1. Answer. Non-Chord Tone Type RETARDATION ESCAPE TONE PASSING TONE APPOGGIATURA Approached by same tone STEP step leap Left by step up leap in opposite direction step in same direction STEP 2 2 10.13.2. Answer. Lead-sheet: B , Dm, E , F Rom. num.: I, iii, IV, V 10.13.3. Answer. a. “Stop! In the Name of Love” example Lead-sheet symbols: Am, G/B, F, G Roman numerals: vi, V/3rd, IV IVM7, V Measure 2: 7-6 suspension in voice part and in right hand of piano, appoggiatura in left hand of piano Measure 3: 9-8 suspension (or incomplete neighbor) in voice part and right hand of piano Measure 4: 6-5 suspension in voice and right hand of piano b. Robert Schumann example Pickup measure: appoggiatura in right hand of piano; Measure 1: appoggiatura in left hand of piano; 7-6 suspension, appoggiatura in right hand of piano; Roman numeral: iv/3rd Measure 2: appoggiatura in right hand; Roman numeral: V7 Measure 3: anticipation, appoggiatura in voice part; appoggiatura in right hand; Roman numeral: ii/3rd, V7, Lead-sheet symbol: E7 Measure 4: 4-3 suspension; appoggiatura in right hand; Roman numeral: I, Lead-sheet symbol: A 12 · Form in Popular Music 12.6 · Practice Exercises 12.6.1. Answer. She’s Out of My Life: • 0:00–0:40, Introduction, approx. 4 bars of keyboard • 0:40–1:25, A, 12 bars • 1:25–2:05, A, 11 bars • 2:05–2:35, B, 8 bars • 2:35–3:33, A, 13 bars Penny Lane: • 0:00–0:20, Verse 1, 8 bars • 0:20–0:38, Verse 2, 8 bars • 0:38–0:54, Chorus, 8 bars • 0:54–1:11, Verse 3, 8 bars • 1:11–1:28, Trumpet Solo on Verse progression, 8 bars • 1:28–1:45, Chorus, 8 bars • 1:45–2:02, Verse 4, 8 bars • 2:02–2:19, Verse 5, 8 bars APPENDIX A. ANSWERS TO PRACTICE EXERCISES 426 • 2:19–2:36, Chorus, 8 bars • 2:36–3:02, Chorus a whole step higher, 9 bars 13 · Phrases in Combination 13.9 · Practice Exercises 13.9.1. Mozart, “Ein Mädchen oder Weibchen,”The Magic Flute. Answer. Mozart, The Magic Flute, “Ein Mädchen oder Weibchen”: • Chords: I – V , V – I • Cadences: HC, PAC • No Sentences • Melodic labels: a, b • Form: contrasting period 13.9.2. Mozart, Piano Sonata K. 333, I. Answer. Mozart, Piano Sonata K. 333, I: • Chords: vii◦ – I , vi – V , vii◦ – I , V – I • Cadences: IAC, HC, IAC, PAC • The 2nd phrase is a sentence • Melodic labels: a, b, a, b’ • Form: parallel double period 13.9.3. Edmond Dédé, Chicago, Grande Valse à l’Américaine. Answer. Dédé, Chicago: • Chords: V , V , V , V , V – I • Cadences: HC, HC, HC, PAC • The 1st and 3rd phrases are sentences • Melodic labels: a, a, a, a’ • Form: parallel double period 16 · Figured Bass 16.6 · Practice Exercises 16.6.1. Answer. • Lead-sheet: 1. C/G ; 2. B◦ /D ; 3. Dm/A ; 4. G • Figured bass: 1. I64 ; 2. vii◦6 ; 3. ii64 ; 4. V 16.6.2. Answer. • Lead-sheet: 1. Em7/G ; 2. G7/F ; 3. Cmaj7/G ; 4. Fmaj7 • Figured bass: 1. iii65 ; 2. V42 ; 3. IM43 ; 4. IVM7 #### &b 558 ## bb bbb APPENDIX A. ANSWERS TO PRACTICE EXERCISES # bb b 1. &•b Lead-sheet: 563 16.6.3. Answer. ◦ # ## ◦7 D /F ; 2. A 427 bbbbb b . 4 G ; 3. Eø 7 ; 4. Dmaj7 F • Figured bass: 1. ii◦6 ; 2. vii◦42 ; 3. viiø7 ; 4. IM65 ? #### 568 ww w & b 1. E: IV6 ? 16.6.5. Answer. 572 7/B F/A G Lead-sheet: ____ ____ 64 882 572 b & 44 œœ C & ww w ? b C:œ I ? 44 C: I œ 591 884 66 910 583 7/F Dm ____ C ____ œ www œ(œ ) www œ C/E œ œ I6 I/3rd C ____ 6 V 5 ____ FUNCTION: I ton. C: ____ E¯: ____ C 1 C ____C œœ ˙œww ww vi7 œvi7 œ Am7 C/G 9-8 susp. I6 4 I/5th b www w E¯7 ____ ii56 ____ I ____ vi V7/____ ____ 2 7 C ____ ton. vi prol. ii ____ V7/____ www w & b # www 3. G: V56 4. d: viio6 G ____ C ____ wwœw w Am7/E vi65 œ œ vi43 vi7/3rd ) vi( 7/5th 7/D E____ V ____ 887 587 914 Am7/G œ ## 29 w wwwww www w Am7/C vi42 w w vi7/7th F____ ˜/A˜ I ____ ____ ww #____ w œœ œ˙˙ ˙____ G w œœ˙ wwwœ (œ ) œ V œ G 4. A: V6/ii pre-dom. dom. ii V V ____ V7/____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ A7 D7 G 3 4 7 5 6 7 87 9 F E Am D G ____D7 ____ ____ ____ ____ F C & 44 ˙˙ ˙˙‰˙ j b ˙˙ # ˙˙˙ ‰˙˙ j 4 ‰ ? 4 &? 4 44 ˙˙ œ ˙ .. ˙˙ ˙ œœ ˙ # œœ 4 ˙ œœ ˙˙ . ˙ > 912 892 2. c: iiø43 ?# ww # wwww ? b # b n w b b ____ ____ Dominant 17 · bSecondary Lead-sheet: ____ ____ ____Chords ____ ____ ____ 7 7 b 7/VI C Am Dm3. 4 1. E¯: V/ii 2. g: V e: V42/iv 17.7 Exercises b 44Practice œ &b· œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ˙ ˙œ (œ ) œ & 4 Answer. 17.7.1. ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙˙Dm ____ 7 7 C˙ E Am A D7 ˙ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ˙ ? 4˙ œ#œ˙˙˙ ( œ) œœ˙˙˙˙. œ # ˙˙˙œj œœ ˙˙˙œ œ # ˙˙˙˙œ ??b b 44444˙˙˙˙œœ ( ˙) œ ˙œ ˙œ7 œ b C: I vi7 ii˙ IV6 C: ____ 579 wwww bb 16.6.4. Answer. ____ 10 ˙˙ ˙˙ n # ˙˙˙ ˙˙ ˙ ˙ # ˙˙ ‰ j # ˙˙ ˙ www‰ j ˙ ˙˙˙˙ ... ˙ ˙ n œœœ ˙˙˙ ... w œœ ˙˙ ˙ œ ˙ . I IV IV > V7/____ vi vi> V7/____ V V> C: ____ V7/____ ____ ____ ____ 7 7 I V /ii /V V ?FUNCTION: 44 C:j ton. j œ prol. ‰ Vpre-dom. ‰ ‰ jœ œ ˙ ton. dom. j œ œ œ œ ˙ œ œ œ ˙ œ 17.7.2. Answer. œ ˙ œ œ œ ˙7 7/B¯ œ. œ.B____ œ ˙ œ D . . œ E¯ A/E G ˜7/F ˜ œ. A¯ >7/D˜ ____ œ Lead-sheet: ____ ____ ____ ˙ œ . œb ____ ˙ . > # . ## # # > b > b w # b # # ww bI b b ww ww IV & C: Iw ww b # www bVb7/V ww w w # w w ? # # # w b w b b . . # w > # # # # . w. b b b w b 4 œj ‰ œœ. ≈ œœ bœ œœ œœœ œ. œœ œ œ œ >œœ b œ ‰ b œ œ7/VI & 4b: œ_____ œ V43/VI œ œ f: V_____ œ64/V œ œE:œ_____ V/vi V V24/vi .V56/iv F: _____ c: _____ G: _____ J 591 π 1 œ. 2 3 4 5 . œ. œ. > œ. œ. n >œ œ 6 œ ? b b œœ. n œ b œ œ J œ ≈ œ œ œ œ b œœ œœ œ ?17.7.3. bb 44b Answer. J ‰ ‰ 993 999 995 572 999 579 ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ 428 œ œ œ œ (œœ) ˙ ww ? #b 4 œœ œœ œ œ ˙ & b #b c4 œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ ( œœ) œ nœœ œ œ# (.œ )# œJœ œ # œ œ u œœœ # n œœœœ œœœœ œœœœ œœœœ n œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ____œœœ œœœ____œœœ œœœ œœœ ____ ? b e:4____ ____ ____ ____ ____ bb 4 i iv V56œ/V œ œ ˙ V b œ . # œ _____ Rom. num.: _____ _____ œ œ œ œ & b b œ _____ œ œ œ ˙ Œ 29 œ œ œ J œ C C/E C/G Am7 Am7/C Am7/E Am7/G w w # ww ww www ? #bw && www wwww www b wwb w w w C: I I6 I64 vi7 vi65 vi43 vi42 ? ## Cm C: I Cm I/3rd b 17.7.4. c & b b Answer. œCœ œ œ œ ____ ?? b b c n œœœwww œœœ œœœ b bb b i 17.7.5. Answer. ?&44b vi7 I/5th Fm D7vi /F7˜/3rd G vi7/5thG œ œ œ œ œ 7œ œ . # œJ œ 7œ œ ˙ œ E¯ E____ /D ____ bw œœœ b œœœ wwwœœœ œœœ œœœ # # n œœœœ# wœwwwœœœ œœœœ œœœœ # #n#œœœ b V3.56/V e: V42/iv _____ 2. _____ g:ivV7/VI . .˙ ˙ c˙˙˙ ‰ œJ œ œ œ# ˙˙˙œ œ œ œ E7 ____ C ____ F D7/F˜ Fm 1. E¯:_____ V/ii Rom. num.: 583 71 ? b b# b U # œ c œ œ ( ) œ œ œ œ APPENDIX A. ANSWERS TO PRACTICE EXERCISES ( ) & œ #œ œ œ œ( ) n œ n(œ ) ww ____ Am A7 ____ Dm ____ Dm7 ____ G /B vi7/7th ˙F____ ˜/A˜ œœœ œœœ œœœ w # ww V 4. A: V6/ii _____ D7 ____ œ . œ œ . œ˙˙ œ œ ˙˙œ . j ˙ # ˙˙n œ ˙˙ œ œ#œ˙˙˙œ ‰ ˙˙˙œJ ˙ G ____ C F E7 ____ ____ vi _____ G ____ V _____ ‰ œJwwwœ . œ œ . œ œ œ œ w ? c ‰ œœœ œœœ œœœ ‰ œœœ œœœ œœœ ‰ œœœ œœœ œœœ ‰ œœœ œœœ œœœ ‰ œœœ œœœ œœœ ‰œœœ œœœ œœœ ‰ œœœ œœœ œœœ ‰ œœœ œœœ œœœ b nœœœ œœ œ J J I mot.1 vi vi mot. ii mot. 2____ aug. C: ____ V7/____ V72/____ ? 44 587 C C7 ____ ____ I F: _____ ˙˙ ˙˙ b ˙˙˙ ˙ # ˙˙˙˙ ˙˙ ˙ ˙ ii mot. 1V7mot. V 2 ____ /____ Am ____ V7/V _____ ˙˙ ˙˙ D7 ____ # ˙˙˙˙ # #C: ____ V /____ ____ V /____ ____ V /____ & c ww w M3 m3 # www m3 # # Secondary 18?· Diminished Chords c # ww 975 70 I 7 IV IV 7 vi vi 7 V 18.5 · Practice Exercises ? D: _____ 977 18.5.1. Answer. ˜o7 Lead-sheet: A ____ # w &591 # ww ? bb ? # # #b w o7 /vi D: vii _____ 1 _____ 983 & b b ww C____ ˜o/E ø7/F G ____ o7/B¯ E ____ b b n # www b b b b ww w bb n w b b b w o6 ø4 vii /V E¯: _____ vii 2 /IV g: _____ 2 3 # _____ # ww bb b b b b b n ww n ww bb b b b _____ # ww o4 vii 3/iii D¯: _____ 4 1Vinv. ____ 2. inv ww ww V ____ ‹o7/E F____ # # # # ‹ ww b b b # w b n ww # # # # w b b b b ww b o7/C A____ vii 2 /V A¯: _____ vii 5 /ii c ˜: _____ 5 6 o4 ### w nw _____ o6 b b b b n ww _____ 591 ˙ ww ˙ ˙ 4 ˙ ˙ ˙ IV vi V V V7/____ ____ wwvi V7/____ b bI www A. ANSWERS bIVwww ____ wwV7/____ bEXERCISES b ww ____ & C: ____ w APPENDIX TO bPRACTICE w w ww C: Answer. ¯VI iv 18.5.2. ˆ o7 ¯6 as: Root ____ E 3rd 599 iio 5thF____ ˜o7/A www # ww n w w bb b ww b b wwn ww bw ? b b bw b b b ww & # 1. A¯: viio7/vi C: ¯III i 595 18.5.3. ¯3 as: Answer. Root 3rd iiø7 viio7 5th F____ ˜ø7/C7th wwww b www b www # ### b ww b ww 429 ¯VII7 7th B____ ˜o7/A w # n # www b ww b w 4. B: viio4/ii 2. c: viio65/V 3. e: viiø43/III ¯VI ¯VII v ¯III 5th ¯7 as: Root . 3rd 5th 2 4 ◦7 4 • Lead–sheet: 1. F ; 2. Am ; 3. B ; 4. F ; 5. D F ; 6. Gm 605 611 ? bb b b •# Figured bass: 1. I ; 2. iii ;b w ww3. IV ; 4. w & b www Mixturew 600 · Mode 19 ? b b b· Practice A is root when ? 19.6 Exercises b G: ____ stacked in 3rds; 19.6.1. Answer. C____ ˜o7/B¯ 616 634 622 640 b & bb b b www ? bb ## ### w b w # w b b b ww b w56/iv b: V A: ¯III ____ ____ E: ____ F: ____ 1 A: iv f:2V34/V ____ ____ ____ ____ 19.6.3. Answer. ### # w & # ww ____ f˜: ____ 1 & ____ 1. E¯: N6 ? 658 e: ____ 2 bbbb b w ww ____ B¯: ____ 3 # ____ ____ 2. b: N c˜: ____ 4 w b bw n # www b b ww ____ 3. D: ¯III ____ B¯: ____ 4 ____ 4. c: viio7/V ____ 3. G: ¯VII7 3 + 3 + 3 + 3 + 3 + 123 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 123 1 D/F˜ ____ b b b # n www 6/V c: V ____ 6 ww w b D¯ w # www b b ____ b w n # www b b b www A: ____ B¯: ____ ____ G ˜o7/F ____ e: viio425/iv ____ ____ ____ B¯: ¯III6 ____ ____ # b bbb b b w w # # # # n w b b ww # # n www ww g: viio7/V A¯: iiø4 G: iio6 ____ e: ____ 3 iv6 B¯: ____ 5 G wø7/B¯ # # b ww____ # b wwww # ____ D: ____ E¯: ____ 3 4 iiø65 D: ¯VI F: ____ ____ ____ ____ f: ____ 2 2. a: N ____ 1. c˜: N6 664 iiø43 B: ____ 4 7/D G B¯ ____ # # b wwww____ w b b w bb b b b ww n w # # b n www b bb n www c: ____ 1 652 viio42/iii G: ____ 3 31 (bass note is 3rd of chord) E¯m/G¯ ____ ____ ? # # # # n ww # # ww & # n www ____ 19.6.2. Answer. Dm ____ E¯: ¯VII7 646 (m3-m3-M3) C˜ø7/G b wwww iiø65 G: ____ # ww # # # # www b b ww # ww # nw bw ¯III A¯: ____ 2 viio42 D: ____ A: ¯VI 1 m3 m3 quality is ø7 A is 2ˆ C¯ A____ ˜o7/G ____ ? # # # b wwww n w b b b b b www & n ww b 615628 b www w 6 vii◦7 ii ; 5. VM3 ii ; 6. ii 2 ____ 4. d: viio65/V 3 + 3 23 3 d: ____ 5 b: ____ 6 # # b www w b b ww w ____ D: ____ 5 ____ d: ____ 6 ____ ____ 5. B¯: iiø4 6. G: N6 ____ ____ 2 5. F: N46 6. f˜: N6 + 3 +2+2 +2+ 2 > 1 2 3 1 2 3 12 1 2 1 2 1 2 APPENDIX A. ANSWERS TO PRACTICE EXERCISES 430 32 74 o7 E¯ D E¯ E¯(maj7)/D __________ 7 /E¯ ped A7__________ o7/C˜ F/A G¯__________ (¯5) G____ ˜o/B__________ A˜____ ____ ____ ____ œ. # ww ?&b b b b w12 8w œJ # n www œ œ œ œ. bb n ww # # # #( )‹ www( w ) b n # www œ # # # wwwwœ J bw nt pt espress. dolce œœ ____ œœ o6/V œb: ____ Ger+6 e: ____ N6 œ B¯: It+6 Fr+6 œ d: ____ vii viiœ g: ____ œœo65 œœ b œc˜œœ: ____ œ œ ped pt œ 5 œ 6 ? b b 12 1 2 œ 3(œ. ) 4 b 8____‰ œ. ____ .œ ____ ____ ____ ____ . œ * # w ? # # b # wwww b b b°∫ b www #* b °www # # # # n°# www b b *# n www b b w*w b # n w b w° b ww E¯7 ____ 666 672 I viio7/I ped I IM42 E¯: __________ __________ __________ __________ D: ____ A¯: ____ G: ____ B: ____ B¯: ____ c: ____ 1C7 2___________ 3 5 6 C7 Eo7/F ped4 Fm __________ ____________ ___________ 628 684 634 689 640 694 b œ b œ .____ T ____ ____ ____ ____ œ. œ C¯ A˜œo7____ n /G C˜ø7œ/G E¯m/G¯ D/F˜ b # # # # b J o4 o4 ø4 6 6 b b # w b b b b J n ww vii 2/iiib wwww b ii 3b ww iv# www Vb /V# n www &&vii# 2 # wwww ¯III w b ____ w w____ ____ ____ ____ œ ____ œ œ œœ # #g: ____ b œ œœœbb: ____ www n œœb b f:œœb____ b www # G:œœ #____ œ F: œ____ ??# # f˜:b w____ w # ped pt w w # b bb b 7 b 8 œ. # w9w # 10n wwœw b b11www œb b b #œn www12 œ (œ ) œ. ____ G: ____ *____ B: ____ ____ ____ D: ____ A¯: ____ B¯: ____ c: ____ ° * *6 1 2 3 5 ° ° 4 * ° & ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ __________ V7/ii ___________ V7/ii b w ____________ viio7/ii ___________ ii ww 5. d:b Gerb www+6 +6 w wwG: EnGer # o65/V 2.ww F: It+6# 3. ? # #1.# #c˜:nFrww+6 ww 4. a:#vii b b w b # w b # # w b w b ww Neapolitan b w 20 · The Chord Lead-sheet: ____ ____ D: ____ ____ ____ ww B¯:____ ____ ____ ____ E:w F: ____ E¯: ____ A: ____ ____ & 44· 20.3 Practice Exercises ____ ww____ w 1 2 3 4 5 6 ? 20.3.1. Answer. C˜o7/B¯ 678 Rom. num.: ____ D¯/F ____ Function: 1. Tonic E¯: It+6 L.S.: ____ ____ ?4 ? b b4 b ? bwww w c: ____ & www 1 6 6. f: N 646 699 652 N6 ## & # # # www ? b b b ww bb w o/E¯ ____ ____ A¯/E¯ ____ C D/F˜ Ao/C C ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ +6 +6 4 Mode mixture Tonic __________ 2. a: Ger 3. D: EnGer 4. c: V3/V 5. B¯: Fr+6 ________ (with ¯6) ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ # b ww bw w bb b ww # # # # n ww ww ww w b b ww # # n ww N64 iio6 N6 viio6/VI b: ____ N G: ____ B¯: ____ ww www c˜: ____ d: ____ w 2 3 4 5 6 7. A¯: viiø7/V 8. b: Fr+6 9. F: ¯III46 10. c˜: viio42/iv ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ww b b w b b b b b w # n # wwww b b b b www # # C____ b w/B¯ ø7 A¯/C w ____ ww ww w ____ b w b w ww # # n w # b w b w____ d:b ____ ww bw n ww b b # n www b D:ww__________ 5 6 ____ 20.3.2. Answer. ? B¯ F F˜o7 ____ ____ ____ w F¯/A¯ w ____ R.N.: ____ ____ ____ f ˜ : ____ f: ____ e: ____ B¯: ____ Func.:__________ Secondary of V __________ 1 2 3 4 6 o7 1. E¯:____ N 2. a:____ N 3. D:____ ¯III 4. c: vii ____/V & · Augmented Sixth Chords 21 21.91. E¯: ·NPractice Exercises 6 2. a: N 3. D: ¯III 4. c: viio7/V 5. B¯: iiø42 ____ 6. G: N6 ____ 5. B¯: iiø4 6. G: N6 ____ ____ 2 21.9.1. Answer. 658 ? ____ 1. c˜: N6 ____ 2. b: N ____ 3. G: ¯VII7 3 + 3 + 3 + 3 + 3 + ____ 4. d: viio65/V 3 + 3 5. F: N46 6. f˜: N6 + 3 +2+2 +2+ 2 31 A 32 APPENDIX A. ANSWERS TO PRACTICE EXERCISES one degree one degree D 775 # www ? bb & w ## E¯7 ____ 666 b Ger+6 g: ____ 1 34 # n ww w N6 It+6 e: ____ B¯: ____ 2 (relative keys3with 1 G 1. c˜: Fr+6 f˜ o7 # # # wwww c˜ Fr+6 viio6/V viio65 c˜: ____ d: ____ b: ____ 5 6 same4key signature) D 5 Em 6F˜o 2 3 major: G Am Bm 4 C 2. F: It+6 3. G: EnGer+6 4. a: viio65/V 739 # # # w # # # ww 22 · b #b Modulation # www b b b b n ww b w w b w & w b D major: D b wEm Fww˜m G wA & · wPractice w Exercises 22.8 678 #### 785 &# # # & # E¯7 684 G____ ˜o/B # # # # ‹ www b n # www w b b b n www # #/C˜ #A#˜____ "sharper" 7(¯5) A ____ b # www # E¯# 7 7 D¯7# ˜o7b/F˜ n w ____ ? # # b # wwww b b b ∫ b www____ w ____ # # # n n # wwwwD____ # b www bB¯b b wwww b b # www # # # # ‹ www # #w # w w b n w b w w # w w & D: ____ A¯: ____ b ww G: ____ b ww B: ____# w B¯: ____ c: ____ 734 36 G¯7 ____ 431 21.9.2. Answer. A7(¯5) ____ 672 36 ### "flatter" F/A ____ E 22.8.1. Answer. f˜: ____ f: ____ (a) d: F, g, A, B2, C 7 8 2 2 2 2 7 7 (b) , b2 G¯ D : e , f, GA, A (¯5) 785 F/A & G: ____ 9 G˜o/B g: ____ 10 b: ____ 11 A˜o7/C˜ 5. d: Ger+6 b # n www o Bmb wC˜ F: ____ 12 (c) f: A2, b2, c, D2, E2 22.8.2. Answer. F ____ C7/B¯ ____ F/A ____ Dm C/E C/G ____ G7 ____ C Lead-sheet symbols: ____ ____ Dm/F ____ ____ o 7/B¯ F/A 7 R. N.: I ii iii IV V vi vii F C Dm C/E Dm/F C/G G C +6 Lead-sheet symbols: 2.____ ____ +6____4. a: ____ ____ 1. c˜: Fr+6 F: It+6____ 3.____ G: EnGer viio65____ /V ____ 5. F: Ger Roman numerals: F: I V42 I6 vi I V42 Am I6 viBm G major: G C I6 D ii6 EmI6 FV˜7o C : ii ___ Roman numerals: F: ? 689 ? 694 C : ii ___ I6 ii6 I46 V7 4 I GmGG/B Cm Cm/E¯ F7 B¯ D major:____ CEø7˜o B¯/F D Em F ˜m ____A ____ Bm ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ +6 +6 +6 4 +6 1. E¯: It 2. a: Ger 3. D: EnGer 4. c: V /V 5. B¯: Fr R. N.:g: i IVV6/ivV iv viiv6 vii3o I ii iii Roman numerals: Lead-sheet symbols: B¯ : ___ ii6 viiø7/V I46 V7 I E¯ 6. f: N 7. A¯: vii /V 8. b: Fr 9. F: ¯III 10. c˜: vii /iv 22.8.3. Answer. B B¯A F F˜ A¯/C aC____/B¯ ____ C f˜F¯/A¯ ____ ____ ____ ____ #### F ˜ # & # # #? b b w bw b w & c˜ b b b ww b www # # n n www b b b # n wwww b b www # b ww D¯ b N 2. a:DN 3. D: ¯III 4. c: vii /V 5.dB¯: ii 6. G:FN 1. E¯: 6 ø7 +6 6 4 o7 787 o4 2 ø7 787 699 789 #### 789 & #### & #### & 809 809 778 & & #### #&####### 817 817 ## 6 e to parallel minor G o7 ø4 2 g 6 B¯ I 36 785 & #### ? b 4 œ˙ . b 4 ˙˙ .. œ œ œ œ. b œœ œœ n œœ œ ˙ ˙ n ˙˙ œ. b œœ APPENDIX A. ANSWERS TO PRACTICE EXERCISES A ____ Lead-sheet symbols: 22.8.4. Answer. A ____ Roman numerals: Lead-sheet symbols: Roman numerals: C ____ ____ ____ I V42 A: I F: ¯III ____ I I6 7/G Dm/F B¯7 Dm/A A A7 ____ B¯ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ A ____ 7/G Dm/F B¯7 Dm/A A A7 ____ B¯ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ 4 A ____ A: IC7/B¯ ¯III F F/A Lead-sheet symbols: Roman numerals: C ____ 432 I V /IV Dm C/E C/G ____ ____ 2 Dm/F ____ ____ V24/IV 4 6 G7 ____ C ____ d :V i Ger+6 i64 vi ___ 2 4 6 +6 d ___ : V2 i Ger i64 7 V7 VI 6 6 6 C : ___ ii I ii I4 V o7 V7 I o7 Gm Gm/B¯ A¯/C D A¯/E¯ E Fm Lead-sheet symbols:Gm____ ____ B¯m/D¯ ____ B¯m/D¯ ____ ____ ____ o7 Fm ____ Do7 A¯/E¯ E____ ____ Gm/B¯ ____ A¯/C ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ Gm G/B Cm Cm/E¯ Eø7 B¯/F F7 B¯ Lead-sheet symbols: ____ ____ ____6 ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ 6 6 6 Roman numerals: g: i i N Roman numerals: g: i i N Roman numerals: g: i V6/iv A¯ iv 6 iv6 66 A¯ : Iii viio7 ___ : I___ viio7/vi ii6/V viiI64o7/V I64 viviio7/vi vi 7 B¯ : ii6 viiø7/V I6 ___ V I 4 Lead-sheet symbols: 22.8.5. Answer. 787 ___ iio ___III d: ___ ___ ___ ˙ ˙ w o˙ ˙ # ˙ ww in Dm: E ( ˙ ) ___ ( ˙) ( ˙ ___ ?Lead-sheet ˙) )Dm (w) ___ (F &b b 44 ˙ symbols ( ˙) ( ) Dm Eo ___ F Lead-sheet symbols in F: ___ ___ LSS: ___ ___ ___ Roman numerals: 822 RN: G: ___ ___ vi ___ ___ ___ vi ___ iv ___ V___ ___ VI ___viio ___ ˙˙ ˙ ___˙ ˙___ w ___ ( Gm ) ˙ A B¯ C˜o ( ) ___ ___ ( ˙ ) ( ˙___ ) ( w)___ Gm ___ Am ___ B¯ C ___ ___ Roman numerals: F: o vi ___ viiD:___ I___ ___ ii ___ ___ iii___ ___ IV___ ___ V ___ ___ ___ ___ HF: PD /V Dom Ton Dom ____ 22.8.6. Answer. 795 ___ ___i ___ Em D___ ˜ /F˜ ___ Em/G ___ # 4 ˙ ˙ & 4 LSS: RN: o w i ___ viio6 ___ i6 e: ___ F/A ˜o7 ___ B ___ A___ n˙ ˙ #w o7 V N6 vii ___ /V ___ ____ Dom Ton PD Cad64 Dom Ton 7(¯5) Bm/F˜ F˜ Bm Em ˜7 Bm/D ___ F___ ___ G___ ___ ___ ___ ˙ #˙ ˙ #˙ ˙ #˙ w i iv ___ V7 ___ i6 Fr+6 ___ i64 ___ V ___ i b:___ HF: 803 Ton Dom Ton PD ___ PD __/ V Dom 22.8.7. Answer. 2m ˜m A2m,EmDm,GD ˜m (a) Fm:GAm, Em PD Dom Ton ___ PD Cad6 Dom Ton ____ 4 G ˜m (b) D2:# ˙F2, F, B œ 2, œB3 (or# ˙A, enharmonically) œ œ #˙ ?(c)42G:# B˙˙2, B, E,œœ En œœœ2 # ˙˙ p 4 4 4 œœ n œœœ # ˙˙ (d) G m: Bm, B m, Em, E m 23 · Enharmonic Modulation 23.4 · Practice Exercises 23.4.1. Answer. Em œ. n œœœ ... j # œœ # œœ J B (no 3rd) # ˙˙ # ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ VI APPENDIX A. ANSWERS TO PRACTICE EXERCISES 42 ˙ b˙ & # ˙˙˙& b 888 433 ˙# ww˙˙˙ ww # ˙ ˙ b ˙˙˙# w ww b ˙ ˙ b w ˙˙ wwb ˙˙ b˙ w w˙ ∫ ˙ w˙˙ b b ∫b˙w b ˙ b b ˙˙˙˙ w a: viio7 V65 c: viio42 +6 V _____ enharmonicallyg: Ger resolve enharmonically respelled respelled bb ˙˙ b ˙ ˙ & b b ˙& 892 respell A¯ V7 V4 __ : ____ e¯: viio43 826 # & E¯: Roman numerals: 104 C¯ ____ A¯ ____ F ____ I ¯VI IV V /V b & bb cb bœ 830 & œœ 897 832 Gm ____ ? bb c & œ œ b b#bœœb œ œœ œ b Vb & b b____ 4 2 b ? # # # # c&œ #b b œ # & 844 & 846 _____ œ # œœ & 4 o7 œœ œ œœ œ __ : ____ œ b www w œ n œœ # n œœœœ n #b œœœœ œ E¯7 ____ ____ vi ____ resolveœœ ____ V7 ____ ‹ # œœœ _____ #œ #œ œ b œœ œ _____ resolve œ /iv ____ resolve www œ n # # www____ œ ____ n œœ ____ bbb ## œ ____ # n nwwwœw ____ o4 a : ____ vii __ 2 respell n www w c : ____ viio43 __ œ ____ resolve resolve n n wwwœ i____ (or I) _____ www i (or I) _____ b: viio7 resolve _____ V œœ # n œœœ œ A¯ ____ ˙˙ ˙ b˙ ____ I ____ ˙˙ ˙ ˙ ____ ____ n˙ ˙ _____ i (or I) ˙ n œœ [or œ G¯] __ œ5 fœ ˜ : ____ vii __ : ____ resolve _____ respell resolve b b bœ iv _____ b œœ œ respell____ n____ b b____ b & # # wwww # c # œœ # œœ œœ o6 & œ b: ____ 6 Fm ____ f:œ V7/VIœ ____ œœ ? ## c œ & 842 o7 E¯: viio7 _____ I ____ +6____ ____ ____ D: Ger respell resolve _____ E: ____ ## E¯7 ____ i6 Ger+6 ____ ____ A ¯: V 7 ____ ____ ____ ____ 836 +6 resolve respell # # # # c œœ # œœ œ œ 838 & 834 23.4.4. Answer. 840 n œœœ n œœœ œ 7/C D____ Gm/B ____ ¯ i g: ____ & 7 7 __ : ____ 23.4.3. Answer. V43 Am/E E /D C ˜ ____ Dm ____ E ____ ____ ____ a Ger ___: i V2 vii G: V7/IV resolve 4 _____ & 828 7 E¯ ____ œ bœ b#b œœrespell b œœ b & 896 I o6 G¯:_____ vii 5 V7 2resolve 23.4.2. Answer. Lead-sheet symbols: ˙˙ ˙˙ enharmonically respelled n˙ ____ 39 150 LSS: Motives: ____ œ ____ ____ ____ œœ œœ œœœ ____ œ œ œ ____ b œ ANSWERS œ ˙ APPENDIX TO J PRACTICE J J œ J EXERCISES & b c A. J J œ œ ˙ 434 œ œo7 œ œ œ7 œ .œ . œ œ œ. œ œ œ 105 œDmœ œGo7œ/Dœ¯ Eœ¯7œ/Dœ¯ Aœ¯m/C œ ? b b c œ___ œ1621œC___ œ˜o7œ ___ œ /B¯ œE¯ /B¯ œA¯m œ Dm ___ ___ ___ ¯ G___ œ œ œ˙ ___b œ # œ___ œ 123 NCTs: Answer. 23.4.5. 150 œ œ ˙ œ 3 & b 4 œœ& ‰œœ œ œœœ œ b œœœ œ b œœ bœœœ b b ˙˙˙ b œœœ n b œb ˙˙ ... œœ Œ b œ b ˙ œ œ ____ ____ RN in B¯: ____ ____ œ œ ____œ ____ p HF: ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ . ____ . LSS: ____ ____œ. ____ ____ œ. ____ .œ .œ œ œ . Motives: ? b 43 œ?# œ œ œœ b œœ œ œ b œ œ œ˙ œ œ b œ n œ œ Œ œ œ____ œ.œ œ œ ____ b ˙ œ. œ˙ œ ˙ ____œ œ____ LSS: b b c ____ œ œ ____ œœ. œ œ ____ J J J J & J J ___ ___ ___ ___ ___ œo7o4œ ___ œvii œ œ b 42œ œ i6œ œ œviiœ o6œ5 œœ œV4œ3 œ œi œ œ œ œ œ a ¯ : vii V œ œ b 3 œ œ œ œœœ œ Menuetto ? œ____ œJ œ J____ œœ œ œ ____ œ˙ œ œ ˙ œ & bbb cJ# œdiagram: œ œ ____ Jœ œ œA____ ____ ____ # # c œ and 24 · Binary œœœ œ œœ œForms NCTs: & œœ Ternary n œœ œ œ œn b œœœœ œ œ n ˙˙˙ n œ œ b œ a b œ œ œ œ n œ____ œ œ Exercises œœ œ /? : bB¯:œPractice œ œ ____ œ ____œ œœ____:/: ____ 24.9 RN inb· ____ œ œ œ œ ˙ :/ Trio diagram: HF: ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ 24.9.1. Answer. . ____ . . # ? #____ B œ b œ 1621 A b œ c œ œ œ œ œ # œ n ˙ RN: ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ # œ LSS: ____ œ ____ ____ œ____ ˙˙ œ____ œ œ ____ œ b œ____ ‰ œa' ____ HF: ____ ____ ____ LSS: ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ œ œd Œ :/ Œ a c____ n œ____ Motives: & œ / : : / : œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ A: ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ Motives: œ œ œ œ b œ œ D: PAC ˙ G: HC œ œp ˙PAC œ8 Jœ œ Jb œJ œ e:m.JPAC & b b c œG:œJm.HC œ J œ œ 4 m. 12 m.. 16 ____ b œJ œJ____ ____ œb œœœ n œœ. ˙ œ. m.˙20 œœ. œœ.____ ____ œœœ. œJ____ œœ. œ œJ ____ œ &NCTs: b b b c? œœ œn œœ œ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ œ n œœ œ œ œ œ œœ œŒ œ œ Œ b ? œ œ˙˙ TERNARY œ & b œœ .#œœ ROUNDED œœœ. œ œœœ CONTINUOUS NCTs: TWO-REPRISE œ#œ œœ œBINARY b c bœ œ SECTIONAL œ n n œœœ BALANCED ? b b œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ bœœ œ œ œ œœ œ ˙œ œ œ œ ˙ Motives: NCTs: 150 .. Œ .. o7 ___ i vii i d: ___ ___ ? bb b c œ bb œ nœ œB ˙ & ____ . œn____ ____ . . œ œ œ œ œ bb œ . œ œ œ œ . œœ ____ œœb. bœ˙œ____œb œ # œ____a' œ œ:/ œ b œ œ ____ ____ ˙____ œ œ Œ Œ & œ ____ ____ HC n œ ____ œ PAC &‰ œ œ œ œ œ m. 12 m. 18 œ œ œ œ p f œ œ b œœœ œ œ. œœ. Bœ œ . . œ A œœ ?&TWO-REPRISE b bb aœJ œœ œJ œœ a'œœ. œœœœ. œœ Jœœ œ Jc œ œb œœœ n œœ ˙ dœ.œ ˙ n œ b ROUNDED ? SECTIONAL CONTINUOUS BALANCED BINARY TERNARY b /: :/: œ Œ :/ Œ b œ œ œ . . NCTs: œ œ 24.9.2. RN in B¯: Answer. ____ ____ 120 Œ œ œ ____ ____ A HF: ____ ____ ____ ____ 1590 RN: ____ ____ ____ ____ HF: ____ ____ ____ a 1621 ____ a' :/: /: b¯: ____ ____ ____ ____ LSS: ____ A: HC ____ ____ PAC ____ Motives: m. 4 m. 8 ? bb œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ____ ____ ____ ____ œ œ œ œ œœœœ œ œ œ œ œ bœ œ œ œ œ ˙ 123 .. .. 123 œœœœ . œ . .. B œ œ œ œ œ œ Uœ ____ ____ ____ ____ œ œ bb œ . œ œ œ ____ œ œ . ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ b œ œ . a' a' :/: e: PAC b D: PAC œ G: HC PAC :/ & b m. 8 m. 12 m. 16 m. 20 PAC HC PAC rit. m. 8 m. 12 m. poco 18 œ œ p A œ œ œ U œB œ ? b a œœ œ a' œœ œb œ c d :/ /: b b :/: 24.9.3. diagram: Answer. Menuetto A ____ ____ /: G: HC m.A: 4 HC m. 4 1594 RN: ____ Trio diagram: HF: ____ a TWO-REPRISE SECTIONAL CONTINUOUS A ROUNDED BALANCED B / A a : diagram: Trio B¯: :/: b B c c' IAC G: HC F: PAC D: PAC c: IAC m. 4 TERNARY A 24.9.4. Answer. Menuetto diagram: BINARY m. 8 B¯: e: PAC m. 12 a IAC d :/ G: HCIAC m. 16 PAC PAC m. 20 HC PAC Two-Reprise Continuous Ternary, if looking at the proportion, or TwoReprise Continuous Rounded Binary, if you interpret the first two notes E¯: HC PAC HC A: PAC PAC D: DC HC PAC A: PAC PAC 435 œ U œ œ œ œ b œ œ œ œ œ œ œ 123 . œ b œ œ œ . . in bbar 13 as being built from the first two notes in bar .1—and if you are œ œ b . . to compose &considering that Mozart, as a Classical-era composer, œ œ˙ isb œlikely œ œ that # œ œ œ œBalanced a rounded binary. Two-Reprise Continuous Binary is a label ˙ œ œ œœ poco ‰ n œ Œ rit. Œ .. œ œ œ œ p &the endings describes that of the halves are the same, but doesn’t take into œ œ œ U œœ material œ in œbar 21. œ ?account bb b œœthe returnœœ œof the opening œ p .œ œ. .œ œ. .œ œ. bœ nœ . APPENDIX A. ANSWERS TO PRACTICE EXERCISES 1594 1621 ? A œ œ 24.9.5. Answer. A . a a' b: IAC A PAC œ /: a /: Sectional Ternary œ. a a' B¯: IAC A: PAC PAC :/: :/: F: PAC a IAC b PAC Œ :/ :/ a' B HC HC c IAC PAC a' HC PAC PAC A: PAC PAC (final phrase could be :/ analyzed as two phrases) B¯: IAC c: IAC Œ a' B b D: DC œ œ A b: HC HC PAC œ b' D: IAC a' B¯: HC Bœ B b 24.9.6. Answer. E¯: HC A PAC /: œ IAC PAC Two-Reprise Menuetto diagram: Sectional Rounded Binary (because the motives from the first section are used in the construction of the melody of the second seca b c a a tion) Trio diagram: a a G: HC b D: PAC c e: PAC c' m. 4 8 m. 12 25 · Sonata andm.Rondo Forms 25.6 · Practice Exercises A: HC 25.6.1. Answer. m. 4 PAC m. 8 (a) Haydn: Expository (b) Beethoven: Developmental (c) Mozart K. 576: Transitional (d) Mozart K. 550: Developmental (e) Mozart K. 309: Expository (f) Haydn: Terminative (g) Mozart K. 309: Transitional (h) Mozart K. 576: Terminative (i) Mozart K. 310: Terminative (j) Haydn: Transitional (k) Mozart K. 457: Expository (l) Mozart K. 550, IV: Developmental 25.6.2. Answer. G: HC m. a16 HC m. 12 PAC dm. 20 PAC m. 18 .. ? # .. G: V65 I 0:30 0:48 1:36 2:07 2:24 IV 1:01 1:27 I V7 3:13 vi 3:37 I6 V7 4 I APPENDIX A. ANSWERS TO PRACTICE EXERCISES DEVELOPMENT EXPOSITION transition transition In major: 0:08 0:00 I modulating In minor: i modulating (2nd time) 0:51 0:58 PT = Primary Theme DEVELOPMENT ST ST CT (CT) III 1:40 III 4:32 436 RECAPITULATION RECAPITULATION RetransitionPTPT transition transition Fragmentation & sequencing 0:45 0:22 V V 1:12 4:19 3:48 3:04 2:37 EXPOSITION PT PT .. ST (CT)CT ST V modulations V pedal 2:03I 2:11 tonicizations 2:31 I I 2:54 III modulations V pedal i tonicizations i i 1:35 ST = SecondaryTheme CT = ClosingTheme Figure A.0.1 Mozart, Piano Sonata K. 545, I. EXPOSITION PT DEVELOPMENT transition ST1 0:00 0:30 0:48 ST2 1:01 CT 1:27 RECAPITULATION Retransition 3:13 3:37 PT transition 3:48 4:19 ST1 ST2 CT 4:32 4:45 5:12 2:07 2:24 2:37 3:04 œœ œœ œœ œ œœ œ œœ œœ & œœ œœ œœ œ œ nachtmusik, Figure K. & œœ A.0.2œœ Mozart,œœ Eine kleine œ œ 525, I. ?œ œœ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœ Leading œ 26 · Triads ? Voice & œœ œ œ œ6 œ6 6 6 C: I V I C: IV I IV 4 4 26.13 · Practice Exercises 6 C: I V64 I6 C: IV Iœ64 IV œ ? œ Answer. œ œ œ 26.13.1. # b 5th 5th6 œœ 5thRtRtI6 œœ 3rd œœœ 3rd C: bI b c œ C: IV I#64 c œ IV6 œ Rt & œœ 3rd Rt bb c œœœ V5th 3rd4 3rd 5th œ œ œœ 5th œ 3rd Rt œ # œœœ 5th c 3rd Rt b œ œ 5th 3rd Rt Rt 5th 3rd & œœ 3rd œœ 3rd œ Rt 3rd 5th œ œ 5th œ 5th # œ 3rd œ 3rd Rt 3rd Rt œ 5th Rt œ 3rd œ Rt œ 3rd ? b c œ 5thRt œ Rt œ 3rd œ 5th # c œ 5th œ 3rd œ Rt œ 5th Rt œœ RtRt # œœ 5thRt œœ 3rd5th ? bb bb cc œœœ 3rdRt œœ 5thRt œœ RtRt œœ 3rd # cc œœ 3rd & Rt Rt Rt 5th Rt Rt b œ œ 5th 3rd Rt Rt 3rd Rt œ Rt Rt 3rd œ RtRt œ E¯: I vi IV ii e: III 5th iv œ 3rd œV Rt VI œœ 5th ? b b cE¯: œI Rt viœ # ce: III (deceptive IV ii iv VI Rt œV Rt cadence) Rt b œ Rt œ Rt œ Rt œ Rt (deceptive cadence) # 3rd b b Answer. œ Rt œ 5th œœ 3rd 26.13.2. œ Rt Vœœ 3rd VIœœ Rt Rt # e:cc IIIœœ 3rd & bb b b b E¯:cc I œœœ 5th œœ 3rd iiœ 3rd 3rd 5th Rt Rt ivœ viœ Rt IVœ 5th 3rd œ œ œœ 5thRt(deceptive Rt Rt 5th & b œ œ œœ 5thRt 3rd œœ 5th œœ 5th œ 3rd œ Rt œœ 3rdRt cadence) Rt œ 5th Rt 5th Rt 5th 3rd œ 5th 3rd œœ œœ 5th œ 3rd ? bb c # 3rd œ Rt 5th œ c 5th Rt 3rd 3rd 3rd œ œ œ Rt œœ 3rdRt œ RtRt # cc œ RtRt œ RtRt œœ 3rd5thRt œ 3rd ? bb bb b cc œœ 5thRtRt œœœ 5th & œ Rt œœ 5thRt œ Rt œœ 5thRt œ RtRt œœ 5thRtRtRt Rt œœ Rt 3rd b f: i iv VII III G: vi 5th œii V 3rd œœ œII 3rd 5th œ iv VII III G: vi ii V ? b b b cf: i # œ Rt c Rt œ œ Rt œ Rt Rt œ Rt b Rt œœ œœ Rt œ & bb cc œœ œ œœœ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ V œœ œœf: i œ iv œœVII III & G: vi œ ii œ œ œ œœ I œ œ œ œ œ 26.13.3. Answer. # œ œ œ œœ œ œ œœ ?b c œ œœ # œœœ œœœ œœ œœ ? b cc œœ & œ œ œœ œœœ œ˜ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ #____ œœV˜ iœ VII III iv VI iv œœ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ œœi ? b d:d:c ____ œ iœ VII III iv V VI iv i œ (deceptive cadence) ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ 159 159 (2nd time) 1:36 # & # cc & 26.13.4. ?# c ? # cc & ˜ (deceptive cadence) œœ œœ œœ œœœ œ œ Answer. œœ œœœ œœ œ i d: ____ ____ ? # G: I G:c ____ œ I I G: ____ VII ____ III ____ œœ œœ œ œ œœ œ œ iv ____ œœœ œœœ œœœœ V VI ____ ____ (deceptive cadence) œœ œœ œ œ œœ œIV œœœ œœœ œœœœ iv ____ ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙ ˙ ˙˙ ˙ V vi ____ ____ V vi ____ ____ (deceptive cadence) (deceptive cadence) iii ____ iii ____ œ ____ IV ____ œ ii ____ ii ____ V ____ V ____ V vi ____ ____ (deceptive cadence) iii ____ IV ____ ii ____ V ____ œ œ ˙ i ____ 159 4:45 5:12 i d: ____ VII ____ III ____ V VI iv ____ ____ ____ (deceptive cadence) PRACTICE EXERCISES APPENDIX A. ANSWERS TO # & c œœœ ?# c œœ œ I G: ____ 160 œœ œ œœ ? # # c œœ b œ Rœœ œœ I ? b b cD:œœ ____ œ œ PRAC EX ## œœœ Dom. ____ œœ œœœ 6 6 viio6 ____ viio6 ____ ? ## c & b D: g:____ œ ____ & b HF:c ____ œ ? bb #b#b#b ccœœ œ ? &&b c œ œ 26.13.7. b b Answer. HW b HW V6 ____ ?#b b# b ? bb 6 chord & type: 4 HF: ____ i b: ____ ? #b b &&b #b V6 A: I 6 4 ____ V64 ____ œ w w ww œœ R œœ œœ V ____ R 5 V ____ Pre-dom. ____ Dom. ____ ˙ œ ˜ ˜ œ œœ œ Ton. œ ____ I ____ I œ œ IV6 œ ____ œ œœ Rt œœœ Rt 5th œ 5thRt 3rd ____ œ 6 6 œ 3rd ____ i6 ____ 3rd ____ ____ iio6 ____ œ ____ ____ œ œ ˙ ˜ w ____w œœ ww œ ________ œ Pre-dom. ____ œ œ ii6 ____ R VI ____ VI ____ ____ ____ œœ œ œ œ V ____ V ____ œœ ____ 3 ww w ww w 6 œœ ____ R 5 ii6 ____ ## œœ œ œœ œœ ____ ____ 5 161 œ œ œ œ 3 5 R R 3 ww R (one of several o6 solutions) vii I ww ii ____ possible ____ ____ 3 I6 œ____ œ 6 3 VI ____ œœ R ˙ œ 5 ˜ 6 66 i6 ____ i ____ 6 c œ œœ œ œœ Ton. ____ œ œœ œ œœ œ c œ passing n œ ____ c: ____ V ____ I ____ Dom. ____ ? #b b# c Answer. œ 26.13.8. œ ____ g: &# Rt # 3rd c œœ 5th & œ 3rd # œœœ Rt 5th ? ## c b ? #b#b cb œc œ 5th & Rt & b D: ____ ____ ? ## b &b PRAC EX œœ ____ œ œœ ____ I # c____ ? #b#B¯: œ Ton. &?b HF:b ____ # c œ ii ____ œ V6 ____ c œ bg: ____ i i g: ____ IV ____ IV œ ____ 26.13.6. Answer. I B¯: ____ iii ____ œ 5 œ 5 bb bb bcc Ton. œœ & ____ & HF: & b cœœ œ ? ? #b bb# cc œ &?b bc œ ˙˙ ˙ 3 6 i6 ____ viio6 ____ &b c œ œœœ # œœ œ R6 437 œœ œ œ b & b c œœ # œœ 26.13.5. Answer. œ œ 3 ? b # #c c &b œ œœ œ i ____ œœœ œ V vi ____ ____ (deceptive cadence) i g: ____ PRAC EX œœ œ œ œ ˜ iv ____ œœ œ œ ____ ____ œ œ œ Dom. ____ ____˙ I ____ # œœ œ Rt 5th œ 3rd 5th ____ i46 ____ 3rd Rt 5th ˜ 6 4 ____ œ V ____ cadential ____ w œ ____ (one of several possible solutions) ( ) V ____ V6 161 161 Rt œ œ œ ( ) V ˙ ˙ ˙˙ ˙ vi 3rd 5th 3rd Rt ____ ˙ ____ VI ____ ˙ Ω 6 ____ œ ____ w ____ & ? b c bb ? ? APPENDIX A. c:ANSWERS EXERCISES i iv TOi64PRACTICE iv6 iio6 i64 6 4 chord type: ____ c˜: V Answer. i 26.13.9. 7 7 A: V7 A:comp. V7 b b c comp. œœ Rt & b inc. comp. 5th œ & ? b c œ 3rd & bb Rt c˜: inc. V 5th œœ comp. œœ 3rd œ Rt œ œ Rt œ i I I inc. Rt inc. 5th 3rd 5th V VI 438 ____ œ œ œ œ 5th Rt f: V7 i E¯: V7 I f:comp. V7 comp. i E¯:comp. V7 I comp. Rt Rt 3rd 3rd comp. comp. comp. 5th comp. 5th œœ œ œ Rt 3rd œœ œ œ 3rd 3rd n œœ œ œ 3rd 5th Rt 5th Rt œ œ œœ 5th 3rd 6 o6 c: i œ iv i64 i64 V VI ? & œ iv œ ii œ cadential œ œ passing ?64 chordœœtype: œ ____ œ consec. 1st-inv. œ ____ œ Dec. Cad. œ œ œ œ7 7 7 7 7 7 7 œ œ7 7 œ 7Leading 7 7 7˜ 27? · Voice Chords œ7 œ œ Seventh b c esc ____ œ b: ____ ____ ____ n ____ ____ ____ ____ œ ant ˜ sus b # & ____Practice ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ 27.6 Exercises & b: c· œ7 ____ 7 7œ 7 œ 7 7 ˙ œœ7 œ œ # # œ œ 27.6.1. Answer. # # ˙____ ˙ ____ # ____œ ____œ ____ bbb ˙˙˙ ____˙˙ # ˙˙ dn ˙˙ & #?˙˙A:b b____ ˙ p˙ csus˙˙ ____#ant # ˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ œ ˙˙ œ b ˙˙ & ˙œ ˙ œ ? ## ˙˙˙c œœ ˙˙ œ ˙ ˙ ˙ œ ˙ # ˙ ˙ œ ˙ œ ˙ œ ? #˙ # # ˙˙ ˙ œ # # ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙ bb ˙ ˙˙ ? ## # ˙ & ˙ p˙ ˙ bb ˙ ˙ ˙ 7 e: ____ D: V____ V7 ____ i I ____ 7 7 V i D: V I inc. comp. comp. inc. inc. comp. comp. inc. ?# # & # c M6 M4 27.6.2. Answer. # # G: I 5 IV 2 & #b œœ œ ? & bb b# bc œ œ œ & bœ œ ? # œ ____ b: ____ ? b# œ b ? bb b b i7 iv7 ____ & b:b c____ 4 f: i iv6 a: a: viiø65 œœ œ œ œ____ œœ œ œ œ ____ œœ œœ œœ œœ 171 7 e: V____ i ____ B¯: ____ V7 I 7 e: comp. V7 i B¯: V I comp. comp. comp. comp. comp. comp. comp. iii4 vi56 ii4 œ ____ œ œœ œ œ ˜ œ ____ œœ vi œœ œœ œ 2 2 œœ ˙ V56 # œ ____ œ œœ œ œ œœ IV œœ œœ I œœ œœ œœ ii42 V56 IM42 IM42 VII7 IIIM7 VIM7 iiø7 V7 i ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ 4 M6 M4 ø 6 VII III 5 or incomplete VI 2 with complete) ii 5 V42 i65 5 2 (alternate complete with2 incomplete, 27.6.3. ? Answer. b# c œœ œœ F: ?# # & M6 & G: I I 5 œœ œœ vi IVM42 IV viiø65 V iii42 vi65 # Voice Leading With Non-Chord Tones 28? · bb & b b· 28.4 Practice Exercises ? bb b # bc esc & œœ œ œœ # œ 28.4.1. Answer. ? # c œœ i e: ____ œ. œ sus 4 - 3 V ____ ant n œ n œ œœ œ p œ œ œœ œ œ p VI ____ iv ____ œœ sus 4 - 3 ant dn œœ # œ œ ˙ ˙ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ i64 ____ V7 ____ ˙ i ____ 167 Rt ant sus 4 - 3 p ˙˙ œ sus 4 - 3 sus œ œ PRACTICE œA. ANSWERS œ œ œ EXERCISES œ œœ # œ APPENDIX TO ? ## c œ œ œ œ œ 9 - 8 ˜ 28.4.2. Answer. # œœ & # c œœ œ œœ œ œœ sus &b c ant 4 - 3 p œ œ œ œ œ œ ? # # cc œ œ œ œ b n iv i b: ____ ____ 172 i I F: ____ b: iv vi ____ i ____ i IV ____ III ____ iv ____ œœ œ 9 - 8 sus œ œ III V____ ˙˙ V ____ VI ____ œœ ˙˙ sus 4 - 3 œœ # œ ˜ ivvi ____ 439 V IV ____ ˙˙ 177 VI I____ # app & œœ 7th œœ n sus 4 - 3 ant 3rd & œ b c œ œ œ œ & œœ œ œœ œ œœ . œ œ œ œ œ œ˙˙ ? œœ ?# #œ n sus 4 - 3 sus 4 - 3 œ œ œ œ C: viioœ7/ii œ œ œ ? b&c œ œ œ œ œ œ ˙ || 5ths 7th 7th b œ œ #? œ ˙ œ œ œ nœ & F: I œ vi œ IV &Vœb b n œ 3rdvi n œ IV n œ 3rdI œ doubled 3rd unequal 5ths 7 7 7 7 29 · Voice Leading Chromatic Harmonies (avoid on V) (preferable) Ω Ω Ω b & # · Practice Exercises œ ? œ 29.5 A¯: ____ ____ ____ ? ____ # œ ____n œœ ____ # œ ____ n œœ 28.4.3. Answer. 178 ?b bb & b b œœ # œ & & ? bb b b œ ?# I ? A¯: ____ 29.5.1. Answer. œœ nœ œ n œœ bœ œ V7/vi ____ V7/ii ____ comp. viio7/ii inc. ii 29.5.2. b Answer. A: I bbb c: b œœ viio7/V œœ n & b# b#b & # c œœ œ n œœ ? bb bb œ œ ? ### c œ #œ A: I viio7/ii nœ œ V œœ œ œ ii V24 n vi ____ V65 /V œœ œ # œœ . œ œ œœ œ œ I6 œœ V sus 4 n œ˙ œ œ ˙˙ #œ V56 /V V ˙˙ viio7/vi ____ ant œ œ ˙˙ viio7/V n œœ V7/V V ____ ____ free res. comp V42 I6 p œœ ii - 3 œ V Notice that the chords on beats 5 and 6 are consecutive first inversion chords (even though one is a 7th chord), therefore the third is doubled on I6 & to avoid parallel fifths. ? 29.5.3. Answer. 4 Ω3 Rom. num.: ____ ____ APPENDIX A. ANSWERS E: ____ ____ Harm. func.: ton. dom. & &b & ? ?b ? 180 6 ____ ____ ton. œ 6 4+ 3N6 6 4 viio7/V ____ ____ ____ ____ ¯6 6 Ω7 ____ ____ ____ ____ ____ dom. ton. prol. 6 ˜ 6 5 ˜ 6 ˙œ œ œ #œ œ b˙œ¯7 œ ¯7 œœ Ω & # Answer. 29.5.4. &# ? # œ œ & œ œ ? # A¯: vi ? # # œœ b # œœ & 6 4 3 # ? &D: Int: œœ œ œ b b b b œœ œœ œœ Fr+6 I ___ Fr+6 ___ V ___ V7 œ n¯VI œ œ bb b b n œ b œ œ 6 6 5 3 6 4 # b: i6 & 44& b b b b œœ œ œœ ## œ œ œ # œ # œœ œœ # œœ œœ viio7/Vœ # # œœ b œœ œ vi # # œœ œœ œœ N6 V +6 i6 IV6 Ger f: ___ ___ ___ G: V43/V EnGer+6 I64 4 b: i6 œœ œ œ b ∫ œœ n œœ c.f. A¯: vi Fr+6 ¯VI V7 N6 viio7/V __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ c.f. ?# V vi w ?4 8 Interval: ____ & 44 & 44 & w w c.f. œœ w __ __ __ __ __ First4and Second Species Exercises 30.9.1. Answer. V __7 œ œ œ 30 · w towCounterpoint 4 Introduction &4 w w w w w w w 30.9 ·esc,Practice Exercises 4-3 sus, p, ant & It+6 V œœ . ? 4? w#b œœ b n œœw b œœ w A b œœw œ w œ w b œ w œœ w 4 b bb w œ nœ & & It+6 V 4/V ˜: i __ V__ V6 viio4/iv IV6 Ger+6 N6 __ __ f __ 2 __ __ __ __3 __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ 29.5.5. ? # Answer. Int: œ œ œ œœ œ 7 ____ 6 V7 VI e: VI N____ G: V43/V EnGer+6 I64 f: ___ ___ ___ 440 # œ nœ #œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ˙ œ 4 4 6 viio7/V b¯:___ ____ ____ vi iv____ V ____ i6 N V 3 ___ F: ___ a: ___ ___ ___ 3___ G: ____ ii7 viio7 ____ I D: ___ ___ ___ Ω5 TO PRACTICE EXERCISES # œ œ œœ œœ ˙œ œ œœ b œœ # œœ œœ # œ œ œ œ œœ b œ œ bœ œ ˙ œ œ œ œœ œ # œ œ œ œ ˙ 6 œ œn6œ# œ b œ ¯7 œ œΩ7 œ œ bœ œ 4 4 Ω 7 3 6 ¯ œ #œ w 3 ____ 6 ____ w 6 ____ w 3 ____ 6 ____ 8 ____ w w w w w w w w w w 4 &4 w w w w w w APPENDIX A. ANSWERS TO PRACTICE EXERCISES w c.f. 8 Interval: ____ c.f. 3 ____ 6 ____ & 44 w w w w 4 &4 w w 6 3 ____ ____ w w w w 6 ____ 6 ____ w w w w 6 3 ____ ____ w w w #w 441 8 ____ w w no more than 3 consecutive 6ths or 3rds changed direction on B (avoid changing on Fn later) w w w w w w w w #w w & 44 w w w w Int: 8 ___ & 44 w & c.f. 8 Int: ___ c.f. 8 Int: 4 ___ w8 Int: c.f. 8 & 44 ___ Int: ___ w c.f. c.f. w & 44 w & & & 444 w & 44 w & & 4 ww 3 3 5 ___ 8 ___ 3 ___ 6 ___ 3 ___ ___ ___ w w w w w w w w w w w 5 ___ 5 ___ 5 ___ 5 ___ w ww w 6 ___ 6 ___ 6 ___ 6 ___ 6 ___ 6 ___ 6 ___ 6 ___ w w ww w w ww w ww w ww ww www 1 ___ w2 ___5 ___6 Int: ___ c.f. 1 2 5 ___ 6 Int: ___ ___ ___ 30.9.2. Answer. w 4 w 1 ___ 2 Int: ___ ___ & 44 c.f. w5 ___6 w c.f. & 44 w pt w & & 444 ˙ pt˙ ˙ ˙ & 44 ˙˙ pt˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ &4 & Int: 6 ___ 6 ___ 3 ___ 3 ___ 6 ___ 8 ___ 8 __ __ 3 ___ 3 ___ 3 ___ 3 ___ w ww w w ww w 3 ___ 3 ___ 3 ___ 3 ___ w ww w w ww w 8 ___ 6 ___ w w w ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ 8 ___ 6 ___ 8 ___ 6 ___ 5 ___ 5 ___ 5 ___ 5 ___ w ww w w ww w 8 ___ 6 ___ 3 ___ 6 ___ 8 6 3 6 ___ ___ ___ ___ 8 ___ 6 ___ 3 ___ 6 ___ 8 ___ 6 ___ 3 ___ 6 ___ w ww w w ww w8 6 ___ ___ w w w ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ 6 ___ 8 ___ 6 ___ 8 ___ w ww w w ww w 3 __ 2 __ 3 __ 5 __ 8 __ 7 __ 3 __ 5 __ 6 __ 7 __ w ww w w ww w 6 ___ 8 ___ w w w ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ 6 ___ 8 ___ 6 ___ 8 ___ w ww w w ww w 3 ___ 3 ___ 3 ___ 3 ___ w ww w w ww w 5 ___ 3 ___ w w w ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ w w 3 ___ 1 ___ 3 1 ___ ___ 3 ___ 1 ___ 3 ___ 1 ___ 5 ___ 3 ___ 5 ___ 3 ___ w ww w w ww w 1 ___ w ww ww ww w w w ww w w 1 ___ 1 ___ 6 __ 3 __ 6 __ 3 __ 5 __ 6 __ 8 __ 8 __ 3 __ 2 __ 3 __ 5 __ 8 __ 7 __ 3 __ 5 __ 6 __ __ __ ˙6 ˙__3 __ ˙6 ˙__3 __˙5 #__6˙ __8w ˙ ˙7__ __ & 444__Ó__˙˙ __˙ __˙ __˙ __˙ __˙˙__˙ __ ˙__˙˙ __ __ __ __ ˙ ˙ ˙__ ˙__ __˙ # ˙__ w ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ Ó ˙ ˙ pt pt ˙ & & 44 Ó ˙ w˙ pt˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ w˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙w ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ # ˙ w ? w &4 w w pt w w pt w pt w w w w ? 444 c.f. w w w w w w w w w w ? 44 c.f. w w w w w w w & Int: Int: Int: c.f. 8 __ 5 __ 3 __ 3 __ 5 __ 8 __ 3 __ 3 __ 2 __ 3 __ 2 __ 3 __ 5 __ 6 __ 7 __ 3 __ 5 __ 6 __ 3 __ 8 __ __ c.f. __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ w __ __ w __ __w __ __w __ & 444 __c.f. w __ __ w__ __w__ __w__ __w__ __w__ __ __ c.f. w & 44 w w pt w pt ˙w ww pt w w w w ˙ w ˙ & 4 Ów ˙ ˙w ? ˙ ˙w ˙ ˙w ˙ ˙w ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙w ˙ w˙ ˙ 4 w ˙ ˙ ? 44 Ó ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙ ˙ ? 44 Ó ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ & Int: Int: & & & & & & w w w w w Intervals: Intervals: __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ 4 &4 &4 APPENDIX A. ANSWERS TO PRACTICE EXERCISES ?4 w w w Dayw Two ? 44 wCounterpoint: Species c.f. c.f. w w 442 w w w 30.9.3. Answer. __ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœœ œ œœœ œœ œœ œ œ œœœ w œ pt pt pt 8 __ 6 __ Int: __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ 88 __ 22 __ 33 __ 8__ 33 __ 22 __ 88 __ 33 __ 6__ 55 __ 33 __ 44 __ 33 __ 44 __ 55 __ 66 __ 33 __ 33 __ 55 __ 66 __ 66 __ 77 __ 88 __ 66 __ 88 __ 77 __ 55 __ 66 Int: __ __ & 44 pt ? 44 w w c.f. c.f. pt pt w pt pt w pt pt w w camb. camb. w __ 88 w 4 w w w &4 w w w w w c.f. camb. c.f. pt pt pt pt pt pt pt ? 44 œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ # œ œ œ œ w Int: __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ 8 __ 7 __ 6 __ 5 __ 3 __ 4 __ 6 __ 5 __ 3 __ 8 __ 2 __ 3 __ 3 __ 2 __ 8 __ 7 __ 5 __ 5 __ tt __ 3 __ 3 __ 8 __ 2 __ 3 __ 3 __ 5 __ 4 __ 3 Int: 8 __ 2 __ 3 __ 5 __ 6 __ 5 __ 3 __ 4 __ 3 __ 2 __ 1 __ 7 __5 __ 4 __ 3 __ 5 __ 6 __ 7 __ 8 __ 7 Int: __ 8 __ 2 __ 3 __ 5 __ 6 __ 5 __ 3 __ 4 __ 3 __ 2 __ 1 __ 7 __5 __ 4 __ 3 __ 5 __ 6 __ 7 __ 8 __ 7 Int: __ 5 __ 4 __ 3 __ 5 __ 5 __ 4 __ 3 __ 5 __ 6 __ 5 __ 3 __ 4 __ 3 __ 2 __ 1 __ 7 __5 __ 4 __ 3 __ 5 __ 6 __ 7 __ 8 __ 7 __ 6 __ 5 __ 3 pt 4 __ 3 pt 2 __ 1 pt 7 __5 __ 4pt __ 3 __ 5 __ 6 __ 7pt__ 8 __ 7 pt __ __ __ __ 5 __ 4 __ 3 __ 5 __ 5 __ 4 __ 3 __ 5 pt __ œœœœ œœœœ œwptœ œ œ œ ptœ œ œ wpt w w __ __ __ __ 6 __ 5 __ 4 __ 3 __ 44 œ œ œ œ & Int: & Int: 4 œ____88 ptœ____22 œ____33 œ____55 4 œ ptœ œ œ & 444 wœ œ œ œ ? & ? 4 w ptpt 4 w ? 4 c.f. w__ __ __ __ ? Int: 4 c.f. 4 c.f. 8 __ 3 __ 4 __ 5 Int: __ 44 c.f. œ œ & Int: œ & Int: 4 œœ____88 œ____33 œ____44 œ____55 4 œ ptœ œ & 444 œw œ œ œ ? & ? 4 œw ptpt 4 ? 4 c.f. w ? 4 c.f. 4 w œœœœ œœœœ œ œ œ ptœ œw œ œ œ w ptpt w __ __ __ __ w 6 __ 7 __ 8 __ 2 __ œ__6 __œœ7 __œœ8 __œœ2 œ6 __7 __8 __2 __ œ ptœœ œœ ptœœ œw pt wptpt pt w w 30.9.4. c.f. Answer. & &4 &4 & ?4 ? ?4 ? 44 c.f. 8 Intervals: __ 8 Intervals: __ & 44 &4 ? ? 4444 Ó ˙˙ Ó w w c.f. c.f. Intervals: Ó ˙ Ó ˙ ww 8 __ c.f. c.f. 4 Ó & & 444 Ó ˙˙ ? 44 w c.f. c.f. 7 __ 6 __ 7 __ 6 __ œœœœ œœœœ œwptœ œ ptœ œ ptœ œ ptœ wpt pt w w__ __ __ __ 5œ __ 3 __ 1 __ 2 __ œ__5 __3œœ __1œœ __2œœ 5 __ __ œ 3œ __1œ __2œ œ œ œ ptœ w pt w pt w w 5 __ 6 __ 5 __ 6 __ œ œœ œœ œœ œ œwptœœ œœ ptœœ œwpt pt wpt pt w __ __ __ __ œœ œœ œœ œœ wœ ptœ œ œ œw ptœ œ œ w pt w __ __ __ __ 6 __ 8 7 6 __ œ œœ __œœ __œ 6œ __ 8 __ 7 __ œ66 __ 6 __ 8 __ 7 __ __ œ œ œ ptœœ œ œw œ w ptpt w w 3 __ 5 __ 3 __ 5 __ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ sync. sus. sync. sync. sus. sync. w w w w w w œœœœ œœœœ wœ ptœ œ œ œw ptœ œ œ w pt w œœœœ œ__66 œ__55 œ__44 œ__33 __ __ __ __ œ œ ptœ œ œw œ œ œ w ptpt w w 3 __ 2 __ 8 __ 6 __ 3 __ 2 __ 8 __ 6 __ 3 __ 2 __ 8 __ 6 __ 7 __ 7 __ 6 __ 6 __ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ sus. sus. w w 8 __ 7 __ 5 __ 6 __ 8 __ 7 __ 5 __ 6 __ 8 __ 8 __ œ œ œ #œ œ œ œ #œ œwcamb. œ œ #œ œwcamb. œ œ #œ camb. wcamb. w __ __ __ __ 3 __tt __5 __6 __ œ__3 __œœtt __œœ5 œœ__6 œ3 __tt __5 __6 __ œwptœœ œœ œœ œ wpt wpt w w__8 w__8 w ww w w __ __ w8 w8 __ __ w8 w w w w w 8 __ 7 __ 5 __ 6 __ 8 __ 7 __ 5 __ 6 __ 7 __ 6 __ 7 __ 6 __ 7 __ 6 __ 7 __ 6 __ sus. sus. sus. sus. ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ w w __ 8 __ w w 8 __ 8 __ w w w w __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ __ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ # ˙ w ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ #˙ w sus. sync. sync. sync. sync. w sus. w w ww w w ww ww w w w 4 __ 3 __ ˙˙ ˙˙ w 8 5 ˙˙ ˙˙ w 6 5 ˙ ˙˙ ˙ w 6 3 ˙˙ ˙˙ w 5 6 ˙˙ ˙ ˙ w 7 6 ˙˙ ## ˙˙ w 8 ww w & ˙˙ ˙ ˙ ## ˙˙ ˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙˙ sync. & 44 Ó ˙ sus. sus. sync. sync. sync. sus. sus. w sync. sync. sync. ww sync. w w w ? 4 w w w w w ?4 w w w EXERCISES APPENDIX TO PRACTICE 4 c.f. A. ANSWERS w ww 443 c.f. 44 & &4 ? ? 44 4 c.f. c.f. 44 & &4 ? ? 444 ÓÓ ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ ##˙˙ ww ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ sus. sus. sync. sync. sus. ww sync. ww ww ww ww ww ww ww c.f. 8 __ 4 __ 3 __ 8 __ 4 __ 3 __ Intervals: Intervals: ÓÓ ˙ ˙ ww Intervals: 3 __4 __ 3 __4 __ ˙˙ ˙ sus. ˙ ww sus. ˙˙ ˙ ˙ sus. sus. ww 8 __ 6 __ 3 __ 5 __ 3 __ 5 __ 3 __ 4 __ 3 __ 4 __ 3 __ ˙ ˙ ˙˙ ˙ ˙ ˙˙ sus. sync. sus. sync. ww ww 4 __ 3 __ 5 __ 8 __ 4 __ 3 __ 8 __ 6 __ 8 __ 6 __ 7 __ 6 __ 7 __ 6 __ 8 __ 8 __ ˙˙ ˙ ˙ # ˙ ˙ sus. ˙ #˙ sync. sus. ww sync. ww 6 __ 8 __ ww ww 7 __ 6 __ 8 __ c.f. Invention Expositions 30.9.5. Answer. œ parts (downbeats restricted to chord tones; non-chord tones occur on œ . weakest . ofœ beats) & 433 œ œ œ . œ œ œ œ œ œ . œ œ œœ œ . œ œœ œ # œ œ . œ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ . œ œœ œ œœ . œ œ œ & 4 œ œ œ œ . œ œ œ œ œ œ . œ œ œ . œ œ # œnn œ . œpp œ œ Intervals: n 8 p2 3 3 3 8 7 3 4 3 3 3 8 7 3 5 3 Intervals: 3 3 3 8 7 3 4 3 3 3 8 7 8 2 3 5 3 33 8877 33 44 33 33 33 Intervals: 3 3 3 8 7 3 4 3 3 3 8 7 8 2 3œ 5 3 3 8 7œ 3œ 4œ 3œ œ œ # œ œ . œ œ œ œ œ3 3œœ ?3 œ œœ œ œ œ œ ∑ œ œ Œ œ œ . œ #œ œ. ? 43 œ œ œœ œ . œp œ œ œ œ œ Œ ∑ 4 pp nn alteration p n œ p n p n alteration (downbeats (downbeats restricted restricted to to chord chord tones; tones; non-chord non-chord tones tones occur occur on on weakest weakest parts parts of of beats) beats) 192 192 192 C: C: II C: I n II I V V V V V V II I œœœœœœœœœœ # œ œœœ#(##œœœnn)œœœ # œ œ œ œ œ œ# œ œ # œ œœ œ # œ #œ œ œ & # œ œ # œ œ œœ œ œœ œœœ œœœœ œœ œ œ œ œ œ ## œœ ( ) œœœ ##œœ œœ œ œ ##œœ œœ œ ##œœ œœ œ & œ œ œ œœœ Intervals: 3 3 4 3 3 8 6 6 5 Intervals: 3 3 4 3 3 8 6 6 5 ?# ?# œ œ œœ œœ###œœœ œœ œœœœœœœœœ œ nn œ œ œ ∑∑ ∑ e: i e: i # & ### & ? ## ? ## i i ? bb ?b ## & & ?# 3 8 7 (8) 3 8 7 (8) œœ ŒŒŒ œ œœ œ V œ #œ œ Œ Œ # œ# œ œœ((##œœ))œœ œ # œ œ œœ œœ Œ #œ œ #œ œ n 3 3 43 38 6 3 3 3 3 43 38 6 3 3 V V V 422 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ . œ œ œœ 4 œ œ œ œ œ œ œ. œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ. œ œ œ œ œ œ œ. D: I V 422 4 43 4 43 e: i 3 ∑ ∑ 8 3 3 I ∑ ∑ 3 5 (ii) 8 3 8 œ œ 7 œ œ. œ œ. œ œ . œœ ## œœ œ œœ nn œœ œœ # œ œœ œœ ## œœ .. œœ œ . #œ œ œ. œ #œ œ œ nœ œ œ œ #œ. œ œ. #œ œ n œ œœ .. œœ nœ nœ œ. œ I œ œ œ tritone is harmonically supported in V7 chord ‰ Jœ œœ œœ œ # œ œ œœ œœ œ ‰ J œ#œœ œ ‰ œJ œ œ œ # œ œ œ œ œ i œ œ œœ œ œ i adjustment V "microharmony" œ . œœ œœ .. œ. œ .œœ œ . alteration alteration i n 3 8 3 3 3 tt 3 œ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œœ œœ œœ œ œ Œ œ œ œ Œ Intervals: j 433 ‰‰ œœj œ œ œ œ œ 4 j œ œ œ ## œœ œ œ 43 ‰ œ œ œ œ # œ œ œ ? 3 ∑ & bb & &b melodic minor melodic minor V Œ Œ Œ #œ nœ œ œ ‰ œJJ # œ n œ œœ ## œœ œœ œ œ ‰ œ #œ nœ œ#œœ œ œ ‰J V i D: I I V (ii) 7 V "microharmony" I tritone is harmonically supported in V7 chord APPENDIX A. ANSWERS TO PRACTICE EXERCISES 3 j & b 4 ‰ œ œ œ œ #œ œ œ œ. œ œ. p ? 3 b 4 Intervals: ∑ d: i Fugue Analysis 30.9.6. Answer. melodic minor œ œ. œ #œ œ œ nœ œ œ #œ œ œ #œ. œ . p œ ‰ J œ œ œ #œ œ œ 673 4 5 3 3 6 i p 444 œ n 3 5 3 2 8 7 (8) alteration V œ Œ ‰ V nœ œ. œ p 6œ 7 3 œ 4 5 3 3 83 3 # œ n œ œ #œ œ œ œ J p alteration i APPENDIX A. ANSWERS TO PRACTICE EXERCISES 445 Table A.0.3 Mass in B Minor: Fugue Analysis Table FORM SOPRANO ALTO TENOR BASS KEY Meas. Exposition 1 Subject F4m 1 Subject Sub. 2 3 Subject Countersubject C4 m 4 l FORM SOPRANO ALTO TENOR BASS KEY Meas. (Bridge) Subject Countersubject 5 Bridge Mot. A Bridge Mot. B Bridge Mot. A Bridge Mot. B Bridge Mot. A Bridge Mot. B 7 8 6 l FORM SOPRANO ALTO TENOR BASS KEY Meas. Exposition 1 (continues until 4th voice has subject) Subject Subject Subject Sub. Countersubject Countersubject Countersubject C.S. Ctrpt Ctrpt Ctrpt Ctrpt Ctrpt 4 Fm C4 m 9 10 11 12 l FORM SOPRANO ALTO TENOR BASS KEY Meas. Subject Countersubject Ctrpt Ctrpt 13 Episode 1 Bridge Mot. A Bridge Mot. B Ctrpt Mot. B Ctrpt 14 15 Bridge Mot. A Ctrpt Ctrpt Ctrpt 16 l FORM SOPRANO ALTO TENOR BASS KEY Meas. Exposition 2 Ctrpt Ctrpt Subject Subject Ctrpt Ctrpt Cadential Cadential Cadential Ctrpt Subject Ctrpt F4m 17 18 31 · Introduction to Jazz Theory 31.12 · Practice Exercises 31.12.1. Answer. 19 20 & 2. B7(˜5) 1. G9sus 4. C˜m11 ¯9 5. D7 ¯5 ¯5 & APPENDIX A. ANSWERS TO PRACTICE EXERCISES 6. GmΔ9 7. A¯Δ9(˜11) 8. D¯69 9. E¯Δ9(˜5) 6. GmΔ9 7. A¯Δ9(˜11) 8. D¯69 9. E¯ # wΔ9(˜5) ? wAwww7 # 95 ? c w˙ ww & ˙w 9 w # wwww b ˙# ww # 76 E b 7(# 9) 2. B7(˜5) 2. B7(˜5) 1. G sus 1. G9sus ? c # ˙˙w ? # ˙ww ? bb # www wΔ9 6. Gm 2. 6. GmΔ9 79 3. Em9(¯5) 446 # # ww # F # 9sus # w ## ## wwww C m b # www # w#w ˙ b www # ˙ 3. Em9(¯5) 4. C˜m11 G 9(13) b #bb wwww b # ww w 10. 10. 6 9 3. Em9(¯5) 4. C˜m11 5. D7 ¯9 ¯9 5. D7 ¯5 ¯5 8. D¯9 8. D¯69 9. E¯Δ9(˜5) 9. 4.E¯Δ9(˜5) 10. FΔ7(¯5) 10. 5. FΔ7(¯5) b ww www b b b w ˙ b ˙ bb bb www b b bbb wwwww # ˙ bΔ9(ww 11) 6 7. A¯ ˜ 7. A¯Δ9(˜11) 3. FΔ7(¯5) FΔ7(¯5) ww b wwww# w bw w www ww C 7( b 5) C 7( 5) C 7( b 9) C 7( 9) C7 _ C 7( b13) or C7(˜5) +5 # ? bw ? b w D b b w C 7 # 95 b b ww F 13susb b ww B 13sus b b ww ¯5E¯maj9(13) 9 bw b w b w & www ˙ n www # ˙ 31.12.2. ww ˙ ww ˜5 ˙˙˙ & cb n bwwwb Answer. # w # w w b ˙ 9 b w respell 5 to agree with ¯7 wrespell ˜9 to agree wwwith ¯7 b #wwww˜ # wwwpreferred ?? b b b wwww˜ ∑ # www n w w ∑ w w # w w b ww w ww∑ ? c b˙# # & ˙ ˙ 9 & A 7E¯m #5 6 E b 7(# 9) G˙ 9(13) F # 9sus Cw# m Gm7(11) A9(˜11) F˜m9(¯5) B13sus¯9 1. _____9 2. _____ 3. _____ 4. _____ 5. _____ ˙ c b ˙ ww & ˙ #˙ w #w nw ˙ w w b w w ww b n ww ?& # ##9#wwwww # ww b wwb # ww b w w b n w # w b w w F #9susb w A 7##˙5 w E b 7(# 9) w G 9(13) C #m w ˙ ? c˙ # w w bw #w b˙ 2 6 9 # # +_ 9 6 9 6 76 82 11 79 85 15 82 & ˙ ˙ww b ˙ b ˙ # w ˙˙ ˙ ? w b ˙ D7˜¯59 ˙ #6.˙˙ _____ EmΔ9(13) ˙ 7. _____ ? w b b b www˙˙w & ˙ # www b ˙ w b w Db 9 & c Dbbb ˙˙b˙w b˙ & b b ˙˙˙ ww &? ? cb ˙ b ˙ w 9. _____ ? b˙ & & # 9b # www ? A7 #5 w & ˙˙ w 6 9 13. _____ &? # ˙˙ 19 & 85 ˙ #9 9 ˙˙ #˙ E sus 8. _____ ww# # ww ˜ ww 9. _____ F ˜# w ˜ ww # ww w ww b w b b b www 11 7 9 5 #9 C7 #5 6 9 31.12.5. Answer. & o7 C 10. _____ C7 #5 6 9 #9 Db C7 #5 F 13sus B 13sus E maj9(13) 4 Diminished-Whole Tone 31.12.4. Answer. 1. G &? &2. b Fb ˙˙4˙Octatonic b ˙˙˙˙ (Half-Whole) b ˙˙˙˙ n # # ˙˙˙˙ # # ## wwww b˙ b 4 3. F Locrian 2 ?4. Cb ˙2Whole-Tone ˙ ˙ 5. A Lydian-Dominant ˙ w 6. C Locrian & w w B 13sus E maj9(13) # ww n ww F 13sus wwww w w ˙ ˙ #˙ # w F 13sus B 13sus E maj9(13) b www b w˙ ˙ bw # ˙ b ˙˙˙ n # ˙˙˙ # # ## wwww bbbw˙˙˙ ˙ 10. _____ ˙ _____ 11. ˙ w 12. _____ ˙ ˙ w ˙ w b ww b www # w n w # w ww E b 7(# 9) F # 9sus C #m # wG 9(13) b b www # w w˙ b b ˙˙ # ˙˙ # w ˙ # w 14. _____ 15. _____ 16. _____ b˙ ˙˙ ˙˙ # ww ˙ # w ˙ #˙ b˙ 31.12.3. Answer. & w 6 w # ˙˙ # ˙ w 6 9 203 199 47 203 & 1. E¯7(˜ ); Scale: ____________________________ & & &3. F Diminished-Whole Tone 4. E¯ Octatonic (Whole-Half) 5 APPENDIX ANSWERS TO PRACTICE EXERCISES 2. B¯7˜9;A. Scale: ____________________________ ? ? ? œ œ & ? œ #œ #œ #œ œ #œ 447 ˜9; Scale: ____________________________ 2. B¯7¯5 9; Scale: ____________________________ ˜¯5 2. B¯7¯5 ˜9; Scale: ____________________________ 2. B¯7¯5 œ bœ bœ bœ bœ bœ bœ œ 7(¯5); Scale: ____________________________ 3.1.Fm E Lydian-Dominant 2. B¯ Phrygian-Dorian 7(¯5); Scale: ____________________________ 3. Fm7(¯5) 3. Fm ; Scale: ____________________________ 3. Fm7(¯5); Scale: ____________________________ & ? & bœ bœ bœ œ & ∫ œ b œ b œ &œ œ bœ bœ bœ nœ #œ œ œ bœ ˜5); Scale: ____________________________ 4.3.A¯FΔ7( Diminished-Whole Tone 4. E¯ Octatonic (Whole-Half) Δ7( ˜5); Scale: ____________________________ 4. A¯Δ7( 5) ˜ 4. A¯ ; Scale: ____________________________ 4. A¯Δ7(˜5); Scale: ____________________________ ? ? ? & ? 31.12.6. Answer. E¯ Whole Tone ˜5); Scale: ____________________________ 1. E¯7( E¯ Whole Tone 1. E¯7(7(˜55)); Scale: ____________________________ E¯ Whole Tone ˜ 1. E¯ ; Scale: ____________________________ E¯ Whole Tone 1. E¯7(˜5); Scale: ____________________________ & & bb ˙˙ & bRoot ˙ & bRoot ˙7 9 Root ˙˙ ˙ 3rd 3rd ˙ 3rd œœ œ œ œœ œ œ ˙˙ ˙ ˙5th ˜5th ˜ B¯ Diminished-Whole Tone ˜5th ˜ ; Scale: ____________________________ 2. B¯ 3rd 7¯5 Root B¯ Diminished-Whole Tone 5th ˜9; Scale: ____________________________ 2. B¯ ¯5 B¯ Diminished-Whole Tone ˜ ˜9; Scale: ____________________________ 2. B¯7¯5 B¯ Diminished-Whole Tone ˜9; Scale: ____________________________ 2. B¯7¯5 ? ? ˙ b˙ ? bRoot ˙ ? bRoot bRoot ˙ h Root h bb œœ bœ bœ w w w w bb ˙˙ b˜9th ˙ b˜9th ˙ ˜9th ˜9th h h h h Locrian nn ˙˙ n3rd ˙ n3rd ˙ ˙˙ ˙ ¯5th ˙ ¯5th 3rd ww ¯5th 3rd w ¯5th w w w w ## œœ #œ #œ bb œœ bœ bœ bb ˙˙ b˙ b˙ ¯7th ¯7th ¯7th ¯7th bb ˙˙ b˙ ¯7th b˙ ¯7th w ¯7th w w ¯7th w w w w w bb œœ bœ bœ w & F (or F Locrian ˜2) 3. Fm7(¯5); Scale: ____________________________ & F Locrian (or F Locrian ˜2) 3. Fm7(¯5); Scale: ____________________________ b˙ œ b˙ œ b & ˙ b œ bb ˙˙ bb œœ b ˙˙ bb œœ b ˙ œ ˙ œ bb ˙˙ bb œœ bb ˙˙ bb œœ b ˙ œ & ˙ bœ ˙ œ (whole step between E¯ and F and between A¯ and B¯ ? (whole step between E¯ and F andbetween betweenF A¯ ? permit whole step or half step andand G) B¯ h h permit whole step or half step between F and G) A¯ Lydian-Augmented ?4. A¯ ˜ ; Scale: ____________________________ ˙ C G b7/Bœ C ? C F C F˙ C Gœ7/D C/E ˙ D m/F œ G7 ? b œ bc˙ ? & Root œœœ .. œœœ œœœ œœ3rd œœ œ œœ 5th œ œ œœ 7thœœ œœ œœœ œ . œ œ œœ œ ˜ œ œ œ Δ7( 5) 123 32 · Impressionism and Extended Tonality ? c œ. œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ 32.5 · Practice œ Exercises œ 32.5.1. Answer. Cm ___ LSS: 125 b & b b c œœ .. œ. ? b c œ. bb i ___ RN: b &bb 127 ? bb b ø7 Fm Cm Fm Cm Cm ___ ___ ___ ___ G___/D¯ ___ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œœ œœ œœ œ œ œ œ bœ œ iv ___ i ___ iv ___ i ___ vø43 ___ i6 ___ D¯/F ___ Gø7 ___ ø7/B¯ Cm Cm G___ ___ ___ b œœ œ b œœœ œœ œœ œœœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ N6 ___ vø7 ___ i ___ vø65 ___ i ___ 207 &c LSS: ___ ___ ___ œ ? c œœ ___ ___ ___ APPENDIX ? A. ANSWERS TO PRACTICE EXERCISES c RN: ___ ___ 32.5.2. Answer. LSS: 128 149 139 144 154 156 LSS: ____ bw & b www w & ww bw ?bw w ? b w ww ___ G9 F9 ___ ___ ___ E¯9 ___ D9 ___ (2) in 4ths & c (1)b œœin 3rds œœ œœ b œœ n œœ œ œ œ ? c œœ œœ œœ b b œœœ # œœœ 32.5.3. Answer. D¯11 E¯(1) + in 3rds B¯ ___ __ __ Dm LSS: ____ C¯ D¯ ww E¯ w & wb œœw c & b b b b œœœœ ww ? w ?c œ 32.5.4. Answer. D ¯ E ¯+ __ ___ C¯ D¯ b œœ & c b b b b œœœœ ?c F9 b œœœ œ b b œœ www wœ nb b B __¯ E¯ n œœœ œœ œ 448 ___ E¯9 ___ ww b œ ww ww Cm ___ A b œœ œ n # n œœœ (lower chords can be any inversion) ___ ___ ___ 209 F9 ___ ___ œœ b œœ (3) in 5ths (4) in 2nds œœ n œœœ œ Cmin 4ths __ D (3) in __ C ¯ ___ (2) 5ths A ___ ___ ___ wF ww b œ B¯ œ ww w C¯ __ D __ B¯ œ # b n œœœœœ F Dmin 2nds ___ (4) ˙ wwwwww Gm Dm ___ Gm ˙˙ bœ b bn n œœœœ n ˙˙˙ œ b ˙ 33 · Set Theory 33.9158· Practice Exercises & Answer. 33.9.1. (a) Normal form is [0, 2, 7]. Prime form is (027). ? Normal form is [1, 3, 6, 8]. Prime form is (0257). (b) (c) Normal form is [6, 10, 11, 1]. Prime form is (0237). (d) Normal form is [7, 8, 0, 3]. Prime form is (0158). (e) Normal form is [11, 0, 1, 4, 6]. Prime form is (01257). (f) Normal form is [6, 7, 10, 11, 2]. Prime form is (01457). (g) Normal form is [9, 10, 0, 1, 4, 6]. Prime form is (013479). 33.9.2. Answer. APPENDIX A. ANSWERS TO PRACTICE EXERCISES 449 Table A.0.4 Set Normal Form 1 [11, 1, 3, 5, 6] 2 [5, 8, 10, 0] 3 [9, 0, 1, 4, 5] 4 P0 [3, 5, 6, 10] 5 [2, 3, 6, 7, 9, 10] 6 [2, 3, 5, 6, 9, 10] Prime Form Forte Number (01357) 5–24 (0247) 4–22 (01458) 5–21 (0237) 4–14 R0 (013478) 6–Z19 (013478) 6–Z19 Interval Vector 131221 021120 202420 111120 313431 313431 bœ nœ œ nœ œ bœ œ bœ bœ œ bœ œ nœ #œ #œ nœ nœ bœ bœ nœ œ œ & œ bœ œ œ #œ #œ nœ œ bœ bœ œ œ #œ nœ nœ &(a)œ[5,n œ 8,# œ9]n œ œ b œ b œ n œ œ # œ # œ I0 RI0 33.9.3. Answer. (b) [9, 11, 3, 4] I (begins on pitch class 9) & œ #œ #œ nœ œ nœ œ #œ œ #œ #œ #œ (c) 9[10, 11, 1, 4, 7] 33.9.4. Answer. (a) [1, 2, 5] œ #œ #œ nœ œ bœ bœ œ bœ nœ nœ nœ & (b)RI[0, 2, 4] on pitch class 5) 5 (ends (c) [10, 11, 3, 5] 33.9.5. Answer. (a) T10 I & P7: 7 10 8 2 1 5 3 4 6 0 9 11 R7 (b) T11 I (c) T5 I I 34 · 7Serialism & · Practice Exercises 34.7 RI7 34.7.1. Answer. œ bœ nœ #œ nœ nœ œ œ #œ œ bœ nœ #œ œ bœ nœ œ bœ œ & œ bœ bœ œ #œ P7: 7 10 8 2 1 5 3 4 6 0 9 11 R7 RI7 œ7 œ # œ œ b œ n œ b œ b œ œ œ bœ nœ bœ œ #œ nœ œ n œ œ b œ œ b œ bœ nœ & I 62 62 PP11 & #œ & (a) (b) œ ? & #œ #œ R4 R 4 8 bœ II8 & œ 10 ? bœ bœ & bœ bœ RI10 RI œ bœ œ œ bœ bœ œ #œ œ œ œ bœ bœ œ œ nœ bœ nœ nœ nœ œ œ #œ #œ œ œ nœ bœ œ bœ nœ nœ œ #œ œ #œ œ nœ œ nœ œ b œ nn œœ n œ bb œœ nœ œ bœ 61 ? R R44 bœ bœ œ nœ bœ nœ nœ nœ bœ nœ # œ ANSWERS # œ œ TO PRACTICE EXERCISES APPENDIX A. (c) & b œ8 II8 œ #œ œ ? bœ bœ RI RI10 10 (d) œ #œ œ #œ œ bœ nœ nœ 450 œ bœ œ bœ nœ nœ œ nœ œ #œ œ 34.7.2. Answer. & (a) RI10 (b) I1 (c) R5 34.7.3. Answer. Table A.0.5 Twelve-Tone Matrix I3 ↓ E2 B G F D2 G2 E A2 P3 → P11 → P7 → P5 → P1 → P6 → P4 → P8 → P0 → P2 → P10 → P9 → I7 ↓ G D4 I11 ↓ B G D4 C4 B A F B2 G4 C E F4 D C4 C D B2 A ↑RI3 ↑RI7 A D C E A2 A4 G2 F ↑RI11 I1 ↓ C4 A F E2 B E D G2 B2 C A2 G ↑RI1 I5 ↓ F C4 I0 ↓ C G4 A G E2 A2 G2 B2 E D B2 E2 D2 D E C B ↑RI5 I2 ↓ D A4 F4 E C F E2 F A B G F4 G B D2 A A2 ↑RI0 ↑RI2 I10 ↓ B2 F4 D C A2 D2 B E2 G A F E ↑RI10 I6 ↓ G2 D B2 A2 I4 ↓ E C A2 G2 E A G B E2 F D2 C ↑RI6 D G F A D2 E2 B B2 œ. . . . > RI5 . b œ . œ # œ # œ # œ n œœ b œœ. b œ n œ b œ . œ nœ œ. bœ œ & c ‰ œ bœ œ #œ w > p 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 34.7.4. Answer. 184 P5 P10 # œ. > n œœ # œ. 4 n n œœ. 9 >12 . n œ. n œ. w . b œ œ . # œ œ b œ œ b œ ‰ J œ 65 œ 8 b œ œ b œ œ n œ. œ b œ #œ 1 ?c Œ 187 2 3 4 5/6 7 8/9 10/11 12 2 3 1 RI3 34.7.5. Answer. In phase 7 10 11 1 23 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 Out of phase 12 In phase (a) Set 1: 3, 7, 11. Normal form: [3, 7, 11] Prime form: (048) Interval œ. . œ. . œ. . œ. . œ . œ . .. œ œ000300 & 85vector: œ œ . . œ œ œ œ . . œ œ œ œ . . œ œ œ œ . . œ œ œ œ . œœœœ . 12345 12345 12345 12345 12345 12345 (b) Set 2:1 2 1, 5, 0. 2Normal form: [0, 1, 5] Prime form: (015)1 Interval 345 3451 34512 45123 51234 2345 vector: 100110 & 85 .. œ œ œ œ œ .. .. œ œ œ œ œ .. .. œ œ œ œ œ .. .. œ œ œ œ œ .. .. œ œ œ œ œ .. œ œ œ œ œ .. (c) Set 3: 2, 10, 6. Normal form: [2, 6, 10] Prime form: (048) Interval vector: 000300 193 & b b www ? ww first rotation # # # wwww b ww second rotation third rotation # www b www fourth rotation bw b ww bw 213 ↑RI4 I8 ↓ G4 E C B2 G2 B A D2 F G D4 D ↑RI8 I9 ↓ A F D2 B G C B2 D G2 A2 E E2 ↑RI9 ←R ←R ←R ←R ←R ←R ←R ←R ←R ←R ←R ←R APPENDIX A. ANSWERS TO PRACTICE EXERCISES 451 (d) Set 4: 4, 8, 9. Normal form: [4, 8, 9] Prime form: (015) Interval vector: 100110 Appendix B GNU Free Documentation License Version 1.3, 3 November 2008 Copyright © 2000, 2001, 2002, 2007, 2008 Free Software Foundation, Inc. <http://www.fsf.org/> Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies of this license document, but changing it is not allowed. 0. PREAMBLE. The purpose of this License is to make a manual, textbook, or other functional and useful document “free” in the sense of freedom: to assure everyone the effective freedom to copy and redistribute it, with or without modifying it, either commercially or noncommercially. Secondarily, this License preserves for the author and publisher a way to get credit for their work, while not being considered responsible for modifications made by others. This License is a kind of “copyleft”, which means that derivative works of the document must themselves be free in the same sense. It complements the GNU General Public License, which is a copyleft license designed for free software. We have designed this License in order to use it for manuals for free software, because free software needs free documentation: a free program should come with manuals providing the same freedoms that the software does. But this License is not limited to software manuals; it can be used for any textual work, regardless of subject matter or whether it is published as a printed book. We recommend this License principally for works whose purpose is instruction or reference. 1. APPLICABILITY AND DEFINITIONS. This License applies to any manual or other work, in any medium, that contains a notice placed by the copyright holder saying it can be distributed under the terms of this License. Such a notice grants a world-wide, royalty-free license, unlimited in duration, to use that work under the conditions stated herein. The “Document”, below, refers to any such manual or work. Any member of the public is a licensee, and is addressed as “you”. You accept the license if you copy, modify or distribute the work in a way requiring permission under copyright law. A “Modified Version” of the Document means any work containing the Document or a portion of it, either copied verbatim, or with modifications and/or translated into another language. 452 APPENDIX B. GNU FREE DOCUMENTATION LICENSE 453 A “Secondary Section” is a named appendix or a front-matter section of the Document that deals exclusively with the relationship of the publishers or authors of the Document to the Document’s overall subject (or to related matters) and contains nothing that could fall directly within that overall subject. (Thus, if the Document is in part a textbook of mathematics, a Secondary Section may not explain any mathematics.) The relationship could be a matter of historical connection with the subject or with related matters, or of legal, commercial, philosophical, ethical or political position regarding them. The “Invariant Sections” are certain Secondary Sections whose titles are designated, as being those of Invariant Sections, in the notice that says that the Document is released under this License. If a section does not fit the above definition of Secondary then it is not allowed to be designated as Invariant. The Document may contain zero Invariant Sections. If the Document does not identify any Invariant Sections then there are none. The “Cover Texts” are certain short passages of text that are listed, as Front-Cover Texts or Back-Cover Texts, in the notice that says that the Document is released under this License. A Front-Cover Text may be at most 5 words, and a Back-Cover Text may be at most 25 words. A “Transparent” copy of the Document means a machine-readable copy, represented in a format whose specification is available to the general public, that is suitable for revising the document straightforwardly with generic text editors or (for images composed of pixels) generic paint programs or (for drawings) some widely available drawing editor, and that is suitable for input to text formatters or for automatic translation to a variety of formats suitable for input to text formatters. A copy made in an otherwise Transparent file format whose markup, or absence of markup, has been arranged to thwart or discourage subsequent modification by readers is not Transparent. An image format is not Transparent if used for any substantial amount of text. A copy that is not “Transparent” is called “Opaque”. Examples of suitable formats for Transparent copies include plain ASCII without markup, Texinfo input format, LaTeX input format, SGML or XML using a publicly available DTD, and standard-conforming simple HTML, PostScript or PDF designed for human modification. Examples of transparent image formats include PNG, XCF and JPG. Opaque formats include proprietary formats that can be read and edited only by proprietary word processors, SGML or XML for which the DTD and/or processing tools are not generally available, and the machine-generated HTML, PostScript or PDF produced by some word processors for output purposes only. The “Title Page” means, for a printed book, the title page itself, plus such following pages as are needed to hold, legibly, the material this License requires to appear in the title page. For works in formats which do not have any title page as such, “Title Page” means the text near the most prominent appearance of the work’s title, preceding the beginning of the body of the text. The “publisher” means any person or entity that distributes copies of the Document to the public. A section “Entitled XYZ” means a named subunit of the Document whose title either is precisely XYZ or contains XYZ in parentheses following text that translates XYZ in another language. (Here XYZ stands for a specific section name mentioned below, such as “Acknowledgements”, “Dedications”, “Endorsements”, or “History”.) To “Preserve the Title” of such a section when you modify the Document means that it remains a section “Entitled XYZ” according to this definition. The Document may include Warranty Disclaimers next to the notice which states that this License applies to the Document. These Warranty Disclaimers APPENDIX B. GNU FREE DOCUMENTATION LICENSE 454 are considered to be included by reference in this License, but only as regards disclaiming warranties: any other implication that these Warranty Disclaimers may have is void and has no effect on the meaning of this License. 2. VERBATIM COPYING. You may copy and distribute the Document in any medium, either commercially or noncommercially, provided that this License, the copyright notices, and the license notice saying this License applies to the Document are reproduced in all copies, and that you add no other conditions whatsoever to those of this License. You may not use technical measures to obstruct or control the reading or further copying of the copies you make or distribute. However, you may accept compensation in exchange for copies. If you distribute a large enough number of copies you must also follow the conditions in section 3. You may also lend copies, under the same conditions stated above, and you may publicly display copies. 3. COPYING IN QUANTITY. If you publish printed copies (or copies in media that commonly have printed covers) of the Document, numbering more than 100, and the Document’s license notice requires Cover Texts, you must enclose the copies in covers that carry, clearly and legibly, all these Cover Texts: Front-Cover Texts on the front cover, and Back-Cover Texts on the back cover. Both covers must also clearly and legibly identify you as the publisher of these copies. The front cover must present the full title with all words of the title equally prominent and visible. You may add other material on the covers in addition. Copying with changes limited to the covers, as long as they preserve the title of the Document and satisfy these conditions, can be treated as verbatim copying in other respects. If the required texts for either cover are too voluminous to fit legibly, you should put the first ones listed (as many as fit reasonably) on the actual cover, and continue the rest onto adjacent pages. If you publish or distribute Opaque copies of the Document numbering more than 100, you must either include a machine-readable Transparent copy along with each Opaque copy, or state in or with each Opaque copy a computernetwork location from which the general network-using public has access to download using public-standard network protocols a complete Transparent copy of the Document, free of added material. If you use the latter option, you must take reasonably prudent steps, when you begin distribution of Opaque copies in quantity, to ensure that this Transparent copy will remain thus accessible at the stated location until at least one year after the last time you distribute an Opaque copy (directly or through your agents or retailers) of that edition to the public. It is requested, but not required, that you contact the authors of the Document well before redistributing any large number of copies, to give them a chance to provide you with an updated version of the Document. 4. MODIFICATIONS. You may copy and distribute a Modified Version of the Document under the conditions of sections 2 and 3 above, provided that you release the Modified Version under precisely this License, with the Modified Version filling the role of the Document, thus licensing distribution and modification of the Modified Version to whoever possesses a copy of it. In addition, you must do these things in the Modified Version: A. Use in the Title Page (and on the covers, if any) a title distinct from that of the Document, and from those of previous versions (which should, if APPENDIX B. GNU FREE DOCUMENTATION LICENSE 455 there were any, be listed in the History section of the Document). You may use the same title as a previous version if the original publisher of that version gives permission. B. List on the Title Page, as authors, one or more persons or entities responsible for authorship of the modifications in the Modified Version, together with at least five of the principal authors of the Document (all of its principal authors, if it has fewer than five), unless they release you from this requirement. C. State on the Title page the name of the publisher of the Modified Version, as the publisher. D. Preserve all the copyright notices of the Document. E. Add an appropriate copyright notice for your modifications adjacent to the other copyright notices. F. Include, immediately after the copyright notices, a license notice giving the public permission to use the Modified Version under the terms of this License, in the form shown in the Addendum below. G. Preserve in that license notice the full lists of Invariant Sections and required Cover Texts given in the Document’s license notice. H. Include an unaltered copy of this License. I. Preserve the section Entitled “History”, Preserve its Title, and add to it an item stating at least the title, year, new authors, and publisher of the Modified Version as given on the Title Page. If there is no section Entitled “History” in the Document, create one stating the title, year, authors, and publisher of the Document as given on its Title Page, then add an item describing the Modified Version as stated in the previous sentence. J. Preserve the network location, if any, given in the Document for public access to a Transparent copy of the Document, and likewise the network locations given in the Document for previous versions it was based on. These may be placed in the “History” section. You may omit a network location for a work that was published at least four years before the Document itself, or if the original publisher of the version it refers to gives permission. K. For any section Entitled “Acknowledgements” or “Dedications”, Preserve the Title of the section, and preserve in the section all the substance and tone of each of the contributor acknowledgements and/or dedications given therein. L. Preserve all the Invariant Sections of the Document, unaltered in their text and in their titles. Section numbers or the equivalent are not considered part of the section titles. M. Delete any section Entitled “Endorsements”. Such a section may not be included in the Modified Version. N. Do not retitle any existing section to be Entitled “Endorsements” or to conflict in title with any Invariant Section. O. Preserve any Warranty Disclaimers. APPENDIX B. GNU FREE DOCUMENTATION LICENSE 456 If the Modified Version includes new front-matter sections or appendices that qualify as Secondary Sections and contain no material copied from the Document, you may at your option designate some or all of these sections as invariant. To do this, add their titles to the list of Invariant Sections in the Modified Version’s license notice. These titles must be distinct from any other section titles. You may add a section Entitled “Endorsements”, provided it contains nothing but endorsements of your Modified Version by various parties — for example, statements of peer review or that the text has been approved by an organization as the authoritative definition of a standard. You may add a passage of up to five words as a Front-Cover Text, and a passage of up to 25 words as a Back-Cover Text, to the end of the list of Cover Texts in the Modified Version. Only one passage of Front-Cover Text and one of Back-Cover Text may be added by (or through arrangements made by) any one entity. If the Document already includes a cover text for the same cover, previously added by you or by arrangement made by the same entity you are acting on behalf of, you may not add another; but you may replace the old one, on explicit permission from the previous publisher that added the old one. The author(s) and publisher(s) of the Document do not by this License give permission to use their names for publicity for or to assert or imply endorsement of any Modified Version. 5. COMBINING DOCUMENTS. You may combine the Document with other documents released under this License, under the terms defined in section 4 above for modified versions, provided that you include in the combination all of the Invariant Sections of all of the original documents, unmodified, and list them all as Invariant Sections of your combined work in its license notice, and that you preserve all their Warranty Disclaimers. The combined work need only contain one copy of this License, and multiple identical Invariant Sections may be replaced with a single copy. If there are multiple Invariant Sections with the same name but different contents, make the title of each such section unique by adding at the end of it, in parentheses, the name of the original author or publisher of that section if known, or else a unique number. Make the same adjustment to the section titles in the list of Invariant Sections in the license notice of the combined work. In the combination, you must combine any sections Entitled “History” in the various original documents, forming one section Entitled “History”; likewise combine any sections Entitled “Acknowledgements”, and any sections Entitled “Dedications”. You must delete all sections Entitled “Endorsements”. 6. COLLECTIONS OF DOCUMENTS. You may make a collection consisting of the Document and other documents released under this License, and replace the individual copies of this License in the various documents with a single copy that is included in the collection, provided that you follow the rules of this License for verbatim copying of each of the documents in all other respects. You may extract a single document from such a collection, and distribute it individually under this License, provided you insert a copy of this License into the extracted document, and follow this License in all other respects regarding verbatim copying of that document. 7. AGGREGATION WITH INDEPENDENT WORKS. A compilation of the Document or its derivatives with other separate and independent APPENDIX B. GNU FREE DOCUMENTATION LICENSE 457 documents or works, in or on a volume of a storage or distribution medium, is called an “aggregate” if the copyright resulting from the compilation is not used to limit the legal rights of the compilation’s users beyond what the individual works permit. When the Document is included in an aggregate, this License does not apply to the other works in the aggregate which are not themselves derivative works of the Document. If the Cover Text requirement of section 3 is applicable to these copies of the Document, then if the Document is less than one half of the entire aggregate, the Document’s Cover Texts may be placed on covers that bracket the Document within the aggregate, or the electronic equivalent of covers if the Document is in electronic form. Otherwise they must appear on printed covers that bracket the whole aggregate. 8. TRANSLATION. Translation is considered a kind of modification, so you may distribute translations of the Document under the terms of section 4. Replacing Invariant Sections with translations requires special permission from their copyright holders, but you may include translations of some or all Invariant Sections in addition to the original versions of these Invariant Sections. You may include a translation of this License, and all the license notices in the Document, and any Warranty Disclaimers, provided that you also include the original English version of this License and the original versions of those notices and disclaimers. In case of a disagreement between the translation and the original version of this License or a notice or disclaimer, the original version will prevail. If a section in the Document is Entitled “Acknowledgements”, “Dedications”, or “History”, the requirement (section 4) to Preserve its Title (section 1) will typically require changing the actual title. 9. TERMINATION. You may not copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute the Document except as expressly provided under this License. Any attempt otherwise to copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute it is void, and will automatically terminate your rights under this License. However, if you cease all violation of this License, then your license from a particular copyright holder is reinstated (a) provisionally, unless and until the copyright holder explicitly and finally terminates your license, and (b) permanently, if the copyright holder fails to notify you of the violation by some reasonable means prior to 60 days after the cessation. Moreover, your license from a particular copyright holder is reinstated permanently if the copyright holder notifies you of the violation by some reasonable means, this is the first time you have received notice of violation of this License (for any work) from that copyright holder, and you cure the violation prior to 30 days after your receipt of the notice. Termination of your rights under this section does not terminate the licenses of parties who have received copies or rights from you under this License. If your rights have been terminated and not permanently reinstated, receipt of a copy of some or all of the same material does not give you any rights to use it. 10. FUTURE REVISIONS OF THIS LICENSE. The Free Software Foundation may publish new, revised versions of the GNU Free Documentation License from time to time. Such new versions will be similar in spirit to the present version, but may differ in detail to address new problems or concerns. See http://www.gnu.org/copyleft/. Each version of the License is given a distinguishing version number. If the Document specifies that a particular numbered version of this License “or APPENDIX B. GNU FREE DOCUMENTATION LICENSE 458 any later version” applies to it, you have the option of following the terms and conditions either of that specified version or of any later version that has been published (not as a draft) by the Free Software Foundation. If the Document does not specify a version number of this License, you may choose any version ever published (not as a draft) by the Free Software Foundation. If the Document specifies that a proxy can decide which future versions of this License can be used, that proxy’s public statement of acceptance of a version permanently authorizes you to choose that version for the Document. 11. RELICENSING. “Massive Multiauthor Collaboration Site” (or “MMC Site”) means any World Wide Web server that publishes copyrightable works and also provides prominent facilities for anybody to edit those works. A public wiki that anybody can edit is an example of such a server. A “Massive Multiauthor Collaboration” (or “MMC”) contained in the site means any set of copyrightable works thus published on the MMC site. “CC-BY-SA” means the Creative Commons Attribution-Share Alike 3.0 license published by Creative Commons Corporation, a not-for-profit corporation with a principal place of business in San Francisco, California, as well as future copyleft versions of that license published by that same organization. “Incorporate” means to publish or republish a Document, in whole or in part, as part of another Document. An MMC is “eligible for relicensing” if it is licensed under this License, and if all works that were first published under this License somewhere other than this MMC, and subsequently incorporated in whole or in part into the MMC, (1) had no cover texts or invariant sections, and (2) were thus incorporated prior to November 1, 2008. The operator of an MMC Site may republish an MMC contained in the site under CC-BY-SA on the same site at any time before August 1, 2009, provided the MMC is eligible for relicensing. ADDENDUM: How to use this License for your documents. To use this License in a document you have written, include a copy of the License in the document and put the following copyright and license notices just after the title page: Copyright (C) YEAR YOUR NAME. Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled "GNU Free Documentation License". If you have Invariant Sections, Front-Cover Texts and Back-Cover Texts, replace the “with. . . Texts.” line with this: with the Invariant Sections being LIST THEIR TITLES, with the Front-Cover Texts being LIST, and with the Back-Cover Texts being LIST. If you have Invariant Sections without Cover Texts, or some other combination of the three, merge those two alternatives to suit the situation. If your document contains nontrivial examples of program code, we recommend releasing these examples in parallel under your choice of free software license, such as the GNU General Public License, to permit their use in free software. Index 6 9 Crucifixus, 232 Kyrie II, 362 Well-Tempered Clavier, Book I Fugue 2 in C minor, BWV 846, 354 Fugue 3 in C-sharp major, BWV 848, 343 Prelude 1 in C major, 72, 94 Brandenburg Concerto No. 2 in F Major, BWV 1047, I., 56 Chorale 103, “Nun ruhen alle Wälder”, BWV 392, 317 Chorale 106, “Jesu Leiden, Pein und Tod”, BWV 245/28, 317 Chorale 153, “Alle Menschen müssen sterben”, BWV 262, 316 Chorale 204, “Wer weiß, wie nahe mir”, BWV 166, 318 Chorale 237, “Gott lebel noch”, BWV 320, 316 Chorale 323, “Allein Gott in der Höh’ sei Erh”’, BWV 104, 330 Chorale 323, “Wie schön leuchtet der Morgenstern”, BWV 172, 330 Chorale 328, “Liebster Jesu, wir sind hier,” BWV 373, 97 Chorale 342, “Lobt Gott, ihr Christen, allzugleich”, BWV 376, 329 Chorale 4, “Es ist das Heil chords, 365 11th chords, 365 13th chords, 365 1950s progression, 75 3–2 son clave, 164 8ve, 2 accidentals, 3 afterbeats, 160 altered chords definition of, 366 alto clef, 2 Amazing Grace, 44 antecedent definition of, 128 antecedent group, 132 anticipation, 92 appoggiatura, 89 atonal music definition of, 392 augmentation, 107 augmented intervals, 30 augmented sixth chord types French augmented sixth chord, 224 German augmented sixth chord, 224 Italian augmented sixth chord, 224 augmented sixth chords, 224 authentic cadence definition of, 42 musical examples, 43 Bach, J.S. Herz und Mund und Tat und Leben BWV 147, X. “Jesus bleibet Freude” (“Jesu, Joy of Man’s Desiring”), 202 Mass in B minor, BWV 232 459 INDEX uns kommen her”, 244 Chorale 8, “Freuet euch, ihr Christen”, BWV 40, 244 English Suite No 3 in G minor, BWV 808 Gavotte I., 281 English Suite No. 4 in F Major, BWV 809, Sarabande, 240, 242, 243, 245 French Suite No. 1 in D Minor, BWV 812, Sarabande, 97, 218 Invention No. 1 in C Major, BWV 772, 106, 107, 111, 350, 353 Invention No. 7 in E Minor, BWV 778, 350 Invention No. 8 in F major, BWV 779, 276 Barber, Samuel Adagio for Strings, 96, 143 Bartók, Béla Piano Concerto No. 2, II., 388 bass clef, 1 beat, 20 beats per minute, 20 Beethoven Moonlight Sonata, Op. 27, No. 2, I, 146, 221 Moonlight Sonata, Op. 27, No. 2, III Terminative function in Closing Theme, 300 32 Variations in C minor, WoO 80, 233 Bagatelle in A minor, WoO 59, “Für Elise” period form, 128 Eleven Bagatelles, Op. 119, No. 9, 286 Minuet in G, WoO 10, No. 2, 89 Pathétique Sonata, Op. 13, I, 269 Pathétique Sonata, Op. 13, I, closing theme, 75 Pathétique Sonata, Op. 13, I, Introduction, 109 Pathétique Sonata, Op. 13, II, 323 Pathétique Sonata, Op. 13, III, 301 Piano Sonata in C minor, Op. 460 13, (Pathétique), II, 130 Piano Sonata Op. 10, No. 1, II (double period), 133 Piano Sonata Op. 110, I, 247 Piano Sonata Op. 2, No. 1, I sentence structure in, 124 Piano Sonata Op. 2, No. 1, III., 255 Piano Sonata Op. 2, No. 1, IV, 160 Piano Sonata Op. 2, No. 3, I., 69 Piano Sonata Op. 53, I, 199 Piano Sonata Op. 53, I (repeated period), 135 Sonatina in F, Anh. 5 No. 2, II. Rondo (phrase chain), 138 Symphony No. 1, Op. 21, I, 103 Symphony No. 2, Op. 36, I., 252 Symphony No. 5, Op. 67, I, 226 Symphony No. 5, Op. 67, I. (opening), 59 Symphony No. 5, Op. 67, II, 266, 270 Symphony No. 7, Op. 92, I, 220 binary balanced, 276 rounded, 278 simple, 281 binary principle, 282 Bizet, Georges Carmen, Habanera (“L’amour est un oiseau rebelle”), 168 Bo Diddley beat, 165 borrowed chords definition of, 207 bpm, 20 Brahms, Johannes Fünf Lieder, Op. 49 “Wiegenlied”, 274 Symphony No. 3 in F major, Op. 90, III. Poco Allegretto, 212 cadence authentic, 42 deceptive, 42 definition of, 42 INDEX half, 42 plagal, 42 cadential six-four (cadential 64 ), 184 Calloway, Reggie, “Casanova”, 166 Chopin, Frédéric Nocturne in E-flat major, Op. 9, No. 2, 219 Prelude Op. 28, No. 20, in C minor, 132 Waltz in A-flat major, Op. 34 No. 1, 74 chord, 32 chromatic mediants, 253 circle of fifths, 7 circle of fifths (harmonic progression) diagram, 57 example (Bach), 56 example (Fly Me to the Moon), 59 example (Handel), 56 example (I Will Survive), 59 example (Love You Like a Love Song), 59 example (Mozart), 58 example (Wagner), 58 circle of fifths (major key signatures) diagram, 8 circle of fifths (minor key signatures) diagram, 12 clef, 1 closely related keys definition of, 241 Coltrane, John “Mr. P.C.”, 229 Columbia, the Gem of the Ocean, 50 common-tone modulation, 251 complement definition of, 401 compound meter, 20 consequent definition of, 128 consequent group, 132 continuous definition of, 275 contrasting period, 129 contrasting verse-chorus form, 119 Copland, Aaron Appalachian Spring, 387, 390 counterpoint 461 definition of, 343 Couperin, Franéois 5 Pièces de Clavecin, 4. Le Petit-Rien (Ordre XIV, 8) (phrase group), 137 Davis, Miles “Tune-Up”, 62 Debussy, Claude Danses, II. Danse profane, 383 Préludes, Book II, No. 3, La Puerto del Vino, 384 Prelude to the Afternoon of a Faun, 385, 386 Suite bergamasque, III. Clair de lune, 384 String Quartet in G minor, Op. 10, I., 382 deceptive cadence definition of, 42 musical examples, 45, 47 developmental function definition of, 299 diatonic definition of, 40 diatonic common chord modulation, 242 diminished intervals, 30 diminution, 107 direct modulation, 248 distantly related keys, 241 dot, 19 double flat, 3 double neighbor, 91 double period definition of, 132 double sharp, 3 duplet, 21 durational symbols, 18 elision, 138 Ellington, Duke “It Don’t Mean A Thing (If It Ain’t Got That Swing)”, 227 “Take the ‘A’ Train”, 61 enharmonic, 4 enharmonic equivalence, 393 enharmonic modulation, 262 escape tone, 90 expository function definition of, 296 figured bass chromatic alterations to, 187 INDEX definition of, 181 for seventh chords, 183 for triads, 183 first inversion, 34 flat, 3 foreign keys, 241 Forte number, 401 Forte, Allen The Structure of Atonal Music, 392 fragment, 110 fugue answer definition of, 353 bridge definition of, 354 countersubject definition of, 354 definition of, 353 episode definition of, 353 exposition definition of, 353 subject definition of, 353 Giacchino, Michael Star Trek, “End Credits”, 222 Giordani, Giuseppe Caro mio ben, 327 Glass, Philip Einstein on the Beach Act 1, Scene 1, “Train”, 418 Music in Fifths, 418 Two Pages, 418 Metamorphosis Two, 84 grand staff, 2 Gretchaninoff, Alexander Children’s Book, Op.98 No. 13 “After the Ball”, 291 guide tones, 371 half cadence definition of, 42 Handel, George Frideric Rinaldo, “Lascia ch’io pianga”, 93 Xerxes, “Ombra mai fu”, 158 Gavotte, HWV 491, 288 Recorder Sonata in A minor, HWV 362, I. Larghetto, 182 Suite in G minor, Passacaglia, 56 462 Suite No. 2 in D Major, HWV 349: II. All Hornpipe, 96 harmonic flowchart in major, 68 in minor, 68 harmonic function definition of, 67 harmonic rhythm definition of, 60 harmonic sequence, 59 harmony, 32 Haydn Piano Sonata in D major, H. XVI:37, III, 304 String Quartet in E-flat major, Op. 33, No. 2, IV, 305 Symphony No. 104 in D major, Hob. I:104, IV, 305 Haydn, Joseph Piano Sonata in C major, Hob. XVI:35, I, 297 Piano Sonata in C Major, Hob. XVI:35, III, 91 Piano Sonata in F Major, Hob. XVI:9, III period form, 127 Symphony No. 94 in G major, Hob. I:94, II, 275 Holst, Gustav The Planets, “Uranus”, 108 imperfect authentic cadence definition of, 123 Impressionism, 382 incomplete chords, 48 interval class definition of, 399 interval vector definition of, 399 intervallic change, 107 intervals augmented, 30 definition of, 26 diminished, 30 harmonic, 26 how to identify, 27 how to write, 29 inversion of, 29 major, 27 melodic, 26 minor, 27 perfect, 27 INDEX inversion, 106 inverted chord, 34 inverted triad, 34 key change, 237 key signature, 6 Kirkland, Kenny Dienda, 23 Kuhlau, Friedrich Sonatina in C Major, Op. 55, No. 1, I, 92 Lassus, Orlande de Expectatio Justorum, 349 lead-sheet symbols, 32 ledger lines, 1 Ligeti, György Trio for Violin, Horn, and Piano, II, 168 Loesser, Frank Hans Christian Andersen, “Inchworm”, 213 M.M. (Maelzel’s Metronome), 20 Maelzel’s Metronome, 20 Mancini, Henry “The Pink Panther Theme”, 229 melodic bass six-four, 186 meter, 20 compound, 20 duple, 20 quadruple, 20 simple, 20 triple, 20 middle C, 2 minor parallel, 11 relative, 11 Miranda, Lin-Manuel “First Burn”, 23 mode mixture definition of, 207 modes Aeolian, 376 Dorian, 376 Ionian, 376 Locrian, 376 Locrian 42, 376 Lydian, 376 Lydian-Augmented, 376 Lydian-Dominant, 376 Mixolydian, 376 Mixolydian-26̂ , 376 Phrygian, 376 463 Phrygian-Dorian, 376 modulation borrowed common chord, 246 common-tone, 251 definition of, 237 diatonic common chord, 242 direct, 248 enharmonic pivot chord, 262 Neapolitan common chord, 247 secondary common chord, 245 sequential, 255 Monk, Thelonious “Blue Monk”, 88 motion, types of contrary motion, 311 oblique motion, 311 parallel motion, 311 similar motion, 311 motive definition of, 103 Mozart, W.A. Don Giovanni, K. 527, “Mi tradi quell’alma ingrata”, 257 Eine kleine Nachtmusik, K. 525, I., 47 Eine kleine Nachtmusik, K. 525, I. (elision), 139 Eine kleine Nachtmusik, K. 525, II., 176 Marriage of Figaro, “Voi che sapete”, 45 Andante in E-flat major, K. 15mm, 283 Ave verum corpus, K. 618, 47 Oboe Concerto in C major, K. 314, III., 256 Piano Sonata in C Major, K. 545, II, 113 Piano Sonata in D major, K. 284, III., 279 Piano Sonata K. 279, III, 161 Piano Sonata K. 283, I., 69 Piano Sonata K. 310, I, 155 Piano Sonata K. 331, I, 289, 324 antecendent and consequent in, 129 period form, 126, 184 sentence structure in, 124 Piano Sonata K. 333, I, 92 Piano Sonata K. 545, I, 149 INDEX Piano Sonata K. 545, I., primary theme, 54 Piano Sonata K. 545, I., secondary theme, 58 Piano Sonata K. 545, II, 98 Piano Sonata, K. 284, I, 298 Piano Sonata, K. 333, I, 296 sentence structure in, 125 String Quartet K. 425, IV, 305 String Quartet K. 428, IV, 144 String Quartet K. 465, IV, 305 Symphony No. 39 K.543, IV, 305 Symphony No. 40, K. 550, I. harmonic function in primary theme, 72 Symphony No. 40, K. 550, I. (opening melody), 60 Symphony No. 40, K. 550, II, 90 Symphony No. 40, K. 550, III, 113 Symphony No. 41, K. 551, I. Terminative function in Closing Theme, 300 natural, 3 Neapolitan definition of, 220 neighbor group, 91 neighbor tone, 88 ninth chords, 364 non-chord tones definition of, 87 normal form definition of, 395 octave, 2 octave equivalence, 393 octave registers, 2 offbeats, 161 order of flats, 7 order of sharps, 7 ornamentation, 109 pandiatonicism, 386 parallel minor, 11 parallel period, 129 passing six-four, 185 passing tone, 87 pedal point, 93 pedal six-four, 186 464 Perfect Authentic Cadence, 123 period definition of, 125 phrase definition of, 111 phrase chain definition of, 137 phrase group definition of, 136 pitch, 1 pitch class, 393 plagal cadence definition of, 42 musical examples, 43 polychord definition of, 388 prime form definition of, 396 Puccini, Giacomo Gianni Schicchi, “O mio babbino caro”, 99 pulse, 20 Purcell, Henry Dido and Aeneas, Z. 636 “When I am laid in earth” (Dido’s Lament), 232 quadruplet, 21 quartal harmony definition of, 387 quintal harmony definition of, 387 quintuplet, 21 Rachmaninoff, Sergei Prelude in C-sharp minor, Op. 3 No. 2, 284 Rahn, John Basic Atonal Theory, 392 Ravel, Maurice Pavane pour une infante défunte, 385 Piano Trio, I., 383 Reich, Steve Clapping Music, 418 Piano Phase, 419 Three Movements, II., 420 relative minor, 11 repeated period, 134 retardation, 98 retrograde, 110 rhythmic change, 108 rondo form, 301 root, 32 INDEX root position, 34 Rossini, Gioachino William Tell Overture, 228 Saint-Georges, Joseph Bologne, Chevalier de Violin Concerto No. 9 in G major, Op. 8, III., 304 scale degree names, 14 scales Altered, 376 bebop dominant, 375 bebop major scale, 378 Blues scale, 375 diminished scale, 376 Diminished-Whole Tone, 376 Octatonic (Half-Whole), 376 Octatonic (Whole-Half), 376 Whole Tone, 376 Schönberg, Claude-Michel Les Miserables “One My Own”, 267 Schoenberg, Arnold Chamber Symphony No. 1, Op. 9, 388 Suite for Piano, Op. 25, 408 Schubert Schwanegesang, D. 957 “Abschied”, 237, 246 “Der Atlas”, 271 “Frühlingssehnsucht”, 248 “Kriegers Ahnung”, 250 “Liebesbotschaft”, 249 Winterreise, D. 911 “Der Wegweiser”, 227 “Die Nebensonnen”, 145 “Frühlingstraum”, 324 “Gute Nacht”, 156 20 Minuets, D. 41 No. 18 in F major, 280 Piano Trio No. 1 in B-flat major, D. 898, I., 253 Schumann, Clara Op. 13, No. 2, “Sie liebten sich beide”, 94 Schumann, Robert Album for the Young, Op. 68, No. 16, “First Loss”, 117 Dichterliebe, Op. 48 “Am leuchtenden Sommermorgen”, 231 “Ich grolle nicht”, 156 “Im wunderschönen Monat Mai”, 101 465 Album for the Young, Op. 68, No. 17, “Little Morning Wanderer”, 131, 241 second inversion, 34 second line drumming, 166 secondary diminished chord, 201 sectional definition of, 274 secundal harmony definition of, 387 segmentation definition of, 398 semitone, 393 sentence definition of, 123 sentence structure example of, 124 sequence definition of, 59 sequential modulation, 255 set theory, 392 seventh chord definition of, 51 example of 5 types, 51 sharp, 3 simple meter, 20 simple verse-chorus form, 119 slash chord, 34 slur, 19 sonata form, 294 sonatina form, 295 songs (popular) CHiPs Theme, 388 Jeopardy Theme, 388 “(Sittin’ On) The Dock of the Bay” (Otis Redding), 198 “All About That Bass” (Meghan Trainor), 73 “All I Do Is Win” (DJ Khaled), 83 “All My Ex’s Live in Texas” (George Strait), 71 “All of Me” (John Legend), 76, 167 “All the Things You Are”, 63 “Another One Bites the Dust” (Queen), 173 “Are You Gonna Be My Girl” (Jet), 155 “As Time Goes By” (from the motion picture Casablanca), 62, 88 INDEX “Baby Love” (The Supremes), 197 “Back in Black” (AC/DC), 174 “Back in the New York Groove” (Ace Frehley), 165 “Barbara Ann” (Beach Boys), 154 “Barbie Girl” (Aqua), 63 “Beautiful Day” (U2), 170 “Beautiful” (Christina Aguilera), 209 “Best of You” (Foo Fighters), 168 “Beyond The Sea”, 64 “Blackbird” (The Beatles), 207 “Blue Moon”, 64 “Born to Run” (Springsteen), 89 “Call Me” (Blondie), 93 “Can You Tell Me How to Get to Sesame Street?”, 158 “Clocks” (Coldplay), 168 “Cold As Ice” (Foreigner), 159 “Cold” (Maroon 5), 170 “Colour My World” (Chicago), 147 “Could You Be Loved” (Bob Marley), 50, 162 “Creep” (Radiohead), 211 “Criminal” (Fiona Apple), 230 “Day Tripper” (Beatles), 172 “Dem Bow” (Shabba Ranks), 169 “Desire” (U2), 79, 165 “Despacito” (Luis Fonsi featuring Daddy Yankee), 169 “Disclosure” (Latch featuring Sam Smith), 23 “Don’t Know Why” (Norah Jones), 190 “Don’t Stop Believin”’ (Journey), 115 “Don’t Stop” (Fleetwood Mac), 114 “Don’t You (Forget About Me)” (Simple Minds), 79, 151 “Downtown” (Macklemore and Ryan Lewis), 173 466 “Dream On” (Aerosmith), 234 “Earth Angel” (The Penguins), 75 “Eye of the Tiger” (Survivor), 166 “Faith” (George Michael), 165 “Fancy” (Iggy Azalea featuring Charli XCX), 173 “Final Song” (MØ), 169 “Flashdance... What A Feeling” (Irene Cara), 77 “Fly Me to the Moon”, 59 “Forget You” (CeeLo Green), 191, 196 “Friend Like Me” (from Aladdin), 230 “Friends in Low Places” (Garth Brooks), 203 “Ghostbusters” (Ray Parker Jr.), 171 “Girl on Fire” (Alicia Keys), 33 “Girls Just Want to Have Fun” (Cyndi Lauper), 167 “Good Times” (Chic), 173 “Greatest Love of All” (Whitney Houston), 66 “Hard to Say I’m Sorry” (Chicago), 37 “Haven’t Met You Yet” (Michael Buble), 159 “Heart and Soul”, 75 “Heartbreaker” (Pat Benatar), 157 “Hello” (Adele), 81 “Hey Jude” (Beatles), 70, 78 “Hold My Hand” (Jess Glynne), 170 “Hotel California” (The Eagles), 77 “I Got Rhythm” (Gershwin), 120 “I Want Candy” (The Strangeloves), 165 “I Want You to Want Me” (Cheap Trick), 190, 196, 202 “I Want to Hold Your Hand” (Beatles), 43 “I Will Always Love You” (Whitney Houston), 76 “I Will Survive”, 59 INDEX “I’ll Be There For You” (The Rembrandts), 74 “I’m Yours” (Jason Mraz), 164 “I’m Every Woman” (Chaka Khan), 112 “I’m Not In Love” (10cc), 107 “If I Ain’t Got You” (Alicia Keys), 146 “Imagine” (John Lennon), 198 “Immigrant Song” (Led Zeppelin), 173 “Interstate Love Song” (Stone Temple Pilots), 234 “Irreplaceable” (Beyoncé), 112 “It’s the Hard Knock Life” (from Annie), 157 “Jar of Hearts” (Christina Perri), 235 “Johnny B. Goode” (Chuck Berry), 121 “Joy to the World” (Three Dog Night), 210 “Just Give Me a Reason” (Pink), 44 “Just the Way You Are” (Billy Joel), 202 “Let’s Get It On” (Marvin Gaye), 150 “Let’s Stay Together (Al Green)”, 23 “Lithium” (Nirvana), 211 “Little Brown Jug” (Glenn Miller), 172 “Livin’ on a Prayer” (Bon Jovi), 237 “London Bridge is Falling Down” (Count Basie), 379 “Love Song” (Sara Bareilles), 37, 160 “Love You Like A Love Song”, 59 “Love Yourself” (Justin Bieber), 49, 153 “Love on Top” (Beyoncé), 237 “Love on the Brain” (Rihanna), 147 “Maneater” (Hall and Oates), 154 “My Girl” (The Temptations), 112 “My Heart Will Go On” (from 467 Titanic), 89, 237, 251 “Never Gonna Give You Up” (Rick Astley), 67 “Never” (Heart), 151 “No Scrubs” (TLC), 54, 148 “O-o-h Child” (The Five Stairsteps), 52 “One Dance” (Drake), 169 “One Day I’ll Fly Away”, 214 “Part of Your World” (from The Little Mermaid), 210 “Party Rock Anthem” (LMFAO), 114, 171 “Pipeline” (The Chantays), 149 “Pompeii” (Bastille), 61 “Pretty Thing” (Bo Diddley), 165 “Problem” (Ariana Grande), 172 “Push It” (Salt-n-Pepa), 108 “Raise Your Glass” (Pink), 171 “Red Red Wine” (UB40), 163 “Reelin’ in the Years” (Steely Dan), 79 “Rock ‘n’ Roll High School” (The Ramones), 76 “Rolling In The Deep” (Adele), 83 “Roxanne” (The Police), 159 “Rude” (by MAGIC ), 76, 164, 168 “Saturday in the Park” (Chicago), 190 “Say You Won’t Let Go” (James Arthur), 153 “Secrets” (One Republic), 148 “See You Again (Wiz Khalifa ft. Charlie Puth)”, 116 “See You Again” (Wiz Khalifa ft. Charlie Puth), 152 “September” (Earth, Wind, and Fire), 66 “Shape of You” (Ed Sheeran), 168 “She’s Got a Way” (Billy Joel), 158 “She’s Out of My Life” (Michael Jackson), 122 “Silly Love Songs” (Wings), 91 “Sir Duke” (Stevie Wonder), 109 INDEX “Smells Like Teen Spirit” (Nirvana), 119 “Smoke on the Water” (Deep Purple), 155 “Some Nights” (fun.), 145 “Someday My Prince Will Come”, 120 “Someone Like You” (Adele), 80, 148 “Sorry” (Justin Bieber), 169 “Stairway to Heaven” (Led Zeppelin), 82, 233 “Star Dust” (Hoagy Carmichael), 121 “Starships” (Nicki Minaj), 172 “Stop In the Name of Love” (The Supremes), 101 “Stranger in Paradise”, 65 “Sunshine of Your Love” (Cream), 375 “Superfreak” (Rick James), 173 “Take Me to Church” (Hozier), 45 “Take the ‘A’ Train”, 61 “That’s What I Like” (Bruno Mars), 152 “The Long and Winding Road” (The Beatles), 53 “The Very Thought of You”, 107, 115 “Theme from New York, New York” (Liza Minnelli), 73 “Thinking Out Loud” (Ed Sheeran), 48, 150 “Tik Tok” (Kesha), 152, 172 “Toxic” (Britney Spears), 110 “Treat You Better” (Shawn Mendes), 167 “True Colors” (Cyndi Lauper), 46 “Umbrella” (Rihanna), 82 “Under Pressure” (Queen and David Bowie), 173 “Underneath It All” (No Doubt), 163 “Walk This Way” (Aerosmith), 174 “Walking On Sunshine” (Katrina and the Waves), 154 “Walking on the Moon” (The Police), 162 468 “Want to Want Me” (Jason Derulo), 88 “Warriors” (Too Many Zooz), 171 “We Are The World”, 118 “We Are Young” (fun.), 157 “We Are the Champions” (Queen), 205 “When I Fall In Love”, 120 “While My Guitar Gently Weeps” (The Beatles), 233 “White Christmas”, 120 “Why Do Fools Fall in Love”, 65 “Yesterday” (The Beatles), 189, 195 “You Can’t Hurry Love” (The Supremes), 154 “You Know You Like It” (Aluna George, DJ Snake Remix), 170 “You Really Got Me” (The Kinks), 173 spacing error, 312 species counterpoint definition of, 343 staff, 1 Star-Spangled Banner, 67, 145, 185 musical example, 43, 90, 216, 217 Straus, Joseph Introduction to Post-Tonal Theory, 392 Strauss, Richard Also Sprach Zarathustra, Op.30, 208 Stravinsky, Igor Petrushka, Fourth Tableau: The Shrovetide Fair (Toward Evening), 386, 390 Rite of Spring, “Dance of the Adolescents”, 389 Septet, 414 subtonic triad definition of, 42 in popular music in the major mode, 78 tonicization of, 194 sus2 chord, 36 sus4 chord, 36 sus9 chord, 36 INDEX suspension, 95 syncopation, 22 Tchaikovsky The Nutcracker “Miniature Overture”, 191, 295 “Waltz of the Flowers”, 214, 265 tempo, 20 tendency tones, 312 tenor clef, 2 terminative function definition of, 300 ternary form, 283 compound, 285 tetrachord, 5 texture, 143 thoroughbass, See figured bass tie, 19 time signature, 17 tonicization definition of, 191 transitional function definition of, 297 transposition definition of, 39 treble clef, 1 triad augmented, 32 definition of, 32 diminished, 32 inverted, 34 major, 32 minor, 32 triplet, 21 tuplet, 21 duplet, 21 quadruplet, 21 quintuplet, 21 triplet, 21 turnaround, 373 twelve-tone technique inversion, 409 prime form, 409 469 retrograde, 409 retrograde inversion, 409 two-reprise definition of, 276 unequal fifths definition of, 325 Vejvoda, Jaromír “Beer Barrel Polka”, 161 Verdi Rigoletto, “La donna è mobile”, 69, 191 Verse-Chorus form, 118 Vivaldi Concerto for Two Violins and Cello in D minor, RV 565, V., 325 voice leading definition of, 310 Wagner, Richard Das Rheingold, Scene 3, 254 Die Meistersinger, Act II, Scene 6, 58 Tristan und Isolde, Prelude to Act I, 46, 382 Webern, Anton 5 movements for string quartet No. 3. Sehr bewegt, 392 Williams, John Raiders of the Lost Ark, “Raiders March”, 222 Star Wars: Return of the Jedi, “Main Title (The Story Continues)”, 254 The Phantom Menace, “Duel of the Fates”, 255 Zimmer, Hans and Antonius Tom Holkenborg Batman v Superman: Dawn of Justice, “The Red Capes are Coming”, 223 Colophon This book was authored and produced with PreTeXt.